ATMEL AT91SAM7XC512-CU

Features
• Incorporates the ARM7TDMI® ARM® Thumb® Processor
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
– High-performance 32-bit RISC Architecture
– High-density 16-bit Instruction Set
– Leader in MIPS/Watt
– EmbeddedICE™ In-circuit Emulation, Debug Communication Channel Support
Internal High-speed Flash
– 512 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC512) Organized in Two Banks of 1024 Pages of 256 Bytes
(Dual Plane)
– 256 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC256) Organized in 1024 Pages of 256 Bytes (Single
Plane)
– 128 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC128) Organized in 512 Pages of 256 Bytes (Single Plane)
• Single Cycle Access at Up to 30 MHz in Worst Case Conditions
• Prefetch Buffer Optimizing Thumb Instruction Execution at Maximum Speed
• Page Programming Time: 6 ms, Including Page Auto-erase,
Full Erase Time: 15 ms
• 10,000 Write Cycles, 10-year Data Retention Capability,
Sector Lock Capabilities, Flash Security Bit
• Fast Flash Programming Interface for High Volume Production
Internal High-speed SRAM, Single-cycle Access at Maximum Speed
– 128 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC512)
– 64 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC256)
– 32 Kbytes (AT91SAM7XC128)
Memory Controller (MC)
– Embedded Flash Controller, Abort Status and Misalignment Detection
Reset Controller (RSTC)
– Based on Power-on Reset Cells and Low-power Factory-calibrated Brownout
Detector
– Provides External Reset Signal Shaping and Reset Source Status
Clock Generator (CKGR)
– Low-power RC Oscillator, 3 to 20 MHz On-chip Oscillator and one PLL
Power Management Controller (PMC)
– Power Optimization Capabilities, Including Slow Clock Mode (Down to 500 Hz) and
Idle Mode
– Four Programmable External Clock Signals
Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC)
– Individually Maskable, Eight-level Priority, Vectored Interrupt Sources
– Two External Interrupt Sources and One Fast Interrupt Source, Spurious Interrupt
Protected
Debug Unit (DBGU)
– 2-wire UART and Support for Debug Communication Channel interrupt,
Programmable ICE Access Prevention
– Mode for General Purpose 2-wire UART Serial Communication
Periodic Interval Timer (PIT)
– 20-bit Programmable Counter plus 12-bit Interval Counter
Windowed Watchdog (WDT)
– 12-bit Key-protected Programmable Counter
– Provides Reset or Interrupt Signals to the System
– Counter May Be Stopped While the Processor is in Debug State or in Idle Mode
AT91 ARM
Thumb-based
Microcontrollers
AT91SAM7XC512
AT91SAM7XC256
AT91SAM7XC128
Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• Real-time Timer (RTT)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
2
– 32-bit Free-running Counter with Alarm
– Runs Off the Internal RC Oscillator
Two Parallel Input/Output Controllers (PIO)
– Sixty-two Programmable I/O Lines Multiplexed with up to Two Peripheral I/Os
– Input Change Interrupt Capability on Each I/O Line
– Individually Programmable Open-drain, Pull-up Resistor and Synchronous Output
Seventeen Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) Channels
One Advanced Encryption System (AES)
– 256-, 192-, 128-bit Key Algorithm, Compliant with FIPS PUB 197 Specifications (AT91SAM7XC512)
– 128-bit Key Algorithm, Compliant with FIPS PUB 197 Specifications (AT91SAM7XC256/128)
– Buffer Encryption/Decryption Capabilities with PDC
One Triple Data Encryption System (TDES)
– Two-key or Three-key Algorithms, Compliant with FIPS PUB 46-3 Specifications
– Optimized for Triple Data Encryption Capability
One USB 2.0 Full Speed (12 Mbits per second) Device Port
– On-chip Transceiver, 1352-byte Configurable Integrated FIFOs
One Ethernet MAC 10/100 base-T
– Media Independent Interface (MII) or Reduced Media Independent Interface (RMII)
– Integrated 28-byte FIFOs and Dedicated DMA Channels for Transmit and Receive
One Part 2.0A and Part 2.0B Compliant CAN Controller
– Eight Fully-programmable Message Object Mailboxes, 16-bit Time Stamp Counter
One Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC)
– Independent Clock and Frame Sync Signals for Each Receiver and Transmitter
– I²S Analog Interface Support, Time Division Multiplex Support
– High-speed Continuous Data Stream Capabilities with 32-bit Data Transfer
Two Universal Synchronous/Asynchronous Receiver Transmitters (USART)
– Individual Baud Rate Generator, IrDA Infrared Modulation/Demodulation
– Support for ISO7816 T0/T1 Smart Card, Hardware Handshaking, RS485 Support
– Full Modem Line Support on USART1
Two Master/Slave Serial Peripheral Interfaces (SPI)
– 8- to 16-bit Programmable Data Length, Four External Peripheral Chip Selects
One Three-channel 16-bit Timer/Counter (TC)
– Three External Clock Inputs, Two Multi-purpose I/O Pins per Channel
– Double PWM Generation, Capture/Waveform Mode, Up/Down Capability
One Four-channel 16-bit Power Width Modulation Controller (PWMC)
One Two-wire Interface (TWI)
– Master Mode Support Only, All Two-wire Atmel EEPROMs and I2C Compatible Devices Supported
One 8-channel 10-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter, Four Channels Multiplexed with Digital I/Os
SAM-BA® Boot Assistant
– Default Boot program
– Interface with SAM-BA Graphic User Interface
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan on All Digital Pins
5V-tolerant I/Os, Including Four High-current Drive I/O lines, Up to 16 mA Each
Power Supplies
– Embedded 1.8V Regulator, Drawing up to 100 mA for the Core and External Components
– 3.3V VDDIO I/O Lines Power Supply, Independent 3.3V VDDFLASH Flash Power Supply
– 1.8V VDDCORE Core Power Supply with Brownout Detector
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• Fully Static Operation: Up to 55 MHz at 1.65V and 85° C Worst Case Conditions
• Available in 100-lead LQFP Green and 100-ball TFBGA Green Packages
3
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
1. Description
Atmel's AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 is a member of a series of highly integrated Flash microcontrollers based on the 32-bit ARM RISC processor. It features 512/256/128 Kbyte high-speed
Flash and 128/64/32 Kbyte SRAM, a large set of peripherals, including an 802.3 Ethernet MAC,
a CAN controller, an AES 128 Encryption accelerator and a Triple Data Encryption System. A
complete set of system functions minimizes the number of external components.
The embedded Flash memory can be programmed in-system via the JTAG-ICE interface or via
a parallel interface on a production programmer prior to mounting. Built-in lock bits and a security bit protect the firmware from accidental overwrite and preserve its confidentiality.
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 system controller includes a reset controller capable of managing the power-on sequence of the microcontroller and the complete system. Correct device
operation can be monitored by a built-in brownout detector and a watchdog running off an integrated RC oscillator.
By combining the ARM7TDMI processor with on-chip Flash and SRAM, and a wide range of
peripheral functions, including USART, SPI, CAN Controller, Ethernet MAC, AES 128 accelerator, TDES, Timer Counter, RTT and Analog-to-Digital Converters on a monolithic chip, the
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 is a powerful device that provides a flexible, cost-effective solution
to many embedded control applications requiring secure communication over, for example,
Ethernet, CAN wired and Zigbee™ wireless networks.
1.1
Configuration Summary of the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128
The AT91SAM7XC512, AT91SAM7XC256 and AT91SAM7XC128 differ only in memory sizes.
Table 1-1 summarizes the configurations of the two devices.
Table 1-1.
Configuration Summary
Device
Flash
Flash Organization
SRAM
AES
TDES
AT91SAM7XC512
512K bytes
dual plane
128K bytes
1 AES 256/192/128
1
AT91SAM7XC256
256K bytes
single plane
64K bytes
1 AES 128
1
AT91SAM7XC128
128K bytes
single plane
32K bytes
1 AES 128
1
4
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
2. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Block Diagram
Figure 2-1.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Block Diagram
TDI
TDO
TMS
TCK
ICE
JTAG
SCAN
ARM7TDMI
Processor
JTAGSEL
1.8 V
Voltage
Regulator
System Controller
TST
FIQ
VDDCORE
AIC
DRXD
DTXD
VDDIO
Memory Controller
PIO
IRQ0-IRQ1
DBGU
VDDIN
GND
VDDOUT
PDC
SRAM
Embedded
Flash
Controller
Address
Decoder
Abort
Status
Misalignment
Detection
128/64/32
Kbytes
PDC
PCK0-PCK3
PLLRC
PLL
XIN
XOUT
OSC
VDDFLASH
Flash
ERASE
512/256/128
Kbytes
PMC
RCOSC
Peripheral Bridge
VDDCORE
VDDFLASH
BOD
Peripheral DMA
Controller
VDDCORE
POR
Reset
Controller
ROM
PGMRDY
PGMNVALID
PGMNOE
PGMCK
PGMM0-PGMM3
PGMD0-PGMD15
PGMNCMD
PGMEN0-PGMEN1
Fast Flash
Programming
Interface
17 Channels
NRST
PIT
APB
SAM-BA
WDT
RTT
DMA
FIFO
PIOB
PIO
PIOA
Ethernet MAC 10/100
PDC
USART0
PDC
PDC
USB Device
USART1
PDC
Transceiver
VDDFLASH
FIFO
PWMC
PDC
PIO
PDC
SPI0
SSC
PDC
PDC
PIO
RXD0
TXD0
SCK0
RTS0
CTS0
RXD1
TXD1
SCK1
RTS1
CTS1
DCD1
DSR1
DTR1
RI1
SPI0_NPCS0
SPI0_NPCS1
SPI0_NPCS2
SPI0_NPCS3
SPI0_MISO
SPI0_MOSI
SPI0_SPCK
SPI1_NPCS0
SPI1_NPCS1
SPI1_NPCS2
SPI1_NPCS3
SPI1_MISO
SPI1_MOSI
SPI1_SPCK
ADTRG
AD0
AD1
AD2
AD3
AD4
AD5
AD6
AD7
ETXCK-ERXCK-EREFCK
ETXEN-ETXER
ECRS-ECOL, ECRSDV
ERXER-ERXDV
ERX0-ERX3
ETX0-ETX3
EMDC
EMDIO
EF100
PDC
Timer Counter
SPI1
TC0
PDC
PDC
TC1
TC2
TWI
ADC
CAN
DDM
DDP
PWM0
PWM1
PWM2
PWM3
TF
TK
TD
RD
RK
RF
TCLK0
TCLK1
TCLK2
TIOA0
TIOB0
TIOA1
TIOB1
TIOA2
TIOB2
TWD
TWCK
CANRX
CANTX
PDC
ADVREF
AES 128
PDC
PDC
TDES
PDC
5
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
3. Signal Description
Table 3-1.
Signal Name
Signal Description List
Function
Type
Active
Level
Comments
Power
VDDIN
Voltage Regulator and ADC Power
Supply Input
Power
3V to 3.6V
VDDOUT
Voltage Regulator Output
Power
1.85V
VDDFLASH
Flash and USB Power Supply
Power
3V to 3.6V
VDDIO
I/O Lines Power Supply
Power
3V to 3.6V
VDDCORE
Core Power Supply
Power
1.65V to 1.95V
VDDPLL
PLL
Power
1.65V to 1.95V
GND
Ground
Ground
Clocks, Oscillators and PLLs
XIN
Main Oscillator Input
XOUT
Main Oscillator Output
PLLRC
PLL Filter
PCK0 - PCK3
Programmable Clock Output
Input
Output
Input
Output
ICE and JTAG
TCK
Test Clock
Input
No pull-up resistor
TDI
Test Data In
Input
No pull-up resistor
TDO
Test Data Out
TMS
Test Mode Select
Input
No pull-up resistor
JTAGSEL
JTAG Selection
Input
Pull-down resistor(1)
Output
Flash Memory
Flash and NVM Configuration Bits Erase
Command
ERASE
Input
High
Pull-down resistor(1)
I/O
Low
Pull-Up resistor, Open Drain
Output.
Input
High
Pull-down resistor(1)
Reset/Test
NRST
Microcontroller Reset
TST
Test Mode Select
DRXD
Debug Receive Data
Input
DTXD
Debug Transmit Data
Output
IRQ0 - IRQ1
External Interrupt Inputs
Input
FIQ
Fast Interrupt Input
Input
Debug Unit
AIC
PIO
PA0 - PA30
Parallel IO Controller A
I/O
Pulled-up input at reset.
PB0 - PB30
Parallel IO Controller B
I/O
Pulled-up input at reset.
6
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 3-1.
Signal Description List (Continued)
Signal Name
Function
Type
Active
Level
Comments
USB Device Port
DDM
USB Device Port Data -
Analog
DDP
USB Device Port Data +
Analog
USART
SCK0 - SCK1
Serial Clock
I/O
TXD0 - TXD1
Transmit Data
I/O
RXD0 - RXD1
Receive Data
Input
RTS0 - RTS1
Request To Send
CTS0 - CTS1
Clear To Send
Input
DCD1
Data Carrier Detect
Input
DTR1
Data Terminal Ready
DSR1
Data Set Ready
Input
RI1
Ring Indicator
Input
Output
Output
Synchronous Serial Controller
TD
Transmit Data
Output
RD
Receive Data
Input
TK
Transmit Clock
I/O
RK
Receive Clock
I/O
TF
Transmit Frame Sync
I/O
RF
Receive Frame Sync
I/O
Timer/Counter
TCLK0 - TCLK2
External Clock Inputs
Input
TIOA0 - TIOA2
I/O Line A
I/O
TIOB0 - TIOB2
I/O Line B
I/O
PWM Controller
PWM0 - PWM3
PWM Channels
Output
Serial Peripheral Interface - SPIx
SPIx_MISO
Master In Slave Out
I/O
SPIx_MOSI
Master Out Slave In
I/O
SPIx_SPCK
SPI Serial Clock
I/O
SPIx_NPCS0
SPI Peripheral Chip Select 0
I/O
Low
SPIx_NPCS1-NPCS3
SPI Peripheral Chip Select 1 to 3
Output
Low
Two-wire Interface
TWD
Two-wire Serial Data
I/O
TWCK
Two-wire Serial Clock
I/O
7
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Table 3-1.
Signal Description List (Continued)
Signal Name
Function
Type
Active
Level
Comments
Analog-to-Digital Converter
AD0-AD3
Analog Inputs
Analog
Digital pulled-up inputs at reset.
AD4-AD7
Analog Inputs
Analog
Analog Inputs
ADTRG
ADC Trigger
ADVREF
ADC Reference
Input
Analog
Fast Flash Programming Interface
PGMEN0-PGMEN1
Programming Enabling
Input
PGMM0-PGMM3
Programming Mode
Input
PGMD0-PGMD15
Programming Data
I/O
PGMRDY
Programming Ready
Output
High
PGMNVALID
Data Direction
Output
Low
PGMNOE
Programming Read
Input
Low
PGMCK
Programming Clock
Input
PGMNCMD
Programming Command
Input
Low
CAN Controller
CANRX
CAN Input
CANTX
CAN Output
Input
Output
Ethernet MAC 10/100
EREFCK
Reference Clock
Input
RMII only
ETXCK
Transmit Clock
Input
MII only
ERXCK
Receive Clock
Input
MII only
ETXEN
Transmit Enable
Output
ETX0 - ETX3
Transmit Data
Output
ETX0 - ETX1 only in RMII
ETXER
Transmit Coding Error
Output
MII only
ERXDV
Receive Data Valid
Input
MII only
ECRSDV
Carrier Sense and Data Valid
Input
RMII only
ERX0 - ERX3
Receive Data
Input
ERX0 - ERX1 only in RMII
ERXER
Receive Error
Input
ECRS
Carrier Sense
Input
MII only
ECOL
Collision Detected
Input
MII only
EMDC
Management Data Clock
EMDIO
Management Data Input/Output
EF100
Force 100 Mbits/sec.
Note:
8
Output
I/O
Output
High
RMII only
1. Refer to Section 6. ”I/O Lines Considerations”.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
4. Package
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 is available in 100-lead LQFP Green and 100-ball TFBGA
RoHS-compliant packages.
4.1
100-lead LQFP Package Outline
Figure 4-1 shows the orientation of the 100-lead LQFP package. A detailed mechanical description is given in the Mechanical Characteristics section of the full datasheet.
Figure 4-1.
100-lead LQFP Package Outline (Top View)
75
51
76
50
100
26
1
25
9
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
4.2
100-lead LQFP Pinout
Table 4-1.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
10
Pinout in 100-lead LQFP Package
ADVREF
GND
AD4
AD5
AD6
AD7
VDDOUT
VDDIN
PB27/AD0
PB28/AD1
PB29/AD2
PB30/AD3
PA8/PGMM0
PA9/PGMM1
VDDCORE
GND
VDDIO
PA10/PGMM2
PA11/PGMM3
PA12/PGMD0
PA13/PGMD1
PA14/PGMD2
PA15/PGMD3
PA16/PGMD4
PA17/PGMD5
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
PA18/PGMD6
PB9
PB8
PB14
PB13
PB6
GND
VDDIO
PB5
PB15
PB17
VDDCORE
PB7
PB12
PB0
PB1
PB2
PB3
PB10
PB11
PA19/PGMD7
PA20/PGMD8
VDDIO
PA21/PGMD9
PA22/PGMD10
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
TDI
GND
PB16
PB4
PA23/PGMD11
PA24/PGMD12
NRST
TST
PA25/PGMD13
PA26/PGMD14
VDDIO
VDDCORE
PB18
PB19
PB20
PB21
PB22
GND
PB23
PB24
PB25
PB26
PA27/PGMD15
PA28
PA29
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
TDO
JTAGSEL
TMS
TCK
PA30
PA0/PGMEN0
PA1/PGMEN1
GND
VDDIO
PA3
PA2
VDDCORE
PA4/PGMNCMD
PA5/PGMRDY
PA6/PGMNOE
PA7/PGMNVALID
ERASE
DDM
DDP
VDDFLASH
GND
XIN/PGMCK
XOUT
PLLRC
VDDPLL
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
4.3
100-ball TFBGA Package Outline
Figure 4-2 shows the orientation of the 100-ball TFBGA package. A detailed mechanical
description is given in the Mechanical Characteristics section of the full datasheet.
Figure 4-2.
100-ball TFBGA Package Orientation (Top View)
TOP VIEW
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
A
BALL A1
4.4
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B10
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
100-ball TFBGA Pinout
Table 4-2.
Pin
B
Pinout in 100-ball TFBGA Package
Signal Name
PA22/PGMD10
PA21/PGMD9
PA20/PGMD8
PB1
PB7
PB5
PB8
PB9
PA18/PGMD6
VDDIO
TDI
PA19/PGMD7
PB11
PB2
PB12
PB15
PB14
PA14/PGMD2
PA16/PGMD4
PA17/PGMD5
PB16
PB4
PB10
PB3
PB0
Pin
C6
C7
C8
C9
C10
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
D10
E1
E2
E3
E4
E5
E6
E7
E8
E9
E10
Signal Name
PB17
PB13
PA13/PGMD1
PA12/PGMD0
PA15/PGMD3
PA23/PGMD11
PA24/PGMD12
NRST
TST
PB19
PB6
PA10/PGMM2
VDDIO
PB27/AD0
PA11/PGMM3
PA25/PGMD13
PA26/PGMD14
PB18
PB20
TMS
GND
VDDIO
PB28/AD1
VDDIO
GND
Pin
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F9
F10
G1
G2
G3
G4
G5
G6
G7
G8
G9
G10
H1
H2
H3
H4
H5
Signal Name
PB21
PB23
PB25
PB26
TCK
PA6/PGMNOE
ERASE
VDDCORE
GND
VDDIN
PB22
PB24
PA27/PGMD15
TDO
PA2
PA5/PGMRDY
VDDCORE
GND
PB30/AD3
VDDOUT
VDDCORE
PA28
JTAGSEL
PA3
PA4/PGMNCMD
Pin
H6
H7
H8
H9
H10
J1
J2
J3
J4
J5
J6
J7
J8
J9
J10
K1
K2
K3
K4
K5
K6
K7
K8
K9
K10
Signal Name
PA7/PGMNVALID
PA9/PGMM1
PA8/PGMM0
PB29/AD2
PLLRC
PA29
PA30
PA0/PGMEN0
PA1/PGMEN1
VDDFLASH
GND
XIN/PGMCK
XOUT
GND
VDDPLL
VDDCORE
VDDCORE
DDP
DDM
GND
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
ADVREF
11
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
5. Power Considerations
5.1
Power Supplies
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 has six types of power supply pins and integrates a voltage regulator, allowing the device to be supplied with only one voltage. The six power supply pin types
are:
• VDDIN pin. It powers the voltage regulator and the ADC; voltage ranges from 3.0V to 3.6V,
3.3V nominal. In order to decrease current consumption, if the voltage regulator and the ADC
are not used, VDDIN, ADVREF,AD4, AD5, AD6 and AD7 should be connected to GND. In this
case, VDDOUT should be left unconnected.
• VDDOUT pin. It is the output of the 1.8V voltage regulator.
• VDDIO pin. It powers the I/O lines; voltage ranges from 3.0V to 3.6V, 3.3V nominal.
• VDDFLASH pin. It powers the USB transceivers and a part of the Flash and is required for
the Flash to operate correctly; voltage ranges from 3.0V to 3.6V, 3.3V nominal.
• VDDCORE pins. They power the logic of the device; voltage ranges from 1.65V to 1.95V,
1.8V typical. It can be connected to the VDDOUT pin with decoupling capacitor. VDDCORE
is required for the device, including its embedded Flash, to operate correctly.
• VDDPLL pin. It powers the oscillator and the PLL. It can be connected directly to the
VDDOUT pin.
No separate ground pins are provided for the different power supplies. Only GND pins are provided and should be connected as shortly as possible to the system ground plane.
5.2
Power Consumption
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 has a static current of less than 60 µA on VDDCORE at 25°C,
including the RC oscillator, the voltage regulator and the power-on reset when the brownout
detector is deactivated. Activating the brownout detector adds 28 µA static current.
The dynamic power consumption on VDDCORE is less than 90 mA at full speed when running
out of the Flash. Under the same conditions, the power consumption on VDDFLASH does not
exceed 10 mA.
5.3
Voltage Regulator
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 embeds a voltage regulator that is managed by the System
Controller.
In Normal Mode, the voltage regulator consumes less than 100 µA static current and draws 100
mA of output current.
The voltage regulator also has a Low-power Mode. In this mode, it consumes less than 25 µA
static current and draws 1 mA of output current.
Adequate output supply decoupling is mandatory for VDDOUT to reduce ripple and avoid oscillations. The best way to achieve this is to use two capacitors in parallel: one external 470 pF (or
1 nF) NPO capacitor should be connected between VDDOUT and GND as close to the chip as
possible. One external 2.2 µF (or 3.3 µF) X7R capacitor should be connected between VDDOUT
and GND.
12
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Adequate input supply decoupling is mandatory for VDDIN in order to improve startup stability
and reduce source voltage drop. The input decoupling capacitor should be placed close to the
chip. For example, two capacitors can be used in parallel: 100 nF NPO and 4.7 µF X7R.
5.4
Typical Powering Schematics
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 supports a 3.3V single supply mode. The internal regulator
input connected to the 3.3V source and its output feeds VDDCORE and the VDDPLL. Figure 51 shows the power schematics to be used for USB bus-powered systems.
Figure 5-1.
3.3V System Single Power Supply Schematic
VDDFLASH
Power Source
ranges
from 4.5V (USB)
to 18V
DC/DC Converter
VDDIO
VDDIN
Voltage
Regulator
3.3V
VDDOUT
VDDCORE
VDDPLL
13
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
6. I/O Lines Considerations
6.1
JTAG Port Pins
TMS, TDI and TCK are schmitt trigger inputs and are not 5-V tolerant. TMS, TDI and TCK do not
integrate a pull-up resistor.
TDO is an output, driven at up to VDDIO, and has no pull-up resistor.
The JTAGSEL pin is used to select the JTAG boundary scan when asserted at a high level. The
JTAGSEL pin integrates a permanent pull-down resistor of about 15 kΩ.
To eliminate any risk of spuriously entering the JTAG boundary scan mode due to noise on
JTAGSEL, it should be tied externally to GND if boundary scan is not used, or pulled down with
an external low-value resistor (such as 1 kΩ) .
6.2
Test Pin
The TST pin is used for manufacturing test or fast programming mode of the
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 when asserted high. The TST pin integrates a permanent pull-down
resistor of about 15 kΩ to GND.
To eliminate any risk of entering the test mode due to noise on the TST pin, it should be tied to
GND if the FFPI is not used, or pulled down with an external low-value resistor (such as 1 kΩ) .
To enter fast programming mode, the TST pin and the PA0 and PA1 pins should be tied high
and PA2 tied to low.
Driving the TST pin at a high level while PA0 or PA1 is driven at 0 leads to unpredictable results.
6.3
Reset Pin
The NRST pin is bidirectional with an open drain output buffer. It is handled by the on-chip reset
controller and can be driven low to provide a reset signal to the external components or asserted
low externally to reset the microcontroller. There is no constraint on the length of the reset pulse,
and the reset controller can guarantee a minimum pulse length. This allows connection of a simple push-button on the NRST pin as system user reset, and the use of the signal NRST to reset
all the components of the system.
The NRST pin integrates a permanent pull-up resistor to VDDIO.
6.4
ERASE Pin
The ERASE pin is used to re-initialize the Flash content and some of its NVM bits. It integrates a
permanent pull-down resistor of about 15 kΩ to GND.
To eliminate any risk of erasing the Flash due to noise on the ERASE pin, it shoul be tied externally to GND, which prevents erasing the Flash from the applicatiion, or pulled down with an
external low-value resistor (such as 1 kΩ) .
This pin is debounced by the RC oscillator to improve the glitch tolerance. Minimum debouncing
time is 200 ms.
6.5
PIO Controller Lines
All the I/O lines, PA0 to PA30 and PB0 to PB30, are 5V-tolerant and all integrate a programmable pull-up resistor. Programming of this pull-up resistor is performed independently for each I/O
line through the PIO controllers.
14
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
5V-tolerant means that the I/O lines can drive voltage level according to VDDIO, but can be
driven with a voltage of up to 5.5V. However, driving an I/O line with a voltage over VDDIO while
the programmable pull-up resistor is enabled will create a current path through the pull-up resistor from the I/O line to VDDIO. Care should be taken, in particular at reset, as all the I/O lines
default to input with pull-up resistor enabled at reset.
6.6
I/O Lines Current Drawing
The PIO lines PA0 to PA3 are high-drive current capable. Each of these I/O lines can drive up to
16 mA permanently.
The remaining I/O lines can draw only 8 mA.
However, the total current drawn by all the I/O lines cannot exceed 200 mA.
15
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
7. Processor and Architecture
7.1
ARM7TDMI Processor
• RISC processor based on ARMv4T Von Neumann architecture
– Runs at up to 55 MHz, providing 0.9 MIPS/MHz
• Two instruction sets
– ARM® high-performance 32-bit instruction set
– Thumb® high code density 16-bit instruction set
• Three-stage pipeline architecture
– Instruction Fetch (F)
– Instruction Decode (D)
– Execute (E)
7.2
Debug and Test Features
• Integrated embedded in-circuit emulator
– Two watchpoint units
– Test access port accessible through a JTAG protocol
– Debug communication channel
• Debug Unit
– Two-pin UART
– Debug communication channel interrupt handling
– Chip ID Register
• IEEE1149.1 JTAG Boundary-scan on all digital pins
7.3
Memory Controller
• Programmable Bus Arbiter
– Handles requests from the ARM7TDMI, the Ethernet MAC and the Peripheral DMA
Controller
• Address decoder provides selection signals for
– Three internal 1 Mbyte memory areas
– One 256 Mbyte embedded peripheral area
• Abort Status Registers
– Source, Type and all parameters of the access leading to an abort are saved
– Facilitates debug by detection of bad pointers
• Misalignment Detector
– Alignment checking of all data accesses
– Abort generation in case of misalignment
• Remap Command
– Remaps the SRAM in place of the embedded non-volatile memory
– Allows handling of dynamic exception vectors
16
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• Embedded Flash Controller
– Embedded Flash interface, up to three programmable wait states
– Prefetch buffer, buffering and anticipating the 16-bit requests, reducing the required
wait states
– Key-protected program, erase and lock/unlock sequencer
– Single command for erasing, programming and locking operations
– Interrupt generation in case of forbidden operation
7.4
Peripheral DMA Controller
• Handles data transfer between peripherals and memories
• Seventeen channels
– Two for each USART
– Two for the Debug Unit
– Two for the Serial Synchronous Controller
– Two for each Serial Peripheral Interface
– Two for the Advanced Encryption Standard 128-bit accelerator
– Two for the Triple Data Encryption Standard 128-bit accelerator
– One for the Analog-to-digital Converter
• Low bus arbitration overhead
– One Master Clock cycle needed for a transfer from memory to peripheral
– Two Master Clock cycles needed for a transfer from peripheral to memory
• Next Pointer management for reducing interrupt latency requirements
17
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
8. Memory
8.1
AT91SAM7XC512
• 512 Kbytes of dual-plane Flash Memory
– 2 contiguous banks of 1024 pages of 256 bytes
– Fast access time, 30 MHz single-cycle access in Worst Case conditions
– Page programming time: 6 ms, including page auto-erase
– Page programming without auto-erase: 3 ms
– Full chip erase time: 15 ms
– 10,000 write cycles, 10-year data retention capability
– 32 lock bits, protecting 32 sectors of 64 pages
– Protection Mode to secure contents of the Flash
• 128 Kbytes of Fast SRAM
– Single-cycle access at full speed
8.2
AT91SAM7XC256
• 256 Kbytes of Flash Memory
– 1024 pages of 256 bytes
– Fast access time, 30 MHz single-cycle access in Worst Case conditions
– Page programming time: 6 ms, including page auto-erase
– Page programming without auto-erase: 3 ms
– Full chip erase time: 15 ms
– 10,000 write cycles, 10-year data retention capability
– 16 lock bits, each protecting 16 sectors of 64 pages
– Protection Mode to secure contents of the Flash
• 64 Kbytes of Fast SRAM
– Single-cycle access at full speed
8.3
AT91SAM7XC128
• 128 Kbytes of Flash Memory
– 512 pages of 256 bytes
– Fast access time, 30 MHz single-cycle access in Worst Case conditions
– Page programming time: 6 ms, including page auto-erase
– Page programming without auto-erase: 3 ms
– Full chip erase time: 15 ms
– 10,000 write cycles, 10-year data retention capability
– 8 lock bits, each protecting 8 sectors of 64 pages
– Protection Mode to secure contents of the Flash
• 32 Kbytes of Fast SRAM
– Single-cycle access at full speed
18
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 8-1.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Memory Mapping
Internal Memory Mapping
Note:
(1) Can be ROM, Flash or SRAM
depending on GPNVM2 and REMAP
0x0000 0000
Boot Memory (1)
Flash before Remap
SRAM after Remap
1 MBytes
Internal Flash
1 MBytes
Internal SRAM
1 MBytes
Internal ROM
1 MBytes
0x000F FFF
0x0010 0000
0x001F FFF
0x0020 0000
0x002F FFF
0x0030 0000
Address Memory Space
0x0000 0000
0x003F FFF
0x0040 0000
Internal Memories
256 MBytes
Reserved
252 MBytes
0x0FFF FFFF
0x0FFF FFFF
System Controller Mapping
0x1000 0000
0xFFFF F000
Peripheral Mapping
0xF000 0000
AIC
512 Bytes/128 registers
DBGU
512 Bytes/128 registers
PIOA
512 Bytes/128 registers
PIOB
512 Bytes/128 registers
Reserved
0xFFF9 FFFF
0xFFFA 0000
Undefined
(Abort)
14 x 256 MBytes
3,584 MBytes
0xFFFA 3FFF
0xFFFA 4000
0xFFFA 7FFF
0xFFFA 8000
0xFFFA BFFF
0xFFFA C000
0xFFFA FFFF
0xFFFB 0000
TC0, TC1, TC2
16 Kbytes
AES 128
16 Kbytes
TDES
16 Kbytes
0xFFFF F1FF
0xFFFF F200
0xFFFF F3FF
0xFFFF F400
Reserved
UDP
16 Kbytes
0xFFFB 3FFF
0xFFFB 4000
0xFFFF F5FF
0xFFFF F600
Reserved
0xFFFB 7FFF
0xFFFB 8000
0xFFFB BFFF
0xFFFB C000
0xEFFF FFFF
0xFFFB FFFF
0xFFFC 0000
0xF000 0000
0xFFFC 3FFF
0xFFFC 4000
Internal Peripherals
0xFFFF FFFF
256 MBytes
TWI
16 Kbytes
Reserved
Reserved
USART0
16 Kbytes
USART1
16 Kbytes
0xFFFC 7FFF
0xFFFC 8000
Reserved
0xFFFC BFFF
0xFFFC C000
PWMC
16 Kbytes
CAN
16 Kbytes
SSC
16 Kbytes
ADC
16 Kbytes
EMAC
16 Kbytes
SPI0
16 Kbytes
SPI1
16 Kbytes
0xFFFC FFFF
0xFFFD 0000
0xFFFD 3FFF
0xFFFD 4000
0xFFFD 7FFF
0xFFFD 8000
0xFFFD BFFF
0xFFFD C000
0xFFFD FFFF
0xFFFE 0000
0xFFFE 3FFF
0xFFFE 4000
0xFFFE 7FFF
0xFFFE 8000
0xFFFF FFFF
0xFFFF FBFF
0xFFFF FC00
0xFFFF FCFF
0xFFFF FD00
0xFFFF FD0F
PMC
256 Bytes/64 registers
RSTC
16 Bytes/4 registers
Reserved
0xFFFF FD20
0xFFFF FC2F
0xFFFF FD30
0xFFFF FC3F
0xFFFF FD40
0xFFFF FD4F
Reserved
0xFFFF EFFF
0xFFFE F000
0xFFFF F7FF
0xFFFF F800
RTT
16 Bytes/4 registers
PIT
16 Bytes/4 registers
WDT
16 Bytes/4 registers
Reserved
0xFFFF FD60
0xFFFF FC6F
0xFFFF FD70
0xFFFF FEFF
0xFFFF FF00
VREG
4 Bytes/1 register
Reserved
MC
256 Bytes/64 registers
SYSC
0xFFFF FFFF
19
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
8.4
8.4.1
Memory Mapping
Internal RAM
• The AT91SAM7XC512 embeds a high-speed 128-Kbyte SRAM bank.
• The AT91SAM7XC256 embeds a high-speed 64-Kbyte SRAM bank.
• The AT91SAM7XC128 embeds a high-speed 32-Kbyte SRAM bank.
After reset and until the Remap Command is performed, the SRAM is only accessible at address
0x0020 0000. After Remap, the SRAM also becomes available at address 0x0.
8.4.2
Internal ROM
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 embeds an Internal ROM. At any time, the ROM is mapped at
address 0x30 0000. The ROM contains the FFPI and the SAM-BA program.
8.4.3
Internal Flash
• The AT91SAM7XC512 features two banks (dual plane) of 256 Kbytes of Flash.
• The AT91SAM7XC256 features one bank (single plane) of 256 Kbytes of Flash.
• The AT91SAM7XC128 features one bank (single plane) of 128 Kbytes of Flash.
At any time, the Flash is mapped to address 0x0010 0000. It is also accessible at address 0x0
after the reset, if GPNVM bit 2 is set and before the Remap Command.
A general purpose NVM (GPNVM) bit is used to boot either on the ROM (default) or from the
Flash.
This GPNVM bit can be cleared or set respectively through the commands “Clear General-purpose NVM Bit” and “Set General-purpose NVM Bit” of the EFC User Interface.
Setting the GPNVM Bit 2 selects the boot from the Flash. Asserting ERASE clears the GPNVM
Bit 2 and thus selects the boot from the ROM by default.
Figure 8-2.
Internal Memory Mapping with GPNVM Bit 2 = 0 (default)
0x0000 0000
0x000F FFFF
ROM Before Remap
SRAM After Remap
1 M Bytes
0x0010 0000
Internal FLASH
1 M Bytes
Internal SRAM
1 M Bytes
Internal ROM
1 M Bytes
0x001F FFFF
0x0020 0000
256M Bytes
0x002F FFFF
0x0030 0000
0x003F FFFF
0x0040 0000
Undefined Areas
(Abort)
252 M Bytes
0x0FFF FFFF
20
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 8-3.
Internal Memory Mapping with GPNVM Bit 2 = 1
0x0000 0000
0x000F FFFF
Flash Before Remap
SRAM After Remap
1 M Bytes
0x0010 0000
Internal FLASH
1 M Bytes
Internal SRAM
1 M Bytes
Internal ROM
1 M Bytes
0x001F FFFF
0x0020 0000
256M Bytes
0x002F FFFF
0x0030 0000
0x003F FFFF
0x0040 0000
Undefined Areas
(Abort)
252 M Bytes
0x0FFF FFFF
8.5
Embedded Flash
8.5.1
Flash Overview
• The Flash of the AT91SAM7XC512 is organized in two banks (dual plane) 0f 1254 pages of
256 bytes. The 524, 288 bytes are organized in 32-bit words.
• The Flash of the AT91SAM7XC256 is organized in 1024 pages of 256 bytes (single plane). It
reads as 65,536 32-bit words.
• The Flash of the AT91SAM7XC128 is organized in 512 pages of 256 bytes (single plane). It
reads as 32,768 32-bit words.
The Flash contains a 256-byte write buffer, accessible through a 32-bit interface.
The Flash benefits from the integration of a power reset cell and from the brownout detector.
This prevents code corruption during power supply changes, even in the worst conditions.
When Flash is not used (read or write access), it is automatically placed into standby mode.
8.5.2
Embedded Flash Controller
The Embedded Flash Controller (EFC) manages accesses performed by the masters of the system. It enables reading the Flash and writing the write buffer. It also contains a User Interface,
mapped within the Memory Controller on the APB. The User Interface allows:
• programming of the access parameters of the Flash (number of wait states, timings, etc.)
• starting commands such as full erase, page erase, page program, NVM bit set, NVM bit
clear, etc.
• getting the end status of the last command
• getting error status
• programming interrupts on the end of the last commands or on errors
The Embedded Flash Controller also provides a dual 32-bit Prefetch Buffer that optimizes 16-bit
access to the Flash. This is particularly efficient when the processor is running in Thumb mode.
Two EFCs are embedded in the AT91SAM7XC512 to control each bank of 256 KBytes. Dualplane organization allows concurrent read and program functionality. Read from one memory
21
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
plane may be performed even while program or erase functions are being executed in the other
memory plane.
One EFC is embedded in the AT91SAM7XC256/128 to control the single plane of 256/128
KBytes.
8.5.3
8.5.3.1
Lock Regions
AT91SAM7XC512
Two Embedded Flash Controllers each manage 16 lock bits to protect 16 regions of the flash
against inadvertent flash erasing or programming commands. The AT91SAM7XC512 contains
32 lock regions and each lock region contains 64 pages of 256 bytes. Each lock region has a
size of 16 Kbytes.
If a locked-region’s erase or program command occurs, the command is aborted and the EFC
trigs an interrupt.
The 32 NVM bits are software programmable through both of the EFC User Interfaces. The command “Set Lock Bit” enables the protection. The command “Clear Lock Bit” unlocks the lock
region.
Asserting the ERASE pin clears the lock bits, thus unlocking the entire Flash.
8.5.3.2
AT91SAM7XC256
The Embedded Flash Controller manages 16 lock bits to protect 16 regions of the flash against
inadvertent flash erasing or programming commands. The AT91SAM7XC256 contains 16 lock
regions and each lock region contains 64 pages of 256 bytes. Each lock region has a size of 16
Kbytes.
If a locked-region’s erase or program command occurs, the command is aborted and the EFC
trigs an interrupt.
The 16 NVM bits are software programmable through the EFC User Interface. The command
“Set Lock Bit” enables the protection. The command “Clear Lock Bit” unlocks the lock region.
Asserting the ERASE pin clears the lock bits, thus unlocking the entire Flash.
8.5.3.3
AT91SAM7XC128
The Embedded Flash Controller manages 8 lock bits to protect 8 regions of the flash against
inadvertent flash erasing or programming commands. The AT91SAM7XC128 contains 8 lock
regions and each lock region contains 64 pages of 256 bytes. Each lock region has a size of 16
Kbytes.
If a locked-region’s erase or program command occurs, the command is aborted and the EFC
trigs an interrupt.
The 8 NVM bits are software programmable through the EFC User Interface. The command “Set
Lock Bit” enables the protection. The command “Clear Lock Bit” unlocks the lock region.
Asserting the ERASE pin clears the lock bits, thus unlocking the entire Flash.
8.5.4
22
Security Bit Feature
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 features a security bit, based on a specific NVM-Bit. When the
security is enabled, any access to the Flash, either through the ICE interface or through the Fast
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Flash Programming Interface, is forbidden. This ensures the confidentiality of the code programmed in the Flash.
This security bit can only be enabled, through the Command “Set Security Bit” of the EFC User
Interface. Disabling the security bit can only be achieved by asserting the ERASE pin at 1, and
after a full flash erase is performed. When the security bit is deactivated, all accesses to the
flash are permitted.
It is important to note that the assertion of the ERASE pin should always be longer than 220 ms.
As the ERASE pin integrates a permanent pull-down, it can be left unconnected during normal
operation. However, it is safer to connect it directly to GND for the final application.
8.5.5
Non-volatile Brownout Detector Control
Two general purpose NVM (GPNVM) bits are used for controlling the brownout detector (BOD),
so that even after a power loss, the brownout detector operations remain in their state.
These two GPNVM bits can be cleared or set respectively through the commands “Clear General-purpose NVM Bit” and “Set General-purpose NVM Bit” of the EFC User Interface.
• GPNVM Bit 0 is used as a brownout detector enable bit. Setting the GPNVM Bit 0 enables
the BOD, clearing it disables the BOD. Asserting ERASE clears the GPNVM Bit 0 and thus
disables the brownout detector by default.
• The GPNVM Bit 1 is used as a brownout reset enable signal for the reset controller. Setting
the GPNVM Bit 1 enables the brownout reset when a brownout is detected, Clearing the
GPNVM Bit 1 disables the brownout reset. Asserting ERASE disables the brownout reset by
default.
8.5.6
8.6
Calibration Bits
Eight NVM bits are used to calibrate the brownout detector and the voltage regulator. These bits
are factory configured and cannot be changed by the user. The ERASE pin has no effect on the
calibration bits.
Fast Flash Programming Interface
The Fast Flash Programming Interface allows programming the device through either a serial
JTAG interface or through a multiplexed fully-handshaked parallel port. It allows gang-programming with market-standard industrial programmers.
The FFPI supports read, page program, page erase, full erase, lock, unlock and protect
commands.
The Fast Flash Programming Interface is enabled and the Fast Programming Mode is entered
when the TST pin and the PA0 and PA1 pins are all tied high.
8.7
SAM-BA Boot Assistant
The SAM-BA Boot Assistant is a default Boot Program that provides an easy way to program insitu the on-chip Flash memory.
The SAM-BA Boot Assistant supports serial communication via the DBGU or the USB Device
Port.
• Communication via the DBGU supports a wide range of crystals from 3 to 20 MHz via
software auto-detection.
23
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• Communication via the USB Device Port is limited to an 18.432 MHz crystal.
The SAM-BA Boot provides an interface with SAM-BA Graphic User Interface (GUI).
The SAM-BA Boot is in ROM and is mapped at address 0x0 when the GPNVM Bit 2 is set to 0.
When GPNVM bit 2 is set to 1, the device boots from the Flash.
When GPNVM bit 2 is set to 0, the device boots from ROM (SAM-BA).
24
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
9. System Controller
The System Controller manages all vital blocks of the microcontroller: interrupts, clocks, power,
time, debug and reset.
The System Controller peripherals are all mapped to the highest 4 Kbytes of address space,
between addresses 0xFFFF F000 and 0xFFFF FFFF.
Figure 9-1 on page 26 shows the System Controller Block Diagram.
Figure 8-1 on page 19 shows the mapping of the User Interface of the System Controller peripherals. Note that the Memory Controller configuration user interface is also mapped within this
address space.
25
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 9-1.
System Controller Block Diagram
System Controller
jtag_nreset
Boundary Scan
TAP Controller
nirq
irq0-irq1
Advanced
Interrupt
Controller
fiq
periph_irq[2..19]
nfiq
proc_nreset
ARM7TDMI
PCK
int
debug
pit_irq
rtt_irq
wdt_irq
dbgu_irq
pmc_irq
rstc_irq
efc_irq
power_on_reset
force_ntrst
MCK
periph_nreset
dbgu_irq
Debug
Unit
force_ntrst
dbgu_txd
dbgu_rxd
security_bit
MCK
debug
periph_nreset
SLCK
power_on_reset
Periodic
Interval
Timer
pit_irq
Real-Time
Timer
rtt_irq
Watchdog
Timer
wdt_irq
flash_poe
cal
gpnvm[0]
flash_wrdis
BOD
power_on_reset
jtag_nreset
POR
efc_irq
bod_rst_en
proc_nreset
Reset
Controller
periph_nreset
proc_nreset
flash_poe
NRST
SLCK
XOUT
Voltage
Regulator
Mode
Controller
standby
Voltage
Regulator
cal
SLCK
MAINCK
Memory
Controller
MCK
rstc_irq
OSC
gpnvm[0..2]
wdt_fault
WDRPROC
gpnvm[1]
en
XIN
Embedded
Flash
cal
SLCK
debug
idle
proc_nreset
RCOSC
flash_wrdis
periph_clk[2..18]
Power
Management
Controller
UDPCK
pck[0-3]
periph_clk[11]
PCK
periph_nreset
UDPCK
USB Device
Port
periph_irq[11]
MCK
usb_suspend
PLLRC
PLL
PLLCK
pmc_irq
int
idle
periph_nreset
periph_clk[4..19]
usb_suspend
periph_nreset
irq0-irq1
periph_clk[2-3]
dbgu_rxd
Embedded
Peripherals
periph_irq{2-3]
periph_nreset
PIO
Controller
fiq
periph_irq[4..19]
dbgu_txd
in
PA0-PA30
PB0-PB30
26
out
enable
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
9.1
Reset Controller
• Based on one power-on reset cell and one brownout detector
• Status of the last reset, either Power-up Reset, Software Reset, User Reset, Watchdog
Reset, Brownout Reset
• Controls the internal resets and the NRST pin output
• Allows to shape a signal on the NRST line, guaranteeing that the length of the pulse meets
any requirement.
9.1.1
Brownout Detector and Power-on Reset
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 embeds one brownout detection circuit and a power-on reset
cell. The power-on reset is supplied with and monitors VDDCORE.
Both signals are provided to the Flash to prevent any code corruption during power-up or powerdown sequences or if brownouts occur on the power supplies.
The power-on reset cell has a limited-accuracy threshold at around 1.5V. Its output remains low
during power-up until VDDCORE goes over this voltage level. This signal goes to the reset controller and allows a full re-initialization of the device.
The brownout detector monitors the VDDCORE and VDDFLASH levels during operation by
comparing them to a fixed trigger level. It secures system operations in the most difficult environments and prevents code corruption in case of brownout on the VDDCORE or VDDFLASH.
When the brownout detector is enabled and VDDCORE decreases to a value below the trigger
level (Vbot18-, defined as Vbot18 - hyst/2), the brownout output is immediately activated.
When VDDCORE increases above the trigger level (Vbot18+, defined as Vbot18 + hyst/2), the
reset is released. The brownout detector only detects a drop if the voltage on VDDCORE stays
below the threshold voltage for longer than about 1µs.
The VDDCORE threshold voltage has a hysteresis of about 50 mV, to ensure spike free brownout detection. The typical value of the brownout detector threshold is 1.68V with an accuracy of
± 2% and is factory calibrated.
When the brownout detector is enabled and VDDFLASH decreases to a value below the trigger
level (Vbot33-, defined as Vbot33 - hyst/2), the brownout output is immediately activated.
When VDDFLASH increases above the trigger level (Vbot33+, defined as Vbot33 + hyst/2), the
reset is released. The brownout detector only detects a drop if the voltage on VDDCORE stays
below the threshold voltage for longer than about 1µs.
The VDDFLASH threshold voltage has a hysteresis of about 50 mV, to ensure spike free brownout detection. The typical value of the brownout detector threshold is 2.80V with an accuracy of
± 3.5% and is factory calibrated.
The brownout detector is low-power, as it consumes less than 28 µA static current. However, it
can be deactivated to save its static current. In this case, it consumes less than 1µA. The deactivation is configured through the GPNVM bit 0 of the Flash.
27
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
9.2
Clock Generator
The Clock Generator embeds one low-power RC Oscillator, one Main Oscillator and one PLL
with the following characteristics:
• RC Oscillator ranges between 22 KHz and 42 KHz
• Main Oscillator frequency ranges between 3 and 20 MHz
• Main Oscillator can be bypassed
• PLL output ranges between 80 and 200 MHz
It provides SLCK, MAINCK and PLLCK.
Figure 9-2.
Clock Generator Block Diagram
Clock Generator
XIN
Embedded
RC
Oscillator
Slow Clock
SLCK
Main
Oscillator
Main Clock
MAINCK
PLL and
Divider
PLL Clock
PLLCK
XOUT
PLLRC
Status
Control
Power
Management
Controller
28
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
9.3
Power Management Controller
The Power Management Controller uses the Clock Generator outputs to provide:
• the Processor Clock PCK
• the Master Clock MCK
• the USB Clock UDPCK
• all the peripheral clocks, independently controllable
• four programmable clock outputs
The Master Clock (MCK) is programmable from a few hundred Hz to the maximum operating frequency of the device.
The Processor Clock (PCK) switches off when entering processor idle mode, thus allowing
reduced power consumption while waiting for an interrupt.
Figure 9-3.
Power Management Controller Block Diagram
Processor
Clock
Controller
Master Clock Controller
SLCK
MAINCK
PLLCK
PCK
int
Idle Mode
Prescaler
/1,/2,/4,...,/64
MCK
Peripherals
Clock Controller
periph_clk[2..18]
ON/OFF
Programmable Clock Controller
SLCK
MAINCK
PLLCK
Prescaler
/1,/2,/4,...,/64
pck[0..3]
USB Clock Controller
ON/OFF
PLLCK
9.4
Divider
/1,/2,/4
UDPCK
Advanced Interrupt Controller
• Controls the interrupt lines (nIRQ and nFIQ) of an ARM Processor
• Individually maskable and vectored interrupt sources
– Source 0 is reserved for the Fast Interrupt Input (FIQ)
– Source 1 is reserved for system peripherals (RTT, PIT, EFC, PMC, DBGU, etc.)
– Other sources control the peripheral interrupts or external interrupts
– Programmable edge-triggered or level-sensitive internal sources
– Programmable positive/negative edge-triggered or high/low level-sensitive external
sources
• 8-level Priority Controller
– Drives the normal interrupt nIRQ of the processor
– Handles priority of the interrupt sources
29
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
– Higher priority interrupts can be served during service of lower priority interrupt
• Vectoring
– Optimizes interrupt service routine branch and execution
– One 32-bit vector register per interrupt source
– Interrupt vector register reads the corresponding current interrupt vector
• Protect Mode
– Easy debugging by preventing automatic operations
• Fast Forcing
– Permits redirecting any interrupt source on the fast interrupt
• General Interrupt Mask
– Provides processor synchronization on events without triggering an interrupt
9.5
Debug Unit
• Comprises:
– One two-pin UART
– One Interface for the Debug Communication Channel (DCC) support
– One set of Chip ID Registers
– One Interface providing ICE Access Prevention
• Two-pin UART
– USART-compatible User Interface
– Programmable Baud Rate Generator
– Parity, Framing and Overrun Error
– Automatic Echo, Local Loopback and Remote Loopback Channel Modes
• Debug Communication Channel Support
– Offers visibility of COMMRX and COMMTX signals from the ARM Processor
• Chip ID Registers
– Identification of the device revision, sizes of the embedded memories, set of
peripherals
– Chip ID is 0x271C 0A40 (VERSION 0) for AT91SAM7XC512
– Chip ID is 0x271B 0940 (VERSION 0) for AT91SAM7XC256
– Chip ID is 0x271A 0740 (VERSION 0) for AT91SAM7XC128
9.6
Periodic Interval Timer
• 20-bit programmable counter plus 12-bit interval counter
9.7
Watchdog Timer
• 12-bit key-protected Programmable Counter running on prescaled SLCK
• Provides reset or interrupt signals to the system
• Counter may be stopped while the processor is in debug state or in idle mode
9.8
Real-time Timer
• 32-bit free-running counter with alarm running on prescaled SLCK
30
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• Programmable 16-bit prescaler for SLCK accuracy compensation
9.9
PIO Controllers
• Two PIO Controllers, each controlling 31 I/O lines
• Fully programmable through set/clear registers
• Multiplexing of two peripheral functions per I/O line
• For each I/O line (whether assigned to a peripheral or used as general-purpose I/O)
– Input change interrupt
– Half a clock period glitch filter
– Multi-drive option enables driving in open drain
– Programmable pull-up on each I/O line
– Pin data status register, supplies visibility of the level on the pin at any time
• Synchronous output, provides Set and Clear of several I/O lines in a single write
9.10
Voltage Regulator Controller
The purpose of this controller is to select the Power Mode of the Voltage Regulator between
Normal Mode (bit 0 is cleared) or Standby Mode (bit 0 is set).
31
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
10. Peripherals
10.1
User Interface
The User Peripherals are mapped in the 256 MBytes of address space between 0xF000 0000
and 0xFFFE FFFF. Each peripheral is allocated 16 Kbytes of address space.
A complete memory map is provided in Figure 8-1 on page 19.
10.2
Peripheral Identifiers
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 embeds a wide range of peripherals. Table 10-1 defines the
Peripheral Identifiers of the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128. Unique peripheral identifiers are
defined for both the Advanced Interrupt Controller and the Power Management Controller.
Table 10-1.
Peripheral ID
Peripheral Mnemonic
Peripheral Name
External
Interrupt
0
AIC
Advanced Interrupt Controller
FIQ
(1)
1
SYSC
System
2
PIOA
Parallel I/O Controller A
3
PIOB
Parallel I/O Controller B
4
SPI0
Serial Peripheral Interface 0
5
SPI1
Serial Peripheral Interface 1
6
US0
USART 0
7
US1
USART 1
8
SSC
Synchronous Serial Controller
9
TWI
Two-wire Interface
10
PWMC
Pulse Width Modulation Controller
11
UDP
USB device Port
12
TC0
Timer/Counter 0
13
TC1
Timer/Counter 1
14
TC2
Timer/Counter 2
15
CAN
CAN Controller
16
EMAC
17
ADC
(1)
18
AES
Advanced Encryption Standard 128-bit
19
TDES
Triple Data Encryption Standard
20-29
Reserved
30
AIC
Advanced Interrupt Controller
IRQ0
31
AIC
Advanced Interrupt Controller
IRQ1
Note:
32
Peripheral Identifiers
Ethernet MAC
Analog-to Digital Converter
1. Setting SYSC and ADC bits in the clock set/clear registers of the PMC has no effect. The System Controller and ADC are continuously clocked.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
10.3
Peripheral Multiplexing on PIO Lines
The AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 features two PIO controllers, PIOA and PIOB, that multiplex the
I/O lines of the peripheral set.
Each PIO Controller controls 31 lines. Each line can be assigned to one of two peripheral functions, A or B. Some of them can also be multiplexed with the analog inputs of the ADC
Controller.
Table 10-2 on page 34 and Table 10-3 on page 35 defines how the I/O lines of the peripherals A,
B or the analog inputs are multiplexed on the PIO Controller A and PIO Controller B. The two
columns “Function” and “Comments” have been inserted for the user’s own comments; they may
be used to track how pins are defined in an application.
Note that some peripheral functions that are output only, may be duplicated in the table.
At reset, all I/O lines are automatically configured as input with the programmable pull-up
enabled, so that the device is maintained in a static state as soon as a reset is detected.
33
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
10.4
PIO Controller A Multiplexing
Table 10-2.
Multiplexing on PIO Controller A
PIO Controller A
34
Peripheral B
Application Usage
I/O Line
Peripheral A
Comments
PA0
RXD0
High-Drive
PA1
TXD0
High-Drive
PA2
SCK0
SPI1_NPCS1
High-Drive
PA3
RTS0
SPI1_NPCS2
High-Drive
PA4
CTS0
SPI1_NPCS3
PA5
RXD1
PA6
TXD1
PA7
SCK1
SPI0_NPCS1
PA8
RTS1
SPI0_NPCS2
PA9
CTS1
SPI0_NPCS3
PA10
TWD
PA11
TWCK
PA12
SPI_NPCS0
PA13
SPI0_NPCS1
PCK1
PA14
SPI0_NPCS2
IRQ1
PA15
SPI0_NPCS3
TCLK2
PA16
SPI0_MISO
PA17
SPI0_MOSI
PA18
SPI0_SPCK
PA19
CANRX
PA20
CANTX
PA21
TF
SPI1_NPCS0
PA22
TK
SPI1_SPCK
PA23
TD
SPI1_MOSI
PA24
RD
SPI1_MISO
PA25
RK
SPI1_NPCS1
PA26
RF
SPI1_NPCS2
PA27
DRXD
PCK3
PA28
DTXD
PA29
FIQ
SPI1_NPCS3
PA30
IRQ0
PCK2
Function
Comments
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
10.5
PIO Controller B Multiplexing
Table 10-3.
Multiplexing on PIO Controller B
PIO Controller B
Application Usage
I/O Line
Peripheral A
Peripheral B
Comments
PB0
ETXCK/EREFCK
PCK0
PB1
ETXEN
PB2
ETX0
PB3
ETX1
PB4
ECRS
PB5
ERX0
PB6
ERX1
PB7
ERXER
PB8
EMDC
PB9
EMDIO
PB10
ETX2
SPI1_NPCS1
PB11
ETX3
SPI1_NPCS2
PB12
ETXER
TCLK0
PB13
ERX2
SPI0_NPCS1
PB14
ERX3
SPI0_NPCS2
PB15
ERXDV/ECRSDV
PB16
ECOL
SPI1_NPCS3
PB17
ERXCK
SPI0_NPCS3
PB18
EF100
ADTRG
PB19
PWM0
TCLK1
PB20
PWM1
PCK0
PB21
PWM2
PCK1
PB22
PWM3
PCK2
PB23
TIOA0
DCD1
PB24
TIOB0
DSR1
PB25
TIOA1
DTR1
PB26
TIOB1
RI1
PB27
TIOA2
PWM0
AD0
PB28
TIOB2
PWM1
AD1
PB29
PCK1
PWM2
AD2
PB30
PCK2
PWM3
AD3
Function
Comments
35
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
10.6
Ethernet MAC
• DMA Master on Receive and Transmit Channels
• Compatible with IEEE Standard 802.3
• 10 and 100 Mbit/s operation
• Full- and half-duplex operation
• Statistics Counter Registers
• MII/RMII interface to the physical layer
• Interrupt generation to signal receive and transmit completion
• 28-byte transmit FIFO and 28-byte receive FIFO
• Automatic pad and CRC generation on transmitted frames
• Automatic discard of frames received with errors
• Address checking logic supports up to four specific 48-bit addresses
• Support Promiscuous Mode where all valid received frames are copied to memory
• Hash matching of unicast and multicast destination addresses
• Physical layer management through MDIO interface
• Half-duplex flow control by forcing collisions on incoming frames
• Full-duplex flow control with recognition of incoming pause frames
• Support for 802.1Q VLAN tagging with recognition of incoming VLAN and priority tagged
frames
• Multiple buffers per receive and transmit frame
• Jumbo frames up to 10240 bytes supported
10.7
Serial Peripheral Interface
• Supports communication with external serial devices
– Four chip selects with external decoder allow communication with up to 15
peripherals
– Serial memories, such as DataFlash® and 3-wire EEPROMs
– Serial peripherals, such as ADCs, DACs, LCD Controllers, CAN Controllers and
Sensors
– External co-processors
• Master or slave serial peripheral bus interface
– 8- to 16-bit programmable data length per chip select
– Programmable phase and polarity per chip select
– Programmable transfer delays per chip select, between consecutive transfers and
between clock and data
– Programmable delay between consecutive transfers
– Selectable mode fault detection
– Maximum frequency at up to Master Clock
36
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
10.8
Two-wire Interface
• Master Mode only
• Compatibility with I2C compatible devices (refer to the TWI section of the datasheet)
• One, two or three bytes internal address registers for easy Serial Memory access
• 7-bit or 10-bit slave addressing
• Sequential read/write operations
10.9
USART
• Programmable Baud Rate Generator
• 5- to 9-bit full-duplex synchronous or asynchronous serial communications
– 1, 1.5 or 2 stop bits in Asynchronous Mode
– 1 or 2 stop bits in Synchronous Mode
– Parity generation and error detection
– Framing error detection, overrun error detection
– MSB or LSB first
– Optional break generation and detection
– By 8 or by 16 over-sampling receiver frequency
– Hardware handshaking RTS - CTS
– Modem Signals Management DTR-DSR-DCD-RI on USART1
– Receiver time-out and transmitter timeguard
– Multi-drop Mode with address generation and detection
• RS485 with driver control signal
• ISO7816, T = 0 or T = 1 Protocols for interfacing with smart cards
– NACK handling, error counter with repetition and iteration limit
• IrDA modulation and demodulation
– Communication at up to 115.2 Kbps
• Test Modes
– Remote Loopback, Local Loopback, Automatic Echo
10.10 Serial Synchronous Controller
• Provides serial synchronous communication links used in audio and telecom applications
• Contains an independent receiver and transmitter and a common clock divider
• Offers a configurable frame sync and data length
• Receiver and transmitter can be programmed to start automatically or on detection of
different event on the frame sync signal
• Receiver and transmitter include a data signal, a clock signal and a frame synchronization
signal
37
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
10.11 Timer Counter
• Three 16-bit Timer Counter Channels
– Two output compare or one input capture per channel
• Wide range of functions including:
– Frequency measurement
– Event counting
– Interval measurement
– Pulse generation
– Delay timing
– Pulse Width Modulation
– Up/down capabilities
• Each channel is user-configurable and contains:
– Three external clock inputs
• Five internal clock inputs, as defined in Table 10-4
Table 10-4.
Timer Counter Clocks Assignment
TC Clock input
Clock
TIMER_CLOCK1
MCK/2
TIMER_CLOCK2
MCK/8
TIMER_CLOCK3
MCK/32
TIMER_CLOCK4
MCK/128
TIMER_CLOCK5
MCK/1024
– Two multi-purpose input/output signals
– Two global registers that act on all three TC channels
10.12 Pulse Width Modulation Controller
• Four channels, one 16-bit counter per channel
• Common clock generator, providing thirteen different clocks
– One Modulo n counter providing eleven clocks
– Two independent linear dividers working on modulo n counter outputs
• Independent channel programming
– Independent enable/disable commands
– Independent clock selection
– Independent period and duty cycle, with double buffering
– Programmable selection of the output waveform polarity
– Programmable center or left aligned output waveform
38
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
10.13 USB Device Port
• USB V2.0 full-speed compliant,12 Mbits per second
• Embedded USB V2.0 full-speed transceiver
• Embedded 1352-byte dual-port RAM for endpoints
• Six endpoints
– Endpoint 0: 8 bytes
– Endpoint 1 and 2: 64 bytes ping-pong
– Endpoint 3: 64 bytes
– Endpoint 4 and 5: 256 bytes ping-pong
– Ping-pong Mode (two memory banks) for bulk endpoints
• Suspend/resume logic
10.14 CAN Controller
•
Fully compliant with CAN 2.0A and 2.0B
•
Bit rates up to 1Mbit/s
•
Eight object oriented mailboxes each with the following properties:
– CAN Specification 2.0 Part A or 2.0 Part B Programmable for each Message
– Object configurable to receive (with overwrite or not) or transmit
– Local tag and mask filters up to 29-bit identifier/channel
– 32-bit access to data registers for each mailbox data object
– Uses a 16-bit time stamp on receive and transmit message
– Hardware concatenation of ID unmasked bitfields to speedup family ID processing
– 16-bit internal timer for time stamping and network synchronization
– Programmable reception buffer length up to 8 mailbox objects
– Priority management between transmission mailboxes
– Autobaud and listening mode
– Low power mode and programmable wake-up on bus activity or by the application
– Data, remote, error and overload frame handling
10.15 128-bit Advanced Encryption Standard
• Compliant with FIPS Publication 197, Advanced Encryption Standard (AES)
• 128-bit (AT91SAM7XC256/128) or 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit (AT91SAM7XC512) Cryptographic
Key
• 12-clock Cycles Encryption/Decryption Processing Time (AT91SAM7XC256/128)
• 12/13/14-clock Cycles Encryption/Decryption Processing Time (AT91SAM7XC512)
• Support of the Five Standard Modes of Operation specified in the NIST Special Publication
800-38A:
– Electronic Codebook (ECB)
– Cipher Block Chaining (CBC)
– Cipher Feedback (CFB)
– Output Feedback (OFB)
39
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
– Counter (CTR)
• 8-, 16-, 32-, 64- and 128-bit Data Sizes Possible in CFB Mode
• Last Output Data Mode allowing Message Authentication Code (MAC) generation
• Hardware Countermeasures against Differential Power Analysis attacks
• Connection to PDC Channel Capabilities Optimizes Data Transfers for all Operating Modes:
– One Channel for the Receiver, One Channel for the Transmitter
– Next Buffer Support
10.16 Triple Data Encryption Standard
• Single Data Encryption Standard (DES) and Triple Data Encryption
• Algorithm (TDEA or TDES) supports
• Compliant with FIPS Publication 46-3, Data Encryption Standard (DES)
• 64-bit Cryptographic Key
• Two-key or Three-key Algorithms
• 18-clock Cycles Encryption/Decryption Processing Time for DES
• 50-clock Cycles Encryption/Decryption Processing Time for TDES
• Support the Four Standard Modes of Operation specified in the FIPS Publication 81, DES
• Modes of Operation:
– Electronic Codebook (ECB)
– Cipher Block Chaining (CBC)
– Cipher Feedback (CFB)
– Output Feedback (OFB)
• 8-, 16-, 32- and 64- Data Sizes Possible in CFB Mode
• Last Output Data Mode allowing Optimized Message (Data) Authentication Code (MAC)
generation
• Connection to PDC Channel Capabilities Optimizes Data Transfers for all Operating Modes:
– One Channel for the Receiver, One Channel for the Transmitter
– Next Buffer Support
10.17 Analog-to-Digital Converter
• 8-channel ADC
• 10-bit 384 Ksamples/sec. Successive Approximation Register ADC
• ±2 LSB Integral Non Linearity, ±1 LSB Differential Non Linearity
• Integrated 8-to-1 multiplexer, offering eight independent 3.3V analog inputs
• External voltage reference for better accuracy on low voltage inputs
• Individual enable and disable of each channel
• Multiple trigger sources
– Hardware or software trigger
– External trigger pin
– Timer Counter 0 to 2 outputs TIOA0 to TIOA2 trigger
• Sleep Mode and conversion sequencer
40
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
– Automatic wakeup on trigger and back to sleep mode after conversions of all
enabled channels
• Four of eight analog inputs shared with digital signals
41
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
42
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
11. ARM7TDMI Processor Overview
11.1
Overview
The ARM7TDMI core executes both the 32-bit ARM® and 16-bit Thumb® instruction sets, allowing the user to trade off between high performance and high code density.The ARM7TDMI
processor implements Von Neuman architecture, using a three-stage pipeline consisting of
Fetch, Decode, and Execute stages.
The main features of the ARM7tDMI processor are:
• ARM7TDMI Based on ARMv4T Architecture
• Two Instruction Sets
– ARM® High-performance 32-bit Instruction Set
– Thumb® High Code Density 16-bit Instruction Set
• Three-Stage Pipeline Architecture
– Instruction Fetch (F)
– Instruction Decode (D)
– Execute (E)
43
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
11.2
ARM7TDMI Processor
For further details on ARM7TDMI, refer to the following ARM documents:
ARM Architecture Reference Manual (DDI 0100E)
ARM7TDMI Technical Reference Manual (DDI 0210B)
11.2.1
Instruction Type
Instructions are either 32 bits long (in ARM state) or 16 bits long (in THUMB state).
11.2.2
Data Type
ARM7TDMI supports byte (8-bit), half-word (16-bit) and word (32-bit) data types. Words must be
aligned to four-byte boundaries and half words to two-byte boundaries.
Unaligned data access behavior depends on which instruction is used where.
11.2.3
ARM7TDMI Operating Mode
The ARM7TDMI, based on ARM architecture v4T, supports seven processor modes:
User: The normal ARM program execution state
FIQ: Designed to support high-speed data transfer or channel process
IRQ: Used for general-purpose interrupt handling
Supervisor: Protected mode for the operating system
Abort mode: Implements virtual memory and/or memory protection
System: A privileged user mode for the operating system
Undefined: Supports software emulation of hardware coprocessors
Mode changes may be made under software control, or may be brought about by external interrupts or exception processing. Most application programs execute in User mode. The non-user
modes, or privileged modes, are entered in order to service interrupts or exceptions, or to
access protected resources.
11.2.4
ARM7TDMI Registers
The ARM7TDMI processor has a total of 37registers:
• 31 general-purpose 32-bit registers
• 6 status registers
These registers are not accessible at the same time. The processor state and operating mode
determine which registers are available to the programmer.
At any one time 16 registers are visible to the user. The remainder are synonyms used to speed
up exception processing.
Register 15 is the Program Counter (PC) and can be used in all instructions to reference data
relative to the current instruction.
R14 holds the return address after a subroutine call.
R13 is used (by software convention) as a stack pointer.
44
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 11-1.
ARM7TDMI ARM Modes and Registers Layout
User and
System Mode
Supervisor
Mode
Abort Mode
Undefined
Mode
Interrupt
Mode
Fast Interrupt
Mode
R0
R0
R0
R0
R0
R0
R1
R1
R1
R1
R1
R1
R2
R2
R2
R2
R2
R2
R3
R3
R3
R3
R3
R3
R4
R4
R4
R4
R4
R4
R5
R5
R5
R5
R5
R5
R6
R6
R6
R6
R6
R6
R7
R7
R7
R7
R7
R7
R8
R8
R8
R8
R8
R8_FIQ
R9
R9
R9
R9
R9
R9_FIQ
R10
R10
R10
R10
R10
R10_FIQ
R11
R11
R11
R11
R11
R11_FIQ
R12
R12
R12
R12
R12
R12_FIQ
R13
R13_SVC
R13_ABORT
R13_UNDEF
R13_IRQ
R13_FIQ
R14
R14_SVC
R14_ABORT
R14_UNDEF
R14_IRQ
R14_FIQ
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
PC
CPSR
CPSR
CPSR
CPSR
CPSR
CPSR
SPSR_SVC
SPSR_ABORT
SPSR_UNDEF
SPSR_IRQ
SPSR_FIQ
Mode-specific banked registers
Registers R0 to R7 are unbanked registers. This means that each of them refers to the same 32bit physical register in all processor modes. They are general-purpose registers, with no special
uses managed by the architecture, and can be used wherever an instruction allows a generalpurpose register to be specified.
Registers R8 to R14 are banked registers. This means that each of them depends on the current
mode of the processor.
11.2.4.1
Modes and Exception Handling
All exceptions have banked registers for R14 and R13.
After an exception, R14 holds the return address for exception processing. This address is used
to return after the exception is processed, as well as to address the instruction that caused the
exception.
R13 is banked across exception modes to provide each exception handler with a private stack
pointer.
The fast interrupt mode also banks registers 8 to 12 so that interrupt processing can begin without having to save these registers.
45
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
A seventh processing mode, System Mode, does not have any banked registers. It uses the
User Mode registers. System Mode runs tasks that require a privileged processor mode and
allows them to invoke all classes of exceptions.
11.2.4.2
Status Registers
All other processor states are held in status registers. The current operating processor status is
in the Current Program Status Register (CPSR). The CPSR holds:
• four ALU flags (Negative, Zero, Carry, and Overflow)
• two interrupt disable bits (one for each type of interrupt)
• one bit to indicate ARM or Thumb execution
• five bits to encode the current processor mode
All five exception modes also have a Saved Program Status Register (SPSR) that holds the
CPSR of the task immediately preceding the exception.
11.2.4.3
Exception Types
The ARM7TDMI supports five types of exception and a privileged processing mode for each type.
The types of exceptions are:
• fast interrupt (FIQ)
• normal interrupt (IRQ)
• memory aborts (used to implement memory protection or virtual memory)
• attempted execution of an undefined instruction
• software interrupts (SWIs)
Exceptions are generated by internal and external sources.
More than one exception can occur in the same time.
When an exception occurs, the banked version of R14 and the SPSR for the exception mode
are used to save state.
To return after handling the exception, the SPSR is moved to the CPSR, and R14 is moved to
the PC. This can be done in two ways:
• by using a data-processing instruction with the S-bit set, and the PC as the destination
• by using the Load Multiple with Restore CPSR instruction (LDM)
11.2.5
ARM Instruction Set Overview
The ARM instruction set is divided into:
• Branch instructions
• Data processing instructions
• Status register transfer instructions
• Load and Store instructions
• Coprocessor instructions
• Exception-generating instructions
ARM instructions can be executed conditionally. Every instruction contains a 4-bit condition
code field (bit[31:28]).
Table 11-2 gives the ARM instruction mnemonic list.
46
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 11-2.
11.2.6
ARM Instruction Mnemonic List
Mnemonic
Operation
Mnemonic
Operation
MOV
Move
CDP
Coprocessor Data Processing
ADD
Add
MVN
Move Not
SUB
Subtract
ADC
Add with Carry
RSB
Reverse Subtract
SBC
Subtract with Carry
CMP
Compare
RSC
Reverse Subtract with Carry
TST
Test
CMN
Compare Negated
AND
Logical AND
TEQ
Test Equivalence
EOR
Logical Exclusive OR
BIC
Bit Clear
MUL
Multiply
ORR
Logical (inclusive) OR
SMULL
Sign Long Multiply
MLA
Multiply Accumulate
SMLAL
Signed Long Multiply Accumulate
UMULL
Unsigned Long Multiply
MSR
Move to Status Register
UMLAL
Unsigned Long Multiply Accumulate
B
Branch
MRS
Move From Status Register
BX
Branch and Exchange
BL
Branch and Link
LDR
Load Word
SWI
Software Interrupt
LDRSH
Load Signed Halfword
STR
Store Word
LDRSB
Load Signed Byte
STRH
Store Half Word
LDRH
Load Half Word
STRB
Store Byte
LDRB
Load Byte
STRBT
Store Register Byte with Translation
LDRBT
Load Register Byte with Translation
STRT
Store Register with Translation
LDRT
Load Register with Translation
STM
Store Multiple
LDM
Load Multiple
SWPB
Swap Byte
SWP
Swap Word
MRC
Move From Coprocessor
MCR
Move To Coprocessor
STC
Store From Coprocessor
LDC
Load To Coprocessor
Thumb Instruction Set Overview
The Thumb instruction set is a re-encoded subset of the ARM instruction set.
The Thumb instruction set is divided into:
• Branch instructions
• Data processing instructions
• Load and Store instructions
• Load and Store Multiple instructions
• Exception-generating instruction
In Thumb mode, eight general-purpose registers, R0 to R7, are available that are the same
physical registers as R0 to R7 when executing ARM instructions. Some Thumb instructions also
access to the Program Counter (ARM Register 15), the Link Register (ARM Register 14) and the
47
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Stack Pointer (ARM Register 13). Further instructions allow limited access to the ARM registers
8 to 15.
Table 11-3 gives the Thumb instruction mnemonic list.
Table 11-3.
48
Thumb Instruction Mnemonic List
Mnemonic
Operation
Mnemonic
Operation
MOV
Move
MVN
Move Not
ADD
Add
ADC
Add with Carry
SUB
Subtract
SBC
Subtract with Carry
CMP
Compare
CMN
Compare Negated
TST
Test
NEG
Negate
AND
Logical AND
BIC
Bit Clear
EOR
Logical Exclusive OR
ORR
Logical (inclusive) OR
LSL
Logical Shift Left
LSR
Logical Shift Right
ASR
Arithmetic Shift Right
ROR
Rotate Right
MUL
Multiply
B
Branch
BL
Branch and Link
BX
Branch and Exchange
SWI
Software Interrupt
LDR
Load Word
STR
Store Word
LDRH
Load Half Word
STRH
Store Half Word
LDRB
Load Byte
STRB
Store Byte
LDRSH
Load Signed Halfword
LDRSB
Load Signed Byte
LDMIA
Load Multiple
STMIA
Store Multiple
PUSH
Push Register to stack
POP
Pop Register from stack
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
12. Debug and Test Features
12.1
Description
The AT91SAM7XC Series features a number of complementary debug and test capabilities. A
common JTAG/ICE (In-Circuit Emulator) port is used for standard debugging functions, such as
downloading code and single-stepping through programs. The Debug Unit provides a two-pin
UART that can be used to upload an application into internal SRAM. It manages the interrupt
handling of the internal COMMTX and COMMRX signals that trace the activity of the Debug
Communication Channel.
A set of dedicated debug and test input/output pins gives direct access to these capabilities from
a PC-based test environment.
12.2
Block Diagram
Figure 12-1. Debug and Test Block Diagram
TMS
TCK
TDI
ICE/JTAG
TAP
Boundary
TAP
JTAGSEL
TDO
ICE
POR
Reset
and
Test
TST
PIO
ARM7TDMI
PDC
DTXD
DBGU
DRXD
49
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
12.3
12.3.1
Application Examples
Debug Environment
Figure 12-2 shows a complete debug environment example. The ICE/JTAG interface is used for
standard debugging functions, such as downloading code and single-stepping through the
program.
Figure 12-2. Application Debug Environment Example
Host Debugger
ICE/JTAG
Interface
ICE/JTAG
Connector
AT91SAMXCxx
RS232
Connector
Terminal
AT91SAM7XCxx-based Application Board
50
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
12.3.2
Test Environment
Figure 12-3 shows a test environment example. Test vectors are sent and interpreted by the tester. In this example, the “board in test” is designed using a number of JTAG-compliant devices.
These devices can be connected to form a single scan chain.
Figure 12-3. Application Test Environment Example
Test Adaptor
Tester
JTAG
Interface
ICE/JTAG
Connector
Chip n
AT91SAM7XCxx
Chip 2
Chip 1
AT91SAM7XCxx-based Application Board In Test
12.4
Debug and Test Pin Description
Table 12-1.
Pin Name
Debug and Test Pin List
Function
Type
Active Level
Input/Output
Low
Input
High
Reset/Test
NRST
Microcontroller Reset
TST
Test Mode Select
ICE and JTAG
TCK
Test Clock
Input
TDI
Test Data In
Input
TDO
Test Data Out
TMS
Test Mode Select
Input
JTAGSEL
JTAG Selection
Input
Output
Debug Unit
DRXD
Debug Receive Data
Input
DTXD
Debug Transmit Data
Output
51
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
12.5
12.5.1
Functional Description
Test Pin
One dedicated pin, TST, is used to define the device operating mode. The user must make sure
that this pin is tied at low level to ensure normal operating conditions. Other values associated
with this pin are reserved for manufacturing test.
12.5.2
EmbeddedICE™ (Embedded In-circuit Emulator)
The ARM7TDMI EmbeddedICE is supported via the ICE/JTAG port. The internal state of the
ARM7TDMI is examined through an ICE/JTAG port.
The ARM7TDMI processor contains hardware extensions for advanced debugging features:
• In halt mode, a store-multiple (STM) can be inserted into the instruction pipeline. This exports
the contents of the ARM7TDMI registers. This data can be serially shifted out without
affecting the rest of the system.
• In monitor mode, the JTAG interface is used to transfer data between the debugger and a
simple monitor program running on the ARM7TDMI processor.
There are three scan chains inside the ARM7TDMI processor that support testing, debugging,
and programming of the EmbeddedICE. The scan chains are controlled by the ICE/JTAG port.
EmbeddedICE mode is selected when JTAGSEL is low. It is not possible to switch directly
between ICE and JTAG operations. A chip reset must be performed after JTAGSEL is changed.
For further details on the EmbeddedICE, see the ARM7TDMI (Rev4) Technical Reference Manual (DDI0210B).
12.5.3
Debug Unit
The Debug Unit provides a two-pin (DXRD and TXRD) USART that can be used for several
debug and trace purposes and offers an ideal means for in-situ programming solutions and
debug monitor communication. Moreover, the association with two peripheral data controller
channels permits packet handling of these tasks with processor time reduced to a minimum.
The Debug Unit also manages the interrupt handling of the COMMTX and COMMRX signals
that come from the ICE and that trace the activity of the Debug Communication Channel. The
Debug Unit allows blockage of access to the system through the ICE interface.
A specific register, the Debug Unit Chip ID Register, gives information about the product version
and its internal configuration.
The AT91SAM7XC512 Debug Unit Chip ID value is 0x271C 0A40 on 32-bit width.
The AT91SAM7XC256 Debug Unit Chip ID value is 0x271B 0940 on 32-bit width.
The AT91SAM7XC128 Debug Unit Chip ID value is 0x271A 0740 on 32-bit width.
For further details on the Debug Unit, see the Debug Unit section.
12.5.4
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan allows pin-level access independent of the device packaging
technology.
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan is enabled when JTAGSEL is high. The SAMPLE, EXTEST
and BYPASS functions are implemented. In ICE debug mode, the ARM processor responds
52
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
with a non-JTAG chip ID that identifies the processor to the ICE system. This is not IEEE 1149.1
JTAG-compliant.
It is not possible to switch directly between JTAG and ICE operations. A chip reset must be performed after JTAGSEL is changed.
A Boundary-scan Descriptor Language (BSDL) file is provided to set up test.
12.5.4.1
JTAG Boundary-scan Register
The Boundary-scan Register (BSR) contains 187 bits that correspond to active pins and associated control signals.
Each AT91SAM7XC input/output pin corresponds to a 3-bit register in the BSR. The OUTPUT
bit contains data that can be forced on the pad. The INPUT bit facilitates the observability of data
applied to the pad. The CONTROL bit selects the direction of the pad.
Table 12-2.
Bit
Number
AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register
Pin Name
Pin Type
187
186
Associated BSR
Cells
INPUT
PA30/IRQ0/PCK2
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
185
CONTROL
184
INPUT
183
PA0/RXD0
IN/OUT
182
181
180
INPUT
PA1/TXD0
IN/OUT
179
OUTPUT
CONTROL
178
177
OUTPUT
CONTROL
INPUT
PA3/RTS0/SPI1_NPCS2
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
176
CONTROL
175
INPUT
174
PA2/SCK0/SPI1_NPCS1
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
173
CONTROL
172
INPUT
171
PA4/CTS0/SPI1_NPCS3
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
170
CONTROL
169
INPUT
168
PA5/RXD1
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
167
CONTROL
166
CONTROL
165
PA6/TXD1
IN/OUT
INPUT
164
OUTPUT
163
CONTROL
162
PA7/SCK1/SPI0_NPCS1
IN/OUT
161
160
INPUT
OUTPUT
ERASE
IN
INPUT
53
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Table 12-2.
Bit
Number
AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register (Continued)
Pin Name
Pin Type
159
158
INPUT
PB27/TIOA2/PWM0/AD0
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
157
CONTROL
156
INPUT
155
PB28/TIOB2/PWM1/AD1
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
154
CONTROL
153
INPUT
152
PB29/PCK1/PWM2/AD2
IN/OUT
151
149
INPUT
PB30/PCK2/PWM3/AD3
IN/OUT
148
INPUT
PA8/RTS1/SPI0_NPCS2
IN/OUT
145
OUTPUT
CONTROL
144
143
OUTPUT
CONTROL
147
146
OUTPUT
CONTROL
150
INPUT
PA9/CTS1/SPI0_NPCS3
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
142
CONTROL
141
INPUT
140
PA10/TWD
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
139
CONTROL
138
INPUT
137
PA11/TWCK
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
136
CONTROL
135
INPUT
134
PA12/SPI0_NPCS0
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
133
CONTROL
132
INPUT
131
PA13/SPI0_NPCS1/PCK1
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
130
CONTROL
129
INPUT
128
PA14/SPI0_NPCS2/IRQ1
IN/OUT
127
125
INPUT
PA15/SPI0_NPCS3/TCLK2
IN/OUT
124
INPUT
PA16/SPI0_MISO
IN/OUT
121
OUTPUT
CONTROL
120
119
OUTPUT
CONTROL
123
122
OUTPUT
CONTROL
126
INPUT
PA17/SPI0_MOSI
118
54
Associated BSR
Cells
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
CONTROL
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 12-2.
Bit
Number
AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register (Continued)
Pin Name
Pin Type
117
116
Associated BSR
Cells
INPUT
PA18/SPI0_SPCK
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
115
CONTROL
114
INPUT
113
PB9/EMDIO
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
112
CONTROL
111
INPUT
110
PB8/EMDC
IN/OUT
109
108
107
INPUT
PB14/ERX3/SPI0_NPCS2
IN/OUT
106
INPUT
PB13/ERX2/SPI0_NPCS1
IN/OUT
103
OUTPUT
CONTROL
102
101
OUTPUT
CONTROL
105
104
OUTPUT
CONTROL
INPUT
PB6/ERX1
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
100
CONTROL
99
INPUT
98
PB5/ERX0
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
97
CONTROL
96
INPUT
95
PB15/ERXDV/ECRSDV
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
94
CONTROL
93
INPUT
92
PB17/ERXCK/SPI0_NPCS3
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
91
CONTROL
90
INPUT
89
PB7/ERXER
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
88
CONTROL
87
INPUT
86
PB12/ETXER/TCLK0
IN/OUT
85
84
83
INPUT
PB0/ETXCK/EREFCK/PCK0
PB0/ETXCK/ERE
FCK/PCK0
82
INPUT
PB1/ETXEN
PB1/ETXEN
79
76
OUTPUT
CONTROL
78
77
OUTPUT
CONTROL
81
80
OUTPUT
CONTROL
INPUT
PB2/ETX0
PB2/ETX0
OUTPUT
CONTROL
55
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Table 12-2.
Bit
Number
AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register (Continued)
Pin Name
Pin Type
75
74
INPUT
PB3/ETX1
PB3/ETX1
OUTPUT
73
CONTROL
72
INPUT
71
PB10/ETX2/SPI1_NPCS1
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
70
CONTROL
69
INPUT
68
PB11/ETX3/SPI1_NPCS2
IN/OUT
67
65
INPUT
PA19/CANRX
IN/OUT
64
INPUT
PA20/CANTX
IN/OUT
61
OUTPUT
CONTROL
60
59
OUTPUT
CONTROL
63
62
OUTPUT
CONTROL
66
INPUT
PA21/TF/SPI1_NPCS0
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
58
CONTROL
57
INPUT
56
PA22/TK/SPI1_SPCK
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
55
CONTROL
54
INPUT
53
PB16/ECOL/SPI1_NPCS3
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
52
CONTROL
51
INPUT
50
PB4/ECRS
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
49
CONTROL
48
INPUT
47
PA23/TD/SPI1_MOSI
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
46
CONTROL
45
INPUT
44
PA24/RD/SPI1_MISO
IN/OUT
43
INPUT
PA25/RK/SPI1_NPCS1
IN/OUT
40
INPUT
PA26/RF/SPI1_NPCS2
IN/OUT
37
OUTPUT
CONTROL
36
35
OUTPUT
CONTROL
39
38
OUTPUT
CONTROL
42
41
INPUT
PB18/EF100/ADTRG
34
56
Associated BSR
Cells
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
CONTROL
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 12-2.
Bit
Number
AT91SAM7XC JTAG Boundary Scan Register (Continued)
Pin Name
Pin Type
33
32
Associated BSR
Cells
INPUT
PB19/PWM0/TCLK1
IN/OUT
31
OUTPUT
CONTROL
30
INPUT
29
PB20/PWM1/PCK0
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
28
CONTROL
27
INPUT
26
PB21/PWM2/PCK2
IN/OUT
25
24
23
INPUT
PB22/PWM3/PCK2
IN/OUT
22
INPUT
PB23/TIOA0/DCD1
IN/OUT
19
OUTPUT
CONTROL
18
17
OUTPUT
CONTROL
21
20
OUTPUT
CONTROL
INPUT
PB24/TIOB0/DSR1
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
16
CONTROL
15
INPUT
14
PB25/TIOA1/DTR1
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
13
CONTROL
12
INPUT
11
PB26/TIOB1/RI1
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
10
CONTROL
9
INPUT
8
PA27DRXD/PCK3
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
7
CONTROL
6
INPUT
5
PA28/DTXD
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
4
CONTROL
3
INPUT
2
1
PA29/FIQ/SPI1_NPCS3
IN/OUT
OUTPUT
CONTROL
57
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
12.5.5
ID Code Register
Access: Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
VERSION
23
22
25
24
PART NUMBER
21
20
19
18
17
16
10
9
8
PART NUMBER
15
14
13
12
11
PART NUMBER
7
6
MANUFACTURER IDENTITY
5
4
3
2
MANUFACTURER IDENTITY
1
0
1
• VERSION[31:28]: Product Version Number
Set to 0x0.
• PART NUMBER[27:12]: Product Part Number
AT91SAM7XC512: 0x5B19
AT91SAM7XC256: 0x5B10
AT91SAM7XC128: 0x5B0F
• MANUFACTURER IDENTITY[11:1]
Set to 0x01F.
Bit[0] Required by IEEE Std. 1149.1.
Set to 0x1.
AT91SAM7XC512: JTAG ID Code value is 05B1_903F
AT91SAM7XC256: JTAG ID Code value is 05B1_003F
AT91SAM7XC128: JTAG ID Code value is 05B0_F03F
58
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
13. Reset Controller (RSTC)
The Reset Controller (RSTC), based on power-on reset cells, handles all the resets of the system without any external components. It reports which reset occurred last.
The Reset Controller also drives independently or simultaneously the external reset and the
peripheral and processor resets.
A brownout detection is also available to prevent the processor from falling into an unpredictable
state.
13.1
Block Diagram
Figure 13-1. Reset Controller Block Diagram
Reset Controller
bod_rst_en
Brownout
Manager
brown_out
Main Supply
POR
bod_reset
Reset
State
Manager
Startup
Counter
rstc_irq
proc_nreset
user_reset
NRST
NRST
Manager
nrst_out
periph_nreset
exter_nreset
WDRPROC
wd_fault
SLCK
59
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
13.2
Functional Description
13.2.1
Reset Controller Overview
The Reset Controller is made up of an NRST Manager, a Brownout Manager, a Startup Counter
and a Reset State Manager. It runs at Slow Clock and generates the following reset signals:
• proc_nreset: Processor reset line. It also resets the Watchdog Timer.
• periph_nreset: Affects the whole set of embedded peripherals.
• nrst_out: Drives the NRST pin.
These reset signals are asserted by the Reset Controller, either on external events or on software action. The Reset State Manager controls the generation of reset signals and provides a
signal to the NRST Manager when an assertion of the NRST pin is required.
The NRST Manager shapes the NRST assertion during a programmable time, thus controlling
external device resets.
The startup counter waits for the complete crystal oscillator startup. The wait delay is given by
the crystal oscillator startup time maximum value that can be found in the section Crystal Oscillator Characteristics in the Electrical Characteristics section of the product documentation.
13.2.2
NRST Manager
The NRST Manager samples the NRST input pin and drives this pin low when required by the
Reset State Manager. Figure 13-2 shows the block diagram of the NRST Manager.
Figure 13-2. NRST Manager
RSTC_MR
URSTIEN
RSTC_SR
URSTS
NRSTL
rstc_irq
RSTC_MR
URSTEN
Other
interrupt
sources
user_reset
NRST
RSTC_MR
ERSTL
nrst_out
13.2.2.1
External Reset Timer
exter_nreset
NRST Signal or Interrupt
The NRST Manager samples the NRST pin at Slow Clock speed. When the line is detected low,
a User Reset is reported to the Reset State Manager.
However, the NRST Manager can be programmed to not trigger a reset when an assertion of
NRST occurs. Writing the bit URSTEN at 0 in RSTC_MR disables the User Reset trigger.
The level of the pin NRST can be read at any time in the bit NRSTL (NRST level) in RSTC_SR.
As soon as the pin NRST is asserted, the bit URSTS in RSTC_SR is set. This bit clears only
when RSTC_SR is read.
The Reset Controller can also be programmed to generate an interrupt instead of generating a
reset. To do so, the bit URSTIEN in RSTC_MR must be written at 1.
60
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
13.2.2.2
NRST External Reset Control
The Reset State Manager asserts the signal ext_nreset to assert the NRST pin. When this
occurs, the “nrst_out” signal is driven low by the NRST Manager for a time programmed by the
field ERSTL in RSTC_MR. This assertion duration, named EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH, lasts
2(ERSTL+1) Slow Clock cycles. This gives the approximate duration of an assertion between 60 µs
and 2 seconds. Note that ERSTL at 0 defines a two-cycle duration for the NRST pulse.
This feature allows the Reset Controller to shape the NRST pin level, and thus to guarantee that
the NRST line is driven low for a time compliant with potential external devices connected on the
system reset.
13.2.3
Brownout Manager
Brownout detection prevents the processor from falling into an unpredictable state if the power
supply drops below a certain level. When VDDCORE drops below the brownout threshold, the
brownout manager requests a brownout reset by asserting the bod_reset signal.
The programmer can disable the brownout reset by setting low the bod_rst_en input signal, i.e.;
by locking the corresponding general-purpose NVM bit in the Flash. When the brownout reset is
disabled, no reset is performed. Instead, the brownout detection is reported in the bit BODSTS
of RSTC_SR. BODSTS is set and clears only when RSTC_SR is read.
The bit BODSTS can trigger an interrupt if the bit BODIEN is set in the RSTC_MR.
At factory, the brownout reset is disabled.
Figure 13-3. Brownout Manager
bod_rst_en
bod_reset
RSTC_MR
BODIEN
RSTC_SR
brown_out
BODSTS
rstc_irq
Other
interrupt
sources
61
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
13.2.4
Reset States
The Reset State Manager handles the different reset sources and generates the internal reset
signals. It reports the reset status in the field RSTTYP of the Status Register (RSTC_SR). The
update of the field RSTTYP is performed when the processor reset is released.
13.2.4.1
Power-up Reset
When VDDCORE is powered on, the Main Supply POR cell output is filtered with a start-up
counter that operates at Slow Clock. The purpose of this counter is to ensure that the Slow
Clock oscillator is stable before starting up the device.
The startup time, as shown in Figure 13-4, is hardcoded to comply with the Slow Clock Oscillator
startup time. After the startup time, the reset signals are released and the field RSTTYP in
RSTC_SR reports a Power-up Reset.
When VDDCORE is detected low by the Main Supply POR Cell, all reset signals are asserted
immediately.
Figure 13-4. Power-up Reset
SLCK
Any
Freq.
MCK
Main Supply
POR output
proc_nreset
Startup Time
Processor Startup
= 3 cycles
periph_nreset
NRST
(nrst_out)
EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH
= 2 cycles
62
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
13.2.4.2
User Reset
The User Reset is entered when a low level is detected on the NRST pin and the bit URSTEN in
RSTC_MR is at 1. The NRST input signal is resynchronized with SLCK to insure proper behavior of the system.
The User Reset is entered as soon as a low level is detected on NRST. The Processor Reset
and the Peripheral Reset are asserted.
The User Reset is left when NRST rises, after a two-cycle resynchronization time and a threecycle processor startup. The processor clock is re-enabled as soon as NRST is confirmed high.
When the processor reset signal is released, the RSTTYP field of the Status Register
(RSTC_SR) is loaded with the value 0x4, indicating a User Reset.
The NRST Manager guarantees that the NRST line is asserted for
EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH Slow Clock cycles, as programmed in the field ERSTL. However, if NRST does not rise after EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH because it is driven low
externally, the internal reset lines remain asserted until NRST actually rises.
Figure 13-5. User Reset State
SLCK
MCK
Any
Freq.
NRST
Resynch.
2 cycles
Resynch.
2 cycles
Processor Startup
= 3 cycles
proc_nreset
RSTTYP
Any
XXX
0x4 = User Reset
periph_nreset
NRST
(nrst_out)
>= EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH
63
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
13.2.4.3
Brownout Reset
When the brown_out/bod_reset signal is asserted, the Reset State Manager immediately enters
the Brownout Reset. In this state, the processor, the peripheral and the external reset lines are
asserted.
The Brownout Reset is left 3 Slow Clock cycles after the rising edge of brown_out/bod_reset
after a two-cycle resynchronization. An external reset is also triggered.
When the processor reset is released, the field RSTTYP in RSTC_SR is loaded with the value
0x5, thus indicating that the last reset is a Brownout Reset.
Figure 13-6. Brownout Reset State
SLCK
MCK
Any
Freq.
brown_out
or bod_reset
Resynch.
2 cycles
Processor Startup
= 3 cycles
proc_nreset
RSTTYP
Any
XXX
0x5 = Brownout Reset
periph_nreset
NRST
(nrst_out)
EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH
8 cycles (ERSTL=2)
64
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
13.2.4.4
Software Reset
The Reset Controller offers several commands used to assert the different reset signals. These
commands are performed by writing the Control Register (RSTC_CR) with the following bits at
1:
• PROCRST: Writing PROCRST at 1 resets the processor and the watchdog timer.
• PERRST: Writing PERRST at 1 resets all the embedded peripherals, including the memory
system, and, in particular, the Remap Command. The Peripheral Reset is generally used for
debug purposes.
Except for Debug purposes, PERRST must always be used in conjuction with PROCRST
(PERRST and PROCRST set both at 1 simultaneously).
• EXTRST: Writing EXTRST at 1 asserts low the NRST pin during a time defined by the field
ERSTL in the Mode Register (RSTC_MR).
The software reset is entered if at least one of these bits is set by the software. All these commands can be performed independently or simultaneously. The software reset lasts 3 Slow
Clock cycles.
The internal reset signals are asserted as soon as the register write is performed. This is
detected on the Master Clock (MCK). They are released when the software reset is left, i.e.; synchronously to SLCK.
If EXTRST is set, the nrst_out signal is asserted depending on the programming of the field
ERSTL. However, the resulting falling edge on NRST does not lead to a User Reset.
If and only if the PROCRST bit is set, the Reset Controller reports the software status in the field
RSTTYP of the Status Register (RSTC_SR). Other Software Resets are not reported in
RSTTYP.
As soon as a software operation is detected, the bit SRCMP (Software Reset Command in
Progress) is set in the Status Register (RSTC_SR). It is cleared as soon as the software reset is
left. No other software reset can be performed while the SRCMP bit is set, and writing any value
in RSTC_CR has no effect.
65
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 13-7. Software Reset
SLCK
MCK
Any
Freq.
Write RSTC_CR
Resynch.
1 cycle
Processor Startup
= 3 cycles
proc_nreset
if PROCRST=1
RSTTYP
Any
XXX
0x3 = Software Reset
periph_nreset
if PERRST=1
NRST
(nrst_out)
if EXTRST=1
EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH
8 cycles (ERSTL=2)
SRCMP in RSTC_SR
66
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
13.2.4.5
Watchdog Reset
The Watchdog Reset is entered when a watchdog fault occurs. This state lasts 3 Slow Clock
cycles.
When in Watchdog Reset, assertion of the reset signals depends on the WDRPROC bit in
WDT_MR:
• If WDRPROC is 0, the Processor Reset and the Peripheral Reset are asserted. The NRST
line is also asserted, depending on the programming of the field ERSTL. However, the
resulting low level on NRST does not result in a User Reset state.
• If WDRPROC = 1, only the processor reset is asserted.
The Watchdog Timer is reset by the proc_nreset signal. As the watchdog fault always causes a
processor reset if WDRSTEN is set, the Watchdog Timer is always reset after a Watchdog
Reset, and the Watchdog is enabled by default and with a period set to a maximum.
When the WDRSTEN in WDT_MR bit is reset, the watchdog fault has no impact on the reset
controller.
Figure 13-8. Watchdog Reset
SLCK
MCK
Any
Freq.
wd_fault
Processor Startup
= 3 cycles
proc_nreset
RSTTYP
Any
XXX
0x2 = Watchdog Reset
periph_nreset
Only if
WDRPROC = 0
NRST
(nrst_out)
EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH
8 cycles (ERSTL=2)
67
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
13.2.5
Reset State Priorities
The Reset State Manager manages the following priorities between the different reset sources,
given in descending order:
• Power-up Reset
• Brownout Reset
• Watchdog Reset
• Software Reset
• User Reset
Particular cases are listed below:
• When in User Reset:
– A watchdog event is impossible because the Watchdog Timer is being reset by the
proc_nreset signal.
– A software reset is impossible, since the processor reset is being activated.
• When in Software Reset:
– A watchdog event has priority over the current state.
– The NRST has no effect.
• When in Watchdog Reset:
– The processor reset is active and so a Software Reset cannot be programmed.
– A User Reset cannot be entered.
68
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
13.2.6
Reset Controller Status Register
The Reset Controller status register (RSTC_SR) provides several status fields:
• RSTTYP field: This field gives the type of the last reset, as explained in previous sections.
• SRCMP bit: This field indicates that a Software Reset Command is in progress and that no
further software reset should be performed until the end of the current one. This bit is
automatically cleared at the end of the current software reset.
• NRSTL bit: The NRSTL bit of the Status Register gives the level of the NRST pin sampled on
each MCK rising edge.
• URSTS bit: A high-to-low transition of the NRST pin sets the URSTS bit of the RSTC_SR
register. This transition is also detected on the Master Clock (MCK) rising edge (see Figure
13-9). If the User Reset is disabled (URSTEN = 0) and if the interruption is enabled by the
URSTIEN bit in the RSTC_MR register, the URSTS bit triggers an interrupt. Reading the
RSTC_SR status register resets the URSTS bit and clears the interrupt.
• BODSTS bit: This bit indicates a brownout detection when the brownout reset is disabled
(bod_rst_en = 0). It triggers an interrupt if the bit BODIEN in the RSTC_MR register enables
the interrupt. Reading the RSTC_SR register resets the BODSTS bit and clears the interrupt.
Figure 13-9.
Reset Controller Status and Interrupt
MCK
read
RSTC_SR
Peripheral Access
2 cycle
resynchronization
2 cycle
resynchronization
NRST
NRSTL
URSTS
rstc_irq
if (URSTEN = 0) and
(URSTIEN = 1)
69
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
13.3
Reset Controller (RSTC) User Interface
Table 13-1.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
0x00
Control Register
0x04
0x08
70
Access
Reset
RSTC_CR
Write-only
-
Status Register
RSTC_SR
Read-only
0x0000_0000
Mode Register
RSTC_MR
Read-write
0x0000_0000
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
13.3.1
Reset Controller Control Register
Register Name:
RSTC_CR
Access Type:
31
Write-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
KEY
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
EXTRST
2
PERRST
1
–
0
PROCRST
• PROCRST: Processor Reset
0 = No effect.
1 = If KEY is correct, resets the processor.
• PERRST: Peripheral Reset
0 = No effect.
1 = If KEY is correct, resets the peripherals.
• EXTRST: External Reset
0 = No effect.
1 = If KEY is correct, asserts the NRST pin.
• KEY: Password
Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation.
71
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
13.3.2
Reset Controller Status Register
Register Name:
RSTC_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
SRCMP
16
NRSTL
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
9
RSTTYP
8
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
BODSTS
0
URSTS
• URSTS: User Reset Status
0 = No high-to-low edge on NRST happened since the last read of RSTC_SR.
1 = At least one high-to-low transition of NRST has been detected since the last read of RSTC_SR.
• BODSTS: Brownout Detection Status
0 = No brownout high-to-low transition happened since the last read of RSTC_SR.
1 = A brownout high-to-low transition has been detected since the last read of RSTC_SR.
• RSTTYP: Reset Type
Reports the cause of the last processor reset. Reading this RSTC_SR does not reset this field.
RSTTYP
Reset Type
Comments
0
0
0
Power-up Reset
VDDCORE rising
0
1
0
Watchdog Reset
Watchdog fault occurred
0
1
1
Software Reset
Processor reset required by the software
1
0
0
User Reset
NRST pin detected low
1
0
1
Brownout Reset
Brownout reset occurred
• NRSTL: NRST Pin Level
Registers the NRST Pin Level at Master Clock (MCK).
• SRCMP: Software Reset Command in Progress
0 = No software command is being performed by the reset controller. The reset controller is ready for a software command.
1 = A software reset command is being performed by the reset controller. The reset controller is busy.
72
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
13.3.3
Reset Controller Mode Register
Register Name:
RSTC_MR
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
KEY
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
BODIEN
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
10
9
8
7
–
6
–
5
4
URSTIEN
3
–
1
–
0
URSTEN
ERSTL
2
–
• URSTEN: User Reset Enable
0 = The detection of a low level on the pin NRST does not generate a User Reset.
1 = The detection of a low level on the pin NRST triggers a User Reset.
• URSTIEN: User Reset Interrupt Enable
0 = USRTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 has no effect on rstc_irq.
1 = USRTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 asserts rstc_irq if URSTEN = 0.
• BODIEN: Brownout Detection Interrupt Enable
0 = BODSTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 has no effect on rstc_irq.
1 = BODSTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 asserts rstc_irq.
• ERSTL: External Reset Length
This field defines the external reset length. The external reset is asserted during a time of 2(ERSTL+1) Slow Clock cycles. This
allows assertion duration to be programmed between 60 µs and 2 seconds.
• KEY: Password
Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation.
73
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
74
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
14. Real-time Timer (RTT)
14.1
Overview
The Real-time Timer is built around a 32-bit counter and used to count elapsed seconds. It generates a periodic interrupt or/and triggers an alarm on a programmed value.
14.2
Block Diagram
Figure 14-1. Real-time Timer
RTT_MR
RTTRST
RTT_MR
RTPRES
RTT_MR
SLCK
RTTINCIEN
reload
16-bit
Divider
set
0
RTT_MR
RTTRST
RTTINC
RTT_SR
1
reset
0
rtt_int
32-bit
Counter
read
RTT_SR
RTT_MR
ALMIEN
RTT_VR
reset
CRTV
RTT_SR
ALMS
set
rtt_alarm
=
RTT_AR
14.3
ALMV
Functional Description
The Real-time Timer is used to count elapsed seconds. It is built around a 32-bit counter fed by
Slow Clock divided by a programmable 16-bit value. The value can be programmed in the field
RTPRES of the Real-time Mode Register (RTT_MR).
Programming RTPRES at 0x00008000 corresponds to feeding the real-time counter with a 1 Hz
signal (if the Slow Clock is 32.768 Hz). The 32-bit counter can count up to 232 seconds, corresponding to more than 136 years, then roll over to 0.
The Real-time Timer can also be used as a free-running timer with a lower time-base. The best
accuracy is achieved by writing RTPRES to 3. Programming RTPRES to 1 or 2 is possible, but
may result in losing status events because the status register is cleared two Slow Clock cycles
after read. Thus if the RTT is configured to trigger an interrupt, the interrupt occurs during 2 Slow
Clock cycles after reading RTT_SR. To prevent several executions of the interrupt handler, the
interrupt must be disabled in the interrupt handler and re-enabled when the status register is
clear.
75
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
The Real-time Timer value (CRTV) can be read at any time in the register RTT_VR (Real-time
Value Register). As this value can be updated asynchronously from the Master Clock, it is advisable to read this register twice at the same value to improve accuracy of the returned value.
The current value of the counter is compared with the value written in the alarm register
RTT_AR (Real-time Alarm Register). If the counter value matches the alarm, the bit ALMS in
RTT_SR is set. The alarm register is set to its maximum value, corresponding to 0xFFFF_FFFF,
after a reset.
The bit RTTINC in RTT_SR is set each time the Real-time Timer counter is incremented. This bit
can be used to start a periodic interrupt, the period being one second when the RTPRES is programmed with 0x8000 and Slow Clock equal to 32.768 Hz.
Reading the RTT_SR status register resets the RTTINC and ALMS fields.
Writing the bit RTTRST in RTT_MR immediately reloads and restarts the clock divider with the
new programmed value. This also resets the 32-bit counter.
Note:
Because of the asynchronism between the Slow Clock (SCLK) and the System Clock (MCK):
1) The restart of the counter and the reset of the RTT_VR current value register is effective only 2
slow clock cycles after the write of the RTTRST bit in the RTT_MR register.
2) The status register flags reset is taken into account only 2 slow clock cycles after the read of the
RTT_SR (Status Register).
Figure 14-2. RTT Counting
APB cycle
APB cycle
MCK
RTPRES - 1
Prescaler
0
RTT
0
...
ALMV-1
ALMV
ALMV+1
ALMV+2
ALMV+3
RTTINC (RTT_SR)
ALMS (RTT_SR)
APB Interface
read RTT_SR
76
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
14.4
Real-time Timer (RTT) User Interface
Table 14-1.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00
Mode Register
RTT_MR
Read-write
0x0000_8000
0x04
Alarm Register
RTT_AR
Read-write
0xFFFF_FFFF
0x08
Value Register
RTT_VR
Read-only
0x0000_0000
0x0C
Status Register
RTT_SR
Read-only
0x0000_0000
77
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
14.4.1
Real-time Timer Mode Register
Register Name:
RTT_MR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
RTTRST
17
RTTINCIEN
16
ALMIEN
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RTPRES
7
6
5
4
RTPRES
• RTPRES: Real-time Timer Prescaler Value
Defines the number of SLCK periods required to increment the real-time timer. RTPRES is defined as follows:
RTPRES = 0: The Prescaler Period is equal to 216
RTPRES ≠ 0: The Prescaler Period is equal to RTPRES.
• ALMIEN: Alarm Interrupt Enable
0 = The bit ALMS in RTT_SR has no effect on interrupt.
1 = The bit ALMS in RTT_SR asserts interrupt.
• RTTINCIEN: Real-time Timer Increment Interrupt Enable
0 = The bit RTTINC in RTT_SR has no effect on interrupt.
1 = The bit RTTINC in RTT_SR asserts interrupt.
• RTTRST: Real-time Timer Restart
1 = Reloads and restarts the clock divider with the new programmed value. This also resets the 32-bit counter.
78
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
14.4.2
Real-time Timer Alarm Register
Register Name:
RTT_AR
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ALMV
23
22
21
20
ALMV
15
14
13
12
ALMV
7
6
5
4
ALMV
• ALMV: Alarm Value
Defines the alarm value (ALMV+1) compared with the Real-time Timer.
14.4.3
Real-time Timer Value Register
Register Name:
RTT_VR
Access Type:
31
Read-only
30
29
28
CRTV
23
22
21
20
CRTV
15
14
13
12
CRTV
7
6
5
4
CRTV
• CRTV: Current Real-time Value
Returns the current value of the Real-time Timer.
79
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
14.4.4
Real-time Timer Status Register
Register Name:
RTT_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
RTTINC
0
ALMS
• ALMS: Real-time Alarm Status
0 = The Real-time Alarm has not occurred since the last read of RTT_SR.
1 = The Real-time Alarm occurred since the last read of RTT_SR.
• RTTINC: Real-time Timer Increment
0 = The Real-time Timer has not been incremented since the last read of the RTT_SR.
1 = The Real-time Timer has been incremented since the last read of the RTT_SR.
80
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15. Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO)
15.1
Overview
The Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) manages up to 32 fully programmable input/output
lines. Each I/O line may be dedicated as a general-purpose I/O or be assigned to a function of
an embedded peripheral. This assures effective optimization of the pins of a product.
Each I/O line is associated with a bit number in all of the 32-bit registers of the 32-bit wide User
Interface.
Each I/O line of the PIO Controller features:
• An input change interrupt enabling level change detection on any I/O line.
• A glitch filter providing rejection of pulses lower than one-half of clock cycle.
• Multi-drive capability similar to an open drain I/O line.
• Control of the the pull-up of the I/O line.
• Input visibility and output control.
The PIO Controller also features a synchronous output providing up to 32 bits of data output in a
single write operation.
81
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.2
Block Diagram
Figure 15-1. Block Diagram
PIO Controller
AIC
PMC
PIO Interrupt
PIO Clock
Data, Enable
Up to 32
peripheral IOs
Embedded
Peripheral
PIN 0
Data, Enable
PIN 1
Up to 32 pins
Embedded
Peripheral
Up to 32
peripheral IOs
PIN 31
APB
Figure 15-2. Application Block Diagram
On-Chip Peripheral Drivers
Keyboard Driver
Control & Command
Driver
On-Chip Peripherals
PIO Controller
Keyboard Driver
82
General Purpose I/Os
External Devices
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.3
Product Dependencies
15.3.1
Pin Multiplexing
Each pin is configurable, according to product definition as either a general-purpose I/O line
only, or as an I/O line multiplexed with one or two peripheral I/Os. As the multiplexing is hardware-defined and thus product-dependent, the hardware designer and programmer must
carefully determine the configuration of the PIO controllers required by their application. When
an I/O line is general-purpose only, i.e. not multiplexed with any peripheral I/O, programming of
the PIO Controller regarding the assignment to a peripheral has no effect and only the PIO Controller can control how the pin is driven by the product.
15.3.2
External Interrupt Lines
The interrupt signals FIQ and IRQ0 to IRQn are most generally multiplexed through the PIO
Controllers. However, it is not necessary to assign the I/O line to the interrupt function as the
PIO Controller has no effect on inputs and the interrupt lines (FIQ or IRQs) are used only as
inputs.
15.3.3
Power Management
The Power Management Controller controls the PIO Controller clock in order to save power.
Writing any of the registers of the user interface does not require the PIO Controller clock to be
enabled. This means that the configuration of the I/O lines does not require the PIO Controller
clock to be enabled.
However, when the clock is disabled, not all of the features of the PIO Controller are available.
Note that the Input Change Interrupt and the read of the pin level require the clock to be
validated.
After a hardware reset, the PIO clock is disabled by default.
The user must configure the Power Management Controller before any access to the input line
information.
15.3.4
Interrupt Generation
For interrupt handling, the PIO Controllers are considered as user peripherals. This means that
the PIO Controller interrupt lines are connected among the interrupt sources 2 to 31. Refer to the
PIO Controller peripheral identifier in the product description to identify the interrupt sources
dedicated to the PIO Controllers.
The PIO Controller interrupt can be generated only if the PIO Controller clock is enabled.
83
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.4
Functional Description
The PIO Controller features up to 32 fully-programmable I/O lines. Most of the control logic associated to each I/O is represented in Figure 15-3. In this description each signal shown
represents but one of up to 32 possible indexes.
Figure 15-3. I/O Line Control Logic
PIO_OER[0]
PIO_OSR[0]
PIO_PUER[0]
PIO_ODR[0]
PIO_PUSR[0]
PIO_PUDR[0]
1
Peripheral A
Output Enable
0
0
Peripheral B
Output Enable
0
1
PIO_ASR[0]
PIO_PER[0]
PIO_ABSR[0]
1
PIO_PSR[0]
PIO_BSR[0]
PIO_PDR[0]
Peripheral A
Output
0
Peripheral B
Output
1
PIO_MDER[0]
PIO_MDSR[0]
PIO_MDDR[0]
0
0
PIO_SODR[0]
PIO_ODSR[0]
1
Pad
PIO_CODR[0]
1
Peripheral A
Input
PIO_PDSR[0]
0
Edge
Detector
Glitch
Filter
Peripheral B
Input
PIO_ISR[0]
(Up to 32 possible inputs)
PIO Interrupt
1
PIO_IFER[0]
PIO_IFSR[0]
PIO_IFDR[0]
PIO_IER[0]
PIO_IMR[0]
PIO_IDR[0]
PIO_ISR[31]
PIO_IER[31]
PIO_IMR[31]
PIO_IDR[31]
84
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.4.1
Pull-up Resistor Control
Each I/O line is designed with an embedded pull-up resistor. The pull-up resistor can be enabled
or disabled by writing respectively PIO_PUER (Pull-up Enable Register) and PIO_PUDR (Pullup Disable Resistor). Writing in these registers results in setting or clearing the corresponding bit
in PIO_PUSR (Pull-up Status Register). Reading a 1 in PIO_PUSR means the pull-up is disabled and reading a 0 means the pull-up is enabled.
Control of the pull-up resistor is possible regardless of the configuration of the I/O line.
After reset, all of the pull-ups are enabled, i.e. PIO_PUSR resets at the value 0x0.
15.4.2
I/O Line or Peripheral Function Selection
When a pin is multiplexed with one or two peripheral functions, the selection is controlled with
the registers PIO_PER (PIO Enable Register) and PIO_PDR (PIO Disable Register). The register PIO_PSR (PIO Status Register) is the result of the set and clear registers and indicates
whether the pin is controlled by the corresponding peripheral or by the PIO Controller. A value of
0 indicates that the pin is controlled by the corresponding on-chip peripheral selected in the
PIO_ABSR (AB Select Status Register). A value of 1 indicates the pin is controlled by the PIO
controller.
If a pin is used as a general purpose I/O line (not multiplexed with an on-chip peripheral),
PIO_PER and PIO_PDR have no effect and PIO_PSR returns 1 for the corresponding bit.
After reset, most generally, the I/O lines are controlled by the PIO controller, i.e. PIO_PSR
resets at 1. However, in some events, it is important that PIO lines are controlled by the peripheral (as in the case of memory chip select lines that must be driven inactive after reset or for
address lines that must be driven low for booting out of an external memory). Thus, the reset
value of PIO_PSR is defined at the product level, depending on the multiplexing of the device.
15.4.3
Peripheral A or B Selection
The PIO Controller provides multiplexing of up to two peripheral functions on a single pin. The
selection is performed by writing PIO_ASR (A Select Register) and PIO_BSR (Select B Register). PIO_ABSR (AB Select Status Register) indicates which peripheral line is currently selected.
For each pin, the corresponding bit at level 0 means peripheral A is selected whereas the corresponding bit at level 1 indicates that peripheral B is selected.
Note that multiplexing of peripheral lines A and B only affects the output line. The peripheral
input lines are always connected to the pin input.
After reset, PIO_ABSR is 0, thus indicating that all the PIO lines are configured on peripheral A.
However, peripheral A generally does not drive the pin as the PIO Controller resets in I/O line
mode.
Writing in PIO_ASR and PIO_BSR manages PIO_ABSR regardless of the configuration of the
pin. However, assignment of a pin to a peripheral function requires a write in the corresponding
peripheral selection register (PIO_ASR or PIO_BSR) in addition to a write in PIO_PDR.
15.4.4
Output Control
When the I/0 line is assigned to a peripheral function, i.e. the corresponding bit in PIO_PSR is at
0, the drive of the I/O line is controlled by the peripheral. Peripheral A or B, depending on the
value in PIO_ABSR, determines whether the pin is driven or not.
When the I/O line is controlled by the PIO controller, the pin can be configured to be driven. This
is done by writing PIO_OER (Output Enable Register) and PIO_ODR (Output Disable Register).
85
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
The results of these write operations are detected in PIO_OSR (Output Status Register). When
a bit in this register is at 0, the corresponding I/O line is used as an input only. When the bit is at
1, the corresponding I/O line is driven by the PIO controller.
The level driven on an I/O line can be determined by writing in PIO_SODR (Set Output Data
Register) and PIO_CODR (Clear Output Data Register). These write operations respectively set
and clear PIO_ODSR (Output Data Status Register), which represents the data driven on the I/O
lines. Writing in PIO_OER and PIO_ODR manages PIO_OSR whether the pin is configured to
be controlled by the PIO controller or assigned to a peripheral function. This enables configuration of the I/O line prior to setting it to be managed by the PIO Controller.
Similarly, writing in PIO_SODR and PIO_CODR effects PIO_ODSR. This is important as it
defines the first level driven on the I/O line.
15.4.5
Synchronous Data Output
Controlling all parallel busses using several PIOs requires two successive write operations in the
PIO_SODR and PIO_CODR registers. This may lead to unexpected transient values. The PIO
controller offers a direct control of PIO outputs by single write access to PIO_ODSR (Output
Data Status Register). Only bits unmasked by PIO_OWSR (Output Write Status Register) are
written. The masked bits in PIO_OWSR are set by writing to PIO_OWER (Output Write Enable
Register) and cleared by writing to PIO_OWDR (Output Write Disable Register).
After reset, the synchronous data output is disabled on all the I/O lines as PIO_OWSR resets at
0x0.
15.4.6
Multi Drive Control (Open Drain)
Each I/O can be independently programmed in Open Drain by using the Multi Drive feature. This
feature permits several drivers to be connected on the I/O line which is driven low only by each
device. An external pull-up resistor (or enabling of the internal one) is generally required to guarantee a high level on the line.
The Multi Drive feature is controlled by PIO_MDER (Multi-driver Enable Register) and
PIO_MDDR (Multi-driver Disable Register). The Multi Drive can be selected whether the I/O line
is controlled by the PIO controller or assigned to a peripheral function. PIO_MDSR (Multi-driver
Status Register) indicates the pins that are configured to support external drivers.
After reset, the Multi Drive feature is disabled on all pins, i.e. PIO_MDSR resets at value 0x0.
15.4.7
86
Output Line Timings
Figure 15-4 shows how the outputs are driven either by writing PIO_SODR or PIO_CODR, or by
directly writing PIO_ODSR. This last case is valid only if the corresponding bit in PIO_OWSR is
set. Figure 15-4 also shows when the feedback in PIO_PDSR is available.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 15-4. Output Line Timings
MCK
Write PIO_SODR
Write PIO_ODSR at 1
APB Access
Write PIO_CODR
Write PIO_ODSR at 0
APB Access
PIO_ODSR
2 cycles
2 cycles
PIO_PDSR
15.4.8
Inputs
The level on each I/O line can be read through PIO_PDSR (Pin Data Status Register). This register indicates the level of the I/O lines regardless of their configuration, whether uniquely as an
input or driven by the PIO controller or driven by a peripheral.
Reading the I/O line levels requires the clock of the PIO controller to be enabled, otherwise
PIO_PDSR reads the levels present on the I/O line at the time the clock was disabled.
15.4.9
Input Glitch Filtering
Optional input glitch filters are independently programmable on each I/O line. When the glitch filter is enabled, a glitch with a duration of less than 1/2 Master Clock (MCK) cycle is automatically
rejected, while a pulse with a duration of 1 Master Clock cycle or more is accepted. For pulse
durations between 1/2 Master Clock cycle and 1 Master Clock cycle the pulse may or may not
be taken into account, depending on the precise timing of its occurrence. Thus for a pulse to be
visible it must exceed 1 Master Clock cycle, whereas for a glitch to be reliably filtered out, its
duration must not exceed 1/2 Master Clock cycle. The filter introduces one Master Clock cycle
latency if the pin level change occurs before a rising edge. However, this latency does not
appear if the pin level change occurs before a falling edge. This is illustrated in Figure 15-5.
The glitch filters are controlled by the register set; PIO_IFER (Input Filter Enable Register),
PIO_IFDR (Input Filter Disable Register) and PIO_IFSR (Input Filter Status Register). Writing
PIO_IFER and PIO_IFDR respectively sets and clears bits in PIO_IFSR. This last register
enables the glitch filter on the I/O lines.
When the glitch filter is enabled, it does not modify the behavior of the inputs on the peripherals.
It acts only on the value read in PIO_PDSR and on the input change interrupt detection. The
glitch filters require that the PIO Controller clock is enabled.
87
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 15-5. Input Glitch Filter Timing
MCK
up to 1.5 cycles
Pin Level
1 cycle
1 cycle
1 cycle
1 cycle
PIO_PDSR
if PIO_IFSR = 0
2 cycles
PIO_PDSR
if PIO_IFSR = 1
15.4.10
up to 2.5 cycles
1 cycle
up to 2 cycles
Input Change Interrupt
The PIO Controller can be programmed to generate an interrupt when it detects an input change
on an I/O line. The Input Change Interrupt is controlled by writing PIO_IER (Interrupt Enable
Register) and PIO_IDR (Interrupt Disable Register), which respectively enable and disable the
input change interrupt by setting and clearing the corresponding bit in PIO_IMR (Interrupt Mask
Register). As Input change detection is possible only by comparing two successive samplings of
the input of the I/O line, the PIO Controller clock must be enabled. The Input Change Interrupt is
available, regardless of the configuration of the I/O line, i.e. configured as an input only, controlled by the PIO Controller or assigned to a peripheral function.
When an input change is detected on an I/O line, the corresponding bit in PIO_ISR (Interrupt
Status Register) is set. If the corresponding bit in PIO_IMR is set, the PIO Controller interrupt
line is asserted. The interrupt signals of the thirty-two channels are ORed-wired together to generate a single interrupt signal to the Advanced Interrupt Controller.
When the software reads PIO_ISR, all the interrupts are automatically cleared. This signifies that
all the interrupts that are pending when PIO_ISR is read must be handled.
Figure 15-6. Input Change Interrupt Timings
MCK
Pin Level
PIO_ISR
Read PIO_ISR
88
APB Access
APB Access
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.5
I/O Lines Programming Example
The programing example as shown in Table 15-1 below is used to define the following
configuration.
• 4-bit output port on I/O lines 0 to 3, (should be written in a single write operation), open-drain,
with pull-up resistor
• Four output signals on I/O lines 4 to 7 (to drive LEDs for example), driven high and low, no
pull-up resistor
• Four input signals on I/O lines 8 to 11 (to read push-button states for example), with pull-up
resistors, glitch filters and input change interrupts
• Four input signals on I/O line 12 to 15 to read an external device status (polled, thus no input
change interrupt), no pull-up resistor, no glitch filter
• I/O lines 16 to 19 assigned to peripheral A functions with pull-up resistor
• I/O lines 20 to 23 assigned to peripheral B functions, no pull-up resistor
• I/O line 24 to 27 assigned to peripheral A with Input Change Interrupt and pull-up resistor
Table 15-1.
Programming Example
Register
Value to be Written
PIO_PER
0x0000 FFFF
PIO_PDR
0x0FFF 0000
PIO_OER
0x0000 00FF
PIO_ODR
0x0FFF FF00
PIO_IFER
0x0000 0F00
PIO_IFDR
0x0FFF F0FF
PIO_SODR
0x0000 0000
PIO_CODR
0x0FFF FFFF
PIO_IER
0x0F00 0F00
PIO_IDR
0x00FF F0FF
PIO_MDER
0x0000 000F
PIO_MDDR
0x0FFF FFF0
PIO_PUDR
0x00F0 00F0
PIO_PUER
0x0F0F FF0F
PIO_ASR
0x0F0F 0000
PIO_BSR
0x00F0 0000
PIO_OWER
0x0000 000F
PIO_OWDR
0x0FFF FFF0
89
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.6
Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) User Interface
Each I/O line controlled by the PIO Controller is associated with a bit in each of the PIO Controller User Interface registers. Each register is 32 bits wide. If a parallel I/O line is not defined,
writing to the corresponding bits has no effect. Undefined bits read zero. If the I/O line is not multiplexed with any peripheral, the I/O line is controlled by the PIO Controller and PIO_PSR returns
1 systematically.
Table 15-2.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x0000
PIO Enable Register
PIO_PER
Write-only
–
0x0004
PIO Disable Register
PIO_PDR
Write-only
–
PIO_PSR
Read-only
(1)
0x0008
PIO Status Register
0x000C
Reserved
0x0010
Output Enable Register
PIO_OER
Write-only
–
0x0014
Output Disable Register
PIO_ODR
Write-only
–
0x0018
Output Status Register
PIO_OSR
Read-only
0x0000 0000
0x001C
Reserved
0x0020
Glitch Input Filter Enable Register
PIO_IFER
Write-only
–
0x0024
Glitch Input Filter Disable Register
PIO_IFDR
Write-only
–
0x0028
Glitch Input Filter Status Register
PIO_IFSR
Read-only
0x0000 0000
0x002C
Reserved
0x0030
Set Output Data Register
PIO_SODR
Write-only
–
0x0034
Clear Output Data Register
PIO_CODR
Write-only
0x0038
Output Data Status Register
PIO_ODSR
Read-only
or(2)
Read-write
0x003C
Pin Data Status Register
PIO_PDSR
Read-only
(3)
0x0040
Interrupt Enable Register
PIO_IER
Write-only
–
0x0044
Interrupt Disable Register
PIO_IDR
Write-only
–
0x0048
Interrupt Mask Register
PIO_IMR
Read-only
0x00000000
0x004C
Interrupt Status Register(4)
PIO_ISR
Read-only
0x00000000
0x0050
Multi-driver Enable Register
PIO_MDER
Write-only
–
0x0054
Multi-driver Disable Register
PIO_MDDR
Write-only
–
0x0058
Multi-driver Status Register
PIO_MDSR
Read-only
0x00000000
0x005C
Reserved
0x0060
Pull-up Disable Register
PIO_PUDR
Write-only
–
0x0064
Pull-up Enable Register
PIO_PUER
Write-only
–
0x0068
Pad Pull-up Status Register
PIO_PUSR
Read-only
0x00000000
0x006C
Reserved
90
–
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 15-2.
Register Mapping (Continued)
Offset
Register
0x0070
0x0074
Name
Peripheral A Select Register
(5)
Peripheral B Select Register
(5)
(5)
Access
Reset
PIO_ASR
Write-only
–
PIO_BSR
Write-only
–
PIO_ABSR
Read-only
0x00000000
0x0078
AB Status Register
0x007C
to
0x009C
Reserved
0x00A0
Output Write Enable
PIO_OWER
Write-only
–
0x00A4
Output Write Disable
PIO_OWDR
Write-only
–
0x00A8
Output Write Status Register
PIO_OWSR
Read-only
0x00000000
0x00AC
Reserved
Notes:
1. Reset value of PIO_PSR depends on the product implementation.
2. PIO_ODSR is Read-only or Read/Write depending on PIO_OWSR I/O lines.
3. Reset value of PIO_PDSR depends on the level of the I/O lines. Reading the I/O line levels requires the clock of the PIO
Controller to be enabled, otherwise PIO_PDSR reads the levels present on the I/O line at the time the clock was disabled.
4. PIO_ISR is reset at 0x0. However, the first read of the register may read a different value as input changes may have
occurred.
5. Only this set of registers clears the status by writing 1 in the first register and sets the status by writing 1 in the second
register.
91
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.6.1
Name:
PIO Controller PIO Enable Register
PIO_PER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: PIO Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the PIO to control the corresponding pin (disables peripheral control of the pin).
15.6.2
Name:
PIO Controller PIO Disable Register
PIO_PDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: PIO Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the PIO from controlling the corresponding pin (enables peripheral control of the pin).
92
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.6.3
Name:
PIO Controller PIO Status Register
PIO_PSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: PIO Status
0 = PIO is inactive on the corresponding I/O line (peripheral is active).
1 = PIO is active on the corresponding I/O line (peripheral is inactive).
15.6.4
Name:
PIO Controller Output Enable Register
PIO_OER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Output Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the output on the I/O line.
93
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.6.5
Name:
PIO Controller Output Disable Register
PIO_ODR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Output Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the output on the I/O line.
15.6.6
Name:
PIO Controller Output Status Register
PIO_OSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Output Status
0 = The I/O line is a pure input.
1 = The I/O line is enabled in output.
94
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.6.7
Name:
PIO Controller Input Filter Enable Register
PIO_IFER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Input Filter Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the input glitch filter on the I/O line.
15.6.8
Name:
PIO Controller Input Filter Disable Register
PIO_IFDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Input Filter Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the input glitch filter on the I/O line.
95
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.6.9
Name:
PIO Controller Input Filter Status Register
PIO_IFSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Input Filer Status
0 = The input glitch filter is disabled on the I/O line.
1 = The input glitch filter is enabled on the I/O line.
15.6.10
Name:
PIO Controller Set Output Data Register
PIO_SODR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Set Output Data
0 = No effect.
1 = Sets the data to be driven on the I/O line.
96
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.6.11
Name:
PIO Controller Clear Output Data Register
PIO_CODR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Set Output Data
0 = No effect.
1 = Clears the data to be driven on the I/O line.
15.6.12
Name:
PIO Controller Output Data Status Register
PIO_ODSR
Access Type:
Read-only or Read/Write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Output Data Status
0 = The data to be driven on the I/O line is 0.
1 = The data to be driven on the I/O line is 1.
97
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.6.13
Name:
PIO Controller Pin Data Status Register
PIO_PDSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Output Data Status
0 = The I/O line is at level 0.
1 = The I/O line is at level 1.
15.6.14
Name:
PIO Controller Interrupt Enable Register
PIO_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the Input Change Interrupt on the I/O line.
98
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.6.15
Name:
PIO Controller Interrupt Disable Register
PIO_IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the Input Change Interrupt on the I/O line.
15.6.16
Name:
PIO Controller Interrupt Mask Register
PIO_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Mask
0 = Input Change Interrupt is disabled on the I/O line.
1 = Input Change Interrupt is enabled on the I/O line.
99
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.6.17
Name:
PIO Controller Interrupt Status Register
PIO_ISR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Status
0 = No Input Change has been detected on the I/O line since PIO_ISR was last read or since reset.
1 = At least one Input Change has been detected on the I/O line since PIO_ISR was last read or since reset.
15.6.18
Name:
PIO Multi-driver Enable Register
PIO_MDER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Multi Drive Enable.
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables Multi Drive on the I/O line.
100
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.6.19
Name:
PIO Multi-driver Disable Register
PIO_MDDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Multi Drive Disable.
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables Multi Drive on the I/O line.
15.6.20
Name:
PIO Multi-driver Status Register
PIO_MDSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Multi Drive Status.
0 = The Multi Drive is disabled on the I/O line. The pin is driven at high and low level.
1 = The Multi Drive is enabled on the I/O line. The pin is driven at low level only.
101
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.6.21
Name:
PIO Pull Up Disable Register
PIO_PUDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Pull Up Disable.
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the pull up resistor on the I/O line.
15.6.22
Name:
PIO Pull Up Enable Register
PIO_PUER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Pull Up Enable.
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the pull up resistor on the I/O line.
102
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.6.23
Name:
PIO Pull Up Status Register
PIO_PUSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Pull Up Status.
0 = Pull Up resistor is enabled on the I/O line.
1 = Pull Up resistor is disabled on the I/O line.
15.6.24
Name:
PIO Peripheral A Select Register
PIO_ASR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Peripheral A Select.
0 = No effect.
1 = Assigns the I/O line to the Peripheral A function.
103
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.6.25
Name:
PIO Peripheral B Select Register
PIO_BSR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Peripheral B Select.
0 = No effect.
1 = Assigns the I/O line to the peripheral B function.
15.6.26
Name:
PIO Peripheral A B Status Register
PIO_ABSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Peripheral A B Status.
0 = The I/O line is assigned to the Peripheral A.
1 = The I/O line is assigned to the Peripheral B.
104
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
15.6.27
Name:
PIO Output Write Enable Register
PIO_OWER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Output Write Enable.
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables writing PIO_ODSR for the I/O line.
15.6.28
Name:
PIO Output Write Disable Register
PIO_OWDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Output Write Disable.
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables writing PIO_ODSR for the I/O line.
105
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
15.6.29
Name:
PIO Output Write Status Register
PIO_OWSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
P31
P30
P29
P28
P27
P26
P25
P24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
P23
P22
P21
P20
P19
P18
P17
P16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
• P0-P31: Output Write Status.
0 = Writing PIO_ODSR does not affect the I/O line.
1 = Writing PIO_ODSR affects the I/O line.
106
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
16. Periodic Interval Timer (PIT)
16.1
Overview
The Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) provides the operating system’s scheduler interrupt. It is
designed to offer maximum accuracy and efficient management, even for systems with long
response time.
16.2
Block Diagram
Figure 16-1. Periodic Interval Timer
PIT_MR
PIV
=?
PIT_MR
PITIEN
set
0
PIT_SR
PITS
pit_irq
reset
0
MCK
Prescaler
0
0
1
12-bit
Adder
1
read PIT_PIVR
20-bit
Counter
MCK/16
CPIV
PIT_PIVR
CPIV
PIT_PIIR
PICNT
PICNT
107
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
16.3
Functional Description
The Periodic Interval Timer aims at providing periodic interrupts for use by operating systems.
The PIT provides a programmable overflow counter and a reset-on-read feature. It is built
around two counters: a 20-bit CPIV counter and a 12-bit PICNT counter. Both counters work at
Master Clock /16.
The first 20-bit CPIV counter increments from 0 up to a programmable overflow value set in the
field PIV of the Mode Register (PIT_MR). When the counter CPIV reaches this value, it resets to
0 and increments the Periodic Interval Counter, PICNT. The status bit PITS in the Status Register (PIT_SR) rises and triggers an interrupt, provided the interrupt is enabled (PITIEN in
PIT_MR).
Writing a new PIV value in PIT_MR does not reset/restart the counters.
When CPIV and PICNT values are obtained by reading the Periodic Interval Value Register
(PIT_PIVR), the overflow counter (PICNT) is reset and the PITS is cleared, thus acknowledging
the interrupt. The value of PICNT gives the number of periodic intervals elapsed since the last
read of PIT_PIVR.
When CPIV and PICNT values are obtained by reading the Periodic Interval Image Register
(PIT_PIIR), there is no effect on the counters CPIV and PICNT, nor on the bit PITS. For example, a profiler can read PIT_PIIR without clearing any pending interrupt, whereas a timer
interrupt clears the interrupt by reading PIT_PIVR.
The PIT may be enabled/disabled using the PITEN bit in the PIT_MR register (disabled on
reset). The PITEN bit only becomes effective when the CPIV value is 0. Figure 16-2 illustrates
the PIT counting. After the PIT Enable bit is reset (PITEN= 0), the CPIV goes on counting until
the PIV value is reached, and is then reset. PIT restarts counting, only if the PITEN is set again.
The PIT is stopped when the core enters debug state.
108
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 16-2. Enabling/Disabling PIT with PITEN
APB cycle
APB cycle
MCK
15
restarts MCK Prescaler
MCK Prescaler 0
PITEN
CPIV
PICNT
0
1
PIV - 1
0
PIV
1
0
1
0
PITS (PIT_SR)
APB Interface
read PIT_PIVR
109
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
16.4
Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) User Interface
Table 16-1.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00
Mode Register
PIT_MR
Read-write
0x000F_FFFF
0x04
Status Register
PIT_SR
Read-only
0x0000_0000
0x08
Periodic Interval Value Register
PIT_PIVR
Read-only
0x0000_0000
0x0C
Periodic Interval Image Register
PIT_PIIR
Read-only
0x0000_0000
110
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
16.4.1
Periodic Interval Timer Mode Register
Register Name:
PIT_MR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
PITIEN
24
PITEN
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
PIV
PIV
7
6
5
4
PIV
• PIV: Periodic Interval Value
Defines the value compared with the primary 20-bit counter of the Periodic Interval Timer (CPIV). The period is equal to
(PIV + 1).
• PITEN: Period Interval Timer Enabled
0 = The Periodic Interval Timer is disabled when the PIV value is reached.
1 = The Periodic Interval Timer is enabled.
• PITIEN: Periodic Interval Timer Interrupt Enable
0 = The bit PITS in PIT_SR has no effect on interrupt.
1 = The bit PITS in PIT_SR asserts interrupt.
16.4.2
Periodic Interval Timer Status Register
Register Name:
PIT_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
PITS
• PITS: Periodic Interval Timer Status
0 = The Periodic Interval timer has not reached PIV since the last read of PIT_PIVR.
1 = The Periodic Interval timer has reached PIV since the last read of PIT_PIVR.
111
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
16.4.3
Periodic Interval Timer Value Register
Register Name:
PIT_PIVR
Access Type:
31
Read-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
PICNT
23
22
21
20
PICNT
15
14
CPIV
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
25
24
17
16
CPIV
7
6
5
4
CPIV
Reading this register clears PITS in PIT_SR.
• CPIV: Current Periodic Interval Value
Returns the current value of the periodic interval timer.
• PICNT: Periodic Interval Counter
Returns the number of occurrences of periodic intervals since the last read of PIT_PIVR.
16.4.4
Periodic Interval Timer Image Register
Register Name:
PIT_PIIR
Access Type:
31
Read-only
30
29
28
27
26
19
18
PICNT
23
22
21
20
PICNT
15
14
CPIV
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CPIV
7
6
5
4
CPIV
• CPIV: Current Periodic Interval Value
Returns the current value of the periodic interval timer.
• PICNT: Periodic Interval Counter
Returns the number of occurrences of periodic intervals since the last read of PIT_PIVR.
112
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
17. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
17.1
Overview
The Watchdog Timer can be used to prevent system lock-up if the software becomes trapped in
a deadlock. It features a 12-bit down counter that allows a watchdog period of up to 16 seconds
(slow clock at 32.768 kHz). It can generate a general reset or a processor reset only. In addition,
it can be stopped while the processor is in debug mode or idle mode.
17.2
Block Diagram
Figure 17-1. Watchdog Timer Block Diagram
write WDT_MR
WDT_MR
WDV
WDT_CR
WDRSTT
reload
1
0
12-bit Down
Counter
WDT_MR
WDD
reload
Current
Value
1/128
SLCK
<= WDD
WDT_MR
WDRSTEN
= 0
wdt_fault
(to Reset Controller)
set
set
read WDT_SR
or
reset
WDERR
reset
WDUNF
reset
wdt_int
WDFIEN
WDT_MR
113
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
17.3
Functional Description
The Watchdog Timer can be used to prevent system lock-up if the software becomes trapped in
a deadlock. It is supplied with VDDCORE. It restarts with initial values on processor reset.
The Watchdog is built around a 12-bit down counter, which is loaded with the value defined in
the field WV of the Mode Register (WDT_MR). The Watchdog Timer uses the Slow Clock
divided by 128 to establish the maximum Watchdog period to be 16 seconds (with a typical Slow
Clock of 32.768 kHz).
After a Processor Reset, the value of WV is 0xFFF, corresponding to the maximum value of the
counter with the external reset generation enabled (field WDRSTEN at 1 after a Backup Reset).
This means that a default Watchdog is running at reset, i.e., at power-up. The user must either
disable it (by setting the WDDIS bit in WDT_MR) if he does not expect to use it or must reprogram it to meet the maximum Watchdog period the application requires.
The Watchdog Mode Register (WDT_MR) can be written only once. Only a processor reset
resets it. Writing the WDT_MR register reloads the timer with the newly programmed mode
parameters.
In normal operation, the user reloads the Watchdog at regular intervals before the timer underflow occurs, by writing the Control Register (WDT_CR) with the bit WDRSTT to 1. The
Watchdog counter is then immediately reloaded from WDT_MR and restarted, and the Slow
Clock 128 divider is reset and restarted. The WDT_CR register is write-protected. As a result,
writing WDT_CR without the correct hard-coded key has no effect. If an underflow does occur,
the “wdt_fault” signal to the Reset Controller is asserted if the bit WDRSTEN is set in the Mode
Register (WDT_MR). Moreover, the bit WDUNF is set in the Watchdog Status Register
(WDT_SR).
To prevent a software deadlock that continuously triggers the Watchdog, the reload of the
Watchdog must occur while the Watchdog counter is within a window between 0 and WDD,
WDD is defined in the WatchDog Mode Register WDT_MR.
Any attempt to restart the Watchdog while the Watchdog counter is between WDV and WDD
results in a Watchdog error, even if the Watchdog is disabled. The bit WDERR is updated in the
WDT_SR and the “wdt_fault” signal to the Reset Controller is asserted.
Note that this feature can be disabled by programming a WDD value greater than or equal to the
WDV value. In such a configuration, restarting the Watchdog Timer is permitted in the whole
range [0; WDV] and does not generate an error. This is the default configuration on reset (the
WDD and WDV values are equal).
The status bits WDUNF (Watchdog Underflow) and WDERR (Watchdog Error) trigger an interrupt, provided the bit WDFIEN is set in the mode register. The signal “wdt_fault” to the reset
controller causes a Watchdog reset if the WDRSTEN bit is set as already explained in the reset
controller programmer Datasheet. In that case, the processor and the Watchdog Timer are
reset, and the WDERR and WDUNF flags are reset.
If a reset is generated or if WDT_SR is read, the status bits are reset, the interrupt is cleared,
and the “wdt_fault” signal to the reset controller is deasserted.
Writing the WDT_MR reloads and restarts the down counter.
While the processor is in debug state or in idle mode, the counter may be stopped depending on
the value programmed for the bits WDIDLEHLT and WDDBGHLT in the WDT_MR.
114
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 17-2. Watchdog Behavior
Watchdog Error
Watchdog Underflow
if WDRSTEN is 1
FFF
Normal behavior
if WDRSTEN is 0
WDV
Forbidden
Window
WDD
Permitted
Window
0
Watchdog
Fault
WDT_CR = WDRSTT
115
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
17.4
Watchdog Timer (WDT) User Interface
Table 17-1.
Offset
Register Mapping
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00
Control Register
WDT_CR
Write-only
-
0x04
Mode Register
WDT_MR
Read/Write Once
0x3FFF_2FFF
0x08
Status Register
WDT_SR
Read-only
0x0000_0000
17.4.1
Watchdog Timer Control Register
Register Name:
WDT_CR
Access Type:
31
Write-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
KEY
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
WDRSTT
• WDRSTT: Watchdog Restart
0: No effect.
1: Restarts the Watchdog.
• KEY: Password
Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation.
116
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
17.4.2
Watchdog Timer Mode Register
Register Name:
WDT_MR
Access Type:
Read/Write Once
31
–
30
–
29
WDIDLEHLT
28
WDDBGHLT
27
26
23
22
21
20
19
18
11
10
25
24
17
16
9
8
1
0
WDD
WDD
15
WDDIS
14
13
12
WDRPROC
WDRSTEN
WDFIEN
7
6
5
4
WDV
3
2
WDV
• WDV: Watchdog Counter Value
Defines the value loaded in the 12-bit Watchdog Counter.
• WDFIEN: Watchdog Fault Interrupt Enable
0: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) has no effect on interrupt.
1: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) asserts interrupt.
• WDRSTEN: Watchdog Reset Enable
0: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) has no effect on the resets.
1: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) triggers a Watchdog reset.
• WDRPROC: Watchdog Reset Processor
0: If WDRSTEN is 1, a Watchdog fault (underflow or error) activates all resets.
1: If WDRSTEN is 1, a Watchdog fault (underflow or error) activates the processor reset.
• WDD: Watchdog Delta Value
Defines the permitted range for reloading the Watchdog Timer.
If the Watchdog Timer value is less than or equal to WDD, writing WDT_CR with WDRSTT = 1 restarts the timer.
If the Watchdog Timer value is greater than WDD, writing WDT_CR with WDRSTT = 1 causes a Watchdog error.
• WDDBGHLT: Watchdog Debug Halt
0: The Watchdog runs when the processor is in debug state.
1: The Watchdog stops when the processor is in debug state.
• WDIDLEHLT: Watchdog Idle Halt
0: The Watchdog runs when the system is in idle mode.
1: The Watchdog stops when the system is in idle state.
• WDDIS: Watchdog Disable
0: Enables the Watchdog Timer.
1: Disables the Watchdog Timer.
117
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
17.4.3
Watchdog Timer Status Register
Register Name:
WDT_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
WDERR
0
WDUNF
• WDUNF: Watchdog Underflow
0: No Watchdog underflow occurred since the last read of WDT_SR.
1: At least one Watchdog underflow occurred since the last read of WDT_SR.
• WDERR: Watchdog Error
0: No Watchdog error occurred since the last read of WDT_SR.
1: At least one Watchdog error occurred since the last read of WDT_SR.
118
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
18. Voltage Regulator Mode Controller (VREG)
18.1
Overview
The Voltage Regulator Mode Controller contains one Read/Write register, the Voltage Regulator
Mode Register. Its offset is 0x60 with respect to the System Controller offset.
This register controls the Voltage Regulator Mode. Setting PSTDBY (bit 0) puts the Voltage
Regulator in Standby Mode or Low-power Mode. On reset, the PSTDBY is reset, so as to wake
up the Voltage Regulator in Normal Mode.
119
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
18.2
Voltage Regulator Power Controller (VREG) User Interface
Table 18-1.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
0x60
Voltage Regulator Mode Register
VREG_MR
Access
Reset
Read/Write
0x0
18.2.1
Voltage Regulator Mode Register
Register Name:
VREG_MR
Access Type:
Read/Write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
PSTDBY
• PSTDBY: Periodic Interval Value
0 = Voltage regulator in normal mode.
1 = Voltage regulator in standby mode (low-power mode).
120
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
19. Memory Controller (MC)
19.1
Overview
The Memory Controller (MC) manages the ASB bus and controls accesses requested by the masters, typically the
ARM7TDMI processor and the Peripheral DMA Controller. It features a bus arbiter, an address decoder, an abort status, a
misalignment detector and an Embedded Flash Controller.
19.2
Block Diagram
Figure 19-1. Memory Controller Block Diagram
Memory Controller
ASB
ARM7TDMI
Processor
Embedded
Flash
Controller
Abort
Internal
Flash
Abort
Status
Internal
RAM
EMAC
DMA
Bus
Arbiter
Misalignment
Detector
Address
Decoder
User
Interface
Peripheral
DMA
Controller
APB
Bridge
Peripheral 0
Peripheral 1
APB
From Master
to Slave
Peripheral N
121
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
19.3
Functional Description
The Memory Controller handles the internal ASB bus and arbitrates the accesses of up to three
masters.
It is made up of:
• A bus arbiter
• An address decoder
• An abort status
• A misalignment detector
• An Embedded Flash Controller
The MC handles only little-endian mode accesses. The masters work in little-endian mode only.
19.3.1
Bus Arbiter
The Memory Controller has a simple, hard-wired priority bus arbiter that gives the control of the
bus to one of the three masters. The EMAC has the highest priority; the Peripheral DMA Controller has the medium priority; the ARM processor has the lowest one.
19.3.2
Address Decoder
The Memory Controller features an Address Decoder that first decodes the four highest bits of
the 32-bit address bus and defines three separate areas:
• One 256-Mbyte address space for the internal memories
• One 256-Mbyte address space reserved for the embedded peripherals
• An undefined address space of 3584M bytes representing fourteen 256-Mbyte areas that
return an Abort if accessed
Figure 19-2 shows the assignment of the 256-Mbyte memory areas.
Figure 19-2. Memory Areas
256M Bytes
0x0000 0000
Internal Memories
0x0FFF FFFF
0x1000 0000
14 x 256MBytes
3,584 Mbytes
Undefined
(Abort)
0xEFFF FFFF
256M Bytes
0xF000 0000
Peripherals
0xFFFF FFFF
122
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
19.3.2.1
Internal Memory Mapping
Within the Internal Memory address space, the Address Decoder of the Memory Controller
decodes eight more address bits to allocate 1-Mbyte address spaces for the embedded
memories.
The allocated memories are accessed all along the 1-Mbyte address space and so are repeated
n times within this address space, n equaling 1M bytes divided by the size of the memory.
When the address of the access is undefined within the internal memory area, the Address
Decoder returns an Abort to the master.
Figure 19-3. Internal Memory Mapping
0x0000 0000
Internal Memory Area 0
1 M Bytes
0x000F FFFF
0x0010 0000
0x001F FFFF
0x0020 0000
256M Bytes
0x002F FFFF
0x0030 0000
0x003F FFFF
0x0040 0000
Internal Memory Area 1
Internal Flash
1 M Bytes
Internal Memory Area 2
Internal SRAM
1 M Bytes
Internal Memory Area 3
Internal ROM
1 M Bytes
Undefined Areas
(Abort)
252 M Bytes
0x0FFF FFFF
19.3.2.2
Internal Memory Area 0
The first 32 bytes of Internal Memory Area 0 contain the ARM processor exception vectors, in
particular, the Reset Vector at address 0x0.
Before execution of the remap command, the on-chip Flash is mapped into Internal Memory
Area 0, so that the ARM7TDMI reaches an executable instruction contained in Flash. After the
remap command, the internal SRAM at address 0x0020 0000 is mapped into Internal Memory
Area 0. The memory mapped into Internal Memory Area 0 is accessible in both its original location and at address 0x0.
19.3.3
Remap Command
After execution, the Remap Command causes the Internal SRAM to be accessed through the
Internal Memory Area 0.
As the ARM vectors (Reset, Abort, Data Abort, Prefetch Abort, Undefined Instruction, Interrupt,
and Fast Interrupt) are mapped from address 0x0 to address 0x20, the Remap Command allows
the user to redefine dynamically these vectors under software control.
The Remap Command is accessible through the Memory Controller User Interface by writing the
MC_RCR (Remap Control Register) RCB field to one.
The Remap Command can be cancelled by writing the MC_RCR RCB field to one, which acts as
a toggling command. This allows easy debug of the user-defined boot sequence by offering a
simple way to put the chip in the same configuration as after a reset.
123
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
19.3.4
Abort Status
There are two reasons for an abort to occur:
• access to an undefined address
• an access to a misaligned address.
When an abort occurs, a signal is sent back to all the masters, regardless of which one has generated the access. However, only the ARM7TDMI can take an abort signal into account, and
only under the condition that it was generating an access. The Peripheral DMA Controller and
the EMAC do not handle the abort input signal. Note that the connections are not represented in
Figure 19-1.
To facilitate debug or for fault analysis by an operating system, the Memory Controller integrates
an Abort Status register set.
The full 32-bit wide abort address is saved in MC_AASR. Parameters of the access are saved in
MC_ASR and include:
• the size of the request (field ABTSZ)
• the type of the access, whether it is a data read or write, or a code fetch (field ABTTYP)
• whether the access is due to accessing an undefined address (bit UNDADD) or a misaligned
address (bit MISADD)
• the source of the access leading to the last abort (bits MST_EMAC, MST_PDC and
MST_ARM)
• whether or not an abort occurred for each master since the last read of the register (bits
SVMST_EMAC, SVMST_PDC and SVMST_ARM) unless this information is loaded in MST
bits
In the case of a Data Abort from the processor, the address of the data access is stored. This is
useful, as searching for which address generated the abort would require disassembling the
instructions and full knowledge of the processor context.
In the case of a Prefetch Abort, the address may have changed, as the prefetch abort is pipelined in the ARM processor. The ARM processor takes the prefetch abort into account only if the
read instruction is executed and it is probable that several aborts have occurred during this time.
Thus, in this case, it is preferable to use the content of the Abort Link register of the ARM
processor.
19.3.5
Embedded Flash Controller
The Embedded Flash Controller is added to the Memory Controller and ensures the interface of
the flash block with the 32-bit internal bus. It allows an increase of performance in Thumb Mode
for Code Fetch with its system of 32-bit buffers. It also manages with the programming, erasing,
locking and unlocking sequences thanks to a full set of commands.
19.3.6
Misalignment Detector
The Memory Controller features a Misalignment Detector that checks the consistency of the
accesses.
For each access, regardless of the master, the size of the access and the bits 0 and 1 of the
address bus are checked. If the type of access is a word (32-bit) and the bits 0 and 1 are not 0,
or if the type of the access is a half-word (16-bit) and the bit 0 is not 0, an abort is returned to the
master and the access is cancelled. Note that the accesses of the ARM processor when it is
fetching instructions are not checked.
124
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
The misalignments are generally due to software bugs leading to wrong pointer handling. These
bugs are particularly difficult to detect in the debug phase.
As the requested address is saved in the Abort Status Register and the address of the instruction generating the misalignment is saved in the Abort Link Register of the processor, detection
and fix of this kind of software bugs is simplified.
125
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
19.4
Memory Controller (MC) User Interface
Base Address: 0xFFFFFF00
Table 19-1.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
0x00
MC Remap Control Register
MC_RCR
Write-only
0x04
MC Abort Status Register
MC_ASR
Read-only
0x0
0x08
MC Abort Address Status Register
MC_AASR
Read-only
0x0
0x10-0x5C
Reserved
0x60
EFC0 Configuration Registers
0x70
EFC1(1) Configuration Registers
Note:
126
Reset
See the Embedded Flash Controller Section
1. EFC1 pertains to AT91SAM7XC512 only.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
19.4.1
MC Remap Control Register
Register Name:
MC_RCR
Access Type:
Write-only
Offset:
0x0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
RCB
• RCB: Remap Command Bit
0: No effect.
1: This Command Bit acts on a toggle basis: writing a 1 alternatively cancels and restores the remapping of the page zero
memory devices.
127
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
19.4.2
MC Abort Status Register
Register Name:
MC_ASR
Access Type:
Read-only
Reset Value:
0x0
Offset:
0x04
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
SVMST_ARM
SVMST_PDC
SVMST_EMAC
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
MST_ARM
MST_PDC
MST_EMAC
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
MISADD
UNDADD
ABTTYP
8
ABTSZ
• UNDADD: Undefined Address Abort Status
0: The last abort was not due to the access of an undefined address in the address space.
1: The last abort was due to the access of an undefined address in the address space.
• MISADD: Misaligned Address Abort Status
0: The last aborted access was not due to an address misalignment.
1: The last aborted access was due to an address misalignment.
• ABTSZ: Abort Size Status
ABTSZ
Abort Size
0
0
Byte
0
1
Half-word
1
0
Word
1
1
Reserved
• ABTTYP: Abort Type Status
ABTTYP
Abort Type
0
0
Data Read
0
1
Data Write
1
0
Code Fetch
1
1
Reserved
• MST_EMAC: EMAC Abort Source
0: The last aborted access was not due to the EMAC.
1: The last aborted access was due to the EMAC.
128
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• MST_PDC: PDC Abort Source
0: The last aborted access was not due to the PDC.
1: The last aborted access was due to the PDC.
• MST_ARM: ARM Abort Source
0: The last aborted access was not due to the ARM.
1: The last aborted access was due to the ARM.
• SVMST_EMAC: Saved EMAC Abort Source
0: No abort due to the EMAC occurred since the last read of MC_ASR or it is notified in the bit MST_EMAC.
1: At least one abort due to the EMAC occurred since the last read of MC_ASR.
• SVMST_PDC: Saved PDC Abort Source
0: No abort due to the PDC occurred since the last read of MC_ASR or it is notified in the bit MST_PDC.
1: At least one abort due to the PDC occurred since the last read of MC_ASR.
• SVMST_ARM: Saved ARM Abort Source
0: No abort due to the ARM occurred since the last read of MC_ASR or it is notified in the bit MST_ARM.
1: At least one abort due to the ARM occurred since the last read of MC_ASR.
129
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
19.4.3
MC Abort Address Status Register
Register Name:
MC_AASR
Access Type:
Read-only
Reset Value:
0x0
Offset:
0x08
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ABTADD
23
22
21
20
ABTADD
15
14
13
12
ABTADD
7
6
5
4
ABTADD
• ABTADD: Abort Address
This field contains the address of the last aborted access.
130
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
20. Embedded Flash Controller (EFC)
20.1
Overview
The Embedded Flash Controller (EFC ) is a part of the Memory Controller and ensures the interface of the Flash block with the 32-bit internal bus. It increases performance in Thumb Mode for
Code Fetch with its system of 32-bit buffers. It also manages the programming, erasing, locking
and unlocking sequences using a full set of commands.
The AT91SAM7XC512 is equipped with two EFCs, EFC0 and EFC1. EFC1 does not feature the
Security bit and GPNVM bits. The Security and GPNVM bits embedded only on EFC0 apply to
the two blocks in the AT91SAM7XC512.
20.2
20.2.1
Functional Description
Embedded Flash Organization
The Embedded Flash interfaces directly to the 32-bit internal bus. It is composed of several
interfaces:
• One memory plane organized in several pages of the same size
• Two 32-bit read buffers used for code read optimization (see “Read Operations” on page
132).
• One write buffer that manages page programming. The write buffer size is equal to the page
size. This buffer is write-only and accessible all along the 1 MByte address space, so that
each word can be written to its final address (see “Write Operations” on page 134).
• Several lock bits used to protect write and erase operations on lock regions. A lock region is
composed of several consecutive pages, and each lock region has its associated lock bit.
• Several general-purpose NVM bits. Each bit controls a specific feature in the device. Refer to
the product definition section to get the GPNVM assignment.
The Embedded Flash size, the page size and the lock region organization are described in the
product definition section.
Table 20-1.
Product Specific Lock and General-purpose NVM Bits
AT91SAM7XC512 AT91SAM7XC256 AT91SAM7XC128 Denomination
3
3
3
Number of General-purpose NVM bits
32
16
8
Number of Lock Bits
131
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 20-1. Embedded Flash Memory Mapping
Page 0
Flash Memory
Start Address
Lock Region 0
Lock Bit 0
Lock Region 1
Lock Bit 1
Lock Region (n-1)
Lock Bit n-1
Page (m-1)
Page ( (n-1)*m )
32-bit wide
Page (n*m-1)
20.2.2
Read Operations
An optimized controller manages embedded Flash reads. A system of 2 x 32-bit buffers is added
in order to start access at following address during the second read, thus increasing performance when the processor is running in Thumb mode (16-bit instruction set). See Figure 20-2,
Figure 20-3 and Figure 20-4.
This optimization concerns only Code Fetch and not Data.
The read operations can be performed with or without wait state. Up to 3 wait states can be programmed in the field FWS (Flash Wait State) in the Flash Mode Register MC_FMR (see “MC
Flash Mode Register” on page 142). Defining FWS to be 0 enables the single-cycle access of
the embedded Flash.
The Flash memory is accessible through 8-, 16- and 32-bit reads.
As the Flash block size is smaller than the address space reserved for the internal memory area,
the embedded Flash wraps around the address space and appears to be repeated within it.
132
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 20-2. Code Read Optimization in Thumb Mode for FWS = 0
Master Clock
ARM Request (16-bit)
Code Fetch
@Byte 0
Flash Access
@Byte 2
@Byte 4
Bytes 0-3
Bytes 4-7
Buffer (32 bits)
Bytes 0-1
@Byte 10
@Byte 8
Bytes 4-7
Bytes 2-3
Bytes 4-5
@Byte 12
Bytes 8-9
@Byte 16
Bytes 16-19
Bytes 12-15
Bytes 8-11
Bytes 6-7
@Byte 14
Bytes 12-15
Bytes 8-11
Bytes 0-3
Data To ARM
Note:
@Byte 6
Bytes 10-11
Bytes 12-13
Bytes 14-15
When FWS is equal to 0, all accesses are performed in a single-cycle access.
Figure 20-3. Code Read Optimization in Thumb Mode for FWS = 1
1 Wait State Cycle
1 Wait State Cycle
1 Wait State Cycle
1 Wait State Cycle
Master Clock
ARM Request (16-bit)
Code Fetch
@Byte 0
Flash Access
@Byte 2
Bytes 0-3
Buffer (32 bits)
Data To ARM
Note:
Bytes 0-1
@Byte 4
@Byte 6
@Byte 8
@Byte 10
@Byte 12
@Byte 14
Bytes 4-7
Bytes 8-11
Bytes 12-15
Bytes 0-3
Bytes 4-7
Bytes 8-11
Bytes 2-3
Bytes 4-5
Bytes 6-7
Bytes 8-9
Bytes 10-11
Bytes 12-13
When FWS is equal to 1, in case of sequential reads, all the accesses are performed in a single-cycle access (except for the
first one).
133
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 20-4. Code Read Optimization in Thumb Mode for FWS = 3
3 Wait State Cycles
3 Wait State Cycles
3 Wait State Cycles
3 Wait State Cycles
Master Clock
ARM Request (16-bit)
Code Fetch
@2
@Byte 0
Flash Access
Bytes 0-3
Buffer (32 bits)
Data To ARM
Note:
20.2.3
0-1
@6
@4
@10
@8
@12
Bytes 4-7
Bytes 8-11
Bytes 12-15
Bytes 0-3
Bytes 4-7
Bytes 8-11
2-3
4-5
8-9 10-11
6-7
12-13
When FWS is equal to 2 or 3, in case of sequential reads, the first access takes FWS cycles, the second access one cycle, the
third access FWS cycles, the fourth access one cycle, etc.
Write Operations
The internal memory area reserved for the embedded Flash can also be written through a writeonly latch buffer. Write operations take into account only the 8 lowest address bits and thus wrap
around within the internal memory area address space and appear to be repeated 1024 times
within it.
Write operations can be prevented by programming the Memory Protection Unit of the product.
Writing 8-bit and 16-bit data is not allowed and may lead to unpredictable data corruption.
Write operations are performed in the number of wait states equal to the number of wait states
for read operations + 1, except for FWS = 3 (see “MC Flash Mode Register” on page 142).
20.2.4
Flash Commands
The EFC offers a command set to manage programming the memory flash, locking and unlocking lock sectors, consecutive programming and locking, and full Flash erasing.
Table 20-2.
134
Set of Commands
Command
Value
Mnemonic
Write page
0x01
WP
Set Lock Bit
0x02
SLB
Write Page and Lock
0x03
WPL
Clear Lock Bit
0x04
CLB
Erase all
0x08
EA
Set General-purpose NVM Bit
0x0B
SGPB
Clear General-purpose NVM Bit
0x0D
CGPB
Set Security Bit
0x0F
SSB
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
To run one of these commands, the field FCMD of the MC_FCR register has to be written with
the command number. As soon as the MC_FCR register is written, the FRDY flag is automatically cleared. Once the current command is achieved, then the FRDY flag is automatically set. If
an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated.
All the commands are protected by the same keyword, which has to be written in the eight highest bits of the MC_FCR register.
Writing MC_FCR with data that does not contain the correct key and/or with an invalid command
has no effect on the memory plane; however, the PROGE flag is set in the MC_FSR register.
This flag is automatically cleared by a read access to the MC_FSR register.
When the current command writes or erases a page in a locked region, the command has no
effect on the whole memory plane; however, the LOCKE flag is set in the MC_FSR register. This
flag is automatically cleared by a read access to the MC_FSR register.
135
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 20-5. Command State Chart
Read Status: MC_FSR
No
Check if FRDY flag set
Yes
Write FCMD and PAGENB in MC_FCR
Read Status: MC_FSR
No
Check if FRDY flag set
Yes
Check if LOCKE flag set
Yes
Locking region violation
No
Check if PROGE flag set
Yes
Bad keyword violation and/or Invalid command
No
Command Successful
In order to guarantee valid operations on the Flash memory, the field Flash Microsecond Cycle
Number (FMCN) in the Flash Mode Register MC_FMR must be correctly programmed (see “MC
Flash Mode Register” on page 142).
20.2.4.1
Flash Programming
Several commands can be used to program the Flash.
The Flash technology requires that an erase must be done before programming. The entire
memory plane can be erased at the same time, or a page can be automatically erased by clearing the NEBP bit in the MC_FMR register before writing the command in the MC_FCR register.
By setting the NEBP bit in the MC_FMR register, a page can be programmed in several steps if
it has been erased before (see Figure 20-6).
136
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 20-6. Example of Partial Page Programming:
32 bits wide
32 bits wide
16 words
16 words
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
16 words
FF
FF
FF
16 words
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF FF
...
FF FF
FF FF
FF
CA
FE
FF
FF
CA
CA
FE
FE
FF FF
...
FF FF
FF FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF FF
...
FF FF
FF FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
...
Step 1.
Erase All Flash
Page 7 erased
...
...
...
...
32 bits wide
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
CA
FE
CA
FE
CA
CA
FE
FE
CA
CA
FE
FE
FF
FF
DE
CA
FF
FF
FF
FF
DE
DE
CA
CA
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
Step 2.
Programming of the second part of Page 7
(NEBP = 1)
FF
...
FF
FF
FF
CA
FE
CA
CA
FE
FE
DE
CA
DE
DE
CA
CA
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
FF
...
...
...
Step 3.
Programming of the third part of Page 7
(NEBP = 1)
After programming, the page (the whole lock region) can be locked to prevent miscellaneous
write or erase sequences. The lock bit can be automatically set after page programming using
WPL.
Data to be written are stored in an internal latch buffer. The size of the latch buffer corresponds
to the page size. The latch buffer wraps around within the internal memory area address space
and appears to be repeated by the number of pages in it.
Note:
Writing of 8-bit and 16-bit data is not allowed and may lead to unpredictable data corruption.
Data are written to the latch buffer before the programming command is written to the Flash
Command Register MC_FCR. The sequence is as follows:
• Write the full page, at any page address, within the internal memory area address space
using only 32-bit access.
• Programming starts as soon as the page number and the programming command are written
to the Flash Command Register. The FRDY bit in the Flash Programming Status Register
(MC_FSR) is automatically cleared.
• When programming is completed, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register
(MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt was enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the
interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated.
Two errors can be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence:
• Programming Error: A bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the
MC_FCR register.
• Lock Error: The page to be programmed belongs to a locked region. A command must be
previously run to unlock the corresponding region.
20.2.4.2
Erase All Command
The entire memory can be erased if the Erase All Command (EA) in the Flash Command Register MC_FCR is written.
137
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Erase All operation is allowed only if there are no lock bits set. Thus, if at least one lock region is
locked, the bit LOCKE in MC_FSR rises and the command is cancelled. If the bit LOCKE has
been written at 1 in MC_FMR, the interrupt line rises.
When programming is complete, the bit FRDY bit in the Flash Programming Status Register
(MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated.
Two errors can be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence:
• Programming Error: A bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the
MC_FCR register.
• Lock Error: At least one lock region to be erased is protected. The erase command has been
refused and no page has been erased. A Clear Lock Bit command must be executed
previously to unlock the corresponding lock regions.
20.2.4.3
Lock Bit Protection
Lock bits are associated with several pages in the embedded Flash memory plane. This defines
lock regions in the embedded Flash memory plane. They prevent writing/erasing protected
pages.
After production, the device may have some embedded Flash lock regions locked. These locked
regions are reserved for a default application. Refer to the product definition section for the
default embedded Flash mapping. Locked sectors can be unlocked to be erased and then programmed with another application or other data.
The lock sequence is:
• The Flash Command register must be written with the following value:
(0x5A << 24) | (lockPageNumber << 8 & PAGEN) | SLB
lockPageNumber is a page of the corresponding lock region.
• When locking completes, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR)
rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line
of the Memory Controller is activated.
A programming error, where a bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the
MC_FCR register, may be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence.
It is possible to clear lock bits that were set previously. Then the locked region can be erased or
programmed. The unlock sequence is:
• The Flash Command register must be written with the following value:
(0x5A << 24) | (lockPageNumber << 8 & PAGEN) | CLB
lockPageNumber is a page of the corresponding lock region.
• When the unlock completes, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register
(MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the
interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated.
A programming error, where a bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the
MC_FCR register, may be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence.
The Unlock command programs the lock bit to 1; the corresponding bit LOCKSx in MC_FSR
reads 0. The Lock command programs the lock bit to 0; the corresponding bit LOCKSx in
MC_FSR reads 1.
Note:
138
Access to the Flash in Read Mode is permitted when a Lock or Unlock command is performed.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
20.2.4.4
General-purpose NVM Bits
General-purpose NVM bits do not interfere with the embedded Flash memory plane. (Does not
apply to EFC1 on the AT91SAM7XC512.) These general-purpose bits are dedicated to protect
other parts of the product. They can be set (activated) or cleared individually. Refer to the product definition section for the general-purpose NVM bit action.
The activation sequence is:
• Start the Set General Purpose Bit command (SGPB) by writing the Flash Command Register
with the SEL command and the number of the general-purpose bit to be set in the PAGEN
field.
• When the bit is set, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register (MC_FSR) rises.
If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the interrupt line of the
Memory Controller is activated.
Two errors can be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence:
• Programming Error: A bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the
MC_FCR register
• If the general-purpose bit number is greater than the total number of general-purpose bits,
then the command has no effect.
It is possible to deactivate a general-purpose NVM bit set previously. The clear sequence is:
• Start the Clear General-purpose Bit command (CGPB) by writing the Flash Command
Register with CGPB and the number of the general-purpose bit to be cleared in the PAGEN
field.
• When the clear completes, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register
(MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the
interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated.
Two errors can be detected in the MC_FSR register after a programming sequence:
• Programming Error: a bad keyword and/or an invalid command have been written in the
MC_FCR register
• If the number of the general-purpose bit set in the PAGEN field is greater than the total
number of general-purpose bits, then the command has no effect.
The Clear General-purpose Bit command programs the general-purpose NVM bit to 1; the corresponding bit GPNVM0 to GPNVMx in MC_FSR reads 0. The Set General-purpose Bit command
programs the general-purpose NVM bit to 0; the corresponding bit GPNVMx in MC_FSR reads
1.
Note:
20.2.4.5
Access to the Flash in read mode is permitted when a Set, Clear or Get General-purpose NVM Bit
command is performed.
Security Bit
The goal of the security bit is to prevent external access to the internal bus system. (Does not
apply to EFC1 on the AT91SAM7XC512.) JTAG, Fast Flash Programming and Flash Serial Test
Interface features are disabled. Once set, this bit can be reset only by an external hardware
ERASE request to the chip. Refer to the product definition section for the pin name that controls
the ERASE. In this case, the full memory plane is erased and all lock and general-purpose NVM
bits are cleared. The security bit in the MC_FSR is cleared only after these operations. The activation sequence is:
• Start the Set Security Bit command (SSB) by writing the Flash Command Register.
139
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• When the locking completes, the bit FRDY in the Flash Programming Status Register
(MC_FSR) rises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit FRDY in MC_FMR, the
interrupt line of the Memory Controller is activated.
When the security bit is active, the SECURITY bit in the MC_FSR is set.
140
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
20.3
Embedded Flash Controller (EFC ) User Interface
The User Interface of the EFC is integrated within the Memory Controller with Base Address: 0xFFFF FF00.
The AT91SAM7XC512 is equipped with two EFCs, EFC0 and EFC1, as described in the Register Mapping tables and Register descriptions that follow.
Table 20-3.
Embedded Flash Controller (EFC0) Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset State
0x60
MC Flash Mode Register
MC_FMR
Read/Write
0x0
0x64
MC Flash Command Register
MC_FCR
Write-only
–
0x68
MC Flash Status Register
MC_FSR
Read-only
–
0x6C
Reserved
–
–
–
Name
Access
Reset State
Table 20-4.
Embedded Flash Controller (EFC1) Register Mapping
Offset
Register
0x70
MC Flash Mode Register
MC_FMR
Read/Write
0x0
0x74
MC Flash Command Register
MC_FCR
Write-only
–
0x78
MC Flash Status Register
MC_FSR
Read-only
–
0x7C
Reserved
–
–
–
141
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
20.3.1
MC Flash Mode Register
Register Name:
MC_FMR
Access Type:
Read/Write
Offset: (EFC0)
0x60
Offset: (EFC1)
0x70
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
23
22
21
20
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
19
18
17
16
FMCN
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
7
NEBP
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
PROGE
2
LOCKE
1
–
8
FWS
0
FRDY
• FRDY: Flash Ready Interrupt Enable
0: Flash Ready does not generate an interrupt.
1: Flash Ready generates an interrupt.
• LOCKE: Lock Error Interrupt Enable
0: Lock Error does not generate an interrupt.
1: Lock Error generates an interrupt.
• PROGE: Programming Error Interrupt Enable
0: Programming Error does not generate an interrupt.
1: Programming Error generates an interrupt.
• NEBP: No Erase Before Programming
0: A page erase is performed before programming.
1: No erase is performed before programming.
• FWS: Flash Wait State
This field defines the number of wait states for read and write operations:
142
FWS
Read Operations
Write Operations
0
1 cycle
2 cycles
1
2 cycles
3 cycles
2
3 cycles
4 cycles
3
4 cycles
4 cycles
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• FMCN: Flash Microsecond Cycle Number
Before writing Non Volatile Memory bits (Lock bits, General Purpose NVM bit and Security bits), this field must be set to the
number of Master Clock cycles in one microsecond.
When writing the rest of the Flash, this field defines the number of Master Clock cycles in 1.5 microseconds. This number
must be rounded up.
Warning: The value 0 is only allowed for a master clock period superior to 30 microseconds.
Warning: In order to guarantee valid operations on the flash memory, the field Flash Microsecond Cycle Number (FMCN)
must be correctly programmed.
143
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
20.3.2
MC Flash Command Register
Register Name:
MC_FCR
Access Type:
Write-only
Offset: (EFC0)
0x64
Offset: (EFC1)
0x74
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
–
18
–
17
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
KEY
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
15
14
13
12
16
PAGEN
PAGEN
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
FCMD
• FCMD: Flash Command
This field defines the Flash commands:
FCMD
0000
No command.
Does not raise the Programming Error Status flag in the Flash Status Register MC_FSR.
0001
Write Page Command (WP):
Starts the programming of the page specified in the PAGEN field.
0010
Set Lock Bit Command (SLB):
Starts a set lock bit sequence of the lock region specified in the PAGEN field.
0011
Write Page and Lock Command (WPL):
The lock sequence of the lock region associated with the page specified in the field PAGEN
occurs automatically after completion of the programming sequence.
0100
Clear Lock Bit Command (CLB):
Starts a clear lock bit sequence of the lock region specified in the PAGEN field.
1000
Erase All Command (EA):
Starts the erase of the entire Flash.
If at least one page is locked, the command is cancelled.
1011
Set General-purpose NVM Bit (SGPB):
Activates the general-purpose NVM bit corresponding to the number specified in the PAGEN
field.
1101
Clear General Purpose NVM Bit (CGPB):
Deactivates the general-purpose NVM bit corresponding to the number specified in the
PAGEN field.
1111
Set Security Bit Command (SSB):
Sets security bit.
Others
144
Operations
Reserved.
Raises the Programming Error Status flag in the Flash Status Register MC_FSR.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• PAGEN: Page Number
Command
PAGEN Description
Write Page Command
PAGEN defines the page number to be written.
Write Page and Lock Command
PAGEN defines the page number to be written and its associated
lock region.
Erase All Command
This field is meaningless
Set/Clear Lock Bit Command
PAGEN defines one page number of the lock region to be locked or
unlocked.
Set/Clear General Purpose NVM Bit Command
PAGEN defines the general-purpose bit number.
Set Security Bit Command
This field is meaningless
Note:
Depending on the command, all the possible unused bits of PAGEN are meaningless.
• KEY: Write Protection Key
This field should be written with the value 0x5A to enable the command defined by the bits of the register. If the field is written with a different value, the write is not performed and no action is started.
145
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
20.3.3
MC Flash Status Register
Register Name:
MC_FSR
Access Type:
Read-only
Offset: (EFC0)
0x68
Offset: (EFC1)
0x78
31
LOCKS15
30
LOCKS14
29
LOCKS13
28
LOCKS12
27
LOCKS11
26
LOCKS10
25
LOCKS9
24
LOCKS8
23
LOCKS7
22
LOCKS6
21
LOCKS5
20
LOCKS4
19
LOCKS3
18
LOCKS2
17
LOCKS1
16
LOCKS0
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
GPNVM2
9
GPNVM1
8
GPNVM0
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
SECURITY
3
PROGE
2
LOCKE
1
–
0
FRDY
• FRDY: Flash Ready Status
0: The EFC is busy and the application must wait before running a new command.
1: The EFC is ready to run a new command.
• LOCKE: Lock Error Status
0: No programming of at least one locked lock region has happened since the last read of MC_FSR.
1: Programming of at least one locked lock region has happened since the last read of MC_FSR.
• PROGE: Programming Error Status
0: No invalid commands and no bad keywords were written in the Flash Command Register MC_FCR.
1: An invalid command and/or a bad keyword was/were written in the Flash Command Register MC_FCR.
• SECURITY: Security Bit Status (Does not apply to EFC1 on the AT91SAM7XC512.)
0: The security bit is inactive.
1: The security bit is active.
• GPNVMx: General-purpose NVM Bit Status (Does not apply to EFC1 on the AT91SAM7XC512.)
0: The corresponding general-purpose NVM bit is inactive.
1: The corresponding general-purpose NVM bit is active.
• EFC LOCKSx: Lock Region x Lock Status
0: The corresponding lock region is not locked.
1: The corresponding lock region is locked.
146
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
21. Fast Flash Programming Interface (FFPI)
21.1
Overview
The Fast Flash Programming Interface provides two solutions - parallel or serial - for high-volume programming using a standard gang programmer. The parallel interface is fully
handshaked and the device is considered to be a standard EEPROM. Additionally, the parallel
protocol offers an optimized access to all the embedded Flash functionalities. The serial interface uses the standard IEEE 1149.1 JTAG protocol. It offers an optimized access to all the
embedded Flash functionalities.
Although the Fast Flash Programming Mode is a dedicated mode for high volume programming,
this mode not designed for in-situ programming.
21.2
21.2.1
Parallel Fast Flash Programming
Device Configuration
In Fast Flash Programming Mode, the device is in a specific test mode. Only a certain set of pins
is significant, the rest of the PIOs are used as inputs with a pull-up. The crystal oscillator is in
bypass mode. Other pins must be left unconnected.
Figure 21-1. Parallel Programming Interface
VDDIO
VDDIO
VDDIO
TST
PGMEN0
PGMEN1
VDDCORE
NCMD
VDDIO
RDY
PGMNCMD
PGMRDY
NOE
PGMNOE
VDDFLASH
PGMNVALID
GND
NVALID
MODE[3:0]
PGMM[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
PGMD[15:0]
0 - 50MHz
XIN
VDDPLL
147
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Table 21-1.
Signal Name
Signal Description List
Function
Active
Level
Type
Comments
Power
VDDFLASH
Flash Power Supply
Power
VDDIO
I/O Lines Power Supply
Power
VDDCORE
Core Power Supply
Power
VDDPLL
PLL Power Supply
Power
GND
Ground
Ground
Clocks
Main Clock Input.
This input can be tied to GND. In this
case, the device is clocked by the internal
RC oscillator.
XIN
Input
32KHz to 50MHz
Test
TST
Test Mode Select
Input
High
Must be connected to VDDIO
PGMEN0
Test Mode Select
Input
High
Must be connected to VDDIO
PGMEN1
Test Mode Select
Input
High
Must be connected to VDDIO
Input
Low
Pulled-up input at reset
Output
High
Pulled-up input at reset
Input
Low
Pulled-up input at reset
Output
Low
Pulled-up input at reset
PIO
PGMNCMD
Valid command available
PGMRDY
0: Device is busy
1: Device is ready for a new command
PGMNOE
Output Enable (active high)
PGMNVALID
0: DATA[15:0] is in input mode
1: DATA[15:0] is in output mode
PGMM[3:0]
Specifies DATA type (See Table 21-2)
PGMD[15:0]
Bi-directional data bus
21.2.2
Input
Pulled-up input at reset
Input/Output
Pulled-up input at reset
Signal Names
Depending on the MODE settings, DATA is latched in different internal registers.
Table 21-2.
Mode Coding
MODE[3:0]
Symbol
Data
0000
CMDE
Command Register
0001
ADDR0
Address Register LSBs
0010
ADDR1
0101
DATA
Data Register
Default
IDLE
No register
When MODE is equal to CMDE, then a new command (strobed on DATA[15:0] signals) is stored
in the command register.
148
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 21-3.
DATA[15:0]
Symbol
Command Executed
0x0011
READ
Read Flash
0x0012
WP
Write Page Flash
0x0022
WPL
Write Page and Lock Flash
0x0032
EWP
Erase Page and Write Page
0x0042
EWPL
Erase Page and Write Page then Lock
0x0013
EA
Erase All
0x0014
SLB
Set Lock Bit
0x0024
CLB
Clear Lock Bit
0x0015
GLB
Get Lock Bit
0x0034
SGPB
Set General Purpose NVM bit
0x0044
CGPB
Clear General Purpose NVM bit
0x0025
GGPB
Get General Purpose NVM bit
0x0054
SSE
Set Security Bit
0x0035
GSE
Get Security Bit
0x001F
WRAM
Write Memory
0x0016
SEFC
Select EFC Controller(1)
0x001E
GVE
Get Version
Note:
21.2.3
Command Bit Coding
1. Applies to AT91SAM7XC512.
Entering Programming Mode
The following algorithm puts the device in Parallel Programming Mode:
• Apply GND, VDDIO, VDDCORE, VDDFLASH and VDDPLL.
• Apply XIN clock within TPOR_RESET if an external clock is available.
• Wait for TPOR_RESET
• Start a read or write handshaking.
Note:
21.2.4
21.2.4.1
After reset, the device is clocked by the internal RC oscillator. Before clearing RDY signal, if an
external clock ( > 32 kHz) is connected to XIN, then the device switches on the external clock.
Else, XIN input is not considered. A higher frequency on XIN speeds up the programmer
handshake.
Programmer Handshaking
An handshake is defined for read and write operations. When the device is ready to start a new
operation (RDY signal set), the programmer starts the handshake by clearing the NCMD signal.
The handshaking is achieved once NCMD signal is high and RDY is high.
Write Handshaking
For details on the write handshaking sequence, refer to Figure 21-2and Table 21-4.
149
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 21-2. Parallel Programming Timing, Write Sequence
NCMD
2
4
3
RDY
5
NOE
NVALID
DATA[15:0]
1
MODE[3:0]
Table 21-4.
Write Handshake
Step
Programmer Action
Device Action
Data I/O
1
Sets MODE and DATA signals
Waits for NCMD low
Input
2
Clears NCMD signal
Latches MODE and DATA
Input
3
Waits for RDY low
Clears RDY signal
Input
4
Releases MODE and DATA signals
Executes command and polls NCMD high
Input
5
Sets NCMD signal
Executes command and polls NCMD high
Input
6
Waits for RDY high
Sets RDY
Input
21.2.4.2
Read Handshaking
For details on the read handshaking sequence, refer to Figure 21-3 and Table 21-5.
Figure 21-3.
Parallel Programming Timing, Read Sequence
NCMD
12
2
3
RDY
13
NOE
9
5
NVALID
11
7
6
4
DATA[15:0]
Adress IN
Z
8
Data OUT
10
X
IN
1
MODE[3:0]
150
ADDR
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 21-5.
Read Handshake
Step
Programmer Action
Device Action
DATA I/O
1
Sets MODE and DATA signals
Waits for NCMD low
Input
2
Clears NCMD signal
Latch MODE and DATA
Input
3
Waits for RDY low
Clears RDY signal
Input
4
Sets DATA signal in tristate
Waits for NOE Low
Input
5
Clears NOE signal
6
Waits for NVALID low
Tristate
7
Sets DATA bus in output mode and outputs
the flash contents.
Output
Clears NVALID signal
Output
Waits for NOE high
Output
8
Reads value on DATA Bus
9
Sets NOE signal
10
Waits for NVALID high
Sets DATA bus in input mode
X
11
Sets DATA in output mode
Sets NVALID signal
Input
12
Sets NCMD signal
Waits for NCMD high
Input
13
Waits for RDY high
Sets RDY signal
Input
21.2.5
Output
Device Operations
Several commands on the Flash memory are available. These commands are summarized in
Table 21-3 on page 149. Each command is driven by the programmer through the parallel interface running several read/write handshaking sequences.
When a new command is executed, the previous one is automatically achieved. Thus, chaining
a read command after a write automatically flushes the load buffer in the Flash.
21.2.5.1
Flash Read Command
This command is used to read the contents of the Flash memory. The read command can start
at any valid address in the memory plane and is optimized for consecutive reads. Read handshaking can be chained; an internal address buffer is automatically increased.
Table 21-6.
Read Command
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
READ
2
Write handshaking
ADDR0
Memory Address LSB
3
Write handshaking
ADDR1
Memory Address
4
Read handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
5
Read handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
...
...
...
...
n
Write handshaking
ADDR0
Memory Address LSB
n+1
Write handshaking
ADDR1
Memory Address
n+2
Read handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
n+3
Read handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
...
...
...
...
151
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
21.2.5.2
Flash Write Command
This command is used to write the Flash contents.
The Flash memory plane is organized into several pages. Data to be written are stored in a load
buffer that corresponds to a Flash memory page. The load buffer is automatically flushed to the
Flash:
• before access to any page other than the current one
• when a new command is validated (MODE = CMDE)
The Write Page command (WP) is optimized for consecutive writes. Write handshaking can be
chained; an internal address buffer is automatically increased.
Table 21-7.
Write Command
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
WP or WPL or EWP or EWPL
2
Write handshaking
ADDR0
Memory Address LSB
3
Write handshaking
ADDR1
Memory Address
4
Write handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
5
Write handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
...
...
...
...
n
Write handshaking
ADDR0
Memory Address LSB
n+1
Write handshaking
ADDR1
Memory Address
n+2
Write handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
n+3
Write handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
The Flash command Write Page and Lock (WPL) is equivalent to the Flash Write Command.
However, the lock bit is automatically set at the end of the Flash write operation. As a lock region
is composed of several pages, the programmer writes to the first pages of the lock region using
Flash write commands and writes to the last page of the lock region using a Flash write and lock
command.
The Flash command Erase Page and Write (EWP) is equivalent to the Flash Write Command.
However, before programming the load buffer, the page is erased.
The Flash command Erase Page and Write the Lock (EWPL) combines EWP and WPL
commands.
21.2.5.3
Flash Full Erase Command
This command is used to erase the Flash memory planes.
All lock regions must be unlocked before the Full Erase command by using the CLB command.
Otherwise, the erase command is aborted and no page is erased.
Table 21-8.
152
Full Erase Command
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
EA
2
Write handshaking
DATA
0
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
21.2.5.4
Flash Lock Commands
Lock bits can be set using WPL or EWPL commands. They can also be set by using the Set
Lock command (SLB). With this command, several lock bits can be activated. A Bit Mask is provided as argument to the command. When bit 0 of the bit mask is set, then the first lock bit is
activated.
In the same way, the Clear Lock command (CLB) is used to clear lock bits. All the lock bits are
also cleared by the EA command.
Table 21-9.
Set and Clear Lock Bit Command
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
SLB or CLB
2
Write handshaking
DATA
Bit Mask
Lock bits can be read using Get Lock Bit command (GLB). The nth lock bit is active when the bit
n of the bit mask is set..
Table 21-10. Get Lock Bit Command
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
GLB
DATA
Lock Bit Mask Status
0 = Lock bit is cleared
1 = Lock bit is set
2
21.2.5.5
Read handshaking
Flash General-purpose NVM Commands
General-purpose NVM bits (GP NVM bits) can be set using the Set GPNVM command (SGPB).
This command also activates GP NVM bits. A bit mask is provided as argument to the command. When bit 0 of the bit mask is set, then the first GP NVM bit is activated.
In the same way, the Clear GPNVM command (CGPB) is used to clear general-purpose NVM
bits. All the general-purpose NVM bits are also cleared by the EA command. The general-purpose NVM bit is deactivated when the corresponding bit in the pattern value is set to 1.
Table 21-11. Set/Clear GP NVM Command
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
SGPB or CGPB
2
Write handshaking
DATA
GP NVM bit pattern value
General-purpose NVM bits can be read using the Get GPNVM Bit command (GGPB). The nth
GP NVM bit is active when bit n of the bit mask is set..
Table 21-12. Get GP NVM Bit Command
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
GGPB
2
Read handshaking
DATA
GP NVM Bit Mask Status
0 = GP NVM bit is cleared
1 = GP NVM bit is set
153
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
21.2.5.6
Flash Security Bit Command
A security bit can be set using the Set Security Bit command (SSE). Once the security bit is
active, the Fast Flash programming is disabled. No other command can be run. An event on the
Erase pin can erase the security bit once the contents of the Flash have been erased.
The AT91SAM7XC512 security bit is controlled by the EFC0. To use the Set Security Bit command, the EFC0 must be selected using the Select EFC command
Table 21-13. Set Security Bit Command
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
SSE
2
Write handshaking
DATA
0
Once the security bit is set, it is not possible to access FFPI. The only way to erase the security
bit is to erase the Flash.
In order to erase the Flash, the user must perform the following:
• Power-off the chip
• Power-on the chip with TST = 0
• Assert Erase during a period of more than 220 ms
• Power-of the chip
Then it i possible to return to FFPI mode and check that Flash is erased.
21.2.5.7
AT91SAM7XC512 Select EFC Command
The commands WPx, EA, xLB, xFB are executed using the current EFC controller. The default
EFC controller is EFC0. The Select EFC command (SEFC) allows selection of the current EFC
controller.
Table 21-14. Select EFC Command
21.2.5.8
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
SEFC
2
Write handshaking
DATA
0 = Select EFC0
1 = Select EFC1
Memory Write Command
This command is used to perform a write access to any memory location.
The Memory Write command (WRAM) is optimized for consecutive writes. Write handshaking
can be chained; an internal address buffer is automatically increased.
Table 21-15. Write Command
154
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
WRAM
2
Write handshaking
ADDR0
Memory Address LSB
3
Write handshaking
ADDR1
Memory Address
4
Write handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
5
Write handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 21-15. Write Command (Continued)
21.2.5.9
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
...
...
...
...
n
Write handshaking
ADDR0
Memory Address LSB
n+1
Write handshaking
ADDR1
Memory Address
n+2
Write handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
n+3
Write handshaking
DATA
*Memory Address++
...
...
...
...
Get Version Command
The Get Version (GVE) command retrieves the version of the FFPI interface.
Table 21-16. Get Version Command
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
GVE
2
Write handshaking
DATA
Version
155
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
21.3
Serial Fast Flash Programming
The Serial Fast Flash programming interface is based on IEEE Std. 1149.1 “Standard Test
Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture”. Refer to this standard for an explanation of terms
used in this chapter and for a description of the TAP controller states.
In this mode, data read/written from/to the embedded Flash of the device are transmitted
through the JTAG interface of the device.
21.3.1
Device Configuration
In Serial Fast Flash Programming Mode, the device is in a specific test mode.Only a certain set
of pins is significant, the rest of the PIOs are used as inputs with a pull-up. The crystal oscillator
is in bypass mode. Other pins must be left unconnected.
Figure 21-4. Serial Programing
VDDIO
VDDIO
VDDIO
TST
PGMEN0
PGMEN1
VDDCORE
VDDIO
TDI
TDO
VDDPLL
TMS
VDDFLASH
TCK
GND
0-50MHz
XIN
Table 21-17. Signal Description List
Signal Name
Function
Type
Active
Level
Comments
Power
VDDFLASH
Flash Power Supply
Power
VDDIO
I/O Lines Power Supply
Power
VDDCORE
Core Power Supply
Power
VDDPLL
PLL Power Supply
Power
GND
Ground
Ground
Clocks
XIN
156
Main Clock Input.
This input can be tied to GND. In this
case, the device is clocked by the internal
RC oscillator.
Input
32 kHz to 50 MHz
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 21-17. Signal Description List (Continued)
Signal Name
Function
Type
Active
Level
Comments
Test
TST
Test Mode Select
Input
High
Must be connected to VDDIO.
PGMEN0
Test Mode Select
Input
High
Must be connected to VDDIO
PGMEN1
Test Mode Select
Input
High
Must be connected to VDDIO
JTAG
TCK
JTAG TCK
Input
-
Pulled-up input at reset
TDI
JTAG Test Data In
Input
-
Pulled-up input at reset
TDO
JTAG Test Data Out
Output
-
TMS
JTAG Test Mode Select
Input
-
21.3.2
Pulled-up input at reset
Entering Serial Programming Mode
The following algorithm puts the device in Serial Programming Mode:
• Apply GND, VDDIO, VDDCORE, VDDFLASH and VDDPLL.
• Apply XIN clock within TPOR_RESET + 32(TSCLK) if an external clock is available.
• Wait for TPOR_RESET.
• Reset the TAP controller clocking 5 TCK pulses with TMS set.
• Shift 0x2 into the IR register (IR is 4 bits long, LSB first) without going through the Run-TestIdle state.
• Shift 0x2 into the DR register (DR is 4 bits long, LSB first) without going through the RunTest-Idle state.
• Shift 0xC into the IR register (IR is 4 bits long, LSB first) without going through the Run-TestIdle state.
Note:
After reset, the device is clocked by the internal RC oscillator. Before clearing RDY signal, if an
external clock ( > 32 kHz) is connected to XIN, then the device will switch on the external clock.
Else, XIN input is not considered. An higher frequency on XIN speeds up the programmer
handshake.
Table 21-18. Reset TAP Controller and Go to Select-DR-Scan
21.3.3
TDI
TMS
TAP Controller State
X
1
X
1
X
1
X
1
X
1
Test-Logic Reset
X
0
Run-Test/Idle
Xt
1
Select-DR-Scan
Read/Write Handshake
The read/write handshake is done by carrying out read/write operations on two registers of the
device that are accessible through the JTAG:
157
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• Debug Comms Control Register: DCCR
• Debug Comms Data Register: DCDR
Access to these registers is done through the TAP 38-bit DR register comprising a 32-bit data
field, a 5-bit address field and a read/write bit. The data to be written is scanned into the 32-bit
data field with the address of the register to the 5-bit address field and 1 to the read/write bit. A
register is read by scanning its address into the address field and 0 into the read/write bit, going
through the UPDATE-DR TAP state, then scanning out the data.
Refer to the ARM7TDMI reference manuel for more information on Comm channel operations.
Figure 21-5. TAP 8-bit DR Register
TDI
r/w
4
Address
0
31
Data
5
Address
Decoder
0
TDO
32
Debug Comms Control Register
Debug Comms Data Register
A read or write takes place when the TAP controller enters UPDATE-DR state. Refer to the IEEE
1149.1 for more details on JTAG operations.
• The address of the Debug Comms Control Register is 0x04.
• The address of the Debug Comms Data Register is 0x05.
The Debug Comms Control Register is read-only and allows synchronized handshaking
between the processor and the debugger.
– Bit 1 (W): Denotes whether the programmer can read a data through the Debug
Comms Data Register. If the device is busy W = 0, then the programmer must poll
until W = 1.
– Bit 0 (R): Denotes whether the programmer can send data from the Debug Comms
Data Register. If R = 1, data previously placed there through the scan chain has not
been collected by the device and so the programmer must wait.
The write handshake is done by polling the Debug Comms Control Register until the R bit is
cleared. Once cleared, data can be written to the Debug Comms Data Register.
The read handshake is done by polling the Debug Comms Control Register until the W bit is set.
Once set, data can be read in the Debug Comms Data Register.
21.3.4
21.3.4.1
158
Device Operations
Several commands on the Flash memory are available. These commands are summarized in
Table 21-3 on page 149. Commands are run by the programmer through the serial interface that
is reading and writing the Debug Comms Registers.
Flash Read Command
This command is used to read the Flash contents. The memory map is accessible through this
command. Memory is seen as an array of words (32-bit wide). The read command can start at
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
any valid address in the memory plane. This address must be word-aligned. The address is
automatically incremented.
Table 21-19. Read Command
21.3.4.2
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
(Number of Words to Read) << 16 | READ
Write
Address
Read
Memory [address]
Read
Memory [address+4]
...
...
Read
Memory [address+(Number of Words to Read - 1)* 4]
Flash Write Command
This command is used to write the Flash contents. The address transmitted must be a valid
Flash address in the memory plane.
The Flash memory plane is organized into several pages. Data to be written is stored in a load
buffer that corresponds to a Flash memory page. The load buffer is automatically flushed to the
Flash:
• before access to any page than the current one
• at the end of the number of words transmitted
The Write Page command (WP) is optimized for consecutive writes. Write handshaking can be
chained; an internal address buffer is automatically increased.
Table 21-20. Write Command
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
(Number of Words to Write) << 16 | (WP or WPL or EWP or EWPL)
Write
Address
Write
Memory [address]
Write
Memory [address+4]
Write
Memory [address+8]
Write
Memory [address+(Number of Words to Write - 1)* 4]
Flash Write Page and Lock command (WPL) is equivalent to the Flash Write Command. However, the lock bit is automatically set at the end of the Flash write operation. As a lock region is
composed of several pages, the programmer writes to the first pages of the lock region using
Flash write commands and writes to the last page of the lock region using a Flash write and lock
command.
Flash Erase Page and Write command (EWP) is equivalent to the Flash Write Command. However, before programming the load buffer, the page is erased.
Flash Erase Page and Write the Lock command (EWPL) combines EWP and WPL
commands.
21.3.4.3
Flash Full Erase Command
This command is used to erase the Flash memory planes.
159
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
All lock bits must be deactivated before using the Full Erase command. This can be done by
using the CLB command.
Table 21-21. Full Erase Command
21.3.4.4
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
EA
Flash Lock Commands
Lock bits can be set using WPL or EWPL commands. They can also be set by using the Set
Lock command (SLB). With this command, several lock bits can be activated at the same time.
Bit 0 of Bit Mask corresponds to the first lock bit and so on.
In the same way, the Clear Lock command (CLB) is used to clear lock bits. All the lock bits can
also be cleared by the EA command.
Table 21-22. Set and Clear Lock Bit Command
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
SLB or CLB
Write
Bit Mask
Lock bits can be read using Get Lock Bit command (GLB). When a bit set in the Bit Mask is
returned, then the corresponding lock bit is active.
Table 21-23. Get Lock Bit Command
21.3.4.5
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
GLB
Read
Bit Mask
Flash General-purpose NVM Commands
General-purpose NVM bits (GP NVM) can be set with the Set GPNVM command (SGPB). Using
this command, several GP NVM bits can be activated at the same time. Bit 0 of Bit Mask corresponds to the first GPNVM bit and so on.
In the same way, the Clear GPNVM command (CGPB) is used to clear GP NVM bits. All the
general-purpose NVM bits are also cleared by the EA command.
Table 21-24. Set and Clear General-purpose NVM Bit Command
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
SGPB or CGPB
Write
Bit Mask
GP NVM bits can be read using Get GPNVM Bit command (GGPB). When a bit set in the Bit
Mask is returned, then the corresponding GPNVM bit is set.
Table 21-25. Get General-purpose NVM Bit Command
160
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
GGPB
Read
Bit Mask
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
21.3.4.6
Flash Security Bit Command
Security bits can be set using Set Security Bit command (SSE). Once the security bit is active,
the Fast Flash programming is disabled. No other command can be run. Only an event on the
Erase pin can erase the security bit once the contents of the Flash have been erased.
The AT91SAM7XC512 security bit is controlled by the EFC0. To use the Set Security Bit command, the EFC0 must be selected using the Select EFC command.
Table 21-26. Set Security Bit Command
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
SSE
Once the security bit is set, it is not possible to access FFPI. The only way to erase the security
bit is to erase the Flash.
In order to erase the Flash, the user must perform the following:
• Power-off the chip
• Power-on the chip with TST = 0
• Assert Erase during a period of more than 220 ms
• Power-off the chip
Then it is possible to return to FFPI mode and check that Flash is erased.
21.3.4.7
AT91SAM7XC512 Select EFC Command
The commands WPx, EA, xLB, xFB are executed using the current EFC controller. The default
EFC controller is EFC0. The Select EFC command (SEFC) allows selection of the current EFC
controller.
Table 21-27. Select EFC Command
21.3.4.8
Step
Handshake Sequence
MODE[3:0]
DATA[15:0]
1
Write handshaking
CMDE
SEFC
2
Write handshaking
DATA
0 = Select EFC0
1 = Select EFC1
Memory Write Command
This command is used to perform a write access to any memory location.
The Memory Write command (WRAM) is optimized for consecutive writes. An internal address
buffer is automatically increased.
Table 21-28. Write Command
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
(Number of Words to Write) << 16 | (WRAM)
Write
Address
Write
Memory [address]
Write
Memory [address+4]
Write
Memory [address+8]
Write
Memory [address+(Number of Words to Write - 1)* 4]
161
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
21.3.4.9
Get Version Command
The Get Version (GVE) command retrieves the version of the FFPI interface.
Table 21-29. Get Version Command
162
Read/Write
DR Data
Write
GVE
Read
Version
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
22. AT91SAM Boot Program
22.1
Overview
The Boot Program integrates different programs permitting download and/or upload into the different memories of the product.
First, it initializes the Debug Unit serial port (DBGU) and the USB Device Port.
SAM-BA® Boot is then executed. It waits for transactions either on the USB device, or on the
DBGU serial port.
22.2
Flow Diagram
The Boot Program implements the algorithm in Figure 22-1.
Figure 22-1. Boot Program Algorithm Flow Diagram
No
Device
Setup
USB Enumeration
Successful ?
No
AutoBaudrate
Sequence Successful ?
Yes
Run SAM-BA Boot
22.3
Yes
Run SAM-BA Boot
Device Initialization
Initialization follows the steps described below:
1. FIQ initialization
1. Stack setup for ARM supervisor mode
2. Setup the Embedded Flash Controller
3. External Clock detection
4. Main oscillator frequency detection if no external clock detected
5. Switch Master Clock on Main Oscillator
6. Copy code into SRAM
7. C variable initialization
8. PLL setup: PLL is initialized to generate a 48 MHz clock necessary to use the USB
Device
9. Disable of the Watchdog and enable of the user reset
10. Initialization of the USB Device Port
11. Jump to SAM-BA Boot sequence (see “SAM-BA Boot” on page 164)
163
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
22.4
SAM-BA Boot
The SAM-BA boot principle is to:
– Check if USB Device enumeration has occurred
– Check if the AutoBaudrate sequence has succeeded (see Figure 22-2)
Figure 22-2. AutoBaudrate Flow Diagram
Device
Setup
Character '0x80'
received ?
No
1st measurement
Yes
Character '0x80'
received ?
No
2nd measurement
No
Test Communication
Yes
Character '#'
received ?
Yes
Send Character '>'
UART operational
Run SAM-BA Boot
– Once the communication interface is identified, the application runs in an infinite
loop waiting for different commands as in Table 22-1.
164
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 22-1.
Commands Available through the SAM-BA Boot
Command
Action
Argument(s)
Example
O
write a byte
Address, Value#
O200001,CA#
o
read a byte
Address,#
o200001,#
H
write a half word
Address, Value#
H200002,CAFE#
h
read a half word
Address,#
h200002,#
W
write a word
Address, Value#
W200000,CAFEDECA#
w
read a word
Address,#
w200000,#
S
send a file
Address,#
S200000,#
R
receive a file
Address, NbOfBytes#
R200000,1234#
G
go
Address#
G200200#
V
display version
No argument
V#
• Write commands: Write a byte (O), a halfword (H) or a word (W) to the target.
– Address: Address in hexadecimal.
– Value: Byte, halfword or word to write in hexadecimal.
– Output: ‘>’.
• Read commands: Read a byte (o), a halfword (h) or a word (w) from the target.
– Address: Address in hexadecimal
– Output: The byte, halfword or word read in hexadecimal following by ‘>’
• Send a file (S): Send a file to a specified address
– Address: Address in hexadecimal
– Output: ‘>’.
Note:
There is a time-out on this command which is reached when the prompt ‘>’ appears before the
end of the command execution.
• Receive a file (R): Receive data into a file from a specified address
– Address: Address in hexadecimal
– NbOfBytes: Number of bytes in hexadecimal to receive
– Output: ‘>’
• Go (G): Jump to a specified address and execute the code
– Address: Address to jump in hexadecimal
– Output: ‘>’
• Get Version (V): Return the SAM-BA boot version
– Output: ‘>’
22.4.1
DBGU Serial Port
Communication is performed through the DBGU serial port initialized to 115200 Baud, 8, n, 1.
The Send and Receive File commands use the Xmodem protocol to communicate. Any terminal
performing this protocol can be used to send the application file to the target. The size of the
binary file to send depends on the SRAM size embedded in the product. In all cases, the size of
165
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
the binary file must be lower than the SRAM size because the Xmodem protocol requires some
SRAM memory to work.
22.4.2
Xmodem Protocol
The Xmodem protocol supported is the 128-byte length block. This protocol uses a two-character CRC-16 to guarantee detection of a maximum bit error.
Xmodem protocol with CRC is accurate provided both sender and receiver report successful
transmission. Each block of the transfer looks like:
<SOH><blk #><255-blk #><--128 data bytes--><checksum> in which:
– <SOH> = 01 hex
– <blk #> = binary number, starts at 01, increments by 1, and wraps 0FFH to 00H (not
to 01)
– <255-blk #> = 1’s complement of the blk#.
– <checksum> = 2 bytes CRC16
Figure 22-3 shows a transmission using this protocol.
Figure 22-3. Xmodem Transfer Example
Host
Device
C
SOH 01 FE Data[128] CRC CRC
ACK
SOH 02 FD Data[128] CRC CRC
ACK
SOH 03 FC Data[100] CRC CRC
ACK
EOT
ACK
22.4.3
USB Device Port
A 48 MHz USB clock is necessary to use the USB Device port. It has been programmed earlier
in the device initialization procedure with PLLB configuration.
The device uses the USB communication device class (CDC) drivers to take advantage of the
installed PC RS-232 software to talk over the USB. The CDC class is implemented in all
releases of Windows®, from Windows 98SE to Windows XP. The CDC document, available at
www.usb.org, describes a way to implement devices such as ISDN modems and virtual COM
ports.
The Vendor ID is Atmel’s vendor ID 0x03EB. The product ID is 0x6124. These references are
used by the host operating system to mount the correct driver. On Windows systems, the INF
files contain the correspondence between vendor ID and product ID.
166
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Atmel provides an INF example to see the device as a new serial port and also provides another
custom driver used by the SAM-BA application: atm6124.sys. Refer to the document “USB Basic
Application”, literature number 6123, for more details.
22.4.3.1
Enumeration Process
The USB protocol is a master/slave protocol. This is the host that starts the enumeration sending requests to the device through the control endpoint. The device handles standard requests
as defined in the USB Specification.
Table 22-2.
Handled Standard Requests
Request
Definition
GET_DESCRIPTOR
Returns the current device configuration value.
SET_ADDRESS
Sets the device address for all future device access.
SET_CONFIGURATION
Sets the device configuration.
GET_CONFIGURATION
Returns the current device configuration value.
GET_STATUS
Returns status for the specified recipient.
SET_FEATURE
Used to set or enable a specific feature.
CLEAR_FEATURE
Used to clear or disable a specific feature.
The device also handles some class requests defined in the CDC class.
Table 22-3.
Handled Class Requests
Request
Definition
SET_LINE_CODING
Configures DTE rate, stop bits, parity and number of
character bits.
GET_LINE_CODING
Requests current DTE rate, stop bits, parity and number of
character bits.
SET_CONTROL_LINE_STATE
RS-232 signal used to tell the DCE device the DTE device
is now present.
Unhandled requests are STALLed.
22.4.3.2
Communication Endpoints
There are two communication endpoints and endpoint 0 is used for the enumeration process.
Endpoint 1 is a 64-byte Bulk OUT endpoint and endpoint 2 is a 64-byte Bulk IN endpoint. SAMBA Boot commands are sent by the host through the endpoint 1. If required, the message is split
by the host into several data payloads by the host driver.
If the command requires a response, the host can send IN transactions to pick up the response.
167
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
22.5
Hardware and Software Constraints
• SAM-BA boot copies itself in the SRAM and uses a block of internal SRAM for variables and
stacks. The remaining available size for the user code is 122880 bytes for AT91SAM7XC512,
57344 bytes for AT91SAM7XC256 and 24576 bytes for AT91SAM7XC128.
• USB requirements:
– pull-up on DDP
– 18.432 MHz Quartz
Table 22-4.
Device
Start Address
End Address
Size (bytes)
AT91SAM7XC512
0x202000
0x220000
122880
AT91SAM7XC256
0x202000
0x210000
57344
AT91SAM7XC128
0x202000
0x208000
24576
Table 22-5.
168
User Area Addresses
Pins Driven during Boot Program Execution
Peripheral
Pin
PIO Line
DBGU
DRXD
PA27
DBGU
DTXD
PA28
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
23. Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC)
23.1
Overview
The Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) transfers data between on-chip serial peripherals such as
the UART, USART, SSC, SPI, MCI and the on- and off-chip memories. Using the Peripheral
DMA Controller avoids processor intervention and removes the processor interrupt-handling
overhead. This significantly reduces the number of clock cycles required for a data transfer and,
as a result, improves the performance of the microcontroller and makes it more power efficient.
The PDC channels are implemented in pairs, each pair being dedicated to a particular peripheral. One channel in the pair is dedicated to the receiving channel and one to the transmitting
channel of each UART, USART, SSC and SPI.
The user interface of a PDC channel is integrated in the memory space of each peripheral. It
contains:
• A 32-bit memory pointer register
• A 16-bit transfer count register
• A 32-bit register for next memory pointer
• A 16-bit register for next transfer count
The peripheral triggers PDC transfers using transmit and receive signals. When the programmed data is transferred, an end of transfer interrupt is generated by the corresponding
peripheral.
23.2
Block Diagram
Figure 23-1. Block Diagram
Peripheral
Peripheral DMA Controller
THR
PDC Channel 0
RHR
PDC Channel 1
Control
Control
Memory
Controller
Status & Control
169
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
23.3
23.3.1
Functional Description
Configuration
The PDC channels user interface enables the user to configure and control the data transfers for
each channel. The user interface of a PDC channel is integrated into the user interface of the
peripheral (offset 0x100), which it is related to.
Per peripheral, it contains four 32-bit Pointer Registers (RPR, RNPR, TPR, and TNPR) and four
16-bit Counter Registers (RCR, RNCR, TCR, and TNCR).
The size of the buffer (number of transfers) is configured in an internal 16-bit transfer counter
register, and it is possible, at any moment, to read the number of transfers left for each channel.
The memory base address is configured in a 32-bit memory pointer by defining the location of
the first address to access in the memory. It is possible, at any moment, to read the location in
memory of the next transfer and the number of remaining transfers. The PDC has dedicated status registers which indicate if the transfer is enabled or disabled for each channel. The status for
each channel is located in the peripheral status register. Transfers can be enabled and/or disabled by setting TXTEN/TXTDIS and RXTEN/RXTDIS in PDC Transfer Control Register. These
control bits enable reading the pointer and counter registers safely without any risk of their
changing between both reads.
The PDC sends status flags to the peripheral visible in its status-register (ENDRX, ENDTX,
RXBUFF, and TXBUFE).
ENDRX flag is set when the PERIPH_RCR register reaches zero.
RXBUFF flag is set when both PERIPH_RCR and PERIPH_RNCR reach zero.
ENDTX flag is set when the PERIPH_TCR register reaches zero.
TXBUFE flag is set when both PERIPH_TCR and PERIPH_TNCR reach zero.
These status flags are described in the peripheral status register.
23.3.2
Memory Pointers
Each peripheral is connected to the PDC by a receiver data channel and a transmitter data
channel. Each channel has an internal 32-bit memory pointer. Each memory pointer points to a
location anywhere in the memory space (on-chip memory or external bus interface memory).
Depending on the type of transfer (byte, half-word or word), the memory pointer is incremented
by 1, 2 or 4, respectively for peripheral transfers.
If a memory pointer is reprogrammed while the PDC is in operation, the transfer address is
changed, and the PDC performs transfers using the new address.
23.3.3
Transfer Counters
There is one internal 16-bit transfer counter for each channel used to count the size of the block
already transferred by its associated channel. These counters are decremented after each data
transfer. When the counter reaches zero, the transfer is complete and the PDC stops transferring data.
If the Next Counter Register is equal to zero, the PDC disables the trigger while activating the
related peripheral end flag.
If the counter is reprogrammed while the PDC is operating, the number of transfers is updated
and the PDC counts transfers from the new value.
170
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Programming the Next Counter/Pointer registers chains the buffers. The counters are decremented after each data transfer as stated above, but when the transfer counter reaches zero,
the values of the Next Counter/Pointer are loaded into the Counter/Pointer registers in order to
re-enable the triggers.
For each channel, two status bits indicate the end of the current buffer (ENDRX, ENTX) and the
end of both current and next buffer (RXBUFF, TXBUFE). These bits are directly mapped to the
peripheral status register and can trigger an interrupt request to the AIC.
The peripheral end flag is automatically cleared when one of the counter-registers (Counter or
Next Counter Register) is written.
Note: When the Next Counter Register is loaded into the Counter Register, it is set to zero.
23.3.4
Data Transfers
The peripheral triggers PDC transfers using transmit (TXRDY) and receive (RXRDY) signals.
When the peripheral receives an external character, it sends a Receive Ready signal to the PDC
which then requests access to the system bus. When access is granted, the PDC starts a read
of the peripheral Receive Holding Register (RHR) and then triggers a write in the memory.
After each transfer, the relevant PDC memory pointer is incremented and the number of transfers left is decremented. When the memory block size is reached, a signal is sent to the
peripheral and the transfer stops.
The same procedure is followed, in reverse, for transmit transfers.
23.3.5
Priority of PDC Transfer Requests
The Peripheral DMA Controller handles transfer requests from the channel according to priorities fixed for each product.These priorities are defined in the product datasheet.
If simultaneous requests of the same type (receiver or transmitter) occur on identical peripherals, the priority is determined by the numbering of the peripherals.
If transfer requests are not simultaneous, they are treated in the order they occurred. Requests
from the receivers are handled first and then followed by transmitter requests.
171
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
23.4
Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) User Interface
Table 23-1.
Offset
Register Mapping
Register
Name
(1)
Access
Reset
0x100
Receive Pointer Register
PERIPH _RPR
Read-write
0x0
0x104
Receive Counter Register
PERIPH_RCR
Read-write
0x0
0x108
Transmit Pointer Register
PERIPH_TPR
Read-write
0x0
0x10C
Transmit Counter Register
PERIPH_TCR
Read-write
0x0
0x110
Receive Next Pointer Register
PERIPH_RNPR
Read-write
0x0
0x114
Receive Next Counter Register
PERIPH_RNCR
Read-write
0x0
0x118
Transmit Next Pointer Register
PERIPH_TNPR
Read-write
0x0
0x11C
Transmit Next Counter Register
PERIPH_TNCR
Read-write
0x0
0x120
PDC Transfer Control Register
PERIPH_PTCR
Write-only
-
0x124
PDC Transfer Status Register
PERIPH_PTSR
Read-only
0x0
Note:
172
1. PERIPH: Ten registers are mapped in the peripheral memory space at the same offset. These can be defined by the user
according to the function and the peripheral desired (DBGU, USART, SSC, SPI, MCI, etc.).
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
23.4.1
PDC Receive Pointer Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_RPR
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RXPTR
23
22
21
20
RXPTR
15
14
13
12
RXPTR
7
6
5
4
RXPTR
• RXPTR: Receive Pointer Address
Address of the next receive transfer.
23.4.2
PDC Receive Counter Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_RCR
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
-23
22
21
20
-15
14
13
12
RXCTR
7
6
5
4
RXCTR
• RXCTR: Receive Counter Value
Number of receive transfers to be performed.
173
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
23.4.3
PDC Transmit Pointer Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_TPR
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
TXPTR
23
22
21
20
TXPTR
15
14
13
12
TXPTR
7
6
5
4
TXPTR
• TXPTR: Transmit Pointer Address
Address of the transmit buffer.
23.4.4
PDC Transmit Counter Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_TCR
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
-23
22
21
20
-15
14
13
12
TXCTR
7
6
5
4
TXCTR
• TXCTR: Transmit Counter Value
TXCTR is the size of the transmit transfer to be performed. At zero, the peripheral DMA transfer is stopped.
174
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
23.4.5
PDC Receive Next Pointer Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_RNPR
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RXNPTR
23
22
21
20
RXNPTR
15
14
13
12
RXNPTR
7
6
5
4
RXNPTR
• RXNPTR: Receive Next Pointer Address
RXNPTR is the address of the next buffer to fill with received data when the current buffer is full.
23.4.6
PDC Receive Next Counter Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_RNCR
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
-23
22
21
20
-15
14
13
12
RXNCR
7
6
5
4
RXNCR
• RXNCR: Receive Next Counter Value
RXNCR is the size of the next buffer to receive.
175
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
23.4.7
PDC Transmit Next Pointer Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_TNPR
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
TXNPTR
23
22
21
20
TXNPTR
15
14
13
12
TXNPTR
7
6
5
4
TXNPTR
• TXNPTR: Transmit Next Pointer Address
TXNPTR is the address of the next buffer to transmit when the current buffer is empty.
23.4.8
PDC Transmit Next Counter Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_TNCR
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
-23
22
21
20
-15
14
13
12
TXNCR
7
6
5
4
TXNCR
• TXNCR: Transmit Next Counter Value
TXNCR is the size of the next buffer to transmit.
176
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
23.4.9
PDC Transfer Control Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_PTCR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
TXTDIS
TXTEN
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
RXTDIS
RXTEN
• RXTEN: Receiver Transfer Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the receiver PDC transfer requests if RXTDIS is not set.
• RXTDIS: Receiver Transfer Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the receiver PDC transfer requests.
• TXTEN: Transmitter Transfer Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the transmitter PDC transfer requests.
• TXTDIS: Transmitter Transfer Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the transmitter PDC transfer requests
177
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
23.4.10 PDC Transfer Status Register
Register Name:
PERIPH_PTSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
TXTEN
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
RXTEN
• RXTEN: Receiver Transfer Enable
0 = Receiver PDC transfer requests are disabled.
1 = Receiver PDC transfer requests are enabled.
• TXTEN: Transmitter Transfer Enable
0 = Transmitter PDC transfer requests are disabled.
1 = Transmitter PDC transfer requests are enabled.
178
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24. Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC)
24.1
Overview
The Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) is an 8-level priority, individually maskable, vectored
interrupt controller, providing handling of up to thirty-two interrupt sources. It is designed to substantially reduce the software and real-time overhead in handling internal and external
interrupts.
The AIC drives the nFIQ (fast interrupt request) and the nIRQ (standard interrupt request) inputs
of an ARM processor. Inputs of the AIC are either internal peripheral interrupts or external interrupts coming from the product's pins.
The 8-level Priority Controller allows the user to define the priority for each interrupt source, thus
permitting higher priority interrupts to be serviced even if a lower priority interrupt is being
treated.
Internal interrupt sources can be programmed to be level sensitive or edge triggered. External
interrupt sources can be programmed to be positive-edge or negative-edge triggered or highlevel or low-level sensitive.
The fast forcing feature redirects any internal or external interrupt source to provide a fast interrupt rather than a normal interrupt.
24.2
Block Diagram
Figure 24-1. Block Diagram
FIQ
IRQ0-IRQn
Embedded
PeripheralEE
Embedded
AIC
ARM
Processor
Up to
Thirty-two
Sources
nFIQ
nIRQ
Peripheral
Embedded
Peripheral
APB
179
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.3
Application Block Diagram
Figure 24-2. Description of the Application Block
OS-based Applications
Standalone
Applications
OS Drivers
RTOS Drivers
Hard Real Time Tasks
General OS Interrupt Handler
Advanced Interrupt Controller
External Peripherals
(External Interrupts)
Embedded Peripherals
24.4
AIC Detailed Block Diagram
Figure 24-3. AIC Detailed Block Diagram
Advanced Interrupt Controller
FIQ
PIO
Controller
Fast
Interrupt
Controller
External
Source
Input
Stage
ARM
Processor
nFIQ
nIRQ
IRQ0-IRQn
Embedded
Peripherals
Interrupt
Priority
Controller
Fast
Forcing
PIOIRQ
Internal
Source
Input
Stage
Processor
Clock
Power
Management
Controller
User Interface
Wake Up
APB
24.5
I/O Line Description
Table 24-1.
I/O Line Description
Pin Name
Pin Description
Type
FIQ
Fast Interrupt
Input
IRQ0 - IRQn
Interrupt 0 - Interrupt n
Input
180
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24.6
24.6.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines
The interrupt signals FIQ and IRQ0 to IRQn are normally multiplexed through the PIO controllers. Depending on the features of the PIO controller used in the product, the pins must be
programmed in accordance with their assigned interrupt function. This is not applicable when
the PIO controller used in the product is transparent on the input path.
24.6.2
Power Management
The Advanced Interrupt Controller is continuously clocked. The Power Management Controller
has no effect on the Advanced Interrupt Controller behavior.
The assertion of the Advanced Interrupt Controller outputs, either nIRQ or nFIQ, wakes up the
ARM processor while it is in Idle Mode. The General Interrupt Mask feature enables the AIC to
wake up the processor without asserting the interrupt line of the processor, thus providing synchronization of the processor on an event.
24.6.3
Interrupt Sources
The Interrupt Source 0 is always located at FIQ. If the product does not feature an FIQ pin, the
Interrupt Source 0 cannot be used.
The Interrupt Source 1 is always located at System Interrupt. This is the result of the OR-wiring
of the system peripheral interrupt lines, such as the System Timer, the Real Time Clock, the
Power Management Controller and the Memory Controller. When a system interrupt occurs, the
service routine must first distinguish the cause of the interrupt. This is performed by reading successively the status registers of the above mentioned system peripherals.
The interrupt sources 2 to 31 can either be connected to the interrupt outputs of an embedded
user peripheral or to external interrupt lines. The external interrupt lines can be connected
directly, or through the PIO Controller.
The PIO Controllers are considered as user peripherals in the scope of interrupt handling.
Accordingly, the PIO Controller interrupt lines are connected to the Interrupt Sources 2 to 31.
The peripheral identification defined at the product level corresponds to the interrupt source
number (as well as the bit number controlling the clock of the peripheral). Consequently, to simplify the description of the functional operations and the user interface, the interrupt sources are
named FIQ, SYS, and PID2 to PID31.
181
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.7
Functional Description
24.7.1
24.7.1.1
Interrupt Source Control
Interrupt Source Mode
The Advanced Interrupt Controller independently programs each interrupt source. The SRCTYPE field of the corresponding AIC_SMR (Source Mode Register) selects the interrupt
condition of each source.
The internal interrupt sources wired on the interrupt outputs of the embedded peripherals can be
programmed either in level-sensitive mode or in edge-triggered mode. The active level of the
internal interrupts is not important for the user.
The external interrupt sources can be programmed either in high level-sensitive or low level-sensitive modes, or in positive edge-triggered or negative edge-triggered modes.
24.7.1.2
Interrupt Source Enabling
Each interrupt source, including the FIQ in source 0, can be enabled or disabled by using the
command registers; AIC_IECR (Interrupt Enable Command Register) and AIC_IDCR (Interrupt
Disable Command Register). This set of registers conducts enabling or disabling in one instruction. The interrupt mask can be read in the AIC_IMR register. A disabled interrupt does not affect
servicing of other interrupts.
24.7.1.3
Interrupt Clearing and Setting
All interrupt sources programmed to be edge-triggered (including the FIQ in source 0) can be
individually set or cleared by writing respectively the AIC_ISCR and AIC_ICCR registers. Clearing or setting interrupt sources programmed in level-sensitive mode has no effect.
The clear operation is perfunctory, as the software must perform an action to reinitialize the
“memorization” circuitry activated when the source is programmed in edge-triggered mode.
However, the set operation is available for auto-test or software debug purposes. It can also be
used to execute an AIC-implementation of a software interrupt.
The AIC features an automatic clear of the current interrupt when the AIC_IVR (Interrupt Vector
Register) is read. Only the interrupt source being detected by the AIC as the current interrupt is
affected by this operation. (See “Priority Controller” on page 186.) The automatic clear reduces
the operations required by the interrupt service routine entry code to reading the AIC_IVR. Note
that the automatic interrupt clear is disabled if the interrupt source has the Fast Forcing feature
enabled as it is considered uniquely as a FIQ source. (For further details, See “Fast Forcing” on
page 190.)
The automatic clear of the interrupt source 0 is performed when AIC_FVR is read.
24.7.1.4
Interrupt Status
For each interrupt, the AIC operation originates in AIC_IPR (Interrupt Pending Register) and its
mask in AIC_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register). AIC_IPR enables the actual activity of the sources,
whether masked or not.
The AIC_ISR register reads the number of the current interrupt (see “Priority Controller” on page
186) and the register AIC_CISR gives an image of the signals nIRQ and nFIQ driven on the
processor.
Each status referred to above can be used to optimize the interrupt handling of the systems.
182
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24.7.1.5
Internal Interrupt Source Input Stage
Figure 24-4.
Internal Interrupt Source Input Stage
AIC_SMRI
(SRCTYPE)
Level/
Edge
Source i
AIC_IPR
AIC_IMR
Fast Interrupt Controller
or
Priority Controller
Edge
AIC_IECR
Detector
Set Clear
FF
AIC_ISCR
AIC_ICCR
AIC_IDCR
24.7.1.6
External Interrupt Source Input Stage
Figure 24-5. External Interrupt Source Input Stage
High/Low
AIC_SMRi
SRCTYPE
Level/
Edge
AIC_IPR
AIC_IMR
Source i
Fast Interrupt Controller
or
Priority Controller
AIC_IECR
Pos./Neg.
Edge
Detector
Set
AIC_ISCR
FF
Clear
AIC_IDCR
AIC_ICCR
183
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.7.2
Interrupt Latencies
Global interrupt latencies depend on several parameters, including:
• The time the software masks the interrupts.
• Occurrence, either at the processor level or at the AIC level.
• The execution time of the instruction in progress when the interrupt occurs.
• The treatment of higher priority interrupts and the resynchronization of the hardware signals.
This section addresses only the hardware resynchronizations. It gives details of the latency
times between the event on an external interrupt leading in a valid interrupt (edge or level) or the
assertion of an internal interrupt source and the assertion of the nIRQ or nFIQ line on the processor. The resynchronization time depends on the programming of the interrupt source and on
its type (internal or external). For the standard interrupt, resynchronization times are given
assuming there is no higher priority in progress.
The PIO Controller multiplexing has no effect on the interrupt latencies of the external interrupt
sources.
24.7.2.1
External Interrupt Edge Triggered Source
Figure 24-6.
External Interrupt Edge Triggered Source
MCK
IRQ or FIQ
(Positive Edge)
IRQ or FIQ
(Negative Edge)
nIRQ
Maximum IRQ Latency = 4 Cycles
nFIQ
Maximum FIQ Latency = 4 Cycles
184
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24.7.2.2
External Interrupt Level Sensitive Source
Figure 24-7.
External Interrupt Level Sensitive Source
MCK
IRQ or FIQ
(High Level)
IRQ or FIQ
(Low Level)
nIRQ
Maximum IRQ
Latency = 3 Cycles
nFIQ
Maximum FIQ
Latency = 3 cycles
24.7.2.3
Internal Interrupt Edge Triggered Source
Figure 24-8.
Internal Interrupt Edge Triggered Source
MCK
nIRQ
Maximum IRQ Latency = 4.5 Cycles
Peripheral Interrupt
Becomes Active
24.7.2.4
Internal Interrupt Level Sensitive Source
Figure 24-9.
Internal Interrupt Level Sensitive Source
MCK
nIRQ
Maximum IRQ Latency = 3.5 Cycles
Peripheral Interrupt
Becomes Active
185
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.7.3
24.7.3.1
Normal Interrupt
Priority Controller
An 8-level priority controller drives the nIRQ line of the processor, depending on the interrupt
conditions occurring on the interrupt sources 1 to 31 (except for those programmed in Fast
Forcing).
Each interrupt source has a programmable priority level of 7 to 0, which is user-definable by writing the PRIOR field of the corresponding AIC_SMR (Source Mode Register). Level 7 is the
highest priority and level 0 the lowest.
As soon as an interrupt condition occurs, as defined by the SRCTYPE field of the AIC_SMR
(Source Mode Register), the nIRQ line is asserted. As a new interrupt condition might have happened on other interrupt sources since the nIRQ has been asserted, the priority controller
determines the current interrupt at the time the AIC_IVR (Interrupt Vector Register) is read. The
read of AIC_IVR is the entry point of the interrupt handling which allows the AIC to consider
that the interrupt has been taken into account by the software.
The current priority level is defined as the priority level of the current interrupt.
If several interrupt sources of equal priority are pending and enabled when the AIC_IVR is read,
the interrupt with the lowest interrupt source number is serviced first.
The nIRQ line can be asserted only if an interrupt condition occurs on an interrupt source with a
higher priority. If an interrupt condition happens (or is pending) during the interrupt treatment in
progress, it is delayed until the software indicates to the AIC the end of the current service by
writing the AIC_EOICR (End of Interrupt Command Register). The write of AIC_EOICR is the
exit point of the interrupt handling.
24.7.3.2
Interrupt Nesting
The priority controller utilizes interrupt nesting in order for the high priority interrupt to be handled
during the service of lower priority interrupts. This requires the interrupt service routines of the
lower interrupts to re-enable the interrupt at the processor level.
When an interrupt of a higher priority happens during an already occurring interrupt service routine, the nIRQ line is re-asserted. If the interrupt is enabled at the core level, the current
execution is interrupted and the new interrupt service routine should read the AIC_IVR. At this
time, the current interrupt number and its priority level are pushed into an embedded hardware
stack, so that they are saved and restored when the higher priority interrupt servicing is finished
and the AIC_EOICR is written.
The AIC is equipped with an 8-level wide hardware stack in order to support up to eight interrupt
nestings pursuant to having eight priority levels.
24.7.3.3
Interrupt Vectoring
The interrupt handler addresses corresponding to each interrupt source can be stored in the registers AIC_SVR1 to AIC_SVR31 (Source Vector Register 1 to 31). When the processor reads
AIC_IVR (Interrupt Vector Register), the value written into AIC_SVR corresponding to the current interrupt is returned.
This feature offers a way to branch in one single instruction to the handler corresponding to the
current interrupt, as AIC_IVR is mapped at the absolute address 0xFFFF F100 and thus accessible from the ARM interrupt vector at address 0x0000 0018 through the following instruction:
LDR
186
PC,[PC,# -&F20]
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
When the processor executes this instruction, it loads the read value in AIC_IVR in its program
counter, thus branching the execution on the correct interrupt handler.
This feature is often not used when the application is based on an operating system (either real
time or not). Operating systems often have a single entry point for all the interrupts and the first
task performed is to discern the source of the interrupt.
However, it is strongly recommended to port the operating system on AT91 products by supporting the interrupt vectoring. This can be performed by defining all the AIC_SVR of the interrupt
source to be handled by the operating system at the address of its interrupt handler. When doing
so, the interrupt vectoring permits a critical interrupt to transfer the execution on a specific very
fast handler and not onto the operating system’s general interrupt handler. This facilitates the
support of hard real-time tasks (input/outputs of voice/audio buffers and software peripheral handling) to be handled efficiently and independently of the application running under an operating
system.
24.7.3.4
Interrupt Handlers
This section gives an overview of the fast interrupt handling sequence when using the AIC. It is
assumed that the programmer understands the architecture of the ARM processor, and especially the processor interrupt modes and the associated status bits.
It is assumed that:
1. The Advanced Interrupt Controller has been programmed, AIC_SVR registers are
loaded with corresponding interrupt service routine addresses and interrupts are
enabled.
2. The instruction at the ARM interrupt exception vector address is required to work with
the vectoring
LDR PC, [PC, # -&F20]
When nIRQ is asserted, if the bit “I” of CPSR is 0, the sequence is as follows:
1. The CPSR is stored in SPSR_irq, the current value of the Program Counter is loaded in
the Interrupt link register (R14_irq) and the Program Counter (R15) is loaded with 0x18.
In the following cycle during fetch at address 0x1C, the ARM core adjusts R14_irq, decrementing it by four.
2. The ARM core enters Interrupt mode, if it has not already done so.
3. When the instruction loaded at address 0x18 is executed, the program counter is
loaded with the value read in AIC_IVR. Reading the AIC_IVR has the following effects:
– Sets the current interrupt to be the pending and enabled interrupt with the highest
priority. The current level is the priority level of the current interrupt.
– De-asserts the nIRQ line on the processor. Even if vectoring is not used, AIC_IVR
must be read in order to de-assert nIRQ.
– Automatically clears the interrupt, if it has been programmed to be edge-triggered.
– Pushes the current level and the current interrupt number on to the stack.
– Returns the value written in the AIC_SVR corresponding to the current interrupt.
4. The previous step has the effect of branching to the corresponding interrupt service
routine. This should start by saving the link register (R14_irq) and SPSR_IRQ. The link
register must be decremented by four when it is saved if it is to be restored directly into
the program counter at the end of the interrupt. For example, the instruction SUB PC,
LR, #4 may be used.
187
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
5. Further interrupts can then be unmasked by clearing the “I” bit in CPSR, allowing reassertion of the nIRQ to be taken into account by the core. This can happen if an interrupt with a higher priority than the current interrupt occurs.
6. The interrupt handler can then proceed as required, saving the registers that will be
used and restoring them at the end. During this phase, an interrupt of higher priority
than the current level will restart the sequence from step 1.
Note:
If the interrupt is programmed to be level sensitive, the source of the interrupt must be cleared during this phase.
7. The “I” bit in CPSR must be set in order to mask interrupts before exiting to ensure that
the interrupt is completed in an orderly manner.
8. The End of Interrupt Command Register (AIC_EOICR) must be written in order to indicate to the AIC that the current interrupt is finished. This causes the current level to be
popped from the stack, restoring the previous current level if one exists on the stack. If
another interrupt is pending, with lower or equal priority than the old current level but
with higher priority than the new current level, the nIRQ line is re-asserted, but the interrupt sequence does not immediately start because the “I” bit is set in the core.
SPSR_irq is restored. Finally, the saved value of the link register is restored directly into
the PC. This has the effect of returning from the interrupt to whatever was being executed before, and of loading the CPSR with the stored SPSR, masking or unmasking
the interrupts depending on the state saved in SPSR_irq.
Note:
188
The “I” bit in SPSR is significant. If it is set, it indicates that the ARM core was on the verge of
masking an interrupt when the mask instruction was interrupted. Hence, when SPSR is restored,
the mask instruction is completed (interrupt is masked).
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24.7.4
Fast Interrupt
24.7.4.1
Fast Interrupt Source
The interrupt source 0 is the only source which can raise a fast interrupt request to the processor
except if fast forcing is used. The interrupt source 0 is generally connected to a FIQ pin of the
product, either directly or through a PIO Controller.
24.7.4.2
Fast Interrupt Control
The fast interrupt logic of the AIC has no priority controller. The mode of interrupt source 0 is
programmed with the AIC_SMR0 and the field PRIOR of this register is not used even if it reads
what has been written. The field SRCTYPE of AIC_SMR0 enables programming the fast interrupt source to be positive-edge triggered or negative-edge triggered or high-level sensitive or
low-level sensitive
Writing 0x1 in the AIC_IECR (Interrupt Enable Command Register) and AIC_IDCR (Interrupt
Disable Command Register) respectively enables and disables the fast interrupt. The bit 0 of
AIC_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register) indicates whether the fast interrupt is enabled or disabled.
24.7.4.3
Fast Interrupt Vectoring
The fast interrupt handler address can be stored in AIC_SVR0 (Source Vector Register 0). The
value written into this register is returned when the processor reads AIC_FVR (Fast Vector Register). This offers a way to branch in one single instruction to the interrupt handler, as AIC_FVR
is mapped at the absolute address 0xFFFF F104 and thus accessible from the ARM fast interrupt vector at address 0x0000 001C through the following instruction:
LDR
PC,[PC,# -&F20]
When the processor executes this instruction it loads the value read in AIC_FVR in its program
counter, thus branching the execution on the fast interrupt handler. It also automatically performs the clear of the fast interrupt source if it is programmed in edge-triggered mode.
24.7.4.4
Fast Interrupt Handlers
This section gives an overview of the fast interrupt handling sequence when using the AIC. It is
assumed that the programmer understands the architecture of the ARM processor, and especially the processor interrupt modes and associated status bits.
Assuming that:
1. The Advanced Interrupt Controller has been programmed, AIC_SVR0 is loaded with
the fast interrupt service routine address, and the interrupt source 0 is enabled.
2. The Instruction at address 0x1C (FIQ exception vector address) is required to vector
the fast interrupt:
LDR PC, [PC, # -&F20]
3. The user does not need nested fast interrupts.
When nFIQ is asserted, if the bit “F” of CPSR is 0, the sequence is:
1. The CPSR is stored in SPSR_fiq, the current value of the program counter is loaded in
the FIQ link register (R14_FIQ) and the program counter (R15) is loaded with 0x1C. In
the following cycle, during fetch at address 0x20, the ARM core adjusts R14_fiq, decrementing it by four.
2. The ARM core enters FIQ mode.
3. When the instruction loaded at address 0x1C is executed, the program counter is
loaded with the value read in AIC_FVR. Reading the AIC_FVR has effect of automati-
189
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
cally clearing the fast interrupt, if it has been programmed to be edge triggered. In this
case only, it de-asserts the nFIQ line on the processor.
4. The previous step enables branching to the corresponding interrupt service routine. It is
not necessary to save the link register R14_fiq and SPSR_fiq if nested fast interrupts
are not needed.
5. The Interrupt Handler can then proceed as required. It is not necessary to save registers R8 to R13 because FIQ mode has its own dedicated registers and the user R8 to
R13 are banked. The other registers, R0 to R7, must be saved before being used, and
restored at the end (before the next step). Note that if the fast interrupt is programmed
to be level sensitive, the source of the interrupt must be cleared during this phase in
order to de-assert the interrupt source 0.
6. Finally, the Link Register R14_fiq is restored into the PC after decrementing it by four
(with instruction SUB PC, LR, #4 for example). This has the effect of returning from
the interrupt to whatever was being executed before, loading the CPSR with the SPSR
and masking or unmasking the fast interrupt depending on the state saved in the
SPSR.
Note:
The “F” bit in SPSR is significant. If it is set, it indicates that the ARM core was just about to mask
FIQ interrupts when the mask instruction was interrupted. Hence when the SPSR is restored, the
interrupted instruction is completed (FIQ is masked).
Another way to handle the fast interrupt is to map the interrupt service routine at the address of
the ARM vector 0x1C. This method does not use the vectoring, so that reading AIC_FVR must
be performed at the very beginning of the handler operation. However, this method saves the
execution of a branch instruction.
24.7.4.5
Fast Forcing
The Fast Forcing feature of the advanced interrupt controller provides redirection of any normal
Interrupt source on the fast interrupt controller.
Fast Forcing is enabled or disabled by writing to the Fast Forcing Enable Register (AIC_FFER)
and the Fast Forcing Disable Register (AIC_FFDR). Writing to these registers results in an
update of the Fast Forcing Status Register (AIC_FFSR) that controls the feature for each internal or external interrupt source.
When Fast Forcing is disabled, the interrupt sources are handled as described in the previous
pages.
When Fast Forcing is enabled, the edge/level programming and, in certain cases, edge detection of the interrupt source is still active but the source cannot trigger a normal interrupt to the
processor and is not seen by the priority handler.
If the interrupt source is programmed in level-sensitive mode and an active level is sampled,
Fast Forcing results in the assertion of the nFIQ line to the core.
If the interrupt source is programmed in edge-triggered mode and an active edge is detected,
Fast Forcing results in the assertion of the nFIQ line to the core.
The Fast Forcing feature does not affect the Source 0 pending bit in the Interrupt Pending Register (AIC_IPR).
The FIQ Vector Register (AIC_FVR) reads the contents of the Source Vector Register 0
(AIC_SVR0), whatever the source of the fast interrupt may be. The read of the FVR does not
clear the Source 0 when the fast forcing feature is used and the interrupt source should be
cleared by writing to the Interrupt Clear Command Register (AIC_ICCR).
190
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
All enabled and pending interrupt sources that have the fast forcing feature enabled and that are
programmed in edge-triggered mode must be cleared by writing to the Interrupt Clear Command
Register. In doing so, they are cleared independently and thus lost interrupts are prevented.
The read of AIC_IVR does not clear the source that has the fast forcing feature enabled.
The source 0, reserved to the fast interrupt, continues operating normally and becomes one of
the Fast Interrupt sources.
Figure 24-10. Fast Forcing
Source 0 _ FIQ
AIC_IPR
Input Stage
Automatic Clear
AIC_IMR
nFIQ
Read FVR if Fast Forcing is
disabled on Sources 1 to 31.
AIC_FFSR
Source n
AIC_IPR
Input Stage
Priority
Manager
Automatic Clear
AIC_IMR
nIRQ
Read IVR if Source n is the current interrupt
and if Fast Forcing is disabled on Source n.
191
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.7.5
Protect Mode
The Protect Mode permits reading the Interrupt Vector Register without performing the associated automatic operations. This is necessary when working with a debug system. When a
debugger, working either with a Debug Monitor or the ARM processor's ICE, stops the applications and updates the opened windows, it might read the AIC User Interface and thus the IVR.
This has undesirable consequences:
• If an enabled interrupt with a higher priority than the current one is pending, it is stacked.
• If there is no enabled pending interrupt, the spurious vector is returned.
In either case, an End of Interrupt command is necessary to acknowledge and to restore the
context of the AIC. This operation is generally not performed by the debug system as the debug
system would become strongly intrusive and cause the application to enter an undesired state.
This is avoided by using the Protect Mode. Writing PROT in AIC_DCR (Debug Control Register)
at 0x1 enables the Protect Mode.
When the Protect Mode is enabled, the AIC performs interrupt stacking only when a write access
is performed on the AIC_IVR. Therefore, the Interrupt Service Routines must write (arbitrary
data) to the AIC_IVR just after reading it. The new context of the AIC, including the value of the
Interrupt Status Register (AIC_ISR), is updated with the current interrupt only when AIC_IVR is
written.
An AIC_IVR read on its own (e.g., by a debugger), modifies neither the AIC context nor the
AIC_ISR. Extra AIC_IVR reads perform the same operations. However, it is recommended to
not stop the processor between the read and the write of AIC_IVR of the interrupt service routine
to make sure the debugger does not modify the AIC context.
To summarize, in normal operating mode, the read of AIC_IVR performs the following operations within the AIC:
1. Calculates active interrupt (higher than current or spurious).
2. Determines and returns the vector of the active interrupt.
3. Memorizes the interrupt.
4. Pushes the current priority level onto the internal stack.
5. Acknowledges the interrupt.
However, while the Protect Mode is activated, only operations 1 to 3 are performed when
AIC_IVR is read. Operations 4 and 5 are only performed by the AIC when AIC_IVR is written.
Software that has been written and debugged using the Protect Mode runs correctly in Normal
Mode without modification. However, in Normal Mode the AIC_IVR write has no effect and can
be removed to optimize the code.
24.7.6
Spurious Interrupt
The Advanced Interrupt Controller features protection against spurious interrupts. A spurious
interrupt is defined as being the assertion of an interrupt source long enough for the AIC to
assert the nIRQ, but no longer present when AIC_IVR is read. This is most prone to occur when:
• An external interrupt source is programmed in level-sensitive mode and an active level occurs
for only a short time.
192
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• An internal interrupt source is programmed in level sensitive and the output signal of the
corresponding embedded peripheral is activated for a short time. (As in the case for the
Watchdog.)
• An interrupt occurs just a few cycles before the software begins to mask it, thus resulting in a
pulse on the interrupt source.
The AIC detects a spurious interrupt at the time the AIC_IVR is read while no enabled interrupt
source is pending. When this happens, the AIC returns the value stored by the programmer in
AIC_SPU (Spurious Vector Register). The programmer must store the address of a spurious
interrupt handler in AIC_SPU as part of the application, to enable an as fast as possible return to
the normal execution flow. This handler writes in AIC_EOICR and performs a return from
interrupt.
24.7.7
General Interrupt Mask
The AIC features a General Interrupt Mask bit to prevent interrupts from reaching the processor.
Both the nIRQ and the nFIQ lines are driven to their inactive state if the bit GMSK in AIC_DCR
(Debug Control Register) is set. However, this mask does not prevent waking up the processor if
it has entered Idle Mode. This function facilitates synchronizing the processor on a next event
and, as soon as the event occurs, performs subsequent operations without having to handle an
interrupt. It is strongly recommended to use this mask with caution.
193
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.8
Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) User Interface
24.8.1
Base Address
The AIC is mapped at the address 0xFFFF F000. It has a total 4-Kbyte addressing space. This
permits the vectoring feature, as the PC-relative load/store instructions of the ARM processor
support only an ± 4-Kbyte offset.
24.8.2
Register Mapping
Table 24-2.
Offset
Register Mapping
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0000
Source Mode Register 0
AIC_SMR0
Read-write
0x0
0x04
Source Mode Register 1
AIC_SMR1
Read-write
0x0
---
---
---
0x7C
---
--Source Mode Register 31
AIC_SMR31
Read-write
0x0
0x80
Source Vector Register 0
AIC_SVR0
Read-write
0x0
0x84
Source Vector Register 1
AIC_SVR1
Read-write
0x0
---
---
---
---
---
AIC_SVR31
Read-write
0x0
Interrupt Vector Register
AIC_IVR
Read-only
0x0
0x104
FIQ Interrupt Vector Register
AIC_FVR
Read-only
0x0
0xFC
Source Vector Register 31
0x100
0x108
Interrupt Status Register
AIC_ISR
Read-only
0x0
0x10C
Interrupt Pending Register(2)
AIC_IPR
Read-only
0x0(1)
0x110
Interrupt Mask Register(2)
AIC_IMR
Read-only
0x0
0x114
Core Interrupt Status Register
AIC_CISR
Read-only
0x0
0x118
Reserved
---
---
---
0x11C
Reserved
---
---
---
0x120
Interrupt Enable Command Register(2)
AIC_IECR
Write-only
---
0x124
Interrupt Disable Command Register
(2)
AIC_IDCR
Write-only
---
0x128
(2)
Interrupt Clear Command Register
AIC_ICCR
Write-only
---
0x12C
(2)
Interrupt Set Command Register
AIC_ISCR
Write-only
---
0x130
End of Interrupt Command Register
AIC_EOICR
Write-only
---
0x134
Spurious Interrupt Vector Register
AIC_SPU
Read-write
0x0
0x138
Debug Control Register
AIC_DCR
Read-write
0x0
0x13C
Reserved
---
---
---
(2)
AIC_FFER
Write-only
---
(2)
AIC_FFDR
Write-only
---
AIC_FFSR
Read-only
0x0
0x140
0x144
0x148
Notes:
Fast Forcing Enable Register
Fast Forcing Disable Register
Fast Forcing Status Register
(2)
1. The reset value of this register depends on the level of the external interrupt source. All other sources are cleared at reset,
thus not pending.
2. PID2...PID31 bit fields refer to the identifiers as defined in the Peripheral Identifiers Section of the product datasheet.
194
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24.8.3
AIC Source Mode Register
Register Name:
AIC_SMR0..AIC_SMR31
Access Type:
Read-write
Reset Value:
0x0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
SRCTYPE
PRIOR
• PRIOR: Priority Level
Programs the priority level for all sources except FIQ source (source 0).
The priority level can be between 0 (lowest) and 7 (highest).
The priority level is not used for the FIQ in the related SMR register AIC_SMRx.
• SRCTYPE: Interrupt Source Type
The active level or edge is not programmable for the internal interrupt sources.
SRCTYPE
Internal Interrupt Sources
External Interrupt Sources
0
0
High level Sensitive
Low level Sensitive
0
1
Positive edge triggered
Negative edge triggered
1
0
High level Sensitive
High level Sensitive
1
1
Positive edge triggered
Positive edge triggered
195
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.8.4
AIC Source Vector Register
Register Name:
AIC_SVR0..AIC_SVR31
Access Type:
Read-write
Reset Value:
0x0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
VECTOR
23
22
21
20
VECTOR
15
14
13
12
VECTOR
7
6
5
4
VECTOR
• VECTOR: Source Vector
The user may store in these registers the addresses of the corresponding handler for each interrupt source.
24.8.5
AIC Interrupt Vector Register
Register Name:
AIC_IVR
Access Type:
Read-only
Reset Value:
0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
IRQV
23
22
21
20
IRQV
15
14
13
12
IRQV
7
6
5
4
IRQV
• IRQV: Interrupt Vector Register
The Interrupt Vector Register contains the vector programmed by the user in the Source Vector Register corresponding to
the current interrupt.
The Source Vector Register is indexed using the current interrupt number when the Interrupt Vector Register is read.
When there is no current interrupt, the Interrupt Vector Register reads the value stored in AIC_SPU.
196
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24.8.6
AIC FIQ Vector Register
Register Name:
AIC_FVR
Access Type:
Read-only
Reset Value:
0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
FIQV
23
22
21
20
FIQV
15
14
13
12
FIQV
7
6
5
4
FIQV
• FIQV: FIQ Vector Register
The FIQ Vector Register contains the vector programmed by the user in the Source Vector Register 0. When there is no
fast interrupt, the FIQ Vector Register reads the value stored in AIC_SPU.
24.8.7
AIC Interrupt Status Register
Register Name:
AIC_ISR
Access Type:
Read-only
Reset Value:
0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
IRQID
• IRQID: Current Interrupt Identifier
The Interrupt Status Register returns the current interrupt source number.
197
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.8.8
AIC Interrupt Pending Register
Register Name:
AIC_IPR
Access Type:
Read-only
Reset Value:
0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
SYS
FIQ
• FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Pending
0 = Corresponding interrupt is not pending.
1 = Corresponding interrupt is pending.
24.8.9
AIC Interrupt Mask Register
Register Name:
AIC_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
Reset Value:
0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
SYS
FIQ
• FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Mask
0 = Corresponding interrupt is disabled.
1 = Corresponding interrupt is enabled.
198
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24.8.10 AIC Core Interrupt Status Register
Register Name:
AIC_CISR
Access Type:
Read-only
Reset Value:
0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
NIRQ
NIFQ
• NFIQ: NFIQ Status
0 = nFIQ line is deactivated.
1 = nFIQ line is active.
• NIRQ: NIRQ Status
0 = nIRQ line is deactivated.
1 = nIRQ line is active.
24.8.11 AIC Interrupt Enable Command Register
Register Name:
AIC_IECR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
SYS
FIQ
• FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID3: Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables corresponding interrupt.
199
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.8.12 AIC Interrupt Disable Command Register
Register Name:
AIC_IDCR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
SYS
FIQ
• FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables corresponding interrupt.
24.8.13 AIC Interrupt Clear Command Register
Register Name:
AIC_ICCR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
SYS
FIQ
• FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Clear
0 = No effect.
1 = Clears corresponding interrupt.
200
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24.8.14 AIC Interrupt Set Command Register
Register Name:
AIC_ISCR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
SYS
FIQ
• FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Set
0 = No effect.
1 = Sets corresponding interrupt.
24.8.15 AIC End of Interrupt Command Register
Register Name:
AIC_EOICR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
The End of Interrupt Command Register is used by the interrupt routine to indicate that the interrupt treatment is complete.
Any value can be written because it is only necessary to make a write to this register location to signal the end of interrupt
treatment.
201
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.8.16 AIC Spurious Interrupt Vector Register
Register Name:
AIC_SPU
Access Type:
Read-write
Reset Value:
0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
SIVR
23
22
21
20
SIVR
15
14
13
12
SIVR
7
6
5
4
SIVR
• SIVR: Spurious Interrupt Vector Register
The user may store the address of a spurious interrupt handler in this register. The written value is returned in AIC_IVR in
case of a spurious interrupt and in AIC_FVR in case of a spurious fast interrupt.
24.8.17 AIC Debug Control Register
Register Name:
AIC_DEBUG
Access Type:
Read-write
Reset Value:
0
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
GMSK
PROT
• PROT: Protection Mode
0 = The Protection Mode is disabled.
1 = The Protection Mode is enabled.
• GMSK: General Mask
0 = The nIRQ and nFIQ lines are normally controlled by the AIC.
1 = The nIRQ and nFIQ lines are tied to their inactive state.
202
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
24.8.18 AIC Fast Forcing Enable Register
Register Name:
AIC_FFER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
SYS
–
• SYS, PID2-PID31: Fast Forcing Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the fast forcing feature on the corresponding interrupt.
24.8.19 AIC Fast Forcing Disable Register
Register Name:
AIC_FFDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
SYS
–
• SYS, PID2-PID31: Fast Forcing Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the Fast Forcing feature on the corresponding interrupt.
203
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
24.8.20 AIC Fast Forcing Status Register
Register Name:
AIC_FFSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
SYS
–
• SYS, PID2-PID31: Fast Forcing Status
0 = The Fast Forcing feature is disabled on the corresponding interrupt.
1 = The Fast Forcing feature is enabled on the corresponding interrupt.
204
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
25. Clock Generator
25.1
Overview
The Clock Generator is made up of 1 PLL, a Main Oscillator, as well as an RC Oscillator .
It provides the following clocks:
• SLCK, the Slow Clock, which is the only permanent clock within the system
• MAINCK is the output of the Main Oscillator
• PLLCK is the output of the Divider and PLL block
The Clock Generator User Interface is embedded within the Power Management Controller one
and is described in Section 26.9. However, the Clock Generator registers are named CKGR_.
25.2
Slow Clock RC Oscillator
The user has to take into account the possible drifts of the RC Oscillator. More details are given
in the section “DC Characteristics” of the product datasheet.
25.3
Main Oscillator
Figure 25-1 shows the Main Oscillator block diagram.
Figure 25-1. Main Oscillator Block Diagram
MOSCEN
XIN
Main
Oscillator
XOUT
MAINCK
Main Clock
OSCOUNT
SLCK
Slow Clock
Main
Oscillator
Counter
Main Clock
Frequency
Counter
25.3.1
MOSCS
MAINF
MAINRDY
Main Oscillator Connections
The Clock Generator integrates a Main Oscillator that is designed for a 3 to 20 MHz fundamental
crystal. The typical crystal connection is illustrated in Figure 25-2. For further details on the electrical characteristics of the Main Oscillator, see the section “DC Characteristics” of the product
datasheet.
205
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 25-2. Typical Crystal Connection
AT91SAM7XC Microcontroller
XIN
XOUT
GND
1K
25.3.2
Main Oscillator Startup Time
The startup time of the Main Oscillator is given in the DC Characteristics section of the product
datasheet. The startup time depends on the crystal frequency and decreases when the frequency rises.
25.3.3
Main Oscillator Control
To minimize the power required to start up the system, the main oscillator is disabled after reset
and slow clock is selected.
The software enables or disables the main oscillator so as to reduce power consumption by
clearing the MOSCEN bit in the Main Oscillator Register (CKGR_MOR).
When disabling the main oscillator by clearing the MOSCEN bit in CKGR_MOR, the MOSCS bit
in PMC_SR is automatically cleared, indicating the main clock is off.
When enabling the main oscillator, the user must initiate the main oscillator counter with a value
corresponding to the startup time of the oscillator. This startup time depends on the crystal frequency connected to the main oscillator.
When the MOSCEN bit and the OSCOUNT are written in CKGR_MOR to enable the main oscillator, the MOSCS bit in PMC_SR (Status Register) is cleared and the counter starts counting
down on the slow clock divided by 8 from the OSCOUNT value. Since the OSCOUNT value is
coded with 8 bits, the maximum startup time is about 62 ms.
When the counter reaches 0, the MOSCS bit is set, indicating that the main clock is valid. Setting the MOSCS bit in PMC_IMR can trigger an interrupt to the processor.
25.3.4
Main Clock Frequency Counter
The Main Oscillator features a Main Clock frequency counter that provides the quartz frequency
connected to the Main Oscillator. Generally, this value is known by the system designer; however, it is useful for the boot program to configure the device with the correct clock speed,
independently of the application.
The Main Clock frequency counter starts incrementing at the Main Clock speed after the next rising edge of the Slow Clock as soon as the Main Oscillator is stable, i.e., as soon as the MOSCS
bit is set. Then, at the 16th falling edge of Slow Clock, the MAINRDY bit in CKGR_MCFR (Main
Clock Frequency Register) is set and the counter stops counting. Its value can be read in the
MAINF field of CKGR_MCFR and gives the number of Main Clock cycles during 16 periods of
206
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Slow Clock, so that the frequency of the crystal connected on the Main Oscillator can be
determined.
25.3.5
25.4
Main Oscillator Bypass
The user can input a clock on the device instead of connecting a crystal. In this case, the user
has to provide the external clock signal on the XIN pin. The input characteristics of the XIN pin
under these conditions are given in the product electrical characteristics section. The programmer has to be sure to set the OSCBYPASS bit to 1 and the MOSCEN bit to 0 in the Main OSC
register (CKGR_MOR) for the external clock to operate properly.
Divider and PLL Block
The PLL embeds an input divider to increase the accuracy of the resulting clock signals. However, the user must respect the PLL minimum input frequency when programming the divider.
Figure 25-3 shows the block diagram of the divider and PLL block.
Figure 25-3. Divider and PLL Block Diagram
DIV
Divider
MAINCK
OUT
MUL
PLLCK
PLL
PLLRC
PLLCOUNT
PLL
Counter
SLCK
25.4.1
LOCK
PLL Filter
The PLL requires connection to an external second-order filter through the PLLRC pin. Figure
25-4 shows a schematic of these filters.
Figure 25-4. PLL Capacitors and Resistors
PLLRC
PLL
R
C2
C1
GND
Values of R, C1 and C2 to be connected to the PLLRC pin must be calculated as a function of
the PLL input frequency, the PLL output frequency and the phase margin. A trade-off has to be
found between output signal overshoot and startup time.
207
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
25.4.2
Divider and Phase Lock Loop Programming
The divider can be set between 1 and 255 in steps of 1. When a divider field (DIV) is set to 0, the
output of the corresponding divider and the PLL output is a continuous signal at level 0. On
reset, each DIV field is set to 0, thus the corresponding PLL input clock is set to 0.
The PLL allows multiplication of the divider’s outputs. The PLL clock signal has a frequency that
depends on the respective source signal frequency and on the parameters DIV and MUL. The
factor applied to the source signal frequency is (MUL + 1)/DIV. When MUL is written to 0, the
corresponding PLL is disabled and its power consumption is saved. Re-enabling the PLL can be
performed by writing a value higher than 0 in the MUL field.
Whenever the PLL is re-enabled or one of its parameters is changed, the LOCK bit in PMC_SR
is automatically cleared. The values written in the PLLCOUNT field in CKGR_PLLR are loaded
in the PLL counter. The PLL counter then decrements at the speed of the Slow Clock until it
reaches 0. At this time, the LOCK bit is set in PMC_SR and can trigger an interrupt to the processor. The user has to load the number of Slow Clock cycles required to cover the PLL
transient time into the PLLCOUNT field. The transient time depends on the PLL filter. The initial
state of the PLL and its target frequency can be calculated using a specific tool provided by
Atmel.
208
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
26. Power Management Controller (PMC)
26.1
Overview
The Power Management Controller (PMC) optimizes power consumption by controlling all system and user peripheral clocks. The PMC enables/disables the clock inputs to many of the
peripherals and the ARM Processor.
The Power Management Controller provides the following clocks:
• MCK, the Master Clock, programmable from a few hundred Hz to the maximum operating
frequency of the device. It is available to the modules running permanently, such as the AIC
and the Memory Controller.
• Processor Clock (PCK), switched off when entering processor in idle mode.
• Peripheral Clocks, typically MCK, provided to the embedded peripherals (USART, SSC, SPI,
TWI, TC, MCI, etc.) and independently controllable. In order to reduce the number of clock
names in a product, the Peripheral Clocks are named MCK in the product datasheet.
• UDP Clock (UDPCK), required by USB Device Port operations.
• Programmable Clock Outputs can be selected from the clocks provided by the clock
generator and driven on the PCKx pins.
26.2
Master Clock Controller
The Master Clock Controller provides selection and division of the Master Clock (MCK). MCK is
the clock provided to all the peripherals and the memory controller.
The Master Clock is selected from one of the clocks provided by the Clock Generator. Selecting
the Slow Clock provides a Slow Clock signal to the whole device. Selecting the Main Clock
saves power consumption of the PLL.
The Master Clock Controller is made up of a clock selector and a prescaler.
The Master Clock selection is made by writing the CSS field (Clock Source Selection) in
PMC_MCKR (Master Clock Register). The prescaler supports the division by a power of 2 of the
selected clock between 1 and 64. The PRES field in PMC_MCKR programs the prescaler.
Each time PMC_MCKR is written to define a new Master Clock, the MCKRDY bit is cleared in
PMC_SR. It reads 0 until the Master Clock is established. Then, the MCKRDY bit is set and can
trigger an interrupt to the processor. This feature is useful when switching from a high-speed
clock to a lower one to inform the software when the change is actually done.
Figure 26-1. Master Clock Controller
PMC_MCKR
CSS
PMC_MCKR
PRES
SLCK
MAINCK
Master Clock
Prescaler
MCK
PLLCK
To the Processor
Clock Controller (PCK)
209
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
26.3
Processor Clock Controller
The PMC features a Processor Clock Controller (PCK) that implements the Processor Idle
Mode. The Processor Clock can be disabled by writing the System Clock Disable Register
(PMC_SCDR). The status o this clock (at least for debug purpose) can be read in the System
Clock Status Register (PMC_SCSR).
The Processor Clock PCK is enabled after a reset and is automatically re-enabled by any
enabled interrupt. The Processor Idle Mode is achieved by disabling the Processor Clock, which
is automatically re-enabled by any enabled fast or normal interrupt, or by the reset of the
product.
When the Processor Clock is disabled, the current instruction is finished before the clock is
stopped, but this does not prevent data transfers from other masters of the system bus.
26.4
USB Clock Controller
The USB Source Clock is the PLL output. If using the USB, the user must program the PLL to
generate a 48 MHz, a 96 MHz or a 192 MHz signal with an accuracy of ± 0.25% depending on
the USBDIV bit in CKGR_PLLR.
When the PLL output is stable, i.e., the LOCK bit is set:
• The USB device clock can be enabled by setting the UDP bit in PMC_SCER. To save power
on this peripheral when it is not used, the user can set the UDP bit in PMC_SCDR. The UDP
bit in PMC_SCSR gives the activity of this clock. The USB device port require both the 48
MHz signal and the Master Clock. The Master Clock may be controlled via the Master Clock
Controller.
Figure 26-2. USB Clock Controller
USBDIV
USB
Source
Clock
26.5
Divider
/1,/2,/4
UDP Clock (UDPCK)
UDP
Peripheral Clock Controller
The Power Management Controller controls the clocks of each embedded peripheral by the way
of the Peripheral Clock Controller. The user can individually enable and disable the Master
Clock on the peripherals by writing into the Peripheral Clock Enable (PMC_PCER) and Peripheral Clock Disable (PMC_PCDR) registers. The status of the peripheral clock activity can be
read in the Peripheral Clock Status Register (PMC_PCSR).
When a peripheral clock is disabled, the clock is immediately stopped. The peripheral clocks are
automatically disabled after a reset.
In order to stop a peripheral, it is recommended that the system software wait until the peripheral
has executed its last programmed operation before disabling the clock. This is to avoid data corruption or erroneous behavior of the system.
210
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
The bit number within the Peripheral Clock Control registers (PMC_PCER, PMC_PCDR, and
PMC_PCSR) is the Peripheral Identifier defined at the product level. Generally, the bit number
corresponds to the interrupt source number assigned to the peripheral.
26.6
Programmable Clock Output Controller
The PMC controls 4 signals to be output on external pins PCKx. Each signal can be independently programmed via the PMC_PCKx registers.
PCKx can be independently selected between the Slow clock, the PLL output and the main
clock by writing the CSS field in PMC_PCKx. Each output signal can also be divided by a power
of 2 between 1 and 64 by writing the PRES (Prescaler) field in PMC_PCKx.
Each output signal can be enabled and disabled by writing 1 in the corresponding bit, PCKx of
PMC_SCER and PMC_SCDR, respectively. Status of the active programmable output clocks
are given in the PCKx bits of PMC_SCSR (System Clock Status Register).
Moreover, like the PCK, a status bitin PMC_SR indicates that the Programmable Clock is actually what has been programmed in the Programmable Clock registers.
As the Programmable Clock Controller does not manage with glitch prevention when switching
clocks, it is strongly recommended to disable the Programmable Clock before any configuration
change and to re-enable it after the change is actually performed.
26.7
Programming Sequence
1. Enabling the Main Oscillator:
The main oscillator is enabled by setting the MOSCEN field in the CKGR_MOR register. In
some cases it may be advantageous to define a start-up time. This can be achieved by writing a value in the OSCOUNT field in the CKGR_MOR register.
Once this register has been correctly configured, the user must wait for MOSCS field in the
PMC_SR register to be set. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to MOSCS has been enabled in
the PMC_IER register.
Code Example:
write_register(CKGR_MOR,0x00000701)
Start Up Time = 8 * OSCOUNT / SLCK = 56 Slow Clock Cycles.
So, the main oscillator will be enabled (MOSCS bit set) after 56 Slow Clock Cycles.
2. Checking the Main Oscillator Frequency (Optional):
In some situations the user may need an accurate measure of the main oscillator frequency.
This measure can be accomplished via the CKGR_MCFR register.
Once the MAINRDY field is set in CKGR_MCFR register, the user may read the MAINF field
in CKGR_MCFR register. This provides the number of main clock cycles within sixteen slow
clock cycles.
211
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
3. Setting PLL and divider:
All parameters needed to configure PLL and the divider are located in the CKGR_PLLR
register.
The DIV field is used to control divider itself. A value between 0 and 255 can be programmed. Divider output is divider input divided by DIV parameter. By default DIV
parameter is set to 0 which means that divider is turned off.
The OUT field is used to select the PLL B output frequency range.
The MUL field is the PLL multiplier factor. This parameter can be programmed between 0
and 2047. If MUL is set to 0, PLL will be turned off, otherwise the PLL output frequency is
PLL input frequency multiplied by (MUL + 1).
The PLLCOUNT field specifies the number of slow clock cycles before LOCK bit is set in the
PMC_SR register after CKGR_PLLR register has been written.
Once the PMC_PLL register has been written, the user must wait for the LOCK bit to be set
in the PMC_SR register. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting
the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to LOCK has been enabled in the
PMC_IER register. All parameters in CKGR_PLLR can be programmed in a single write
operation. If at some stage one of the following parameters, MUL, DIV is modified, LOCK bit
will go low to indicate that PLL is not ready yet. When PLL is locked, LOCK will be set again.
The user is constrained to wait for LOCK bit to be set before using the PLL output clock.
The USBDIV field is used to control the additional divider by 1, 2 or 4, which generates the
USB clock(s).
Code Example:
write_register(CKGR_PLLR,0x00040805)
If PLL and divider are enabled, the PLL input clock is the main clock. PLL output clock is PLL
input clock multiplied by 5. Once CKGR_PLLR has been written, LOCK bit will be set after
eight slow clock cycles.
4. Selection of Master Clock and Processor Clock
The Master Clock and the Processor Clock are configurable via the PMC_MCKR register.
The CSS field is used to select the Master Clock divider source. By default, the selected
clock source is slow clock.
The PRES field is used to control the Master Clock prescaler. The user can choose between
different values (1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64). Master Clock output is prescaler input divided by
PRES parameter. By default, PRES parameter is set to 1 which means that master clock is
equal to slow clock.
Once the PMC_MCKR register has been written, the user must wait for the MCKRDY bit to
be set in the PMC_SR register. This can be done either by polling the status register or by
waiting for the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to MCKRDY has been
enabled in the PMC_IER register.
The PMC_MCKR register must not be programmed in a single write operation. The preferred programming sequence for the PMC_MCKR register is as follows:
212
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• If a new value for CSS field corresponds to PLL Clock,
– Program the PRES field in the PMC_MCKR register.
– Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register.
– Program the CSS field in the PMC_MCKR register.
– Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register.
• If a new value for CSS field corresponds to Main Clock or Slow Clock,
– Program the CSS field in the PMC_MCKR register.
– Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register.
– Program the PRES field in the PMC_MCKR register.
– Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register.
If at some stage one of the following parameters, CSS or PRES, is modified, the MCKRDY
bit will go low to indicate that the Master Clock and the Processor Clock are not ready yet.
The user must wait for MCKRDY bit to be set again before using the Master and Processor
Clocks.
Note:
IF PLLx clock was selected as the Master Clock and the user decides to modify it by writing in
CKGR_PLLR, the MCKRDY flag will go low while PLL is unlocked. Once PLL is locked again,
LOCK goes high and MCKRDY is set.
While PLL is unlocked, the Master Clock selection is automatically changed to Main Clock. For further information, see Section 26.8.2. “Clock Switching Waveforms” on page 215.
Code Example:
write_register(PMC_MCKR,0x00000001)
wait (MCKRDY=1)
write_register(PMC_MCKR,0x00000011)
wait (MCKRDY=1)
The Master Clock is main clock divided by 16.
The Processor Clock is the Master Clock.
5. Selection of Programmable clocks
Programmable clocks are controlled via registers; PMC_SCER, PMC_SCDR and
PMC_SCSR.
Programmable clocks can be enabled and/or disabled via the PMC_SCER and PMC_SCDR
registers. Depending on the system used, 4 Programmable clocks can be enabled or disabled. The PMC_SCSR provides a clear indication as to which Programmable clock is
enabled. By default all Programmable clocks are disabled.
PMC_PCKx registers are used to configure Programmable clocks.
The CSS field is used to select the Programmable clock divider source. Four clock options
are available: main clock, slow clock, PLLCK. By default, the clock source selected is slow
clock.
The PRES field is used to control the Programmable clock prescaler. It is possible to choose
between different values (1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64). Programmable clock output is prescaler
213
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
input divided by PRES parameter. By default, the PRES parameter is set to 1 which means
that master clock is equal to slow clock.
Once the PMC_PCKx register has been programmed, The corresponding Programmable
clock must be enabled and the user is constrained to wait for the PCKRDYx bit to be set in
the PMC_SR register. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting the
interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to PCKRDYx has been enabled in the
PMC_IER register. All parameters in PMC_PCKx can be programmed in a single write
operation.
If the CSS and PRES parameters are to be modified, the corresponding Programmable
clock must be disabled first. The parameters can then be modified. Once this has been
done, the user must re-enable the Programmable clock and wait for the PCKRDYx bit to be
set.
Code Example:
write_register(PMC_PCK0,0x00000015)
Programmable clock 0 is main clock divided by 32.
6. Enabling Peripheral Clocks
Once all of the previous steps have been completed, the peripheral clocks can be enabled
and/or disabled via registers PMC_PCER and PMC_PCDR.
Depending on the system used, 15 peripheral clocks can be enabled or disabled. The
PMC_PCSR provides a clear view as to which peripheral clock is enabled.
Note:
Each enabled peripheral clock corresponds to Master Clock.
Code Examples:
write_register(PMC_PCER,0x00000110)
Peripheral clocks 4 and 8 are enabled.
write_register(PMC_PCDR,0x00000010)
Peripheral clock 4 is disabled.
214
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
26.8
26.8.1
Clock Switching Details
Master Clock Switching Timings
Table 26-1 gives the worst case timings required for the Master Clock to switch from one
selected clock to another one. This is in the event that the prescaler is de-activated. When the
prescaler is activated, an additional time of 64 clock cycles of the new selected clock has to be
added.
Table 26-1.
Clock Switching Timings (Worst Case)
From
Main Clock
SLCK
PLL Clock
–
4 x SLCK +
2.5 x Main Clock
3 x PLL Clock +
4 x SLCK +
1 x Main Clock
0.5 x Main Clock +
4.5 x SLCK
–
3 x PLL Clock +
5 x SLCK
0.5 x Main Clock +
4 x SLCK +
PLLCOUNT x SLCK +
2.5 x PLLx Clock
2.5 x PLL Clock +
5 x SLCK +
PLLCOUNT x SLCK
2.5 x PLL Clock +
4 x SLCK +
PLLCOUNT x SLCK
To
Main Clock
SLCK
PLL Clock
26.8.2
Clock Switching Waveforms
Figure 26-3. Switch Master Clock from Slow Clock to PLL Clock
Slow Clock
PLL Clock
LOCK
MCKRDY
Master Clock
Write PMC_MCKR
215
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 26-4. Switch Master Clock from Main Clock to Slow Clock
Slow Clock
Main Clock
MCKRDY
Master Clock
Write PMC_MCKR
Figure 26-5. Change PLL Programming
Main Clock
PLL Clock
LOCK
MCKRDY
Master Clock
Main Clock
Write CKGR_PLLR
216
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 26-6. Programmable Clock Output Programming
PLL Clock
PCKRDY
PCKx Output
Write PMC_PCKx
Write PMC_SCER
Write PMC_SCDR
PLL Clock is selected
PCKx is enabled
PCKx is disabled
217
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
26.9
Power Management Controller (PMC) User Interface
Table 26-2.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x0000
System Clock Enable Register
PMC_SCER
Write-only
–
0x0004
System Clock Disable Register
PMC_SCDR
Write-only
–
0x0008
System Clock Status Register
PMC _SCSR
Read-only
0x01
0x000C
Reserved
–
–
0x0010
Peripheral Clock Enable Register
PMC _PCER
Write-only
–
0x0014
Peripheral Clock Disable Register
PMC_PCDR
Write-only
–
0x0018
Peripheral Clock Status Register
PMC_PCSR
Read-only
0x0
0x001C
Reserved
–
–
0x0020
Main Oscillator Register
CKGR_MOR
Read-write
0x0
0x0024
Main Clock Frequency Register
CKGR_MCFR
Read-only
0x0
0x0028
Reserved
–
–
0x002C
PLL Register
CKGR_PLLR
Read-write
0x3F00
0x0030
Master Clock Register
PMC_MCKR
Read-write
0x0
0x0038
Reserved
–
–
–
0x003C
Reserved
–
–
–
0x0040
Programmable Clock 0 Register
PMC_PCK0
Read-write
0x0
0x0044
Programmable Clock 1 Register
PMC_PCK1
Read-write
0x0
...
...
0x0060
Interrupt Enable Register
PMC_IER
Write-only
--
0x0064
Interrupt Disable Register
PMC_IDR
Write-only
--
0x0068
Status Register
PMC_SR
Read-only
0x08
0x006C
Interrupt Mask Register
PMC_IMR
Read-only
0x0
–
–
...
0x0070 - 0x007C
218
Reserved
–
–
–
...
–
...
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
26.9.1
PMC System Clock Enable Register
Register Name:
PMC_SCER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
PCK3
PCK2
PCK1
PCK0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
UDP
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
• UDP: USB Device Port Clock Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the 48 MHz clock of the USB Device Port.
• PCKx: Programmable Clock x Output Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding Programmable Clock output.
219
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
26.9.2
PMC System Clock Disable Register
Register Name:
PMC_SCDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
PCK3
PCK2
PCK1
PCK0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
UDP
–
–
–
–
–
–
PCK
• PCK: Processor Clock Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the Processor clock. This is used to enter the processor in Idle Mode.
• UDP: USB Device Port Clock Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the 48 MHz clock of the USB Device Port.
• PCKx: Programmable Clock x Output Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding Programmable Clock output.
220
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
26.9.3
PMC System Clock Status Register
Register Name:
PMC_SCSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
PCK3
PCK2
PCK1
PCK0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
UDP
–
–
–
–
–
–
PCK
• PCK: Processor Clock Status
0 = The Processor clock is disabled.
1 = The Processor clock is enabled.
• UDP: USB Device Port Clock Status
0 = The 48 MHz clock (UDPCK) of the USB Device Port is disabled.
1 = The 48 MHz clock (UDPCK) of the USB Device Port is enabled.
• PCKx: Programmable Clock x Output Status
0 = The corresponding Programmable Clock output is disabled.
1 = The corresponding Programmable Clock output is enabled.
221
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
26.9.4
PMC Peripheral Clock Enable Register
Register Name:
PMC_PCER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
-
-
• PIDx: Peripheral Clock x Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding peripheral clock.
Note:
PID2 to PID31 refer to identifiers as defined in the section “Peripheral Identifiers” in the product datasheet.
Note:
Programming the control bits of the Peripheral ID that are not implemented has no effect on the behavior of the PMC.
26.9.5
PMC Peripheral Clock Disable Register
Register Name:
PMC_PCDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
-
-
• PIDx: Peripheral Clock x Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding peripheral clock.
Note:
222
PID2 to PID31 refer to identifiers as defined in the section “Peripheral Identifiers” in the product datasheet.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
26.9.6
PMC Peripheral Clock Status Register
Register Name:
PMC_PCSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
PID31
PID30
PID29
PID28
PID27
PID26
PID25
PID24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
PID23
PID22
PID21
PID20
PID19
PID18
PID17
PID16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PID15
PID14
PID13
PID12
PID11
PID10
PID9
PID8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
–
–
• PIDx: Peripheral Clock x Status
0 = The corresponding peripheral clock is disabled.
1 = The corresponding peripheral clock is enabled.
Note:
PID2 to PID31 refer to identifiers as defined in the section “Peripheral Identifiers” in the product datasheet.
223
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
26.9.7
PMC Clock Generator Main Oscillator Register
Register Name:
CKGR_MOR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
–
2
–
1
OSCBYPASS
0
MOSCEN
OSCOUNT
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
• MOSCEN: Main Oscillator Enable
A crystal must be connected between XIN and XOUT.
0 = The Main Oscillator is disabled.
1 = The Main Oscillator is enabled. OSCBYPASS must be set to 0.
When MOSCEN is set, the MOSCS flag is set once the Main Oscillator startup time is achieved.
• OSCBYPASS: Oscillator Bypass
0 = No effect.
1 = The Main Oscillator is bypassed. MOSCEN must be set to 0. An external clock must be connected on XIN.
When OSCBYPASS is set, the MOSCS flag in PMC_SR is automatically set.
Clearing MOSCEN and OSCBYPASS bits allows resetting the MOSCS flag.
• OSCOUNT: Main Oscillator Start-up Time
Specifies the number of Slow Clock cycles multiplied by 8 for the Main Oscillator start-up time.
224
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
26.9.8
PMC Clock Generator Main Clock Frequency Register
Register Name:
CKGR_MCFR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
MAINRDY
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
MAINF
7
6
5
4
MAINF
• MAINF: Main Clock Frequency
Gives the number of Main Clock cycles within 16 Slow Clock periods.
• MAINRDY: Main Clock Ready
0 = MAINF value is not valid or the Main Oscillator is disabled.
1 = The Main Oscillator has been enabled previously and MAINF value is available.
225
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
26.9.9
PMC Clock Generator PLL Register
Register Name:
CKGR_PLLR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
23
22
21
28
27
–
26
25
MUL
24
20
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
2
1
0
USBDIV
MUL
15
14
13
12
OUT
7
PLLCOUNT
6
5
4
3
DIV
Possible limitations on PLL input frequencies and multiplier factors should be checked before using the PMC.
• DIV: Divider
DIV
Divider Selected
0
Divider output is 0
1
Divider is bypassed
2 - 255
Divider output is the selected clock divided by DIV.
• PLLCOUNT: PLL Counter
Specifies the number of slow clock cycles before the LOCK bit is set in PMC_SR after CKGR_PLLR is written.
• OUT: PLL Clock Frequency Range
To optimize clock performance, this field must be programmed as specified in “PLL Characteristics” in the Electrical Characteristics section of the product datasheet.
• MUL: PLL Multiplier
0 = The PLL is deactivated.
1 up to 2047 = The PLL Clock frequency is the PLL input frequency multiplied by MUL+ 1.
• USBDIV: Divider for USB Clock
USBDIV
226
Divider for USB Clock(s)
0
0
Divider output is PLL clock output.
0
1
Divider output is PLL clock output divided by 2.
1
0
Divider output is PLL clock output divided by 4.
1
1
Reserved.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
26.9.10 PMC Master Clock Register
Register Name:
PMC_MCKR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
4
3
2
1
7
6
5
–
–
–
PRES
0
CSS
• CSS: Master Clock Selection
CSS
Clock Source Selection
0
0
Slow Clock is selected
0
1
Main Clock is selected
1
0
Reserved
1
1
PLL Clock is selected.
• PRES: Processor Clock Prescaler
PRES
Processor Clock
0
0
0
Selected clock
0
0
1
Selected clock divided by 2
0
1
0
Selected clock divided by 4
0
1
1
Selected clock divided by 8
1
0
0
Selected clock divided by 16
1
0
1
Selected clock divided by 32
1
1
0
Selected clock divided by 64
1
1
1
Reserved
227
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
26.9.11 PMC Programmable Clock Register
Register Name:
PMC_PCKx
Access Type:
Read-write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
4
3
2
1
7
6
5
–
–
–
PRES
0
CSS
• CSS: Master Clock Selection
CSS
Clock Source Selection
0
0
Slow Clock is selected
0
1
Main Clock is selected
1
0
Reserved
1
1
PLL Clock is selected
• PRES: Programmable Clock Prescaler
PRES
228
Programmable Clock
0
0
0
Selected clock
0
0
1
Selected clock divided by 2
0
1
0
Selected clock divided by 4
0
1
1
Selected clock divided by 8
1
0
0
Selected clock divided by 16
1
0
1
Selected clock divided by 32
1
1
0
Selected clock divided by 64
1
1
1
Reserved
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
26.9.12 PMC Interrupt Enable Register
Register Name:
PMC_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
PCKRDY2
PCKRDY1
PCKRDY0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
MCKRDY
LOCK
–
MOSCS
• MOSCS: Main Oscillator Status Interrupt Enable
• LOCK: PLL Lock Interrupt Enable
• MCKRDY: Master Clock Ready Interrupt Enable
• PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready x Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
229
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
26.9.13 PMC Interrupt Disable Register
Register Name:
PMC_IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
PCKRDY2
PCKRDY1
PCKRDY0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
MCKRDY
LOCK
–
MOSCS
• MOSCS: Main Oscillator Status Interrupt Disable
• LOCK: PLL Lock Interrupt Disable
• MCKRDY: Master Clock Ready Interrupt Disable
• PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready x Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
230
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
26.9.14 PMC Status Register
Register Name:
PMC_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
PCKRDY2
PCKRDY1
PCKRDY0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
MCKRDY
LOCK
–
MOSCS
• MOSCS: MOSCS Flag Status
0 = Main oscillator is not stabilized.
1 = Main oscillator is stabilized.
• LOCK: PLL Lock Status
0 = PLL is not locked
1 = PLL is locked.
• MCKRDY: Master Clock Status
0 = Master Clock is not ready.
1 = Master Clock is ready.
• PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready Status
0 = Programmable Clock x is not ready.
1 = Programmable Clock x is ready.
231
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
26.9.15 PMC Interrupt Mask Register
Register Name:
PMC_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
PCKRDY2
PCKRDY1
PCKRDY0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
MCKRDY
LOCK
–
MOSCS
• MOSCS: Main Oscillator Status Interrupt Mask
• LOCK: PLL Lock Interrupt Mask
• MCKRDY: Master Clock Ready Interrupt Mask
• PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready x Interrupt Mask
0 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
1 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled.
232
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
27. Debug Unit (DBGU)
27.1
Overview
The Debug Unit provides a single entry point from the processor for access to all the debug
capabilities of Atmel’s ARM-based systems.
The Debug Unit features a two-pin UART that can be used for several debug and trace purposes
and offers an ideal medium for in-situ programming solutions and debug monitor communications. The Debug Unit two-pin UART can be used standalone for general purpose serial
communication. Moreover, the association with two peripheral data controller channels permits
packet handling for these tasks with processor time reduced to a minimum.
The Debug Unit also makes the Debug Communication Channel (DCC) signals provided by the
In-circuit Emulator of the ARM processor visible to the software. These signals indicate the status of the DCC read and write registers and generate an interrupt to the ARM processor, making
possible the handling of the DCC under interrupt control.
Chip Identifier registers permit recognition of the device and its revision. These registers inform
as to the sizes and types of the on-chip memories, as well as the set of embedded peripherals.
Finally, the Debug Unit features a Force NTRST capability that enables the software to decide
whether to prevent access to the system via the In-circuit Emulator. This permits protection of
the code, stored in ROM.
233
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
27.2
Block Diagram
Figure 27-1. Debug Unit Functional Block Diagram
Peripheral
Bridge
Peripheral DMA Controller
APB
Debug Unit
DTXD
Transmit
Power
Management
Controller
MCK
Parallel
Input/
Output
Baud Rate
Generator
Receive
DRXD
COMMRX
R
ARM
Processor
COMMTX
DCC
Handler
Chip ID
nTRST
ICE
Access
Handler
Interrupt
Control
dbgu_irq
Power-on
Reset
force_ntrst
Table 27-1.
Debug Unit Pin Description
Pin Name
Description
Type
DRXD
Debug Receive Data
Input
DTXD
Debug Transmit Data
Output
Debug Unit Application Example
Boot Program
Debug Monitor
Trace Manager
Debug Unit
RS232 Drivers
Programming Tool
234
Debug Console
Trace Console
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
27.3
27.3.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines
Depending on product integration, the Debug Unit pins may be multiplexed with PIO lines. In this
case, the programmer must first configure the corresponding PIO Controller to enable I/O lines
operations of the Debug Unit.
27.3.2
Power Management
Depending on product integration, the Debug Unit clock may be controllable through the Power
Management Controller. In this case, the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the
Debug Unit clock. Usually, the peripheral identifier used for this purpose is 1.
27.3.3
Interrupt Source
Depending on product integration, the Debug Unit interrupt line is connected to one of the interrupt sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Interrupt handling requires programming of
the AIC before configuring the Debug Unit. Usually, the Debug Unit interrupt line connects to the
interrupt source 1 of the AIC, which may be shared with the real-time clock, the system timer
interrupt lines and other system peripheral interrupts, as shown in Figure 27-1. This sharing
requires the programmer to determine the source of the interrupt when the source 1 is triggered.
27.4
UART Operations
The Debug Unit operates as a UART, (asynchronous mode only) and supports only 8-bit character handling (with parity). It has no clock pin.
The Debug Unit's UART is made up of a receiver and a transmitter that operate independently,
and a common baud rate generator. Receiver timeout and transmitter time guard are not implemented. However, all the implemented features are compatible with those of a standard USART.
27.4.1
Baud Rate Generator
The baud rate generator provides the bit period clock named baud rate clock to both the receiver
and the transmitter.
The baud rate clock is the master clock divided by 16 times the value (CD) written in
DBGU_BRGR (Baud Rate Generator Register). If DBGU_BRGR is set to 0, the baud rate clock
is disabled and the Debug Unit's UART remains inactive. The maximum allowable baud rate is
Master Clock divided by 16. The minimum allowable baud rate is Master Clock divided by (16 x
65536).
MCK
Baud Rate = ---------------------16 × CD
235
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 27-2. Baud Rate Generator
CD
CD
MCK
16-bit Counter
OUT
>1
1
0
Divide
by 16
Baud Rate
Clock
0
Receiver
Sampling Clock
27.4.2
27.4.2.1
Receiver
Receiver Reset, Enable and Disable
After device reset, the Debug Unit receiver is disabled and must be enabled before being used.
The receiver can be enabled by writing the control register DBGU_CR with the bit RXEN at 1. At
this command, the receiver starts looking for a start bit.
The programmer can disable the receiver by writing DBGU_CR with the bit RXDIS at 1. If the
receiver is waiting for a start bit, it is immediately stopped. However, if the receiver has already
detected a start bit and is receiving the data, it waits for the stop bit before actually stopping its
operation.
The programmer can also put the receiver in its reset state by writing DBGU_CR with the bit
RSTRX at 1. In doing so, the receiver immediately stops its current operations and is disabled,
whatever its current state. If RSTRX is applied when data is being processed, this data is lost.
27.4.2.2
Start Detection and Data Sampling
The Debug Unit only supports asynchronous operations, and this affects only its receiver. The
Debug Unit receiver detects the start of a received character by sampling the DRXD signal until
it detects a valid start bit. A low level (space) on DRXD is interpreted as a valid start bit if it is
detected for more than 7 cycles of the sampling clock, which is 16 times the baud rate. Hence, a
space that is longer than 7/16 of the bit period is detected as a valid start bit. A space which is
7/16 of a bit period or shorter is ignored and the receiver continues to wait for a valid start bit.
When a valid start bit has been detected, the receiver samples the DRXD at the theoretical midpoint of each bit. It is assumed that each bit lasts 16 cycles of the sampling clock (1-bit period)
so the bit sampling point is eight cycles (0.5-bit period) after the start of the bit. The first sampling
point is therefore 24 cycles (1.5-bit periods) after the falling edge of the start bit was detected.
Each subsequent bit is sampled 16 cycles (1-bit period) after the previous one.
236
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 27-3. Start Bit Detection
Sampling Clock
DRXD
True Start
Detection
D0
Baud Rate
Clock
Figure 27-4. Character Reception
Example: 8-bit, parity enabled 1 stop
0.5 bit
period
1 bit
period
DRXD
D0
D1
True Start Detection
Sampling
27.4.2.3
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Stop Bit
Parity Bit
Receiver Ready
When a complete character is received, it is transferred to the DBGU_RHR and the RXRDY status bit in DBGU_SR (Status Register) is set. The bit RXRDY is automatically cleared when the
receive holding register DBGU_RHR is read.
Figure 27-5. Receiver Ready
DRXD
S
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
S
P
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
RXRDY
Read DBGU_RHR
27.4.2.4
Receiver Overrun
If DBGU_RHR has not been read by the software (or the Peripheral Data Controller) since the
last transfer, the RXRDY bit is still set and a new character is received, the OVRE status bit in
DBGU_SR is set. OVRE is cleared when the software writes the control register DBGU_CR with
the bit RSTSTA (Reset Status) at 1.
Figure 27-6. Receiver Overrun
DRXD
S
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
stop
S
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
stop
RXRDY
OVRE
RSTSTA
27.4.2.5
Parity Error
Each time a character is received, the receiver calculates the parity of the received data bits, in
accordance with the field PAR in DBGU_MR. It then compares the result with the received parity
237
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
bit. If different, the parity error bit PARE in DBGU_SR is set at the same time the RXRDY is set.
The parity bit is cleared when the control register DBGU_CR is written with the bit RSTSTA
(Reset Status) at 1. If a new character is received before the reset status command is written,
the PARE bit remains at 1.
Figure 27-7. Parity Error
DRXD
S
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
stop
RXRDY
PARE
Wrong Parity Bit
27.4.2.6
RSTSTA
Receiver Framing Error
When a start bit is detected, it generates a character reception when all the data bits have been
sampled. The stop bit is also sampled and when it is detected at 0, the FRAME (Framing Error)
bit in DBGU_SR is set at the same time the RXRDY bit is set. The bit FRAME remains high until
the control register DBGU_CR is written with the bit RSTSTA at 1.
Figure 27-8. Receiver Framing Error
DRXD
S
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
P
stop
RXRDY
FRAME
Stop Bit
Detected at 0
27.4.3
27.4.3.1
RSTSTA
Transmitter
Transmitter Reset, Enable and Disable
After device reset, the Debug Unit transmitter is disabled and it must be enabled before being
used. The transmitter is enabled by writing the control register DBGU_CR with the bit TXEN at 1.
From this command, the transmitter waits for a character to be written in the Transmit Holding
Register DBGU_THR before actually starting the transmission.
The programmer can disable the transmitter by writing DBGU_CR with the bit TXDIS at 1. If the
transmitter is not operating, it is immediately stopped. However, if a character is being processed into the Shift Register and/or a character has been written in the Transmit Holding
Register, the characters are completed before the transmitter is actually stopped.
The programmer can also put the transmitter in its reset state by writing the DBGU_CR with the
bit RSTTX at 1. This immediately stops the transmitter, whether or not it is processing
characters.
27.4.3.2
238
Transmit Format
The Debug Unit transmitter drives the pin DTXD at the baud rate clock speed. The line is driven
depending on the format defined in the Mode Register and the data stored in the Shift Register.
One start bit at level 0, then the 8 data bits, from the lowest to the highest bit, one optional parity
bit and one stop bit at 1 are consecutively shifted out as shown on the following figure. The field
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
PARE in the mode register DBGU_MR defines whether or not a parity bit is shifted out. When a
parity bit is enabled, it can be selected between an odd parity, an even parity, or a fixed space or
mark bit.
Figure 27-9. Character Transmission
Example: Parity enabled
Baud Rate
Clock
DTXD
Start
Bit
27.4.3.3
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity
Bit
Stop
Bit
Transmitter Control
When the transmitter is enabled, the bit TXRDY (Transmitter Ready) is set in the status register
DBGU_SR. The transmission starts when the programmer writes in the Transmit Holding Register DBGU_THR, and after the written character is transferred from DBGU_THR to the Shift
Register. The bit TXRDY remains high until a second character is written in DBGU_THR. As
soon as the first character is completed, the last character written in DBGU_THR is transferred
into the shift register and TXRDY rises again, showing that the holding register is empty.
When both the Shift Register and the DBGU_THR are empty, i.e., all the characters written in
DBGU_THR have been processed, the bit TXEMPTY rises after the last stop bit has been
completed.
Figure 27-10. Transmitter Control
DBGU_THR
Data 0
Data 1
Shift Register
DTXD
Data 0
S
Data 0
Data 1
P
stop
S
Data 1
P
stop
TXRDY
TXEMPTY
Write Data 0
in DBGU_THR
27.4.4
Write Data 1
in DBGU_THR
Peripheral Data Controller
Both the receiver and the transmitter of the Debug Unit's UART are generally connected to a
Peripheral Data Controller (PDC) channel.
The peripheral data controller channels are programmed via registers that are mapped within
the Debug Unit user interface from the offset 0x100. The status bits are reported in the Debug
Unit status register DBGU_SR and can generate an interrupt.
239
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
The RXRDY bit triggers the PDC channel data transfer of the receiver. This results in a read of
the data in DBGU_RHR. The TXRDY bit triggers the PDC channel data transfer of the transmitter. This results in a write of a data in DBGU_THR.
27.4.5
Test Modes
The Debug Unit supports three tests modes. These modes of operation are programmed by
using the field CHMODE (Channel Mode) in the mode register DBGU_MR.
The Automatic Echo mode allows bit-by-bit retransmission. When a bit is received on the DRXD
line, it is sent to the DTXD line. The transmitter operates normally, but has no effect on the
DTXD line.
The Local Loopback mode allows the transmitted characters to be received. DTXD and DRXD
pins are not used and the output of the transmitter is internally connected to the input of the
receiver. The DRXD pin level has no effect and the DTXD line is held high, as in idle state.
The Remote Loopback mode directly connects the DRXD pin to the DTXD line. The transmitter
and the receiver are disabled and have no effect. This mode allows a bit-by-bit retransmission.
Figure 27-11. Test Modes
Automatic Echo
RXD
Receiver
Transmitter
Disabled
TXD
Local Loopback
Disabled
Receiver
RXD
VDD
Disabled
Transmitter
Remote Loopback
Receiver
Transmitter
27.4.6
240
TXD
VDD
Disabled
Disabled
RXD
TXD
Debug Communication Channel Support
The Debug Unit handles the signals COMMRX and COMMTX that come from the Debug Communication Channel of the ARM Processor and are driven by the In-circuit Emulator.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
The Debug Communication Channel contains two registers that are accessible through the ICE
Breaker on the JTAG side and through the coprocessor 0 on the ARM Processor side.
As a reminder, the following instructions are used to read and write the Debug Communication
Channel:
MRC
p14, 0, Rd, c1, c0, 0
Returns the debug communication data read register into Rd
MCR
p14, 0, Rd, c1, c0, 0
Writes the value in Rd to the debug communication data write register.
The bits COMMRX and COMMTX, which indicate, respectively, that the read register has been
written by the debugger but not yet read by the processor, and that the write register has been
written by the processor and not yet read by the debugger, are wired on the two highest bits of
the status register DBGU_SR. These bits can generate an interrupt. This feature permits handling under interrupt a debug link between a debug monitor running on the target system and a
debugger.
27.4.7
Chip Identifier
The Debug Unit features two chip identifier registers, DBGU_CIDR (Chip ID Register) and
DBGU_EXID (Extension ID). Both registers contain a hard-wired value that is read-only. The first
register contains the following fields:
• EXT - shows the use of the extension identifier register
• NVPTYP and NVPSIZ - identifies the type of embedded non-volatile memory and its size
• ARCH - identifies the set of embedded peripheral
• SRAMSIZ - indicates the size of the embedded SRAM
• EPROC - indicates the embedded ARM processor
• VERSION - gives the revision of the silicon
The second register is device-dependent and reads 0 if the bit EXT is 0.
27.4.8
ICE Access Prevention
The Debug Unit allows blockage of access to the system through the ARM processor's ICE
interface. This feature is implemented via the register Force NTRST (DBGU_FNR), that allows
assertion of the NTRST signal of the ICE Interface. Writing the bit FNTRST (Force NTRST) to 1
in this register prevents any activity on the TAP controller.
On standard devices, the FNTRST bit resets to 0 and thus does not prevent ICE access.
This feature is especially useful on custom ROM devices for customers who do not want their
on-chip code to be visible.
241
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
27.5
Debug Unit User Interface
Table 27-2.
Debug Unit Memory Map
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset Value
0x0000
Control Register
DBGU_CR
Write-only
–
0x0004
Mode Register
DBGU_MR
Read/Write
0x0
0x0008
Interrupt Enable Register
DBGU_IER
Write-only
–
0x000C
Interrupt Disable Register
DBGU_IDR
Write-only
–
0x0010
Interrupt Mask Register
DBGU_IMR
Read-only
0x0
0x0014
Status Register
DBGU_SR
Read-only
–
0x0018
Receive Holding Register
DBGU_RHR
Read-only
0x0
0x001C
Transmit Holding Register
DBGU_THR
Write-only
–
0x0020
Baud Rate Generator Register
DBGU_BRGR
Read/Write
0x0
–
–
–
0x0024 - 0x003C
Reserved
0x0040
Chip ID Register
DBGU_CIDR
Read-only
–
0x0044
Chip ID Extension Register
DBGU_EXID
Read-only
–
0x0048
Force NTRST Register
DBGU_FNR
Read/Write
0x0
0x004C - 0x00FC
Reserved
–
–
–
0x0100 - 0x0124
PDC Area
–
–
–
242
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
27.5.1
Name:
Debug Unit Control Register
DBGU_CR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
RSTSTA
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TXDIS
TXEN
RXDIS
RXEN
RSTTX
RSTRX
–
–
• RSTRX: Reset Receiver
0 = No effect.
1 = The receiver logic is reset and disabled. If a character is being received, the reception is aborted.
• RSTTX: Reset Transmitter
0 = No effect.
1 = The transmitter logic is reset and disabled. If a character is being transmitted, the transmission is aborted.
• RXEN: Receiver Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = The receiver is enabled if RXDIS is 0.
• RXDIS: Receiver Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = The receiver is disabled. If a character is being processed and RSTRX is not set, the character is completed before the
receiver is stopped.
• TXEN: Transmitter Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = The transmitter is enabled if TXDIS is 0.
• TXDIS: Transmitter Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = The transmitter is disabled. If a character is being processed and a character has been written the DBGU_THR and
RSTTX is not set, both characters are completed before the transmitter is stopped.
• RSTSTA: Reset Status Bits
0 = No effect.
1 = Resets the status bits PARE, FRAME and OVRE in the DBGU_SR.
243
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
27.5.2
Name:
Debug Unit Mode Register
DBGU_MR
Access Type:
Read/Write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
14
13
12
11
10
9
–
–
15
CHMODE
8
–
PAR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
• PAR: Parity Type
PAR
Parity Type
0
0
0
Even parity
0
0
1
Odd parity
0
1
0
Space: parity forced to 0
0
1
1
Mark: parity forced to 1
1
x
x
No parity
• CHMODE: Channel Mode
CHMODE
244
Mode Description
0
0
Normal Mode
0
1
Automatic Echo
1
0
Local Loopback
1
1
Remote Loopback
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
27.5.3
Name:
Debug Unit Interrupt Enable Register
DBGU_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
COMMRX
COMMTX
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
RXBUFF
TXBUFE
–
TXEMPTY
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PARE
FRAME
OVRE
ENDTX
ENDRX
–
TXRDY
RXRDY
• RXRDY: Enable RXRDY Interrupt
• TXRDY: Enable TXRDY Interrupt
• ENDRX: Enable End of Receive Transfer Interrupt
• ENDTX: Enable End of Transmit Interrupt
• OVRE: Enable Overrun Error Interrupt
• FRAME: Enable Framing Error Interrupt
• PARE: Enable Parity Error Interrupt
• TXEMPTY: Enable TXEMPTY Interrupt
• TXBUFE: Enable Buffer Empty Interrupt
• RXBUFF: Enable Buffer Full Interrupt
• COMMTX: Enable COMMTX (from ARM) Interrupt
• COMMRX: Enable COMMRX (from ARM) Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
245
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
27.5.4
Name:
Debug Unit Interrupt Disable Register
DBGU_IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
COMMRX
COMMTX
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
RXBUFF
TXBUFE
–
TXEMPTY
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PARE
FRAME
OVRE
ENDTX
ENDRX
–
TXRDY
RXRDY
• RXRDY: Disable RXRDY Interrupt
• TXRDY: Disable TXRDY Interrupt
• ENDRX: Disable End of Receive Transfer Interrupt
• ENDTX: Disable End of Transmit Interrupt
• OVRE: Disable Overrun Error Interrupt
• FRAME: Disable Framing Error Interrupt
• PARE: Disable Parity Error Interrupt
• TXEMPTY: Disable TXEMPTY Interrupt
• TXBUFE: Disable Buffer Empty Interrupt
• RXBUFF: Disable Buffer Full Interrupt
• COMMTX: Disable COMMTX (from ARM) Interrupt
• COMMRX: Disable COMMRX (from ARM) Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
246
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
27.5.5
Name:
Debug Unit Interrupt Mask Register
DBGU_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
COMMRX
COMMTX
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
RXBUFF
TXBUFE
–
TXEMPTY
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PARE
FRAME
OVRE
ENDTX
ENDRX
–
TXRDY
RXRDY
• RXRDY: Mask RXRDY Interrupt
• TXRDY: Disable TXRDY Interrupt
• ENDRX: Mask End of Receive Transfer Interrupt
• ENDTX: Mask End of Transmit Interrupt
• OVRE: Mask Overrun Error Interrupt
• FRAME: Mask Framing Error Interrupt
• PARE: Mask Parity Error Interrupt
• TXEMPTY: Mask TXEMPTY Interrupt
• TXBUFE: Mask TXBUFE Interrupt
• RXBUFF: Mask RXBUFF Interrupt
• COMMTX: Mask COMMTX Interrupt
• COMMRX: Mask COMMRX Interrupt
0 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled.
1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
247
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
27.5.6
Name:
Debug Unit Status Register
DBGU_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
COMMRX
COMMTX
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
RXBUFF
TXBUFE
–
TXEMPTY
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PARE
FRAME
OVRE
ENDTX
ENDRX
–
TXRDY
RXRDY
• RXRDY: Receiver Ready
0 = No character has been received since the last read of the DBGU_RHR or the receiver is disabled.
1 = At least one complete character has been received, transferred to DBGU_RHR and not yet read.
• TXRDY: Transmitter Ready
0 = A character has been written to DBGU_THR and not yet transferred to the Shift Register, or the transmitter is disabled.
1 = There is no character written to DBGU_THR not yet transferred to the Shift Register.
• ENDRX: End of Receiver Transfer
0 = The End of Transfer signal from the receiver Peripheral Data Controller channel is inactive.
1 = The End of Transfer signal from the receiver Peripheral Data Controller channel is active.
• ENDTX: End of Transmitter Transfer
0 = The End of Transfer signal from the transmitter Peripheral Data Controller channel is inactive.
1 = The End of Transfer signal from the transmitter Peripheral Data Controller channel is active.
• OVRE: Overrun Error
0 = No overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA.
1 = At least one overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA.
• FRAME: Framing Error
0 = No framing error has occurred since the last RSTSTA.
1 = At least one framing error has occurred since the last RSTSTA.
• PARE: Parity Error
0 = No parity error has occurred since the last RSTSTA.
1 = At least one parity error has occurred since the last RSTSTA.
• TXEMPTY: Transmitter Empty
0 = There are characters in DBGU_THR, or characters being processed by the transmitter, or the transmitter is disabled.
1 = There are no characters in DBGU_THR and there are no characters being processed by the transmitter.
248
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• TXBUFE: Transmission Buffer Empty
0 = The buffer empty signal from the transmitter PDC channel is inactive.
1 = The buffer empty signal from the transmitter PDC channel is active.
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full
0 = The buffer full signal from the receiver PDC channel is inactive.
1 = The buffer full signal from the receiver PDC channel is active.
• COMMTX: Debug Communication Channel Write Status
0 = COMMTX from the ARM processor is inactive.
1 = COMMTX from the ARM processor is active.
• COMMRX: Debug Communication Channel Read Status
0 = COMMRX from the ARM processor is inactive.
1 = COMMRX from the ARM processor is active.
249
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
27.5.7
Name:
Debug Unit Receiver Holding Register
DBGU_RHR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RXCHR
• RXCHR: Received Character
Last received character if RXRDY is set.
250
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
27.5.8
Name:
Debug Unit Transmit Holding Register
DBGU_THR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TXCHR
• TXCHR: Character to be Transmitted
Next character to be transmitted after the current character if TXRDY is not set.
251
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
27.5.9
Name:
Debug Unit Baud Rate Generator Register
DBGU_BRGR
Access Type:
Read/Write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CD
7
6
5
4
CD
• CD: Clock Divisor
CD
0
Disabled
1
MCK
2 to 65535
252
Baud Rate Clock
MCK / (CD x 16)
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
27.5.10
Name:
Debug Unit Chip ID Register
DBGU_CIDR
Access Type:
31
Read-only
30
29
EXT
23
28
27
26
NVPTYP
22
21
20
19
18
ARCH
15
14
13
6
24
17
16
9
8
1
0
SRAMSIZ
12
11
10
NVPSIZ2
7
25
ARCH
NVPSIZ
5
4
3
EPROC
2
VERSION
• VERSION: Version of the Device
• EPROC: Embedded Processor
EPROC
Processor
0
0
1
ARM946ES™
0
1
0
ARM7TDMI®
1
0
0
ARM920T™
1
0
1
ARM926EJS™
• NVPSIZ: Nonvolatile Program Memory Size
NVPSIZ
Size
0
0
0
0
None
0
0
0
1
8K bytes
0
0
1
0
16K bytes
0
0
1
1
32K bytes
0
1
0
0
Reserved
0
1
0
1
64K bytes
0
1
1
0
Reserved
0
1
1
1
128K bytes
1
0
0
0
Reserved
1
0
0
1
256K bytes
1
0
1
0
512K bytes
1
0
1
1
Reserved
1
1
0
0
1024K bytes
1
1
0
1
Reserved
1
1
1
0
2048K bytes
1
1
1
1
Reserved
253
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• NVPSIZ2 Second Nonvolatile Program Memory Size
NVPSIZ2
Size
0
0
0
0
None
0
0
0
1
8K bytes
0
0
1
0
16K bytes
0
0
1
1
32K bytes
0
1
0
0
Reserved
0
1
0
1
64K bytes
0
1
1
0
Reserved
0
1
1
1
128K bytes
1
0
0
0
Reserved
1
0
0
1
256K bytes
1
0
1
0
512K bytes
1
0
1
1
Reserved
1
1
0
0
1024K bytes
1
1
0
1
Reserved
1
1
1
0
2048K bytes
1
1
1
1
Reserved
• SRAMSIZ: Internal SRAM Size
SRAMSIZ
254
Size
0
0
0
0
Reserved
0
0
0
1
1K bytes
0
0
1
0
2K bytes
0
0
1
1
6K bytes
0
1
0
0
112K bytes
0
1
0
1
4K bytes
0
1
1
0
80K bytes
0
1
1
1
160K bytes
1
0
0
0
8K bytes
1
0
0
1
16K bytes
1
0
1
0
32K bytes
1
0
1
1
64K bytes
1
1
0
0
128K bytes
1
1
0
1
256K bytes
1
1
1
0
96K bytes
1
1
1
1
512K bytes
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• ARCH: Architecture Identifier
ARCH
Hex
Bin
Architecture
0x19
0001 1001
AT91SAM9xx Series
0x29
0010 1001
AT91SAM9XExx Series
0x34
0011 0100
AT91x34 Series
0x37
0011 0111
CAP7Series
0x39
0011 1001
CAP9 Series
0x3B
0011 1011
CAP11 Series
0x40
0100 0000
AT91x40 Series
0x42
0100 0010
AT91x42 Series
0x55
0101 0101
AT91x55 Series
0x60
0110 0000
AT91SAM7Axx Series
0x61
0110 0001
AT91SAM7AQxx Series
0x63
0110 0011
AT91x63 Series
0x70
0111 0000
AT91SAM7Sxx Series
0x71
0111 0001
AT91SAM7XCxx Series
0x72
0111 0010
AT91SAM7SExx Series
0x73
0111 0011
AT91SAM7Lxx Series
0x75
0111 0101
AT91SAM7Xxx Series
0x92
1001 0010
AT91x92 Series
0xF0
1111 0000
AT75Cxx Series
• NVPTYP: Nonvolatile Program Memory Type
NVPTYP
Memory
0
0
0
ROM
0
0
1
ROMless or on-chip Flash
1
0
0
SRAM emulating ROM
0
1
0
Embedded Flash Memory
0
1
1
ROM and Embedded Flash Memory
NVPSIZ is ROM size
NVPSIZ2 is Flash size
• EXT: Extension Flag
0 = Chip ID has a single register definition without extension
1 = An extended Chip ID exists.
255
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
27.5.11
Name:
Debug Unit Chip ID Extension Register
DBGU_EXID
Access Type:
31
Read-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
EXID
23
22
21
20
EXID
15
14
13
12
EXID
7
6
5
4
EXID
• EXID: Chip ID Extension
Reads 0 if the bit EXT in DBGU_CIDR is 0.
27.5.12
Name:
Debug Unit Force NTRST Register
DBGU_FNR
Access Type:
Read/Write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
FNTRST
• FNTRST: Force NTRST
0 = NTRST of the ARM processor’s TAP controller is driven by the power_on_reset signal.
1 = NTRST of the ARM processor’s TAP controller is held low.
256
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28. Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
28.1
Overview
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) circuit is a synchronous serial data link that provides communication with external devices in Master or Slave Mode. It also enables communication
between processors if an external processor is connected to the system.
The Serial Peripheral Interface is essentially a shift register that serially transmits data bits to
other SPIs. During a data transfer, one SPI system acts as the “master”' which controls the data
flow, while the other devices act as “slaves” which have data shifted into and out by the master.
Different CPUs can take turn being masters (Multiple Master Protocol opposite to Single Master
Protocol where one CPU is always the master while all of the others are always slaves) and one
master may simultaneously shift data into multiple slaves. However, only one slave may drive its
output to write data back to the master at any given time.
A slave device is selected when the master asserts its NSS signal. If multiple slave devices
exist, the master generates a separate slave select signal for each slave (NPCS).
The SPI system consists of two data lines and two control lines:
• Master Out Slave In (MOSI): This data line supplies the output data from the master shifted
into the input(s) of the slave(s).
• Master In Slave Out (MISO): This data line supplies the output data from a slave to the input
of the master. There may be no more than one slave transmitting data during any particular
transfer.
• Serial Clock (SPCK): This control line is driven by the master and regulates the flow of the
data bits. The master may transmit data at a variety of baud rates; the SPCK line cycles once
for each bit that is transmitted.
• Slave Select (NSS): This control line allows slaves to be turned on and off by hardware.
257
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
28.2
Block Diagram
Figure 28-1. Block Diagram
PDC
APB
SPCK
MISO
PMC
MOSI
MCK
SPI Interface
PIO
NPCS0/NSS
NPCS1
NPCS2
Interrupt Control
NPCS3
SPI Interrupt
28.3
Application Block Diagram
Figure 28-2. Application Block Diagram: Single Master/Multiple Slave Implementation
SPI Master
SPCK
SPCK
MISO
MISO
MOSI
MOSI
NPCS0
NSS
Slave 0
SPCK
NPCS1
NPCS2
NC
NPCS3
MISO
Slave 1
MOSI
NSS
SPCK
MISO
Slave 2
MOSI
NSS
258
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28.4
Signal Description
Table 28-1.
Signal Description
Type
Pin Name
Pin Description
Master
Slave
MISO
Master In Slave Out
Input
Output
MOSI
Master Out Slave In
Output
Input
SPCK
Serial Clock
Output
Input
NPCS1-NPCS3
Peripheral Chip Selects
Output
Unused
NPCS0/NSS
Peripheral Chip Select/Slave Select
Output
Input
28.5
28.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines
The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines.
The programmer must first program the PIO controllers to assign the SPI pins to their peripheral
functions.
28.5.2
Power Management
The SPI may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), thus the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the SPI clock.
28.5.3
Interrupt
The SPI interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC).
Handling the SPI interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the SPI.
259
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
28.6
28.6.1
Functional Description
Modes of Operation
The SPI operates in Master Mode or in Slave Mode.
Operation in Master Mode is programmed by writing at 1 the MSTR bit in the Mode Register.
The pins NPCS0 to NPCS3 are all configured as outputs, the SPCK pin is driven, the MISO line
is wired on the receiver input and the MOSI line driven as an output by the transmitter.
If the MSTR bit is written at 0, the SPI operates in Slave Mode. The MISO line is driven by the
transmitter output, the MOSI line is wired on the receiver input, the SPCK pin is driven by the
transmitter to synchronize the receiver. The NPCS0 pin becomes an input, and is used as a
Slave Select signal (NSS). The pins NPCS1 to NPCS3 are not driven and can be used for other
purposes.
The data transfers are identically programmable for both modes of operations. The baud rate
generator is activated only in Master Mode.
28.6.2
Data Transfer
Four combinations of polarity and phase are available for data transfers. The clock polarity is
programmed with the CPOL bit in the Chip Select Register. The clock phase is programmed with
the NCPHA bit. These two parameters determine the edges of the clock signal on which data is
driven and sampled. Each of the two parameters has two possible states, resulting in four possible combinations that are incompatible with one another. Thus, a master/slave pair must use the
same parameter pair values to communicate. If multiple slaves are used and fixed in different
configurations, the master must reconfigure itself each time it needs to communicate with a different slave.
Table 28-2 shows the four modes and corresponding parameter settings.
Table 28-2.
SPI Bus Protocol Mode
SPI Mode
CPOL
NCPHA
0
0
1
1
0
0
2
1
1
3
1
0
Figure 28-3 and Figure 28-4 show examples of data transfers.
260
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 28-3. SPI Transfer Format (NCPHA = 1, 8 bits per transfer)
1
SPCK cycle (for reference)
2
3
4
6
5
7
8
SPCK
(CPOL = 0)
SPCK
(CPOL = 1)
MOSI
(from master)
MSB
MISO
(from slave)
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
LSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
LSB
*
NSS
(to slave)
* Not defined, but normally MSB of previous character received.
Figure 28-4. SPI Transfer Format (NCPHA = 0, 8 bits per transfer)
1
SPCK cycle (for reference)
2
3
4
5
7
6
8
SPCK
(CPOL = 0)
SPCK
(CPOL = 1)
MOSI
(from master)
MISO
(from slave)
*
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
LSB
LSB
NSS
(to slave)
* Not defined but normally LSB of previous character transmitted.
261
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
28.6.3
Master Mode Operations
When configured in Master Mode, the SPI operates on the clock generated by the internal programmable baud rate generator. It fully controls the data transfers to and from the slave(s)
connected to the SPI bus. The SPI drives the chip select line to the slave and the serial clock
signal (SPCK).
The SPI features two holding registers, the Transmit Data Register and the Receive Data Register, and a single Shift Register. The holding registers maintain the data flow at a constant rate.
After enabling the SPI, a data transfer begins when the processor writes to the SPI_TDR (Transmit Data Register). The written data is immediately transferred in the Shift Register and transfer
on the SPI bus starts. While the data in the Shift Register is shifted on the MOSI line, the MISO
line is sampled and shifted in the Shift Register. Transmission cannot occur without reception.
Before writing the TDR, the PCS field must be set in order to select a slave.
If new data is written in SPI_TDR during the transfer, it stays in it until the current transfer is
completed. Then, the received data is transferred from the Shift Register to SPI_RDR, the data
in SPI_TDR is loaded in the Shift Register and a new transfer starts.
The transfer of a data written in SPI_TDR in the Shift Register is indicated by the TDRE bit
(Transmit Data Register Empty) in the Status Register (SPI_SR). When new data is written in
SPI_TDR, this bit is cleared. The TDRE bit is used to trigger the Transmit PDC channel.
The end of transfer is indicated by the TXEMPTY flag in the SPI_SR register. If a transfer delay
(DLYBCT) is greater than 0 for the last transfer, TXEMPTY is set after the completion of said
delay. The master clock (MCK) can be switched off at this time.
The transfer of received data from the Shift Register in SPI_RDR is indicated by the RDRF bit
(Receive Data Register Full) in the Status Register (SPI_SR). When the received data is read,
the RDRF bit is cleared.
If the SPI_RDR (Receive Data Register) has not been read before new data is received, the
Overrun Error bit (OVRES) in SPI_SR is set. As long as this flag is set, data is loaded in
SPI_RDR. The user has to read the status register to clear the OVRES bit.
Figure 28-5 on page 263 shows a block diagram of the SPI when operating in Master Mode. Figure 28-6 on page 264 shows a flow chart describing how transfers are handled.
262
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28.6.3.1
Master Mode Block Diagram
Figure 28-5. Master Mode Block Diagram
SPI_CSR0..3
SCBR
Baud Rate Generator
MCK
SPCK
SPI
Clock
SPI_CSR0..3
BITS
NCPHA
CPOL
LSB
MISO
SPI_RDR
RDRF
OVRES
RD
MSB
Shift Register
MOSI
SPI_TDR
TD
SPI_CSR0..3
CSAAT
TDRE
SPI_RDR
PCS
PS
NPCS3
PCSDEC
SPI_MR
PCS
0
NPCS2
Current
Peripheral
NPCS1
SPI_TDR
NPCS0
PCS
1
MSTR
MODF
NPCS0
MODFDIS
263
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
28.6.3.2
Master Mode Flow Diagram
Figure 28-6. Master Mode Flow Diagram S
SPI Enable
- NPCS defines the current Chip Select
- CSAAT, DLYBS, DLYBCT refer to the fields of the
Chip Select Register corresponding to the Current Chip Select
- When NPCS is 0xF, CSAAT is 0.
1
TDRE ?
0
1
CSAAT ?
PS ?
0
1
0
Fixed
peripheral
PS ?
1
Fixed
peripheral
0
Variable
peripheral
Variable
peripheral
SPI_TDR(PCS)
= NPCS ?
no
NPCS = SPI_TDR(PCS)
NPCS = SPI_MR(PCS)
yes
SPI_MR(PCS)
= NPCS ?
no
NPCS = 0xF
NPCS = 0xF
Delay DLYBCS
Delay DLYBCS
NPCS = SPI_TDR(PCS)
NPCS = SPI_MR(PCS),
SPI_TDR(PCS)
Delay DLYBS
Serializer = SPI_TDR(TD)
TDRE = 1
Data Transfer
SPI_RDR(RD) = Serializer
RDRF = 1
Delay DLYBCT
0
TDRE ?
1
1
CSAAT ?
0
NPCS = 0xF
Delay DLYBCS
264
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28.6.3.3
Clock Generation
The SPI Baud rate clock is generated by dividing the Master Clock (MCK), by a value between 1
and 255.
This allows a maximum operating baud rate at up to Master Clock and a minimum operating
baud rate of MCK divided by 255.
Programming the SCBR field at 0 is forbidden. Triggering a transfer while SCBR is at 0 can lead
to unpredictable results.
At reset, SCBR is 0 and the user has to program it at a valid value before performing the first
transfer.
The divisor can be defined independently for each chip select, as it has to be programmed in the
SCBR field of the Chip Select Registers. This allows the SPI to automatically adapt the baud
rate for each interfaced peripheral without reprogramming.
28.6.3.4
Transfer Delays
Figure 28-7 shows a chip select transfer change and consecutive transfers on the same chip
select. Three delays can be programmed to modify the transfer waveforms:
• The delay between chip selects, programmable only once for all the chip selects by writing
the DLYBCS field in the Mode Register. Allows insertion of a delay between release of one
chip select and before assertion of a new one.
• The delay before SPCK, independently programmable for each chip select by writing the field
DLYBS. Allows the start of SPCK to be delayed after the chip select has been asserted.
• The delay between consecutive transfers, independently programmable for each chip select
by writing the DLYBCT field. Allows insertion of a delay between two transfers occurring on
the same chip select
These delays allow the SPI to be adapted to the interfaced peripherals and their speed and bus
release time.
Figure 28-7. Programmable Delays
Chip Select 1
Chip Select 2
SPCK
DLYBCS
28.6.3.5
DLYBS
DLYBCT
DLYBCT
Peripheral Selection
The serial peripherals are selected through the assertion of the NPCS0 to NPCS3 signals. By
default, all the NPCS signals are high before and after each transfer.
The peripheral selection can be performed in two different ways:
• Fixed Peripheral Select: SPI exchanges data with only one peripheral
265
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• Variable Peripheral Select: Data can be exchanged with more than one peripheral
Fixed Peripheral Select is activated by writing the PS bit to zero in SPI_MR (Mode Register). In
this case, the current peripheral is defined by the PCS field in SPI_MR and the PCS field in the
SPI_TDR has no effect.
Variable Peripheral Select is activated by setting PS bit to one. The PCS field in SPI_TDR is
used to select the current peripheral. This means that the peripheral selection can be defined for
each new data.
The Fixed Peripheral Selection allows buffer transfers with a single peripheral. Using the PDC is
an optimal means, as the size of the data transfer between the memory and the SPI is either 8
bits or 16 bits. However, changing the peripheral selection requires the Mode Register to be
reprogrammed.
The Variable Peripheral Selection allows buffer transfers with multiple peripherals without reprogramming the Mode Register. Data written in SPI_TDR is 32 bits wide and defines the real data
to be transmitted and the peripheral it is destined to. Using the PDC in this mode requires 32-bit
wide buffers, with the data in the LSBs and the PCS and LASTXFER fields in the MSBs, however the SPI still controls the number of bits (8 to16) to be transferred through MISO and MOSI
lines with the chip select configuration registers. This is not the optimal means in term of memory size for the buffers, but it provides a very effective means to exchange data with several
peripherals without any intervention of the processor.
28.6.3.6
Peripheral Chip Select Decoding
The user can program the SPI to operate with up to 15 peripherals by decoding the four Chip
Select lines, NPCS0 to NPCS3 with an external logic. This can be enabled by writing the PCSDEC bit at 1 in the Mode Register (SPI_MR).
When operating without decoding, the SPI makes sure that in any case only one chip select line
is activated, i.e. driven low at a time. If two bits are defined low in a PCS field, only the lowest
numbered chip select is driven low.
When operating with decoding, the SPI directly outputs the value defined by the PCS field of
either the Mode Register or the Transmit Data Register (depending on PS).
As the SPI sets a default value of 0xF on the chip select lines (i.e. all chip select lines at 1) when
not processing any transfer, only 15 peripherals can be decoded.
The SPI has only four Chip Select Registers, not 15. As a result, when decoding is activated,
each chip select defines the characteristics of up to four peripherals. As an example, SPI_CRS0
defines the characteristics of the externally decoded peripherals 0 to 3, corresponding to the
PCS values 0x0 to 0x3. Thus, the user has to make sure to connect compatible peripherals on
the decoded chip select lines 0 to 3, 4 to 7, 8 to 11 and 12 to 14.
28.6.3.7
Peripheral Deselection
When operating normally, as soon as the transfer of the last data written in SPI_TDR is completed, the NPCS lines all rise. This might lead to runtime error if the processor is too long in
responding to an interrupt, and thus might lead to difficulties for interfacing with some serial
peripherals requiring the chip select line to remain active during a full set of transfers.
To facilitate interfacing with such devices, the Chip Select Register can be programmed with the
CSAAT bit (Chip Select Active After Transfer) at 1. This allows the chip select lines to remain in
their current state (low = active) until transfer to another peripheral is required.
266
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 28-8 shows different peripheral deselection cases and the effect of the CSAAT bit.
Figure 28-8. Peripheral Deselection
CSAAT = 0
TDRE
NPCS[0..3]
CSAAT = 1
DLYBCT
DLYBCT
A
A
A
A
DLYBCS
A
DLYBCS
PCS = A
PCS = A
Write SPI_TDR
TDRE
NPCS[0..3]
DLYBCT
DLYBCT
A
A
A
A
DLYBCS
A
DLYBCS
PCS=A
PCS = A
Write SPI_TDR
TDRE
NPCS[0..3]
DLYBCT
DLYBCT
A
B
A
B
DLYBCS
PCS = B
DLYBCS
PCS = B
Write SPI_TDR
28.6.3.8
Mode Fault Detection
A mode fault is detected when the SPI is programmed in Master Mode and a low level is driven
by an external master on the NPCS0/NSS signal. NPCS0, MOSI, MISO and SPCK must be configured in open drain through the PIO controller, so that external pull up resistors are needed to
guarantee high level.
When a mode fault is detected, the MODF bit in the SPI_SR is set until the SPI_SR is read and
the SPI is automatically disabled until re-enabled by writing the SPIEN bit in the SPI_CR (Control Register) at 1.
By default, the Mode Fault detection circuitry is enabled. The user can disable Mode Fault
detection by setting the MODFDIS bit in the SPI Mode Register (SPI_MR).
28.6.4
SPI Slave Mode
When operating in Slave Mode, the SPI processes data bits on the clock provided on the SPI
clock pin (SPCK).
The SPI waits for NSS to go active before receiving the serial clock from an external master.
When NSS falls, the clock is validated on the serializer, which processes the number of bits
267
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
defined by the BITS field of the Chip Select Register 0 (SPI_CSR0). These bits are processed
following a phase and a polarity defined respectively by the NCPHA and CPOL bits of the
SPI_CSR0. Note that BITS, CPOL and NCPHA of the other Chip Select Registers have no
effect when the SPI is programmed in Slave Mode.
The bits are shifted out on the MISO line and sampled on the MOSI line.
When all the bits are processed, the received data is transferred in the Receive Data Register
and the RDRF bit rises. If the SPI_RDR (Receive Data Register) has not been read before new
data is received, the Overrun Error bit (OVRES) in SPI_SR is set. As long as this flag is set, data
is loaded in SPI_RDR. The user has to read the status register to clear the OVRES bit.
When a transfer starts, the data shifted out is the data present in the Shift Register. If no data
has been written in the Transmit Data Register (SPI_TDR), the last data received is transferred.
If no data has been received since the last reset, all bits are transmitted low, as the Shift Register resets at 0.
When a first data is written in SPI_TDR, it is transferred immediately in the Shift Register and the
TDRE bit rises. If new data is written, it remains in SPI_TDR until a transfer occurs, i.e. NSS falls
and there is a valid clock on the SPCK pin. When the transfer occurs, the last data written in
SPI_TDR is transferred in the Shift Register and the TDRE bit rises. This enables frequent
updates of critical variables with single transfers.
Then, a new data is loaded in the Shift Register from the Transmit Data Register. In case no
character is ready to be transmitted, i.e. no character has been written in SPI_TDR since the last
load from SPI_TDR to the Shift Register, the Shift Register is not modified and the last received
character is retransmitted.
Figure 28-9 shows a block diagram of the SPI when operating in Slave Mode.
Figure 28-9. Slave Mode Functional Block Diagram
SPCK
NSS
SPI
Clock
SPIEN
SPIENS
SPIDIS
SPI_CSR0
BITS
NCPHA
CPOL
MOSI
LSB
SPI_RDR
RDRF
OVRES
RD
MSB
Shift Register
MISO
SPI_TDR
TD
268
TDRE
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28.7
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) User Interface
Table 28-3.
SPI Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00
Control Register
SPI_CR
Write-only
---
0x04
Mode Register
SPI_MR
Read/Write
0x0
0x08
Receive Data Register
SPI_RDR
Read-only
0x0
0x0C
Transmit Data Register
SPI_TDR
Write-only
---
0x10
Status Register
SPI_SR
Read-only
0x000000F0
0x14
Interrupt Enable Register
SPI_IER
Write-only
---
0x18
Interrupt Disable Register
SPI_IDR
Write-only
---
0x1C
Interrupt Mask Register
SPI_IMR
Read-only
0x0
0x20 - 0x2C
Reserved
0x30
Chip Select Register 0
SPI_CSR0
Read/Write
0x0
0x34
Chip Select Register 1
SPI_CSR1
Read/Write
0x0
0x38
Chip Select Register 2
SPI_CSR2
Read/Write
0x0
0x3C
Chip Select Register 3
SPI_CSR3
Read/Write
0x0
0x004C - 0x00F8
Reserved
–
–
–
0x004C - 0x00FC
Reserved
–
–
–
0x100 - 0x124
Reserved for the PDC
269
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
28.7.1
Name:
SPI Control Register
SPI_CR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
LASTXFER
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SWRST
–
–
–
–
–
SPIDIS
SPIEN
• SPIEN: SPI Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the SPI to transfer and receive data.
• SPIDIS: SPI Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the SPI.
As soon as SPIDIS is set, SPI finishes its transfer.
All pins are set in input mode and no data is received or transmitted.
If a transfer is in progress, the transfer is finished before the SPI is disabled.
If both SPIEN and SPIDIS are equal to one when the control register is written, the SPI is disabled.
• SWRST: SPI Software Reset
0 = No effect.
1 = Reset the SPI. A software-triggered hardware reset of the SPI interface is performed.
The SPI is in slave mode after software reset.
PDC channels are not affected by software reset.
• LASTXFER: Last Transfer
0 = No effect.
1 = The current NPCS will be deasserted after the character written in TD has been transferred. When CSAAT is set, this
allows to close the communication with the current serial peripheral by raising the corresponding NPCS line as soon as TD
transfer has completed.
270
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28.7.2
Name:
SPI Mode Register
SPI_MR
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
27
26
19
18
25
24
17
16
DLYBCS
23
22
21
20
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
3
7
6
5
4
LLB
–
–
MODFDIS
PCS
2
1
0
PCSDEC
PS
MSTR
• MSTR: Master/Slave Mode
0 = SPI is in Slave mode.
1 = SPI is in Master mode.
• PS: Peripheral Select
0 = Fixed Peripheral Select.
1 = Variable Peripheral Select.
• PCSDEC: Chip Select Decode
0 = The chip selects are directly connected to a peripheral device.
1 = The four chip select lines are connected to a 4- to 16-bit decoder.
When PCSDEC equals one, up to 15 Chip Select signals can be generated with the four lines using an external 4- to 16-bit
decoder. The Chip Select Registers define the characteristics of the 15 chip selects according to the following rules:
SPI_CSR0 defines peripheral chip select signals 0 to 3.
SPI_CSR1 defines peripheral chip select signals 4 to 7.
SPI_CSR2 defines peripheral chip select signals 8 to 11.
SPI_CSR3 defines peripheral chip select signals 12 to 14.
• MODFDIS: Mode Fault Detection
0 = Mode fault detection is enabled.
1 = Mode fault detection is disabled.
• LLB: Local Loopback Enable
0 = Local loopback path disabled.
1 = Local loopback path enabled.
LLB controls the local loopback on the data serializer for testing in Master Mode only. (MISO is internally connected on
MOSI.)
• PCS: Peripheral Chip Select
This field is only used if Fixed Peripheral Select is active (PS = 0).
271
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
If PCSDEC = 0:
PCS = xxx0
NPCS[3:0] = 1110
PCS = xx01
NPCS[3:0] = 1101
PCS = x011
NPCS[3:0] = 1011
PCS = 0111
NPCS[3:0] = 0111
PCS = 1111
forbidden (no peripheral is selected)
(x = don’t care)
If PCSDEC = 1:
NPCS[3:0] output signals = PCS.
• DLYBCS: Delay Between Chip Selects
This field defines the delay from NPCS inactive to the activation of another NPCS. The DLYBCS time guarantees non-overlapping chip selects and solves bus contentions in case of peripherals having long data float times.
If DLYBCS is less than or equal to six, six MCK periods will be inserted by default.
Otherwise, the following equation determines the delay:
Delay Between Chip Selects = DLYBCS
------------------------MCK
272
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28.7.3
Name:
SPI Receive Data Register
SPI_RDR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
PCS
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RD
7
6
5
4
RD
• RD: Receive Data
Data received by the SPI Interface is stored in this register right-justified. Unused bits read zero.
• PCS: Peripheral Chip Select
In Master Mode only, these bits indicate the value on the NPCS pins at the end of a transfer. Otherwise, these bits read
zero.
273
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
28.7.4
Name:
SPI Transmit Data Register
SPI_TDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
LASTXFER
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
PCS
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
TD
7
6
5
4
TD
• TD: Transmit Data
Data to be transmitted by the SPI Interface is stored in this register. Information to be transmitted must be written to the
transmit data register in a right-justified format.
PCS: Peripheral Chip Select
This field is only used if Variable Peripheral Select is active (PS = 1).
If PCSDEC = 0:
PCS = xxx0
NPCS[3:0] = 1110
PCS = xx01
NPCS[3:0] = 1101
PCS = x011
NPCS[3:0] = 1011
PCS = 0111
NPCS[3:0] = 0111
PCS = 1111
forbidden (no peripheral is selected)
(x = don’t care)
If PCSDEC = 1:
NPCS[3:0] output signals = PCS
• LASTXFER: Last Transfer
0 = No effect.
1 = The current NPCS will be deasserted after the character written in TD has been transferred. When CSAAT is set, this
allows to close the communication with the current serial peripheral by raising the corresponding NPCS line as soon as TD
transfer has completed.
This field is only used if Variable Peripheral Select is active (PS = 1).
274
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28.7.5
Name:
SPI Status Register
SPI_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
SPIENS
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
TXEMPTY
NSSR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
OVRES
MODF
TDRE
RDRF
• RDRF: Receive Data Register Full
0 = No data has been received since the last read of SPI_RDR
1 = Data has been received and the received data has been transferred from the serializer to SPI_RDR since the last read
of SPI_RDR.
• TDRE: Transmit Data Register Empty
0 = Data has been written to SPI_TDR and not yet transferred to the serializer.
1 = The last data written in the Transmit Data Register has been transferred to the serializer.
TDRE equals zero when the SPI is disabled or at reset. The SPI enable command sets this bit to one.
• MODF: Mode Fault Error
0 = No Mode Fault has been detected since the last read of SPI_SR.
1 = A Mode Fault occurred since the last read of the SPI_SR.
• OVRES: Overrun Error Status
0 = No overrun has been detected since the last read of SPI_SR.
1 = An overrun has occurred since the last read of SPI_SR.
An overrun occurs when SPI_RDR is loaded at least twice from the serializer since the last read of the SPI_RDR.
• ENDRX: End of RX buffer
0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in SPI_RCR(1) or SPI_RNCR(1).
1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in SPI_RCR(1) or SPI_RNCR(1).
• ENDTX: End of TX buffer
0 = The Transmit Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in SPI_TCR(1) or SPI_TNCR(1).
1 = The Transmit Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in SPI_TCR(1) or SPI_TNCR(1).
• RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full
0 = SPI_RCR(1) or SPI_RNCR(1) has a value other than 0.
1 = Both SPI_RCR(1) and SPI_RNCR(1) have a value of 0.
275
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty
0 = SPI_TCR(1) or SPI_TNCR(1) has a value other than 0.
1 = Both SPI_TCR(1) and SPI_TNCR(1) have a value of 0.
• NSSR: NSS Rising
0 = No rising edge detected on NSS pin since last read.
1 = A rising edge occurred on NSS pin since last read.
• TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty
0 = As soon as data is written in SPI_TDR.
1 = SPI_TDR and internal shifter are empty. If a transfer delay has been defined, TXEMPTY is set after the completion of
such delay.
• SPIENS: SPI Enable Status
0 = SPI is disabled.
1 = SPI is enabled.
Note: 1.
276
SPI_RCR, SPI_RNCR, SPI_TCR, SPI_TNCR are physically located in the PDC.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28.7.6
Name:
SPI Interrupt Enable Register
SPI_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
TXEMPTY
NSSR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
OVRES
MODF
TDRE
RDRF
• RDRF: Receive Data Register Full Interrupt Enable
• TDRE: SPI Transmit Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable
• MODF: Mode Fault Error Interrupt Enable
• OVRES: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Enable
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable
• TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty Enable
• NSSR: NSS Rising Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
277
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
28.7.7
Name:
SPI Interrupt Disable Register
SPI_IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
TXEMPTY
NSSR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
OVRES
MODF
TDRE
RDRF
• RDRF: Receive Data Register Full Interrupt Disable
• TDRE: SPI Transmit Data Register Empty Interrupt Disable
• MODF: Mode Fault Error Interrupt Disable
• OVRES: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Disable
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable
• TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty Disable
• NSSR: NSS Rising Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
278
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
28.7.8
Name:
SPI Interrupt Mask Register
SPI_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
TXEMPTY
NSSR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
OVRES
MODF
TDRE
RDRF
• RDRF: Receive Data Register Full Interrupt Mask
• TDRE: SPI Transmit Data Register Empty Interrupt Mask
• MODF: Mode Fault Error Interrupt Mask
• OVRES: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Mask
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask
• TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty Mask
• NSSR: NSS Rising Interrupt Mask
0 = The corresponding interrupt is not enabled.
1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
279
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
28.7.9
Name:
SPI Chip Select Register
SPI_CSR0... SPI_CSR3
Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
DLYBCT
23
22
21
20
DLYBS
15
14
13
12
SCBR
7
6
5
4
BITS
3
2
1
0
CSAAT
–
NCPHA
CPOL
• CPOL: Clock Polarity
0 = The inactive state value of SPCK is logic level zero.
1 = The inactive state value of SPCK is logic level one.
CPOL is used to determine the inactive state value of the serial clock (SPCK). It is used with NCPHA to produce the
required clock/data relationship between master and slave devices.
• NCPHA: Clock Phase
0 = Data is changed on the leading edge of SPCK and captured on the following edge of SPCK.
1 = Data is captured on the leading edge of SPCK and changed on the following edge of SPCK.
NCPHA determines which edge of SPCK causes data to change and which edge causes data to be captured. NCPHA is
used with CPOL to produce the required clock/data relationship between master and slave devices.
• CSAAT: Chip Select Active After Transfer
0 = The Peripheral Chip Select Line rises as soon as the last transfer is achieved.
1 = The Peripheral Chip Select does not rise after the last transfer is achieved. It remains active until a new transfer is
requested on a different chip select.
280
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• BITS: Bits Per Transfer
The BITS field determines the number of data bits transferred. Reserved values should not be used.
BITS
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
Bits Per Transfer
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
• SCBR: Serial Clock Baud Rate
In Master Mode, the SPI Interface uses a modulus counter to derive the SPCK baud rate from the Master Clock MCK. The
Baud rate is selected by writing a value from 1 to 255 in the SCBR field. The following equations determine the SPCK baud
rate:
MCKSPCK Baudrate = ---------------SCBR
Programming the SCBR field at 0 is forbidden. Triggering a transfer while SCBR is at 0 can lead to unpredictable results.
At reset, SCBR is 0 and the user has to program it at a valid value before performing the first transfer.
• DLYBS: Delay Before SPCK
This field defines the delay from NPCS valid to the first valid SPCK transition.
When DLYBS equals zero, the NPCS valid to SPCK transition is 1/2 the SPCK clock period.
Otherwise, the following equations determine the delay:
Delay Before SPCK = DLYBS
--------------------MCK
281
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• DLYBCT: Delay Between Consecutive Transfers
This field defines the delay between two consecutive transfers with the same peripheral without removing the chip select.
The delay is always inserted after each transfer and before removing the chip select if needed.
When DLYBCT equals zero, no delay between consecutive transfers is inserted and the clock keeps its duty cycle over the
character transfers.
Otherwise, the following equation determines the delay:
32 × DLYBCT
Delay Between Consecutive Transfers = --------------------------------------MCK
282
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
29. Two-wire Interface (TWI)
29.1
Overview
The Two-wire Interface (TWI) interconnects components on a unique two-wire bus, made up of
one clock line and one data line with speeds of up to 400 Kbits per second, based on a byte-oriented transfer format. It can be used with any Atmel Two-wire Interface bus Serial EEPROM and
I²C compatible device such as Real Time Clock (RTC), Dot Matrix/Graphic LCD Controllers and
Temperature Sensor, to name but a few. The TWI is programmable as master transmitter or
master receiver with sequential or single-byte access. A configurable baud rate generator permits the output data rate to be adapted to a wide range of core clock frequencies. Below, Table
29-1 lists the compatibility level of the Atmel Two-wire Interface and a full I2C compatible device.
Table 29-1.
Atmel TWI compatibility with i2C Standard
I2C Standard
Atmel TWI
Standard Mode Speed (100 KHz)
Supported
Fast Mode Speed (400 KHz)
Supported
7 or 10 bits Slave Addressing
Supported
(1)
START BYTE
Not Supported
Repeated Start (Sr) Condition
Not Fully Supported(2)
ACK and NACK Management
Supported
Slope control and input filtering (Fast mode)
Not Supported
Clock stretching
Supported
Notes:
1. START + b000000001 + Ack + Sr
2. A repeated start condition is only supported in Master Receiver mode. See Section 29.6.5
“Internal Address” on page 288
29.2
List of Abbreviations
Table 29-2.
Abbreviations
Abbreviation
Description
TWI
Two-wire Interface
A
Acknowledge
NA
Non Acknowledge
P
Stop
S
Start
Sr
Repeated Start
SADR
Slave Address
ADR
Any address except SADR
R
Read
W
Write
283
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.3
Block Diagram
Figure 29-1. Block Diagram
APB Bridge
TWCK
PIO
PMC
MCK
TWD
Two-wire
Interface
TWI
Interrupt
29.4
AIC
Application Block Diagram
Figure 29-2. Application Block Diagram
VDD
Rp
Host with
TWI
Interface
Rp
TWD
TWCK
Atmel TWI
Serial EEPROM
Slave 1
I²C RTC
I²C LCD
Controller
I²C Temp.
Sensor
Slave 2
Slave 3
Slave 4
Rp: Pull up value as given by the I²C Standard
29.4.1
I/O Lines Description
Table 29-3.
29.5
29.5.1
I/O Lines Description
Pin Name
Pin Description
Type
TWD
Two-wire Serial Data
Input/Output
TWCK
Two-wire Serial Clock
Input/Output
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines
Both TWD and TWCK are bidirectional lines, connected to a positive supply voltage via a current
source or pull-up resistor (see Figure 29-2 on page 284). When the bus is free, both lines are
284
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
high. The output stages of devices connected to the bus must have an open-drain or open-collector to perform the wired-AND function.
TWD and TWCK pins may be multiplexed with PIO lines. To enable the TWI, the programmer
must perform the following step:
• Program the PIO controller to dedicate TWD and TWCK as peripheral lines.
The user must not program TWD and TWCK as open-drain. It is already done by the hardware.
29.5.2
Power Management
• Enable the peripheral clock.
The TWI interface may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), thus the
programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the TWI clock.
29.5.3
Interrupt
The TWI interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). In
order to handle interrupts, the AIC must be programmed before configuring the TWI.
29.6
29.6.1
Functional Description
Transfer format
The data put on the TWD line must be 8 bits long. Data is transferred MSB first; each byte must
be followed by an acknowledgement. The number of bytes per transfer is unlimited (see Figure
29-4 on page 285).
Each transfer begins with a START condition and terminates with a STOP condition (see Figure
29-3 on page 285).
• A high-to-low transition on the TWD line while TWCK is high defines the START condition.
• A low-to-high transition on the TWD line while TWCK is high defines a STOP condition.
Figure 29-3.
START and STOP Conditions
TWD
TWCK
Start
Stop
Figure 29-4. Transfer Format
TWD
TWCK
Start
29.6.2
285
Address R/W
Ack
Data
Ack
Data
Ack
Stop
Modes of Operation
The TWI has two modes of operation:
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• Master transmitter mode
• Master receiver mode
The TWI Control Register (TWI_CR) allows configuration of the interface in Master Mode. In this
mode, it generates the clock according to the value programmed in the Clock Waveform Generator Register (TWI_CWGR). This register defines the TWCK signal completely, enabling the
interface to be adapted to a wide range of clocks.
29.6.3
Master Transmitter Mode
After the master initiates a Start condition when writing into the Transmit Holding Register,
TWI_THR, it sends a 7-bit slave address, configured in the Master Mode register (DADR in
TWI_MMR), to notify the slave device. The bit following the slave address indicates the transfer
direction, 0 in this case (MREAD = 0 in TWI_MMR).
The TWI transfers require the slave to acknowledge each received byte. During the acknowledge clock pulse (9th pulse), the master releases the data line (HIGH), enabling the slave to pull
it down in order to generate the acknowledge. The master polls the data line during this clock
pulse and sets the Not Acknowledge bit (NACK) in the status register if the slave does not
acknowledge the byte. As with the other status bits, an interrupt can be generated if enabled in
the interrupt enable register (TWI_IER). If the slave acknowledges the byte, the data written in
the TWI_THR, is then shifted in the internal shifter and transferred. When an acknowledge is
detected, the TXRDY bit is set until a new write in the TWI_THR. When no more data is written
into the TWI_THR, the master generates a stop condition to end the transfer. The end of the
complete transfer is marked by the TWI_TXCOMP bit set to one. See Figure 29-5, Figure 29-6,
and Figure 29-7.
Figure 29-5. Master Write with One Data Byte
TWD
S
DADR
W
A
DATA
A
P
TXCOMP
TXRDY
STOP sent automaticaly
(ACK received and TXRDY = 1)
Write THR (DATA)
Figure 29-6. Master Write with Multiple Data Byte
TWD
S
DADR
W
A
DATA n
A
DATA n+5
A
DATA n+x
A
P
TXCOMP
TXRDY
Write THR (Data n)
286
Write THR (Data n+1)
Write THR (Data n+x)
Last data sent
STOP sent automaticaly
(ACK received and TXRDY = 1)
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 29-7. Master Write with One Byte Internal Address and Multiple Data Bytes
TWD S
DADR
W
A
IADR(7:0)
A
DATA n
A
DATA n+5
A
DATA n+x
A
P
TXCOMP
TXRDY
Write THR (Data n)
29.6.4
Write THR (Data n+1)
Write THR (Data n+x) STOP sent automaticaly
Last data sent (ACK received and TXRDY = 1)
Master Receiver Mode
The read sequence begins by setting the START bit. After the start condition has been sent, the
master sends a 7-bit slave address to notify the slave device. The bit following the slave address
indicates the transfer direction, 1 in this case (MREAD = 1 in TWI_MMR). During the acknowledge clock pulse (9th pulse), the master releases the data line (HIGH), enabling the slave to pull
it down in order to generate the acknowledge. The master polls the data line during this clock
pulse and sets the NACK bit in the status register if the slave does not acknowledge the byte.
If an acknowledge is received, the master is then ready to receive data from the slave. After data
has been received, the master sends an acknowledge condition to notify the slave that the data
has been received except for the last data, after the stop condition. See Figure 29-9. When the
RXRDY bit is set in the status register, a character has been received in the receive-holding register (TWI_RHR). The RXRDY bit is reset when reading the TWI_RHR.
When a single data byte read is performed, with or without internal address (IADR), the START
and STOP bits must be set at the same time. See Figure 29-8. When a multiple data byte read is
performed, with or without internal address (IADR), the STOP bit must be set after the next-tolast data received. See Figure 29-9. For Internal Address usage see Section 29.6.5.
Figure 29-8. Master Read with One Data Byte
TWD
S
DADR
R
A
DATA
N
P
TXCOMP
Write START &
STOP Bit
RXRDY
Read RHR
287
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 29-9. Master Read with Multiple Data Bytes
TWD
S
DADR
R
A
DATA n
A
DATA (n+1)
A
DATA (n+m)-1
A
DATA (n+m)
N
P
TXCOMP
Write START Bit
RXRDY
Read RHR
DATA n
Read RHR
DATA (n+1)
Read RHR
DATA (n+m)-1
Read RHR
DATA (n+m)
Write STOP Bit
after next-to-last data read
29.6.5
29.6.5.1
Internal Address
The TWI interface can perform various transfer formats: Transfers with 7-bit slave address
devices and 10-bit slave address devices.
7-bit Slave Addressing
When Addressing 7-bit slave devices, the internal address bytes are used to perform random
address (read or write) accesses to reach one or more data bytes, within a memory page location in a serial memory, for example. When performing read operations with an internal address,
the TWI performs a write operation to set the internal address into the slave device, and then
switch to Master Receiver mode. Note that the second start condition (after sending the IADR) is
sometimes called “repeated start” (Sr) in I2C fully-compatible devices. See Figure 29-10, Figure
29-11 and Figure 29-12.
The three internal address bytes are configurable through the Master Mode register
(TWI_MMR).
If the slave device supports only a 7-bit address, i.e. no internal address, IADRSZ must be set to
0.
In the figures below the following abbreviations are used:
288
•S
Start
•P
Stop
•W
Write
•R
Read
•A
Acknowledge
•N
Not Acknowledge
• DADR
Device Address
• IADR
Internal Address
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 29-10. Master Write with One, Two or Three Bytes Internal Address and One Data Byte
Three bytes internal address
S
TWD
DADR
W
A
IADR(23:16)
A
IADR(15:8)
A
IADR(7:0)
A
W
A
IADR(15:8)
A
IADR(7:0)
A
DATA
A
W
A
IADR(7:0)
A
DATA
A
DATA
A
P
Two bytes internal address
S
TWD
DADR
P
One byte internal address
S
TWD
DADR
P
Figure 29-11. Master Read with One, Two or Three Bytes Internal Address and One Data Byte
Three bytes internal address
S
TWD
DADR
W
A
IADR(23:16)
A
IADR(15:8)
A
IADR(7:0)
A
S
DADR
R
A
DATA
N
P
Two bytes internal address
S
TWD
DADR
W
A
IADR(15:8)
A
IADR(7:0)
A
IADR(7:0)
A
S
A
S
R
A
DADR
R
A
DATA
N
P
One byte internal address
TWD
29.6.5.2
S
DADR
W
DADR
DATA
N
P
10-bit Slave Addressing
For a slave address higher than 7 bits, the user must configure the address size (IADRSZ) and
set the other slave address bits in the internal address register (TWI_IADR). The two remaining
Internal address bytes, IADR[15:8] and IADR[23:16] can be used the same as in 7-bit Slave
Addressing.
Example: Address a 10-bit device (10-bit device address is b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 b8 b9 b10)
1. Program IADRSZ = 1,
2. Program DADR with 1 1 1 1 0 b1 b2 (b1 is the MSB of the 10-bit address, b2, etc.)
3. Program TWI_IADR with b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 b8 b9 b10 (b10 is the LSB of the 10-bit
address)
Figure 29-12 below shows a byte write to an Atmel AT24LC512 EEPROM. This demonstrates
the use of internal addresses to access the device.
Figure 29-12. Internal Address Usage
S
T
A
R
T
Device
Address
W
R
I
T
E
FIRST
WORD ADDRESS
SECOND
WORD ADDRESS
S
T
O
P
DATA
0
M
S
B
289
L R A
S / C
BW K
M
S
B
A
C
K
L A
SC
BK
A
C
K
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.6.6
Read/Write Flowcharts
The following flowcharts shown in Figure 29-13, Figure 29-14 on page 291, Figure 29-15 on
page 292, Figure 29-16 on page 293, Figure 29-17 on page 294 and Figure 29-18 on page 295
give examples for read and write operations. A polling or interrupt method can be used to check
the status bits. The interrupt method requires that the interrupt enable register (TWI_IER) be
configured first.
Figure 29-13. TWI Write Operation with Single Data Byte without Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock
(CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR
(Needed only once)
Set the Control register:
- Master enable
TWI_CR = MSEN
Set the Master Mode register:
- Device slave address (DADR)
- Transfer direction bit
Write ==> bit MREAD = 0
Load Transmit register
TWI_THR = Data to send
Read Status register
No
TXRDY = 1?
Yes
Read Status register
No
TXCOMP = 1?
Yes
Transfer finished
290
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 29-14. TWI Write Operation with Single Data Byte and Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock
(CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR
(Needed only once)
Set the Control register:
- Master enable
TWI_CR = MSEN
Set the Master Mode register:
- Device slave address (DADR)
- Internal address size (IADRSZ)
- Transfer direction bit
Write ==> bit MREAD = 0
Set the internal address
TWI_IADR = address
Load transmit register
TWI_THR = Data to send
Read Status register
No
TXRDY = 1?
Yes
Read Status register
TXCOMP = 1?
No
Yes
Transfer finished
291
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 29-15. TWI Write Operation with Multiple Data Bytes with or without Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock
(CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR
(Needed only once)
Set the Control register:
- Master enable
TWI_CR = MSEN
Set the Master Mode register:
- Device slave address
- Internal address size (if IADR used)
- Transfer direction bit
Write ==> bit MREAD = 0
No
Internal address size = 0?
Set the internal address
TWI_IADR = address
Yes
Load Transmit register
TWI_THR = Data to send
Read Status register
TWI_THR = data to send
No
TXRDY = 1?
Yes
Data to send?
Yes
Read Status register
Yes
No
TXCOMP = 1?
END
292
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 29-16. TWI Read Operation with Single Data Byte without Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock
(CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR
(Needed only once)
Set the Control register:
- Master enable
TWI_CR = MSEN
Set the Master Mode register:
- Device slave address
- Transfer direction bit
Read ==> bit MREAD = 1
Start the transfer
TWI_CR = START | STOP
Read status register
RXRDY = 1?
No
Yes
Read Receive Holding Register
Read Status register
No
TXCOMP = 1?
Yes
END
293
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 29-17. TWI Read Operation with Single Data Byte and Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock
(CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR
(Needed only once)
Set the Control register:
- Master enable
TWI_CR = MSEN
Set the Master Mode register:
- Device slave address
- Internal address size (IADRSZ)
- Transfer direction bit
Read ==> bit MREAD = 1
Set the internal address
TWI_IADR = address
Start the transfer
TWI_CR = START | STOP
Read Status register
No
RXRDY = 1?
Yes
Read Receive Holding register
Read Status register
No
TXCOMP = 1?
Yes
END
294
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 29-18. TWI Read Operation with Multiple Data Bytes with or without Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock
(CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR
(Needed only once)
Set the Control register:
- Master enable
TWI_CR = MSEN
Set the Master Mode register:
- Device slave address
- Internal address size (if IADR used)
- Transfer direction bit
Read ==> bit MREAD = 1
Internal address size = 0?
Set the internal address
TWI_IADR = address
Yes
Start the transfer
TWI_CR = START
Read Status register
RXRDY = 1?
No
Yes
Read Receive Holding register (TWI_RHR)
No
Last data to read
but one?
Yes
Stop the transfer
TWI_CR = STOP
Read Status register
No
RXRDY = 1?
Yes
Read Receive Holding register (TWI_RHR)
Read status register
TXCOMP = 1?
No
Yes
END
295
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7
Two-wire Interface (TWI) User Interface
Table 29-4.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x0000
Control Register
TWI_CR
Write-only
N/A
0x0004
Master Mode Register
TWI_MMR
Read-write
0x0000
0x0008
Reserved
-
-
-
0x000C
Internal Address Register
TWI_IADR
Read-write
0x0000
0x0010
Clock Waveform Generator Register
TWI_CWGR
Read-write
0x0000
0x0020
Status Register
TWI_SR
Read-only
0x0008
0x0024
Interrupt Enable Register
TWI_IER
Write-only
N/A
0x0028
Interrupt Disable Register
TWI_IDR
Write-only
N/A
0x002C
Interrupt Mask Register
TWI_IMR
Read-only
0x0000
0x0030
Receive Holding Register
TWI_RHR
Read-only
0x0000
0x0034
Transmit Holding Register
TWI_THR
Read-write
0x0000
–
–
–
0x0038 - 0x00FC
296
Reserved
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7.1
TWI Control Register
Register Name:TWI_CR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
SWRST
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
MSDIS
2
MSEN
1
STOP
0
START
• START: Send a START Condition
0 = No effect.
1 = A frame beginning with a START bit is transmitted according to the features defined in the mode register.
This action is necessary when the TWI peripheral wants to read data from a slave. When configured in Master Mode with a
write operation, a frame is sent as soon as the user writes a character in the Transmit Holding Register (TWI_THR).
• STOP: Send a STOP Condition
0 = No effect.
1 = STOP Condition is sent just after completing the current byte transmission in master read mode.
– In single data byte master read, the START and STOP must both be set.
– In multiple data bytes master read, the STOP must be set after the last data received but one.
– In master read mode, if a NACK bit is received, the STOP is automatically performed.
– In multiple data write operation, when both THR and shift register are empty, a STOP condition is automatically
sent.
• MSEN: TWI Master Transfer Enabled
0 = No effect.
1 = If MSDIS = 0, the master data transfer is enabled.
• MSDIS: TWI Master Transfer Disabled
0 = No effect.
1 = The master data transfer is disabled, all pending data is transmitted. The shifter and holding characters (if they contain
data) are transmitted in case of write operation. In read operation, the character being transferred must be completely
received before disabling.
• SWRST: Software Reset
0 = No effect.
1 = Equivalent to a system reset.
297
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7.2
TWI Master Mode Register
Register Name:TWI_MMR
Address Type: Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
21
20
19
DADR
18
17
16
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
MREAD
11
–
10
–
9
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
8
IADRSZ
0
–
• IADRSZ: Internal Device Address Size
Table 29-5.
IADRSZ[9:8]
0
0
No internal device address (Byte command protocol)
0
1
One-byte internal device address
1
0
Two-byte internal device address
1
1
Three-byte internal device address
• MREAD: Master Read Direction
0 = Master write direction.
1 = Master read direction.
• DADR: Device Address
The device address is used to access slave devices in read or write mode.
298
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7.3
TWI Internal Address Register
Register Name:TWI_IADR
Access Type: Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
23
22
21
20
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
IADR
15
14
13
12
IADR
7
6
5
4
IADR
• IADR: Internal Address
0, 1, 2 or 3 bytes depending on IADRSZ.
– Low significant byte address in 10-bit mode addresses.
299
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7.4
TWI Clock Waveform Generator Register
Register Name:TWI_CWGR
Access Type: Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
17
CKDIV
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CHDIV
7
6
5
4
CLDIV
• CLDIV: Clock Low Divider
The SCL low period is defined as follows:
T low = ( ( CLDIV × 2
CKDIV
) + 3 ) × T MCK
• CHDIV: Clock High Divider
The SCL high period is defined as follows:
T high = ( ( CHDIV × 2
CKDIV
) + 3 ) × T MCK
• CKDIV: Clock Divider
The CKDIV is used to increase both SCL high and low periods.
300
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7.5
TWI Status Register
Register Name:TWI_SR
Access Type: Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
NACK
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
TXRDY
1
RXRDY
0
TXCOMP
• TXCOMP: Transmission Completed
0 = During the length of the current frame.
1 = When both holding and shift registers are empty and STOP condition has been sent, or when MSEN is set (enable
TWI).
• RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready
0 = No character has been received since the last TWI_RHR read operation.
1 = A byte has been received in the TWI_RHR since the last read.
• TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready
0 = The transmit holding register has not been transferred into shift register. Set to 0 when writing into TWI_THR register.
1 = As soon as data byte is transferred from TWI_THR to internal shifter or if a NACK error is detected, TXRDY is set at the
same time as TXCOMP and NACK. TXRDY is also set when MSEN is set (enable TWI).
• NACK: Not Acknowledged
0 = Each data byte has been correctly received by the far-end side TWI slave component.
1 = A data byte has not been acknowledged by the slave component. Set at the same time as TXCOMP. Reset after read.
301
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7.6
TWI Interrupt Enable Register
Register Name:TWI_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
NACK
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
TXRDY
1
RXRDY
0
TXCOMP
• TXCOMP: Transmission Completed
• RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready
• TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready
• NACK: Not Acknowledge
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
29.7.7
TWI Interrupt Disable Register
Register Name:TWI_IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
NACK
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
TXRDY
1
RXRDY
0
TXCOMP
• TXCOMP: Transmission Completed
• RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready
• TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready
• NACK: Not Acknowledge
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
302
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7.8
TWI Interrupt Mask Register
Register Name:TWI_IMR
Access Type: Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
NACK
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
TXRDY
1
RXRDY
0
TXCOMP
• TXCOMP: Transmission Completed
• RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready
• TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready
• NACK: Not Acknowledge
0 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled.
1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
29.7.9
TWI Receive Holding Register
Register Name:TWI_RHR
Access Type: Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RXDATA
• RXDATA: Receive Holding Data
303
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7.10 TWI Transmit Holding Register
Register Name: TWI_THR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TXDATA
• TXDATA: Transmit Holding Data
304
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30. Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC)
30.1
Overview
The Atmel Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) provides a synchronous communication link
with external devices. It supports many serial synchronous communication protocols generally
used in audio and telecom applications such as I2S, Short Frame Sync, Long Frame Sync, etc.
The SSC contains an independent receiver and transmitter and a common clock divider. The
receiver and the transmitter each interface with three signals: the TD/RD signal for data, the
TK/RK signal for the clock and the TF/RF signal for the Frame Sync. The transfers can be programmed to start automatically or on different events detected on the Frame Sync signal.
The SSC’s high-level of programmability and its two dedicated PDC channels of up to 32 bits
permit a continuous high bit rate data transfer without processor intervention.
Featuring connection to two PDC channels, the SSC permits interfacing with low processor
overhead to the following:
• CODEC’s in master or slave mode
• DAC through dedicated serial interface, particularly I2S
• Magnetic card reader
305
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
30.2
Block Diagram
Figure 30-1. Block Diagram
ASB
APB Bridge
PDC
APB
TF
TK
PMC
TD
MCK
PIO
SSC Interface
RF
RK
Interrupt Control
RD
SSC Interrupt
30.3
Application Block Diagram
Figure 30-2. Application Block Diagram
OS or RTOS Driver
Power
Management
Interrupt
Management
Test
Management
SSC
Serial AUDIO
306
Codec
Time Slot
Management
Frame
Management
Line Interface
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.4
Pin Name List
Table 30-1.
I/O Lines Description
Pin Name
Pin Description
RF
Receiver Frame Synchro
Input/Output
RK
Receiver Clock
Input/Output
RD
Receiver Data
Input
TF
Transmitter Frame Synchro
Input/Output
TK
Transmitter Clock
Input/Output
TD
Transmitter Data
Output
30.5
30.5.1
Type
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines
The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines.
Before using the SSC receiver, the PIO controller must be configured to dedicate the SSC
receiver I/O lines to the SSC peripheral mode.
Before using the SSC transmitter, the PIO controller must be configured to dedicate the SSC
transmitter I/O lines to the SSC peripheral mode.
30.5.2
Power Management
The SSC is not continuously clocked. The SSC interface may be clocked through the Power
Management Controller (PMC), therefore the programmer must first configure the PMC to
enable the SSC clock.
30.5.3
Interrupt
The SSC interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC).
Handling interrupts requires programming the AIC before configuring the SSC.
All SSC interrupts can be enabled/disabled configuring the SSC Interrupt mask register. Each
pending and unmasked SSC interrupt will assert the SSC interrupt line. The SSC interrupt service routine can get the interrupt origin by reading the SSC interrupt status register.
30.6
Functional Description
This chapter contains the functional description of the following: SSC Functional Block, Clock
Management, Data format, Start, Transmitter, Receiver and Frame Sync.
The receiver and transmitter operate separately. However, they can work synchronously by programming the receiver to use the transmit clock and/or to start a data transfer when transmission
starts. Alternatively, this can be done by programming the transmitter to use the receive clock
and/or to start a data transfer when reception starts. The transmitter and the receiver can be programmed to operate with the clock signals provided on either the TK or RK pins. This allows the
SSC to support many slave-mode data transfers. The maximum clock speed allowed on the TK
and RK pins is the master clock divided by 2.
307
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 30-3. SSC Functional Block Diagram
Transmitter
MCK
TK Input
Clock
Divider
Transmit Clock
Controller
RX clock
TF
RF
Start
Selector
TX clock
Clock Output
Controller
TK
Frame Sync
Controller
TF
Transmit Shift Register
TX PDC
APB
Transmit Holding
Register
TD
Transmit Sync
Holding Register
Load Shift
User
Interface
Receiver
RK Input
Receive Clock RX Clock
Controller
TX Clock
RF
TF
Start
Selector
Interrupt Control
RK
Frame Sync
Controller
RF
RD
Receive Shift Register
RX PDC
PDC
Clock Output
Controller
Receive Holding
Register
Receive Sync
Holding Register
Load Shift
AIC
30.6.1
Clock Management
The transmitter clock can be generated by:
• an external clock received on the TK I/O pad
• the receiver clock
• the internal clock divider
The receiver clock can be generated by:
• an external clock received on the RK I/O pad
• the transmitter clock
• the internal clock divider
Furthermore, the transmitter block can generate an external clock on the TK I/O pad, and the
receiver block can generate an external clock on the RK I/O pad.
This allows the SSC to support many Master and Slave Mode data transfers.
308
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.6.1.1
Clock Divider
Figure 30-4. Divided Clock Block Diagram
Clock Divider
SSC_CMR
MCK
/2
12-bit Counter
Divided Clock
The Master Clock divider is determined by the 12-bit field DIV counter and comparator (so its
maximal value is 4095) in the Clock Mode Register SSC_CMR, allowing a Master Clock division
by up to 8190. The Divided Clock is provided to both the Receiver and Transmitter. When this
field is programmed to 0, the Clock Divider is not used and remains inactive.
When DIV is set to a value equal to or greater than 1, the Divided Clock has a frequency of Master Clock divided by 2 times DIV. Each level of the Divided Clock has a duration of the Master
Clock multiplied by DIV. This ensures a 50% duty cycle for the Divided Clock regardless of
whether the DIV value is even or odd.
Figure 30-5.
Divided Clock Generation
Master Clock
Divided Clock
DIV = 1
Divided Clock Frequency = MCK/2
Master Clock
Divided Clock
DIV = 3
Divided Clock Frequency = MCK/6
Table 30-2.
30.6.1.2
Maximum
Minimum
MCK / 2
MCK / 8190
Transmitter Clock Management
The transmitter clock is generated from the receiver clock or the divider clock or an external
clock scanned on the TK I/O pad. The transmitter clock is selected by the CKS field in
SSC_TCMR (Transmit Clock Mode Register). Transmit Clock can be inverted independently by
the CKI bits in SSC_TCMR.
The transmitter can also drive the TK I/O pad continuously or be limited to the actual data transfer. The clock output is configured by the SSC_TCMR register. The Transmit Clock Inversion
(CKI) bits have no effect on the clock outputs. Programming the TCMR register to select TK pin
309
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
(CKS field) and at the same time Continuous Transmit Clock (CKO field) might lead to unpredictable results.
Figure 30-6. Transmitter Clock Management
SSC_TCMR.CKS
SSC_TCMR.CKO
TK
Receiver Clock
TK
Divider Clock
0
Transmitter Clock
1
SSC_TCMR.CKI
30.6.1.3
Receiver Clock Management
The receiver clock is generated from the transmitter clock or the divider clock or an external
clock scanned on the RK I/O pad. The Receive Clock is selected by the CKS field in
SSC_RCMR (Receive Clock Mode Register). Receive Clocks can be inverted independently by
the CKI bits in SSC_RCMR.
The receiver can also drive the RK I/O pad continuously or be limited to the actual data transfer.
The clock output is configured by the SSC_RCMR register. The Receive Clock Inversion (CKI)
bits have no effect on the clock outputs. Programming the RCMR register to select RK pin (CKS
field) and at the same time Continuous Receive Clock (CKO field) can lead to unpredictable
results.
Figure 30-7. Receiver Clock Management
SSC_RCMR.CKO
SSC_RCMR.CKS
RK
Transmitter Clock
RK
Divider Clock
0
Receiver Clock
1
SSC_RCMR.CKI
30.6.1.4
Serial Clock Ratio Considerations
The Transmitter and the Receiver can be programmed to operate with the clock signals provided
on either the TK or RK pins. This allows the SSC to support many slave-mode data transfers. In
this case, the maximum clock speed allowed on the RK pin is:
– Master Clock divided by 2 if Receiver Frame Synchro is input
– Master Clock divided by 3 if Receiver Frame Synchro is output
In addition, the maximum clock speed allowed on the TK pin is:
– Master Clock divided by 6 if Transmit Frame Synchro is input
– Master Clock divided by 2 if Transmit Frame Synchro is output
310
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.6.2
Transmitter Operations
A transmitted frame is triggered by a start event and can be followed by synchronization data
before data transmission.
The start event is configured by setting the Transmit Clock Mode Register (SSC_TCMR). See
“Start” on page 312.
The frame synchronization is configured setting the Transmit Frame Mode Register
(SSC_TFMR). See “Frame Sync” on page 314.
To transmit data, the transmitter uses a shift register clocked by the transmitter clock signal and
the start mode selected in the SSC_TCMR. Data is written by the application to the SSC_THR
register then transferred to the shift register according to the data format selected.
When both the SSC_THR and the transmit shift register are empty, the status flag TXEMPTY is
set in SSC_SR. When the Transmit Holding register is transferred in the Transmit shift register,
the status flag TXRDY is set in SSC_SR and additional data can be loaded in the holding
register.
Figure 30-8. Transmitter Block Diagram
SSC_CR.TXEN
SSC_SR.TXEN
SSC_CR.TXDIS
SSC_TFMR.DATDEF
1
RF
Transmitter Clock
TF
Start
Selector
30.6.3
TD
0
SSC_TFMR.MSBF
Transmit Shift Register
SSC_TFMR.FSDEN
SSC_TCMR.STTDLY
SSC_TFMR.DATLEN
SSC_TCMR.STTDLY
SSC_TFMR.FSDEN
SSC_TFMR.DATNB
0
SSC_THR
1
SSC_TSHR
SSC_TFMR.FSLEN
Receiver Operations
A received frame is triggered by a start event and can be followed by synchronization data
before data transmission.
The start event is configured setting the Receive Clock Mode Register (SSC_RCMR). See
“Start” on page 312.
The frame synchronization is configured setting the Receive Frame Mode Register
(SSC_RFMR). See “Frame Sync” on page 314.
The receiver uses a shift register clocked by the receiver clock signal and the start mode
selected in the SSC_RCMR. The data is transferred from the shift register depending on the
data format selected.
311
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
When the receiver shift register is full, the SSC transfers this data in the holding register, the status flag RXRDY is set in SSC_SR and the data can be read in the receiver holding register. If
another transfer occurs before read of the RHR register, the status flag OVERUN is set in
SSC_SR and the receiver shift register is transferred in the RHR register.
Figure 30-9. Receiver Block Diagram
SSC_CR.RXEN
SSC_SR.RXEN
SSC_CR.RXDIS
RF
Receiver Clock
TF
Start
Selector
SSC_RFMR.MSBF
SSC_RFMR.DATNB
Receive Shift Register
SSC_RSHR
SSC_RHR
SSC_RFMR.FSLEN
SSC_RFMR.DATLEN
RD
SSC_RCMR.STTDLY
30.6.4
Start
The transmitter and receiver can both be programmed to start their operations when an event
occurs, respectively in the Transmit Start Selection (START) field of SSC_TCMR and in the
Receive Start Selection (START) field of SSC_RCMR.
Under the following conditions the start event is independently programmable:
• Continuous. In this case, the transmission starts as soon as a word is written in SSC_THR
and the reception starts as soon as the Receiver is enabled.
• Synchronously with the transmitter/receiver
• On detection of a falling/rising edge on TF/RF
• On detection of a low level/high level on TF/RF
• On detection of a level change or an edge on TF/RF
A start can be programmed in the same manner on either side of the Transmit/Receive Clock
Register (RCMR/TCMR). Thus, the start could be on TF (Transmit) or RF (Receive).
Moreover, the Receiver can start when data is detected in the bit stream with the Compare
Functions.
Detection on TF/RF input/output is done by the field FSOS of the Transmit/Receive Frame Mode
Register (TFMR/RFMR).
312
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 30-10. Transmit Start Mode
TK
TF
(Input)
Start = Low Level on TF
Start = Falling Edge on TF
Start = High Level on TF
Start = Rising Edge on TF
Start = Level Change on TF
Start = Any Edge on TF
TD
(Output)
TD
(Output)
X
BO
STTDLY
BO
X
B1
STTDLY
BO
X
TD
(Output)
B1
STTDLY
TD
(Output)
BO
X
B1
STTDLY
TD
(Output)
TD
(Output)
B1
BO
X
B1
BO
B1
STTDLY
X
B1
BO
BO
B1
STTDLY
Figure 30-11. Receive Pulse/Edge Start Modes
RK
RF
(Input)
Start = Low Level on RF
Start = Falling Edge on RF
Start = High Level on RF
Start = Rising Edge on RF
Start = Level Change on RF
Start = Any Edge on RF
RD
(Input)
RD
(Input)
X
BO
STTDLY
BO
X
B1
STTDLY
BO
X
RD
(Input)
B1
STTDLY
RD
(Input)
BO
X
B1
STTDLY
RD
(Input)
RD
(Input)
B1
BO
X
B1
BO
B1
STTDLY
X
BO
B1
BO
B1
STTDLY
313
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
30.6.5
Frame Sync
The Transmitter and Receiver Frame Sync pins, TF and RF, can be programmed to generate
different kinds of frame synchronization signals. The Frame Sync Output Selection (FSOS) field
in the Receive Frame Mode Register (SSC_RFMR) and in the Transmit Frame Mode Register
(SSC_TFMR) are used to select the required waveform.
• Programmable low or high levels during data transfer are supported.
• Programmable high levels before the start of data transfers or toggling are also supported.
If a pulse waveform is selected, the Frame Sync Length (FSLEN) field in SSC_RFMR and
SSC_TFMR programs the length of the pulse, from 1 bit time up to 16 bit time.
The periodicity of the Receive and Transmit Frame Sync pulse output can be programmed
through the Period Divider Selection (PERIOD) field in SSC_RCMR and SSC_TCMR.
30.6.5.1
Frame Sync Data
Frame Sync Data transmits or receives a specific tag during the Frame Sync signal.
During the Frame Sync signal, the Receiver can sample the RD line and store the data in the
Receive Sync Holding Register and the transmitter can transfer Transmit Sync Holding Register
in the Shifter Register. The data length to be sampled/shifted out during the Frame Sync signal
is programmed by the FSLEN field in SSC_RFMR/SSC_TFMR and has a maximum value of 16.
Concerning the Receive Frame Sync Data operation, if the Frame Sync Length is equal to or
lower than the delay between the start event and the actual data reception, the data sampling
operation is performed in the Receive Sync Holding Register through the Receive Shift Register.
The Transmit Frame Sync Operation is performed by the transmitter only if the bit Frame Sync
Data Enable (FSDEN) in SSC_TFMR is set. If the Frame Sync length is equal to or lower than
the delay between the start event and the actual data transmission, the normal transmission has
priority and the data contained in the Transmit Sync Holding Register is transferred in the Transmit Register, then shifted out.
30.6.5.2
30.6.6
Frame Sync Edge Detection
The Frame Sync Edge detection is programmed by the FSEDGE field in
SSC_RFMR/SSC_TFMR. This sets the corresponding flags RXSYN/TXSYN in the SSC Status
Register (SSC_SR) on frame synchro edge detection (signals RF/TF).
Receive Compare Modes
Figure 30-12. Receive Compare Modes
RK
RD
(Input)
CMP0
CMP1
CMP2
CMP3
Ignored
B0
B1
B2
Start
FSLEN
Up to 16 Bits
(4 in This Example)
314
STDLY
DATLEN
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.6.6.1
30.6.7
Compare Functions
Length of the comparison patterns (Compare 0, Compare 1) and thus the number of bits they
are compared to is defined by FSLEN, but with a maximum value of 16 bits. Comparison is
always done by comparing the last bits received with the comparison pattern. Compare 0 can be
one start event of the Receiver. In this case, the receiver compares at each new sample the last
bits received at the Compare 0 pattern contained in the Compare 0 Register (SSC_RC0R).
When this start event is selected, the user can program the Receiver to start a new data transfer
either by writing a new Compare 0, or by receiving continuously until Compare 1 occurs. This
selectio is done with the bit (STOP) in SSC_RCMR.
Data Format
The data framing format of both the transmitter and the receiver are programmable through the
Transmitter Frame Mode Register (SSC_TFMR) and the Receiver Frame Mode Register
(SSC_RFMR). In either case, the user can independently select:
• the event that starts the data transfer (START)
• the delay in number of bit periods between the start event and the first data bit (STTDLY)
• the length of the data (DATLEN)
• the number of data to be transferred for each start event (DATNB).
• the length of synchronization transferred for each start event (FSLEN)
• the bit sense: most or lowest significant bit first (MSBF).
Additionally, the transmitter can be used to transfer synchronization and select the level driven
on the TD pin while not in data transfer operation. This is done respectively by the Frame Sync
Data Enable (FSDEN) and by the Data Default Value (DATDEF) bits in SSC_TFMR.
315
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Table 30-3.
Data Frame Registers
Transmitter
Receiver
Field
Length
Comment
SSC_TFMR
SSC_RFMR
DATLEN
Up to 32
Size of word
SSC_TFMR
SSC_RFMR
DATNB
Up to 16
Number of words transmitted in frame
SSC_TFMR
SSC_RFMR
MSBF
SSC_TFMR
SSC_RFMR
FSLEN
Up to 16
Size of Synchro data register
SSC_TFMR
DATDEF
0 or 1
Data default value ended
SSC_TFMR
FSDEN
Most significant bit first
Enable send SSC_TSHR
SSC_TCMR
SSC_RCMR
PERIOD
Up to 512
Frame size
SSC_TCMR
SSC_RCMR
STTDLY
Up to 255
Size of transmit start delay
Figure 30-13. Transmit and Receive Frame Format in Edge/Pulse Start Modes
Start
Start
PERIOD
TF/RF
(1)
FSLEN
TD
(If FSDEN = 1)
TD
(If FSDEN = 0)
RD
Sync Data
Data
Data
From SSC_THR
From SSC_THR
Default
From SSC_TSHR FromDATDEF
Default
Sync Data
Ignored
To SSC_RSHR
STTDLY
From SSC_THR
Data
Data
To SSC_RHR
To SSC_RHR
DATLEN
DATLEN
Sync Data
FromDATDEF
Data
Data
From SSC_THR
From DATDEF
Default
Default
From DATDEF
Ignored
Sync Data
DATNB
Note:
1. Example of input on falling edge of TF/RF.
Figure 30-14. Transmit Frame Format in Continuous Mode
Start
TD
Data
From SSC_THR
Data
Default
From SSC_THR
DATLEN
DATLEN
Start: 1. TXEMPTY set to 1
2. Write into the SSC_THR
316
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Note:
1. STTDLY is set to 0. In this example, SSC_THR is loaded twice. FSDEN value has no effect on
the transmission. SyncData cannot be output in continuous mode.
Figure 30-15. Receive Frame Format in Continuous Mode
Start = Enable Receiver
Data
Data
To SSC_RHR
To SSC_RHR
DATLEN
DATLEN
RD
Note:
30.6.8
1. STTDLY is set to 0.
Loop Mode
The receiver can be programmed to receive transmissions from the transmitter. This is done by
setting the Loop Mode (LOOP) bit in SSC_RFMR. In this case, RD is connected to TD, RF is
connected to TF and RK is connected to TK.
30.6.9
Interrupt
Most bits in SSC_SR have a corresponding bit in interrupt management registers.
The SSC can be programmed to generate an interrupt when it detects an event. The interrupt is
controlled by writing SSC_IER (Interrupt Enable Register) and SSC_IDR (Interrupt Disable Register) These registers enable and disable, respectively, the corresponding interrupt by setting
and clearing the corresponding bit in SSC_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register), which controls the
generation of interrupts by asserting the SSC interrupt line connected to the AIC.
Figure 30-16. Interrupt Block Diagram
SSC_IMR
SSC_IER
PDC
SSC_IDR
Set
Clear
TXBUFE
ENDTX
Transmitter
TXRDY
TXEMPTY
TXSYNC
Interrupt
Control
RXBUFF
ENDRX
SSC Interrupt
Receiver
RXRDY
OVRUN
RXSYNC
317
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
30.7
SSC Application Examples
The SSC can support several serial communication modes used in audio or high speed serial
links. Some standard applications are shown in the following figures. All serial link applications
supported by the SSC are not listed here.
Figure 30-17. Audio Application Block Diagram
Clock SCK
TK
Word Select WS
I2S
RECEIVER
TF
Data SD
SSC
TD
RD
Clock SCK
RF
Word Select WS
RK
MSB
Data SD
LSB
MSB
Right Channel
Left Channel
Figure 30-18. Codec Application Block Diagram
Serial Data Clock (SCLK)
TK
Frame sync (FSYNC)
TF
Serial Data Out
SSC
CODEC
TD
Serial Data In
RD
RF
RK
Serial Data Clock (SCLK)
Frame sync (FSYNC)
First Time Slot
Dstart
Dend
Serial Data Out
Serial Data In
318
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 30-19. Time Slot Application Block Diagram
SCLK
TK
FSYNC
TF
CODEC
First
Time Slot
Data Out
TD
SSC
RD
Data in
RF
RK
CODEC
Second
Time Slot
Serial Data Clock (SCLK)
Frame sync (FSYNC)
First Time Slot
Dstart
Second Time Slot
Dend
Serial Data Out
Serial Data in
319
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8
Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) User Interface
Table 30-4.
Offset
Register Mapping
Register
Name
Access
Reset
SSC_CR
Write
–
SSC_CMR
Read-write
0x0
0x0
Control Register
0x4
Clock Mode Register
0x8
Reserved
–
–
–
0xC
Reserved
–
–
–
0x10
Receive Clock Mode Register
SSC_RCMR
Read-write
0x0
0x14
Receive Frame Mode Register
SSC_RFMR
Read-write
0x0
0x18
Transmit Clock Mode Register
SSC_TCMR
Read-write
0x0
0x1C
Transmit Frame Mode Register
SSC_TFMR
Read-write
0x0
0x20
Receive Holding Register
SSC_RHR
Read
0x0
0x24
Transmit Holding Register
SSC_THR
Write
–
0x28
Reserved
–
–
–
0x2C
Reserved
–
–
–
0x30
Receive Sync. Holding Register
SSC_RSHR
Read
0x0
0x34
Transmit Sync. Holding Register
SSC_TSHR
Read-write
0x0
0x38
Receive Compare 0 Register
SSC_RC0R
Read-write
0x0
0x3C
Receive Compare 1 Register
SSC_RC1R
Read-write
0x0
0x40
Status Register
SSC_SR
Read
0x000000CC
0x44
Interrupt Enable Register
SSC_IER
Write
–
0x48
Interrupt Disable Register
SSC_IDR
Write
–
0x4C
Interrupt Mask Register
SSC_IMR
Read
0x0
Reserved
–
–
–
Reserved for Peripheral Data Controller (PDC)
–
–
–
0x50-0xFC
0x100- 0x124
320
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.1
Name:
SSC Control Register
SSC_CR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
SWRST
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
TXDIS
8
TXEN
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
RXDIS
0
RXEN
• RXEN: Receive Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables Receive if RXDIS is not set.
• RXDIS: Receive Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables Receive. If a character is currently being received, disables at end of current character reception.
• TXEN: Transmit Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables Transmit if TXDIS is not set.
• TXDIS: Transmit Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables Transmit. If a character is currently being transmitted, disables at end of current character transmission.
• SWRST: Software Reset
0: No effect.
1: Performs a software reset. Has priority on any other bit in SSC_CR.
321
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.2
Name:
SSC Clock Mode Register
SSC_CMR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
1
0
DIV
3
2
DIV
• DIV: Clock Divider
0: The Clock Divider is not active.
Any Other Value: The Divided Clock equals the Master Clock divided by 2 times DIV. The maximum bit rate is MCK/2. The
minimum bit rate is MCK/2 x 4095 = MCK/8190.
322
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.3
Name:
SSC Receive Clock Mode Register
SSC_RCMR
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
10
9
8
PERIOD
23
22
21
20
STTDLY
15
–
7
14
–
13
–
12
STOP
11
6
5
CKI
4
3
CKO
CKG
START
2
1
0
CKS
• CKS: Receive Clock Selection
CKS
Selected Receive Clock
0x0
Divided Clock
0x1
TK Clock signal
0x2
RK pin
0x3
Reserved
• CKO: Receive Clock Output Mode Selection
CKO
Receive Clock Output Mode
0x0
None
0x1
Continuous Receive Clock
Output
0x2
Receive Clock only during data transfers
Output
0x3-0x7
RK pin
Input-only
Reserved
• CKI: Receive Clock Inversion
0: The data inputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are sampled on Receive Clock falling edge. The Frame Sync signal output is shifted out on Receive Clock rising edge.
1: The data inputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are sampled on Receive Clock rising edge. The Frame Sync signal output is shifted out on Receive Clock falling edge.
CKI affects only the Receive Clock and not the output clock signal.
323
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• CKG: Receive Clock Gating Selection
CKG
Receive Clock Gating
0x0
None, continuous clock
0x1
Receive Clock enabled only if RF Low
0x2
Receive Clock enabled only if RF High
0x3
Reserved
• START: Receive Start Selection
START
Receive Start
0x0
Continuous, as soon as the receiver is enabled, and immediately after the end of
transfer of the previous data.
0x1
Transmit start
0x2
Detection of a low level on RF signal
0x3
Detection of a high level on RF signal
0x4
Detection of a falling edge on RF signal
0x5
Detection of a rising edge on RF signal
0x6
Detection of any level change on RF signal
0x7
Detection of any edge on RF signal
0x8
Compare 0
0x9-0xF
Reserved
• STOP: Receive Stop Selection
0: After completion of a data transfer when starting with a Compare 0, the receiver stops the data transfer and waits for a
new compare 0.
1: After starting a receive with a Compare 0, the receiver operates in a continuous mode until a Compare 1 is detected.
• STTDLY: Receive Start Delay
If STTDLY is not 0, a delay of STTDLY clock cycles is inserted between the start event and the actual start of reception.
When the Receiver is programmed to start synchronously with the Transmitter, the delay is also applied.
Note: It is very important that STTDLY be set carefully. If STTDLY must be set, it should be done in relation to TAG
(Receive Sync Data) reception.
• PERIOD: Receive Period Divider Selection
This field selects the divider to apply to the selected Receive Clock in order to generate a new Frame Sync Signal. If 0, no
PERIOD signal is generated. If not 0, a PERIOD signal is generated each 2 x (PERIOD+1) Receive Clock.
324
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.4
Name:
SSC Receive Frame Mode Register
SSC_RFMR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
FSEDGE
23
–
22
21
FSOS
20
19
18
17
16
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
9
8
7
MSBF
6
–
5
LOOP
4
3
1
0
FSLEN
10
DATNB
2
DATLEN
• DATLEN: Data Length
0: Forbidden value (1-bit data length not supported).
Any other value: The bit stream contains DATLEN + 1 data bits. Moreover, it defines the transfer size performed by the
PDC2 assigned to the Receiver. If DATLEN is lower or equal to 7, data transfers are in bytes. If DATLEN is between 8 and
15 (included), half-words are transferred, and for any other value, 32-bit words are transferred.
• LOOP: Loop Mode
0: Normal operating mode.
1: RD is driven by TD, RF is driven by TF and TK drives RK.
• MSBF: Most Significant Bit First
0: The lowest significant bit of the data register is sampled first in the bit stream.
1: The most significant bit of the data register is sampled first in the bit stream.
• DATNB: Data Number per Frame
This field defines the number of data words to be received after each transfer start, which is equal to (DATNB + 1).
• FSLEN: Receive Frame Sync Length
This field defines the length of the Receive Frame Sync Signal and the number of bits sampled and stored in the Receive
Sync Data Register. When this mode is selected by the START field in the Receive Clock Mode Register, it also determines the length of the sampled data to be compared to the Compare 0 or Compare 1 register.
Pulse length is equal to (FSLEN + 1) Receive Clock periods. Thus, if FSLEN is 0, the Receive Frame Sync signal is generated during one Receive Clock period.
325
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• FSOS: Receive Frame Sync Output Selection
FSOS
Selected Receive Frame Sync Signal
RF Pin
0x0
None
0x1
Negative Pulse
Output
0x2
Positive Pulse
Output
0x3
Driven Low during data transfer
Output
0x4
Driven High during data transfer
Output
0x5
Toggling at each start of data transfer
Output
0x6-0x7
Input-only
Reserved
Undefined
• FSEDGE: Frame Sync Edge Detection
Determines which edge on Frame Sync will generate the interrupt RXSYN in the SSC Status Register.
FSEDGE
Frame Sync Edge Detection
0x0
Positive Edge Detection
0x1
Negative Edge Detection
326
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.5
Name:
SSC Transmit Clock Mode Register
SSC_TCMR
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
10
9
8
PERIOD
23
22
21
20
STTDLY
15
–
7
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
6
5
CKI
4
3
CKO
CKG
START
2
1
0
CKS
• CKS: Transmit Clock Selection
CKS
Selected Transmit Clock
0x0
Divided Clock
0x1
RK Clock signal
0x2
TK Pin
0x3
Reserved
• CKO: Transmit Clock Output Mode Selection
CKO
Transmit Clock Output Mode
0x0
None
0x1
Continuous Transmit Clock
Output
0x2
Transmit Clock only during data transfers
Output
0x3-0x7
TK pin
Input-only
Reserved
• CKI: Transmit Clock Inversion
0: The data outputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are shifted out on Transmit Clock falling edge. The Frame sync signal
input is sampled on Transmit clock rising edge.
1: The data outputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are shifted out on Transmit Clock rising edge. The Frame sync signal
input is sampled on Transmit clock falling edge.
CKI affects only the Transmit Clock and not the output clock signal.
327
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• CKG: Transmit Clock Gating Selection
CKG
Transmit Clock Gating
0x0
None, continuous clock
0x1
Transmit Clock enabled only if TF Low
0x2
Transmit Clock enabled only if TF High
0x3
Reserved
• START: Transmit Start Selection
START
Transmit Start
0x0
Continuous, as soon as a word is written in the SSC_THR Register (if Transmit is enabled), and
immediately after the end of transfer of the previous data.
0x1
Receive start
0x2
Detection of a low level on TF signal
0x3
Detection of a high level on TF signal
0x4
Detection of a falling edge on TF signal
0x5
Detection of a rising edge on TF signal
0x6
Detection of any level change on TF signal
0x7
Detection of any edge on TF signal
0x8 - 0xF
Reserved
• STTDLY: Transmit Start Delay
If STTDLY is not 0, a delay of STTDLY clock cycles is inserted between the start event and the actual start of transmission
of data. When the Transmitter is programmed to start synchronously with the Receiver, the delay is also applied.
Note: STTDLY must be set carefully. If STTDLY is too short in respect to TAG (Transmit Sync Data) emission, data is emitted instead of the end of TAG.
• PERIOD: Transmit Period Divider Selection
This field selects the divider to apply to the selected Transmit Clock to generate a new Frame Sync Signal. If 0, no period
signal is generated. If not 0, a period signal is generated at each 2 x (PERIOD+1) Transmit Clock.
328
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.6
Name:
SSC Transmit Frame Mode Register
SSC_TFMR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
FSEDGE
23
FSDEN
22
21
FSOS
20
19
18
17
16
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
9
8
7
MSBF
6
–
5
DATDEF
4
3
1
0
FSLEN
10
DATNB
2
DATLEN
• DATLEN: Data Length
0: Forbidden value (1-bit data length not supported).
Any other value: The bit stream contains DATLEN + 1 data bits. Moreover, it defines the transfer size performed by the
PDC2 assigned to the Transmit. If DATLEN is lower or equal to 7, data transfers are bytes, if DATLEN is between 8 and 15
(included), half-words are transferred, and for any other value, 32-bit words are transferred.
• DATDEF: Data Default Value
This bit defines the level driven on the TD pin while out of transmission. Note that if the pin is defined as multi-drive by the
PIO Controller, the pin is enabled only if the SCC TD output is 1.
• MSBF: Most Significant Bit First
0: The lowest significant bit of the data register is shifted out first in the bit stream.
1: The most significant bit of the data register is shifted out first in the bit stream.
• DATNB: Data Number per frame
This field defines the number of data words to be transferred after each transfer start, which is equal to (DATNB +1).
• FSLEN: Transmit Frame Sync Length
This field defines the length of the Transmit Frame Sync signal and the number of bits shifted out from the Transmit Sync
Data Register if FSDEN is 1.
Pulse length is equal to (FSLEN + 1) Transmit Clock periods, i.e., the pulse length can range from 1 to 16 Transmit Clock
periods. If FSLEN is 0, the Transmit Frame Sync signal is generated during one Transmit Clock period.
329
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• FSOS: Transmit Frame Sync Output Selection
FSOS
Selected Transmit Frame Sync Signal
TF Pin
0x0
None
0x1
Negative Pulse
Output
0x2
Positive Pulse
Output
0x3
Driven Low during data transfer
Output
0x4
Driven High during data transfer
Output
0x5
Toggling at each start of data transfer
Output
0x6-0x7
Reserved
Input-only
Undefined
• FSDEN: Frame Sync Data Enable
0: The TD line is driven with the default value during the Transmit Frame Sync signal.
1: SSC_TSHR value is shifted out during the transmission of the Transmit Frame Sync signal.
• FSEDGE: Frame Sync Edge Detection
Determines which edge on frame sync will generate the interrupt TXSYN (Status Register).
FSEDGE
Frame Sync Edge Detection
0x0
Positive Edge Detection
0x1
Negative Edge Detection
330
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.7
Name:
SSC Receive Holding Register
SSC_RHR
Access Type:
31
Read-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RDAT
23
22
21
20
RDAT
15
14
13
12
RDAT
7
6
5
4
RDAT
• RDAT: Receive Data
Right aligned regardless of the number of data bits defined by DATLEN in SSC_RFMR.
30.8.8
Name:
SSC Transmit Holding Register
SSC_THR
Access Type:
31
Write-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
TDAT
23
22
21
20
TDAT
15
14
13
12
TDAT
7
6
5
4
TDAT
• TDAT: Transmit Data
Right aligned regardless of the number of data bits defined by DATLEN in SSC_TFMR.
331
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.9
Name:
SSC Receive Synchronization Holding Register
SSC_RSHR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RSDAT
7
6
5
4
RSDAT
• RSDAT: Receive Synchronization Data
30.8.10
Name:
SSC Transmit Synchronization Holding Register
SSC_TSHR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
TSDAT
7
6
5
4
TSDAT
• TSDAT: Transmit Synchronization Data
332
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.11
Name:
SSC Receive Compare 0 Register
SSC_RC0R
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CP0
7
6
5
4
CP0
• CP0: Receive Compare Data 0
333
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.12
Name:
SSC Receive Compare 1 Register
SSC_RC1R
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CP1
7
6
5
4
CP1
• CP1: Receive Compare Data 1
334
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.13
Name:
SSC Status Register
SSC_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
RXEN
16
TXEN
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
RXSYN
10
TXSYN
9
CP1
8
CP0
7
RXBUFF
6
ENDRX
5
OVRUN
4
RXRDY
3
TXBUFE
2
ENDTX
1
TXEMPTY
0
TXRDY
• TXRDY: Transmit Ready
0: Data has been loaded in SSC_THR and is waiting to be loaded in the Transmit Shift Register (TSR).
1: SSC_THR is empty.
• TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty
0: Data remains in SSC_THR or is currently transmitted from TSR.
1: Last data written in SSC_THR has been loaded in TSR and last data loaded in TSR has been transmitted.
• ENDTX: End of Transmission
0: The register SSC_TCR has not reached 0 since the last write in SSC_TCR or SSC_TNCR.
1: The register SSC_TCR has reached 0 since the last write in SSC_TCR or SSC_TNCR.
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty
0: SSC_TCR or SSC_TNCR have a value other than 0.
1: Both SSC_TCR and SSC_TNCR have a value of 0.
• RXRDY: Receive Ready
0: SSC_RHR is empty.
1: Data has been received and loaded in SSC_RHR.
• OVRUN: Receive Overrun
0: No data has been loaded in SSC_RHR while previous data has not been read since the last read of the Status Register.
1: Data has been loaded in SSC_RHR while previous data has not yet been read since the last read of the Status Register.
• ENDRX: End of Reception
0: Data is written on the Receive Counter Register or Receive Next Counter Register.
1: End of PDC transfer when Receive Counter Register has arrived at zero.
335
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full
0: SSC_RCR or SSC_RNCR have a value other than 0.
1: Both SSC_RCR and SSC_RNCR have a value of 0.
• CP0: Compare 0
0: A compare 0 has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
1: A compare 0 has occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
• CP1: Compare 1
0: A compare 1 has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
1: A compare 1 has occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
• TXSYN: Transmit Sync
0: A Tx Sync has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
1: A Tx Sync has occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
• RXSYN: Receive Sync
0: An Rx Sync has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
1: An Rx Sync has occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
• TXEN: Transmit Enable
0: Transmit is disabled.
1: Transmit is enabled.
• RXEN: Receive Enable
0: Receive is disabled.
1: Receive is enabled.
336
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.14
Name:
SSC Interrupt Enable Register
SSC_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
RXSYN
10
TXSYN
9
CP1
8
CP0
7
RXBUFF
6
ENDRX
5
OVRUN
4
RXRDY
3
TXBUFE
2
ENDTX
1
TXEMPTY
0
TXRDY
• TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Transmit Ready Interrupt.
• TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Transmit Empty Interrupt.
• ENDTX: End of Transmission Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the End of Transmission Interrupt.
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt
• RXRDY: Receive Ready Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Receive Ready Interrupt.
• OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Receive Overrun Interrupt.
• ENDRX: End of Reception Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the End of Reception Interrupt.
337
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Receive Buffer Full Interrupt.
• CP0: Compare 0 Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Compare 0 Interrupt.
• CP1: Compare 1 Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Compare 1 Interrupt.
• TXSYN: Tx Sync Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Tx Sync Interrupt.
• RXSYN: Rx Sync Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the Rx Sync Interrupt.
338
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.15
Name:
SSC Interrupt Disable Register
SSC_IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
RXSYN
10
TXSYN
9
CP1
8
CP0
7
RXBUFF
6
ENDRX
5
OVRUN
4
RXRDY
3
TXBUFE
2
ENDTX
1
TXEMPTY
0
TXRDY
• TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Transmit Ready Interrupt.
• TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty Interrupt Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Transmit Empty Interrupt.
• ENDTX: End of Transmission Interrupt Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the End of Transmission Interrupt.
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt.
• RXRDY: Receive Ready Interrupt Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Receive Ready Interrupt.
• OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Receive Overrun Interrupt.
• ENDRX: End of Reception Interrupt Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the End of Reception Interrupt.
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable
339
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Receive Buffer Full Interrupt.
• CP0: Compare 0 Interrupt Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Compare 0 Interrupt.
• CP1: Compare 1 Interrupt Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Compare 1 Interrupt.
• TXSYN: Tx Sync Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Tx Sync Interrupt.
• RXSYN: Rx Sync Interrupt Enable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the Rx Sync Interrupt.
340
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
30.8.16
Name:
SSC Interrupt Mask Register
SSC_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
RXSYN
10
TXSYN
9
CP1
8
CP0
7
RXBUFF
6
ENDRX
5
OVRUN
4
RXRDY
3
TXBUFE
2
ENDTX
1
TXEMPTY
0
TXRDY
• TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Mask
0: The Transmit Ready Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Transmit Ready Interrupt is enabled.
• TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty Interrupt Mask
0: The Transmit Empty Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Transmit Empty Interrupt is enabled.
• ENDTX: End of Transmission Interrupt Mask
0: The End of Transmission Interrupt is disabled.
1: The End of Transmission Interrupt is enabled.
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask
0: The Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt is enabled.
• RXRDY: Receive Ready Interrupt Mask
0: The Receive Ready Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Receive Ready Interrupt is enabled.
• OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Mask
0: The Receive Overrun Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Receive Overrun Interrupt is enabled.
• ENDRX: End of Reception Interrupt Mask
0: The End of Reception Interrupt is disabled.
1: The End of Reception Interrupt is enabled.
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask
341
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
0: The Receive Buffer Full Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Receive Buffer Full Interrupt is enabled.
• CP0: Compare 0 Interrupt Mask
0: The Compare 0 Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Compare 0 Interrupt is enabled.
• CP1: Compare 1 Interrupt Mask
0: The Compare 1 Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Compare 1 Interrupt is enabled.
• TXSYN: Tx Sync Interrupt Mask
0: The Tx Sync Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Tx Sync Interrupt is enabled.
• RXSYN: Rx Sync Interrupt Mask
0: The Rx Sync Interrupt is disabled.
1: The Rx Sync Interrupt is enabled.
342
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31. Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART)
31.1
Overview
The Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART) provides one full
duplex universal synchronous asynchronous serial link. Data frame format is widely programmable (data length, parity, number of stop bits) to support a maximum of standards. The receiver
implements parity error, framing error and overrun error detection. The receiver time-out enables
handling variable-length frames and the transmitter timeguard facilitates communications with
slow remote devices. Multidrop communications are also supported through address bit handling in reception and transmission.
The USART features three test modes: remote loopback, local loopback and automatic echo.
The USART supports specific operating modes providing interfaces on RS485 buses, with
ISO7816 T = 0 or T = 1 smart card slots, infrared transceivers and connection to modem ports.
The hardware handshaking feature enables an out-of-band flow control by automatic management of the pins RTS and CTS.
The USART supports the connection to the Peripheral DMA Controller, which enables data
transfers to the transmitter and from the receiver. The PDC provides chained buffer management without any intervention of the processor.
343
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.2
Block Diagram
Figure 31-1. USART Block Diagram
Peripheral DMA
Controller
Channel
Channel
PIO
Controller
USART
RXD
Receiver
RTS
AIC
USART
Interrupt
TXD
Transmitter
CTS
DTR
PMC
Modem
Signals
Control
MCK
DIV
DSR
DCD
MCK/DIV
RI
SLCK
Baud Rate
Generator
SCK
User Interface
APB
344
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.3
Application Block Diagram
Figure 31-2. Application Block Diagram
IrLAP
PPP
Modem
Driver
Serial
Driver
Field Bus
Driver
EMV
Driver
IrDA
Driver
USART
RS232
Drivers
RS232
Drivers
RS485
Drivers
Serial
Port
Differential
Bus
Smart
Card
Slot
IrDA
Transceivers
Modem
PSTN
31.4
I/O Lines Description
Table 31-1.
I/O Line Description
Name
Description
Type
Active Level
SCK
Serial Clock
I/O
TXD
Transmit Serial Data
I/O
RXD
Receive Serial Data
Input
RI
Ring Indicator
Input
Low
DSR
Data Set Ready
Input
Low
DCD
Data Carrier Detect
Input
Low
DTR
Data Terminal Ready
Output
Low
CTS
Clear to Send
Input
Low
RTS
Request to Send
Output
Low
345
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.5
31.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines
The pins used for interfacing the USART may be multiplexed with the PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign the desired USART pins to their peripheral
function. If I/O lines of the USART are not used by the application, they can be used for other
purposes by the PIO Controller.
To prevent the TXD line from falling when the USART is disabled, the use of an internal pull up
is mandatory. If the hardware handshaking feature or Modem mode is used, the internal pull up
on TXD must also be enabled.
All the pins of the modems may or may not be implemented on the USART. Only USART1 is
fully equipped with all the modem signals. On USARTs not equipped with the corresponding pin,
the associated control bits and statuses have no effect on the behavior of the USART.
31.5.2
Power Management
The USART is not continuously clocked. The programmer must first enable the USART Clock in
the Power Management Controller (PMC) before using the USART. However, if the application
does not require USART operations, the USART clock can be stopped when not needed and be
restarted later. In this case, the USART will resume its operations where it left off.
Configuring the USART does not require the USART clock to be enabled.
31.5.3
Interrupt
The USART interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt
Controller. Using the USART interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. Note that it is not
recommended to use the USART interrupt line in edge sensitive mode.
346
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.6
Functional Description
The USART is capable of managing several types of serial synchronous or asynchronous
communications.
It supports the following communication modes:
• 5- to 9-bit full-duplex asynchronous serial communication
– MSB- or LSB-first
– 1, 1.5 or 2 stop bits
– Parity even, odd, marked, space or none
– By 8 or by 16 over-sampling receiver frequency
– Optional hardware handshaking
– Optional modem signals management
– Optional break management
– Optional multidrop serial communication
• High-speed 5- to 9-bit full-duplex synchronous serial communication
– MSB- or LSB-first
– 1 or 2 stop bits
– Parity even, odd, marked, space or none
– By 8 or by 16 over-sampling frequency
– Optional hardware handshaking
– Optional modem signals management
– Optional break management
– Optional multidrop serial communication
• RS485 with driver control signal
• ISO7816, T0 or T1 protocols for interfacing with smart cards
– NACK handling, error counter with repetition and iteration limit
• InfraRed IrDA Modulation and Demodulation
• Test modes
– Remote loopback, local loopback, automatic echo
31.6.1
Baud Rate Generator
The Baud Rate Generator provides the bit period clock named the Baud Rate Clock to both the
receiver and the transmitter.
The Baud Rate Generator clock source can be selected by setting the USCLKS field in the Mode
Register (US_MR) between:
• the Master Clock MCK
• a division of the Master Clock, the divider being product dependent, but generally set to 8
• the external clock, available on the SCK pin
The Baud Rate Generator is based upon a 16-bit divider, which is programmed with the CD field
of the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). If CD is programmed at 0, the Baud Rate
Generator does not generate any clock. If CD is programmed at 1, the divider is bypassed and
becomes inactive.
347
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
If the external SCK clock is selected, the duration of the low and high levels of the signal provided on the SCK pin must be longer than a Master Clock (MCK) period. The frequency of the
signal provided on SCK must be at least 4.5 times lower than MCK.
Figure 31-3. Baud Rate Generator
USCLKS
MCK
MCK/DIV
SCK
Reserved
CD
CD
SCK
0
1
16-bit Counter
2
FIDI
>1
3
1
0
SYNC
OVER
0
0
Sampling
Divider
0
Baud Rate
Clock
1
1
SYNC
Sampling
Clock
USCLKS = 3
31.6.1.1
Baud Rate in Asynchronous Mode
If the USART is programmed to operate in asynchronous mode, the selected clock is first
divided by CD, which is field programmed in the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR).
The resulting clock is provided to the receiver as a sampling clock and then divided by 16 or 8,
depending on the programming of the OVER bit in US_MR.
If OVER is set to 1, the receiver sampling is 8 times higher than the baud rate clock. If OVER is
cleared, the sampling is performed at 16 times the baud rate clock.
The following formula performs the calculation of the Baud Rate.
SelectedClock
Baudrate = ---------------------------------------------( 8 ( 2 – Over )CD )
This gives a maximum baud rate of MCK divided by 8, assuming that MCK is the highest possible clock and that OVER is programmed at 1.
31.6.1.2
Baud Rate Calculation Example
Table 31-2 shows calculations of CD to obtain a baud rate at 38400 bauds for different source
clock frequencies. This table also shows the actual resulting baud rate and the error.
Table 31-2.
348
Baud Rate Example (OVER = 0)
Source Clock
Expected Baud
Rate
MHz
Bit/s
3 686 400
38 400
6.00
6
38 400.00
0.00%
4 915 200
38 400
8.00
8
38 400.00
0.00%
5 000 000
38 400
8.14
8
39 062.50
1.70%
7 372 800
38 400
12.00
12
38 400.00
0.00%
Calculation Result
CD
Actual Baud Rate
Error
Bit/s
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 31-2.
Baud Rate Example (OVER = 0) (Continued)
Source Clock
Expected Baud
Rate
Calculation Result
CD
Actual Baud Rate
Error
8 000 000
38 400
13.02
13
38 461.54
0.16%
12 000 000
38 400
19.53
20
37 500.00
2.40%
12 288 000
38 400
20.00
20
38 400.00
0.00%
14 318 180
38 400
23.30
23
38 908.10
1.31%
14 745 600
38 400
24.00
24
38 400.00
0.00%
18 432 000
38 400
30.00
30
38 400.00
0.00%
24 000 000
38 400
39.06
39
38 461.54
0.16%
24 576 000
38 400
40.00
40
38 400.00
0.00%
25 000 000
38 400
40.69
40
38 109.76
0.76%
32 000 000
38 400
52.08
52
38 461.54
0.16%
32 768 000
38 400
53.33
53
38 641.51
0.63%
33 000 000
38 400
53.71
54
38 194.44
0.54%
40 000 000
38 400
65.10
65
38 461.54
0.16%
50 000 000
38 400
81.38
81
38 580.25
0.47%
The baud rate is calculated with the following formula:
BaudRate = MCK ⁄ CD × 16
The baud rate error is calculated with the following formula. It is not recommended to work with
an error higher than 5%.
ExpectedBaudRate
Error = 1 – ⎛ ---------------------------------------------------------⎞
⎝ ActualBaudRate ⎠
31.6.1.3
Fractional Baud Rate in Asynchronous Mode
The Baud Rate generator previously defined is subject to the following limitation: the output frequency changes by only integer multiples of the reference frequency. An approach to this
problem is to integrate a fractional N clock generator that has a high resolution. The generator
architecture is modified to obtain Baud Rate changes by a fraction of the reference source clock.
This fractional part is programmed with the FP field in the Baud Rate Generator Register
(US_BRGR). If FP is not 0, the fractional part is activated. The resolution is one eighth of the
clock divider. This feature is only available when using USART normal mode. The fractional
Baud Rate is calculated using the following formula:
SelectedClock
Baudrate = -----------------------------------------------------------------⎛ 8 ( 2 – Over ) ⎛ CD + FP
--------⎞ ⎞
⎝
⎝
8 ⎠⎠
The modified architecture is presented below:
349
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 31-4. Fractional Baud Rate Generator
FP
USCLKS
CD
Modulus
Control
FP
MCK
MCK/DIV
SCK
Reserved
CD
SCK
0
1
16-bit Counter
2
3
glitch-free
logic
1
0
FIDI
>1
0
0
SYNC
OVER
Sampling
Divider
0
Baud Rate
Clock
1
1
SYNC
USCLKS = 3
31.6.1.4
Sampling
Clock
Baud Rate in Synchronous Mode
If the USART is programmed to operate in synchronous mode, the selected clock is simply
divided by the field CD in US_BRGR.
BaudRate = SelectedClock
----------------------------------------CD
In synchronous mode, if the external clock is selected (USCLKS = 3), the clock is provided
directly by the signal on the USART SCK pin. No division is active. The value written in
US_BRGR has no effect. The external clock frequency must be at least 4.5 times lower than the
system clock.
When either the external clock SCK or the internal clock divided (MCK/DIV) is selected, the
value programmed in CD must be even if the user has to ensure a 50:50 mark/space ratio on the
SCK pin. If the internal clock MCK is selected, the Baud Rate Generator ensures a 50:50 duty
cycle on the SCK pin, even if the value programmed in CD is odd.
31.6.1.5
Baud Rate in ISO 7816 Mode
The ISO7816 specification defines the bit rate with the following formula:
Di
B = ------ × f
Fi
where:
• B is the bit rate
• Di is the bit-rate adjustment factor
• Fi is the clock frequency division factor
• f is the ISO7816 clock frequency (Hz)
350
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Di is a binary value encoded on a 4-bit field, named DI, as represented in Table 31-3.
Table 31-3.
Binary and Decimal Values for Di
DI field
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
1000
1001
1
2
4
8
16
32
12
20
Di (decimal)
Fi is a binary value encoded on a 4-bit field, named FI, as represented in Table 31-4.
Table 31-4.
Binary and Decimal Values for Fi
FI field
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
Fi (decimal
372
372
558
744
1116
1488
1860
512
768
1024
1536
2048
Table 31-5 shows the resulting Fi/Di Ratio, which is the ratio between the ISO7816 clock and the
baud rate clock.
Table 31-5.
Possible Values for the Fi/Di Ratio
Fi/Di
372
558
774
1116
1488
1806
512
768
1024
1536
2048
1
372
558
744
1116
1488
1860
512
768
1024
1536
2048
2
186
279
372
558
744
930
256
384
512
768
1024
4
93
139.5
186
279
372
465
128
192
256
384
512
8
46.5
69.75
93
139.5
186
232.5
64
96
128
192
256
16
23.25
34.87
46.5
69.75
93
116.2
32
48
64
96
128
32
11.62
17.43
23.25
34.87
46.5
58.13
16
24
32
48
64
12
31
46.5
62
93
124
155
42.66
64
85.33
128
170.6
20
18.6
27.9
37.2
55.8
74.4
93
25.6
38.4
51.2
76.8
102.4
If the USART is configured in ISO7816 Mode, the clock selected by the USCLKS field in the
Mode Register (US_MR) is first divided by the value programmed in the field CD in the Baud
Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). The resulting clock can be provided to the SCK pin to
feed the smart card clock inputs. This means that the CLKO bit can be set in US_MR.
This clock is then divided by the value programmed in the FI_DI_RATIO field in the FI_DI_Ratio
register (US_FIDI). This is performed by the Sampling Divider, which performs a division by up
to 2047 in ISO7816 Mode. The non-integer values of the Fi/Di Ratio are not supported and the
user must program the FI_DI_RATIO field to a value as close as possible to the expected value.
The FI_DI_RATIO field resets to the value 0x174 (372 in decimal) and is the most common
divider between the ISO7816 clock and the bit rate (Fi = 372, Di = 1).
Figure 31-5 shows the relation between the Elementary Time Unit, corresponding to a bit time,
and the ISO 7816 clock.
351
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 31-5. Elementary Time Unit (ETU)
FI_DI_RATIO
ISO7816 Clock Cycles
ISO7816 Clock
on SCK
ISO7816 I/O Line
on TXD
1 ETU
31.6.2
Receiver and Transmitter Control
After reset, the receiver is disabled. The user must enable the receiver by setting the RXEN bit
in the Control Register (US_CR). However, the receiver registers can be programmed before the
receiver clock is enabled.
After reset, the transmitter is disabled. The user must enable it by setting the TXEN bit in the
Control Register (US_CR). However, the transmitter registers can be programmed before being
enabled.
The Receiver and the Transmitter can be enabled together or independently.
At any time, the software can perform a reset on the receiver or the transmitter of the USART by
setting the corresponding bit, RSTRX and RSTTX respectively, in the Control Register (US_CR).
The software resets clear the status flag and reset internal state machines but the user interface
configuration registers hold the value configured prior to software reset. Regardless of what the
receiver or the transmitter is performing, the communication is immediately stopped.
The user can also independently disable the receiver or the transmitter by setting RXDIS and
TXDIS respectively in US_CR. If the receiver is disabled during a character reception, the
USART waits until the end of reception of the current character, then the reception is stopped. If
the transmitter is disabled while it is operating, the USART waits the end of transmission of both
the current character and character being stored in the Transmit Holding Register (US_THR). If
a timeguard is programmed, it is handled normally.
31.6.3
31.6.3.1
Synchronous and Asynchronous Modes
Transmitter Operations
The transmitter performs the same in both synchronous and asynchronous operating modes
(SYNC = 0 or SYNC = 1). One start bit, up to 9 data bits, one optional parity bit and up to two
stop bits are successively shifted out on the TXD pin at each falling edge of the programmed
serial clock.
The number of data bits is selected by the CHRL field and the MODE 9 bit in the Mode Register
(US_MR). Nine bits are selected by setting the MODE 9 bit regardless of the CHRL field. The
parity bit is set according to the PAR field in US_MR. The even, odd, space, marked or none
parity bit can be configured. The MSBF field in US_MR configures which data bit is sent first. If
written at 1, the most significant bit is sent first. At 0, the less significant bit is sent first. The number of stop bits is selected by the NBSTOP field in US_MR. The 1.5 stop bit is supported in
asynchronous mode only.
352
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 31-6. Character Transmit
Example: 8-bit, Parity Enabled One Stop
Baud Rate
Clock
TXD
Start
Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity
Bit
Stop
Bit
The characters are sent by writing in the Transmit Holding Register (US_THR). The transmitter
reports two status bits in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR): TXRDY (Transmitter Ready),
which indicates that US_THR is empty and TXEMPTY, which indicates that all the characters
written in US_THR have been processed. When the current character processing is completed,
the last character written in US_THR is transferred into the Shift Register of the transmitter and
US_THR becomes empty, thus TXRDY raises.
Both TXRDY and TXEMPTY bits are low since the transmitter is disabled. Writing a character in
US_THR while TXRDY is active has no effect and the written character is lost.
Figure 31-7. Transmitter Status
Baud Rate
Clock
TXD
Start
D0
Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Stop Start
D0
Bit Bit Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Stop
Bit Bit
Write
US_THR
TXRDY
TXEMPTY
31.6.3.2
Asynchronous Receiver
If the USART is programmed in asynchronous operating mode (SYNC = 0), the receiver oversamples the RXD input line. The oversampling is either 16 or 8 times the Baud Rate clock,
depending on the OVER bit in the Mode Register (US_MR).
The receiver samples the RXD line. If the line is sampled during one half of a bit time at 0, a start
bit is detected and data, parity and stop bits are successively sampled on the bit rate clock.
If the oversampling is 16, (OVER at 0), a start is detected at the eighth sample at 0. Then, data
bits, parity bit and stop bit are sampled on each 16 sampling clock cycle. If the oversampling is 8
(OVER at 1), a start bit is detected at the fourth sample at 0. Then, data bits, parity bit and stop
bit are sampled on each 8 sampling clock cycle.
The number of data bits, first bit sent and parity mode are selected by the same fields and bits
as the transmitter, i.e. respectively CHRL, MODE9, MSBF and PAR. For the synchronization
mechanism only, the number of stop bits has no effect on the receiver as it considers only one
stop bit, regardless of the field NBSTOP, so that resynchronization between the receiver and the
353
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
transmitter can occur. Moreover, as soon as the stop bit is sampled, the receiver starts looking
for a new start bit so that resynchronization can also be accomplished when the transmitter is
operating with one stop bit.
Figure 31-8 and Figure 31-9 illustrate start detection and character reception when USART
operates in asynchronous mode.
Figure 31-8. Asynchronous Start Detection
Baud Rate
Clock
Sampling
Clock (x16)
RXD
Sampling
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
D0
Sampling
Start
Detection
RXD
Sampling
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0 1
Start
Rejection
Figure 31-9. Asynchronous Character Reception
Example: 8-bit, Parity Enabled
Baud Rate
Clock
RXD
Start
Detection
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
samples samples samples samples samples samples samples samples samples samples
D0
31.6.3.3
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity
Bit
Stop
Bit
Synchronous Receiver
In synchronous mode (SYNC = 1), the receiver samples the RXD signal on each rising edge of
the Baud Rate Clock. If a low level is detected, it is considered as a start. All data bits, the parity
bit and the stop bits are sampled and the receiver waits for the next start bit. Synchronous mode
operations provide a high speed transfer capability.
Configuration fields and bits are the same as in asynchronous mode.
Figure 31-10 illustrates a character reception in synchronous mode.
354
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 31-10. Synchronous Mode Character Reception
Example: 8-bit, Parity Enabled 1 Stop
Baud Rate
Clock
RXD
Sampling
Start
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
Stop Bit
D7
Parity Bit
31.6.3.4
Receiver Operations
When a character reception is completed, it is transferred to the Receive Holding Register
(US_RHR) and the RXRDY bit in the Status Register (US_CSR) rises. If a character is completed while the RXRDY is set, the OVRE (Overrun Error) bit is set. The last character is
transferred into US_RHR and overwrites the previous one. The OVRE bit is cleared by writing
the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTSTA (Reset Status) bit at 1.
Figure 31-11. Receiver Status
Baud Rate
Clock
RXD
Start
D0
Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Stop Start
D0
Bit Bit Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Stop
Bit Bit
RSTSTA = 1
Write
US_CR
Read
US_RHR
RXRDY
OVRE
355
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.6.3.5
Parity
The USART supports five parity modes selected by programming the PAR field in the Mode
Register (US_MR). The PAR field also enables the Multidrop mode, see “Multidrop Mode” on
page 357. Even and odd parity bit generation and error detection are supported.
If even parity is selected, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 0 if a number of 1s in the character data bit is even, and at 1 if the number of 1s is odd. Accordingly, the
receiver parity checker counts the number of received 1s and reports a parity error if the sampled parity bit does not correspond. If odd parity is selected, the parity generator of the
transmitter drives the parity bit at 1 if a number of 1s in the character data bit is even, and at 0 if
the number of 1s is odd. Accordingly, the receiver parity checker counts the number of received
1s and reports a parity error if the sampled parity bit does not correspond. If the mark parity is
used, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 1 for all characters. The
receiver parity checker reports an error if the parity bit is sampled at 0. If the space parity is
used, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 0 for all characters. The
receiver parity checker reports an error if the parity bit is sampled at 1. If parity is disabled, the
transmitter does not generate any parity bit and the receiver does not report any parity error.
Table 31-6 shows an example of the parity bit for the character 0x41 (character ASCII “A”)
depending on the configuration of the USART. Because there are two bits at 1, 1 bit is added
when a parity is odd, or 0 is added when a parity is even.
Table 31-6.
Parity Bit Examples
Character
Hexa
Binary
Parity Bit
Parity Mode
A
0x41
0100 0001
1
Odd
A
0x41
0100 0001
0
Even
A
0x41
0100 0001
1
Mark
A
0x41
0100 0001
0
Space
A
0x41
0100 0001
None
None
When the receiver detects a parity error, it sets the PARE (Parity Error) bit in the Channel Status
Register (US_CSR). The PARE bit can be cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with
the RSTSTA bit at 1. Figure 31-12 illustrates the parity bit status setting and clearing.
356
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 31-12. Parity Error
Baud Rate
Clock
RXD
Start
D0
Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Bad Stop
Parity Bit
Bit
RSTSTA = 1
Write
US_CR
PARE
RXRDY
31.6.3.6
Multidrop Mode
If the PAR field in the Mode Register (US_MR) is programmed to the value 0x6 or 0x07, the
USART runs in Multidrop Mode. This mode differentiates the data characters and the address
characters. Data is transmitted with the parity bit at 0 and addresses are transmitted with the
parity bit at 1.
If the USART is configured in multidrop mode, the receiver sets the PARE parity error bit when
the parity bit is high and the transmitter is able to send a character with the parity bit high when
the Control Register is written with the SENDA bit at 1.
To handle parity error, the PARE bit is cleared when the Control Register is written with the bit
RSTSTA at 1.
The transmitter sends an address byte (parity bit set) when SENDA is written to US_CR. In this
case, the next byte written to US_THR is transmitted as an address. Any character written in
US_THR without having written the command SENDA is transmitted normally with the parity at
0.
31.6.3.7
Transmitter Timeguard
The timeguard feature enables the USART interface with slow remote devices.
The timeguard function enables the transmitter to insert an idle state on the TXD line between
two characters. This idle state actually acts as a long stop bit.
The duration of the idle state is programmed in the TG field of the Transmitter Timeguard Register (US_TTGR). When this field is programmed at zero no timeguard is generated. Otherwise,
the transmitter holds a high level on TXD after each transmitted byte during the number of bit
periods programmed in TG in addition to the number of stop bits.
As illustrated in Figure 31-13, the behavior of TXRDY and TXEMPTY status bits is modified by
the programming of a timeguard. TXRDY rises only when the start bit of the next character is
sent, and thus remains at 0 during the timeguard transmission if a character has been written in
US_THR. TXEMPTY remains low until the timeguard transmission is completed as the timeguard is part of the current character being transmitted.
357
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 31-13. Timeguard Operations
TG = 4
TG = 4
Baud Rate
Clock
TXD
Start
D0
Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Stop
Bit Bit
Start
D0
Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Stop
Bit Bit
Write
US_THR
TXRDY
TXEMPTY
Table 31-7 indicates the maximum length of a timeguard period that the transmitter can handle
in relation to the function of the Baud Rate.
Table 31-7.
31.6.3.8
Maximum Timeguard Length Depending on Baud Rate
Baud Rate
Bit time
Timeguard
Bit/sec
µs
ms
1 200
833
212.50
9 600
104
26.56
14400
69.4
17.71
19200
52.1
13.28
28800
34.7
8.85
33400
29.9
7.63
56000
17.9
4.55
57600
17.4
4.43
115200
8.7
2.21
Receiver Time-out
The Receiver Time-out provides support in handling variable-length frames. This feature detects
an idle condition on the RXD line. When a time-out is detected, the bit TIMEOUT in the Channel
Status Register (US_CSR) rises and can generate an interrupt, thus indicating to the driver an
end of frame.
The time-out delay period (during which the receiver waits for a new character) is programmed
in the TO field of the Receiver Time-out Register (US_RTOR). If the TO field is programmed at
0, the Receiver Time-out is disabled and no time-out is detected. The TIMEOUT bit in US_CSR
remains at 0. Otherwise, the receiver loads a 16-bit counter with the value programmed in TO.
This counter is decremented at each bit period and reloaded each time a new character is
received. If the counter reaches 0, the TIMEOUT bit in the Status Register rises. Then, the user
can either:
• Stop the counter clock until a new character is received. This is performed by writing the
Control Register (US_CR) with the STTTO (Start Time-out) bit at 1. In this case, the idle state
358
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
on RXD before a new character is received will not provide a time-out. This prevents having
to handle an interrupt before a character is received and allows waiting for the next idle state
on RXD after a frame is received.
• Obtain an interrupt while no character is received. This is performed by writing US_CR with
the RETTO (Reload and Start Time-out) bit at 1. If RETTO is performed, the counter starts
counting down immediately from the value TO. This enables generation of a periodic interrupt
so that a user time-out can be handled, for example when no key is pressed on a keyboard.
If STTTO is performed, the counter clock is stopped until a first character is received. The idle
state on RXD before the start of the frame does not provide a time-out. This prevents having to
obtain a periodic interrupt and enables a wait of the end of frame when the idle state on RXD is
detected.
If RETTO is performed, the counter starts counting down immediately from the value TO. This
enables generation of a periodic interrupt so that a user time-out can be handled, for example
when no key is pressed on a keyboard.
Figure 31-14 shows the block diagram of the Receiver Time-out feature.
Figure 31-14. Receiver Time-out Block Diagram
TO
Baud Rate
Clock
1
D
Q
Clock
16-bit Time-out
Counter
16-bit
Value
=
STTTO
Character
Received
Load
Clear
TIMEOUT
0
RETTO
Table 31-8 gives the maximum time-out period for some standard baud rates.
Table 31-8.
Maximum Time-out Period
Baud Rate
Bit Time
Time-out
bit/sec
µs
ms
600
1 667
109 225
1 200
833
54 613
2 400
417
27 306
4 800
208
13 653
9 600
104
6 827
14400
69
4 551
19200
52
3 413
28800
35
2 276
33400
30
1 962
359
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Table 31-8.
31.6.3.9
Maximum Time-out Period (Continued)
Baud Rate
Bit Time
Time-out
56000
18
1 170
57600
17
1 138
200000
5
328
Framing Error
The receiver is capable of detecting framing errors. A framing error happens when the stop bit of
a received character is detected at level 0. This can occur if the receiver and the transmitter are
fully desynchronized.
A framing error is reported on the FRAME bit of the Channel Status Register (US_CSR). The
FRAME bit is asserted in the middle of the stop bit as soon as the framing error is detected. It is
cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTSTA bit at 1.
Figure 31-15. Framing Error Status
Baud Rate
Clock
RXD
Start
D0
Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Stop
Bit Bit
RSTSTA = 1
Write
US_CR
FRAME
RXRDY
31.6.3.10
Transmit Break
The user can request the transmitter to generate a break condition on the TXD line. A break condition drives the TXD line low during at least one complete character. It appears the same as a
0x00 character sent with the parity and the stop bits at 0. However, the transmitter holds the
TXD line at least during one character until the user requests the break condition to be removed.
A break is transmitted by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the STTBRK bit at 1. This
can be performed at any time, either while the transmitter is empty (no character in either the
Shift Register or in US_THR) or when a character is being transmitted. If a break is requested
while a character is being shifted out, the character is first completed before the TXD line is held
low.
Once STTBRK command is requested further STTBRK commands are ignored until the end of
the break is completed.
The break condition is removed by writing US_CR with the STPBRK bit at 1. If the STPBRK is
requested before the end of the minimum break duration (one character, including start, data,
parity and stop bits), the transmitter ensures that the break condition completes.
360
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
The transmitter considers the break as though it is a character, i.e. the STTBRK and STPBRK
commands are taken into account only if the TXRDY bit in US_CSR is at 1 and the start of the
break condition clears the TXRDY and TXEMPTY bits as if a character is processed.
Writing US_CR with the both STTBRK and STPBRK bits at 1 can lead to an unpredictable
result. All STPBRK commands requested without a previous STTBRK command are ignored. A
byte written into the Transmit Holding Register while a break is pending, but not started, is
ignored.
After the break condition, the transmitter returns the TXD line to 1 for a minimum of 12 bit times.
Thus, the transmitter ensures that the remote receiver detects correctly the end of break and the
start of the next character. If the timeguard is programmed with a value higher than 12, the TXD
line is held high for the timeguard period.
After holding the TXD line for this period, the transmitter resumes normal operations.
Figure 31-16 illustrates the effect of both the Start Break (STTBRK) and Stop Break (STPBRK)
commands on the TXD line.
Figure 31-16. Break Transmission
Baud Rate
Clock
TXD
Start
D0
Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
STTBRK = 1
D6
D7
Parity Stop
Bit Bit
Break Transmission
End of Break
STPBRK = 1
Write
US_CR
TXRDY
TXEMPTY
31.6.3.11
Receive Break
The receiver detects a break condition when all data, parity and stop bits are low. This corresponds to detecting a framing error with data at 0x00, but FRAME remains low.
When the low stop bit is detected, the receiver asserts the RXBRK bit in US_CSR. This bit may
be cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the bit RSTSTA at 1.
An end of receive break is detected by a high level for at least 2/16 of a bit period in asynchronous operating mode or one sample at high level in synchronous operating mode. The end of
break detection also asserts the RXBRK bit.
31.6.3.12
Hardware Handshaking
The USART features a hardware handshaking out-of-band flow control. The RTS and CTS pins
are used to connect with the remote device, as shown in Figure 31-17.
361
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 31-17. Connection with a Remote Device for Hardware Handshaking
USART
Remote
Device
TXD
RXD
RXD
TXD
CTS
RTS
RTS
CTS
Setting the USART to operate with hardware handshaking is performed by writing the
USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x2.
The USART behavior when hardware handshaking is enabled is the same as the behavior in
standard synchronous or asynchronous mode, except that the receiver drives the RTS pin as
described below and the level on the CTS pin modifies the behavior of the transmitter as
described below. Using this mode requires using the PDC channel for reception. The transmitter
can handle hardware handshaking in any case.
Figure 31-18 shows how the receiver operates if hardware handshaking is enabled. The RTS
pin is driven high if the receiver is disabled and if the status RXBUFF (Receive Buffer Full) coming from the PDC channel is high. Normally, the remote device does not start transmitting while
its CTS pin (driven by RTS) is high. As soon as the Receiver is enabled, the RTS falls, indicating
to the remote device that it can start transmitting. Defining a new buffer to the PDC clears the
status bit RXBUFF and, as a result, asserts the pin RTS low.
Figure 31-18. Receiver Behavior when Operating with Hardware Handshaking
RXD
RXEN = 1
RXDIS = 1
Write
US_CR
RTS
RXBUFF
Figure 31-19 shows how the transmitter operates if hardware handshaking is enabled. The CTS
pin disables the transmitter. If a character is being processing, the transmitter is disabled only
after the completion of the current character and transmission of the next character happens as
soon as the pin CTS falls.
Figure 31-19. Transmitter Behavior when Operating with Hardware Handshaking
CTS
TXD
362
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.6.4
ISO7816 Mode
The USART features an ISO7816-compatible operating mode. This mode permits interfacing
with smart cards and Security Access Modules (SAM) communicating through an ISO7816 link.
Both T = 0 and T = 1 protocols defined by the ISO7816 specification are supported.
Setting the USART in ISO7816 mode is performed by writing the USART_MODE field in the
Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x4 for protocol T = 0 and to the value 0x5 for protocol T =
1.
31.6.4.1
ISO7816 Mode Overview
The ISO7816 is a half duplex communication on only one bidirectional line. The baud rate is
determined by a division of the clock provided to the remote device (see “Baud Rate Generator”
on page 347).
The USART connects to a smart card as shown in Figure 31-20. The TXD line becomes bidirectional and the Baud Rate Generator feeds the ISO7816 clock on the SCK pin. As the TXD pin
becomes bidirectional, its output remains driven by the output of the transmitter but only when
the transmitter is active while its input is directed to the input of the receiver. The USART is considered as the master of the communication as it generates the clock.
Figure 31-20. Connection of a Smart Card to the USART
USART
SCK
TXD
CLK
I/O
Smart
Card
When operating in ISO7816, either in T = 0 or T = 1 modes, the character format is fixed. The
configuration is 8 data bits, even parity and 1 or 2 stop bits, regardless of the values programmed in the CHRL, MODE9, PAR and CHMODE fields. MSBF can be used to transmit LSB
or MSB first. Parity Bit (PAR) can be used to transmit in normal or inverse mode. Refer to
“USART Mode Register” on page 375 and “PAR: Parity Type” on page 376.
The USART cannot operate concurrently in both receiver and transmitter modes as the communication is unidirectional at a time. It has to be configured according to the required mode by
enabling or disabling either the receiver or the transmitter as desired. Enabling both the receiver
and the transmitter at the same time in ISO7816 mode may lead to unpredictable results.
The ISO7816 specification defines an inverse transmission format. Data bits of the character
must be transmitted on the I/O line at their negative value. The USART does not support this format and the user has to perform an exclusive OR on the data before writing it in the Transmit
Holding Register (US_THR) or after reading it in the Receive Holding Register (US_RHR).
31.6.4.2
Protocol T = 0
In T = 0 protocol, a character is made up of one start bit, eight data bits, one parity bit and one
guard time, which lasts two bit times. The transmitter shifts out the bits and does not drive the
I/O line during the guard time.
If no parity error is detected, the I/O line remains at 1 during the guard time and the transmitter
can continue with the transmission of the next character, as shown in Figure 31-21.
363
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
If a parity error is detected by the receiver, it drives the I/O line at 0 during the guard time, as
shown in Figure 31-22. This error bit is also named NACK, for Non Acknowledge. In this case,
the character lasts 1 bit time more, as the guard time length is the same and is added to the
error bit time which lasts 1 bit time.
When the USART is the receiver and it detects an error, it does not load the erroneous character
in the Receive Holding Register (US_RHR). It appropriately sets the PARE bit in the Status Register (US_SR) so that the software can handle the error.
Figure 31-21. T = 0 Protocol without Parity Error
Baud Rate
Clock
RXD
Start
Bit
D0
D2
D1
D4
D3
D5
D6
D7
Parity Guard Guard Next
Bit Time 1 Time 2 Start
Bit
Figure 31-22. T = 0 Protocol with Parity Error
Baud Rate
Clock
Error
I/O
Start
Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Guard
Bit Time 1
Guard Start
Time 2 Bit
D0
D1
Repetition
31.6.4.3
Receive Error Counter
The USART receiver also records the total number of errors. This can be read in the Number of
Error (US_NER) register. The NB_ERRORS field can record up to 255 errors. Reading US_NER
automatically clears the NB_ERRORS field.
31.6.4.4
Receive NACK Inhibit
The USART can also be configured to inhibit an error. This can be achieved by setting the
INACK bit in the Mode Register (US_MR). If INACK is at 1, no error signal is driven on the I/O
line even if a parity bit is detected, but the INACK bit is set in the Status Register (US_SR). The
INACK bit can be cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTNACK bit at 1.
Moreover, if INACK is set, the erroneous received character is stored in the Receive Holding
Register, as if no error occurred. However, the RXRDY bit does not raise.
31.6.4.5
Transmit Character Repetition
When the USART is transmitting a character and gets a NACK, it can automatically repeat the
character before moving on to the next one. Repetition is enabled by writing the
MAX_ITERATION field in the Mode Register (US_MR) at a value higher than 0. Each character
can be transmitted up to eight times; the first transmission plus seven repetitions.
If MAX_ITERATION does not equal zero, the USART repeats the character as many times as
the value loaded in MAX_ITERATION.
364
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
When the USART repetition number reaches MAX_ITERATION, the ITERATION bit is set in the
Channel Status Register (US_CSR). If the repetition of the character is acknowledged by the
receiver, the repetitions are stopped and the iteration counter is cleared.
The ITERATION bit in US_CSR can be cleared by writing the Control Register with the RSIT bit
at 1.
31.6.4.6
Disable Successive Receive NACK
The receiver can limit the number of successive NACKs sent back to the remote transmitter.
This is programmed by setting the bit DSNACK in the Mode Register (US_MR). The maximum
number of NACK transmitted is programmed in the MAX_ITERATION field. As soon as
MAX_ITERATION is reached, the character is considered as correct, an acknowledge is sent on
the line and the ITERATION bit in the Channel Status Register is set.
31.6.4.7
Protocol T = 1
When operating in ISO7816 protocol T = 1, the transmission is similar to an asynchronous format with only one stop bit. The parity is generated when transmitting and checked when
receiving. Parity error detection sets the PARE bit in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR).
31.6.5
IrDA Mode
The USART features an IrDA mode supplying half-duplex point-to-point wireless communication. It embeds the modulator and demodulator which allows a glueless connection to the
infrared transceivers, as shown in Figure 31-23. The modulator and demodulator are compliant
with the IrDA specification version 1.1 and support data transfer speeds ranging from 2.4 Kb/s to
115.2 Kb/s.
The USART IrDA mode is enabled by setting the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register
(US_MR) to the value 0x8. The IrDA Filter Register (US_IF) allows configuring the demodulator
filter. The USART transmitter and receiver operate in a normal asynchronous mode and all
parameters are accessible. Note that the modulator and the demodulator are activated.
Figure 31-23. Connection to IrDA Transceivers
USART
IrDA
Transceivers
Receiver
Demodulator
RXD
Transmitter
Modulator
TXD
RX
TX
The receiver and the transmitter must be enabled or disabled according to the direction of the
transmission to be managed.
To receive IrDA signals, the following needs to be done:
• Disable TX and Enable RX
365
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• Configure the TXD pin as PIO and set it as an output at 0 (to avoid LED emission). Disable
the internal pull-up (better for power consumption).
Receive data
31.6.5.1
IrDA Modulation
For baud rates up to and including 115.2 Kbits/sec, the RZI modulation scheme is used. “0” is
represented by a light pulse of 3/16th of a bit time. Some examples of signal pulse duration are
shown in Table 31-9.
Table 31-9.
IrDA Pulse Duration
Baud Rate
Pulse Duration (3/16)
2.4 Kb/s
78.13 µs
9.6 Kb/s
19.53 µs
19.2 Kb/s
9.77 µs
38.4 Kb/s
4.88 µs
57.6 Kb/s
3.26 µs
115.2 Kb/s
1.63 µs
Figure 31-24 shows an example of character transmission.
Figure 31-24. IrDA Modulation
Start
Bit
Transmitter
Output
0
Stop
Bit
Data Bits
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
TXD
3
16 Bit Period
Bit Period
31.6.5.2
IrDA Baud Rate
Table 31-10 gives some examples of CD values, baud rate error and pulse duration. Note that
the requirement on the maximum acceptable error of ±1.87% must be met.
Table 31-10. IrDA Baud Rate Error
Peripheral Clock
366
Baud Rate
CD
Baud Rate Error
Pulse Time
3 686 400
115 200
2
0.00%
1.63
20 000 000
115 200
11
1.38%
1.63
32 768 000
115 200
18
1.25%
1.63
40 000 000
115 200
22
1.38%
1.63
3 686 400
57 600
4
0.00%
3.26
20 000 000
57 600
22
1.38%
3.26
32 768 000
57 600
36
1.25%
3.26
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 31-10. IrDA Baud Rate Error (Continued)
Peripheral Clock
31.6.5.3
Baud Rate
CD
Baud Rate Error
Pulse Time
40 000 000
57 600
43
0.93%
3.26
3 686 400
38 400
6
0.00%
4.88
20 000 000
38 400
33
1.38%
4.88
32 768 000
38 400
53
0.63%
4.88
40 000 000
38 400
65
0.16%
4.88
3 686 400
19 200
12
0.00%
9.77
20 000 000
19 200
65
0.16%
9.77
32 768 000
19 200
107
0.31%
9.77
40 000 000
19 200
130
0.16%
9.77
3 686 400
9 600
24
0.00%
19.53
20 000 000
9 600
130
0.16%
19.53
32 768 000
9 600
213
0.16%
19.53
40 000 000
9 600
260
0.16%
19.53
3 686 400
2 400
96
0.00%
78.13
20 000 000
2 400
521
0.03%
78.13
32 768 000
2 400
853
0.04%
78.13
IrDA Demodulator
The demodulator is based on the IrDA Receive filter comprised of an 8-bit down counter which is
loaded with the value programmed in US_IF. When a falling edge is detected on the RXD pin,
the Filter Counter starts counting down at the Master Clock (MCK) speed. If a rising edge is
detected on the RXD pin, the counter stops and is reloaded with US_IF. If no rising edge is
detected when the counter reaches 0, the input of the receiver is driven low during one bit time.
Figure 31-25 illustrates the operations of the IrDA demodulator.
Figure 31-25. IrDA Demodulator Operations
MCK
RXD
Counter
Value
Receiver
Input
6
5
4 3
Pulse
Rejected
2
6
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Pulse
Accepted
As the IrDA mode uses the same logic as the ISO7816, note that the FI_DI_RATIO field in
US_FIDI must be set to a value higher than 0 in order to assure IrDA communications operate
correctly.
367
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.6.6
RS485 Mode
The USART features the RS485 mode to enable line driver control. While operating in RS485
mode, the USART behaves as though in asynchronous or synchronous mode and configuration
of all the parameters is possible. The difference is that the RTS pin is driven high when the
transmitter is operating. The behavior of the RTS pin is controlled by the TXEMPTY bit. A typical
connection of the USART to a RS485 bus is shown in Figure 31-26.
Figure 31-26. Typical Connection to a RS485 Bus
USART
RXD
Differential
Bus
TXD
RTS
The USART is set in RS485 mode by programming the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x1.
The RTS pin is at a level inverse to the TXEMPTY bit. Significantly, the RTS pin remains high
when a timeguard is programmed so that the line can remain driven after the last character completion. Figure 31-27 gives an example of the RTS waveform during a character transmission
when the timeguard is enabled.
Figure 31-27. Example of RTS Drive with Timeguard
TG = 4
Baud Rate
Clock
TXD
Start
D0
Bit
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Stop
Bit Bit
Write
US_THR
TXRDY
TXEMPTY
RTS
368
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.6.7
Modem Mode
The USART features modem mode, which enables control of the signals: DTR (Data Terminal
Ready), DSR (Data Set Ready), RTS (Request to Send), CTS (Clear to Send), DCD (Data Carrier Detect) and RI (Ring Indicator). While operating in modem mode, the USART behaves as a
DTE (Data Terminal Equipment) as it drives DTR and RTS and can detect level change on DSR,
DCD, CTS and RI.
Setting the USART in modem mode is performed by writing the USART_MODE field in the Mode
Register (US_MR) to the value 0x3. While operating in modem mode the USART behaves as
though in asynchronous mode and all the parameter configurations are available.
Table 31-11 gives the correspondence of the USART signals with modem connection standards.
Table 31-11. Circuit References
USART Pin
V24
CCITT
Direction
TXD
2
103
From terminal to modem
RTS
4
105
From terminal to modem
DTR
20
108.2
From terminal to modem
RXD
3
104
From modem to terminal
CTS
5
106
From terminal to modem
DSR
6
107
From terminal to modem
DCD
8
109
From terminal to modem
RI
22
125
From terminal to modem
The control of the DTR output pin is performed by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the
DTRDIS and DTREN bits respectively at 1. The disable command forces the corresponding pin
to its inactive level, i.e. high. The enable command forces the corresponding pin to its active
level, i.e. low. RTS output pin is automatically controlled in this mode
The level changes are detected on the RI, DSR, DCD and CTS pins. If an input change is
detected, the RIIC, DSRIC, DCDIC and CTSIC bits in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR)
are set respectively and can trigger an interrupt. The status is automatically cleared when
US_CSR is read. Furthermore, the CTS automatically disables the transmitter when it is
detected at its inactive state. If a character is being transmitted when the CTS rises, the character transmission is completed before the transmitter is actually disabled.
31.6.8
Test Modes
The USART can be programmed to operate in three different test modes. The internal loopback
capability allows on-board diagnostics. In the loopback mode the USART interface pins are disconnected or not and reconfigured for loopback internally or externally.
31.6.8.1
Normal Mode
Normal mode connects the RXD pin on the receiver input and the transmitter output on the TXD
pin.
369
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 31-28. Normal Mode Configuration
RXD
Receiver
TXD
Transmitter
31.6.8.2
Automatic Echo Mode
Automatic echo mode allows bit-by-bit retransmission. When a bit is received on the RXD pin, it
is sent to the TXD pin, as shown in Figure 31-29. Programming the transmitter has no effect on
the TXD pin. The RXD pin is still connected to the receiver input, thus the receiver remains
active.
Figure 31-29. Automatic Echo Mode Configuration
RXD
Receiver
TXD
Transmitter
31.6.8.3
Local Loopback Mode
Local loopback mode connects the output of the transmitter directly to the input of the receiver,
as shown in Figure 31-30. The TXD and RXD pins are not used. The RXD pin has no effect on
the receiver and the TXD pin is continuously driven high, as in idle state.
Figure 31-30. Local Loopback Mode Configuration
RXD
Receiver
Transmitter
31.6.8.4
370
1
TXD
Remote Loopback Mode
Remote loopback mode directly connects the RXD pin to the TXD pin, as shown in Figure 31-31.
The transmitter and the receiver are disabled and have no effect. This mode allows bit-by-bit
retransmission.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 31-31. Remote Loopback Mode Configuration
Receiver
1
RXD
TXD
Transmitter
371
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.7
(Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART) User Interface
Table 31-12. Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x0000
Control Register
US_CR
Write-only
–
0x0004
Mode Register
US_MR
Read-write
–
0x0008
Interrupt Enable Register
US_IER
Write-only
–
0x000C
Interrupt Disable Register
US_IDR
Write-only
–
0x0010
Interrupt Mask Register
US_IMR
Read-only
0x0
0x0014
Channel Status Register
US_CSR
Read-only
–
0x0018
Receiver Holding Register
US_RHR
Read-only
0x0
0x001C
Transmitter Holding Register
US_THR
Write-only
–
0x0020
Baud Rate Generator Register
US_BRGR
Read-write
0x0
0x0024
Receiver Time-out Register
US_RTOR
Read-write
0x0
0x0028
Transmitter Timeguard Register
US_TTGR
Read-write
0x0
–
–
–
0x2C - 0x3C
0x0040
FI DI Ratio Register
US_FIDI
Read-write
0x174
0x0044
Number of Errors Register
US_NER
Read-only
–
0x0048
Reserved
–
–
–
0x004C
IrDA Filter Register
US_IF
Read-write
0x0
Reserved
–
–
–
Reserved for PDC Registers
–
–
–
0x5C - 0xFC
0x100 - 0x128
372
Reserved
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.7.1
Name:
USART Control Register
US_CR
Access Type:Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
RTSDIS
18
RTSEN
17
DTRDIS
16
DTREN
15
RETTO
14
RSTNACK
13
RSTIT
12
SENDA
11
STTTO
10
STPBRK
9
STTBRK
8
RSTSTA
7
TXDIS
6
TXEN
5
RXDIS
4
RXEN
3
RSTTX
2
RSTRX
1
–
0
–
• RSTRX: Reset Receiver
0: No effect.
1: Resets the receiver.
• RSTTX: Reset Transmitter
0: No effect.
1: Resets the transmitter.
• RXEN: Receiver Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the receiver, if RXDIS is 0.
• RXDIS: Receiver Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the receiver.
• TXEN: Transmitter Enable
0: No effect.
1: Enables the transmitter if TXDIS is 0.
• TXDIS: Transmitter Disable
0: No effect.
1: Disables the transmitter.
• RSTSTA: Reset Status Bits
0: No effect.
1: Resets the status bits PARE, FRAME, OVRE, and RXBRK in US_CSR.
• STTBRK: Start Break
0: No effect.
1: Starts transmission of a break after the characters present in US_THR and the Transmit Shift Register have been transmitted. No effect if a break is already being transmitted.
373
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• STPBRK: Stop Break
0: No effect.
1: Stops transmission of the break after a minimum of one character length and transmits a high level during 12-bit periods.
No effect if no break is being transmitted.
• STTTO: Start Time-out
0: No effect.
1: Starts waiting for a character before clocking the time-out counter. Resets the status bit TIMEOUT in US_CSR.
• SENDA: Send Address
0: No effect.
1: In Multidrop Mode only, the next character written to the US_THR is sent with the address bit set.
• RSTIT: Reset Iterations
0: No effect.
1: Resets ITERATION in US_CSR. No effect if the ISO7816 is not enabled.
• RSTNACK: Reset Non Acknowledge
0: No effect
1: Resets NACK in US_CSR.
• RETTO: Rearm Time-out
0: No effect
1: Restart Time-out
• DTREN: Data Terminal Ready Enable
0: No effect.
1: Drives the pin DTR at 0.
• DTRDIS: Data Terminal Ready Disable
0: No effect.
1: Drives the pin DTR to 1.
• RTSEN: Request to Send Enable
0: No effect.
1: Drives the pin RTS to 0.
• RTSDIS: Request to Send Disable
0: No effect.
1: Drives the pin RTS to 1.
374
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.7.2
Name:
USART Mode Register
US_MR
Access Type:Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
FILTER
27
–
26
25
MAX_ITERATION
24
23
–
22
–
21
DSNACK
20
INACK
19
OVER
18
CLKO
17
MODE9
16
MSBF
15
14
13
12
11
10
PAR
9
8
SYNC
4
3
2
1
0
CHMODE
7
NBSTOP
6
5
CHRL
USCLKS
USART_MODE
• USART_MODE
USART_MODE
Mode of the USART
0
0
0
0
Normal
0
0
0
1
RS485
0
0
1
0
Hardware Handshaking
0
0
1
1
Modem
0
1
0
0
IS07816 Protocol: T = 0
0
1
0
1
Reserved
0
1
1
0
IS07816 Protocol: T = 1
0
1
1
1
Reserved
1
0
0
0
IrDA
1
1
x
x
Reserved
• USCLKS: Clock Selection
USCLKS
Selected Clock
0
0
MCK
0
1
MCK/DIV (DIV = 8)
1
0
Reserved
1
1
SCK
375
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• CHRL: Character Length.
CHRL
Character Length
0
0
5 bits
0
1
6 bits
1
0
7 bits
1
1
8 bits
• SYNC: Synchronous Mode Select
0: USART operates in Asynchronous Mode.
1: USART operates in Synchronous Mode.
• PAR: Parity Type
PAR
Parity Type
0
0
0
Even parity
0
0
1
Odd parity
0
1
0
Parity forced to 0 (Space)
0
1
1
Parity forced to 1 (Mark)
1
0
x
No parity
1
1
x
Multidrop mode
• NBSTOP: Number of Stop Bits
NBSTOP
Asynchronous (SYNC = 0)
Synchronous (SYNC = 1)
0
0
1 stop bit
1 stop bit
0
1
1.5 stop bits
Reserved
1
0
2 stop bits
2 stop bits
1
1
Reserved
Reserved
• CHMODE: Channel Mode
CHMODE
Mode Description
0
0
Normal Mode
0
1
Automatic Echo. Receiver input is connected to the TXD pin.
1
0
Local Loopback. Transmitter output is connected to the Receiver Input..
1
1
Remote Loopback. RXD pin is internally connected to the TXD pin.
• MSBF: Bit Order
0: Least Significant Bit is sent/received first.
1: Most Significant Bit is sent/received first.
376
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• MODE9: 9-bit Character Length
0: CHRL defines character length.
1: 9-bit character length.
• CLKO: Clock Output Select
0: The USART does not drive the SCK pin.
1: The USART drives the SCK pin if USCLKS does not select the external clock SCK.
• OVER: Oversampling Mode
0: 16x Oversampling.
1: 8x Oversampling.
• INACK: Inhibit Non Acknowledge
0: The NACK is generated.
1: The NACK is not generated.
• DSNACK: Disable Successive NACK
0: NACK is sent on the ISO line as soon as a parity error occurs in the received character (unless INACK is set).
1: Successive parity errors are counted up to the value specified in the MAX_ITERATION field. These parity errors generate a NACK on the ISO line. As soon as this value is reached, no additional NACK is sent on the ISO line. The flag
ITERATION is asserted.
• MAX_ITERATION
Defines the maximum number of iterations in mode ISO7816, protocol T= 0.
• FILTER: Infrared Receive Line Filter
0: The USART does not filter the receive line.
1: The USART filters the receive line using a three-sample filter (1/16-bit clock) (2 over 3 majority).
377
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.7.3
Name:
USART Interrupt Enable Register
US_IER
Access Type:Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
CTSIC
18
DCDIC
17
DSRIC
16
RIIC
15
–
14
–
13
NACK
12
RXBUFF
11
TXBUFE
10
ITERATION
9
TXEMPTY
8
TIMEOUT
7
PARE
6
FRAME
5
OVRE
4
ENDTX
3
ENDRX
2
RXBRK
1
TXRDY
0
RXRDY
• RXRDY: RXRDY Interrupt Enable
• TXRDY: TXRDY Interrupt Enable
• RXBRK: Receiver Break Interrupt Enable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Transfer Interrupt Enable
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Interrupt Enable
• OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable
• FRAME: Framing Error Interrupt Enable
• PARE: Parity Error Interrupt Enable
• TIMEOUT: Time-out Interrupt Enable
• TXEMPTY: TXEMPTY Interrupt Enable
• ITERATION: Iteration Interrupt Enable
• TXBUFE: Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable
• RXBUFF: Buffer Full Interrupt Enable
• NACK: Non Acknowledge Interrupt Enable
• RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Enable
• DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Enable
• DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Interrupt Enable
• CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Interrupt Enable
378
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.7.4
Name:
USART Interrupt Disable Register
US_IDR
Access Type:Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
CTSIC
18
DCDIC
17
DSRIC
16
RIIC
15
–
14
–
13
NACK
12
RXBUFF
11
TXBUFE
10
ITERATION
9
TXEMPTY
8
TIMEOUT
7
PARE
6
FRAME
5
OVRE
4
ENDTX
3
ENDRX
2
RXBRK
1
TXRDY
0
RXRDY
• RXRDY: RXRDY Interrupt Disable
• TXRDY: TXRDY Interrupt Disable
• RXBRK: Receiver Break Interrupt Disable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Transfer Interrupt Disable
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Interrupt Disable
• OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable
• FRAME: Framing Error Interrupt Disable
• PARE: Parity Error Interrupt Disable
• TIMEOUT: Time-out Interrupt Disable
• TXEMPTY: TXEMPTY Interrupt Disable
• ITERATION: Iteration Interrupt Disable
• TXBUFE: Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable
• RXBUFF: Buffer Full Interrupt Disable
• NACK: Non Acknowledge Interrupt Disable
• RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Disable
• DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Disable
• DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Interrupt Disable
• CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Interrupt Disable
379
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.7.5
Name:
USART Interrupt Mask Register
US_IMR
Access Type:Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
CTSIC
18
DCDIC
17
DSRIC
16
RIIC
15
–
14
–
13
NACK
12
RXBUFF
11
TXBUFE
10
ITERATION
9
TXEMPTY
8
TIMEOUT
7
PARE
6
FRAME
5
OVRE
4
ENDTX
3
ENDRX
2
RXBRK
1
TXRDY
0
RXRDY
• RXRDY: RXRDY Interrupt Mask
• TXRDY: TXRDY Interrupt Mask
• RXBRK: Receiver Break Interrupt Mask
• ENDRX: End of Receive Transfer Interrupt Mask
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Interrupt Mask
• OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask
• FRAME: Framing Error Interrupt Mask
• PARE: Parity Error Interrupt Mask
• TIMEOUT: Time-out Interrupt Mask
• TXEMPTY: TXEMPTY Interrupt Mask
• ITERATION: Iteration Interrupt Mask
• TXBUFE: Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask
• RXBUFF: Buffer Full Interrupt Mask
• NACK: Non Acknowledge Interrupt Mask
• RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Mask
• DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Mask
• DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Interrupt Mask
• CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Interrupt Mask
380
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.7.6
Name:
USART Channel Status Register
US_CSR
Access Type:Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
CTS
22
DCD
21
DSR
20
RI
19
CTSIC
18
DCDIC
17
DSRIC
16
RIIC
15
–
14
–
13
NACK
12
RXBUFF
11
TXBUFE
10
ITERATION
9
TXEMPTY
8
TIMEOUT
7
PARE
6
FRAME
5
OVRE
4
ENDTX
3
ENDRX
2
RXBRK
1
TXRDY
0
RXRDY
• RXRDY: Receiver Ready
0: No complete character has been received since the last read of US_RHR or the receiver is disabled. If characters were
being received when the receiver was disabled, RXRDY changes to 1 when the receiver is enabled.
1: At least one complete character has been received and US_RHR has not yet been read.
• TXRDY: Transmitter Ready
0: A character is in the US_THR waiting to be transferred to the Transmit Shift Register, or an STTBRK command has been
requested, or the transmitter is disabled. As soon as the transmitter is enabled, TXRDY becomes 1.
1: There is no character in the US_THR.
• RXBRK: Break Received/End of Break
0: No Break received or End of Break detected since the last RSTSTA.
1: Break Received or End of Break detected since the last RSTSTA.
• ENDRX: End of Receiver Transfer
0: The End of Transfer signal from the Receive PDC channel is inactive.
1: The End of Transfer signal from the Receive PDC channel is active.
• ENDTX: End of Transmitter Transfer
0: The End of Transfer signal from the Transmit PDC channel is inactive.
1: The End of Transfer signal from the Transmit PDC channel is active.
• OVRE: Overrun Error
0: No overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA.
1: At least one overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA.
• FRAME: Framing Error
0: No stop bit has been detected low since the last RSTSTA.
1: At least one stop bit has been detected low since the last RSTSTA.
381
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• PARE: Parity Error
0: No parity error has been detected since the last RSTSTA.
1: At least one parity error has been detected since the last RSTSTA.
• TIMEOUT: Receiver Time-out
0: There has not been a time-out since the last Start Time-out command (STTTO in US_CR) or the Time-out Register is 0.
1: There has been a time-out since the last Start Time-out command (STTTO in US_CR).
• TXEMPTY: Transmitter Empty
0: There are characters in either US_THR or the Transmit Shift Register, or the transmitter is disabled.
1: There are no characters in US_THR, nor in the Transmit Shift Register.
• ITERATION: Max number of Repetitions Reached
0: Maximum number of repetitions has not been reached since the last RSIT.
1: Maximum number of repetitions has been reached since the last RSIT.
• TXBUFE: Transmission Buffer Empty
0: The signal Buffer Empty from the Transmit PDC channel is inactive.
1: The signal Buffer Empty from the Transmit PDC channel is active.
• RXBUFF: Reception Buffer Full
0: The signal Buffer Full from the Receive PDC channel is inactive.
1: The signal Buffer Full from the Receive PDC channel is active.
• NACK: Non Acknowledge
0: No Non Acknowledge has not been detected since the last RSTNACK.
1: At least one Non Acknowledge has been detected since the last RSTNACK.
• RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Flag
0: No input change has been detected on the RI pin since the last read of US_CSR.
1: At least one input change has been detected on the RI pin since the last read of US_CSR.
• DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Flag
0: No input change has been detected on the DSR pin since the last read of US_CSR.
1: At least one input change has been detected on the DSR pin since the last read of US_CSR.
• DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Flag
0: No input change has been detected on the DCD pin since the last read of US_CSR.
1: At least one input change has been detected on the DCD pin since the last read of US_CSR.
• CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Flag
0: No input change has been detected on the CTS pin since the last read of US_CSR.
1: At least one input change has been detected on the CTS pin since the last read of US_CSR.
• RI: Image of RI Input
0: RI is at 0.
1: RI is at 1.
382
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• DSR: Image of DSR Input
0: DSR is at 0
1: DSR is at 1.
• DCD: Image of DCD Input
0: DCD is at 0.
1: DCD is at 1.
• CTS: Image of CTS Input
0: CTS is at 0.
1: CTS is at 1.
383
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.7.7
Name:
USART Receive Holding Register
US_RHR
Access Type:Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
RXSYNH
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
RXCHR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RXCHR
• RXCHR: Received Character
Last character received if RXRDY is set.
• RXSYNH: Received Sync
0: Last Character received is a Data.
1: Last Character received is a Command.
384
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.7.8
Name:
USART Transmit Holding Register
US_THR
Access Type:Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
TXSYNH
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
TXCHR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TXCHR
• TXCHR: Character to be Transmitted
Next character to be transmitted after the current character if TXRDY is not set.
• TXSYNH: Sync Field to be transmitted
0: The next character sent is encoded as a data. Start Frame Delimiter is DATA SYNC.
1: The next character sent is encoded as a command. Start Frame Delimiter is COMMAND SYNC.
385
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.7.9
Name:
USART Baud Rate Generator Register
US_BRGR
Access Type:Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
17
FP
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CD
7
6
5
4
CD
• CD: Clock Divider
USART_MODE ≠ ISO7816
SYNC = 0
CD
OVER = 0
USART_MODE =
ISO7816
OVER = 1
0
1 to 65535
SYNC = 1
Baud Rate Clock Disabled
Baud Rate =
Selected Clock/16/CD
Baud Rate =
Selected Clock/8/CD
Baud Rate =
Selected Clock /CD
Baud Rate = Selected
Clock/CD/FI_DI_RATIO
• FP: Fractional Part
0: Fractional divider is disabled.
1 - 7: Baudrate resolution, defined by FP x 1/8.
386
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.7.10
Name:
USART Receiver Time-out Register
US_RTOR
Access Type:Read-write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
TO
7
6
5
4
TO
• TO: Time-out Value
0: The Receiver Time-out is disabled.
1 - 65535: The Receiver Time-out is enabled and the Time-out delay is TO x Bit Period.
387
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.7.11
Name:
USART Transmitter Timeguard Register
US_TTGR
Access Type:Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TG
• TG: Timeguard Value
0: The Transmitter Timeguard is disabled.
1 - 255: The Transmitter timeguard is enabled and the timeguard delay is TG x Bit Period.
388
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
31.7.12
Name:
USART FI DI RATIO Register
US_FIDI
Access Type:Read-write
Reset Value :0x174
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
9
FI_DI_RATIO
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FI_DI_RATIO
• FI_DI_RATIO: FI Over DI Ratio Value
0: If ISO7816 mode is selected, the Baud Rate Generator generates no signal.
1 - 2047: If ISO7816 mode is selected, the Baud Rate is the clock provided on SCK divided by FI_DI_RATIO.
31.7.13
Name:
USART Number of Errors Register
US_NER
Access Type:Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NB_ERRORS
• NB_ERRORS: Number of Errors
Total number of errors that occurred during an ISO7816 transfer. This register automatically clears when read.
389
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
31.7.14
Name:
USART IrDA FILTER Register
US_IF
Access Type:Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IRDA_FILTER
• IRDA_FILTER: IrDA Filter
Sets the filter of the IrDA demodulator.
390
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32. Timer Counter (TC)
32.1
Overview
The Timer Counter (TC) includes three identical 16-bit Timer Counter channels.
Each channel can be independently programmed to perform a wide range of functions including
frequency measurement, event counting, interval measurement, pulse generation, delay timing
and pulse width modulation.
Each channel has three external clock inputs, five internal clock inputs and two multi-purpose
input/output signals which can be configured by the user. Each channel drives an internal interrupt signal which can be programmed to generate processor interrupts.
The Timer Counter block has two global registers which act upon all three TC channels.
The Block Control Register allows the three channels to be started simultaneously with the same
instruction.
The Block Mode Register defines the external clock inputs for each channel, allowing them to be
chained.
Table 32-1 gives the assignment of the device Timer Counter clock inputs common to Timer
Counter 0 to 2
Table 32-1.
Timer Counter Clock Assignment
Name
Definition
TIMER_CLOCK1
MCK/2
TIMER_CLOCK2
MCK/8
TIMER_CLOCK3
MCK/32
TIMER_CLOCK4
MCK/128
TIMER_CLOCK5
MCK/1024
391
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.2
Block Diagram
Figure 32-1. Timer Counter Block Diagram
Parallel I/O
Controller
TIMER_CLOCK1
TCLK0
TIMER_CLOCK2
TIOA1
TIOA2
TIMER_CLOCK3
XC0
XC1
TCLK1
Timer/Counter
Channel 0
TIOA
TIOA0
TIOB0
TIOA0
TIOB
TIMER_CLOCK4
XC2
TCLK2
TIMER_CLOCK5
TIOB0
TC0XC0S
SYNC
TCLK0
TCLK1
TCLK2
INT0
TCLK0
XC0
TCLK1
TIOA0
XC1
Timer/Counter
Channel 1
TIOA
TIOA1
TIOB1
TIOA1
TIOB
TIOA2
TCLK2
XC2
TIOB1
SYNC
TC1XC1S
TCLK0
XC0
TCLK1
XC1
TCLK2
XC2
Timer/Counter
Channel 2
INT1
TIOA
TIOA2
TIOB2
TIOA2
TIOB
TIOA0
TIOA1
TC2XC2S
TIOB2
SYNC
INT2
Timer Counter
Advanced
Interrupt
Controller
Table 32-2.
Signal Name Description
Block/Channel
Signal Name
XC0, XC1, XC2
Channel Signal
External Clock Inputs
TIOA
Capture Mode: Timer Counter Input
Waveform Mode: Timer Counter Output
TIOB
Capture Mode: Timer Counter Input
Waveform Mode: Timer Counter Input/Output
INT
SYNC
392
Description
Interrupt Signal Output
Synchronization Input Signal
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.3
Pin Name List
Table 32-3.
32.4
32.4.1
TC pin list
Pin Name
Description
Type
TCLK0-TCLK2
External Clock Input
Input
TIOA0-TIOA2
I/O Line A
I/O
TIOB0-TIOB2
I/O Line B
I/O
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines
The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines.
The programmer must first program the PIO controllers to assign the TC pins to their peripheral
functions.
32.4.2
Power Management
The TC is clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), thus the programmer must
first configure the PMC to enable the Timer Counter clock.
32.4.3
Interrupt
The TC has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling the
TC interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the TC.
393
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.5
Functional Description
32.5.1
TC Description
The three channels of the Timer Counter are independent and identical in operation. The registers for channel programming are listed in Table 32-4 on page 407.
32.5.2
16-bit Counter
Each channel is organized around a 16-bit counter. The value of the counter is incremented at
each positive edge of the selected clock. When the counter has reached the value 0xFFFF and
passes to 0x0000, an overflow occurs and the COVFS bit in TC_SR (Status Register) is set.
The current value of the counter is accessible in real time by reading the Counter Value Register, TC_CV. The counter can be reset by a trigger. In this case, the counter value passes to
0x0000 on the next valid edge of the selected clock.
32.5.3
Clock Selection
At block level, input clock signals of each channel can either be connected to the external inputs
TCLK0, TCLK1 or TCLK2, or be connected to the internal I/O signals TIOA0, TIOA1 or TIOA2
for chaining by programming the TC_BMR (Block Mode). See Figure 32-2 on page 395.
Each channel can independently select an internal or external clock source for its counter:
•
Internal clock signals: TIMER_CLOCK1, TIMER_CLOCK2, TIMER_CLOCK3,
TIMER_CLOCK4, TIMER_CLOCK5
•
External clock signals: XC0, XC1 or XC2
This selection is made by the TCCLKS bits in the TC Channel Mode Register.
The selected clock can be inverted with the CLKI bit in TC_CMR. This allows counting on the
opposite edges of the clock.
The burst function allows the clock to be validated when an external signal is high. The BURST
parameter in the Mode Register defines this signal (none, XC0, XC1, XC2). See Figure 32-3 on
page 395
Note:
394
In all cases, if an external clock is used, the duration of each of its levels must be longer than the
master clock period. The external clock frequency must be at least 2.5 times lower than the master clock
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 32-2. Clock Chaining Selection
TC0XC0S
Timer/Counter
Channel 0
TCLK0
TIOA1
XC0
TIOA2
TIOA0
XC1 = TCLK1
XC2 = TCLK2
TIOB0
SYNC
TC1XC1S
Timer/Counter
Channel 1
TCLK1
XC0 = TCLK2
TIOA0
TIOA1
XC1
TIOA2
XC2 = TCLK2
TIOB1
SYNC
Timer/Counter
Channel 2
TC2XC2S
XC0 = TCLK0
TCLK2
TIOA2
XC1 = TCLK1
TIOA0
XC2
TIOB2
TIOA1
SYNC
Figure 32-3. Clock Selection
TCCLKS
TIMER_CLOCK1
TIMER_CLOCK2
CLKI
TIMER_CLOCK3
TIMER_CLOCK4
TIMER_CLOCK5
Selected
Clock
XC0
XC1
XC2
BURST
1
395
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.5.4
Clock Control
The clock of each counter can be controlled in two different ways: it can be enabled/disabled
and started/stopped. See Figure 32-4.
•
The clock can be enabled or disabled by the user with the CLKEN and the CLKDIS
commands in the Control Register. In Capture Mode it can be disabled by an RB load event
if LDBDIS is set to 1 in TC_CMR. In Waveform Mode, it can be disabled by an RC Compare
event if CPCDIS is set to 1 in TC_CMR. When disabled, the start or the stop actions have no
effect: only a CLKEN command in the Control Register can re-enable the clock. When the
clock is enabled, the CLKSTA bit is set in the Status Register.
•
The clock can also be started or stopped: a trigger (software, synchro, external or compare)
always starts the clock. The clock can be stopped by an RB load event in Capture Mode
(LDBSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR) or a RC compare event in Waveform Mode (CPCSTOP = 1 in
TC_CMR). The start and the stop commands have effect only if the clock is enabled.
Figure 32-4. Clock Control
Selected
Clock
Trigger
CLKSTA
CLKEN
Q
Q
S
CLKDIS
S
R
R
Counter
Clock
32.5.5
Stop
Event
Disable
Event
TC Operating Modes
Each channel can independently operate in two different modes:
•
Capture Mode provides measurement on signals.
•
Waveform Mode provides wave generation.
The TC Operating Mode is programmed with the WAVE bit in the TC Channel Mode Register.
In Capture Mode, TIOA and TIOB are configured as inputs.
In Waveform Mode, TIOA is always configured to be an output and TIOB is an output if it is not
selected to be the external trigger.
32.5.6
Trigger
A trigger resets the counter and starts the counter clock. Three types of triggers are common to
both modes, and a fourth external trigger is available to each mode.
The following triggers are common to both modes:
396
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
•
Software Trigger: Each channel has a software trigger, available by setting SWTRG in
TC_CCR.
•
SYNC: Each channel has a synchronization signal SYNC. When asserted, this signal has
the same effect as a software trigger. The SYNC signals of all channels are asserted
simultaneously by writing TC_BCR (Block Control) with SYNC set.
•
Compare RC Trigger: RC is implemented in each channel and can provide a trigger when
the counter value matches the RC value if CPCTRG is set in TC_CMR.
The channel can also be configured to have an external trigger. In Capture Mode, the external
trigger signal can be selected between TIOA and TIOB. In Waveform Mode, an external event
can be programmed on one of the following signals: TIOB, XC0, XC1 or XC2. This external
event can then be programmed to perform a trigger by setting ENETRG in TC_CMR.
If an external trigger is used, the duration of the pulses must be longer than the master clock
period in order to be detected.
Regardless of the trigger used, it will be taken into account at the following active edge of the
selected clock. This means that the counter value can be read differently from zero just after a
trigger, especially when a low frequency signal is selected as the clock.
32.5.7
Capture Operating Mode
This mode is entered by clearing the WAVE parameter in TC_CMR (Channel Mode Register).
Capture Mode allows the TC channel to perform measurements such as pulse timing, frequency, period, duty cycle and phase on TIOA and TIOB signals which are considered as
inputs.
Figure 32-5 shows the configuration of the TC channel when programmed in Capture Mode.
32.5.8
Capture Registers A and B
Registers A and B (RA and RB) are used as capture registers. This means that they can be
loaded with the counter value when a programmable event occurs on the signal TIOA.
The LDRA parameter in TC_CMR defines the TIOA edge for the loading of register A, and the
LDRB parameter defines the TIOA edge for the loading of Register B.
RA is loaded only if it has not been loaded since the last trigger or if RB has been loaded since
the last loading of RA.
RB is loaded only if RA has been loaded since the last trigger or the last loading of RB.
Loading RA or RB before the read of the last value loaded sets the Overrun Error Flag (LOVRS)
in TC_SR (Status Register). In this case, the old value is overwritten.
32.5.9
Trigger Conditions
In addition to the SYNC signal, the software trigger and the RC compare trigger, an external trigger can be defined.
The ABETRG bit in TC_CMR selects TIOA or TIOB input signal as an external trigger. The
ETRGEDG parameter defines the edge (rising, falling or both) detected to generate an external
trigger. If ETRGEDG = 0 (none), the external trigger is disabled.
397
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
398
MTIOA
MTIOB
1
If RA is not loaded
or RB is Loaded
Edge
Detector
ETRGEDG
SWTRG
Timer/Counter Channel
ABETRG
BURST
CLKI
S
R
OVF
LDRB
Edge
Detector
Edge
Detector
Capture
Register A
LDBSTOP
R
S
CLKEN
LDRA
If RA is Loaded
CPCTRG
16-bit Counter
RESET
Trig
CLK
Q
Q
CLKSTA
LDBDIS
Capture
Register B
CLKDIS
TC1_SR
TIOA
TIOB
SYNC
XC2
XC1
XC0
TIMER_CLOCK5
TIMER_CLOCK4
TIMER_CLOCK3
TIMER_CLOCK2
TIMER_CLOCK1
TCCLKS
Compare RC =
Register C
COVFS
INT
Figure 32-5. Capture Mode
CPCS
LOVRS
LDRBS
ETRGS
LDRAS
TC1_IMR
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.5.10
Waveform Operating Mode
Waveform operating mode is entered by setting the WAVE parameter in TC_CMR (Channel
Mode Register).
In Waveform Operating Mode the TC channel generates 1 or 2 PWM signals with the same frequency and independently programmable duty cycles, or generates different types of one-shot
or repetitive pulses.
In this mode, TIOA is configured as an output and TIOB is defined as an output if it is not used
as an external event (EEVT parameter in TC_CMR).
Figure 32-6 shows the configuration of the TC channel when programmed in Waveform Operating Mode.
32.5.11
Waveform Selection
Depending on the WAVSEL parameter in TC_CMR (Channel Mode Register), the behavior of
TC_CV varies.
With any selection, RA, RB and RC can all be used as compare registers.
RA Compare is used to control the TIOA output, RB Compare is used to control the TIOB output
(if correctly configured) and RC Compare is used to control TIOA and/or TIOB outputs.
399
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
400
TIOB
SYNC
XC2
XC1
XC0
TIMER_CLOCK5
TIMER_CLOCK4
TIMER_CLOCK3
TIMER_CLOCK2
TIMER_CLOCK1
1
EEVT
BURST
Timer/Counter Channel
Edge
Detector
EEVTEDG
SWTRG
ENETRG
CLKI
Trig
CLK
R
S
OVF
WAVSEL
RESET
16-bit Counter
WAVSEL
Q
Compare RA =
Register A
Q
CLKSTA
Compare RC =
Compare RB =
CPCSTOP
CPCDIS
Register C
CLKDIS
Register B
R
S
CLKEN
CPAS
INT
BSWTRG
BEEVT
BCPB
BCPC
ASWTRG
AEEVT
ACPA
ACPC
Output Controller
Output Controller
TCCLKS
TIOB
MTIOB
TIOA
MTIOA
Figure 32-6. Waveform Mode
CPCS
CPBS
COVFS
TC1_SR
ETRGS
TC1_IMR
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.5.11.1
WAVSEL = 00
When WAVSEL = 00, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to 0xFFFF. Once 0xFFFF has
been reached, the value of TC_CV is reset. Incrementation of TC_CV starts again and the cycle
continues. See Figure 32-7.
An external event trigger or a software trigger can reset the value of TC_CV. It is important to
note that the trigger may occur at any time. See Figure 32-8.
RC Compare cannot be programmed to generate a trigger in this configuration. At the same
time, RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR) and/or disable the
counter clock (CPCDIS = 1 in TC_CMR).
Figure 32-7. WAVSEL= 00 without trigger
Counter Value
Counter cleared by compare match with 0xFFFF
0xFFFF
RC
RB
RA
Waveform Examples
Time
TIOB
TIOA
401
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 32-8. WAVSEL= 00 with trigger
Counter cleared by compare match with 0xFFFF
Counter Value
0xFFFF
Counter cleared by trigger
RC
RB
RA
Time
Waveform Examples
TIOB
TIOA
32.5.11.2
WAVSEL = 10
When WAVSEL = 10, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to the value of RC, then automatically reset on a RC Compare. Once the value of TC_CV has been reset, it is then
incremented and so on. See Figure 32-9.
It is important to note that TC_CV can be reset at any time by an external event or a software
trigger if both are programmed correctly. See Figure 32-10.
In addition, RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR) and/or disable
the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1 in TC_CMR).
Figure 32-9. WAVSEL = 10 Without Trigger
Counter Value
0xFFFF
Counter cleared by compare match with RC
RC
RB
RA
Waveform Examples
Time
TIOB
TIOA
402
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 32-10. WAVSEL = 10 With Trigger
Counter Value
0xFFFF
Counter cleared by compare match with RC
Counter cleared by trigger
RC
RB
RA
Waveform Examples
Time
TIOB
TIOA
32.5.11.3
WAVSEL = 01
When WAVSEL = 01, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to 0xFFFF. Once 0xFFFF is
reached, the value of TC_CV is decremented to 0, then re-incremented to 0xFFFF and so on.
See Figure 32-11.
A trigger such as an external event or a software trigger can modify TC_CV at any time. If a trigger occurs while TC_CV is incrementing, TC_CV then decrements. If a trigger is received while
TC_CV is decrementing, TC_CV then increments. See Figure 32-12.
RC Compare cannot be programmed to generate a trigger in this configuration.
At the same time, RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1) and/or disable the
counter clock (CPCDIS = 1).
403
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 32-11. WAVSEL = 01 Without Trigger
Counter decremented by compare match with 0xFFFF
Counter Value
0xFFFF
RC
RB
RA
Time
Waveform Examples
TIOB
TIOA
Figure 32-12. WAVSEL = 01 With Trigger
Counter Value
Counter decremented by compare match with 0xFFFF
0xFFFF
Counter decremented
by trigger
RC
RB
Counter incremented
by trigger
RA
Time
Waveform Examples
TIOB
TIOA
32.5.11.4
WAVSEL = 11
When WAVSEL = 11, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to RC. Once RC is reached, the
value of TC_CV is decremented to 0, then re-incremented to RC and so on. See Figure 32-13.
A trigger such as an external event or a software trigger can modify TC_CV at any time. If a trigger occurs while TC_CV is incrementing, TC_CV then decrements. If a trigger is received while
TC_CV is decrementing, TC_CV then increments. See Figure 32-14.
RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1) and/or disable the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1).
404
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 32-13. WAVSEL = 11 Without Trigger
Counter Value
0xFFFF
Counter decremented by compare match with RC
RC
RB
RA
Time
Waveform Examples
TIOB
TIOA
Figure 32-14. WAVSEL = 11 With Trigger
Counter Value
0xFFFF
Counter decremented by compare match with RC
RC
RB
Counter decremented
by trigger
Counter incremented
by trigger
RA
Waveform Examples
Time
TIOB
TIOA
405
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.5.12
External Event/Trigger Conditions
An external event can be programmed to be detected on one of the clock sources (XC0, XC1,
XC2) or TIOB. The external event selected can then be used as a trigger.
The EEVT parameter in TC_CMR selects the external trigger. The EEVTEDG parameter defines
the trigger edge for each of the possible external triggers (rising, falling or both). If EEVTEDG is
cleared (none), no external event is defined.
If TIOB is defined as an external event signal (EEVT = 0), TIOB is no longer used as an output
and the compare register B is not used to generate waveforms and subsequently no IRQs. In
this case the TC channel can only generate a waveform on TIOA.
When an external event is defined, it can be used as a trigger by setting bit ENETRG in
TC_CMR.
As in Capture Mode, the SYNC signal and the software trigger are also available as triggers. RC
Compare can also be used as a trigger depending on the parameter WAVSEL.
32.5.13
Output Controller
The output controller defines the output level changes on TIOA and TIOB following an event.
TIOB control is used only if TIOB is defined as output (not as an external event).
The following events control TIOA and TIOB: software trigger, external event and RC compare.
RA compare controls TIOA and RB compare controls TIOB. Each of these events can be programmed to set, clear or toggle the output as defined in the corresponding parameter in
TC_CMR.
406
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.6
Timer Counter (TC) User Interface
Table 32-4.
Register Mapping
Offset(1)
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x00
Channel Control Register
TC_CCR
Write-only
–
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x04
Channel Mode Register
TC_CMR
Read-write
0
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x08
Reserved
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x0C
Reserved
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x10
Counter Value
TC_CV
Read-only
0
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x14
Register A
TC_RA
Read-write
(2)
0
Read-write
(2)
0
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x18
Register B
TC_RB
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x1C
Register C
TC_RC
Read-write
0
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x20
Status Register
TC_SR
Read-only
0
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x24
Interrupt Enable Register
TC_IER
Write-only
–
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x28
Interrupt Disable Register
TC_IDR
Write-only
–
0x00 + channel * 0x40 + 0x2C
Interrupt Mask Register
TC_IMR
Read-only
0
0xC0
Block Control Register
TC_BCR
Write-only
–
0xC4
Block Mode Register
TC_BMR
Read-write
0
0xFC
Reserved
–
–
–
Notes:
1. Channel index range from 0 to 2.
2. Read-only if WAVE = 0
407
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.6.1
TC Block Control Register
Register Name:
TC_BCR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
SYNC
• SYNC: Synchro Command
0 = No effect.
1 = Asserts the SYNC signal which generates a software trigger simultaneously for each of the channels.
408
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.6.2
TC Block Mode Register
Register Name:
TC_BMR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
–
–
TC2XC2S
TC1XC1S
0
TC0XC0S
• TC0XC0S: External Clock Signal 0 Selection
TC0XC0S
Signal Connected to XC0
0
0
TCLK0
0
1
none
1
0
TIOA1
1
1
TIOA2
• TC1XC1S: External Clock Signal 1 Selection
TC1XC1S
Signal Connected to XC1
0
0
TCLK1
0
1
none
1
0
TIOA0
1
1
TIOA2
• TC2XC2S: External Clock Signal 2 Selection
TC2XC2S
Signal Connected to XC2
0
0
TCLK2
0
1
none
1
0
TIOA0
1
1
TIOA1
409
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.6.3
TC Channel Control Register
Register Name:
TC_CCRx [x=0..2]
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
SWTRG
CLKDIS
CLKEN
• CLKEN: Counter Clock Enable Command
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the clock if CLKDIS is not 1.
• CLKDIS: Counter Clock Disable Command
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the clock.
• SWTRG: Software Trigger Command
0 = No effect.
1 = A software trigger is performed: the counter is reset and the clock is started.
410
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.6.4
TC Channel Mode Register: Capture Mode
Register Name:
TC_CMRx [x=0..2] (WAVE = 0)
Access Type:
Read-write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
WAVE
CPCTRG
–
–
–
ABETRG
7
6
5
3
2
LDBDIS
LDBSTOP
16
LDRB
4
BURST
CLKI
LDRA
9
8
ETRGEDG
1
0
TCCLKS
• TCCLKS: Clock Selection
TCCLKS
Clock Selected
0
0
0
TIMER_CLOCK1
0
0
1
TIMER_CLOCK2
0
1
0
TIMER_CLOCK3
0
1
1
TIMER_CLOCK4
1
0
0
TIMER_CLOCK5
1
0
1
XC0
1
1
0
XC1
1
1
1
XC2
• CLKI: Clock Invert
0 = Counter is incremented on rising edge of the clock.
1 = Counter is incremented on falling edge of the clock.
• BURST: Burst Signal Selection
BURST
0
0
The clock is not gated by an external signal.
0
1
XC0 is ANDed with the selected clock.
1
0
XC1 is ANDed with the selected clock.
1
1
XC2 is ANDed with the selected clock.
• LDBSTOP: Counter Clock Stopped with RB Loading
0 = Counter clock is not stopped when RB loading occurs.
1 = Counter clock is stopped when RB loading occurs.
411
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• LDBDIS: Counter Clock Disable with RB Loading
0 = Counter clock is not disabled when RB loading occurs.
1 = Counter clock is disabled when RB loading occurs.
• ETRGEDG: External Trigger Edge Selection
ETRGEDG
Edge
0
0
none
0
1
rising edge
1
0
falling edge
1
1
each edge
• ABETRG: TIOA or TIOB External Trigger Selection
0 = TIOB is used as an external trigger.
1 = TIOA is used as an external trigger.
• CPCTRG: RC Compare Trigger Enable
0 = RC Compare has no effect on the counter and its clock.
1 = RC Compare resets the counter and starts the counter clock.
• WAVE
0 = Capture Mode is enabled.
1 = Capture Mode is disabled (Waveform Mode is enabled).
• LDRA: RA Loading Selection
LDRA
Edge
0
0
none
0
1
rising edge of TIOA
1
0
falling edge of TIOA
1
1
each edge of TIOA
• LDRB: RB Loading Selection
LDRB
412
Edge
0
0
none
0
1
rising edge of TIOA
1
0
falling edge of TIOA
1
1
each edge of TIOA
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.6.5
TC Channel Mode Register: Waveform Mode
Register Name:
TC_CMRx [x=0..2] (WAVE = 1)
Access Type:
Read-write
31
30
29
BSWTRG
23
22
21
ASWTRG
15
28
27
BEEVT
20
19
AEEVT
14
WAVE
13
7
6
CPCDIS
CPCSTOP
24
BCPB
18
11
ENETRG
5
25
17
16
ACPC
12
WAVSEL
26
BCPC
ACPA
10
9
EEVT
4
3
BURST
CLKI
8
EEVTEDG
2
1
0
TCCLKS
• TCCLKS: Clock Selection
TCCLKS
Clock Selected
0
0
0
TIMER_CLOCK1
0
0
1
TIMER_CLOCK2
0
1
0
TIMER_CLOCK3
0
1
1
TIMER_CLOCK4
1
0
0
TIMER_CLOCK5
1
0
1
XC0
1
1
0
XC1
1
1
1
XC2
• CLKI: Clock Invert
0 = Counter is incremented on rising edge of the clock.
1 = Counter is incremented on falling edge of the clock.
• BURST: Burst Signal Selection
BURST
0
0
The clock is not gated by an external signal.
0
1
XC0 is ANDed with the selected clock.
1
0
XC1 is ANDed with the selected clock.
1
1
XC2 is ANDed with the selected clock.
• CPCSTOP: Counter Clock Stopped with RC Compare
0 = Counter clock is not stopped when counter reaches RC.
1 = Counter clock is stopped when counter reaches RC.
413
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• CPCDIS: Counter Clock Disable with RC Compare
0 = Counter clock is not disabled when counter reaches RC.
1 = Counter clock is disabled when counter reaches RC.
• EEVTEDG: External Event Edge Selection
EEVTEDG
Edge
0
0
none
0
1
rising edge
1
0
falling edge
1
1
each edge
• EEVT: External Event Selection
EEVT
Signal selected as external event
TIOB Direction
0
0
TIOB
input (1)
0
1
XC0
output
1
0
XC1
output
1
1
XC2
output
Note:
1. If TIOB is chosen as the external event signal, it is configured as an input and no longer generates waveforms and subsequently no IRQs.
• ENETRG: External Event Trigger Enable
0 = The external event has no effect on the counter and its clock. In this case, the selected external event only controls the
TIOA output.
1 = The external event resets the counter and starts the counter clock.
• WAVSEL: Waveform Selection
WAVSEL
Effect
0
0
UP mode without automatic trigger on RC Compare
1
0
UP mode with automatic trigger on RC Compare
0
1
UPDOWN mode without automatic trigger on RC Compare
1
1
UPDOWN mode with automatic trigger on RC Compare
• WAVE
0 = Waveform Mode is disabled (Capture Mode is enabled).
1 = Waveform Mode is enabled.
414
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• ACPA: RA Compare Effect on TIOA
ACPA
Effect
0
0
none
0
1
set
1
0
clear
1
1
toggle
• ACPC: RC Compare Effect on TIOA
ACPC
Effect
0
0
none
0
1
set
1
0
clear
1
1
toggle
• AEEVT: External Event Effect on TIOA
AEEVT
Effect
0
0
none
0
1
set
1
0
clear
1
1
toggle
• ASWTRG: Software Trigger Effect on TIOA
ASWTRG
Effect
0
0
none
0
1
set
1
0
clear
1
1
toggle
• BCPB: RB Compare Effect on TIOB
BCPB
Effect
0
0
none
0
1
set
1
0
clear
1
1
toggle
415
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• BCPC: RC Compare Effect on TIOB
BCPC
Effect
0
0
none
0
1
set
1
0
clear
1
1
toggle
• BEEVT: External Event Effect on TIOB
BEEVT
Effect
0
0
none
0
1
set
1
0
clear
1
1
toggle
• BSWTRG: Software Trigger Effect on TIOB
BSWTRG
416
Effect
0
0
none
0
1
set
1
0
clear
1
1
toggle
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.6.6
TC Counter Value Register
Register Name:
TC_CVx [x=0..2]
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CV
7
6
5
4
CV
• CV: Counter Value
CV contains the counter value in real time.
417
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.6.7
TC Register A
Register Name:
TC_RAx [x=0..2]
Access Type:
Read-only if WAVE = 0, Read-write if WAVE = 1
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RA
7
6
5
4
RA
• RA: Register A
RA contains the Register A value in real time.
418
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.6.8
TC Register B
Register Name:
TC_RBx [x=0..2]
Access Type:
Read-only if WAVE = 0, Read-write if WAVE = 1
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RB
7
6
5
4
RB
• RB: Register B
RB contains the Register B value in real time.
32.6.9
TC Register C
Register Name:
TC_RCx [x=0..2]
Access Type:
Read-write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RC
7
6
5
4
RC
• RC: Register C
RC contains the Register C value in real time.
419
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.6.10 TC Status Register
Register Name:
TC_SRx [x=0..2]
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
MTIOB
MTIOA
CLKSTA
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ETRGS
LDRBS
LDRAS
CPCS
CPBS
CPAS
LOVRS
COVFS
• COVFS: Counter Overflow Status
0 = No counter overflow has occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
1 = A counter overflow has occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
• LOVRS: Load Overrun Status
0 = Load overrun has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 1.
1 = RA or RB have been loaded at least twice without any read of the corresponding register since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 0.
• CPAS: RA Compare Status
0 = RA Compare has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 0.
1 = RA Compare has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 1.
• CPBS: RB Compare Status
0 = RB Compare has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 0.
1 = RB Compare has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 1.
• CPCS: RC Compare Status
0 = RC Compare has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
1 = RC Compare has occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
• LDRAS: RA Loading Status
0 = RA Load has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 1.
1 = RA Load has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 0.
• LDRBS: RB Loading Status
0 = RB Load has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 1.
1 = RB Load has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 0.
• ETRGS: External Trigger Status
0 = External trigger has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
1 = External trigger has occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
420
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• CLKSTA: Clock Enabling Status
0 = Clock is disabled.
1 = Clock is enabled.
• MTIOA: TIOA Mirror
0 = TIOA is low. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOA pin is low. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOA is driven low.
1 = TIOA is high. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOA pin is high. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOA is driven high.
• MTIOB: TIOB Mirror
0 = TIOB is low. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOB pin is low. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOB is driven low.
1 = TIOB is high. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOB pin is high. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOB is driven high.
421
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.6.11 TC Interrupt Enable Register
Register Name:
TC_IERx [x=0..2]
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ETRGS
LDRBS
LDRAS
CPCS
CPBS
CPAS
LOVRS
COVFS
• COVFS: Counter Overflow
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the Counter Overflow Interrupt.
• LOVRS: Load Overrun
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the Load Overrun Interrupt.
• CPAS: RA Compare
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the RA Compare Interrupt.
• CPBS: RB Compare
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the RB Compare Interrupt.
• CPCS: RC Compare
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the RC Compare Interrupt.
• LDRAS: RA Loading
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the RA Load Interrupt.
• LDRBS: RB Loading
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the RB Load Interrupt.
• ETRGS: External Trigger
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the External Trigger Interrupt.
422
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
32.6.12 TC Interrupt Disable Register
Register Name:
TC_IDRx [x=0..2]
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ETRGS
LDRBS
LDRAS
CPCS
CPBS
CPAS
LOVRS
COVFS
• COVFS: Counter Overflow
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the Counter Overflow Interrupt.
• LOVRS: Load Overrun
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the Load Overrun Interrupt (if WAVE = 0).
• CPAS: RA Compare
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the RA Compare Interrupt (if WAVE = 1).
• CPBS: RB Compare
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the RB Compare Interrupt (if WAVE = 1).
• CPCS: RC Compare
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the RC Compare Interrupt.
• LDRAS: RA Loading
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the RA Load Interrupt (if WAVE = 0).
• LDRBS: RB Loading
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the RB Load Interrupt (if WAVE = 0).
• ETRGS: External Trigger
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the External Trigger Interrupt.
423
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
32.6.13 TC Interrupt Mask Register
Register Name:
TC_IMRx [x=0..2]
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ETRGS
LDRBS
LDRAS
CPCS
CPBS
CPAS
LOVRS
COVFS
• COVFS: Counter Overflow
0 = The Counter Overflow Interrupt is disabled.
1 = The Counter Overflow Interrupt is enabled.
• LOVRS: Load Overrun
0 = The Load Overrun Interrupt is disabled.
1 = The Load Overrun Interrupt is enabled.
• CPAS: RA Compare
0 = The RA Compare Interrupt is disabled.
1 = The RA Compare Interrupt is enabled.
• CPBS: RB Compare
0 = The RB Compare Interrupt is disabled.
1 = The RB Compare Interrupt is enabled.
• CPCS: RC Compare
0 = The RC Compare Interrupt is disabled.
1 = The RC Compare Interrupt is enabled.
• LDRAS: RA Loading
0 = The Load RA Interrupt is disabled.
1 = The Load RA Interrupt is enabled.
• LDRBS: RB Loading
0 = The Load RB Interrupt is disabled.
1 = The Load RB Interrupt is enabled.
• ETRGS: External Trigger
0 = The External Trigger Interrupt is disabled.
1 = The External Trigger Interrupt is enabled.
424
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
33. Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM)
33.1
Overview
The PWM macrocell controls several channels independently. Each channel controls one
square output waveform. Characteristics of the output waveform such as period, duty-cycle and
polarity are configurable through the user interface. Each channel selects and uses one of the
clocks provided by the clock generator. The clock generator provides several clocks resulting
from the division of the PWM macrocell master clock.
All PWM macrocell accesses are made through APB mapped registers.
Channels can be synchronized, to generate non overlapped waveforms. All channels integrate a
double buffering system in order to prevent an unexpected output waveform while modifying the
period or the duty-cycle.
33.2
Block Diagram
Figure 33-1. Pulse Width Modulation Controller Block Diagram
PWM
Controller
PWMx
Channel
Period
PWMx
Update
Duty Cycle
Clock
Selector
Comparator
PWMx
Counter
PIO
PWM0
Channel
Period
PWM0
Update
Duty Cycle
Clock
Selector
PMC
MCK
Clock Generator
Comparator
PWM0
Counter
APB Interface
Interrupt Generator
AIC
APB
425
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.3
I/O Lines Description
Each channel outputs one waveform on one external I/O line.
Table 33-1.
33.4
33.4.1
I/O Line Description
Name
Description
Type
PWMx
PWM Waveform Output for channel x
Output
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines
The pins used for interfacing the PWM may be multiplexed with PIO lines. The programmer must
first program the PIO controller to assign the desired PWM pins to their peripheral function. If I/O
lines of the PWM are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the
PIO controller.
All of the PWM outputs may or may not be enabled. If an application requires only four channels,
then only four PIO lines will be assigned to PWM outputs.
33.4.2
Power Management
The PWM is not continuously clocked. The programmer must first enable the PWM clock in the
Power Management Controller (PMC) before using the PWM. However, if the application does
not require PWM operations, the PWM clock can be stopped when not needed and be restarted
later. In this case, the PWM will resume its operations where it left off.
Configuring the PWM does not require the PWM clock to be enabled.
33.4.3
33.5
Interrupt Sources
The PWM interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt
Controller. Using the PWM interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. Note that it is not
recommended to use the PWM interrupt line in edge sensitive mode.
Functional Description
The PWM macrocell is primarily composed of a clock generator module and 4 channels.
– Clocked by the system clock, MCK, the clock generator module provides 13 clocks.
– Each channel can independently choose one of the clock generator outputs.
– Each channel generates an output waveform with attributes that can be defined
independently for each channel through the user interface registers.
426
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
33.5.1
PWM Clock Generator
Figure 33-2. Functional View of the Clock Generator Block Diagram
MCK
modulo n counter
MCK
MCK/2
MCK/4
MCK/8
MCK/16
MCK/32
MCK/64
MCK/128
MCK/256
MCK/512
MCK/1024
Divider A
PREA
clkA
DIVA
PWM_MR
Divider B
PREB
clkB
DIVB
PWM_MR
Caution: Before using the PWM macrocell, the programmer must first enable the PWM clock in
the Power Management Controller (PMC).
The PWM macrocell master clock, MCK, is divided in the clock generator module to provide different clocks available for all channels. Each channel can independently select one of the
divided clocks.
The clock generator is divided in three blocks:
– a modulo n counter which provides 11 clocks: FMCK, FMCK/2, FMCK/4, FMCK/8,
FMCK/16, FMCK/32, FMCK/64, FMCK/128, FMCK/256, FMCK/512, FMCK/1024
– two linear dividers (1, 1/2, 1/3, ... 1/255) that provide two separate clocks: clkA and
clkB
Each linear divider can independently divide one of the clocks of the modulo n counter. The
selection of the clock to be divided is made according to the PREA (PREB) field of the PWM
Mode register (PWM_MR). The resulting clock clkA (clkB) is the clock selected divided by DIVA
(DIVB) field value in the PWM Mode register (PWM_MR).
427
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
After a reset of the PWM controller, DIVA (DIVB) and PREA (PREB) in the PWM Mode register
are set to 0. This implies that after reset clkA (clkB) are turned off.
At reset, all clocks provided by the modulo n counter are turned off except clock “clk”. This situation is also true when the PWM master clock is turned off through the Power Management
Controller.
33.5.2
33.5.2.1
PWM Channel
Block Diagram
Figure 33-3. Functional View of the Channel Block Diagram
inputs
from clock
generator
Channel
Clock
Selector
Internal
Counter
Comparator
PWMx
output waveform
inputs from
APB bus
Each of the 4 channels is composed of three blocks:
• A clock selector which selects one of the clocks provided by the clock generator described in
Section 33.5.1 “PWM Clock Generator” on page 427.
• An internal counter clocked by the output of the clock selector. This internal counter is
incremented or decremented according to the channel configuration and comparators events.
The size of the internal counter is 16 bits.
• A comparator used to generate events according to the internal counter value. It also
computes the PWMx output waveform according to the configuration.
33.5.2.2
Waveform Properties
The different properties of output waveforms are:
• the internal clock selection. The internal channel counter is clocked by one of the clocks
provided by the clock generator described in the previous section. This channel parameter is
defined in the CPRE field of the PWM_CMRx register. This field is reset at 0.
• the waveform period. This channel parameter is defined in the CPRD field of the
PWM_CPRDx register.
- If the waveform is left aligned, then the output waveform period depends on the counter
source clock and can be calculated:
By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value
(with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024), the resulting period formula
will be:
( X × CPRD )
---------------------------------MCK
428
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes,
respectively:
( CRPD × DIVA )
( CRPD × DIVAB )
--------------------------------------------- or ------------------------------------------------MCK
MCK
If the waveform is center aligned then the output waveform period depends on the counter
source clock and can be calculated:
By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value
(with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024). The resulting period formula will
be:
(-------------------------------------------2 × X × CPRD )
MCK
By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes,
respectively:
(------------------------------------------------------2 × CPRD × DIVA )
( 2 × CPRD × DIVB )
or ------------------------------------------------------MCK
MCK
• the waveform duty cycle. This channel parameter is defined in the CDTY field of the
PWM_CDTYx register.
If the waveform is left aligned then:
period – 1 ⁄ fchannel_x_clock × CDTY )duty cycle = (------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------period
If the waveform is center aligned, then:
( ( period ⁄ 2 ) – 1 ⁄ fchannel_x_clock × CDTY ) -)
duty cycle = -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------( period ⁄ 2 )
• the waveform polarity. At the beginning of the period, the signal can be at high or low level.
This property is defined in the CPOL field of the PWM_CMRx register. By default the signal
starts by a low level.
• the waveform alignment. The output waveform can be left or center aligned. Center aligned
waveforms can be used to generate non overlapped waveforms. This property is defined in
the CALG field of the PWM_CMRx register. The default mode is left aligned.
Figure 33-4. Non Overlapped Center Aligned Waveforms
No overlap
PWM0
PWM1
Period
Note:
See Figure 33-5 on page 431 for a detailed description of center aligned waveforms.
429
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
When center aligned, the internal channel counter increases up to CPRD and.decreases down
to 0. This ends the period.
When left aligned, the internal channel counter increases up to CPRD and is reset. This ends
the period.
Thus, for the same CPRD value, the period for a center aligned channel is twice the period for a
left aligned channel.
Waveforms are fixed at 0 when:
• CDTY = CPRD and CPOL = 0
• CDTY = 0 and CPOL = 1
Waveforms are fixed at 1 (once the channel is enabled) when:
• CDTY = 0 and CPOL = 0
• CDTY = CPRD and CPOL = 1
The waveform polarity must be set before enabling the channel. This immediately affects the
channel output level. Changes on channel polarity are not taken into account while the channel
is enabled.
430
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 33-5. Waveform Properties
PWM_MCKx
CHIDx(PWM_SR)
CHIDx(PWM_ENA)
CHIDx(PWM_DIS)
Center Aligned
CALG(PWM_CMRx) = 1
PWM_CCNTx
CPRD(PWM_CPRDx)
CDTY(PWM_CDTYx)
Period
Output Waveform PWMx
CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 0
Output Waveform PWMx
CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 1
CHIDx(PWM_ISR)
Left Aligned
CALG(PWM_CMRx) = 0
PWM_CCNTx
CPRD(PWM_CPRDx)
CDTY(PWM_CDTYx)
Period
Output Waveform PWMx
CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 0
Output Waveform PWMx
CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 1
CHIDx(PWM_ISR)
431
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.5.3
33.5.3.1
PWM Controller Operations
Initialization
Before enabling the output channel, this channel must have been configured by the software
application:
• Configuration of the clock generator if DIVA and DIVB are required
• Selection of the clock for each channel (CPRE field in the PWM_CMRx register)
• Configuration of the waveform alignment for each channel (CALG field in the PWM_CMRx
register)
• Configuration of the period for each channel (CPRD in the PWM_CPRDx register). Writing in
PWM_CPRDx Register is possible while the channel is disabled. After validation of the
channel, the user must use PWM_CUPDx Register to update PWM_CPRDx as explained
below.
• Configuration of the duty cycle for each channel (CDTY in the PWM_CDTYx register).
Writing in PWM_CDTYx Register is possible while the channel is disabled. After validation of
the channel, the user must use PWM_CUPDx Register to update PWM_CDTYx as explained
below.
• Configuration of the output waveform polarity for each channel (CPOL in the PWM_CMRx
register)
• Enable Interrupts (Writing CHIDx in the PWM_IER register)
• Enable the PWM channel (Writing CHIDx in the PWM_ENA register)
It is possible to synchronize different channels by enabling them at the same time by means of
writing simultaneously several CHIDx bits in the PWM_ENA register.
• In such a situation, all channels may have the same clock selector configuration and the
same period specified.
33.5.3.2
Source Clock Selection Criteria
The large number of source clocks can make selection difficult. The relationship between the
value in the Period Register (PWM_CPRDx) and the Duty Cycle Register (PWM_CDTYx) can
help the user in choosing. The event number written in the Period Register gives the PWM accuracy. The Duty Cycle quantum cannot be lower than 1/PWM_CPRDx value. The higher the value
of PWM_CPRDx, the greater the PWM accuracy.
For example, if the user sets 15 (in decimal) in PWM_CPRDx, the user is able to set a value
between 1 up to 14 in PWM_CDTYx Register. The resulting duty cycle quantum cannot be lower
than 1/15 of the PWM period.
33.5.3.3
Changing the Duty Cycle or the Period
It is possible to modulate the output waveform duty cycle or period.
To prevent unexpected output waveform, the user must use the update register (PWM_CUPDx)
to change waveform parameters while the channel is still enabled. The user can write a new
period value or duty cycle value in the update register (PWM_CUPDx). This register holds the
new value until the end of the current cycle and updates the value for the next cycle. Depending
on the CPD field in the PWM_CMRx register, PWM_CUPDx either updates PWM_CPRDx or
PWM_CDTYx. Note that even if the update register is used, the period must not be smaller than
the duty cycle.
432
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 33-6. Synchronized Period or Duty Cycle Update
User's Writing
PWM_CUPDx Value
0
1
PWM_CPRDx
PWM_CMRx. CPD
PWM_CDTYx
End of Cycle
To prevent overwriting the PWM_CUPDx by software, the user can use status events in order to
synchronize his software. Two methods are possible. In both, the user must enable the dedicated interrupt in PWM_IER at PWM Controller level.
The first method (polling method) consists of reading the relevant status bit in PWM_ISR Register according to the enabled channel(s). See Figure 33-7.
The second method uses an Interrupt Service Routine associated with the PWM channel.
Note:
Reading the PWM_ISR register automatically clears CHIDx flags.
Figure 33-7. Polling Method
PWM_ISR Read
Acknowledgement and clear previous register state
Writing in CPD field
Update of the Period or Duty Cycle
CHIDx = 1
YES
Writing in PWM_CUPDx
The last write has been taken into account
Note:
Polarity and alignment can be modified only when the channel is disabled.
433
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.5.3.4
Interrupts
Depending on the interrupt mask in the PWM_IMR register, an interrupt is generated at the end
of the corresponding channel period. The interrupt remains active until a read operation in the
PWM_ISR register occurs.
A channel interrupt is enabled by setting the corresponding bit in the PWM_IER register. A channel interrupt is disabled by setting the corresponding bit in the PWM_IDR register.
434
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
33.6
Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) User Interface
Table 33-2.
Offset
Register Mapping
(1)
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00
PWM Mode Register
PWM_MR
Read-write
0
0x04
PWM Enable Register
PWM_ENA
Write-only
-
0x08
PWM Disable Register
PWM_DIS
Write-only
-
0x0C
PWM Status Register
PWM_SR
Read-only
0
0x10
PWM Interrupt Enable Register
PWM_IER
Write-only
-
0x14
PWM Interrupt Disable Register
PWM_IDR
Write-only
-
0x18
PWM Interrupt Mask Register
PWM_IMR
Read-only
0
0x1C
PWM Interrupt Status Register
PWM_ISR
Read-only
0
0x4C - 0xFC
Reserved
–
–
0x100 - 0x1FC
Reserved
0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x00
PWM Channel Mode Register
PWM_CMR
Read-write
0x0
0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x04
PWM Channel Duty Cycle Register
PWM_CDTY
Read-write
0x0
0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x08
PWM Channel Period Register
PWM_CPRD
Read-write
0x0
0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x0C
PWM Channel Counter Register
PWM_CCNT
Read-only
0x0
0x200 + ch_num * 0x20 + 0x10
PWM Channel Update Register
PWM_CUPD
Write-only
-
Note:
–
1. Some registers are indexed with “ch_num” index ranging from 0 to X-1.
435
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.6.1
PWM Mode Register
Register Name: PWM_MR
Access Type: Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
23
22
21
20
19
11
26
25
24
18
17
16
10
9
8
1
0
PREB
DIVB
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
7
6
5
4
PREA
3
2
DIVA
• DIVA, DIVB: CLKA, CLKB Divide Factor
DIVA, DIVB
CLKA, CLKB
0
CLKA, CLKB clock is turned off
1
CLKA, CLKB clock is clock selected by PREA, PREB
2-255
CLKA, CLKB clock is clock selected by PREA, PREB divided by DIVA, DIVB factor.
• PREA, PREB
PREA, PREB
0
0
0
0
MCK.
0
0
0
1
MCK/2
0
0
1
0
MCK/4
0
0
1
1
MCK/8
0
1
0
0
MCK/16
0
1
0
1
MCK/32
0
1
1
0
MCK/64
0
1
1
1
MCK/128
1
0
0
0
MCK/256
1
0
0
1
MCK/512
1
0
1
0
MCK/1024
Other
436
Divider Input Clock
Reserved
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
33.6.2
PWM Enable Register
Register Name: PWM_ENA
Access Type: Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
CHID3
2
CHID2
1
CHID1
0
CHID0
• CHIDx: Channel ID
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable PWM output for channel x.
437
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.6.3
PWM Disable Register
Register Name: PWM_DIS
Access Type: Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
CHID3
2
CHID2
1
CHID1
0
CHID0
• CHIDx: Channel ID
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable PWM output for channel x.
438
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
33.6.4
PWM Status Register
Register Name: PWM_SR
Access Type: Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
CHID3
2
CHID2
1
CHID1
0
CHID0
• CHIDx: Channel ID
0 = PWM output for channel x is disabled.
1 = PWM output for channel x is enabled.
439
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.6.5
PWM Interrupt Enable Register
Register Name:PWM_IER
Access Type: Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
CHID3
2
CHID2
1
CHID1
0
CHID0
• CHIDx: Channel ID.
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable interrupt for PWM channel x.
440
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
33.6.6
PWM Interrupt Disable Register
Register Name: PWM_IDR
Access Type: Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
CHID3
2
CHID2
1
CHID1
0
CHID0
• CHIDx: Channel ID.
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable interrupt for PWM channel x.
441
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.6.7
PWM Interrupt Mask Register
Register Name: PWM_IMR
Access Type: Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
CHID3
2
CHID2
1
CHID1
0
CHID0
• CHIDx: Channel ID.
0 = Interrupt for PWM channel x is disabled.
1 = Interrupt for PWM channel x is enabled.
442
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
33.6.8
PWM Interrupt Status Register
Register Name: PWM_ISR
Access Type: Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
CHID3
2
CHID2
1
CHID1
0
CHID0
• CHIDx: Channel ID
0 = No new channel period has been achieved since the last read of the PWM_ISR register.
1 = At least one new channel period has been achieved since the last read of the PWM_ISR register.
Note: Reading PWM_ISR automatically clears CHIDx flags.
443
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.6.9
PWM Channel Mode Register
Register Name: PWM_CMR[0..X-1]
Access Type: Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
CPD
9
CPOL
8
CALG
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
2
1
0
CPRE
• CPRE: Channel Pre-scaler
CPRE
Channel Pre-scaler
0
0
0
0
MCK
0
0
0
1
MCK/2
0
0
1
0
MCK/4
0
0
1
1
MCK/8
0
1
0
0
MCK/16
0
1
0
1
MCK/32
0
1
1
0
MCK/64
0
1
1
1
MCK/128
1
0
0
0
MCK/256
1
0
0
1
MCK/512
1
0
1
0
MCK/1024
1
0
1
1
CLKA
1
1
0
0
CLKB
Other
Reserved
• CALG: Channel Alignment
0 = The period is left aligned.
1 = The period is center aligned.
• CPOL: Channel Polarity
0 = The output waveform starts at a low level.
1 = The output waveform starts at a high level.
• CPD: Channel Update Period
0 = Writing to the PWM_CUPDx will modify the duty cycle at the next period start event.
1 = Writing to the PWM_CUPDx will modify the period at the next period start event.
444
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
33.6.10 PWM Channel Duty Cycle Register
Register Name:PWM_CDTY[0..X-1]
Access Type: Read-write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CDTY
23
22
21
20
CDTY
15
14
13
12
CDTY
7
6
5
4
CDTY
Only the first 16 bits (internal channel counter size) are significant.
• CDTY: Channel Duty Cycle
Defines the waveform duty cycle. This value must be defined between 0 and CPRD (PWM_CPRx).
445
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.6.11 PWM Channel Period Register
Register Name:PWM_CPRD[0. X-1]
Access Type: Read-write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CPRD
23
22
21
20
CPRD
15
14
13
12
CPRD
7
6
5
4
CPRD
Only the first 16 bits (internal channel counter size) are significant.
• CPRD: Channel Period
If the waveform is left-aligned, then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be
calculated:
– By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128,
256, 512, or 1024). The resulting period formula will be:
(--------------------------------X × CPRD -)
MCK
– By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively:
(-------------------------------------------CRPD × DIVA -)
( CRPD × DIVAB )
or ------------------------------------------------MCK
MCK
If the waveform is center-aligned, then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be
calculated:
– By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128,
256, 512, or 1024). The resulting period formula will be:
( 2 × X × CPRD )
-------------------------------------------MCK
– By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively:
(------------------------------------------------------2 × CPRD × DIVA )
( 2 × CPRD × DIVB )
or ------------------------------------------------------MCK
MCK
446
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
33.6.12 PWM Channel Counter Register
Register Name: PWM_CCNT[0..X-1]
Access Type: Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CNT
23
22
21
20
CNT
15
14
13
12
CNT
7
6
5
4
CNT
• CNT: Channel Counter Register
Internal counter value. This register is reset when:
• the channel is enabled (writing CHIDx in the PWM_ENA register).
• the counter reaches CPRD value defined in the PWM_CPRDx register if the waveform is left aligned.
447
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
33.6.13 PWM Channel Update Register
Register Name: PWM_CUPD[0..X-1]
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CUPD
23
22
21
20
CUPD
15
14
13
12
CUPD
7
6
5
4
CUPD
This register acts as a double buffer for the period or the duty cycle. This prevents an unexpected waveform when modifying the waveform period or duty-cycle.
Only the first 16 bits (internal channel counter size) are significant.
CPD (PWM_CMRx Register)
448
0
The duty-cycle (CDTY in the PWM_CDTYx register) is updated with the CUPD value at the
beginning of the next period.
1
The period (CPRD in the PWM_CPRDx register) is updated with the CUPD value at the beginning
of the next period.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34. USB Device Port (UDP)
34.1
Overview
The USB Device Port (UDP) is compliant with the Universal Serial Bus (USB) V2.0 full-speed
device specification.
Each endpoint can be configured in one of several USB transfer types. It can be associated with
one or two banks of a dual-port RAM used to store the current data payload. If two banks are
used, one DPR bank is read or written by the processor, while the other is read or written by the
USB device peripheral. This feature is mandatory for isochronous endpoints. Thus the device
maintains the maximum bandwidth (1M bytes/s) by working with endpoints with two banks of
DPR.
Table 34-1.
USB Endpoint Description
Mnemonic
Dual-Bank(1)
Max. Endpoint Size
Endpoint Type
0
EP0
No
8
Control/Bulk/Interrupt
1
EP1
Yes
64
Bulk/Iso/Interrupt
2
EP2
Yes
64
Bulk/Iso/Interrupt
3
EP3
No
64
Control/Bulk/Interrupt
4
EP4
Yes
256
Bulk/Iso/Interrupt
EP5
Yes
256
Bulk/Iso/Interrupt
Endpoint Number
5
Note:
1. The Dual-Bank function provides two banks for an endpoint. This feature is used for ping-pong mode.
Suspend and resume are automatically detected by the USB device, which notifies the processor by raising an interrupt. Depending on the product, an external signal can be used to send a
wake up to the USB host controller.
449
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.2
Block Diagram
Figure 34-1. Block Diagram
Atmel Bridge
MCK
APB
to
MCU
Bus
UDPCK
USB Device
txoen
U
s
e
r
I
n
t
e
r
f
a
c
e
udp_int
external_resume
W
r
a
p
p
e
r
Dual
Port
RAM
FIFO
W
r
a
p
p
e
r
eopn
Serial
Interface
Engine
12 MHz
SIE
txd
rxdm
Embedded
USB
Transceiver
DP
DM
rxd
rxdp
Suspend/Resume Logic
Master Clock
Domain
Recovered 12 MHz
Domain
Access to the UDP is via the APB bus interface. Read and write to the data FIFO are done by
reading and writing 8-bit values to APB registers.
The UDP peripheral requires two clocks: one peripheral clock used by the MCK domain and a
48 MHz clock used by the 12 MHz domain.
A USB 2.0 full-speed pad is embedded and controlled by the Serial Interface Engine (SIE).
The signal external_resume is optional. It allows the UDP peripheral to wake up once in system
mode. The host is then notified that the device asks for a resume. This optional feature must be
also negotiated with the host during the enumeration.
450
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34.3
Product Dependencies
For further details on the USB Device hardware implementation, see the specific Product Properties document.
The USB physical transceiver is integrated into the product. The bidirectional differential signals
DP and DM are available from the product boundary.
Two I/O lines may be used by the application:
• One to check that VBUS is still available from the host. Self-powered devices may use this
entry to be notified that the host has been powered off. In this case, the board pullup on DP
must be disabled in order to prevent feeding current to the host.
• One to control the board pullup on DP. Thus, when the device is ready to communicate with
the host, it activates its DP pullup through this control line.
34.3.1
I/O Lines
DP and DM are not controlled by any PIO controllers. The embedded USB physical transceiver
is controlled by the USB device peripheral.
To reserve an I/O line to check VBUS, the programmer must first program the PIO controller to
assign this I/O in input PIO mode.
To reserve an I/O line to control the board pullup, the programmer must first program the PIO
controller to assign this I/O in output PIO mode.
34.3.2
Power Management
The USB device peripheral requires a 48 MHz clock. This clock must be generated by a PLL
with an accuracy of ± 0.25%.
Thus, the USB device receives two clocks from the Power Management Controller (PMC): the
master clock, MCK, used to drive the peripheral user interface, and the UDPCK, used to interface with the bus USB signals (recovered 12 MHz domain).
WARNING: The UDP peripheral clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) must be
enabled before any read/write operations to the UDP registers including the UDP_TXCV
register.
34.3.3
Interrupt
The USB device interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller
(AIC).
Handling the USB device interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the UDP.
451
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.4
Typical Connection
Figure 34-2. Board Schematic to Interface USB Device Peripheral
PIO
5V Bus Monitoring
27 K
47 K
3V3
PIO
Pullup Control
0: Enable
1: Disable
1.5K
REXT
DDM
2
1
3
Type B 4
Connector
DDP
REXT
330 K
34.4.1
330 K
USB Device Transceiver
The USB device transceiver is embedded in the product. A few discrete components are
required as follows:
• the application detects all device states as defined in chapter 9 of the USB specification;
– pullup enable/disable
– VBUS monitoring
• to reduce power consumption the host is disconnected
• for line termination.
Pullup enable/disable is done through a MOSFET controlled by a PIO. The pullup is enabled
when the PIO drives a 0. Thus PIO default state to 1 corresponds to a pullup disable. Once the
pullup is enabled, the host will force a device reset 100 ms later. Bus powered devices must
connect the pullup within 100 ms.
34.4.2
VBUS Monitoring
VBUS monitoring is required to detect host connection. VBUS monitoring is done using a standard PIO with internal pullup disabled. When the host is switched off, it should be considered as
a disconnect, the pullup must be disabled in order to prevent powering the host through the pullup resistor.
When the host is disconnected and the transceiver is enabled, then DDP and DDM are floating.
This may lead to over consumption. A solution is to connect 330 KΩ pulldowns on DP and DM.
These pulldowns do not alter DDP and DDM signal integrity.
452
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
A termination serial resistor must be connected to DP and DM. The resistor value is defined in
the electrical specification of the product (REXT).
453
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.5
Functional Description
34.5.1
USB V2.0 Full-speed Introduction
The USB V2.0 full-speed provides communication services between host and attached USB
devices. Each device is offered with a collection of communication flows (pipes) associated with
each endpoint. Software on the host communicates with a USB device through a set of communication flows.
Figure 34-3. Example of USB V2.0 Full-speed Communication Control
USB Host V2.0
Software Client 1
Software Client 2
Data Flow: Control Transfer
EP0
Data Flow: Isochronous In Transfer
USB Device 2.0
EP1 Block 1
Data Flow: Isochronous Out Transfer
EP2
Data Flow: Control Transfer
EP0
Data Flow: Bulk In Transfer
USB Device 2.0
EP4 Block 2
Data Flow: Bulk Out Transfer
EP5
USB Device endpoint configuration requires that
in the first instance Control Transfer must be EP0.
The Control Transfer endpoint EP0 is always used when a USB device is first configured (USB v. 2.0 specifications).
34.5.1.1
USB V2.0 Full-speed Transfer Types
A communication flow is carried over one of four transfer types defined by the USB device.
Table 34-2.
Transfer
USB Communication Flow
Direction
Bandwidth
Supported Endpoint Size
Error Detection
Retrying
Bidirectional
Not guaranteed
8, 16, 32, 64
Yes
Automatic
Isochronous
Unidirectional
Guaranteed
256
Yes
No
Interrupt
Unidirectional
Not guaranteed
≤64
Yes
Yes
Bulk
Unidirectional
Not guaranteed
8, 16, 32, 64
Yes
Yes
Control
454
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34.5.1.2
USB Bus Transactions
Each transfer results in one or more transactions over the USB bus. There are three kinds of
transactions flowing across the bus in packets:
1. Setup Transaction
2. Data IN Transaction
3. Data OUT Transaction
34.5.1.3
USB Transfer Event Definitions
As indicated below, transfers are sequential events carried out on the USB bus.
Table 34-3.
USB Transfer Events
• Setup transaction > Data IN transactions > Status
OUT transaction
Control Transfers(1) (3)
Interrupt IN Transfer
(device toward host)
• Setup transaction > Data OUT transactions > Status
IN transaction
• Setup transaction > Status IN transaction
• Data IN transaction > Data IN transaction
Interrupt OUT Transfer
(host toward device)
• Data OUT transaction > Data OUT transaction
Isochronous IN Transfer(2)
(device toward host)
• Data IN transaction > Data IN transaction
Isochronous OUT Transfer(2)
(host toward device)
• Data OUT transaction > Data OUT transaction
Bulk IN Transfer
(device toward host)
• Data IN transaction > Data IN transaction
Bulk OUT Transfer
(host toward device)
• Data OUT transaction > Data OUT transaction
Notes:
1. Control transfer must use endpoints with no ping-pong attributes.
2. Isochronous transfers must use endpoints with ping-pong attributes.
3. Control transfers can be aborted using a stall handshake.
A status transaction is a special type of host-to-device transaction used only in a control transfer.
The control transfer must be performed using endpoints with no ping-pong attributes. According
to the control sequence (read or write), the USB device sends or receives a status transaction.
455
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 34-4. Control Read and Write Sequences
Setup Stage
Control Read
Setup TX
Data Stage
Data OUT TX
No Data
Control
Notes:
Setup TX
Data OUT TX
Data Stage
Setup Stage
Control Write
Status Stage
Data IN TX
Setup Stage
Status Stage
Setup TX
Status IN TX
Data IN TX
Status IN TX
Status Stage
Status OUT TX
1. During the Status IN stage, the host waits for a zero length packet (Data IN transaction with no data) from the device using
DATA1 PID. Refer to Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0, for more information on the protocol layer.
2. During the Status OUT stage, the host emits a zero length packet to the device (Data OUT transaction with no data).
34.5.2
34.5.2.1
Handling Transactions with USB V2.0 Device Peripheral
Setup Transaction
Setup is a special type of host-to-device transaction used during control transfers. Control transfers must be performed using endpoints with no ping-pong attributes. A setup transaction needs
to be handled as soon as possible by the firmware. It is used to transmit requests from the host
to the device. These requests are then handled by the USB device and may require more arguments. The arguments are sent to the device by a Data OUT transaction which follows the setup
transaction. These requests may also return data. The data is carried out to the host by the next
Data IN transaction which follows the setup transaction. A status transaction ends the control
transfer.
When a setup transfer is received by the USB endpoint:
• The USB device automatically acknowledges the setup packet
• RXSETUP is set in the UDP_ CSRx register
• An endpoint interrupt is generated while the RXSETUP is not cleared. This interrupt is
carried out to the microcontroller if interrupts are enabled for this endpoint.
Thus, firmware must detect the RXSETUP polling the UDP_ CSRx or catching an interrupt, read
the setup packet in the FIFO, then clear the RXSETUP. RXSETUP cannot be cleared before the
setup packet has been read in the FIFO. Otherwise, the USB device would accept the next Data
OUT transfer and overwrite the setup packet in the FIFO.
456
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 34-5. Setup Transaction Followed by a Data OUT Transaction
Setup Received
USB
Bus Packets
Setup
PID
Data Setup
Setup Handled by Firmware
ACK
PID
RXSETUP Flag
Data OUT
PID
Data OUT
Data OUT
PID
Data OUT
ACK
PID
Cleared by Firmware
Set by USB
Device Peripheral
RX_Data_BKO
(UDP_CSRx)
34.5.2.2
NAK
PID
Interrupt Pending
Set by USB Device
FIFO (DPR)
Content
Data Out Received
XX
Data Setup
XX
Data OUT
Data IN Transaction
Data IN transactions are used in control, isochronous, bulk and interrupt transfers and conduct
the transfer of data from the device to the host. Data IN transactions in isochronous transfer
must be done using endpoints with ping-pong attributes.
Using Endpoints Without Ping-pong Attributes
To perform a Data IN transaction using a non ping-pong endpoint:
1. The application checks if it is possible to write in the FIFO by polling TXPKTRDY in the
endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register (TXPKTRDY must be cleared).
2. The application writes the first packet of data to be sent in the endpoint’s FIFO, writing
zero or more byte values in the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register,
3. The application notifies the USB peripheral it has finished by setting the TXPKTRDY in
the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
4. The application is notified that the endpoint’s FIFO has been released by the USB
device when TXCOMP in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register has been set. Then an
interrupt for the corresponding endpoint is pending while TXCOMP is set.
5. The microcontroller writes the second packet of data to be sent in the endpoint’s FIFO,
writing zero or more byte values in the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register,
6. The microcontroller notifies the USB peripheral it has finished by setting the TXPKTRDY in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
7. The application clears the TXCOMP in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx.
After the last packet has been sent, the application must clear TXCOMP once this has been set.
TXCOMP is set by the USB device when it has received an ACK PID signal for the Data IN
packet. An interrupt is pending while TXCOMP is set.
Warning: TX_COMP must be cleared after TX_PKTRDY has been set.
Note:
Refer to Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0, for more information on the
Data IN protocol layer.
457
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 34-6. Data IN Transfer for Non Ping-pong Endpoint
Prevous Data IN TX
USB Bus Packets
Data IN
PID
Microcontroller Load Data in FIFO
Data IN 1
ACK
PID
Data IN
PID
NAK
PID
Data is Sent on USB Bus
Data IN
PID
ACK
PID
Data IN 2
TXPKTRDY Flag
(UDP_CSRx)
Set by the firmware
Cleared by Hw
Set by the firmware
Cleared by Hw
Interrupt
Pending
Interrupt Pending
TXCOMP Flag
(UDP_CSRx)
Payload in FIFO
Cleared by Firmware
DPR access by the firmware
FIFO (DPR)
Content
Data IN 1
Cleared by
Firmware
DPR access by the hardware
Load In Progress
Data IN 2
Using Endpoints With Ping-pong Attribute
The use of an endpoint with ping-pong attributes is necessary during isochronous transfer. This
also allows handling the maximum bandwidth defined in the USB specification during bulk transfer. To be able to guarantee a constant or the maximum bandwidth, the microcontroller must
prepare the next data payload to be sent while the current one is being sent by the USB device.
Thus two banks of memory are used. While one is available for the microcontroller, the other
one is locked by the USB device.
Figure 34-7. Bank Swapping Data IN Transfer for Ping-pong Endpoints
Microcontroller
1st Data Payload
USB Device
Write
Bank 0
Endpoint 1
USB Bus
Read
Read and Write at the Same Time
2nd Data Payload
Bank 0
Endpoint 1
1st Data Payload
Bank 0
Endpoint 1
Bank 1
Endpoint 1
2nd Data Payload
3rd Data Payload
Bank 0
Endpoint 1
458
Data IN Packet
Bank 1
Endpoint 1
Data IN Packet
Data IN Packet
3rd Data Payload
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
When using a ping-pong endpoint, the following procedures are required to perform Data IN
transactions:
1. The microcontroller checks if it is possible to write in the FIFO by polling TXPKTRDY to
be cleared in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
2. The microcontroller writes the first data payload to be sent in the FIFO (Bank 0), writing
zero or more byte values in the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register.
3. The microcontroller notifies the USB peripheral it has finished writing in Bank 0 of the
FIFO by setting the TXPKTRDY in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
4. Without waiting for TXPKTRDY to be cleared, the microcontroller writes the second
data payload to be sent in the FIFO (Bank 1), writing zero or more byte values in the
endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register.
5. The microcontroller is notified that the first Bank has been released by the USB device
when TXCOMP in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register is set. An interrupt is pending
while TXCOMP is being set.
6. Once the microcontroller has received TXCOMP for the first Bank, it notifies the USB
device that it has prepared the second Bank to be sent rising TXPKTRDY in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
7. At this step, Bank 0 is available and the microcontroller can prepare a third data payload to be sent.
Figure 34-8. Data IN Transfer for Ping-pong Endpoint
Microcontroller
Load Data IN Bank 0
USB Bus
Packets
Data IN
PID
TXPKTRDY Flag
(UDP_MCSRx)
Microcontroller Load Data IN Bank 1
USB Device Send Bank 0
ACK
PID
Data IN
Data IN
PID
Cleared by USB Device,
Data Payload Fully Transmitted
Set by Firmware,
Data Payload Written in FIFO Bank 0
Data IN
ACK
PID
Set by Firmware,
Data Payload Written in FIFO Bank 1
Interrupt Pending
Set by USB
Device
TXCOMP Flag
(UDP_CSRx)
Set by USB Device
Interrupt Cleared by Firmware
FIFO (DPR) Written by
Microcontroller
Bank 0
FIFO (DPR)
Bank 1
Microcontroller Load Data IN Bank 0
USB Device Send Bank 1
Read by USB Device
Written by
Microcontroller
Written by
Microcontroller
Read by USB Device
Warning: There is software critical path due to the fact that once the second bank is filled, the
driver has to wait for TX_COMP to set TX_PKTRDY. If the delay between receiving TX_COMP
is set and TX_PKTRDY is set is too long, some Data IN packets may be NACKed, reducing the
bandwidth.
Warning: TX_COMP must be cleared after TX_PKTRDY has been set.
459
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.5.2.3
Data OUT Transaction
Data OUT transactions are used in control, isochronous, bulk and interrupt transfers and conduct the transfer of data from the host to the device. Data OUT transactions in isochronous
transfers must be done using endpoints with ping-pong attributes.
Data OUT Transaction Without Ping-pong Attributes
To perform a Data OUT transaction, using a non ping-pong endpoint:
1. The host generates a Data OUT packet.
2. This packet is received by the USB device endpoint. While the FIFO associated to this
endpoint is being used by the microcontroller, a NAK PID is returned to the host. Once
the FIFO is available, data are written to the FIFO by the USB device and an ACK is
automatically carried out to the host.
3. The microcontroller is notified that the USB device has received a data payload polling
RX_DATA_BK0 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. An interrupt is pending for this
endpoint while RX_DATA_BK0 is set.
4. The number of bytes available in the FIFO is made available by reading RXBYTECNT
in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
5. The microcontroller carries out data received from the endpoint’s memory to its memory. Data received is available by reading the endpoint’s UDP_ FDRx register.
6. The microcontroller notifies the USB device that it has finished the transfer by clearing
RX_DATA_BK0 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
7. A new Data OUT packet can be accepted by the USB device.
Figure 34-9. Data OUT Transfer for Non Ping-pong Endpoints
USB Bus
Packets
Host Sends Data Payload
Microcontroller Transfers Data
Host Sends the Next Data Payload
Data OUT
PID
ACK
PID
Data OUT 1
Data OUT2
PID
RX_DATA_BK0
(UDP_CSRx)
NAK
PID
Data OUT
PID
Data OUT2
ACK
PID
Interrupt Pending
Set by USB Device
FIFO (DPR)
Content
Data OUT2
Host Resends the Next Data Payload
Data OUT 1
Written by USB Device
Cleared by Firmware,
Data Payload Written in FIFO
Data OUT 1
Microcontroller Read
Data OUT 2
Written by USB Device
An interrupt is pending while the flag RX_DATA_BK0 is set. Memory transfer between the USB
device, the FIFO and microcontroller memory can not be done after RX_DATA_BK0 has been
cleared. Otherwise, the USB device would accept the next Data OUT transfer and overwrite the
current Data OUT packet in the FIFO.
Using Endpoints With Ping-pong Attributes
During isochronous transfer, using an endpoint with ping-pong attributes is obligatory. To be
able to guarantee a constant bandwidth, the microcontroller must read the previous data payload sent by the host, while the current data payload is received by the USB device. Thus two
460
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
banks of memory are used. While one is available for the microcontroller, the other one is locked
by the USB device.
Figure 34-10. Bank Swapping in Data OUT Transfers for Ping-pong Endpoints
Microcontroller
USB Device
Write
USB Bus
Read
Data IN Packet
Bank 0
Endpoint 1
1st Data Payload
Bank 0
Endpoint 1
Bank 1
Endpoint 1
2nd Data Payload
Bank 1
Endpoint 1
Bank 0
Endpoint 1
3rd Data Payload
Write and Read at the Same Time
1st Data Payload
2nd Data Payload
Data IN Packet
Data IN Packet
3rd Data Payload
Bank 0
Endpoint 1
When using a ping-pong endpoint, the following procedures are required to perform Data OUT
transactions:
1. The host generates a Data OUT packet.
2. This packet is received by the USB device endpoint. It is written in the endpoint’s FIFO
Bank 0.
3. The USB device sends an ACK PID packet to the host. The host can immediately send
a second Data OUT packet. It is accepted by the device and copied to FIFO Bank 1.
4. The microcontroller is notified that the USB device has received a data payload, polling
RX_DATA_BK0 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. An interrupt is pending for this
endpoint while RX_DATA_BK0 is set.
5. The number of bytes available in the FIFO is made available by reading RXBYTECNT
in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
6. The microcontroller transfers out data received from the endpoint’s memory to the
microcontroller’s memory. Data received is made available by reading the endpoint’s
UDP_ FDRx register.
7. The microcontroller notifies the USB peripheral device that it has finished the transfer
by clearing RX_DATA_BK0 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
8. A third Data OUT packet can be accepted by the USB peripheral device and copied in
the FIFO Bank 0.
9. If a second Data OUT packet has been received, the microcontroller is notified by the
flag RX_DATA_BK1 set in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register. An interrupt is pending
for this endpoint while RX_DATA_BK1 is set.
10. The microcontroller transfers out data received from the endpoint’s memory to the
microcontroller’s memory. Data received is available by reading the endpoint’s UDP_
FDRx register.
461
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
11. The microcontroller notifies the USB device it has finished the transfer by clearing
RX_DATA_BK1 in the endpoint’s UDP_ CSRx register.
12. A fourth Data OUT packet can be accepted by the USB device and copied in the FIFO
Bank 0.
Figure 34-11. Data OUT Transfer for Ping-pong Endpoint
Microcontroller Reads Data 1 in Bank 0,
Host Sends Second Data Payload
Host Sends First Data Payload
USB Bus
Packets
Data OUT
PID
RX_DATA_BK0 Flag
(UDP_CSRx)
Data OUT 1
Data OUT
PID
Data OUT 2
Set by USB Device,
Data Payload Written
in FIFO Endpoint Bank 0
ACK
PID
Data OUT 3
A
P
Cleared by Firmware
Set by USB Device,
Data Payload Written
in FIFO Endpoint Bank 1
Interrupt Pending
Data OUT1
Data OUT 1
Data OUT 3
Write by USB Device
Read By Microcontroller
Write In Progress
FIFO (DPR)
Bank 1
Data OUT 2
Write by USB Device
Note:
Data OUT
PID
Cleared by Firmware
Interrupt Pending
RX_DATA_BK1 Flag
(UDP_CSRx)
FIFO (DPR)
Bank 0
ACK
PID
Microcontroller Reads Data2 in Bank 1,
Host Sends Third Data Payload
Data OUT 2
Read By Microcontroller
An interrupt is pending while the RX_DATA_BK0 or RX_DATA_BK1 flag is set.
Warning: When RX_DATA_BK0 and RX_DATA_BK1 are both set, there is no way to determine
which one to clear first. Thus the software must keep an internal counter to be sure to clear alternatively RX_DATA_BK0 then RX_DATA_BK1. This situation may occur when the software
application is busy elsewhere and the two banks are filled by the USB host. Once the application
comes back to the USB driver, the two flags are set.
34.5.2.4
Stall Handshake
A stall handshake can be used in one of two distinct occasions. (For more information on the
stall handshake, refer to Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0.)
• A functional stall is used when the halt feature associated with the endpoint is set. (Refer to
Chapter 9 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0, for more information on the halt
feature.)
• To abort the current request, a protocol stall is used, but uniquely with control transfer.
The following procedure generates a stall packet:
1. The microcontroller sets the FORCESTALL flag in the UDP_ CSRx endpoint’s register.
2. The host receives the stall packet.
462
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
3. The microcontroller is notified that the device has sent the stall by polling the
STALLSENT to be set. An endpoint interrupt is pending while STALLSENT is set. The
microcontroller must clear STALLSENT to clear the interrupt.
When a setup transaction is received after a stall handshake, STALLSENT must be cleared in
order to prevent interrupts due to STALLSENT being set.
Figure 34-12. Stall Handshake (Data IN Transfer)
USB Bus
Packets
Data IN PID
Stall PID
Cleared by Firmware
FORCESTALL
Set by Firmware
Interrupt Pending
Cleared by Firmware
STALLSENT
Set by
USB Device
Figure 34-13. Stall Handshake (Data OUT Transfer)
USB Bus
Packets
Data OUT PID
Data OUT
Stall PID
Set by Firmware
FORCESTALL
Interrupt Pending
STALLSENT
Cleared by Firmware
Set by USB Device
463
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.5.2.5
Transmit Data Cancellation
Some endpoints have dual-banks whereas some endpoints have only one bank. The procedure
to cancel transmission data held in these banks is described below.
To see the organization of dual-bank availablity refer to Table 34-1 ”USB Endpoint Description”.
Endpoints Without Dual-Banks
There are two possibilities: In one case, TXPKTRDY field in UDP_CSR has already been set. In
the other instance, TXPKTRDY is not set.
• TXPKTRDY is not set:
– Reset the endpoint to clear the FIFO (pointers). (See, Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset
Endpoint Register”.)
• TXPKTRDY has already been set:
– Clear TXPKTRDY so that no packet is ready to be sent
– Reset the endpoint to clear the FIFO (pointers). (See, Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset
Endpoint Register”.)
Endpoints With Dual-Banks
There are two possibilities: In one case, TXPKTRDY field in UDP_CSR has already been set. In
the other instance, TXPKTRDY is not set.
• TXPKTRDY is not set:
– Reset the endpoint to clear the FIFO (pointers). (See, Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset
Endpoint Register”.)
• TXPKTRDY has already been set:
– Clear TXPKTRDY and read it back until actually read at 0.
– Set TXPKTRDY and read it back until actually read at 1.
– Clear TXPKTRDY so that no packet is ready to be sent.
– Reset the endpoint to clear the FIFO (pointers). (See, Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset
Endpoint Register”.)
464
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34.5.3
Controlling Device States
A USB device has several possible states. Refer to Chapter 9 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0.
Figure 34-14. USB Device State Diagram
Attached
Hub Reset
or
Deconfigured
Hub
Configured
Bus Inactive
Powered
Suspended
Bus Activity
Power
Interruption
Reset
Bus Inactive
Suspended
Default
Bus Activity
Reset
Address
Assigned
Bus Inactive
Address
Suspended
Bus Activity
Device
Deconfigured
Device
Configured
Bus Inactive
Configured
Suspended
Bus Activity
Movement from one state to another depends on the USB bus state or on standard requests
sent through control transactions via the default endpoint (endpoint 0).
After a period of bus inactivity, the USB device enters Suspend Mode. Accepting Suspend/Resume requests from the USB host is mandatory. Constraints in Suspend Mode are very
strict for bus-powered applications; devices may not consume more than 500 µA on the USB
bus.
While in Suspend Mode, the host may wake up a device by sending a resume signal (bus activity) or a USB device may send a wake up request to the host, e.g., waking up a PC by moving a
USB mouse.
The wake up feature is not mandatory for all devices and must be negotiated with the host.
465
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.5.3.1
Not Powered State
Self powered devices can detect 5V VBUS using a PIO as described in the typical connection
section. When the device is not connected to a host, device power consumption can be reduced
by disabling MCK for the UDP, disabling UDPCK and disabling the transceiver. DDP and DDM
lines are pulled down by 330 KΩ resistors.
34.5.3.2
Entering Attached State
When no device is connected, the USB DP and DM signals are tied to GND by 15 KΩ pull-down
resistors integrated in the hub downstream ports. When a device is attached to a hub downstream port, the device connects a 1.5 KΩ pull-up resistor on DP. The USB bus line goes into
IDLE state, DP is pulled up by the device 1.5 KΩ resistor to 3.3V and DM is pulled down by the
15 KΩ resistor of the host.
After pullup connection, the device enters the powered state. In this state, the UDPCK and MCK
must be enabled in the Power Management Controller. The transceiver can remain disabled.
34.5.3.3
From Powered State to Default State
After its connection to a USB host, the USB device waits for an end-of-bus reset. The
unmaskable flag ENDBUSRES is set in the register UDP_ISR and an interrupt is triggered.
Once the ENDBUSRES interrupt has been triggered, the device enters Default State. In this
state, the UDP software must:
• Enable the default endpoint, setting the EPEDS flag in the UDP_CSR[0] register and,
optionally, enabling the interrupt for endpoint 0 by writing 1 to the UDP_IER register. The
enumeration then begins by a control transfer.
• Configure the interrupt mask register which has been reset by the USB reset detection
• Enable the transceiver clearing the TXVDIS flag in the UDP_TXVC register.
In this state UDPCK and MCK must be enabled.
Warning: Each time an ENDBUSRES interrupt is triggered, the Interrupt Mask Register and
UDP_CSR registers have been reset.
34.5.3.4
From Default State to Address State
After a set address standard device request, the USB host peripheral enters the address state.
Warning: Before the device enters in address state, it must achieve the Status IN transaction of
the control transfer, i.e., the UDP device sets its new address once the TXCOMP flag in the
UDP_CSR[0] register has been received and cleared.
To move to address state, the driver software sets the FADDEN flag in the UDP_GLB_STAT
register, sets its new address, and sets the FEN bit in the UDP_FADDR register.
34.5.3.5
From Address State to Configured State
Once a valid Set Configuration standard request has been received and acknowledged, the
device enables endpoints corresponding to the current configuration. This is done by setting the
EPEDS and EPTYPE fields in the UDP_CSRx registers and, optionally, enabling corresponding
interrupts in the UDP_IER register.
34.5.3.6
Entering in Suspend State
When a Suspend (no bus activity on the USB bus) is detected, the RXSUSP signal in the
UDP_ISR register is set. This triggers an interrupt if the corresponding bit is set in the UDP_IMR
466
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
register.This flag is cleared by writing to the UDP_ICR register. Then the device enters Suspend
Mode.
In this state bus powered devices must drain less than 500uA from the 5V VBUS. As an example, the microcontroller switches to slow clock, disables the PLL and main oscillator, and goes
into Idle Mode. It may also switch off other devices on the board.
The USB device peripheral clocks can be switched off. Resume event is asynchronously
detected. MCK and UDPCK can be switched off in the Power Management controller and the
USB transceiver can be disabled by setting the TXVDIS field in the UDP_TXVC register.
Warning: Read, write operations to the UDP registers are allowed only if MCK is enabled for the
UDP peripheral. Switching off MCK for the UDP peripheral must be one of the last operations
after writing to the UDP_TXVC and acknowledging the RXSUSP.
34.5.3.7
Receiving a Host Resume
In suspend mode, a resume event on the USB bus line is detected asynchronously, transceiver
and clocks are disabled (however the pullup shall not be removed).
Once the resume is detected on the bus, the WAKEUP signal in the UDP_ISR is set. It may generate an interrupt if the corresponding bit in the UDP_IMR register is set. This interrupt may be
used to wake up the core, enable PLL and main oscillators and configure clocks.
Warning: Read, write operations to the UDP registers are allowed only if MCK is enabled for the
UDP peripheral. MCK for the UDP must be enabled before clearing the WAKEUP bit in the
UDP_ICR register and clearing TXVDIS in the UDP_TXVC register.
34.5.3.8
Sending a Device Remote Wakeup
In Suspend state it is possible to wake up the host sending an external resume.
• The device must wait at least 5 ms after being entered in suspend before sending an external
resume.
• The device has 10 ms from the moment it starts to drain current and it forces a K state to
resume the host.
• The device must force a K state from 1 to 15 ms to resume the host
To force a K state to the bus (DM at 3.3V and DP tied to GND), it is possible to use a transistor
to connect a pullup on DM. The K state is obtained by disabling the pullup on DP and enabling
the pullup on DM. This should be under the control of the application.
Figure 34-15. Board Schematic to Drive a K State
3V3
PIO
0: Force Wake UP (K State)
1: Normal Mode
1.5 K
DM
467
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.6
USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface
WARNING: The UDP peripheral clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) must be enabled before any read/write
operations to the UDP registers including the UDP_TXCV register.
Table 34-4.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x000
Frame Number Register
UDP_FRM_NUM
Read-only
0x0000_0000
0x004
Global State Register
UDP_GLB_STAT
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x008
Function Address Register
UDP_FADDR
Read-write
0x0000_0100
0x00C
Reserved
–
–
–
0x010
Interrupt Enable Register
UDP_IER
Write-only
0x014
Interrupt Disable Register
UDP_IDR
Write-only
0x018
Interrupt Mask Register
UDP_IMR
Read-only
0x0000_1200
0x01C
Interrupt Status Register
UDP_ISR
Read-only
–(1)
0x020
Interrupt Clear Register
UDP_ICR
Write-only
0x024
Reserved
–
–
–
0x028
Reset Endpoint Register
UDP_RST_EP
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x02C
Reserved
–
–
–
0x030 + 0x4 * ( ept_num - 1 )
Endpoint Control and Status Register
UDP_CSR
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x050 + 0x4 * ( ept_num - 1 )
Endpoint FIFO Data Register
UDP_FDR
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x070
Reserved
–
–
–
Read-write
0x0000_0000
–
–
0x074
Transceiver Control Register
UDP_TXVC
0x078 - 0xFC
Reserved
–
Notes:
(2)
1. Reset values are not defined for UDP_ISR.
2. See Warning above the ”Register Mapping” on this page.
468
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34.6.1
UDP Frame Number Register
Register Name:
UDP_ FRM_NUM
Access Type:
Read-only
31
---
30
---
29
---
28
---
27
---
26
---
25
---
24
---
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
FRM_OK
16
FRM_ERR
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
9
FRM_NUM
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FRM_NUM
• FRM_NUM[10:0]: Frame Number as Defined in the Packet Field Formats
This 11-bit value is incremented by the host on a per frame basis. This value is updated at each start of frame.
Value Updated at the SOF_EOP (Start of Frame End of Packet).
• FRM_ERR: Frame Error
This bit is set at SOF_EOP when the SOF packet is received containing an error.
This bit is reset upon receipt of SOF_PID.
• FRM_OK: Frame OK
This bit is set at SOF_EOP when the SOF packet is received without any error.
This bit is reset upon receipt of SOF_PID (Packet Identification).
In the Interrupt Status Register, the SOF interrupt is updated upon receiving SOF_PID. This bit is set without waiting for
EOP.
Note:
In the 8-bit Register Interface, FRM_OK is bit 4 of FRM_NUM_H and FRM_ERR is bit 3 of FRM_NUM_L.
469
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.6.2
UDP Global State Register
Register Name:
UDP_ GLB_STAT
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
8
–
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
CONFG
0
FADDEN
This register is used to get and set the device state as specified in Chapter 9 of the USB Serial Bus Specification, Rev.2.0.
• FADDEN: Function Address Enable
Read:
0 = Device is not in address state.
1 = Device is in address state.
Write:
0 = No effect, only a reset can bring back a device to the default state.
1 = Sets device in address state. This occurs after a successful Set Address request. Beforehand, the UDP_ FADDR register must have been initialized with Set Address parameters. Set Address must complete the Status Stage before setting
FADDEN. Refer to chapter 9 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more details.
• CONFG: Configured
Read:
0 = Device is not in configured state.
1 = Device is in configured state.
Write:
0 = Sets device in a non configured state
1 = Sets device in configured state.
The device is set in configured state when it is in address state and receives a successful Set Configuration request. Refer
to Chapter 9 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more details.
470
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34.6.3
UDP Function Address Register
Register Name:
UDP_ FADDR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
8
–
FEN
7
–
6
5
4
3
FADD
2
1
0
• FADD[6:0]: Function Address Value
The Function Address Value must be programmed by firmware once the device receives a set address request from the
host, and has achieved the status stage of the no-data control sequence. Refer to the Universal Serial Bus Specification,
Rev. 2.0 for more information. After power up or reset, the function address value is set to 0.
• FEN: Function Enable
Read:
0 = Function endpoint disabled.
1 = Function endpoint enabled.
Write:
0 = Disables function endpoint.
1 = Default value.
The Function Enable bit (FEN) allows the microcontroller to enable or disable the function endpoints. The microcontroller
sets this bit after receipt of a reset from the host. Once this bit is set, the USB device is able to accept and transfer data
packets from and to the host.
471
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.6.4
UDP Interrupt Enable Register
Register Name:
UDP_ IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
WAKEUP
12
–
11
SOFINT
10
–
9
8
RXRSM
RXSUSP
7
6
5
EP5INT
4
EP4INT
3
EP3INT
2
EP2INT
1
EP1INT
0
EP0INT
• EP0INT: Enable Endpoint 0 Interrupt
• EP1INT: Enable Endpoint 1 Interrupt
• EP2INT: Enable Endpoint 2Interrupt
• EP3INT: Enable Endpoint 3 Interrupt
• EP4INT: Enable Endpoint 4 Interrupt
• EP5INT: Enable Endpoint 5 Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables corresponding Endpoint Interrupt.
• RXSUSP: Enable UDP Suspend Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables UDP Suspend Interrupt.
• RXRSM: Enable UDP Resume Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables UDP Resume Interrupt.
• SOFINT: Enable Start Of Frame Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables Start Of Frame Interrupt.
• WAKEUP: Enable UDP bus Wakeup Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables USB bus Interrupt.
472
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34.6.5
UDP Interrupt Disable Register
Register Name:
UDP_ IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
WAKEUP
12
–
11
SOFINT
10
–
9
8
RXRSM
RXSUSP
7
6
5
EP5INT
4
EP4INT
3
EP3INT
2
EP2INT
1
EP1INT
0
EP0INT
• EP0INT: Disable Endpoint 0 Interrupt
• EP1INT: Disable Endpoint 1 Interrupt
• EP2INT: Disable Endpoint 2 Interrupt
• EP3INT: Disable Endpoint 3 Interrupt
• EP4INT: Disable Endpoint 4 Interrupt
• EP5INT: Disable Endpoint 5 Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables corresponding Endpoint Interrupt.
• RXSUSP: Disable UDP Suspend Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables UDP Suspend Interrupt.
• RXRSM: Disable UDP Resume Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables UDP Resume Interrupt.
• SOFINT: Disable Start Of Frame Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables Start Of Frame Interrupt
• WAKEUP: Disable USB Bus Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables USB Bus Wakeup Interrupt.
473
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.6.6
UDP Interrupt Mask Register
Register Name:
UDP_ IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
WAKEUP
12
–
11
SOFINT
10
–
9
8
RXRSM
RXSUSP
7
6
5
EP5INT
4
EP4INT
3
EP3INT
2
EP2INT
1
EP1INT
0
EP0INT
• EP0INT: Mask Endpoint 0 Interrupt
• EP1INT: Mask Endpoint 1 Interrupt
• EP2INT: Mask Endpoint 2 Interrupt
• EP3INT: Mask Endpoint 3 Interrupt
• EP4INT: Mask Endpoint 4 Interrupt
• EP5INT: Mask Endpoint 5 Interrupt
0 = Corresponding Endpoint Interrupt is disabled.
1 = Corresponding Endpoint Interrupt is enabled.
• RXSUSP: Mask UDP Suspend Interrupt
0 = UDP Suspend Interrupt is disabled.
1 = UDP Suspend Interrupt is enabled.
• RXRSM: Mask UDP Resume Interrupt.
0 = UDP Resume Interrupt is disabled.
1 = UDP Resume Interrupt is enabled.
• SOFINT: Mask Start Of Frame Interrupt
0 = Start of Frame Interrupt is disabled.
1 = Start of Frame Interrupt is enabled.
• BIT12: UDP_IMR Bit 12
Bit 12 of UDP_IMR cannot be masked and is always read at 1.
474
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• WAKEUP: USB Bus WAKEUP Interrupt
0 = USB Bus Wakeup Interrupt is disabled.
1 = USB Bus Wakeup Interrupt is enabled.
Note:
When the USB block is in suspend mode, the application may power down the USB logic. In this case, any USB HOST resume
request that is made must be taken into account and, thus, the reset value of the RXRSM bit of the register UDP_ IMR is
enabled.
475
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.6.7
UDP Interrupt Status Register
Register Name:
UDP_ ISR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
WAKEUP
12
ENDBUSRES
11
SOFINT
10
–
9
8
RXRSM
RXSUSP
7
6
5
EP5INT
4
EP4INT
3
EP3INT
2
EP2INT
1
EP1INT
0
EP0INT
• EP0INT: Endpoint 0 Interrupt Status
• EP1INT: Endpoint 1 Interrupt Status
• EP2INT: Endpoint 2 Interrupt Status
• EP3INT: Endpoint 3 Interrupt Status
• EP4INT: Endpoint 4 Interrupt Status
• EP5INT: Endpoint 5 Interrupt Status
0 = No Endpoint0 Interrupt pending.
1 = Endpoint0 Interrupt has been raised.
Several signals can generate this interrupt. The reason can be found by reading UDP_ CSR0:
RXSETUP set to 1
RX_DATA_BK0 set to 1
RX_DATA_BK1 set to 1
TXCOMP set to 1
STALLSENT set to 1
EP0INT is a sticky bit. Interrupt remains valid until EP0INT is cleared by writing in the corresponding UDP_ CSR0 bit.
• RXSUSP: UDP Suspend Interrupt Status
0 = No UDP Suspend Interrupt pending.
1 = UDP Suspend Interrupt has been raised.
The USB device sets this bit when it detects no activity for 3ms. The USB device enters Suspend mode.
• RXRSM: UDP Resume Interrupt Status
0 = No UDP Resume Interrupt pending.
1 =UDP Resume Interrupt has been raised.
The USB device sets this bit when a UDP resume signal is detected at its port.
476
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
After reset, the state of this bit is undefined, the application must clear this bit by setting the RXRSM flag in the UDP_ ICR
register.
• SOFINT: Start of Frame Interrupt Status
0 = No Start of Frame Interrupt pending.
1 = Start of Frame Interrupt has been raised.
This interrupt is raised each time a SOF token has been detected. It can be used as a synchronization signal by using
isochronous endpoints.
• ENDBUSRES: End of BUS Reset Interrupt Status
0 = No End of Bus Reset Interrupt pending.
1 = End of Bus Reset Interrupt has been raised.
This interrupt is raised at the end of a UDP reset sequence. The USB device must prepare to receive requests on the endpoint 0. The host starts the enumeration, then performs the configuration.
• WAKEUP: UDP Resume Interrupt Status
0 = No Wakeup Interrupt pending.
1 = A Wakeup Interrupt (USB Host Sent a RESUME or RESET) occurred since the last clear.
After reset the state of this bit is undefined, the application must clear this bit by setting the WAKEUP flag in the UDP_ ICR
register.
477
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.6.8
UDP Interrupt Clear Register
Register Name:
UDP_ ICR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
WAKEUP
12
ENDBUSRES
11
SOFINT
10
–
9
RXRSM
8
RXSUSP
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
–
• RXSUSP: Clear UDP Suspend Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Clears UDP Suspend Interrupt.
• RXRSM: Clear UDP Resume Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Clears UDP Resume Interrupt.
• SOFINT: Clear Start Of Frame Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Clears Start Of Frame Interrupt.
• ENDBUSRES: Clear End of Bus Reset Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Clears End of Bus Reset Interrupt.
• WAKEUP: Clear Wakeup Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Clears Wakeup Interrupt.
478
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34.6.9
UDP Reset Endpoint Register
Register Name:
UDP_ RST_EP
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
8
–
–
7
6
5
EP5
4
EP4
3
EP3
2
EP2
1
EP1
0
EP0
• EP0: Reset Endpoint 0
• EP1: Reset Endpoint 1
• EP2: Reset Endpoint 2
• EP3: Reset Endpoint 3
• EP4: Reset Endpoint 4
• EP5: Reset Endpoint 5
This flag is used to reset the FIFO associated with the endpoint and the bit RXBYTECOUNT in the register UDP_CSRx.It
also resets the data toggle to DATA0. It is useful after removing a HALT condition on a BULK endpoint. Refer to Chapter
5.8.5 in the USB Serial Bus Specification, Rev.2.0.
Warning: This flag must be cleared at the end of the reset. It does not clear UDP_ CSRx flags.
0 = No reset.
1 = Forces the corresponding endpoint FIF0 pointers to 0, therefore RXBYTECNT field is read at 0 in UDP_ CSRx register.
Reseting the endpoint is a two-step operation:
1. Set the corresponding EPx field.
2. Clear the corresponding EPx field.
479
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.6.10 UDP Endpoint Control and Status Register
Register Name:
UDP_ CSRx [x = 0..5]
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
25
RXBYTECNT
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
RXBYTECNT
15
EPEDS
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
DTGLE
10
9
EPTYPE
8
7
6
RX_DATA_
BK1
5
FORCE
STALL
4
3
STALLSENT
ISOERROR
2
1
RX_DATA_
BK0
0
DIR
TXPKTRDY
RXSETUP
TXCOMP
WARNING: Due to synchronization between MCK and UDPCK, the software application must wait for the end of the write
operation before executing another write by polling the bits which must be set/cleared.
//! Clear flags of UDP UDP_CSR register and waits for synchronization
#define Udp_ep_clr_flag(pInterface, endpoint, flags) { \
pInterface->UDP_CSR[endpoint] &= ~(flags); \
while ( (pInterface->UDP_CSR[endpoint] & (flags)) == (flags) ); \
}
//! Set flags of UDP UDP_CSR register and waits for synchronization
#define Udp_ep_set_flag(pInterface, endpoint, flags) { \
pInterface->UDP_CSR[endpoint] |= (flags); \
while ( (pInterface->UDP_CSR[endpoint] & (flags)) != (flags) ); \
}
Note:
In a preemptive environment, set or clear the flag and wait for a time of 1 UDPCK clock cycle and 1peripheral clock cycle. However, RX_DATA_BLK0, TXPKTRDY, RX_DATA_BK1 require wait times of 3 UDPCK clock cycles and 3 peripheral clock cycles
before accessing DPR.
• TXCOMP: Generates an IN Packet with Data Previously Written in the DPR
This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one.
Write (Cleared by the firmware):
0 = Clear the flag, clear the interrupt.
1 = No effect.
Read (Set by the USB peripheral):
0 = Data IN transaction has not been acknowledged by the Host.
1 = Data IN transaction is achieved, acknowledged by the Host.
After having issued a Data IN transaction setting TXPKTRDY, the device firmware waits for TXCOMP to be sure that the
host has acknowledged the transaction.
480
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• RX_DATA_BK0: Receive Data Bank 0
This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one.
Write (Cleared by the firmware):
0 = Notify USB peripheral device that data have been read in the FIFO's Bank 0.
1 = To leave the read value unchanged.
Read (Set by the USB peripheral):
0 = No data packet has been received in the FIFO's Bank 0.
1 = A data packet has been received, it has been stored in the FIFO's Bank 0.
When the device firmware has polled this bit or has been interrupted by this signal, it must transfer data from the FIFO to
the microcontroller memory. The number of bytes received is available in RXBYTCENT field. Bank 0 FIFO values are read
through the UDP_ FDRx register. Once a transfer is done, the device firmware must release Bank 0 to the USB peripheral
device by clearing RX_DATA_BK0.
After setting or clearing this bit, a wait time of 3 UDPCK clock cycles and 3 peripheral clock cycles is required before
accessing DPR.
• RXSETUP: Received Setup
This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one.
Read:
0 = No setup packet available.
1 = A setup data packet has been sent by the host and is available in the FIFO.
Write:
0 = Device firmware notifies the USB peripheral device that it has read the setup data in the FIFO.
1 = No effect.
This flag is used to notify the USB device firmware that a valid Setup data packet has been sent by the host and successfully received by the USB device. The USB device firmware may transfer Setup data from the FIFO by reading the UDP_
FDRx register to the microcontroller memory. Once a transfer has been done, RXSETUP must be cleared by the device
firmware.
Ensuing Data OUT transaction is not accepted while RXSETUP is set.
• STALLSENT: Stall Sent (Control, Bulk Interrupt Endpoints) / ISOERROR (Isochronous Endpoints)
This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one.
STALLSENT: This ends a STALL handshake.
Read:
0 = The host has not acknowledged a STALL.
1 = Host has acknowledged the stall.
Write:
0 = Resets the STALLSENT flag, clears the interrupt.
1 = No effect.
This is mandatory for the device firmware to clear this flag. Otherwise the interrupt remains.
481
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Refer to chapters 8.4.5 and 9.4.5 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information on the STALL
handshake.
ISOERROR: A CRC error has been detected in an isochronous transfer.
Read:
0 = No error in the previous isochronous transfer.
1 = CRC error has been detected, data available in the FIFO are corrupted.
Write:
0 = Resets the ISOERROR flag, clears the interrupt.
1 = No effect.
• TXPKTRDY: Transmit Packet Ready
This flag is cleared by the USB device.
This flag is set by the USB device firmware.
Read:
0 = Can be set to one to send the FIFO data.
1 = The data is waiting to be sent upon reception of token IN.
Write:
0 = Can be written if old value is zero.
1 = A new data payload is has been written in the FIFO by the firmware and is ready to be sent.
This flag is used to generate a Data IN transaction (device to host). Device firmware checks that it can write a data payload
in the FIFO, checking that TXPKTRDY is cleared. Transfer to the FIFO is done by writing in the UDP_ FDRx register. Once
the data payload has been transferred to the FIFO, the firmware notifies the USB device setting TXPKTRDY to one. USB
bus transactions can start. TXCOMP is set once the data payload has been received by the host.
After setting or clearing this bit, a wait time of 3 UDPCK clock cycles and 3 peripheral clock cycles is required before
accessing DPR.
• FORCESTALL: Force Stall (used by Control, Bulk and Isochronous Endpoints)
Read:
0 = Normal state.
1 = Stall state.
Write:
0 = Return to normal state.
1 = Send STALL to the host.
Refer to chapters 8.4.5 and 9.4.5 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information on the STALL
handshake.
Control endpoints: During the data stage and status stage, this bit indicates that the microcontroller cannot complete the
request.
Bulk and interrupt endpoints: This bit notifies the host that the endpoint is halted.
The host acknowledges the STALL, device firmware is notified by the STALLSENT flag.
482
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• RX_DATA_BK1: Receive Data Bank 1 (only used by endpoints with ping-pong attributes)
This flag generates an interrupt while it is set to one.
Write (Cleared by the firmware):
0 = Notifies USB device that data have been read in the FIFO’s Bank 1.
1 = No effect.
Read (Set by the USB peripheral):
0 = No data packet has been received in the FIFO's Bank 1.
1 = A data packet has been received, it has been stored in FIFO's Bank 1.
When the device firmware has polled this bit or has been interrupted by this signal, it must transfer data from the FIFO to
microcontroller memory. The number of bytes received is available in RXBYTECNT field. Bank 1 FIFO values are read
through UDP_ FDRx register. Once a transfer is done, the device firmware must release Bank 1 to the USB device by
clearing RX_DATA_BK1.
• DIR: Transfer Direction (only available for control endpoints)
Read/Write
0 = Allows Data OUT transactions in the control data stage.
1 = Enables Data IN transactions in the control data stage.
Refer to Chapter 8.5.3 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information on the control data stage.
This bit must be set before UDP_ CSRx/RXSETUP is cleared at the end of the setup stage. According to the request sent
in the setup data packet, the data stage is either a device to host (DIR = 1) or host to device (DIR = 0) data transfer. It is not
necessary to check this bit to reverse direction for the status stage.
• EPTYPE[2:0]: Endpoint Type
Read/Write
000
Control
001
Isochronous OUT
101
Isochronous IN
010
Bulk OUT
110
Bulk IN
011
Interrupt OUT
111
Interrupt IN
• DTGLE: Data Toggle
Read-only
0 = Identifies DATA0 packet.
1 = Identifies DATA1 packet.
Refer to Chapter 8 of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0 for more information on DATA0, DATA1 packet
definitions.
483
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• EPEDS: Endpoint Enable Disable
Read:
0 = Endpoint disabled.
1 = Endpoint enabled.
Write:
0 = Disables endpoint.
1 = Enables endpoint.
Control endpoints are always enabled. Reading or writing this field has no effect on control endpoints.
Note: After reset, all endpoints are configured as control endpoints (zero).
• RXBYTECNT[10:0]: Number of Bytes Available in the FIFO
Read-only
When the host sends a data packet to the device, the USB device stores the data in the FIFO and notifies the microcontroller. The microcontroller can load the data from the FIFO by reading RXBYTECENT bytes in the UDP_ FDRx register.
484
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34.6.11 UDP FIFO Data Register
Register Name:
UDP_ FDRx [x = 0..5]
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
8
–
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FIFO_DATA
• FIFO_DATA[7:0]: FIFO Data Value
The microcontroller can push or pop values in the FIFO through this register.
RXBYTECNT in the corresponding UDP_ CSRx register is the number of bytes to be read from the FIFO (sent by the host).
The maximum number of bytes to write is fixed by the Max Packet Size in the Standard Endpoint Descriptor. It can not be
more than the physical memory size associated to the endpoint. Refer to the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev. 2.0
for more information.
485
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
34.6.12 UDP Transceiver Control Register
Register Name:
UDP_ TXVC
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
8
–
TXVDIS
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
0
–
–
WARNING: The UDP peripheral clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) must be enabled before any read/write
operations to the UDP registers including the UDP_TXCV register.
• TXVDIS: Transceiver Disable
When UDP is disabled, power consumption can be reduced significantly by disabling the embedded transceiver. This can
be done by setting TXVDIS field.
To enable the transceiver, TXVDIS must be cleared.
NOTE: If the USB pullup is not connected on DP, the user should not write in any UDP register other than the UDP_ TXVC
register. This is because if DP and DM are floating at 0, or pulled down, then SE0 is received by the device with the consequence of a USB Reset.
486
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
35.1
Overview
The ADC is based on a Successive Approximation Register (SAR) 10-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). It also integrates an 8-to-1 analog multiplexer, making possible the analog-todigital conversions of 8 analog lines. The conversions extend from 0V to ADVREF.
The ADC supports an 8-bit or 10-bit resolution mode, and conversion results are reported in a
common register for all channels, as well as in a channel-dedicated register. Software trigger,
external trigger on rising edge of the ADTRG pin or internal triggers from Timer Counter output(s) are configurable.
The ADC also integrates a Sleep Mode and a conversion sequencer and connects with a PDC
channel. These features reduce both power consumption and processor intervention.
Finally, the user can configure ADC timings, such as Startup Time and Sample & Hold Time.
35.2
Block Diagram
Figure 35-1. Analog-to-Digital Converter Block Diagram
Timer
Counter
Channels
PMC
MCK
ADC Controller
Trigger
Selection
ADTRG
Control
Logic
ADC Interrupt
AIC
ADC cell
VDDIN
ADVREF
ASB
AD-
Dedicated
Analog
Inputs
PDC
ADUser
Interface
AD-
AD-
Analog Inputs
Multiplexed
with I/O lines
PIO
AD-
Peripheral Bridge
Successive
Approximation
Register
Analog-to-Digital
Converter
APB
AD-
GND
487
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
35.3
Signal Description
Table 35-1.
ADC Pin Description
Pin Name
Description
ADVREF
Reference voltage
AD0 - AD7
Analog input channels
ADTRG
External trigger
35.4
Product Dependencies
35.4.1
Power Management
The ADC Controller clock (MCK) is always clocked.
35.4.2
Interrupt Sources
The ADC interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt
Controller. Using the ADC interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first.
35.4.3
Analog Inputs
The analog input pins can be multiplexed with PIO lines. In this case, the assignment of the ADC
input is automatically done as soon as the corresponding channel is enabled by writing the register ADC_CHER. By default, after reset, the PIO line is configured as input with its pull-up
enabled and the ADC input is connected to the GND.
35.4.4
I/O Lines
The pin ADTRG may be shared with other peripheral functions through the PIO Controller. In
this case, the PIO Controller should be set accordingly to assign the pin ADTRG to the ADC
function.
35.4.5
Timer Triggers
Timer Counters may or may not be used as hardware triggers depending on user requirements.
Thus, some or all of the timer counters may be non-connected.
35.4.6
488
Conversion Performances
For performance and electrical characteristics of the ADC, see the DC Characteristics section.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.5
35.5.1
Functional Description
Analog-to-digital Conversion
The ADC uses the ADC Clock to perform conversions. Converting a single analog value to a 10bit digital data requires Sample and Hold Clock cycles as defined in the field SHTIM of the “ADC
Mode Register” on page 496 and 10 ADC Clock cycles. The ADC Clock frequency is selected in
the PRESCAL field of the Mode Register (ADC_MR).
The ADC clock range is between MCK/2, if PRESCAL is 0, and MCK/128, if PRESCAL is set to
63 (0x3F). PRESCAL must be programmed in order to provide an ADC clock frequency according to the parameters given in the Product definition section.
35.5.2
Conversion Reference
The conversion is performed on a full range between 0V and the reference voltage pin ADVREF.
Analog inputs between these voltages convert to values based on a linear conversion.
35.5.3
Conversion Resolution
The ADC supports 8-bit or 10-bit resolutions. The 8-bit selection is performed by setting the bit
LOWRES in the ADC Mode Register (ADC_MR). By default, after a reset, the resolution is the
highest and the DATA field in the data registers is fully used. By setting the bit LOWRES, the
ADC switches in the lowest resolution and the conversion results can be read in the eight lowest
significant bits of the data registers. The two highest bits of the DATA field in the corresponding
ADC_CDR register and of the LDATA field in the ADC_LCDR register read 0.
Moreover, when a PDC channel is connected to the ADC, 10-bit resolution sets the transfer
request sizes to 16-bit. Setting the bit LOWRES automatically switches to 8-bit data transfers. In
this case, the destination buffers are optimized.
489
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
35.5.4
Conversion Results
When a conversion is completed, the resulting 10-bit digital value is stored in the Channel Data
Register (ADC_CDR) of the current channel and in the ADC Last Converted Data Register
(ADC_LCDR).
The channel EOC bit in the Status Register (ADC_SR) is set and the DRDY is set. In the case of
a connected PDC channel, DRDY rising triggers a data transfer request. In any case, either
EOC and DRDY can trigger an interrupt.
Reading one of the ADC_CDR registers clears the corresponding EOC bit. Reading ADC_LCDR
clears the DRDY bit and the EOC bit corresponding to the last converted channel.
Figure 35-2. EOCx and DRDY Flag Behavior
Write the ADC_CR
with START = 1
Read the ADC_CDRx
Write the ADC_CR
with START = 1
Read the ADC_LCDR
CHx
(ADC_CHSR)
EOCx
(ADC_SR)
Conversion Time
Conversion Time
DRDY
(ADC_SR)
490
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
If the ADC_CDR is not read before further incoming data is converted, the corresponding Overrun Error (OVRE) flag is set in the Status Register (ADC_SR).
In the same way, new data converted when DRDY is high sets the bit GOVRE (General Overrun
Error) in ADC_SR.
The OVRE and GOVRE flags are automatically cleared when ADC_SR is read.
Figure 35-3. GOVRE and OVREx Flag Behavior
Read ADC_SR
ADTRG
CH0
(ADC_CHSR)
CH1
(ADC_CHSR)
ADC_LCDR
Undefined Data
ADC_CDR0
Undefined Data
ADC_CDR1
EOC0
(ADC_SR)
EOC1
(ADC_SR)
Data B
Data A
Data C
Data A
Data C
Undefined Data
Data B
Conversion
Conversion
Conversion
Read ADC_CDR0
Read ADC_CDR1
GOVRE
(ADC_SR)
DRDY
(ADC_SR)
OVRE0
(ADC_SR)
Warning: If the corresponding channel is disabled during a conversion or if it is disabled and
then reenabled during a conversion, its associated data and its corresponding EOC and OVRE
flags in ADC_SR are unpredictable.
491
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
35.5.5
Conversion Triggers
Conversions of the active analog channels are started with a software or a hardware trigger. The
software trigger is provided by writing the Control Register (ADC_CR) with the bit START at 1.
The hardware trigger can be one of the TIOA outputs of the Timer Counter channels, or the
external trigger input of the ADC (ADTRG). The hardware trigger is selected with the field TRGSEL in the Mode Register (ADC_MR). The selected hardware trigger is enabled with the bit
TRGEN in the Mode Register (ADC_MR).
If a hardware trigger is selected, the start of a conversion is triggered after a delay starting at
each rising edge of the selected signal. Due to asynchronism handling, the delay may vary in a
range of 2 MCK clock periods to 1 ADC clock period.
trigger
start
delay
If one of the TIOA outputs is selected, the corresponding Timer Counter channel must be programmed in Waveform Mode.
Only one start command is necessary to initiate a conversion sequence on all the channels. The
ADC hardware logic automatically performs the conversions on the active channels, then waits
for a new request. The Channel Enable (ADC_CHER) and Channel Disable (ADC_CHDR) Registers enable the analog channels to be enabled or disabled independently.
If the ADC is used with a PDC, only the transfers of converted data from enabled channels are
performed and the resulting data buffers should be interpreted accordingly.
Warning: Enabling hardware triggers does not disable the software trigger functionality. Thus, if
a hardware trigger is selected, the start of a conversion can be initiated either by the hardware or
the software trigger.
35.5.6
Sleep Mode and Conversion Sequencer
The ADC Sleep Mode maximizes power saving by automatically deactivating the ADC when it is
not being used for conversions. Sleep Mode is selected by setting the bit SLEEP in the Mode
Register ADC_MR.
The SLEEP mode is automatically managed by a conversion sequencer, which can automatically process the conversions of all channels at lowest power consumption.
When a start conversion request occurs, the ADC is automatically activated. As the analog cell
requires a start-up time, the logic waits during this time and starts the conversion on the enabled
channels. When all conversions are complete, the ADC is deactivated until the next trigger. Triggers occurring during the sequence are not taken into account.
The conversion sequencer allows automatic processing with minimum processor intervention
and optimized power consumption. Conversion sequences can be performed periodically using
a Timer/Counter output. The periodic acquisition of several samples can be processed automatically without any intervention of the processor thanks to the PDC.
Note:
492
The reference voltage pins always remain connected in normal mode as in sleep mode.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.5.7
ADC Timings
Each ADC has its own minimal Startup Time that is programmed through the field STARTUP in
the Mode Register ADC_MR.
In the same way, a minimal Sample and Hold Time is necessary for the ADC to guarantee the
best converted final value between two channels selection. This time has to be programmed
through the bitfield SHTIM in the Mode Register ADC_MR.
Warning: No input buffer amplifier to isolate the source is included in the ADC. This must be
taken into consideration to program a precise value in the SHTIM field. See the section, ADC
Characteristics in the product datasheet.
493
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
35.6
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) User Interface
Table 35-2.
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00
Control Register
ADC_CR
Write-only
–
0x04
Mode Register
ADC_MR
Read-write
0x00000000
0x08
Reserved
–
–
–
0x0C
Reserved
–
–
–
0x10
Channel Enable Register
ADC_CHER
Write-only
–
0x14
Channel Disable Register
ADC_CHDR
Write-only
–
0x18
Channel Status Register
ADC_CHSR
Read-only
0x00000000
0x1C
Status Register
ADC_SR
Read-only
0x000C0000
0x20
Last Converted Data Register
ADC_LCDR
Read-only
0x00000000
0x24
Interrupt Enable Register
ADC_IER
Write-only
–
0x28
Interrupt Disable Register
ADC_IDR
Write-only
–
0x2C
Interrupt Mask Register
ADC_IMR
Read-only
0x00000000
0x30
Channel Data Register 0
ADC_CDR0
Read-only
0x00000000
0x34
Channel Data Register 1
ADC_CDR1
Read-only
0x00000000
...
...
...
ADC_CDR7
Read-only
0x00000000
–
–
–
...
0x4C
0x50 - 0xFC
494
Register Mapping
...
Channel Data Register 7
Reserved
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.6.1
ADC Control Register
Register Name:
ADC_CR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
START
0
SWRST
• SWRST: Software Reset
0 = No effect.
1 = Resets the ADC simulating a hardware reset.
• START: Start Conversion
0 = No effect.
1 = Begins analog-to-digital conversion.
495
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
35.6.2
ADC Mode Register
Register Name:
ADC_MR
Access Type:
Read/Write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
23
–
22
21
20
19
STARTUP
15
14
13
12
26
25
24
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
TRGSEL
1
0
TRGEN
SHTIM
PRESCAL
7
–
6
–
5
SLEEP
4
LOWRES
• TRGEN: Trigger Enable
TRGEN
Selected TRGEN
0
Hardware triggers are disabled. Starting a conversion is only possible by software.
1
Hardware trigger selected by TRGSEL field is enabled.
• TRGSEL: Trigger Selection
TRGSEL
Selected TRGSEL
0
0
0
TIOA Ouput of the Timer Counter Channel 0
0
0
1
TIOA Ouput of the Timer Counter Channel 1
0
1
0
TIOA Ouput of the Timer Counter Channel 2
0
1
1
Reserved
1
0
0
Reserved
1
0
1
Reserved
1
1
0
External trigger
1
1
1
Reserved
• LOWRES: Resolution
LOWRES
Selected Resolution
0
10-bit resolution
1
8-bit resolution
• SLEEP: Sleep Mode
SLEEP
496
Selected Mode
0
Normal Mode
1
Sleep Mode
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• PRESCAL: Prescaler Rate Selection
ADCClock = MCK / ( (PRESCAL+1) * 2 )
• STARTUP: Start Up Time
Startup Time = (STARTUP+1) * 8 / ADCClock
• SHTIM: Sample & Hold Time
Sample & Hold Time = SHTIM/ADCClock
497
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.6.3
ADC Channel Enable Register
Register Name:
ADC_CHER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
CH7
6
CH6
5
CH5
4
CH4
3
CH3
2
CH2
1
CH1
0
CH0
• CHx: Channel x Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding channel.
35.6.4
ADC Channel Disable Register
Register Name:
ADC_CHDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
CH7
6
CH6
5
CH5
4
CH4
3
CH3
2
CH2
1
CH1
0
CH0
• CHx: Channel x Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding channel.
Warning: If the corresponding channel is disabled during a conversion or if it is disabled then reenabled during a conversion, its associated data and its corresponding EOC and OVRE flags in ADC_SR are unpredictable.
498
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.6.5
ADC Channel Status Register
Register Name:
ADC_CHSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
CH7
6
CH6
5
CH5
4
CH4
3
CH3
2
CH2
1
CH1
0
CH0
• CHx: Channel x Status
0 = Corresponding channel is disabled.
1 = Corresponding channel is enabled.
499
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.6.6
ADC Status Register
Register Name:
ADC_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
RXBUFF
18
ENDRX
17
GOVRE
16
DRDY
15
OVRE7
14
OVRE6
13
OVRE5
12
OVRE4
11
OVRE3
10
OVRE2
9
OVRE1
8
OVRE0
7
EOC7
6
EOC6
5
EOC5
4
EOC4
3
EOC3
2
EOC2
1
EOC1
0
EOC0
• EOCx: End of Conversion x
0 = Corresponding analog channel is disabled, or the conversion is not finished.
1 = Corresponding analog channel is enabled and conversion is complete.
• OVREx: Overrun Error x
0 = No overrun error on the corresponding channel since the last read of ADC_SR.
1 = There has been an overrun error on the corresponding channel since the last read of ADC_SR.
• DRDY: Data Ready
0 = No data has been converted since the last read of ADC_LCDR.
1 = At least one data has been converted and is available in ADC_LCDR.
• GOVRE: General Overrun Error
0 = No General Overrun Error occurred since the last read of ADC_SR.
1 = At least one General Overrun Error has occurred since the last read of ADC_SR.
• ENDRX: End of RX Buffer
0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in ADC_RCR or ADC_RNCR.
1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in ADC_RCR or ADC_RNCR.
• RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full
0 = ADC_RCR or ADC_RNCR have a value other than 0.
1 = Both ADC_RCR and ADC_RNCR have a value of 0.
500
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.6.7
ADC Last Converted Data Register
Register Name:
ADC_LCDR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
8
LDATA
0
LDATA
• LDATA: Last Data Converted
The analog-to-digital conversion data is placed into this register at the end of a conversion and remains until a new conversion is completed.
35.6.8
ADC Interrupt Enable Register
Register Name:
ADC_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
RXBUFF
18
ENDRX
17
GOVRE
16
DRDY
15
OVRE7
14
OVRE6
13
OVRE5
12
OVRE4
11
OVRE3
10
OVRE2
9
OVRE1
8
OVRE0
7
EOC7
6
EOC6
5
EOC5
4
EOC4
3
EOC3
2
EOC2
1
EOC1
0
EOC0
• EOCx: End of Conversion Interrupt Enable x
• OVREx: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable x
• DRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Enable
• GOVRE: General Overrun Error Interrupt Enable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
501
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.6.9
ADC Interrupt Disable Register
Register Name:
ADC_IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
RXBUFF
18
ENDRX
17
GOVRE
16
DRDY
15
OVRE7
14
OVRE6
13
OVRE5
12
OVRE4
11
OVRE3
10
OVRE2
9
OVRE1
8
OVRE0
7
EOC7
6
EOC6
5
EOC5
4
EOC4
3
EOC3
2
EOC2
1
EOC1
0
EOC0
• EOCx: End of Conversion Interrupt Disable x
• OVREx: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable x
• DRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Disable
• GOVRE: General Overrun Error Interrupt Disable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
502
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.6.10 ADC Interrupt Mask Register
Register Name:
ADC_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
RXBUFF
18
ENDRX
17
GOVRE
16
DRDY
15
OVRE7
14
OVRE6
13
OVRE5
12
OVRE4
11
OVRE3
10
OVRE2
9
OVRE1
8
OVRE0
7
EOC7
6
EOC6
5
EOC5
4
EOC4
3
EOC3
2
EOC2
1
EOC1
0
EOC0
• EOCx: End of Conversion Interrupt Mask x
• OVREx: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask x
• DRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Mask
• GOVRE: General Overrun Error Interrupt Mask
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask
0 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled.
1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
503
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
35.6.11 ADC Channel Data Register
Register Name:
ADC_CDRx
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
8
DATA
0
DATA
• DATA: Converted Data
The analog-to-digital conversion data is placed into this register at the end of a conversion and remains until a new conversion is completed. The Convert Data Register (CDR) is only loaded if the corresponding analog channel is enabled.
504
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
505
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
506
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
36. Advanced Encryption Standard (AES)
36.1
Description
The Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) is compliant with the American FIPS (Federal Information Processing Standard) Publication 197 specification.
The AES supports all five confidentiality modes of operation for symmetrical key block cipher
algorithms (ECB, CBC, OFB, CFB and CTR), as specified in the NIST Special Publication 80038A Recommendation. It is compatible with all these modes via Peripheral DMA Controller channels, minimizing processor intervention for large buffer transfers.
• For the AT91SAM7XC256 and AT91SAM7XC128, the 128-bit key is stored in four 32-bit
registers (AES_KEYWxR) which are all write-only.
• For the AT91SAM7XC512, the 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit keys are stored in four/six/eight 32-bit
registers (AES_KEYWxR), respectively, which are all write-only.
The 128-bit input data and initialization vector (for some modes) are each stored in four 32-bit
registers (AES_IDATAxR and AES_IVxR) which are all write-only.
As soon as the initialization vector, the input data and the key are configured, the encryption/decryption process may be started. Then the encrypted/decrypted data is ready to be read
out on the four 32-bit output data registers (AES_ODATAxR) or through the PDC channels.
36.2
Product Dependencies
36.2.1
Power Management
The AES may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), so the programmer
must first to configure the PMC to enable the AES clock.
36.2.2
Interrupt
The AES interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC).
Handling the AES interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the AES.
36.3
Functional Description
The Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) specifies a FIPS-approved cryptographic algorithm
that can be used to protect electronic data. The AES algorithm is a symmetric block cipher that
can encrypt (encipher) and decrypt (decipher) information.
Encryption converts data to an unintelligible form called ciphertext. Decrypting the ciphertext
converts the data back into its original form, called plaintext. The CIPHER bit in the AES Mode
Register (AES_MR) allows selection between the encryption and the decryption processes.
The AES is capable of using cryptographic keys of 128/192/256 bits to encrypt and decrypt data
in blocks of 128 bits. This 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit key is defined in the Key Registers
(AES_KEYWxR).
The input to the encryption processes of the CBC, CFB, and OFB modes includes, in addition to
the plaintext, a 128-bit data block called the initialization vector (IV), which must be set in the Initialization Vector Registers (AES_IVxR). The initialization vector is used in an initial step in the
encryption of a message and in the corresponding decryption of the message. The Initialization
Vector Registers are also used by the CTR mode to set the counter value.
507
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
36.3.1
Operation Modes
The AES supports the following modes of operation:
• ECB: Electronic Code Book
• CBC: Cipher Block Chaining
• OFB: Output Feedback
• CFB: Cipher Feedback
– CFB8 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 8 bits)
– CFB16 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 16 bits)
– CFB32 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 32 bits)
– CFB64 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 64 bits)
– CFB128 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 128 bits)
• CTR: Counter
The data pre-processing, post-processing and data chaining for the concerned modes are automatically performed. Refer to the NIST Special Publication 800-38A Recommendation for more
complete information.
These modes are selected by setting the OPMOD field in the AES Mode Register (AES_MR).
In CFB mode, five data sizes are possible (8 bits, 16 bits, 32 bits, 64 bits or 128 bits), configurable by means of the CFBS field in the mode register. (See “AES Mode Register” on page
516.).
36.3.2
Start Modes
The SMOD field in the AES Mode Register (AES_MR) allows selection of the encryption (or
decryption) start mode.
36.3.2.1
Manual Mode
The sequence is as follows:
• Write the 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit key in the Key Registers (AES_KEYWxR).
• Write the initialization vector (or counter) in the Initialization Vector Registers (AES_IVxR).
Note:
The Initialization Vector Registers concern all modes except ECB.
• Set the bit DATRDY (Data Ready) in the AES Interrupt Enable register (AES_IER),
depending on whether an interrupt is required or not at the end of processing.
• Write the data to be encrypted/decrypted in the authorized Input Data Registers (See Table
36-1).
Table 36-1.
508
Authorized Input Data Registers
Operation Mode
Input Data Registers to Write
ECB
All
CBC
All
OFB
All
128-bit CFB
All
64-bit CFB
AES_IDATA1R and AES_IDATA2R
32-bit CFB
AES_IDATA1R
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 36-1.
Authorized Input Data Registers (Continued)
Operation Mode
Input Data Registers to Write
16-bit CFB
AES_IDATA1R
8-bit CFB
AES_IDATA1R
CTR
All
Note:
In 64-bit CFB mode, writing to AES_IDATA3R and AES_IDATA4R registers is not allowed and may
lead to errors in processing.
Note:
In 32-, 16- and 8-bit CFB modes, writing to AES_IDATA2R, AES_IDATA3R and AES_IDATA4R
registers is not allowed and may lead to errors in processing.
• Set the START bit in the AES Control register AES_CR to begin the encryption or the
decryption process.
• When processing completes, the bit DATRDY in the AES Interrupt Status Register
(AES_ISR) raises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit DATRDY in AES_IER,
the interrupt line of the AES is activated.
• When the software reads one of the Output Data Registers (AES_ODATAxR), the DATRDY
bit is automatically cleared.
36.3.2.2
Auto Mode
The Auto Mode is similar to the manual one, except that in this mode, as soon as the correct
number of Input Data registers is written, processing is automatically started without any action
in the Control Register.
36.3.2.3
PDC Mode
The Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) can be used in association with the AES to perform an
encryption/decryption of a buffer without any action by the software during processing.
In this starting mode, the type of the data transfer (byte, half-word or word) depends on the operation mode.
Table 36-2.
Data Transfer Type for the Different Operation Modes
Operation Mode
Data Transfer Type (PDC)
ECB
Word
CBC
Word
OFB
Word
CFB 128-bit
Word
CFB 64-bit
Word
CFB 32-bit
Word
CFB 16-bit
Half-word
CFB 8-bit
Byte
CTR
Word
The sequence is as follows:
• Write the 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit key in the Key Registers (AES_KEYWxR).
• Write the initialization vector (or counter) in the Initialization Vector Registers (AES_IVxR).
509
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Note:
The Initialization Vector Registers concern all modes except ECB.
• Set the Transmit Pointer Register (AES_TPR) to the address where the data buffer to
encrypt/decrypt is stored and the Receive Pointer Register (AES_RPR) where it must be
encrypted/decrypted.
Note:
Transmit and receive buffers can be identical.
• Set the Transmit and the Receive Counter Registers (AES_TCR and AES_RCR) to the same
value. This value must be a multiple of the data transfer type size (see Table 36-2).
Note:
The same requirements are necessary for the Next Pointer(s) and Counter(s) of the PDC
(AES_TNPR, AES_RNPR, AES_TNCR, AES_RNCR).
• If not already done, set the bit ENDRX (or RXBUFF if the next pointers and counters are
used) in the AES Interrupt Enable register (AES_IER), depending on whether an interrupt is
required or not at the end of processing.
• Enable the PDC in transmission and reception to start the processing (AES_PTCR).
• When the processing completes, the bit ENDRX (or RXBUFF) in the AES Interrupt Status
Register (AES_ISR) raises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the corresponding bit
in AES_IER, the interrupt line of the AES is activated.
36.3.3
Last Output Data Mode
This mode is used to generate cryptographic checksums on data (MAC) by means of cipher
block chaining encryption algorithm (CBC-MAC algorithm for example).
After each end of encryption/decryption, the output data is available either on the output data
registers for Manual and Auto mode or at the address specified in the receive buffer pointer for
PDC mode (See Table 36-3 on page 512).
The Last Output Data bit (LOD) in the AES Mode Register (AES_MR) allows retrieval of only the
last data of several encryption/decryption processes.
Therefore, there is no need to define a read buffer in PDC mode.
This data is only available on the Output Data Registers (AES_ODATAxR).
36.3.3.1
Manual and Auto Modes
If LOD = 0
The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Output Data Registers is read (See Figure
36-1).
Figure 36-1. Manual and Auto Modes with LOD = 0
Write START bit in AES_CR (Manual mode)
or
Write AES_IDATAxR register(s) (Auto mode)
Read the AES_ODATAxR
DATRDY
Encryption or Decryption Process
510
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
If the user does not want to read the output data registers between each encryption/decryption,
the DATRDY flag will not be cleared. If the DATRDY flag is not cleared, the user cannot know
the end of the following encryptions/decryptions.
If LOD = 1
The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one Input Data Register is written, so before the start
of a new transfer (See Figure 36-2). No more Output Data Register reads are necessary
between consecutive encryptions/decryptions.
Figure 36-2. Manual and Auto Modes with LOD = 1
Write START bit in AES_CR (Manual mode)
or
Write AES_IDATAxR register(s) (Auto mode)
Write AES_IDATAxR register(s)
DATRDY
Encryption or Decryption Process
36.3.3.2
PDC Mode
If LOD = 0
The end of the encryption/decryption is notified by the ENDRX (or RXBUFF) flag rise (see Figure
36-3).
Figure 36-3. PDC Mode with LOD = 0
Enable PDC Channels (Receive and Transmit Channels)
Multiple Encryption or Decryption Processes
ENDRX (or RXBUFF)
If LOD = 1
The user must first wait for the ENDTX (or TXBUFE) flag to rise, then for DATRDY to ensure that
the encryption/decryption is completed (see Figure 36-4).
In this case, no receive buffers are required.
The output data is only available on the Output Data Registers (AES_ODATAxR).
511
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 36-4. PDC Mode with LOD = 1
Enable PDC Channels (only Transmit Channels)
DATRDY
Multiple Encryption or Decryption Processes
ENDTX (or TXBUFE)
Table 36-3 summarizes the different cases.
Table 36-3.
Last Output Mode Behavior versus Start Modes
Manual and Auto Modes
PDC Mode
LOD = 0
LOD = 1
LOD = 0
LOD = 1
DATRDY Flag Clearing
Condition(1)
At least one Output
Data Register must be
read
At least one Input Data
Register must be written
Not used
Managed by the PDC
Encrypted/Decrypted
Data Result Location
In the Output Data
Registers
In the Output Data
Registers
At the address
specified in the
Receive Pointer
Register (AES_RPR)
In the Output Data
Registers
End of
Encryption/Decryption
DATRDY
DATRDY
ENDRX (or RXBUFF)
ENDTX (or TXBUFE)
then DATRDY
Note:
1. Depending on the mode, there are other ways of clearing the DATRDY flag. See “AES Interrupt Status Register” on
page 522.
Warning: In PDC mode, reading to the Output Data registers before the last data transfer may lead to unpredictable result.
36.3.4
36.3.4.1
Security Features
Countermeasures
The AES also features hardware countermeasures that can be useful to protect data against Differential Power Analysis (DPA) attacks.
These countermeasures can be enabled through the CTYPE field in the AES Mode Register.
This field is write-only, and all changes to it are taken into account if, at the same time, the Countermeasure Key (CKEY field) is correctly written (see “AES Mode Register” on page 516).
Note:
Enabling countermeasures has an impact on the AES encryption/decryption throughput.
By default, all the countermeasures are enabled.
The best throughput is achieved with all the countermeasures disabled. On the other hand, the
best protection is achieved with all of them enabled.
The LOADSEED bit in the AES Control Register (AES_CR) restarts the countermeasures generator to an internal predefined value.
512
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
36.3.4.2
Unspecified Register Access Detection
When an unspecified register access occurs, the URAD bit in the Interrupt Status Register
(AES_ISR) raises. Its source is then reported in the Unspecified Register Access Type field
(URAT). Only the last unspecified register access is available through the URAT field.
Several kinds of unspecified register accesses can occur:
• Input Data Register written during the data processing in PDC mode
• Output Data Register read during data processing
• Mode Register written during data processing
• Output Data Register read during sub-keys generation
• Mode Register written during sub-keys generation
• Write-only register read access
The URAD bit and the URAT field can only be reset by the SWRST bit in the AES_CR control
register.
513
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
36.4
Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) User Interface
Table 36-4.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00
Control Register
AES_CR
Write-only
–
0x04
Mode Register
AES_MR
Read-write
0x0
0x08-0x0C
Reserved
–
–
–
0x10
Interrupt Enable Register
AES_IER
Write-only
–
0x14
Interrupt Disable Register
AES_IDR
Write-only
–
0x18
Interrupt Mask Register
AES_IMR
Read-only
0x0
0x1C
Interrupt Status Register
AES_ISR
Read-only
0x0000001E
0x20
Key Word 1 Register
AES_KEYW1R
Write-only
–
0x24
Key Word 2 Register
AES_KEYW2R
Write-only
–
0x28
Key Word 3 Register
AES_KEYW3R
Write-only
–
0x2C
Key Word 4 Register
AES_KEYW4R
Write-only
–
Key Word 5 Register
(1)
AES_KEYW5R
Write-only
–
Key Word 6 Register
(1)
AES_KEYW6R
Write-only
–
Key Word 7 Register
(1)
AES_KEYW7R
Write-only
–
0x3C
Key Word 8 Register
(1)
AES_KEYW8R
Write-only
–
0x40
Input Data 1 Register
AES_IDATA1R
Write-only
–
0x44
Input Data 2 Register
AES_IDATA2R
Write-only
–
0x48
Input Data 3 Register
AES_IDATA3R
Write-only
–
0x4C
Input Data 4 Register
AES_IDATA4R
Write-only
–
0x50
Output Data 1 Register
AES_ODATA1R
Read-only
0x0
0x54
Output Data 2 Register
AES_ODATA2R
Read-only
0xC01F0000
0x58
Output Data 3 Register
AES_ODATA3R
Read-only
0x0
0x5C
Output Data 4 Register
AES_ODATA4R
Read-only
0x0
0x60
Initialization Vector 1 Register
AES_IV1R
Write-only
–
0x64
Initialization Vector 2 Register
AES_IV2R
Write-only
–
0x68
Initialization Vector 3 Register
AES_IV3R
Write-only
–
0x6C
Initialization Vector 4 Register
AES_IV4R
Write-only
–
0x30
0x34
0x38
0x70 - 0xFC
Reserved
–
–
–
0x100-0x124
Reserved for the PDC
–
–
–
Note:
514
1. Not available in the AT91SAM7XC256 and the AT91SAM7XC128.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
36.4.1
Name:
AES Control Register
AES_CR
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
LOADSEED
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
SWRST
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
START
• START: Start Processing
0 = No effect
1 = Starts manual encryption/decryption process.
• SWRST: Software Reset
0 = No effect.
1 = Resets the AES. A software triggered hardware reset of the AES interface is performed.
• LOADSEED: Random Number Generator Seed Loading
0 = No effect.
1 = Restarts the countermeasures generator to an internal predefined value.
515
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
36.4.2
Name:
AES Mode Register
AES_MR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
30
29
–
–
–
23
22
21
28
15
20
19
18
–
14
13
12
6
5
25
24
17
16
CFBS
11
10
9
KEYSIZE(1)
OPMOD
7
26
CTYPE
CKEY
LOD
27
4
PROCDLY
8
SMOD
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
CIPHER
• CIPHER: Processing Mode
0 = Decrypts data.
1 = Encrypts data.
• PROCDLY: Processing Delay
Processing Time = 12 × ( PROCDLY + 1 )
The processing time represents the number of clock cycles that the AES needs in order to perform one encryption/decryption with no countermeasures activated.
Note:
The best performance is achieved with PROCDLY equal to 0.
• SMOD: Start Mode
SMOD
Description
0
0
Manual Mode
0
1
Auto Mode
PDC Mode
1
0
• LOD = 0: The encrypted/decrypted data are available at the address specified in the
receive pointer registers (AES_RPR, AES_RNPR).
• LOD = 1: The encrypted/decrypted data are available in the output data registers.
1
1
Reserved
• KEYSIZE: Key Size(1)
KEYSIZE
Note:
516
Description
0
0
AES Key Size is 128 bits
0
1
AES Key Size is 192 bits(1)
1
X
AES Key Size is 256 bits(1)
1. The key size for AT91SAM7XC128 and AT91SAM7XC256 is 128 bits.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• OPMOD: Operation Mode
OPMOD
Description
0
0
0
ECB: Electronic Code Book mode
0
0
1
CBC: Cipher Block Chaining mode
0
1
0
OFB: Output Feedback mode
0
1
1
CFB: Cipher Feedback mode
1
0
0
CTR: Counter mode
others
Reserved
• LOD: Last Output Data Mode
0 = No effect.
After each end of encryption/decryption, the output data is available either on the output data registers (Manual and Auto
modes), or at the address specified in the receive buffer pointer (PDC mode).
In Manual and Auto modes, the DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Output Data registers is read.
1 = The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Input Data Registers is written.
No more Output Data Register reads is necessary between consecutive encryptions/decryptions (see “Last Output Data
Mode” on page 510).
Warning: In PDC mode, reading to the Output Data registers before the last data encryption/decryption process may lead to
unpredictable results.
• CFBS: Cipher Feedback Data Size
CFBS
Description
0
0
0
128-bit
0
0
1
64-bit
0
1
0
32-bit
0
1
1
16-bit
1
0
0
8-bit
Others
Reserved
• CKEY: Countermeasure Key
This field should be written with the value 0xE to allow CTYPE field changes.
If the field is written with a different value, changes made through the CTYPE field will not be taken into account.
Note:
CKEY field is write-only.
• CTYPE: Countermeasure Type
CTYPE
Description
X
X
X
X
0
Countermeasure type 1 is disabled
X
X
X
X
1
Countermeasure type 1 is enabled
X
X
X
0
X
Countermeasure type 2 is disabled
517
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
CTYPE
Description
X
X
X
1
X
Countermeasure type 2 is enabled
X
X
0
X
X
Countermeasure type 3 is disabled
X
X
1
X
X
Countermeasure type 3 is enabled
X
0
X
X
X
Countermeasure type 4 is disabled
X
1
X
X
X
Countermeasure type 4 is enabled
0
X
X
X
X
Countermeasure type 5 is disabled
1
X
X
X
X
Countermeasure type 5 is enabled
Note:
All the countermeasures are enabled by default.
Note:
CTYPE field is write-only and can only be modified if CKEY is correctly set.
518
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
36.4.3
Name:
AES Interrupt Enable Register
AES_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
URAD
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
DATRDY
• DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Enable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Enable
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable
• URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
519
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
36.4.4
Name:
AES Interrupt Disable Register
AES_IDR
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
URAD
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
DATRDY
• DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Disable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Disable
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable
• URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
520
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
36.4.5
Name:
AES Interrupt Mask Register
AES_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
URAD
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
DATRDY
• DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Mask
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Mask
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask
• URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Mask
0 = The corresponding interrupt is not enabled.
1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
521
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
36.4.6
Name:
AES Interrupt Status Register
AES_ISR
Access Type: Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
URAD
URAT
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
DATRDY
• DATRDY: Data Ready
0 = Output data is not valid.
1 = Encryption or decryption process is completed.
DATRDY is cleared when a Manual encryption/decryption occurs (START bit in AES_CR) or when a software triggered
hardware reset of the AES interface is performed (SWRST bit in AES_CR).
LOD = 0 (AES_MR):
In Manual and Auto mode, the DATRDY flag can also be cleared when at least one of the Output Data Registers is read.
In PDC mode, DATRDY is set and cleared automatically.
LOD = 1 (AES_MR):
In Manual and Auto mode, the DATRDY flag can also be cleared when at least one of the Input Data Registers is written.
In PDC mode, DATRDY is set and cleared automatically.
• ENDRX: End of RX Buffer
0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in AES_RCR or AES_RNCR.
1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in AES_RCR or AES_RNCR.
Note:
This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit cleared.
• ENDTX: End of TX Buffer
0 = The Transmit Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in AES_TCR or AES_TNCR.
1 = The Transmit Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in AES_TCR or AES_TNCR.
Note:
This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit set.
• RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full
0 = AES_RCR or AES_RNCR has a value other than 0.
1 =This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit cleared.
Both AES_RCR and AES_RNCR have a value of 0.
Note:
• TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty
0 = AES_TCR or AES_TNCR has a value other than 0.
522
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
1 = Both AES_TCR and AES_TNCR have a value of 0.
Note:
This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit set.
• URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Status
0 = No unspecified register access has been detected since the last SWRST.
1 = At least one unspecified register access has been detected since the last SWRST.
URAD bit is reset only by the SWRST bit in the AES_CR control register.
• URAT: Unspecified Register Access Type:
URAT
Description
0
0
0
Input Data Register written during the data processing in PDC mode.
0
0
1
Output Data Register read during the data processing.
0
1
0
Mode Register written during the data processing.
0
1
1
Output Data Register read during the sub-keys generation.
1
0
0
Mode Register written during the sub-keys generation.
1
0
1
Write-only register read access.
others
Reserved
Only the last Unspecified Register Access Type is available through the URAT field.
URAT field is reset only by the SWRST bit in the AES_CR control register.
523
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
36.4.7
Name:
AES Key Word x Register
AES_KEYWxR
Access Type:
31
Write-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
KEYWx
23
22
21
20
KEYWx
15
14
13
12
KEYWx
7
6
5
4
KEYWx
• KEYWx: Key Word x
The four/six/eight 32-bit Key Word registers set the 128-bit/192-bit/256-bit cryptographic key used for
encryption/decryption.
KEYW1 corresponds to the first word of the key and respectively KEYW4/KEYW6/KEYW8 to the last one.
These registers are write-only to prevent the key from being read by another application.
524
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
36.4.8
Name:
AES Input Data x Register
AES_IDATAxR
Access Type:
31
Write-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
IDATAx
23
22
21
20
IDATAx
15
14
13
12
IDATAx
7
6
5
4
IDATAx
• IDATAx: Input Data Word x
The four 32-bit Input Data registers set the 128-bit data block used for encryption/decryption.
IDATA1 corresponds to the first word of the data to be encrypted/decrypted, and IDATA4 to the last one.
These registers are write-only to prevent the input data from being read by another application.
36.4.9
Name:
AES Output Data x Register
AES_ODATAxR
Access Type:
31
Read-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ODATAx
23
22
21
20
ODATAx
15
14
13
12
ODATAx
7
6
5
4
ODATAx
• ODATAx: Output Data x
The four 32-bit Output Data registers contain the 128-bit data block that has been encrypted/decrypted.
ODATA1 corresponds to the first word, ODATA4 to the last one.
525
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
36.4.10
Name:
AES Initialization Vector x Register
AES_IVxR
Access Type:
31
Write-only
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
IVx
23
22
21
20
IVx
15
14
13
12
IVx
7
6
5
4
IVx
• IVx: Initialization Vector x
The four 32-bit Initialization Vector registers set the 128-bit Initialization Vector data block that is used by some modes of
operation as an additional initial input.
IV1 corresponds to the first word of the Initialization Vector, IV4 to the last one.
These registers are write-only to prevent the Initialization Vector from being read by another application.
For CBC, OFB and CFB modes, the Initialization Vector corresponds to the initialization vector.
For CTR mode, it corresponds to the counter value.
Note:
526
These registers are not used in ECB mode and must not be written.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37. Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES)
37.1
Overview
The Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES) is compliant with the American FIPS (Federal
Information Processing Standard) Publication 46-3 specification.
The TDES supports the four different confidentiality modes of operation (ECB, CBC, OFB and
CFB), specified in the FIPS (Federal Information Processing Standard) Publication 81 and is
compatible with the Peripheral Data Controller channels for all of these modes, minimizing processor intervention for large buffer transfers.
The 64-bit long keys and input data (and initialization vector for some modes) are each stored in
two 32-bit registers (TDES_KEYxWxR, TDES_IDATAxR and TDES_IVxR) which are both writeonly.
As soon as the initialization vector, the input data and the key are configured, the encryption/decryption process may be started. Then the encrypted/decrypted data is ready to be read
out on the two 32-bit output data registers (TDES_ODATAxR) or through the PDC channels.
37.2
Product Dependencies
37.2.1
Power Management
The TDES may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), so the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the TDES clock.
37.2.2
Interrupt
The TDES interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC).
Handling the TDES interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the TDES.
37.3
Functional Description
The Data Encryption Standard (DES) and the Triple Data Encryption Algorithm (TDEA) specify
FIPS-approved cryptographic algorithms that can be used to protect electronic data. The TDES
bit in the TDES Mode Register (TDES_MR) is used to select either the single DES or the Triple
DES mode.
Encryption (enciphering) converts data to an unintelligible form called ciphertext. Decrypting
(deciphering) the ciphertext converts the data back into its original form, called plaintext. The
CIPHER bit in the TDES Mode Register is used to choose between encryption and decryption.
A DES is capable of using cryptographic keys of 64 bits to encrypt and decrypt data in blocks of
64 bits. This 64-bit key is defined in the Key 1 Word Registers (TDES_KEY1WxR).
A TDEA key consists of three DES keys, which is also referred to as a key bundle. These three
64-bit keys are defined, respectively, in the Key 1, 2 and 3 Word Registers (TDES_KEY1WxR,
TDES_KEY2WxR and TDES_KEY3WxR). In Triple DES mode (TDESMOD set to 1), the KEYMOD bit in the TDES Mode Register is used to choose between a two- and a three-key
algorithm:
– In three-key encryption mode, the data is first encrypted with Key 1, then decrypted
using Key 2 and then encrypted with Key 3.
– In three-key decryption mode, the data is decrypted with Key 3, then encrypted with
Key 2 and then decrypted using Key 1.
527
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
– In two-key encryption mode, the data is first encrypted with Key 1, then decrypted
using Key 2 and then encrypted with Key 1.
– In two-key decryption mode, the data is decrypted with Key 1, then encrypted with
Key 2 and then decrypted using Key 1.
The input to the encryption processes of the CBC, CFB, and OFB modes includes, in addition to
the plaintext, a 64-bit data block called the initialization vector (IV), which must be set in the Initialization Vector Registers (TDES_IVxR). The initialization vector is used in an initial step in the
encryption of a message and in the corresponding decryption of the message.
37.3.1
Operation Modes
The TDES supports the following modes of operation:
• ECB: Electronic Code Book
• CBC: Cipher Block Chaining
• OFB: Output Feedback
• CFB: Cipher Feedback
– CFB8 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 8 bits)
– CFB16 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 16 bits)
– CFB32 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 32 bits)
– CFB64 (CFB where the length of the data segment is 64 bits)
The data pre-processing, post-processing and data chaining for each mode are automatically
performed. Refer to the FIPS Publication 81 for more complete information.
These modes are selected by setting the OPMOD field in the TDES Mode Register (TDES_MR).
In CFB mode, four data sizes are possible (8, 16, 32 and 64 bits), configurable by means of the
CFBS field in the mode register. (See “TDES Mode Register” on page 536.).
37.3.2
Start Modes
The SMOD field in the TDES Mode Register (TDES_MR) allows selection of encryption (or
decryption) start mode.
37.3.2.1
Manual Mode
The sequence is as follows:
• Write the 64-bit key(s) in the different Key Word Registers (TDES_KEYxWxR), depending on
whether one, two or three keys are required.
• Write the initialization vector (or counter) in the Initialization Vector Registers (TDES_IVxR).
Note:
The Initialization Vector Registers concern all modes except ECB.
• Set the bit DATRDY (Data Ready) in the TDES Interrupt Enable register (TDES_IER),
depending on whether an interrupt is required or not at the end of processing.
• Write the data to be encrypted/decrypted in the authorized Input Data Registers (See Table
37-1).
Table 37-1.
528
Authorized Input Data Registers
Operation Mode
Input Data Registers to Write
ECB
All
CBC
All
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 37-1.
Note:
Authorized Input Data Registers (Continued)
Operation Mode
Input Data Registers to Write
OFB
All
CFB 64-bit
All
CFB 32-bit
TDES_IDATA1R
CFB 16-bit
TDES_IDATA1R
CFB 8-bit
TDES_IDATA1R
In 32-, 16- and 8-bit CFB mode, writing to TDES_IDATA2R register is not allowed and may lead to
errors in processing.
• Set the START bit in the TDES Control register TDES_CR to begin the encryption or the
decryption process.
• When the processing completes, the bit DATRDY in the TDES Interrupt Status Register
(TDES_ISR) raises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the bit DATRDY in
TDES_IER, the interrupt line of the TDES is activated.
• When the software reads one of the Output Data Registers (TDES_ODATAxR), the DATRDY
bit is automatically cleared.
37.3.2.2
Auto Mode
The Auto Mode is similar to Manual Mode, except that, as soon as the correct number of Input
Data registers is written, processing is automatically started without any action in the control
register.
37.3.2.3
PDC Mode
The Peripheral Data Controller (PDC) can be used in association with the TDES to perform an
encryption/decryption of a buffer without any action by the software during processing.
In this starting mode, the type of the data transfer (byte, half-word or word) depends on the operation mode as per Table 37-2.
Table 37-2.
Data Transfer Type for Different Operation Modes
Operation Mode
Data Transfer Type (PDC)
ECB
Word
CBC
Word
OFB
Word
CFB 64-bit
Word
CFB 32-bit
Word
CFB 16-bit
Half-word
CFB 8-bit
Byte
The sequence is as follows:
• Write the 64-bit key(s) in the different Key Word Registers (TDES_KEYxWxR), depending on
whether one, two or three keys are required.
• Write the initialization vector (or counter) in the Initialization Vector Registers (TDES_IVxR).
Note:
The Initialization Vector Registers concern all modes except ECB.
529
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• Set the Transmit Pointer Register (TDES_TPR) to the address where the data buffer to
encrypt/decrypt is stored and the Receive Pointer Register (TDES_RPR) where it must be
encrypted/decrypted.
Note:
Transmit and receive buffers can be identical.
• Set the Transmit and the Receive Counter Registers (TDES_TCR and TDES_RCR) to the
same value. This value must be a multiple of the data transfer type size (see Table 37-2).
Note:
The same requirements are necessary for the Next Pointer(s) and Counter(s) of the PDC
(TDES_TNPR, TDES_RNPR, TDES_TNCR, TDES_RNCR).
• If not already done, set the bit ENDRX (or RXBUFF if the next pointers and counters are
used) in the TDES Interrupt Enable register (TDES_IER), depending on whether an interrupt
is required or not at the end of processing.
• Enable the PDC in transmission and reception to start the processing (TDES_PTCR).
• When the processing completes, the bit ENDRX (or RXBUFF) in the TDES Interrupt Status
Register (TDES_ISR) raises. If an interrupt has been enabled by setting the corresponding
bit in TDES_IER, the interrupt line of the TDES is activated.
37.3.3
Last Output Data Mode
This mode is used to generate cryptographic checksums on data (MAC) using a CBC or a CFB
encryption algorithm (See FIPS Publication 81 Appendix F).
After each end of encryption/decryption, the output data is available either on the output data
registers for Manual and Auto mode or at the address specified in the receive buffer pointer for
PDC mode (See Table on page 532).
The Last Output Data bit (LOD) in the TDES Mode Register (TDES_MR) retrieves only the last
data of several encryption/decryption processes.
Therefore, there is no need to define a read buffer in PDC mode.
This data is only available on the Output Data Registers (TDES_ODATAxR).
37.3.3.1
Manual and Auto Modes
If LOD = 0:
The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Output Data Registers is read. See Figure
37-1.
Figure 37-1. Manual and Auto Modes with LOD = 0
Write START bit in TDES_CR (Manual mode)
or
Write TDES_IDATAxR register(s) (Auto mode)
Read the TDES_ODATAxR
DATRDY
Encryption or Decryption Process
530
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
If the user does not want to read the output data registers between each encryption/decryption,
the DATRDY flag will not be cleared. If the DATRDY flag is not cleared, the user will not be
informed of the end of the encryptions/decryptions that follow.
If LOD = 1:
The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one Input Data Register is written, before the start of
a new transfer. See Figure 37-2. No further Output Data Register reads are necessary between
consecutive encryptions/decryptions.
Figure 37-2. Manual and Auto Modes with LOD = 1
Write START bit in TDES_CR (Manual mode)
or
Write TDES_IDATAxR register(s) (Auto mode)
Write TDES_IDATAxR register(s)
DATRDY
Encryption or Decryption Process
37.3.3.2
PDC Mode
If LOD = 0:
The end of the encryption/decryption is notified by the ENDRX (or RXBUFF) flag rise See Figure
37-3.
Figure 37-3. PDC mode with LOD = 0:
Enable PDC Channels (Receive and Transmit Channels)
Multiple Encryption or Decryption Process
ENDRX (or RXBUFF)
If LOD = 1:
The user must first wait for the ENDTX (or TXBUFE) flag rise, then for DATRDY to ensure that
the encryption/decryption is completed. See Figure 37-4.
In this case, no receive buffers are required.
The output data is only available on the Output Data Registers (TDES_ODATAxR).
531
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 37-4. PDC Mode with LOD = 1:
Enable PDC Channels (only Transmit Channels)
DATRDY
Multiple Encryption or Decryption Process
ENDTX (or TXBUFE)
Table 37-3 summarizes the different cases.
Table 37-3.
Last Output Mode Behavior versus Start Modes
Manual and Auto Modes
DATRDY Flag
Clearing Condition(1)
PDC Mode
LOD = 0
LOD = 1
LOD = 0
LOD = 1
At least one Output
Data Register must be
read
At least one Input Data
Register must be written
Not used
Managed by the PDC
In the Output Data
Registers
ENDTX (or TXBUFE)
then DATRDY
Encrypted/Decrypted
Data Result Location
In the Output Data
Registers
In the Output Data
Registers
At the address
specified in the
Receive Pointer
Register
(TDES_RPR)
End of
Encryption/Decryption
DATRDY
DATRDY
ENDRX (or RXBUFF)
Note:
1. Depending on the mode, there are other ways of clearing the DATRDY flag. See “TDES Interrupt Status Register” on page
541.
Warning: In PDC mode, reading to the Output Data registers before the last data transfer may lead to unpredictable result.
532
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37.3.4
Security Features
When an unspecified register access occurs, the URAD bit in the Interrupt Status Register
(TDES_ISR) raises. Its source is then reported in the Unspecified Register Access Type field
(URAT). Only the last unspecified register access is available through the URAT field.
Several kinds of unspecified register accesses can occur:
• Input Data Register written during the data processing in PDC mode
• Output Data Register read during the data processing
• Mode Register written during the data processing
• Write-only register read access
The URAD bit and the URAT field can only be reset by the SWRST bit in the TDES_CR control
register.
533
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
37.4
Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES) User Interface
Table 37-4.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00
Control Register
TDES_CR
Write-only
–
0x04
Mode Register
TDES_MR
Read-write
0x2
0x08-0x0C
Reserved
–
–
–
0x10
Interrupt Enable Register
TDES_IER
Write-only
–
0x14
Interrupt Disable Register
TDES_IDR
Write-only
–
0x18
Interrupt Mask Register
TDES_IMR
Read-only
0x0
0x1C
Interrupt Status Register
TDES_ISR
Read-only
0x0000001E
0x20
Key 1 Word 1 Register
TDES_KEY1W1R
Write-only
–
0x24
Key 1 Word 2 Register
TDES_KEY1W2R
Write-only
–
0x28
Key 2 Word 1 Register
TDES_KEY2W1R
Write-only
–
0x2C
Key 2 Word 2 Register
TDES_KEY2W2R
Write-only
–
0x30
Key 3 Word 1 Register
TDES_KEY3W1R
Write-only
–
0x34
Key 3 Word 2 Register
TDES_KEY3W2R
Write-only
–
0x38-0x3C
Reserved
–
–
–
0x40
Input Data 1 Register
TDES_IDATA1R
Write-only
–
0x44
Input Data 2 Register
TDES_IDATA2R
Write-only
–
–
–
–
0x48-0x4C
Reserved
0x50
Output Data 1 Register
TDES_ODATA1R
Read-only
0x0
0x54
Output Data 2 Register
TDES_ODATA2R
Read-only
0x0
–
–
–
0x58-0x5C
Reserved
0x60
Initialization Vector 1 Register
TDES_IV1R
Write-only
–
0x64
Initialization Vector 2 Register
TDES_IV2R
Write-only
–
0x68 - 0xFC
Reserved
–
–
–
0x100-0x124
Reserved for the PDC
–
–
–
534
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37.4.1
TDES Control Register
Register name: TDES_CR
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
SWRST
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
START
• START: Start Processing
0 = No effect
1 = Starts Manual encryption/decryption process.
• SWRST: Software Reset
0 = No effect.
1 = Resets the TDES. A software triggered hardware reset of the TDES interface is performed.
535
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
37.4.2
Name:
TDES Mode Register
TDES_MR
Access Type: Read-write
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
LOD
–
–
–
OPMOD
16
CFBS
9
8
SMOD
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
KEYMOD
–
–
TDESMOD
CIPHER
• CIPHER: Processing Mode
0 = Decrypts data.
1 = Encrypts data.
• TDESMOD: Single or Triple DES Mode
0 = Single DES processing using TDES_KEY1WxR registers.
1= Triple DES processing using TDES_KEY1WxR, TDES_KEY2WxR and TDES_KEY3WxR registers.
• KEYMOD: Key Mode
0 = Three-key algorithm is selected.
1 = Two-key algorithm is selected. There is no need to write TDES_KEY3WxR registers.
• SMOD: Start Mode
SMOD
Description
0
0
Manual Mode.
0
1
Auto Mode.
PDC Mode.
1
0
• LOD = 0: The encrypted/decrypted data are available at the address specified in the
receive pointer registers (TDES_RPR, TDES_RNPR).
• LOD = 1: The encrypted/decrypted data are available in the output data registers.
1
1
Reserved
• OPMOD: Operation Mode
OPMOD
536
Description
0
0
ECB: Electronic Code Book mode
0
1
CBC: Cipher Block Chaining mode
1
0
OFB: Output Feedback mode
1
1
CFB: Cipher Feedback mode
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• LOD: Last Output Data Mode
0 = No effect.
After each end of encryption/decryption, the output data is available either on the output data registers (Manual and Auto
modes), or at the address specified in the receive buffer pointer (PDC mode).
In Manual and Auto modes, the DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Output Data registers is read.
1 = The DATRDY flag is cleared when at least one of the Input Data Registers is written.
No more Output Data Register reads are necessary between consecutive encryptions/decryptions (See “Last Output Data
Mode” on page 530.).
Warning: In PDC mode, reading to the Output Data registers before the last data encryption/decryption process may lead to
unpredictable result.
• CFBS: Cipher Feedback Data Size
CFBS
Description
0
0
64-bit
0
1
32-bit
1
0
16-bit
1
1
8-bit
537
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
37.4.3
Name:
TDES Interrupt Enable Register
TDES_IER
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
URAD
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
DATRDY
• DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Enable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Enable
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable
• URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
538
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37.4.4
Name:
TDES Interrupt Disable Register
TDES_IDR
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
URAD
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
DATRDY
• DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Disable
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Disable
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable
• URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
539
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
37.4.5
Name:
TDES Interrupt Mask Register
TDES_IMR
Access Type: Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
URAD
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
DATRDY
• DATRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Mask
• ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask
• ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Mask
• RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask
• TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask
• URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Interrupt Mask
0 = The corresponding interrupt is not enabled.
1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
540
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37.4.6
Name:
TDES Interrupt Status Register
TDES_ISR
Access Type: Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
URAD
URAT
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
DATRDY
• DATRDY: Data Ready
0 = Output data is not valid.
1 = Encryption or decryption process is completed.
DATRDY is cleared when a Manual encryption/decryption occurs (START bit in TDES_CR) or when a software triggered
hardware reset of the TDES interface is performed (SWRST bit in TDES_CR).
LOD = 0 (TDES_MR):
In Manual and Auto mode, the DATRDY flag can also be cleared when at least one of the Output Data Registers is read.
In PDC mode, DATRDY is set and cleared automatically.
LOD = 1 (TDES_MR):
In Manual and Auto mode, the DATRDY flag can also be cleared when at least one of the Input Data Registers is written.
In PDC mode, DATRDY is set and cleared automatically.
• ENDRX: End of RX Buffer
0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in TDES_RCR or TDES_RNCR.
1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in TDES_RCR or TDES_RNCR.
Note:
This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit cleared.
• ENDTX: End of TX Buffer
0 = The Transmit Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in TDES_TCR or TDES_TNCR.
1 = The Transmit Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in TDES_TCR or TDES_TNCR.
Note:
This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit set.
• RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full
0 = TDES_RCR or TDES_RNCR has a value other than 0.
1 =This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit cleared.
Both TDES_RCR and TDES_RNCR have a value of 0.
Note:
• TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty
0 = TDES_TCR or TDES_TNCR has a value other than 0.
541
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
1 = Both TDES_TCR and TDES_TNCR have a value of 0.
Note:
This flag must be used only in PDC mode with LOD bit set.
• URAD: Unspecified Register Access Detection Status
0 = No unspecified register access has been detected since the last SWRST.
1 = At least one unspecified register access has been detected since the last SWRST.
URAD bit is reset only by the SWRST bit in the TDES_CR control register.
• URAT: Unspecified Register Access Type:
URAT
Description
0
0
Input Data Register written during the data processing in PDC mode.
0
1
Output Data Register read during the data processing.
1
0
Mode Register written during the data processing.
1
1
Write-only register read access.
Only the last Unspecified Register Access Type is available through the URAT field.
URAT field is reset only by the SWRST bit in the TDES_CR control register.
542
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37.4.7
Name:
TDES Key 1 Word x Register
TDES_KEY1WxR
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
KEY1Wx
23
22
21
20
KEY1Wx
15
14
13
12
KEY1Wx
7
6
5
4
KEY1Wx
• KEY1Wx: Key 1 Word x
The two 32-bit Key 1 Word Registers allow to set the 64-bit cryptographic key used for encryption/decryption.
KEY1W1 corresponds to the first word of the key and KEY1W2 to the last one.
These registers are write-only to prevent the key from being read by another application.
543
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
37.4.8
Name:
TDES Key 2 Word x Register
TDES_KEY2WxR
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
KEY2Wx
23
22
21
20
KEY2Wx
15
14
13
12
KEY2Wx
7
6
5
4
KEY2Wx
• KEY2Wx: Key 2 Word x
The two 32-bit Key 2 Word Registers allow to set the 64-bit cryptographic key used for encryption/decryption.
KEY2W1 corresponds to the first word of the key and KEY2W2 to the last one.
These registers are write-only to prevent the key from being read by another application.
Note:
544
KEY2WxR registers are not used in DES mode.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37.4.9
Name:
TDES Key 3 Word x Register
TDES_KEY3WxR
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
KEY3Wx
23
22
21
20
KEY3Wx
15
14
13
12
KEY3Wx
7
6
5
4
KEY3Wx
• KEY3Wx: Key 3 Word x
The two 32-bit Key 3 Word Registers allow to set the 64-bit cryptographic key used for encryption/decryption.
KEY3W1 corresponds to the first word of the key and KEY3W2 to the last one.
These registers are write-only to prevent the key from being read by another application.
Note:
KEY3WxR registers are not used in DES mode and TDES with two-key algorithm selected.
545
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37.4.10
Name:
TDES Input Data x Register
TDES_IDATAxR
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
IDATAx
23
22
21
20
IDATAx
15
14
13
12
IDATAx
7
6
5
4
IDATAx
• IDATAx: Input Data x
The two 32-bit Input Data registers allow to set the 64-bit data block used for encryption/decryption.
IDATA1 corresponds to the first word of the data to be encrypted/decrypted, and IDATA2 to the last one.
These registers are write-only to prevent the input data from being read by another application.
546
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37.4.11
Name:
TDES Output Data x Register
TDES_ODATAxR
Access Type: Read-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ODATAx
23
22
21
20
ODATAx
15
14
13
12
ODATAx
7
6
5
4
ODATAx
• ODATAx: Output Data x
The two 32-bit Output Data registers contain the 64-bit data block which has been encrypted/decrypted.
ODATA1 corresponds to the first word, ODATA2 to the last one.
547
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
37.4.12
Name:
TDES Initialization Vector x Register
TDES_IVxR
Access Type: Write-only
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
IVx
23
22
21
20
IVx
15
14
13
12
IVx
7
6
5
4
IVx
• IVx: Initialization Vector x
The two 32-bit Initialization Vector registers are used to set the 64-bit initialization vector data block, which is used by some
modes of operation as an additional initial input.
IV1 corresponds to the first word of the Initialization Vector, IV2 to the last one.
These registers are write-only to prevent the Initialization Vector from being read by another application.
Note:
These registers are not used for ECB mode and must not be written.
548
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38. Controller Area Network (CAN)
38.1
Overview
The CAN controller provides all the features required to implement the serial communication
protocol CAN defined by Robert Bosch GmbH, the CAN specification as referred to by
ISO/11898A (2.0 Part A and 2.0 Part B) for high speeds and ISO/11519-2 for low speeds. The
CAN Controller is able to handle all types of frames (Data, Remote, Error and Overload) and
achieves a bitrate of 1 Mbit/sec.
CAN controller accesses are made through configuration registers. 8 independent message
objects (mailboxes) are implemented.
Any mailbox can be programmed as a reception buffer block (even non-consecutive buffers).
For the reception of defined messages, one or several message objects can be masked without
participating in the buffer feature. An interrupt is generated when the buffer is full. According to
the mailbox configuration, the first message received can be locked in the CAN controller registers until the application acknowledges it, or this message can be discarded by new received
messages.
Any mailbox can be programmed for transmission. Several transmission mailboxes can be
enabled in the same time. A priority can be defined for each mailbox independently.
An internal 16-bit timer is used to stamp each received and sent message. This timer starts
counting as soon as the CAN controller is enabled. This counter can be reset by the application
or automatically after a reception in the last mailbox in Time Triggered Mode.
The CAN controller offers optimized features to support the Time Triggered Communication
(TTC) protocol.
549
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
38.2
Block Diagram
Figure 38-1. CAN Block Diagram
Controller Area Network
CANRX
CAN Protocol Controller
PIO
CANTX
Error Counter
Mailbox
Priority
Encoder
Control
&
Status
MB0
MB1
MCK
PMC
MBx
(x = number of mailboxes - 1)
CAN Interrupt
User Interface
Internal Bus
550
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.3
Application Block Diagram
Figure 38-2.
38.4
Application Block Diagram
Layers
Implementation
CAN-based Profiles
Software
CAN-based Application Layer
Software
CAN Data Link Layer
CAN Controller
CAN Physical Layer
Transceiver
I/O Lines Description
Table 38-1.
I/O Lines Description
Name
Description
Type
CANRX
CAN Receive Serial Data
Input
CANTX
CAN Transmit Serial Data
Output
38.5
38.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines
The pins used for interfacing the CAN may be multiplexed with the PIO lines. The programmer
must first program the PIO controller to assign the desired CAN pins to their peripheral function.
If I/O lines of the CAN are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by
the PIO Controller.
38.5.2
Power Management
The programmer must first enable the CAN clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC)
before using the CAN.
A Low-power Mode is defined for the CAN controller: If the application does not require CAN
operations, the CAN clock can be stopped when not needed and be restarted later. Before stopping the clock, the CAN Controller must be in Low-power Mode to complete the current transfer.
After restarting the clock, the application must disable the Low-power Mode of the CAN
controller.
38.5.3
Interrupt
The CAN interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt
Controller. Using the CAN interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. Note that it is not
recommended to use the CAN interrupt line in edge-sensitive mode.
551
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.6
CAN Controller Features
38.6.1
CAN Protocol Overview
The Controller Area Network (CAN) is a multi-master serial communication protocol that efficiently supports real-time control with a very high level of security with bit rates up to 1 Mbit/s.
The CAN protocol supports four different frame types:
• Data frames: They carry data from a transmitter node to the receiver nodes. The overall
maximum data frame length is 108 bits for a standard frame and 128 bits for an extended
frame.
• Remote frames: A destination node can request data from the source by sending a remote
frame with an identifier that matches the identifier of the required data frame. The appropriate
data source node then sends a data frame as a response to this node request.
• Error frames: An error frame is generated by any node that detects a bus error.
• Overload frames: They provide an extra delay between the preceding and the successive
data frames or remote frames.
The Atmel CAN controller provides the CPU with full functionality of the CAN protocol V2.0 Part
A and V2.0 Part B. It minimizes the CPU load in communication overhead. The Data Link Layer
and part of the physical layer are automatically handled by the CAN controller itself.
The CPU reads or writes data or messages via the CAN controller mailboxes. An identifier is
assigned to each mailbox. The CAN controller encapsulates or decodes data messages to build
or to decode bus data frames. Remote frames, error frames and overload frames are automatically handled by the CAN controller under supervision of the software application.
38.6.2
Mailbox Organization
The CAN module has 8 buffers, also called channels or mailboxes. An identifier that corresponds to the CAN identifier is defined for each active mailbox. Message identifiers can match
the standard frame identifier or the extended frame identifier. This identifier is defined for the first
time during the CAN initialization, but can be dynamically reconfigured later so that the mailbox
can handle a new message family. Several mailboxes can be configured with the same ID.
Each mailbox can be configured in receive or in transmit mode independently. The mailbox
object type is defined in the MOT field of the CAN_MMRx register.
38.6.2.1
Message Acceptance Procedure
If the MIDE field in the CAN_MIDx register is set, the mailbox can handle the extended format
identifier; otherwise, the mailbox handles the standard format identifier. Once a new message is
received, its ID is masked with the CAN_MAMx value and compared with the CAN_MIDx value.
If accepted, the message ID is copied to the CAN_MIDx register.
552
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 38-3. Message Acceptance Procedure
CAN_MAMx
CAN_MIDx
&
Message Received
&
==
No
Message Refused
Yes
Message Accepted
CAN_MFIDx
If a mailbox is dedicated to receiving several messages (a family of messages) with different
IDs, the acceptance mask defined in the CAN_MAMx register must mask the variable part of the
ID family. Once a message is received, the application must decode the masked bits in the
CAN_MIDx. To speed up the decoding, masked bits are grouped in the family ID register
(CAN_MFIDx).
For example, if the following message IDs are handled by the same mailbox:
ID0 101000100100010010000100 0 11 00b
ID1 101000100100010010000100 0 11 01b
ID2 101000100100010010000100 0 11 10b
ID3 101000100100010010000100 0 11 11b
ID4 101000100100010010000100 1 11 00b
ID5 101000100100010010000100 1 11 01b
ID6 101000100100010010000100 1 11 10b
ID7 101000100100010010000100 1 11 11b
The CAN_MIDx and CAN_MAMx of Mailbox x must be initialized to the corresponding values:
CAN_MIDx = 001 101000100100010010000100 x 11 xxb
CAN_MAMx = 001 111111111111111111111111 0 11 00b
If Mailbox x receives a message with ID6, then CAN_MIDx and CAN_MFIDx are set:
CAN_MIDx = 001 101000100100010010000100 1 11 10b
CAN_MFIDx = 00000000000000000000000000000110b
If the application associates a handler for each message ID, it may define an array of pointers to
functions:
void (*pHandler[8])(void);
When a message is received, the corresponding handler can be invoked using CAN_MFIDx register and there is no need to check masked bits:
unsigned int MFID0_register;
MFID0_register = Get_CAN_MFID0_Register();
// Get_CAN_MFID0_Register() returns the value of the CAN_MFID0 register
pHandler[MFID0_register]();
553
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.6.2.2
Receive Mailbox
When the CAN module receives a message, it looks for the first available mailbox with the lowest number and compares the received message ID with the mailbox ID. If such a mailbox is
found, then the message is stored in its data registers. Depending on the configuration, the mailbox is disabled as long as the message has not been acknowledged by the application (Receive
only), or, if new messages with the same ID are received, then they overwrite the previous ones
(Receive with overwrite).
It is also possible to configure a mailbox in Consumer Mode. In this mode, after each transfer
request, a remote frame is automatically sent. The first answer received is stored in the corresponding mailbox data registers.
Several mailboxes can be chained to receive a buffer. They must be configured with the same
ID in Receive Mode, except for the last one, which can be configured in Receive with Overwrite
Mode. The last mailbox can be used to detect a buffer overflow.
Mailbox Object Type
The first message received is stored in mailbox data registers. Data remain available until the
next transfer request.
Receive
Receive with overwrite
The last message received is stored in mailbox data register. The next message always
overwrites the previous one. The application has to check whether a new message has not
overwritten the current one while reading the data registers.
A remote frame is sent by the mailbox. The answer received is stored in mailbox data register.
This extends Receive mailbox features. Data remain available until the next transfer request.
Consumer
38.6.2.3
Description
Transmit Mailbox
When transmitting a message, the message length and data are written to the transmit mailbox
with the correct identifier. For each transmit mailbox, a priority is assigned. The controller automatically sends the message with the highest priority first (set with the field PRIOR in
CAN_MMRx register).
It is also possible to configure a mailbox in Producer Mode. In this mode, when a remote frame
is received, the mailbox data are sent automatically. By enabling this mode, a producer can be
done using only one mailbox instead of two: one to detect the remote frame and one to send the
answer.
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Transmit
The message stored in the mailbox data registers will try to win the bus arbitration immediately
or later according to or not the Time Management Unit configuration (see Section 38.6.3).
The application is notified that the message has been sent or aborted.
Producer
The message prepared in the mailbox data registers will be sent after receiving the next remote
frame. This extends transmit mailbox features.
554
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.6.3
Time Management Unit
The CAN Controller integrates a free-running 16-bit internal timer. The counter is driven by the
bit clock of the CAN bus line. It is enabled when the CAN controller is enabled (CANEN set in the
CAN_MR register). It is automatically cleared in the following cases:
• after a reset
• when the CAN controller is in Low-power Mode is enabled (LPM bit set in the CAN_MR and
SLEEP bit set in the CAN_SR)
• after a reset of the CAN controller (CANEN bit in the CAN_MR register)
• in Time-triggered Mode, when a message is accepted by the last mailbox (rising edge of the
MRDY signal in the CAN_MSRlast_mailbox_number register).
The application can also reset the internal timer by setting TIMRST in the CAN_TCR register.
The current value of the internal timer is always accessible by reading the CAN_TIM register.
When the timer rolls-over from FFFFh to 0000h, TOVF (Timer Overflow) signal in the CAN_SR
register is set. TOVF bit in the CAN_SR register is cleared by reading the CAN_SR register.
Depending on the corresponding interrupt mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is generated while TOVF is set.
In a CAN network, some CAN devices may have a larger counter. In this case, the application
can also decide to freeze the internal counter when the timer reaches FFFFh and to wait for a
restart condition from another device. This feature is enabled by setting TIMFRZ in the CAN_MR
register. The CAN_TIM register is frozen to the FFFFh value. A clear condition described above
restarts the timer. A timer overflow (TOVF) interrupt is triggered.
To monitor the CAN bus activity, the CAN_TIM register is copied to the CAN _TIMESTP register
after each start of frame or end of frame and a TSTP interrupt is triggered. If TEOF bit in the
CAN_MR register is set, the value is captured at each End Of Frame, else it is captured at each
Start Of Frame. Depending on the corresponding mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is
generated while TSTP is set in the CAN_SR. TSTP bit is cleared by reading the CAN_SR
register.
The time management unit can operate in one of the two following modes:
• Timestamping mode: The value of the internal timer is captured at each Start Of Frame or
each End Of Frame
• Time Triggered mode: A mailbox transfer operation is triggered when the internal timer
reaches the mailbox trigger.
Timestamping Mode is enabled by clearing TTM field in the CAN_MR register. Time Triggered
Mode is enabled by setting TTM field in the CAN_MR register.
555
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.6.4
38.6.4.1
CAN 2.0 Standard Features
CAN Bit Timing Configuration
All controllers on a CAN bus must have the same bit rate and bit length. At different clock frequencies of the individual controllers, the bit rate has to be adjusted by the time segments.
The CAN protocol specification partitions the nominal bit time into four different segments:
Figure 38-4. Partition of the CAN Bit Time
NOMINAL BIT TIME
SYNC_SEG
PROP_SEG
PHASE_SEG1
PHASE_SEG2
Sample Point
• TIME QUANTUM
The TIME QUANTUM (TQ) is a fixed unit of time derived from the MCK period. The total number
of TIME QUANTA in a bit time is programmable from 8 to 25.
SYNC SEG: SYNChronization Segment.
This part of the bit time is used to synchronize the various nodes on the bus. An edge is
expected to lie within this segment. It is 1 TQ long.
• PROP SEG: PROPagation Segment.
This part of the bit time is used to compensate for the physical delay times within the network. It
is twice the sum of the signal’s propagation time on the bus line, the input comparator delay, and
the output driver delay. It is programmable to be 1,2,..., 8 TQ long.
This parameter is defined in the PROPAG field of the ”CAN Baudrate Register”.
• PHASE SEG1, PHASE SEG2: PHASE Segment 1 and 2.
The Phase-Buffer-Segments are used to compensate for edge phase errors. These segments
can be lengthened (PHASE SEG1) or shortened (PHASE SEG2) by resynchronization.
Phase Segment 1 is programmable to be 1,2,..., 8 TQ long.
Phase Segment 2 length has to be at least as long as the Information Processing Time (IPT)
and may not be more than the length of Phase Segment 1.
These parameters are defined in the PHASE1 and PHASE2 fields of the ”CAN Baudrate
Register”.
• INFORMATION PROCESSING TIME:
The Information Processing Time (IPT) is the time required for the logic to determine the bit level
of a sampled bit. The IPT begins at the sample point, is measured in TQ and is fixed at 2 TQ for
the Atmel CAN. Since Phase Segment 2 also begins at the sample point and is the last segment in the bit time, PHASE SEG2 shall not be less than the IPT.
• SAMPLE POINT:
556
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
The SAMPLE POINT is the point in time at which the bus level is read and interpreted as the
value of that respective bit. Its location is at the end of PHASE_SEG1.
• SJW: ReSynchronization Jump Width.
The ReSynchronization Jump Width defines the limit to the amount of lengthening or shortening
of the Phase Segments.
SJW is programmable to be the minimum of PHASE SEG1 and 4 TQ.
If the SMP field in the CAN_BR register is set, then the incoming bit stream is sampled three
times with a period of half a CAN clock period, centered on sample point.
In the CAN controller, the length of a bit on the CAN bus is determined by the parameters (BRP,
PROPAG, PHASE1 and PHASE2).
t BIT = t CSC + t PRS + t PHS1 + t PHS2
The time quantum is calculated as follows:
t CSC = ( BRP + 1 ) ⁄ MCK
Note: The BRP field must be within the range [1, 0x7F], i.e., BRP = 0 is not authorized.
t PRS = t CSC × ( PROPAG + 1 )
t PHS1 = t CSC × ( PHASE1 + 1 )
t PHS2 = t CSC × ( PHASE2 + 1 )
To compensate for phase shifts between clock oscillators of different controllers on the bus, the
CAN controller must resynchronize on any relevant signal edge of the current transmission. The
resynchronization shortens or lengthens the bit time so that the position of the sample point is
shifted with regard to the detected edge. The resynchronization jump width (SJW) defines the
maximum of time by which a bit period may be shortened or lengthened by resynchronization.
t SJW = t CSC × ( SJW + 1 )
Figure 38-5. CAN Bit Timing
MCK
CAN Clock
tCSC
tPRS
tPHS1
tPHS2
NOMINAL BIT TIME
SYNC_
SEG
PROP_SEG
PHASE_SEG1
PHASE_SEG2
Sample Point
Transmission Point
Example of bit timing determination for CAN baudrate of 500 Kbit/s:
MCK = 48MHz
CAN baudrate= 500kbit/s => bit time= 2us
557
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Delay of the bus driver: 50 ns
Delay of the receiver: 30ns
Delay of the bus line (20m): 110ns
The total number of time quanta in a bit time must be comprised between 8
and 25. If we fix the bit time to 16 time quanta:
Tcsc = 1 time quanta = bit time / 16 = 125 ns
=> BRP = (Tcsc x MCK) - 1 = 5
The propagation segment time is equal to twice the sum of the signal’s
propagation time on the bus line, the receiver delay and the output driver
delay:
Tprs = 2 * (50+30+110) ns = 380 ns = 3 Tcsc
=> PROPAG = Tprs/Tcsc - 1 = 2
The remaining time for the two phase segments is:
Tphs1 + Tphs2 = bit time - Tcsc - Tprs = (16 - 1 - 3)Tcsc
Tphs1 + Tphs2 = 12 Tcsc
Because this number is even, we choose Tphs2 = Tphs1 (else we would choose
Tphs2 = Tphs1 + Tcsc)
Tphs1 = Tphs2 = (12/2) Tcsc = 6 Tcsc
=> PHASE1 = PHASE2 = Tphs1/Tcsc - 1 = 5
The resynchronization jump width must be comprised between 1 Tcsc and the
minimum of 4 Tcsc and Tphs1. We choose its maximum value:
Tsjw = Min(4 Tcsc,Tphs1) = 4 Tcsc
=> SJW = Tsjw/Tcsc - 1 = 3
Finally: CAN_BR = 0x00053255
38.6.4.2
CAN Bus Synchronization
Two types of synchronization are distinguished: “hard synchronization” at the start of a frame
and “resynchronization” inside a frame. After a hard synchronization, the bit time is restarted
with the end of the SYNC_SEG segment, regardless of the phase error. Resynchronization
causes a reduction or increase in the bit time so that the position of the sample point is shifted
with respect to the detected edge.
The effect of resynchronization is the same as that of hard synchronization when the magnitude
of the phase error of the edge causing the resynchronization is less than or equal to the programmed value of the resynchronization jump width (tSJW).
When the magnitude of the phase error is larger than the resynchronization jump width and
• the phase error is positive, then PHASE_SEG1 is lengthened by an amount equal to the
resynchronization jump width.
• the phase error is negative, then PHASE_SEG2 is shortened by an amount equal to the
resynchronization jump width.
558
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 38-6. CAN Resynchronization
THE PHASE ERROR IS POSITIVE
(the transmitter is slower than the receiver)
Nominal
Sample point
Sample point
after resynchronization
Received
data bit
Nominal bit time
(before resynchronization)
SYNC_
SEG
PROP_SEG
PHASE_SEG1 PHASE_SEG2
Phase error (max Tsjw)
Phase error
Bit time with
resynchronization
SYNC_
SEG
SYNC_
SEG
PROP_SEG
PHASE_SEG1
THE PHASE ERROR IS NEGATIVE
(the transmitter is faster than the receiver)
PHASE_SEG2
Sample point
after resynchronization
SYNC_
SEG
Nominal
Sample point
Received
data bit
Nominal bit time
(before resynchronization)
PHASE_SEG2
SYNC_
SEG
PROP_SEG
PHASE_SEG1 PHASE_SEG2
SYNC_
SEG
Phase error
Bit time with
resynchronization
PHASE_ SYNC_
SEG2 SEG
PROP_SEG
PHASE_SEG1 PHASE_SEG2
SYNC_
SEG
Phase error (max Tsjw)
38.6.4.3
Autobaud Mode
The autobaud feature is enabled by setting the ABM field in the CAN_MR register. In this mode,
the CAN controller is only listening to the line without acknowledging the received messages. It
can not send any message. The errors flags are updated. The bit timing can be adjusted until no
error occurs (good configuration found). In this mode, the error counters are frozen. To go back
to the standard mode, the ABM bit must be cleared in the CAN_MR register.
38.6.4.4
Error Detection
There are five different error types that are not mutually exclusive. Each error concerns only specific fields of the CAN data frame (refer to the Bosch CAN specification for their
correspondence):
• CRC error (CERR bit in the CAN_SR register): With the CRC, the transmitter calculates a
checksum for the CRC bit sequence from the Start of Frame bit until the end of the Data
Field. This CRC sequence is transmitted in the CRC field of the Data or Remote Frame.
• Bit-stuffing error (SERR bit in the CAN_SR register): If a node detects a sixth consecutive
equal bit level during the bit-stuffing area of a frame, it generates an Error Frame starting with
the next bit-time.
• Bit error (BERR bit in CAN_SR register): A bit error occurs if a transmitter sends a dominant
bit but detects a recessive bit on the bus line, or if it sends a recessive bit but detects a
dominant bit on the bus line. An error frame is generated and starts with the next bit time.
• Form Error (FERR bit in the CAN_SR register): If a transmitter detects a dominant bit in one
of the fix-formatted segments CRC Delimiter, ACK Delimiter or End of Frame, a form error
has occurred and an error frame is generated.
559
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• Acknowledgment error (AERR bit in the CAN_SR register): The transmitter checks the
Acknowledge Slot, which is transmitted by the transmitting node as a recessive bit, contains a
dominant bit. If this is the case, at least one other node has received the frame correctly. If
not, an Acknowledge Error has occurred and the transmitter will start in the next bit-time an
Error Frame transmission.
38.6.4.5
Fault Confinement
To distinguish between temporary and permanent failures, every CAN controller has two error
counters: REC (Receive Error Counter) and TEC (Transmit Error Counter). The two counters
are incremented upon detected errors and are decremented upon correct transmissions or
receptions, respectively. Depending on the counter values, the state of the node changes: the
initial state of the CAN controller is Error Active, meaning that the controller can send Error
Active flags. The controller changes to the Error Passive state if there is an accumulation of
errors. If the CAN controller fails or if there is an extreme accumulation of errors, there is a state
transition to Bus Off.
Figure 38-7. Line Error Mode
Init
TEC < 127
and
REC < 127
ERROR
PASSIVE
ERROR
ACTIVE
TEC > 127
or
REC > 127
128 occurences of 11 consecutive recessive bits
or
CAN controller reset
BUS OFF
TEC > 255
An error active unit takes part in bus communication and sends an active error frame when the
CAN controller detects an error.
An error passive unit cannot send an active error frame. It takes part in bus communication, but
when an error is detected, a passive error frame is sent. Also, after a transmission, an error passive unit waits before initiating further transmission.
A bus off unit is not allowed to have any influence on the bus.
For fault confinement, two errors counters (TEC and REC) are implemented. These counters are
accessible via the CAN_ECR register. The state of the CAN controller is automatically updated
according to these counter values. If the CAN controller is in Error Active state, then the ERRA
bit is set in the CAN_SR register. The corresponding interrupt is pending while the interrupt is
not masked in the CAN_IMR register. If the CAN controller is in Error Passive Mode, then the
ERRP bit is set in the CAN_SR register and an interrupt remains pending while the ERRP bit is
set in the CAN_IMR register. If the CAN is in Bus Off Mode, then the BOFF bit is set in the
CAN_SR register. As for ERRP and ERRA, an interrupt is pending while the BOFF bit is set in
the CAN_IMR register.
560
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
When one of the error counters values exceeds 96, an increased error rate is indicated to the
controller through the WARN bit in CAN_SR register, but the node remains error active. The corresponding interrupt is pending while the interrupt is set in the CAN_IMR register.
Refer to the Bosch CAN specification v2.0 for details on fault confinement.
38.6.4.6
Error Interrupt Handler
WARN, BOFF, ERRA and ERRP (CAN_SR) represent the current status of the CAN bus and
are not latched. They reflect the current TEC and REC (CAN_ECR) values as described in Section 38.6.4.5 “Fault Confinement” on page 560.
Based on that, if these bits are used as an interrupt, the user can enter into an interrupt and not
see the corresponding status register if the TEC and REC counter have changed their state.
When entering Bus Off Mode, the only way to exit from this state is 128 occurrences of 11 consecutive recessive bits or a CAN controller reset.
In Error Active Mode, the user reads:
• ERRA =1
• ERRP = 0
• BOFF = 0
In Error Passive Mode, the user reads:
• ERRA = 0
• ERRP =1
• BOFF = 0
In Bus Off Mode, the user reads:
• ERRA = 0
• ERRP =1
• BOFF =1
The CAN interrupt handler should do the following:
• Only enable one error mode interrupt at a time.
• Look at and check the REC and TEC values in the interrupt handler to determine the current
state.
38.6.4.7
Overload
The overload frame is provided to request a delay of the next data or remote frame by the
receiver node (“Request overload frame”) or to signal certain error conditions (“Reactive overload frame”) related to the intermission field respectively.
Reactive overload frames are transmitted after detection of the following error conditions:
• Detection of a dominant bit during the first two bits of the intermission field
• Detection of a dominant bit in the last bit of EOF by a receiver, or detection of a dominant bit
by a receiver or a transmitter at the last bit of an error or overload frame delimiter
The CAN controller can generate a request overload frame automatically after each message
sent to one of the CAN controller mailboxes. This feature is enabled by setting the OVL bit in the
CAN_MR register.
561
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Reactive overload frames are automatically handled by the CAN controller even if the OVL bit in
the CAN_MR register is not set. An overload flag is generated in the same way as an error flag,
but error counters do not increment.
38.6.5
Low-power Mode
In Low-power Mode, the CAN controller cannot send or receive messages. All mailboxes are
inactive.
In Low-power Mode, the SLEEP signal in the CAN_SR register is set; otherwise, the WAKEUP
signal in the CAN_SR register is set. These two fields are exclusive except after a CAN controller reset (WAKEUP and SLEEP are stuck at 0 after a reset). After power-up reset, the Lowpower Mode is disabled and the WAKEUP bit is set in the CAN_SR register only after detection
of 11 consecutive recessive bits on the bus.
38.6.5.1
Enabling Low-power Mode
A software application can enable Low-power Mode by setting the LPM bit in the CAN_MR global register. The CAN controller enters Low-power Mode once all pending transmit messages
are sent.
When the CAN controller enters Low-power Mode, the SLEEP signal in the CAN_SR register is
set. Depending on the corresponding mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is generated
while SLEEP is set.
The SLEEP signal in the CAN_SR register is automatically cleared once WAKEUP is set. The
WAKEUP signal is automatically cleared once SLEEP is set.
Reception is disabled while the SLEEP signal is set to one in the CAN_SR register. It is important to note that those messages with higher priority than the last message transmitted can be
received between the LPM command and entry in Low-power Mode.
Once in Low-power Mode, the CAN controller clock can be switched off by programming the
chip’s Power Management Controller (PMC). The CAN controller drains only the static current.
Error counters are disabled while the SLEEP signal is set to one.
Thus, to enter Low-power Mode, the software application must:
– Set LPM field in the CAN_MR register
– Wait for SLEEP signal rising
Now the CAN Controller clock can be disabled. This is done by programming the Power Management Controller (PMC).
562
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 38-8. Enabling Low-power Mode
Arbitration lost
Mailbox 1
CAN BUS
Mailbox 3
LPEN= 1
LPM
(CAN_MR)
SLEEP
(CAN_SR)
WAKEUP
(CAN_SR)
MRDY
(CAN_MSR1)
MRDY
(CAN_MSR3)
CAN_TIM
38.6.5.2
0x0
Disabling Low-power Mode
The CAN controller can be awake after detecting a CAN bus activity. Bus activity detection is
done by an external module that may be embedded in the chip. When it is notified of a CAN bus
activity, the software application disables Low-power Mode by programming the CAN controller.
To disable Low-power Mode, the software application must:
– Enable the CAN Controller clock. This is done by programming the Power
Management Controller (PMC).
– Clear the LPM field in the CAN_MR register
The CAN controller synchronizes itself with the bus activity by checking for eleven consecutive
“recessive” bits. Once synchronized, the WAKEUP signal in the CAN_SR register is set.
Depending on the corresponding mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is generated while
WAKEUP is set. The SLEEP signal in the CAN_SR register is automatically cleared once
WAKEUP is set. WAKEUP signal is automatically cleared once SLEEP is set.
If no message is being sent on the bus, then the CAN controller is able to send a message
eleven bit times after disabling Low-power Mode.
If there is bus activity when Low-power mode is disabled, the CAN controller is synchronized
with the bus activity in the next interframe. The previous message is lost (see Figure 38-9).
563
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 38-9. Disabling Low-power Mode
Bus Activity Detected
CAN BUS
Message lost
Message x
Interframe synchronization
LPM
(CAN_MR)
SLEEP
(CAN_SR)
WAKEUP
(CAN_SR)
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
38.7
38.7.1
Functional Description
CAN Controller Initialization
After power-up reset, the CAN controller is disabled. The CAN controller clock must be activated
by the Power Management Controller (PMC) and the CAN controller interrupt line must be
enabled by the interrupt controller (AIC).
The CAN controller must be initialized with the CAN network parameters. The CAN_BR register
defines the sampling point in the bit time period. CAN_BR must be set before the CAN controller
is enabled by setting the CANEN field in the CAN_MR register.
The CAN controller is enabled by setting the CANEN flag in the CAN_MR register. At this stage,
the internal CAN controller state machine is reset, error counters are reset to 0, error flags are
reset to 0.
Once the CAN controller is enabled, bus synchronization is done automatically by scanning
eleven recessive bits. The WAKEUP bit in the CAN_SR register is automatically set to 1 when
the CAN controller is synchronized (WAKEUP and SLEEP are stuck at 0 after a reset).
The CAN controller can start listening to the network in Autobaud Mode. In this case, the error
counters are locked and a mailbox may be configured in Receive Mode. By scanning error flags,
the CAN_BR register values synchronized with the network. Once no error has been detected,
the application disables the Autobaud Mode, clearing the ABM field in the CAN_MR register.
564
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 38-10. Possible Initialization Procedure
Enable CAN Controller Clock
(PMC)
Enable CAN Controller Interrupt Line
(AIC)
Configure a Mailbox in Reception Mode
Change CAN_BR value
(ABM == 1 and CANEN == 1)
Errors ?
Yes
(CAN_SR or CAN_MSRx)
No
ABM = 0 and CANEN = 0
CANEN = 1 (ABM == 0)
End of Initialization
38.7.2
CAN Controller Interrupt Handling
There are two different types of interrupts. One type of interrupt is a message-object related
interrupt, the other is a system interrupt that handles errors or system-related interrupt sources.
All interrupt sources can be masked by writing the corresponding field in the CAN_IDR register.
They can be unmasked by writing to the CAN_IER register. After a power-up reset, all interrupt
sources are disabled (masked). The current mask status can be checked by reading the
CAN_IMR register.
The CAN_SR register gives all interrupt source states.
The following events may initiate one of the two interrupts:
• Message object interrupt
– Data registers in the mailbox object are available to the application. In Receive
Mode, a new message was received. In Transmit Mode, a message was transmitted
successfully.
– A sent transmission was aborted.
• System interrupts
– Bus off interrupt: The CAN module enters the bus off state.
– Error passive interrupt: The CAN module enters Error Passive Mode.
– Error Active Mode: The CAN module is neither in Error Passive Mode nor in Bus Off
mode.
565
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
– Warn Limit interrupt: The CAN module is in Error-active Mode, but at least one of its
error counter value exceeds 96.
– Wake-up interrupt: This interrupt is generated after a wake-up and a bus
synchronization.
– Sleep interrupt: This interrupt is generated after a Low-power Mode enable once all
pending messages in transmission have been sent.
– Internal timer counter overflow interrupt: This interrupt is generated when the
internal timer rolls over.
– Timestamp interrupt: This interrupt is generated after the reception or the
transmission of a start of frame or an end of frame. The value of the internal counter
is copied in the CAN_TIMESTP register.
All interrupts are cleared by clearing the interrupt source except for the internal timer counter
overflow interrupt and the timestamp interrupt. These interrupts are cleared by reading the
CAN_SR register.
566
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.7.3
CAN Controller Message Handling
38.7.3.1
Receive Handling
Two modes are available to configure a mailbox to receive messages. In Receive Mode, the
first message received is stored in the mailbox data register. In Receive with Overwrite Mode,
the last message received is stored in the mailbox.
38.7.3.2
Simple Receive Mailbox
A mailbox is in Receive Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance Mask must be set before the Receive Mode is
enabled.
After Receive Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically
cleared until the first message is received. When the first message has been accepted by the
mailbox, the MRDY flag is set. An interrupt is pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set.
This interrupt can be masked depending on the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register.
Message data are stored in the mailbox data register until the software application notifies that
data processing has ended. This is done by asking for a new transfer command, setting the
MTCR flag in the CAN_MCRx register. This automatically clears the MRDY signal.
The MMI flag in the CAN_MSRx register notifies the software that a message has been lost by
the mailbox. This flag is set when messages are received while MRDY is set in the CAN_MSRx
register. This flag is cleared by reading the CAN_MSRs register. A receive mailbox prevents
from overwriting the first message by new ones while MRDY flag is set in the CAN_MSRx register. See Figure 38-11.
Figure 38-11. Receive Mailbox
Message ID = CAN_MIDx
CAN BUS
Message 1
Message 2 lost
Message 3
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
MMI
(CAN_MSRx)
(CAN_MDLx
CAN_MDHx)
Message 1
Message 3
MTCR
(CAN_MCRx)
Reading CAN_MSRx
Reading CAN_MDHx & CAN_MDLx
Writing CAN_MCRx
Note:
In the case of ARM architecture, CAN_MSRx, CAN_MDLx, CAN_MDHx can be read using an optimized ldm assembler
instruction.
567
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.7.3.3
Receive with Overwrite Mailbox
A mailbox is in Receive with Overwrite Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has
been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance masks must be set before Receive
Mode is enabled.
After Receive Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically
cleared until the first message is received. When the first message has been accepted by the
mailbox, the MRDY flag is set. An interrupt is pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set.
This interrupt is masked depending on the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register.
If a new message is received while the MRDY flag is set, this new message is stored in the mailbox data register, overwriting the previous message. The MMI flag in the CAN_MSRx register
notifies the software that a message has been dropped by the mailbox. This flag is cleared when
reading the CAN_MSRx register.
The CAN controller may store a new message in the CAN data registers while the application
reads them. To check that CAN_MDHx and CAN_MDLx do not belong to different messages,
the application must check the MMI field in the CAN_MSRx register before and after reading
CAN_MDHx and CAN_MDLx. If the MMI flag is set again after the data registers have been
read, the software application has to re-read CAN_MDHx and CAN_MDLx (see Figure 38-12).
Figure 38-12. Receive with Overwrite Mailbox
Message ID = CAN_MIDx
CAN BUS
Message 1
Message 2
Message 3
Message 4
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
MMI
(CAN_MSRx)
(CAN_MDLx
CAN_MDHx)
Message 1
Message 2
Message 3
Message 4
MTCR
(CAN_MCRx)
Reading CAN_MSRx
Reading CAN_MDHx & CAN_MDLx
Writing CAN_MCRx
38.7.3.4
Chaining Mailboxes
Several mailboxes may be used to receive a buffer split into several messages with the same ID.
In this case, the mailbox with the lowest number is serviced first. In the receive and receive with
overwrite modes, the field PRIOR in the CAN_MMRx register has no effect. If Mailbox 0 and
Mailbox 5 accept messages with the same ID, the first message is received by Mailbox 0 and the
second message is received by Mailbox 5. Mailbox 0 must be configured in Receive Mode (i.e.,
the first message received is considered) and Mailbox 5 must be configured in Receive with
Overwrite Mode. Mailbox 0 cannot be configured in Receive with Overwrite Mode; otherwise, all
messages are accepted by this mailbox and Mailbox 5 is never serviced.
568
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
If several mailboxes are chained to receive a buffer split into several messages, all mailboxes
except the last one (with the highest number) must be configured in Receive Mode. The first
message received is handled by the first mailbox, the second one is refused by the first mailbox
and accepted by the second mailbox, the last message is accepted by the last mailbox and
refused by previous ones (see Figure 38-13).
Figure 38-13. Chaining Three Mailboxes to Receive a Buffer Split into Three Messages
Buffer split in 3 messages
CAN BUS
Message s1
Message s2
Message s3
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
MMI
(CAN_MSRx)
MRDY
(CAN_MSRy)
MMI
(CAN_MSRy)
MRDY
(CAN_MSRz)
MMI
(CAN_MSRz)
Reading CAN_MSRx, CAN_MSRy and CAN_MSRz
Reading CAN_MDH & CAN_MDL for mailboxes x, y and z
Writing MBx MBy MBz in CAN_TCR
If the number of mailboxes is not sufficient (the MMI flag of the last mailbox raises), the user
must read each data received on the last mailbox in order to retrieve all the messages of the
buffer split (see Figure 38-14).
569
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 38-14. Chaining Three Mailboxes to Receive a Buffer Split into Four Messages
Buffer split in 4 messages
CAN BUS
Message s1
Message s2
Message s3
Message s4
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
MMI
(CAN_MSRx)
MRDY
(CAN_MSRy)
MMI
(CAN_MSRy)
MRDY
(CAN_MSRz)
MMI
(CAN_MSRz)
Reading CAN_MSRx, CAN_MSRy and CAN_MSRz
Reading CAN_MDH & CAN_MDL for mailboxes x, y and z
Writing MBx MBy MBz in CAN_TCR
38.7.3.5
Transmission Handling
A mailbox is in Transmit Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance mask must be set before Receive Mode is enabled.
After Transmit Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically set
until the first command is sent. When the MRDY flag is set, the software application can prepare
a message to be sent by writing to the CAN_MDx registers. The message is sent once the software asks for a transfer command setting the MTCR bit and the message data length in the
CAN_MCRx register.
The MRDY flag remains at zero as long as the message has not been sent or aborted. It is
important to note that no access to the mailbox data register is allowed while the MRDY flag is
cleared. An interrupt is pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set. This interrupt can be
masked depending on the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register.
It is also possible to send a remote frame setting the MRTR bit instead of setting the MDLC field.
The answer to the remote frame is handled by another reception mailbox. In this case, the
device acts as a consumer but with the help of two mailboxes. It is possible to handle the remote
frame emission and the answer reception using only one mailbox configured in Consumer Mode.
Refer to the section “Remote Frame Handling” on page 571.
Several messages can try to win the bus arbitration in the same time. The message with the
highest priority is sent first. Several transfer request commands can be generated at the same
time by setting MBx bits in the CAN_TCR register. The priority is set in the PRIOR field of the
CAN_MMRx register. Priority 0 is the highest priority, priority 15 is the lowest priority. Thus it is
possible to use a part of the message ID to set the PRIOR field. If two mailboxes have the same
priority, the message of the mailbox with the lowest number is sent first. Thus if mailbox 0 and
570
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
mailbox 5 have the same priority and have a message to send at the same time, then the message of the mailbox 0 is sent first.
Setting the MACR bit in the CAN_MCRx register aborts the transmission. Transmission for several mailboxes can be aborted by writing MBx fields in the CAN_MACR register. If the message
is being sent when the abort command is set, then the application is notified by the MRDY bit set
and not the MABT in the CAN_MSRx register. Otherwise, if the message has not been sent,
then the MRDY and the MABT are set in the CAN_MSR register.
When the bus arbitration is lost by a mailbox message, the CAN controller tries to win the next
bus arbitration with the same message if this one still has the highest priority. Messages to be
sent are re-tried automatically until they win the bus arbitration. This feature can be disabled by
setting the bit DRPT in the CAN_MR register. In this case if the message was not sent the first
time it was transmitted to the CAN transceiver, it is automatically aborted. The MABT flag is set
in the CAN_MSRx register until the next transfer command.
Figure 38-15 shows three MBx message attempts being made (MRDY of MBx set to 0).
The first MBx message is sent, the second is aborted and the last one is trying to be aborted but
too late because it has already been transmitted to the CAN transceiver.
Figure 38-15. Transmitting Messages
CAN BUS
MBx message
MBx message
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
MABT
(CAN_MSRx)
MTCR
(CAN_MCRx)
MACR
(CAN_MCRx)
Abort MBx message
Try to Abort MBx message
Reading CAN_MSRx
Writing CAN_MDHx &
CAN_MDLx
38.7.3.6
Remote Frame Handling
Producer/consumer model is an efficient means of handling broadcasted messages. The push
model allows a producer to broadcast messages; the pull model allows a customer to ask for
messages.
571
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 38-16. Producer / Consumer Model
Producer
Request
PUSH MODEL
CAN Data Frame
Consumer
Indication(s)
PULL MODEL
Producer
Indications
Response
Consumer
CAN Remote Frame
Request(s)
CAN Data Frame
Confirmation(s)
In Pull Mode, a consumer transmits a remote frame to the producer. When the producer
receives a remote frame, it sends the answer accepted by one or many consumers. Using transmit and receive mailboxes, a consumer must dedicate two mailboxes, one in Transmit Mode to
send remote frames, and at least one in Receive Mode to capture the producer’s answer. The
same structure is applicable to a producer: one reception mailbox is required to get the remote
frame and one transmit mailbox to answer.
Mailboxes can be configured in Producer or Consumer Mode. A lonely mailbox can handle the
remote frame and the answer. With 8 mailboxes, the CAN controller can handle 8 independent
producers/consumers.
38.7.3.7
Producer Configuration
A mailbox is in Producer Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance masks must be set before Receive Mode is
enabled.
After Producer Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically set
until the first transfer command. The software application prepares data to be sent by writing to
the CAN_MDHx and the CAN_MDLx registers, then by setting the MTCR bit in the CAN_MCRx
register. Data is sent after the reception of a remote frame as soon as it wins the bus arbitration.
The MRDY flag remains at zero as long as the message has not been sent or aborted. No
access to the mailbox data register can be done while MRDY flag is cleared. An interrupt is
pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set. This interrupt can be masked according to
the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register.
If a remote frame is received while no data are ready to be sent (signal MRDY set in the
CAN_MSRx register), then the MMI signal is set in the CAN_MSRx register. This bit is cleared
by reading the CAN_MSRx register.
The MRTR field in the CAN_MSRx register has no meaning. This field is used only when using
Receive and Receive with Overwrite modes.
572
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
After a remote frame has been received, the mailbox functions like a transmit mailbox. The message with the highest priority is sent first. The transmitted message may be aborted by setting
the MACR bit in the CAN_MCR register. Please refer to the section “Transmission Handling” on
page 570.
Figure 38-17. Producer Handling
Remote Frame
CAN BUS
Message 1
Remote Frame
Remote Frame
Message 2
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
MMI
(CAN_MSRx)
Reading CAN_MSRx
MTCR
(CAN_MCRx)
(CAN_MDLx
CAN_MDHx)
38.7.3.8
Message 1
Message 2
Consumer Configuration
A mailbox is in Consumer Mode once the MOT field in the CAN_MMRx register has been configured. Message ID and Message Acceptance masks must be set before Receive Mode is
enabled.
After Consumer Mode is enabled, the MRDY flag in the CAN_MSR register is automatically
cleared until the first transfer request command. The software application sends a remote frame
by setting the MTCR bit in the CAN_MCRx register or the MBx bit in the global CAN_TCR register. The application is notified of the answer by the MRDY flag set in the CAN_MSRx register.
The application can read the data contents in the CAN_MDHx and CAN_MDLx registers. An
interrupt is pending for the mailbox while the MRDY flag is set. This interrupt can be masked
according to the mailbox flag in the CAN_IMR global register.
The MRTR bit in the CAN_MCRx register has no effect. This field is used only when using
Transmit Mode.
After a remote frame has been sent, the consumer mailbox functions as a reception mailbox.
The first message received is stored in the mailbox data registers. If other messages intended
for this mailbox have been sent while the MRDY flag is set in the CAN_MSRx register, they will
be lost. The application is notified by reading the MMI field in the CAN_MSRx register. The read
operation automatically clears the MMI flag.
If several messages are answered by the Producer, the CAN controller may have one mailbox in
consumer configuration, zero or several mailboxes in Receive Mode and one mailbox in Receive
with Overwrite Mode. In this case, the consumer mailbox must have a lower number than the
Receive with Overwrite mailbox. The transfer command can be triggered for all mailboxes at the
same time by setting several MBx fields in the CAN_TCR register.
573
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 38-18. Consumer Handling
Remote Frame
CAN BUS
Message x
Remote Frame
Message y
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
MMI
(CAN_MSRx)
MTCR
(CAN_MCRx)
(CAN_MDLx
CAN_MDHx)
38.7.4
Message y
Message x
CAN Controller Timing Modes
Using the free running 16-bit internal timer, the CAN controller can be set in one of the two following timing modes:
• Timestamping Mode: The value of the internal timer is captured at each Start Of Frame or
each End Of Frame.
• Time Triggered Mode: The mailbox transfer operation is triggered when the internal timer
reaches the mailbox trigger.
Timestamping Mode is enabled by clearing the TTM bit in the CAN_MR register. Time Triggered
Mode is enabled by setting the TTM bit in the CAN_MR register.
38.7.4.1
Timestamping Mode
Each mailbox has its own timestamp value. Each time a message is sent or received by a mailbox, the 16-bit value MTIMESTAMP of the CAN_TIMESTP register is transferred to the LSB bits
of the CAN_MSRx register. The value read in the CAN_MSRx register corresponds to the internal timer value at the Start Of Frame or the End Of Frame of the message handled by the
mailbox.
Figure 38-19. Mailbox Timestamp
Start of Frame
CAN BUS
Message 1
End of Frame
Message 2
CAN_TIM
TEOF
(CAN_MR)
TIMESTAMP
(CAN_TSTP)
Timestamp 1
MTIMESTAMP
(CAN_MSRx)
Timestamp 1
MTIMESTAMP
(CAN_MSRy)
Timestamp 2
Timestamp 2
574
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.7.4.2
Time Triggered Mode
In Time Triggered Mode, basic cycles can be split into several time windows. A basic cycle starts
with a reference message. Each time a window is defined from the reference message, a transmit operation should occur within a pre-defined time window. A mailbox must not win the
arbitration in a previous time window, and it must not be retried if the arbitration is lost in the time
window.
Figure 38-20. Time Triggered Principle
Time Cycle
Reference
Message
Reference
Message
Time Windows for Messages
Global Time
Time Trigger Mode is enabled by setting the TTM field in the CAN_MR register. In Time Triggered Mode, as in Timestamp Mode, the CAN_TIMESTP field captures the values of the internal
counter, but the MTIMESTAMP fields in the CAN_MSRx registers are not active and are read at
0.
38.7.4.3
Synchronization by a Reference Message
In Time Triggered Mode, the internal timer counter is automatically reset when a new message
is received in the last mailbox. This reset occurs after the reception of the End Of Frame on the
rising edge of the MRDY signal in the CAN_MSRx register. This allows synchronization of the
internal timer counter with the reception of a reference message and the start a new time
window.
38.7.4.4
Transmitting within a Time Window
A time mark is defined for each mailbox. It is defined in the 16-bit MTIMEMARK field of the
CAN_MMRx register. At each internal timer clock cycle, the value of the CAN_TIM is compared
with each mailbox time mark. When the internal timer counter reaches the MTIMEMARK value,
an internal timer event for the mailbox is generated for the mailbox.
In Time Triggered Mode, transmit operations are delayed until the internal timer event for the
mailbox. The application prepares a message to be sent by setting the MTCR in the CAN_MCRx
register. The message is not sent until the CAN_TIM value is less than the MTIMEMARK value
defined in the CAN_MMRx register.
If the transmit operation is failed, i.e., the message loses the bus arbitration and the next transmit attempt is delayed until the next internal time trigger event. This prevents overlapping the
next time window, but the message is still pending and is retried in the next time window when
CAN_TIM value equals the MTIMEMARK value. It is also possible to prevent a retry by setting
the DRPT field in the CAN_MR register.
38.7.4.5
Freezing the Internal Timer Counter
The internal counter can be frozen by setting TIMFRZ in the CAN_MR register. This prevents an
unexpected roll-over when the counter reaches FFFFh. When this occurs, it automatically
freezes until a new reset is issued, either due to a message received in the last mailbox or any
other reset counter operations. The TOVF bit in the CAN_SR register is set when the counter is
575
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
frozen. The TOVF bit in the CAN_SR register is cleared by reading the CAN_SR register.
Depending on the corresponding interrupt mask in the CAN_IMR register, an interrupt is generated when TOVF is set.
Figure 38-21. Time Triggered Operations
Message x
Arbitration Lost
End of Frame
CAN BUS
Reference
Message
Message y
Arbitration Win
Message y
Internal Counter Reset
CAN_TIM
Cleared by software
MRDY
(CAN_MSRlast_mailbox_number)
Timer Event x
MTIMEMARKx == CAN_TIM
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
MTIMEMARKy == CAN_TIM
Timer Event y
MRDY
(CAN_MSRy)
Time Window
Basic Cycle
Message x
Arbitration Win
End of Frame
CAN BUS
Reference
Message
Message x
Internal Counter Reset
CAN_TIM
Cleared by software
MRDY
(CAN_MSRlast_mailbox_number)
Timer Event x
MTIMEMARKx == CAN_TIM
MRDY
(CAN_MSRx)
Time Window
Basic Cycle
576
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8
Controller Area Network (CAN) User Interface
Table 38-2.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x0000
Mode Register
CAN_MR
Read-write
0x0
0x0004
Interrupt Enable Register
CAN_IER
Write-only
-
0x0008
Interrupt Disable Register
CAN_IDR
Write-only
-
0x000C
Interrupt Mask Register
CAN_IMR
Read-only
0x0
0x0010
Status Register
CAN_SR
Read-only
0x0
0x0014
Baudrate Register
CAN_BR
Read-write
0x0
0x0018
Timer Register
CAN_TIM
Read-only
0x0
0x001C
Timestamp Register
CAN_TIMESTP
Read-only
0x0
0x0020
Error Counter Register
CAN_ECR
Read-only
0x0
0x0024
Transfer Command Register
CAN_TCR
Write-only
-
0x0028
Abort Command Register
CAN_ACR
Write-only
-
–
–
–
0x0100 - 0x01FC
Reserved
0x0200
Mailbox 0 Mode Register
CAN_MMR0
Read-write
0x0
0x0204
Mailbox 0 Acceptance Mask Register
CAN_MAM0
Read-write
0x0
0x0208
Mailbox 0 ID Register
CAN_MID0
Read-write
0x0
0x020C
Mailbox 0 Family ID Register
CAN_MFID0
Read-only
0x0
0x0210
Mailbox 0 Status Register
CAN_MSR0
Read-only
0x0
0x0214
Mailbox 0 Data Low Register
CAN_MDL0
Read-write
0x0
0x0218
Mailbox 0 Data High Register
CAN_MDH0
Read-write
0x0
0x021C
Mailbox 0 Control Register
CAN_MCR0
Write-only
-
0x0220
Mailbox 1 Mode Register
CAN_MMR1
Read-write
0x0
0x0224
Mailbox 1 Acceptance Mask Register
CAN_MAM1
Read-write
0x0
0x0228
Mailbox 1 ID register
CAN_MID1
Read-write
0x0
0x022C
Mailbox 1 Family ID Register
CAN_MFID1
Read-only
0x0
0x0230
Mailbox 1 Status Register
CAN_MSR1
Read-only
0x0
0x0234
Mailbox 1 Data Low Register
CAN_MDL1
Read-write
0x0
0x0238
Mailbox 1 Data High Register
CAN_MDH1
Read-write
0x0
0x023C
Mailbox 1 Control Register
CAN_MCR1
Write-only
-
...
...
-
...
...
577
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.1
Name:
CAN Mode Register
CAN_MR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
25
RXSYNC
24
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
DRPT
6
TIMFRZ
5
TTM
4
TEOF
3
OVL
2
ABM
1
LPM
0
CANEN
• CANEN: CAN Controller Enable
0 = The CAN Controller is disabled.
1 = The CAN Controller is enabled.
• LPM: Disable/Enable Low Power Mode
w Power Mode.
1 = Enable Low Power M
CAN controller enters Low Power Mode once all pending messages have been transmitted.
• ABM: Disable/Enable Autobaud/Listen mode
0 = Disable Autobaud/listen mode.
1 = Enable Autobaud/listen mode.
• OVL: Disable/Enable Overload Frame
0 = No overload frame is generated.
1 = An overload frame is generated after each successful reception for mailboxes configured in Receive with/without overwrite Mode, Producer and Consumer.
• TEOF: Timestamp messages at each end of Frame
0 = The value of CAN_TIM is captured in the CAN_TIMESTP register at each Start Of Frame.
1 = The value of CAN_TIM is captured in the CAN_TIMESTP register at each End Of Frame.
• TTM: Disable/Enable Time Triggered Mode
0 = Time Triggered Mode is disabled.
1 = Time Triggered Mode is enabled.
• TIMFRZ: Enable Timer Freeze
0 = The internal timer continues to be incremented after it reached 0xFFFF.
1 = The internal timer stops incrementing after reaching 0xFFFF. It is restarted after a timer reset. See “Freezing the Internal Timer Counter” on page 575.
578
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• DRPT: Disable Repeat
0 = When a transmit mailbox loses the bus arbitration, the transfer request remains pending.
1 = When a transmit mailbox lose the bus arbitration, the transfer request is automatically aborted. It automatically raises
the MABT and MRDT flags in the corresponding CAN_MSRx.
• RXSYNC: Reception Synchronization Stage (not readable)
This field allows configuration of the reception stage of the macrocell (for debug purposes only)
RXSYNC
Reception Synchronization Stage
0
Rx Signal with Double Synchro Stages (2 Positive Edges)
1
Rx Signal with Double Synchro Stages (One Positive Edge and One Negative Edge)
2
Rx Signal with Single Synchro Stage (Positive Edge)
others
Rx Signal with No Synchro Stage
579
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.2
Name:
CAN Interrupt Enable Register
CAN_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
BERR
27
FERR
26
AERR
25
SERR
24
CERR
23
TSTP
22
TOVF
21
WAKEUP
20
SLEEP
19
BOFF
18
ERRP
17
WARN
16
ERRA
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
MB7
6
MB6
5
MB5
4
MB4
3
MB3
2
MB2
1
MB1
0
MB0
• MBx: Mailbox x Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable Mailbox x interrupt.
• ERRA: Error Active Mode Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable ERRA interrupt.
• WARN: Warning Limit Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable WARN interrupt.
• ERRP: Error Passive Mode Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable ERRP interrupt.
• BOFF: Bus Off Mode Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable BOFF interrupt.
• SLEEP: Sleep Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable SLEEP interrupt.
• WAKEUP: Wakeup Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable SLEEP interrupt.
• TOVF: Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable TOVF interrupt.
580
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• TSTP: TimeStamp Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable TSTP interrupt.
• CERR: CRC Error Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable CRC Error interrupt.
• SERR: Stuffing Error Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable Stuffing Error interrupt.
• AERR: Acknowledgment Error Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable Acknowledgment Error interrupt.
• FERR: Form Error Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable Form Error interrupt.
• BERR: Bit Error Interrupt Enable
0 = No effect.
1 = Enable Bit Error interrupt.
581
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.3
Name:
CAN Interrupt Disable Register
CAN_IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
BERR
27
FERR
26
AERR
25
SERR
24
CERR
23
TSTP
22
TOVF
21
WAKEUP
20
SLEEP
19
BOFF
18
ERRP
17
WARN
16
ERRA
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
MB7
6
MB6
5
MB5
4
MB4
3
MB3
2
MB2
1
MB1
0
MB0
• MBx: Mailbox x Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable Mailbox x interrupt.
• ERRA: Error Active Mode Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable ERRA interrupt.
• WARN: Warning Limit Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable WARN interrupt.
• ERRP: Error Passive Mode Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable ERRP interrupt.
• BOFF: Bus Off Mode Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable BOFF interrupt.
• SLEEP: Sleep Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable SLEEP interrupt.
• WAKEUP: Wakeup Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable WAKEUP interrupt.
• TOVF: Timer Overflow Interrupt
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable TOVF interrupt.
582
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• TSTP: TimeStamp Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable TSTP interrupt.
• CERR: CRC Error Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable CRC Error interrupt.
• SERR: Stuffing Error Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable Stuffing Error interrupt.
• AERR: Acknowledgment Error Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable Acknowledgment Error interrupt.
• FERR: Form Error Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable Form Error interrupt.
• BERR: Bit Error Interrupt Disable
0 = No effect.
1 = Disable Bit Error interrupt.
583
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.4
Name:
CAN Interrupt Mask Register
CAN_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
BERR
27
FERR
26
AERR
25
SERR
24
CERR
23
TSTP
22
TOVF
21
WAKEUP
20
SLEEP
19
BOFF
18
ERRP
17
WARN
16
ERRA
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
MB7
6
MB6
5
MB5
4
MB4
3
MB3
2
MB2
1
MB1
0
MB0
• MBx: Mailbox x Interrupt Mask
0 = Mailbox x interrupt is disabled.
1 = Mailbox x interrupt is enabled.
• ERRA: Error Active Mode Interrupt Mask
0 = ERRA interrupt is disabled.
1 = ERRA interrupt is enabled.
• WARN: Warning Limit Interrupt Mask
0 = Warning Limit interrupt is disabled.
1 = Warning Limit interrupt is enabled.
• ERRP: Error Passive Mode Interrupt Mask
0 = ERRP interrupt is disabled.
1 = ERRP interrupt is enabled.
• BOFF: Bus Off Mode Interrupt Mask
0 = BOFF interrupt is disabled.
1 = BOFF interrupt is enabled.
• SLEEP: Sleep Interrupt Mask
0 = SLEEP interrupt is disabled.
1 = SLEEP interrupt is enabled.
• WAKEUP: Wakeup Interrupt Mask
0 = WAKEUP interrupt is disabled.
1 = WAKEUP interrupt is enabled.
• TOVF: Timer Overflow Interrupt Mask
0 = TOVF interrupt is disabled.
1 = TOVF interrupt is enabled.
584
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• TSTP: Timestamp Interrupt Mask
0 = TSTP interrupt is disabled.
1 = TSTP interrupt is enabled.
• CERR: CRC Error Interrupt Mask
0 = CRC Error interrupt is disabled.
1 = CRC Error interrupt is enabled.
• SERR: Stuffing Error Interrupt Mask
0 = Bit Stuffing Error interrupt is disabled.
1 = Bit Stuffing Error interrupt is enabled.
• AERR: Acknowledgment Error Interrupt Mask
0 = Acknowledgment Error interrupt is disabled.
1 = Acknowledgment Error interrupt is enabled.
• FERR: Form Error Interrupt Mask
0 = Form Error interrupt is disabled.
1 = Form Error interrupt is enabled.
• BERR: Bit Error Interrupt Mask
0 = Bit Error interrupt is disabled.
1 = Bit Error interrupt is enabled.
585
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.5
Name:
CAN Status Register
CAN_SR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
OVLSY
30
TBSY
29
RBSY
28
BERR
27
FERR
26
AERR
25
SERR
24
CERR
23
TSTP
22
TOVF
21
WAKEUP
20
SLEEP
19
BOFF
18
ERRP
17
WARN
16
ERRA
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
MB7
6
MB6
5
MB5
4
MB4
3
MB3
2
MB2
1
MB1
0
MB0
• MBx: Mailbox x Event
0 = No event occurred on Mailbox x.
1 = An event occurred on Mailbox x.
An event corresponds to MRDY, MABT fields in the CAN_MSRx register.
• ERRA: Error Active Mode
0 = CAN controller is not in Error Active Mode.
1 = CAN controller is in Error Active Mode.
This flag is set depending on TEC and REC counter values. It is set when node is neither in Error Passive Mode nor in Bus
Off Mode.
This flag is automatically reset when above condition is not satisfied. Refer to Section 38.6.4.6 “Error Interrupt Handler” on
page 561 for more information.
• WARN: Warning Limit
0 = CAN controller Warning Limit is not reached.
1 = CAN controller Warning Limit is reached.
This flag is set depending on TEC and REC counter values. It is set when at least one of the counter values exceeds 96.
This flag is automatically reset when above condition is not satisfied. Refer to Section 38.6.4.6 “Error Interrupt Handler” on
page 561 for more information.
• ERRP: Error Passive Mode
0 = CAN controller is not in Error Passive Mode.
1 = CAN controller is in Error Passive Mode.
This flag is set depending on TEC and REC counters values.
A node is error passive when TEC counter is greater or equal to 128 (decimal) or when the REC counter is greater or equal
to 128 (decimal).
This flag is automatically reset when above condition is not satisfied. Refer to Section 38.6.4.6 “Error Interrupt Handler” on
page 561 for more information.
586
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• BOFF: Bus Off Mode
0 = CAN controller is not in Bus Off Mode.
1 = CAN controller is in Bus Off Mode.
This flag is set depending on TEC counter value. A node is bus off when TEC counter is greater or equal to 256 (decimal).
This flag is automatically reset when above condition is not satisfied. Refer to Section 38.6.4.6 “Error Interrupt Handler” on
page 561 for more information.
• SLEEP: CAN controller in Low power Mode
0 = CAN controller is not in low power mode.
1 = CAN controller is in low power mode.
This flag is automatically reset when Low power mode is disabled
• WAKEUP: CAN controller is not in Low power Mode
0 = CAN controller is in low power mode.
1 = CAN controller is not in low power mode.
When a WAKEUP event occurs, the CAN controller is synchronized with the bus activity. Messages can be transmitted or
received. The CAN controller clock must be available when a WAKEUP event occurs. This flag is automatically reset when
the CAN Controller enters Low Power mode.
• TOVF: Timer Overflow
0 = The timer has not rolled-over FFFFh to 0000h.
1 = The timer rolls-over FFFFh to 0000h.
This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register.
• TSTP Timestamp
0 = No bus activity has been detected.
1 = A start of frame or an end of frame has been detected (according to the TEOF field in the CAN_MR register).
This flag is automatically cleared by reading the CAN_SR register.
• CERR: Mailbox CRC Error
0 = No CRC error occurred during a previous transfer.
1 = A CRC error occurred during a previous transfer.
A CRC error has been detected during last reception.
This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register.
• SERR: Mailbox Stuffing Error
0 = No stuffing error occurred during a previous transfer.
1 = A stuffing error occurred during a previous transfer.
A form error results from the detection of more than five consecutive bit with the same polarity.
This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register.
587
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• AERR: Acknowledgment Error
0 = No acknowledgment error occurred during a previous transfer.
1 = An acknowledgment error occurred during a previous transfer.
An acknowledgment error is detected when no detection of the dominant bit in the acknowledge slot occurs.
This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register.
• FERR: Form Error
0 = No form error occurred during a previous transfer
1 = A form error occurred during a previous transfer
A form error results from violations on one or more of the fixed form of the following bit fields:
– CRC delimiter
– ACK delimiter
– End of frame
– Error delimiter
– Overload delimiter
This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register.
• BERR: Bit Error
0 = No bit error occurred during a previous transfer.
1 = A bit error occurred during a previous transfer.
A bit error is set when the bit value monitored on the line is different from the bit value sent.
This flag is automatically cleared by reading CAN_SR register.
• RBSY: Receiver busy
0 = CAN receiver is not receiving a frame.
1 = CAN receiver is receiving a frame.
Receiver busy. This status bit is set by hardware while CAN receiver is acquiring or monitoring a frame (remote, data, overload or error frame). It is automatically reset when CAN is not receiving.
• TBSY: Transmitter busy
0 = CAN transmitter is not transmitting a frame.
1 = CAN transmitter is transmitting a frame.
Transmitter busy. This status bit is set by hardware while CAN transmitter is generating a frame (remote, data, overload or
error frame). It is automatically reset when CAN is not transmitting.
• OVLSY: Overload busy
0 = CAN transmitter is not transmitting an overload frame.
1 = CAN transmitter is transmitting a overload frame.
It is automatically reset when the bus is not transmitting an overload frame.
588
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.6
Name:
CAN Baudrate Register
CAN_BR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
SMP
23
–
22
21
20
19
BRP
18
17
16
15
–
14
–
13
12
11
–
10
9
PROPAG
8
7
–
6
5
PHASE1
4
3
–
2
1
PHASE2
0
SJW
Any modification on one of the fields of the CANBR register must be done while CAN module is disabled.
To compute the different Bit Timings, please refer to the Section 38.6.4.1 “CAN Bit Timing Configuration” on page 556.
• PHASE2: Phase 2 segment
This phase is used to compensate the edge phase error.
t PHS2 = t CSC × ( PHASE2 + 1 )
Warning: PHASE2 value must be different from 0.
• PHASE1: Phase 1 segment
This phase is used to compensate for edge phase error.
t PHS1 = t CSC × ( PHASE1 + 1 )
• PROPAG: Programming time segment
This part of the bit time is used to compensate for the physical delay times within the network.
t PRS = t CSC × ( PROPAG + 1 )
• SJW: Re-synchronization jump width
To compensate for phase shifts between clock oscillators of different controllers on bus. The controller must re-synchronize
on any relevant signal edge of the current transmission. The synchronization jump width defines the maximum of clock
cycles a bit period may be shortened or lengthened by re-synchronization.
t SJW = t CSC × ( SJW + 1 )
• BRP: Baudrate Prescaler.
This field allows user to program the period of the CAN system clock to determine the individual bit timing.
t CSC = ( BRP + 1 ) ⁄ MCK
The BRP field must be within the range [1, 0x7F], i.e., BRP = 0 is not authorized.
• SMP: Sampling Mode
0 = The incoming bit stream is sampled once at sample point.
1 = The incoming bit stream is sampled three times with a period of a MCK clock period, centered on sample point.
SMP Sampling Mode is automatically disabled if BRP = 0.
589
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.7
Name:
CAN Timer Register
CAN_TIM
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
TIMER15
14
TIMER14
13
TIMER13
12
TIMER12
11
TIMER11
10
TIMER10
9
TIMER9
8
TIMER8
7
TIMER7
6
TIMER6
5
TIMER5
4
TIMER4
3
TIMER3
2
TIMER2
1
TIMER1
0
TIMER0
• TIMERx: Timer
This field represents the internal CAN controller 16-bit timer value.
590
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.8
Name:
CAN Timestamp Register
CAN_TIMESTP
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
MTIMESTAMP
15
MTIMESTAMP
14
MTIMESTAMP
13
MTIMESTAMP
12
MTIMESTAMP
11
MTIMESTAMP
10
MTIMESTAMP
9
MTIMESTAMP
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MTIMESTAMP
7
MTIMESTAMP
6
MTIMESTAMP
5
MTIMESTAMP
4
MTIMESTAMP
3
MTIMESTAMP
2
MTIMESTAMP
1
MTIMESTAMP
0
• MTIMESTAMPx: Timestamp
This field represents the internal CAN controller 16-bit timer value.
If the TEOF bit is cleared in the CAN_MR register, the internal Timer Counter value is captured in the MTIMESTAMP field
at each start of frame. Else the value is captured at each end of frame. When the value is captured, the TSTP flag is set in
the CAN_SR register. If the TSTP mask in the CAN_IMR register is set, an interrupt is generated while TSTP flag is set in
the CAN_SR register. This flag is cleared by reading the CAN_SR register.
Note:
The CAN_TIMESTP register is reset when the CAN is disabled then enabled thanks to the CANEN bit in the CAN_MR.
591
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.9
Name:
CAN Error Counter Register
CAN_ECR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
3
2
1
0
TEC
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
7
6
5
4
REC
• REC: Receive Error Counter
When a receiver detects an error, REC will be increased by one, except when the detected error is a BIT ERROR while
sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG or an OVERLOAD FLAG.
When a receiver detects a dominant bit as the first bit after sending an ERROR FLAG, REC is increased by 8.
When a receiver detects a BIT ERROR while sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG, REC is increased by 8.
Any node tolerates up to 7 consecutive dominant bits after sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG, PASSIVE ERROR FLAG or
OVERLOAD FLAG. After detecting the 14th consecutive dominant bit (in case of an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG or an OVERLOAD FLAG) or after detecting the 8th consecutive dominant bit following a PASSIVE ERROR FLAG, and after each
sequence of additional eight consecutive dominant bits, each receiver increases its REC by 8.
After successful reception of a message, REC is decreased by 1 if it was between 1 and 127. If REC was 0, it stays 0, and
if it was greater than 127, then it is set to a value between 119 and 127.
• TEC: Transmit Error Counter
When a transmitter sends an ERROR FLAG, TEC is increased by 8 except when
– the transmitter is error passive and detects an ACKNOWLEDGMENT ERROR because of not detecting a
dominant ACK and does not detect a dominant bit while sending its PASSIVE ERROR FLAG.
– the transmitter sends an ERROR FLAG because a STUFF ERROR occurred during arbitration and should
have been recessive and has been sent as recessive but monitored as dominant.
When a transmitter detects a BIT ERROR while sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG or an OVERLOAD FLAG, the TEC will
be increased by 8.
Any node tolerates up to 7 consecutive dominant bits after sending an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG, PASSIVE ERROR FLAG or
OVERLOAD FLAG. After detecting the 14th consecutive dominant bit (in case of an ACTIVE ERROR FLAG or an OVERLOAD FLAG) or after detecting the 8th consecutive dominant bit following a PASSIVE ERROR FLAG, and after each
sequence of additional eight consecutive dominant bits every transmitter increases its TEC by 8.
After a successful transmission the TEC is decreased by 1 unless it was already 0.
592
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.10
Name:
CAN Transfer Command Register
CAN_TCR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
TIMRST
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
MB7
6
MB6
5
MB5
4
MB4
3
MB3
2
MB2
1
MB1
0
MB0
This register initializes several transfer requests at the same time.
• MBx: Transfer Request for Mailbox x
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
It receives the next message.
Receive with overwrite
This triggers a new reception.
Transmit
Sends data prepared in the mailbox as soon as possible.
Consumer
Sends a remote frame.
Producer
Sends data prepared in the mailbox after receiving a remote frame from a
consumer.
This flag clears the MRDY and MABT flags in the corresponding CAN_MSRx register.
When several mailboxes are requested to be transmitted simultaneously, they are transmitted in turn, starting with the mailbox with the highest priority. If several mailboxes have the same priority, then the mailbox with the lowest number is sent
first (i.e., MB0 will be transferred before MB1).
• TIMRST: Timer Reset
Resets the internal timer counter. If the internal timer counter is frozen, this command automatically re-enables it. This
command is useful in Time Triggered mode.
593
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.11
Name:
CAN Abort Command Register
CAN_ACR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
MB7
6
MB6
5
MB5
4
MB4
3
MB3
2
MB2
1
MB1
0
MB0
This register initializes several abort requests at the same time.
• MBx: Abort Request for Mailbox x
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
No action
Receive with overwrite
No action
Transmit
Cancels transfer request if the message has not been transmitted to the
CAN transceiver.
Consumer
Cancels the current transfer before the remote frame has been sent.
Producer
Cancels the current transfer. The next remote frame is not serviced.
It is possible to set MACR field (in the CAN_MCRx register) for each mailbox.
594
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
595
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.12
Name:
CAN Message Mode Register
CAN_MMRx
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
18
15
14
13
12
11
MTIMEMARK15
MTIMEMARK14
MTIMEMARK13
MTIMEMARK12
MTIMEMARK11
25
24
MOT
17
16
10
9
8
MTIMEMARK10
MTIMEMARK9
MTIMEMARK8
PRIOR
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MTIMEMARK7
MTIMEMARK6
MTIMEMARK5
MTIMEMARK4
MTIMEMARK3
MTIMEMARK2
MTIMEMARK1
MTIMEMARK0
• MTIMEMARK: Mailbox Timemark
This field is active in Time Triggered Mode. Transmit operations are allowed when the internal timer counter reaches the
Mailbox Timemark. See “Transmitting within a Time Window” on page 575.
In Timestamp Mode, MTIMEMARK is set to 0.
• PRIOR: Mailbox Priority
This field has no effect in receive and receive with overwrite modes. In these modes, the mailbox with the lowest number is
serviced first.
When several mailboxes try to transmit a message at the same time, the mailbox with the highest priority is serviced first. If
several mailboxes have the same priority, the mailbox with the lowest number is serviced first (i.e., MBx0 is serviced before
MBx 15 if they have the same priority).
• MOT: Mailbox Object Type
This field allows the user to define the type of the mailbox. All mailboxes are independently configurable. Five different
types are possible for each mailbox:
MOT
Mailbox Object Type
0
0
0
Mailbox is disabled. This prevents receiving or transmitting any messages
with this mailbox.
0
0
1
Reception Mailbox. Mailbox is configured for reception. If a message is
received while the mailbox data register is full, it is discarded.
0
1
0
Reception mailbox with overwrite. Mailbox is configured for reception. If a
message is received while the mailbox is full, it overwrites the previous
message.
0
1
1
Transmit mailbox. Mailbox is configured for transmission.
1
0
0
Consumer Mailbox. Mailbox is configured in reception but behaves as a
Transmit Mailbox, i.e., it sends a remote frame and waits for an answer.
1
0
1
Producer Mailbox. Mailbox is configured in transmission but also behaves
like a reception mailbox, i.e., it waits to receive a Remote Frame before
sending its contents.
1
1
X
Reserved
596
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.13
Name:
CAN Message Acceptance Mask Register
CAN_MAMx
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
MIDE
28
27
26
MIDvA
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
MIDvA
15
14
13
MIDvB
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
MIDvB
7
6
5
4
MIDvB
To prevent concurrent access with the internal CAN core, the application must disable the mailbox before writing to
CAN_MAMx registers.
• MIDvB: Complementary bits for identifier in extended frame mode
Acceptance mask for corresponding field of the message IDvB register of the mailbox.
• MIDvA: Identifier for standard frame mode
Acceptance mask for corresponding field of the message IDvA register of the mailbox.
• MIDE: Identifier Version
0= Compares IDvA from the received frame with the CAN_MIDx register masked with CAN_MAMx register.
1= Compares IDvA and IDvB from the received frame with the CAN_MIDx register masked with CAN_MAMx register.
597
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.14
Name:
CAN Message ID Register
CAN_MIDx
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
MIDE
28
27
26
MIDvA
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
MIDvA
15
14
13
MIDvB
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
MIDvB
7
6
5
4
MIDvB
To prevent concurrent access with the internal CAN core, the application must disable the mailbox before writing to
CAN_MIDx registers.
• MIDvB: Complementary bits for identifier in extended frame mode
If MIDE is cleared, MIDvB value is 0.
• MIDE: Identifier Version
This bit allows the user to define the version of messages processed by the mailbox. If set, mailbox is dealing with version
2.0 Part B messages; otherwise, mailbox is dealing with version 2.0 Part A messages.
• MIDvA: Identifier for standard frame mode
598
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.15
Name:
CAN Message Family ID Register
CAN_MFIDx
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
27
26
MFID
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
MFID
15
14
13
12
MFID
7
6
5
4
MFID
• MFID: Family ID
This field contains the concatenation of CAN_MIDx register bits masked by the CAN_MAMx register. This field is useful to
speed up message ID decoding. The message acceptance procedure is described below.
As an example:
CAN_MIDx = 0x305A4321
CAN_MAMx = 0x3FF0F0FF
CAN_MFIDx = 0x000000A3
599
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.16
Name:
CAN Message Status Register
CAN_MSRx
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
23
MRDY
22
MABT
21
–
20
MRTR
19
18
15
14
13
12
11
25
–
24
MMI
17
16
9
8
MTIMESTAMP9
MTIMESTAMP8
MDLC
10
MTIMESTAMP15 MTIMESTAMP14 MTIMESTAMP13 MTIMESTAMP12 MTIMESTAMP11 MTIMESTAMP10
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MTIMESTAMP7
MTIMESTAMP6
MTIMESTAMP5
MTIMESTAMP4
MTIMESTAMP3
MTIMESTAMP2
MTIMESTAMP1
MTIMESTAMP0
These register fields are updated each time a message transfer is received or aborted.
MMI is cleared by reading the CAN_MSRx register.
MRDY, MABT are cleared by writing MTCR or MACR in the CAN_MCRx register.
Warning: MRTR and MDLC state depends partly on the mailbox object type.
• MTIMESTAMP: Timer value
This field is updated only when time-triggered operations are disabled (TTM cleared in CAN_MR register). If the TEOF field
in the CAN_MR register is cleared, TIMESTAMP is the internal timer value at the start of frame of the last message
received or sent by the mailbox. If the TEOF field in the CAN_MR register is set, TIMESTAMP is the internal timer value at
the end of frame of the last message received or sent by the mailbox.
In Time Triggered Mode, MTIMESTAMP is set to 0.
• MDLC: Mailbox Data Length Code
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
Length of the first mailbox message received
Receive with overwrite
Length of the last mailbox message received
Transmit
No action
Consumer
Length of the mailbox message received
Producer
Length of the mailbox message to be sent after the remote frame reception
600
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• MRTR: Mailbox Remote Transmission Request
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
The first frame received has the RTR bit set.
Receive with overwrite
The last frame received has the RTR bit set.
Transmit
Reserved
Consumer
Reserved. After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRTR is reset to 1.
Producer
Reserved. After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRTR is reset to 0.
• MABT: Mailbox Message Abort
An interrupt is triggered when MABT is set.
0 = Previous transfer is not aborted.
1 = Previous transfer has been aborted.
This flag is cleared by writing to CAN_MCRx register
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
Reserved
Receive with overwrite
Reserved
Transmit
Previous transfer has been aborted
Consumer
The remote frame transfer request has been aborted.
Producer
The response to the remote frame transfer has been aborted.
• MRDY: Mailbox Ready
An interrupt is triggered when MRDY is set.
0 = Mailbox data registers can not be read/written by the software application. CAN_MDx are locked by the CAN_MDx.
1 = Mailbox data registers can be read/written by the software application.
This flag is cleared by writing to CAN_MCRx register.
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
At least one message has been received since the last mailbox transfer order. Data from the first frame
received can be read in the CAN_MDxx registers.
After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 0.
Receive with overwrite
At least one frame has been received since the last mailbox transfer order. Data from the last frame received
can be read in the CAN_MDxx registers.
After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 0.
Transmit
Mailbox data have been transmitted.
After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 1.
Consumer
At least one message has been received since the last mailbox transfer order. Data from the first message
received can be read in the CAN_MDxx registers.
After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 0.
Producer
A remote frame has been received, mailbox data have been transmitted.
After setting the MOT field in the CAN_MMR, MRDY is reset to 1.
601
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• MMI: Mailbox Message Ignored
0 = No message has been ignored during the previous transfer
1 = At least one message has been ignored during the previous transfer
Cleared by reading the CAN_MSRx register.
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
Set when at least two messages intended for the mailbox have been sent. The first one is available in the
mailbox data register. Others have been ignored. A mailbox with a lower priority may have accepted the
message.
Receive with overwrite
Set when at least two messages intended for the mailbox have been sent. The last one is available in the
mailbox data register. Previous ones have been lost.
Transmit
Reserved
Consumer
A remote frame has been sent by the mailbox but several messages have been received. The first one is
available in the mailbox data register. Others have been ignored. Another mailbox with a lower priority may
have accepted the message.
Producer
A remote frame has been received, but no data are available to be sent.
602
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.17
Name:
CAN Message Data Low Register
CAN_MDLx
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
MDL
23
22
21
20
MDL
15
14
13
12
MDL
7
6
5
4
MDL
• MDL: Message Data Low Value
When MRDY field is set in the CAN_MSRx register, the lower 32 bits of a received message can be read or written by the
software application. Otherwise, the MDL value is locked by the CAN controller to send/receive a new message.
In Receive with overwrite, the CAN controller may modify MDL value while the software application reads MDH and MDL
registers. To check that MDH and MDL do not belong to different messages, the application has to check the MMI field in
the CAN_MSRx register. In this mode, the software application must re-read CAN_MDH and CAN_MDL, while the MMI bit
in the CAN_MSRx register is set.
Bytes are received/sent on the bus in the following order:
1. CAN_MDL[7:0]
2. CAN_MDL[15:8]
3. CAN_MDL[23:16]
4. CAN_MDL[31:24]
5. CAN_MDH[7:0]
6. CAN_MDH[15:8]
7. CAN_MDH[23:16]
8. CAN_MDH[31:24]
603
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.18
Name:
CAN Message Data High Register
CAN_MDHx
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
MDH
23
22
21
20
MDH
15
14
13
12
MDH
7
6
5
4
MDH
• MDH: Message Data High Value
When MRDY field is set in the CAN_MSRx register, the upper 32 bits of a received message are read or written by the software application. Otherwise, the MDH value is locked by the CAN controller to send/receive a new message.
In Receive with overwrite, the CAN controller may modify MDH value while the software application reads MDH and MDL
registers. To check that MDH and MDL do not belong to different messages, the application has to check the MMI field in
the CAN_MSRx register. In this mode, the software application must re-read CAN_MDH and CAN_MDL, while the MMI bit
in the CAN_MSRx register is set.
Bytes are received/sent on the bus in the following order:
1. CAN_MDL[7:0]
2. CAN_MDL[15:8]
3. CAN_MDL[23:16]
4. CAN_MDL[31:24]
5. CAN_MDH[7:0]
6. CAN_MDH[15:8]
7. CAN_MDH[23:16]
8. CAN_MDH[31:24]
604
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
38.8.19
Name:
CAN Message Control Register
CAN_MCRx
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
23
MTCR
22
MACR
21
–
20
MRTR
19
18
15
–
14
13
–
12
11
–
7
–
6
5
–
4
3
–
–
–
–
–
25
24
–
–
17
16
10
9
–
–
8
–
2
–
1
0
–
–
MDLC
• MDLC: Mailbox Data Length Code
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
No action.
Receive with overwrite
No action.
Transmit
Length of the mailbox message.
Consumer
No action.
Producer
Length of the mailbox message to be sent after the remote frame reception.
• MRTR: Mailbox Remote Transmission Request
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
No action
Receive with overwrite
No action
Transmit
Set the RTR bit in the sent frame
Consumer
No action, the RTR bit in the sent frame is set automatically
Producer
No action
Consumer situations can be handled automatically by setting the mailbox object type in Consumer. This requires only one
mailbox.
It can also be handled using two mailboxes, one in reception, the other in transmission. The MRTR and the MTCR bits
must be set in the same time.
605
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• MACR: Abort Request for Mailbox x
Mailbox Object Type
Description
Receive
No action
Receive with overwrite
No action
Transmit
Cancels transfer request if the message has not been transmitted to the
CAN transceiver.
Consumer
Cancels the current transfer before the remote frame has been sent.
Producer
Cancels the current transfer. The next remote frame will not be serviced.
It is possible to set MACR field for several mailboxes in the same time, setting several bits to the CAN_ACR register.
• MTCR: Mailbox Transfer Command
Mailbox Object Type
Receive
Receive with overwrite
Transmit
Description
Allows the reception of the next message.
Triggers a new reception.
Sends data prepared in the mailbox as soon as possible.
Consumer
Sends a remote transmission frame.
Producer
Sends data prepared in the mailbox after receiving a remote frame from a
Consumer.
This flag clears the MRDY and MABT flags in the CAN_MSRx register.
When several mailboxes are requested to be transmitted simultaneously, they are transmitted in turn. The mailbox with the
highest priority is serviced first. If several mailboxes have the same priority, the mailbox with the lowest number is serviced
first (i.e., MBx0 will be serviced before MBx 15 if they have the same priority).
It is possible to set MTCR for several mailboxes at the same time by writing to the CAN_TCR register.
606
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39. Ethernet MAC 10/100 (EMAC)
39.1
Overview
The EMAC module implements a 10/100 Ethernet MAC compatible with the IEEE 802.3 standard using an address checker, statistics and control registers, receive and transmit blocks, and
a DMA interface.
The address checker recognizes four specific 48-bit addresses and contains a 64-bit hash register for matching multicast and unicast addresses. It can recognize the broadcast address of all
ones, copy all frames, and act on an external address match signal.
The statistics register block contains registers for counting various types of event associated
with transmit and receive operations. These registers, along with the status words stored in the
receive buffer list, enable software to generate network management statistics compatible with
IEEE 802.3.
39.2
Block Diagram
Figure 39-1.
EMAC Block Diagram
Address Checker
APB
Slave
Register Interface
Statistics Registers
MDIO
Control Registers
DMA Interface
RX FIFO
TX FIFO
Ethernet Receive
MII/RMII
ASB
Master
Ethernet Transmit
607
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.3
Functional Description
The EMAC has several clock domains:
•
System bus clock (AHB and APB): DMA and register blocks
•
Transmi clock: transmit block
•
Receive clock: receive and address checker blocks
The only system constraint is 160 MHz for the system bus clock, above which MDC would toggle
at above 2.5 MHz.
The system bus clock must run at least as fast as the receive clock and transmit clock (25 MHz
at 100 Mbps, and 2.5 MHz at 10 Mbps).
Figure 39-1 illustrates the different blocks of the EMAC module.
The control registers drive the MDIO interface, setup up DMA activity, start frame transmission
and select modes of operation such as full- or half-duplex.
The receive block checks for valid preamble, FCS, alignment and length, and presents received
frames to the address checking block and DMA interface.
The transmit block takes data from the DMA interface, adds preamble and, if necessary, pad
and FCS, and transmits data according to the CSMA/CD (carrier sense multiple access with collision detect) protocol. The start of transmission is deferred if CRS (carrier sense) is active.
If COL (collision) becomes active during transmission, a jam sequence is asserted and the
transmission is retried after a random back off. CRS and COL have no effect in full duplex mode.
The DMA block connects to external memory through its ASB bus interface. It contains receive
and transmit FIFOs for buffering frame data. It loads the transmit FIFO and empties the receive
FIFO using ASB bus master operations. Receive data is not sent to memory until the address
checking logic has determined that the frame should be copied. Receive or transmit frames are
stored in one or more buffers. Receive buffers have a fixed length of 128 bytes. Transmit buffers
range in length between 0 and 2047 bytes, and up to 128 buffers are permitted per frame. The
DMA block manages the transmit and receive framebuffer queues. These queues can hold multiple frames.
39.3.1
Memory Interface
Frame data is transferred to and from the EMAC through the DMA interface. All transfers are 32bit words and may be single accesses or bursts of 2, 3 or 4 words. Burst accesses do not cross
sixteen-byte boundaries. Bursts of 4 words are the default data transfer; single accesses or
bursts of less than four words may be used to transfer data at the beginning or the end of a
buffer.
The DMA controller performs six types of operation on the bus. In order of priority, these are:
1. Receive buffer manager write
2. Receive buffer manager read
3. Transmit data DMA read
4. Receive data DMA write
5. Transmit buffer manager read
6. Transmit buffer manager write
608
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.3.1.1
FIFO
The FIFO depths are 28 bytes for receive and 28 bytes for transmit and are a function of the system clock speed, memory latency and network speed.
Data is typically transferred into and out of the FIFOs in bursts of four words. For receive, a bus
request is asserted when the FIFO contains four words and has space for three more. For transmit, a bus request is generated when there is space for four words, or when there is space for
two words if the next transfer is to be only one or two words.
Thus the bus latency must be less than the time it takes to load the FIFO and transmit or receive
three words (12 bytes) of data.
At 100 Mbit/s, it takes 960 ns to transmit or receive 12 bytes of data. In addition, six master clock
cycles should be allowed for data to be loaded from the bus and to propagate through the
FIFOs. For a 60 MHz master clock this takes 100 ns, making the bus latency requirement 860
ns.
39.3.1.2
Receive Buffers
Received frames, including CRC/FCS optionally, are written to receive buffers stored in memory. Each receive buffer is 128 bytes long. The start location for each receive buffer is stored in
memory in a list of receive buffer descriptors at a location pointed to by the receive buffer queue
pointer register. The receive buffer start location is a word address. For the first buffer of a
frame, the start location can be offset by up to three bytes depending on the value written to bits
14 and 15 of the network configuration register. If the start location of the buffer is offset the
available length of the first buffer of a frame is reduced by the corresponding number of bytes.
Each list entry consists of two words, the first being the address of the receive buffer and the
second being the receive status. If the length of a receive frame exceeds the buffer length, the
status word for the used buffer is written with zeroes except for the “start of frame” bit and the
offset bits, if appropriate. Bit zero of the address field is written to one to show the buffer has
been used. The receive buffer manager then reads the location of the next receive buffer and
fills that with receive frame data. The final buffer descriptor status word contains the complete
frame status. Refer to Table 39-1 for details of the receive buffer descriptor list.
Table 39-1.
Receive Buffer Descriptor Entry
Bit
Function
Word 0
31:2
Address of beginning of buffer
1
Wrap - marks last descriptor in receive buffer descriptor list.
0
Ownership - needs to be zero for the EMAC to write data to the receive buffer. The EMAC sets this to one once it has
successfully written a frame to memory.
Software has to clear this bit before the buffer can be used again.
Word 1
31
Global all ones broadcast address detected
30
Multicast hash match
29
Unicast hash match
28
External address match
27
Reserved for future use
609
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Table 39-1.
Receive Buffer Descriptor Entry (Continued)
Bit
Function
26
Specific address register 1 match
25
Specific address register 2 match
24
Specific address register 3 match
23
Specific address register 4 match
22
Type ID match
21
VLAN tag detected (i.e., type id of 0x8100)
20
Priority tag detected (i.e., type id of 0x8100 and null VLAN identifier)
19:17
VLAN priority (only valid if bit 21 is set)
16
Concatenation format indicator (CFI) bit (only valid if bit 21 is set)
15
End of frame - when set the buffer contains the end of a frame. If end of frame is not set, then the only other valid status
are bits 12, 13 and 14.
14
Start of frame - when set the buffer contains the start of a frame. If both bits 15 and 14 are set, then the buffer contains a
whole frame.
13:12
Receive buffer offset - indicates the number of bytes by which the data in the first buffer is offset from the word address.
Updated with the current values of the network configuration register. If jumbo frame mode is enabled through bit 3 of the
network configuration register, then bits 13:12 of the receive buffer descriptor entry are used to indicate bits 13:12 of the
frame length.
11:0
Length of frame including FCS (if selected). Bits 13:12 are also used if jumbo frame mode is selected.
To receive frames, the buffer descriptors must be initialized by writing an appropriate address to
bits 31 to 2 in the first word of each list entry. Bit zero must be written with zero. Bit one is the
wrap bit and indicates the last entry in the list.
The start location of the receive buffer descriptor list must be written to the receive buffer queue
pointer register before setting the receive enable bit in the network control register to enable
receive. As soon as the receive block starts writing received frame data to the receive FIFO, the
receive buffer manager reads the first receive buffer location pointed to by the receive buffer
queue pointer register.
If the filter block then indicates that the frame should be copied to memory, the receive data
DMA operation starts writing data into the receive buffer. If an error occurs, the buffer is recovered. If the current buffer pointer has its wrap bit set or is the 1024th descriptor, the next receive
buffer location is read from the beginning of the receive descriptor list. Otherwise, the next
receive buffer location is read from the next word in memory.
There is an 11-bit counter to count out the 2048 word locations of a maximum length, receive
buffer descriptor list. This is added with the value originally written to the receive buffer queue
pointer register to produce a pointer into the list. A read of the receive buffer queue pointer register returns the pointer value, which is the queue entry currently being accessed. The counter is
reset after receive status is written to a descriptor that has its wrap bit set or rolls over to zero
after 1024 descriptors have been accessed. The value written to the receive buffer pointer register may be any word-aligned address, provided that there are at least 2048 word locations
available between the pointer and the top of the memory.
Section 3.6 of the AMBA™ 2.0 specification states that bursts should not cross 1K boundaries.
As receive buffer manager writes are bursts of two words, to ensure that this does not occur, it is
610
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
best to write the pointer register with the least three significant bits set to zero. As receive buffers
are used, the receive buffer manager sets bit zero of the first word of the descriptor to indicate
used. If a receive error is detected the receive buffer currently being written is recovered. Previous buffers are not recovered. Software should search through the used bits in the buffer
descriptors to find out how many frames have been received. It should be checking the start-offrame and end-of-frame bits, and not rely on the value returned by the receive buffer queue
pointer register which changes continuously as more buffers are used.
For CRC errored frames, excessive length frames or length field mismatched frames, all of
which are counted in the statistics registers, it is possible that a frame fragment might be stored
in a sequence of receive buffers. Software can detect this by looking for start of frame bit set in a
buffer following a buffer with no end of frame bit set.
For a properly working Ethernet system, there should be no excessively long frames or frames
greater than 128 bytes with CRC/FCS errors. Collision fragments are less than 128 bytes long.
Therefore, it is a rare occurrence to find a frame fragment in a receive buffer.
If bit zero is set when the receive buffer manager reads the location of the receive buffer, then
the buffer has already been used and cannot be used again until software has processed the
frame and cleared bit zero. In this case, the DMA block sets the buffer not available bit in the
receive status register and triggers an interrupt.
If bit zero is set when the receive buffer manager reads the location of the receive buffer and a
frame is being received, the frame is discarded and the receive resource error statistics register
is incremented.
A receive overrun condition occurs when bus was not granted in time or because HRESP was
not OK (bus error). In a receive overrun condition, the receive overrun interrupt is asserted and
the buffer currently being written is recovered. The next frame received with an address that is
recognized reuses the buffer.
If bit 17 of the network configuration register is set, the FCS of received frames shall not be copied to memory. The frame length indicated in the receive status field shall be reduced by four
bytes in this case.
39.3.1.3
Transmit Buffer
Frames to be transmitted are stored in one or more transmit buffers. Transmit buffers can be
between 0 and 2047 bytes long, so it is possible to transmit frames longer than the maximum
length specified in IEEE Standard 802.3. Zero length buffers are allowed. The maximum number
of buffers permitted for each transmit frame is 128.
The start location for each transmit buffer is stored in memory in a list of transmit buffer descriptors at a location pointed to by the transmit buffer queue pointer register. Each list entry consists
of two words, the first being the byte address of the transmit buffer and the second containing
the transmit control and status. Frames can be transmitted with or without automatic CRC generation. If CRC is automatically generated, pad is also automatically generated to take frames to
a minimum length of 64 bytes. Table 39-2 on page 612 defines an entry in the transmit buffer
descriptor list. To transmit frames, the buffer descriptors must be initialized by writing an appropriate byte address to bits 31 to 0 in the first word of each list entry. The second transmit buffer
descriptor is initialized with control information that indicates the length of the buffer, whether or
not it is to be transmitted with CRC and whether the buffer is the last buffer in the frame.
After transmission, the control bits are written back to the second word of the first buffer along
with the “used” bit and other status information. Bit 31 is the “used” bit which must be zero when
611
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
the control word is read if transmission is to happen. It is written to one when a frame has been
transmitted. Bits 27, 28 and 29 indicate various transmit error conditions. Bit 30 is the “wrap” bit
which can be set for any buffer within a frame. If no wrap bit is encountered after 1024 descriptors, the queue pointer rolls over to the start in a similar fashion to the receive queue.
The transmit buffer queue pointer register must not be written while transmit is active. If a new
value is written to the transmit buffer queue pointer register, the queue pointer resets itself to
point to the beginning of the new queue. If transmit is disabled by writing to bit 3 of the network
control, the transmit buffer queue pointer register resets to point to the beginning of the transmit
queue. Note that disabling receive does not have the same effect on the receive queue pointer.
Once the transmit queue is initialized, transmit is activated by writing to bit 9, the Transmit Start
bit of the network control register. Transmit is halted when a buffer descriptor with its used bit set
is read, or if a transmit error occurs, or by writing to the transmit halt bit of the network control
register. (Transmission is suspended if a pause frame is received while the pause enable bit is
set in the network configuration register.) Rewriting the start bit while transmission is active is
allowed.
Transmission control is implemented with a Tx_go variable which is readable in the transmit status register at bit location 3. The Tx_go variable is reset when:
– transmit is disabled
– a buffer descriptor with its ownership bit set is read
– a new value is written to the transmit buffer queue pointer register
– bit 10, tx_halt, of the network control register is written
– there is a transmit error such as too many retries or a transmit underrun.
To set tx_go, write to bit 9, tx_start, of the network control register. Transmit halt does not take
effect until any ongoing transmit finishes. If a collision occurs during transmission of a multibuffer frame, transmission automatically restarts from the first buffer of the frame. If a “used” bit
is read midway through transmission of a multi-buffer frame, this is treated as a transmit error.
Transmission stops, tx_er is asserted and the FCS is bad.
If transmission stops due to a transmit error, the transmit queue pointer resets to point to the
beginning of the transmit queue. Software needs to re-initialize the transmit queue after a transmit error.
If transmission stops due to a “used” bit being read at the start of the frame, the transmission
queue pointer is not reset and transmit starts from the same transmit buffer descriptor when the
transmit start bit is written
Table 39-2.
Transmit Buffer Descriptor Entry
Bit
Function
Word 0
31:0
Byte Address of buffer
Word 1
31
Used. Needs to be zero for the EMAC to read data from the transmit buffer. The EMAC sets this to one for the first buffer
of a frame once it has been successfully transmitted.
Software has to clear this bit before the buffer can be used again.
Note:
30
612
This bit is only set for the first buffer in a frame unlike receive where all buffers have the Used bit set once used.
Wrap. Marks last descriptor in transmit buffer descriptor list.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 39-2.
Transmit Buffer Descriptor Entry (Continued)
Bit
Function
29
Retry limit exceeded, transmit error detected
28
Transmit underrun, occurs either when hresp is not OK (bus error) or the transmit data could not be fetched in time or
when buffers are exhausted in mid frame.
27
Buffers exhausted in mid frame
26:17
Reserved
16
No CRC. When set, no CRC is appended to the current frame. This bit only needs to be set for the last buffer of a frame.
15
Last buffer. When set, this bit indicates the last buffer in the current frame has been reached.
14:11
Reserved
10:0
Length of buffer
39.3.2
Transmit Block
This block transmits frames in accordance with the Ethernet IEEE 802.3 CSMA/CD protocol.
Frame assembly starts by adding preamble and the start frame delimiter. Data is taken from the
transmit FIFO a word at a time. Data is transmitted least significant nibble first. If necessary,
padding is added to increase the frame length to 60 bytes. CRC is calculated as a 32-bit polynomial. This is inverted and appended to the end of the frame, taking the frame length to a
minimum of 64 bytes. If the No CRC bit is set in the second word of the last buffer descriptor of a
transmit frame, neither pad nor CRC are appended.
In full-duplex mode, frames are transmitted immediately. Back-to-back frames are transmitted at
least 96 bit times apart to guarantee the interframe gap.
In half-duplex mode, the transmitter checks carrier sense. If asserted, it waits for it to de-assert
and then starts transmission after the interframe gap of 96 bit times. If the collision signal is
asserted during transmission, the transmitter transmits a jam sequence of 32 bits taken from the
data register and then retry transmission after the back off time has elapsed.
The back-off time is based on an XOR of the 10 least significant bits of the data coming from the
transmit FIFO and a 10-bit pseudo random number generator. The number of bits used depends
on the number of collisions seen. After the first collision, 1 bit is used, after the second 2, and so
on up to 10. Above 10, all 10 bits are used. An error is indicated and no further attempts are
made if 16 attempts cause collisions.
If transmit DMA underruns, bad CRC is automatically appended using the same mechanism as
jam insertion and the tx_er signal is asserted. For a properly configured system, this should
never happen.
If the back pressure bit is set in the network control register in half duplex mode, the transmit
block transmits 64 bits of data, which can consist of 16 nibbles of 1011 or in bit-rate mode 64 1s,
whenever it sees an incoming frame to force a collision. This provides a way of implementing
flow control in half-duplex mode.
613
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.3.3
Pause Frame Support
The start of an 802.3 pause frame is as follows:
Table 39-3.
Start of an 802.3 Pause Frame
Destination
Address
Source
Address
Type
(Mac Control Frame)
Pause
Opcode
Pause Time
0x0180C2000001
6 bytes
0x8808
0x0001
2 bytes
The network configuration register contains a receive pause enable bit (13). If a valid pause
frame is received, the pause time register is updated with the frame’s pause time, regardless of
its current contents and regardless of the state of the configuration register bit 13. An interrupt
(12) is triggered when a pause frame is received, assuming it is enabled in the interrupt mask
register. If bit 13 is set in the network configuration register and the value of the pause time register is non-zero, no new frame is transmitted until the pause time register has decremented to
zero.
The loading of a new pause time, and hence the pausing of transmission, only occurs when the
EMAC is configured for full-duplex operation. If the EMAC is configured for half-duplex, there is
no transmission pause, but the pause frame received interrupt is still triggered.
A valid pause frame is defined as having a destination address that matches either the address
stored in specific address register 1 or matches 0x0180C2000001 and has the MAC control
frame type ID of 0x8808 and the pause opcode of 0x0001. Pause frames that have FCS or other
errors are treated as invalid and are discarded. Valid pause frames received increment the
Pause Frame Received statistic register.
The pause time register decrements every 512 bit times (i.e., 128 rx_clks in nibble mode)
once transmission has stopped. For test purposes, the register decrements every rx_clk cycle
once transmission has stopped if bit 12 (retry test) is set in the network configuration register. If
the pause enable bit (13) is not set in the network configuration register, then the decrementing
occurs regardless of whether transmission has stopped or not.
An interrupt (13) is asserted whenever the pause time register decrements to zero (assuming it
is enabled in the interrupt mask register).
39.3.4
Receive Block
The receive block checks for valid preamble, FCS, alignment and length, presents received
frames to the DMA block and stores the frames destination address for use by the address
checking block. If, during frame reception, the frame is found to be too long or rx_er is asserted,
a bad frame indication is sent to the DMA block. The DMA block then ceases sending data to
memory. At the end of frame reception, the receive block indicates to the DMA block whether the
frame is good or bad. The DMA block recovers the current receive buffer if the frame was bad.
The receive block signals the register block to increment the alignment error, the CRC (FCS)
error, the short frame, long frame, jabber error, the receive symbol error statistics and the length
field mismatch statistics.
The enable bit for jumbo frames in the network configuration register allows the EMAC to receive
jumbo frames of up to 10240 bytes in size. This operation does not form part of the IEEE802.3
specification and is disabled by default. When jumbo frames are enabled, frames received with a
frame size greater than 10240 bytes are discarded.
614
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.3.5
Address Checking Block
The address checking (or filter) block indicates to the DMA block which receive frames should
be copied to memory. Whether a frame is copied depends on what is enabled in the network
configuration register, the state of the external match pin, the contents of the specific address
and hash registers and the frame’s destination address. In this implementation of the EMAC, the
frame’s source address is not checked. Provided that bit 18 of the Network Configuration register is not set, a frame is not copied to memory if the EMAC is transmitting in half duplex mode at
the time a destination address is received. If bit 18 of the Network Configuration register is set,
frames can be received while transmitting in half-duplex mode.
Ethernet frames are transmitted a byte at a time, least significant bit first. The first six bytes (48
bits) of an Ethernet frame make up the destination address. The first bit of the destination
address, the LSB of the first byte of the frame, is the group/individual bit: this is One for multicast
addresses and Zero for unicast. The All Ones address is the broadcast address, and a special
case of multicast.
The EMAC supports recognition of four specific addresses. Each specific address requires two
registers, specific address register bottom and specific address register top. Specific address
register bottom stores the first four bytes of the destination address and specific address register
top contains the last two bytes. The addresses stored can be specific, group, local or universal.
The destination address of received frames is compared against the data stored in the specific
address registers once they have been activated. The addresses are deactivated at reset or
when their corresponding specific address register bottom is written. They are activated when
specific address register top is written. If a receive frame address matches an active address,
the frame is copied to memory.
The following example illustrates the use of the address match registers for a MAC address of
21:43:65:87:A9:CB.
Preamble 55
SFD D5
DA (Octet0 - LSB) 21
DA(Octet 1) 43
DA(Octet 2) 65
DA(Octet 3) 87
DA(Octet 4) A9
DA (Octet5 - MSB) CB
SA (LSB) 00
SA 00
SA 00
SA 00
SA 00
SA (MSB) 43
SA (LSB) 21
615
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
The sequence above shows the beginning of an Ethernet frame. Byte order of transmission is
from top to bottom as shown. For a successful match to specific address 1, the following
address matching registers must be set up:
• Base address + 0x98 0x87654321 (Bottom)
• Base address + 0x9C 0x0000CBA9 (Top)
And for a successful match to the Type ID register, the following should be set up:
• Base address + 0xB8 0x00004321
39.3.6
Broadcast Address
The broadcast address of 0xFFFFFFFFFFFF is recognized if the ‘no broadcast’ bit in the network configuration register is zero.
39.3.7
Hash Addressing
The hash address register is 64 bits long and takes up two locations in the memory map. The
least significant bits are stored in hash register bottom and the most significant bits in hash register top.
The unicast hash enable and the multicast hash enable bits in the network configuration register
enable the reception of hash matched frames. The destination address is reduced to a 6-bit
index into the 64-bit hash register using the following hash function. The hash function is an
exclusive or of every sixth bit of the destination address.
hash_index[5] = da[5] ^ da[11] ^ da[17] ^ da[23] ^ da[29] ^ da[35] ^ da[41] ^ da[47]
hash_index[4] = da[4] ^ da[10] ^ da[16] ^ da[22] ^ da[28] ^ da[34] ^ da[40] ^ da[46]
hash_index[3] = da[3] ^ da[09] ^ da[15] ^ da[21] ^ da[27] ^ da[33] ^ da[39] ^ da[45]
hash_index[2] = da[2] ^ da[08] ^ da[14] ^ da[20] ^ da[26] ^ da[32] ^ da[38] ^ da[44]
hash_index[1] = da[1] ^ da[07] ^ da[13] ^ da[19] ^ da[25] ^ da[31] ^ da[37] ^ da[43]
hash_index[0] = da[0] ^ da[06] ^ da[12] ^ da[18] ^ da[24] ^ da[30] ^ da[36] ^ da[42]
da[0] represents the least significant bit of the first byte received, that is, the multicast/unicast
indicator, and da[47] represents the most significant bit of the last byte received.
If the hash index points to a bit that is set in the hash register, then the frame is matched according to whether the frame is multicast or unicast.
A multicast match is signalled if the multicast hash enable bit is set. da[0] is 1 and the hash index
points to a bit set in the hash register.
A unicast match is signalled if the unicast hash enable bit is set. da[0] is 0 and the hash index
points to a bit set in the hash register.
To receive all multicast frames, the hash register should be set with all ones and the multicast
hash enable bit should be set in the network configuration register.
39.3.8
616
Copy All Frames (or Promiscuous Mode)
If the copy all frames bit is set in the network configuration register, then all non-errored frames
are copied to memory. For example, frames that are too long, too short, or have FCS errors or
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
rx_er asserted during reception are discarded and all others are received. Frames with FCS
errors are copied to memory if bit 19 in the network configuration register is set.
39.3.9
Type ID Checking
The contents of the type_id register are compared against the length/type ID of received frames
(i.e., bytes 13 and 14). Bit 22 in the receive buffer descriptor status is set if there is a match. The
reset state of this register is zero which is unlikely to match the length/type ID of any valid Ethernet frame.
Note:
39.3.10
A type ID match does not affect whether a frame is copied to memory.
VLAN Support
An Ethernet encoded 802.1Q VLAN tag looks like this:
Table 39-4.
802.1Q VLAN Tag
TPID (Tag Protocol Identifier) 16 bits
TCI (Tag Control Information) 16 bits
0x8100
First 3 bits priority, then CFI bit, last 12 bits VID
The VLAN tag is inserted at the 13th byte of the frame, adding an extra four bytes to the frame. If
the VID (VLAN identifier) is null (0x000), this indicates a priority-tagged frame. The MAC can
support frame lengths up to 1536 bytes, 18 bytes more than the original Ethernet maximum
frame length of 1518 bytes. This is achieved by setting bit 8 in the network configuration register.
The following bits in the receive buffer descriptor status word give information about VLAN
tagged frames:
• Bit 21 set if receive frame is VLAN tagged (i.e. type id of 0x8100)
• Bit 20 set if receive frame is priority tagged (i.e. type id of 0x8100 and null VID). (If bit 20 is
set bit 21 is set also.)
• Bit 19, 18 and 17 set to priority if bit 21 is set
• Bit 16 set to CFI if bit 21 is set
39.3.11
PHY Maintenance
The register EMAC_MAN enables the EMAC to communicate with a PHY by means of the MDIO
interface. It is used during auto-negotiation to ensure that the EMAC and the PHY are configured for the same speed and duplex configuration.
The PHY maintenance register is implemented as a shift register. Writing to the register starts a
shift operation which is signalled as complete when bit two is set in the network status register
(about 2000 MCK cycles later when bit ten is set to zero, and bit eleven is set to one in the network configuration register). An interrupt is generated as this bit is set. During this time, the MSB
of the register is output on the MDIO pin and the LSB updated from the MDIO pin with each
MDC cycle. This causes transmission of a PHY management frame on MDIO.
Reading during the shift operation returns the current contents of the shift register. At the end of
management operation, the bits have shifted back to their original locations. For a read operation, the data bits are updated with data read from the PHY. It is important to write the correct
values to the register to ensure a valid PHY management frame is produced.
The MDIO interface can read IEEE 802.3 clause 45 PHYs as well as clause 22 PHYs. To read
clause 45 PHYs, bits[31:28] should be written as 0x0011. For a description of MDC generation,
see the network configuration register in the “Network Control Register” on page 624.
617
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.3.12
Media Independent Interface
The Ethernet MAC is capable of interfacing to both RMII and MII Interfaces. The RMII bit in the
EMAC_USRIO register controls the interface that is selected. When this bit is set, the RMII interface is selected, else the MII interface is selected.
The MII and RMII interface are capable of both 10Mb/s and 100Mb/s data rates as described in
the IEEE 802.3u standard. The signals used by the MII and RMII interfaces are described in
Table 39-5.
Table 39-5.
Pin Configuration
Pin Name
ETXCK_EREFCK
MII
RMII
ETXCK: Transmit Clock
EREFCK: Reference Clock
ECRS
ECRS: Carrier Sense
ECOL
ECOL: Collision Detect
ERXDV
ERXDV: Data Valid
ECRSDV: Carrier Sense/Data Valid
ERX0 - ERX3: 4-bit Receive Data
ERX0 - ERX1: 2-bit Receive Data
ERXER
ERXER: Receive Error
ERXER: Receive Error
ERXCK
ERXCK: Receive Clock
ETXEN
ETXEN: Transmit Enable
ETXEN: Transmit Enable
ETX0 - ETX3: 4-bit Transmit Data
ETX0 - ETX1: 2-bit Transmit Data
ERX0 - ERX3
ETX0-ETX3
ETXER
ETXER: Transmit Error
The intent of the RMII is to provide a reduced pin count alternative to the IEEE 802.3u MII. It
uses 2 bits for transmit (ETX0 and ETX1) and two bits for receive (ERX0 and ERX1). There is a
Transmit Enable (ETXEN), a Receive Error (ERXER), a Carrier Sense (ECRS_DV), and a 50
MHz Reference Clock (ETXCK_EREFCK) for 100Mb/s data rate.
39.3.12.1
618
RMII Transmit and Receive Operation
The same signals are used internally for both the RMII and the MII operations. The RMII maps
these signals in a more pin-efficient manner. The transmit and receive bits are converted from a
4-bit parallel format to a 2-bit parallel scheme that is clocked at twice the rate. The carrier sense
and data valid signals are combined into the ECRSDV signal. This signal contains information
on carrier sense, FIFO status, and validity of the data. Transmit error bit (ETXER) and collision
detect (ECOL) are not used in RMII mode.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.4
Programming Interface
39.4.1
39.4.1.1
Initialization
Configuration
Initialization of the EMAC configuration (e.g., loop-back mode, frequency ratios) must be done
while the transmit and receive circuits are disabled. See the description of the network control
register and network configuration register earlier in this document.
To change loop-back mode, the following sequence of operations must be followed:
1. Write to network control register to disable transmit and receive circuits.
2. Write to network control register to change loop-back mode.
3. Write to network control register to re-enable transmit or receive circuits.
Note:
39.4.1.2
These writes to network control register cannot be combined in any way.
Receive Buffer List
Receive data is written to areas of data (i.e., buffers) in system memory. These buffers are listed
in another data structure that also resides in main memory. This data structure (receive buffer
queue) is a sequence of descriptor entries as defined in “Receive Buffer Descriptor Entry” on
page 609. It points to this data structure.
Figure 39-2. Receive Buffer List
Receive Buffer 0
Receive Buffer Queue Pointer
(MAC Register)
Receive Buffer 1
Receive Buffer N
Receive Buffer Descriptor List
(In memory)
(In memory)
To create the list of buffers:
1. Allocate a number (n) of buffers of 128 bytes in system memory.
2. Allocate an area 2n words for the receive buffer descriptor entry in system memory and
create n entries in this list. Mark all entries in this list as owned by EMAC, i.e., bit 0 of
word 0 set to 0.
3. If less than 1024 buffers are defined, the last descriptor must be marked with the wrap
bit (bit 1 in word 0 set to 1).
4. Write address of receive buffer descriptor entry to EMAC register receive_buffer
queue pointer.
5. The receive circuits can then be enabled by writing to the address recognition registers
and then to the network control register.
619
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.4.1.3
Transmit Buffer List
Transmit data is read from areas of data (the buffers) in system memory These buffers are listed
in another data structure that also resides in main memory. This data structure (Transmit Buffer
Queue) is a sequence of descriptor entries (as defined in Table 39-2 on page 612) that points to
this data structure.
To create this list of buffers:
1. Allocate a number (n) of buffers of between 1 and 2047 bytes of data to be transmitted
in system memory. Up to 128 buffers per frame are allowed.
2. Allocate an area 2n words for the transmit buffer descriptor entry in system memory
and create N entries in this list. Mark all entries in this list as owned by EMAC, i.e. bit 31
of word 1 set to 0.
3. If fewer than 1024 buffers are defined, the last descriptor must be marked with the wrap
bit — bit 30 in word 1 set to 1.
4. Write address of transmit buffer descriptor entry to EMAC register transmit_buffer
queue pointer.
5. The transmit circuits can then be enabled by writing to the network control register.
39.4.1.4
Address Matching
The EMAC register-pair hash address and the four specific address register-pairs must be written with the required values. Each register-pair comprises a bottom register and top register,
with the bottom register being written first. The address matching is disabled for a particular register-pair after the bottom-register has been written and re-enabled when the top register is
written. See “Address Checking Block” on page 615. for details of address matching. Each register-pair may be written at any time, regardless of whether the receive circuits are enabled or
disabled.
39.4.1.5
Interrupts
There are 14 interrupt conditions that are detected within the EMAC. These are ORed to make a
single interrupt. Depending on the overall system design, this may be passed through a further
level of interrupt collection (interrupt controller). On receipt of the interrupt signal, the CPU
enters the interrupt handler (Refer to the AIC programmer datasheet). To ascertain which interrupt has been generated, read the interrupt status register. Note that this register clears itself
when read. At reset, all interrupts are disabled. To enable an interrupt, write to interrupt enable
register with the pertinent interrupt bit set to 1. To disable an interrupt, write to interrupt disable
register with the pertinent interrupt bit set to 1. To check whether an interrupt is enabled or disabled, read interrupt mask register: if the bit is set to 1, the interrupt is disabled.
39.4.1.6
Transmitting Frames
To set up a frame for transmission:
1. Enable transmit in the network control register.
2. Allocate an area of system memory for transmit data. This does not have to be contiguous, varying byte lengths can be used as long as they conclude on byte borders.
3. Set-up the transmit buffer list.
4. Set the network control register to enable transmission and enable interrupts.
5. Write data for transmission into these buffers.
6. Write the address to transmit buffer descriptor queue pointer.
7. Write control and length to word one of the transmit buffer descriptor entry.
620
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
8. Write to the transmit start bit in the network control register.
39.4.1.7
Receiving Frames
When a frame is received and the receive circuits are enabled, the EMAC checks the address
and, in the following cases, the frame is written to system memory:
• if it matches one of the four specific address registers.
• if it matches the hash address function.
• if it is a broadcast address (0xFFFFFFFFFFFF) and broadcasts are allowed.
• if the EMAC is configured to copy all frames.
The register receive buffer queue pointer points to the next entry (see Table 39-1 on page 609)
and the EMAC uses this as the address in system memory to write the frame to. Once the frame
has been completely and successfully received and written to system memory, the EMAC then
updates the receive buffer descriptor entry with the reason for the address match and marks the
area as being owned by software. Once this is complete an interrupt receive complete is set.
Software is then responsible for handling the data in the buffer and then releasing the buffer by
writing the ownership bit back to 0.
If the EMAC is unable to write the data at a rate to match the incoming frame, then an interrupt
receive overrun is set. If there is no receive buffer available, i.e., the next buffer is still owned by
software, the interrupt receive buffer not available is set. If the frame is not successfully
received, a statistic register is incremented and the frame is discarded without informing
software.
621
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5
Ethernet MAC 10/100 (EMAC) User Interface
Table 39-6.
Register Mapping
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x00
Network Control Register
EMAC_NCR
Read-write
0
0x04
Network Configuration Register
EMAC_NCFG
Read-write
0x800
0x08
Network Status Register
EMAC_NSR
Read-only
-
0x0C
Reserved
0x10
Reserved
0x14
Transmit Status Register
EMAC_TSR
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x18
Receive Buffer Queue Pointer Register
EMAC_RBQP
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x1C
Transmit Buffer Queue Pointer Register
EMAC_TBQP
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x20
Receive Status Register
EMAC_RSR
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x24
Interrupt Status Register
EMAC_ISR
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x28
Interrupt Enable Register
EMAC_IER
Write-only
-
0x2C
Interrupt Disable Register
EMAC_IDR
Write-only
-
0x30
Interrupt Mask Register
EMAC_IMR
Read-only
0x0000_3FFF
0x34
Phy Maintenance Register
EMAC_MAN
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x38
Pause Time Register
EMAC_PTR
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x3C
Pause Frames Received Register
EMAC_PFR
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x40
Frames Transmitted Ok Register
EMAC_FTO
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x44
Single Collision Frames Register
EMAC_SCF
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x48
Multiple Collision Frames Register
EMAC_MCF
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x4C
Frames Received Ok Register
EMAC_FRO
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x50
Frame Check Sequence Errors Register
EMAC_FCSE
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x54
Alignment Errors Register
EMAC_ALE
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x58
Deferred Transmission Frames Register
EMAC_DTF
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x5C
Late Collisions Register
EMAC_LCOL
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x60
Excessive Collisions Register
EMAC_ECOL
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x64
Transmit Underrun Errors Register
EMAC_TUND
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x68
Carrier Sense Errors Register
EMAC_CSE
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x6C
Receive Resource Errors Register
EMAC_RRE
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x70
Receive Overrun Errors Register
EMAC_ROV
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x74
Receive Symbol Errors Register
EMAC_RSE
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x78
Excessive Length Errors Register
EMAC_ELE
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x7C
Receive Jabbers Register
EMAC_RJA
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x80
Undersize Frames Register
EMAC_USF
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x84
SQE Test Errors Register
EMAC_STE
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x88
Received Length Field Mismatch Register
EMAC_RLE
Read-write
0x0000_0000
622
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 39-6.
Register Mapping (Continued)
Offset
Register
Name
Access
Reset
0x90
Hash Register Bottom [31:0] Register
EMAC_HRB
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x94
Hash Register Top [63:32] Register
EMAC_HRT
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x98
Specific Address 1 Bottom Register
EMAC_SA1B
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0x9C
Specific Address 1 Top Register
EMAC_SA1T
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0xA0
Specific Address 2 Bottom Register
EMAC_SA2B
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0xA4
Specific Address 2 Top Register
EMAC_SA2T
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0xA8
Specific Address 3 Bottom Register
EMAC_SA3B
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0xAC
Specific Address 3 Top Register
EMAC_SA3T
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0xB0
Specific Address 4 Bottom Register
EMAC_SA4B
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0xB4
Specific Address 4 Top Register
EMAC_SA4T
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0xB8
Type ID Checking Register
EMAC_TID
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0xC0
User Input/output Register
EMAC_USRIO
Read-write
0x0000_0000
0xC8-0xF8
Reserved
–
–
–
0xC8 - 0xFC
Reserved
–
–
–
623
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.1
Network Control Register
Register Name:
EMAC_NCR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
THALT
9
TSTART
8
BP
7
WESTAT
6
INCSTAT
5
CLRSTAT
4
MPE
3
TE
2
RE
1
LLB
0
LB
• LB: LoopBack
Asserts the loopback signal to the PHY.
• LLB: Loopback local
Connects txd to rxd, tx_en to rx_dv, forces full duplex and drives rx_clk and tx_clk with pclk divided by 4.
rx_clk and tx_clk may glitch as the EMAC is switched into and out of internal loop back. It is important that receive
and transmit circuits have already been disabled when making the switch into and out of internal loop back.
• RE: Receive enable
When set, enables the EMAC to receive data. When reset, frame reception stops immediately and the receive FIFO is
cleared. The receive queue pointer register is unaffected.
• TE: Transmit enable
When set, enables the Ethernet transmitter to send data. When reset transmission, stops immediately, the transmit FIFO
and control registers are cleared and the transmit queue pointer register resets to point to the start of the transmit descriptor list.
• MPE: Management port enable
Set to one to enable the management port. When zero, forces MDIO to high impedance state and MDC low.
• CLRSTAT: Clear statistics registers
This bit is write only. Writing a one clears the statistics registers.
• INCSTAT: Increment statistics registers
This bit is write only. Writing a one increments all the statistics registers by one for test purposes.
• WESTAT: Write enable for statistics registers
Setting this bit to one makes the statistics registers writable for functional test purposes.
• BP: Back Pressure
If set in half duplex mode, forces collisions on all received frames.
• TSTART: Start transmission
Writing one to this bit starts transmission.
• THALT: Transmit halt
624
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Writing one to this bit halts transmission as soon as any ongoing frame transmission ends.
39.5.2
Network Configuration Register
Register Name:
EMAC_NCFGR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
IRXFCS
18
EFRHD
17
DRFCS
16
RLCE
14
13
PAE
12
RTY
11
10
9
8
BIG
5
NBC
4
CAF
3
JFRAME
2
–
1
FD
0
SPD
15
RBOF
7
UNI
6
MTI
CLK
• SPD: Speed
Set to 1 to indicate 100 Mbit/s operation, 0 for 10 Mbit/s.
• FD: Full Duplex
If set to 1, the transmit block ignores the state of collision and carrier sense and allows receive while transmitting.
• CAF: Copy All Frames
When set to 1, all valid frames are received.
• JFRAME: Jumbo Frames
Set to one to enable jumbo frames of up to 10240 bytes to be accepted.
• NBC: No Broadcast
When set to 1, frames addressed to the broadcast address of all ones are not received.
• MTI: Multicast Hash Enable
When set, multicast frames are received when the 6-bit hash function of the destination address points to a bit that is set in
the hash register.
• UNI: Unicast Hash Enable
When set, unicast frames are received when the 6-bit hash function of the destination address points to a bit that is set in
the hash register.
• BIG: Receive 1536 Bytes Frames
Setting this bit means the EMAC receives frames up to 1536 bytes in length. Normally, the EMAC would reject any frame
above 1518 bytes.
625
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• CLK: MDC clock divider
Set according to system clock speed. This determines by what number system clock is divided to generate MDC.
For conformance with 802.3, MDC must not exceed 2.5MHz (MDC is only active during MDIO read and write operations).
CLK
MDC
00
MCK divided by 8 (MCK up to 20 MHz)
01
MCK divided by 16 (MCK up to 40 MHz)
10
MCK divided by 32 (MCK up to 80 MHz)
11
MCK divided by 64 (MCK up to 160 MHz)
• RTY: Retry Test
Must be set to zero for normal operation. If set to one, the back off between collisions is always one slot time. Setting this
bit to one helps testing the too many retries condition. Also used in the pause frame tests to reduce the pause counters
decrement time from 512 bit times, to every rx_clk cycle.
• PAE: Pause Enable
When set, transmission pauses when a valid pause frame is received.
• RBOF: Receive Buffer Offset
Indicates the number of bytes by which the received data is offset from the start of the first receive buffer.
RBOF
Offset
00
No offset from start of receive buffer
01
One-byte offset from start of receive buffer
10
Two-byte offset from start of receive buffer
11
Three-byte offset from start of receive buffer
• RLCE: Receive Length field Checking Enable
When set, frames with measured lengths shorter than their length fields are discarded. Frames containing a type ID in
bytes 13 and 14 — length/type ID = 0600 — are not be counted as length errors.
• DRFCS: Discard Receive FCS
When set, the FCS field of received frames are not be copied to memory.
• EFRHD:
Enable Frames to be received in half-duplex mode while transmitting.
• IRXFCS: Ignore RX FCS
When set, frames with FCS/CRC errors are not rejected and no FCS error statistics are counted. For normal operation, this
bit must be set to 0.
626
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.3
Network Status Register
Register Name:
EMAC_NSR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
IDLE
1
MDIO
0
–
• MDIO
Returns status of the MDIO pin. Use the PHY maintenance register for reading managed frames rather than this bit.
• IDLE
0 = The PHY logic is running.
1 = The PHY management logic is idle (i.e., has completed).
627
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.4
Transmit Status Register
Register Name:
EMAC_TSR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
UND
5
COMP
4
BEX
3
TGO
2
RLE
1
COL
0
UBR
This register, when read, provides details of the status of a transmit. Once read, individual bits may be cleared by writing 1
to them. It is not possible to set a bit to 1 by writing to the register.
• UBR: Used Bit Read
Set when a transmit buffer descriptor is read with its used bit set. Cleared by writing a one to this bit.
• COL: Collision Occurred
Set by the assertion of collision. Cleared by writing a one to this bit.
• RLE: Retry Limit exceeded
Cleared by writing a one to this bit.
• TGO: Transmit Go
If high transmit is active.
• BEX: Buffers exhausted mid frame
If the buffers run out during transmission of a frame, then transmission stops, FCS shall be bad and tx_er asserted. Cleared
by writing a one to this bit.
• COMP: Transmit Complete
Set when a frame has been transmitted. Cleared by writing a one to this bit.
• UND: Transmit Underrun
Set when transmit DMA was not able to read data from memory, either because the bus was not granted in time, because
a not OK hresp(bus error) was returned or because a used bit was read midway through frame transmission. If this
occurs, the transmitter forces bad CRC. Cleared by writing a one to this bit.
628
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.5
Receive Buffer Queue Pointer Register
Register Name:
EMAC_RBQP
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
–
0
–
ADDR
23
22
21
20
ADDR
15
14
13
12
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
This register points to the entry in the receive buffer queue (descriptor list) currently being used. It is written with the start
location of the receive buffer descriptor list. The lower order bits increment as buffers are used up and wrap to their original
values after either 1024 buffers or when the wrap bit of the entry is set.
Reading this register returns the location of the descriptor currently being accessed. This value increments as buffers are
used. Software should not use this register for determining where to remove received frames from the queue as it constantly changes as new frames are received. Software should instead work its way through the buffer descriptor queue
checking the used bits.
Receive buffer writes also comprise bursts of two words and, as with transmit buffer reads, it is recommended that bit 2 is
always written with zero to prevent a burst crossing a 1K boundary, in violation of section 3.6 of the AMBA specification.
• ADDR: Receive buffer queue pointer address
Written with the address of the start of the receive queue, reads as a pointer to the current buffer being used.
629
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.6
Transmit Buffer Queue Pointer Register
Register Name:
EMAC_TBQP
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
–
0
–
ADDR
23
22
21
20
ADDR
15
14
13
12
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
This register points to the entry in the transmit buffer queue (descriptor list) currently being used. It is written with the start
location of the transmit buffer descriptor list. The lower order bits increment as buffers are used up and wrap to their original
values after either 1024 buffers or when the wrap bit of the entry is set. This register can only be written when bit 3 in the
transmit status register is low.
As transmit buffer reads consist of bursts of two words, it is recommended that bit 2 is always written with zero to prevent a
burst crossing a 1K boundary, in violation of section 3.6 of the AMBA specification.
• ADDR: Transmit buffer queue pointer address
Written with the address of the start of the transmit queue, reads as a pointer to the first buffer of the frame being transmitted or about to be transmitted.
630
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.7
Receive Status Register
Register Name:
EMAC_RSR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
OVR
1
REC
0
BNA
This register, when read, provides details of the status of a receive. Once read, individual bits may be cleared by writing 1
to them. It is not possible to set a bit to 1 by writing to the register.
• BNA: Buffer Not Available
An attempt was made to get a new buffer and the pointer indicated that it was owned by the processor. The DMA rereads
the pointer each time a new frame starts until a valid pointer is found. This bit is set at each attempt that fails even if it has
not had a successful pointer read since it has been cleared.
Cleared by writing a one to this bit.
• REC: Frame Received
One or more frames have been received and placed in memory. Cleared by writing a one to this bit.
• OVR: Receive Overrun
The DMA block was unable to store the receive frame to memory, either because the bus was not granted in time or
because a not OK hresp(bus error) was returned. The buffer is recovered if this happens.
Cleared by writing a one to this bit.
631
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.8
Interrupt Status Register
Register Name:
EMAC_ISR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
PTZ
12
PFR
11
HRESP
10
ROVR
9
–
8
–
7
TCOMP
6
TXERR
5
RLE
4
TUND
3
TXUBR
2
RXUBR
1
RCOMP
0
MFD
• MFD: Management Frame Done
The PHY maintenance register has completed its operation. Cleared on read.
• RCOMP: Receive Complete
A frame has been stored in memory. Cleared on read.
• RXUBR: Receive Used Bit Read
Set when a receive buffer descriptor is read with its used bit set. Cleared on read.
• TXUBR: Transmit Used Bit Read
Set when a transmit buffer descriptor is read with its used bit set. Cleared on read.
• TUND: Ethernet Transmit Buffer Underrun
The transmit DMA did not fetch frame data in time for it to be transmitted or hresp returned not OK. Also set if a used bit
is read mid-frame or when a new transmit queue pointer is written. Cleared on read.
• RLE: Retry Limit Exceeded
Cleared on read.
• TXERR: Transmit Error
Transmit buffers exhausted in mid-frame - transmit error. Cleared on read.
• TCOMP: Transmit Complete
Set when a frame has been transmitted. Cleared on read.
• ROVR: Receive Overrun
Set when the receive overrun status bit gets set. Cleared on read.
• HRESP: Hresp not OK
Set when the DMA block sees a bus error. Cleared on read.
• PFR: Pause Frame Received
Indicates a valid pause has been received. Cleared on a read.
• PTZ: Pause Time Zero
Set when the pause time register, 0x38 decrements to zero. Cleared on a read.
632
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.9
Interrupt Enable Register
Register Name:
EMAC_IER
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
PTZ
12
PFR
11
HRESP
10
ROVR
9
–
8
–
7
TCOMP
6
TXERR
5
RLE
4
TUND
3
TXUBR
2
RXUBR
1
RCOMP
0
MFD
• MFD: Management Frame sent
Enable management done interrupt.
• RCOMP: Receive Complete
Enable receive complete interrupt.
• RXUBR: Receive Used Bit Read
Enable receive used bit read interrupt.
• TXUBR: Transmit Used Bit Read
Enable transmit used bit read interrupt.
• TUND: Ethernet Transmit Buffer Underrun
Enable transmit underrun interrupt.
• RLE: Retry Limit Exceeded
Enable retry limit exceeded interrupt.
• TXERR
Enable transmit buffers exhausted in mid-frame interrupt.
• TCOMP: Transmit Complete
Enable transmit complete interrupt.
• ROVR: Receive Overrun
Enable receive overrun interrupt.
• HRESP: Hresp not OK
Enable Hresp not OK interrupt.
• PFR: Pause Frame Received
Enable pause frame received interrupt.
• PTZ: Pause Time Zero
Enable pause time zero interrupt.
633
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.10 Interrupt Disable Register
Register Name:
EMAC_IDR
Access Type:
Write-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
PTZ
12
PFR
11
HRESP
10
ROVR
9
8
–
7
TCOMP
6
TXERR
5
RLE
4
TUND
3
TXUBR
2
RXUBR
1
RCOMP
0
MFD
• MFD: Management Frame sent
Disable management done interrupt.
• RCOMP: Receive Complete
Disable receive complete interrupt.
• RXUBR: Receive Used Bit Read
Disable receive used bit read interrupt.
• TXUBR: Transmit Used Bit Read
Disable transmit used bit read interrupt.
• TUND: Ethernet Transmit Buffer Underrun
Disable transmit underrun interrupt.
• RLE: Retry Limit Exceeded
Disable retry limit exceeded interrupt.
• TXERR
Disable transmit buffers exhausted in mid-frame interrupt.
• TCOMP: Transmit Complete
Disable transmit complete interrupt.
• ROVR: Receive Overrun
Disable receive overrun interrupt.
• HRESP: Hresp not OK
Disable Hresp not OK interrupt.
• PFR: Pause Frame Received
Disable pause frame received interrupt.
• PTZ: Pause Time Zero
Disable pause time zero interrupt.
634
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.11 Interrupt Mask Register
Register Name:
EMAC_IMR
Access Type:
Read-only
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
PTZ
12
PFR
11
HRESP
10
ROVR
9
8
–
7
TCOMP
6
TXERR
5
RLE
4
TUND
3
TXUBR
2
RXUBR
1
RCOMP
0
MFD
• MFD: Management Frame sent
Management done interrupt masked.
• RCOMP: Receive Complete
Receive complete interrupt masked.
• RXUBR: Receive Used Bit Read
Receive used bit read interrupt masked.
• TXUBR: Transmit Used Bit Read
Transmit used bit read interrupt masked.
• TUND: Ethernet Transmit Buffer Underrun
Transmit underrun interrupt masked.
• RLE: Retry Limit Exceeded
Retry limit exceeded interrupt masked.
• TXERR
Transmit buffers exhausted in mid-frame interrupt masked.
• TCOMP: Transmit Complete
Transmit complete interrupt masked.
• ROVR: Receive Overrun
Receive overrun interrupt masked.
• HRESP: Hresp not OK
Hresp not OK interrupt masked.
• PFR: Pause Frame Received
Pause frame received interrupt masked.
• PTZ: Pause Time Zero
Pause time zero interrupt masked.
635
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.12 PHY Maintenance Register
Register Name:
EMAC_MAN
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
SOF
28
27
26
RW
23
PHYA
22
15
14
21
13
25
24
17
16
PHYA
20
REGA
19
18
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
CODE
DATA
7
6
5
4
DATA
• DATA
For a write operation this is written with the data to be written to the PHY.
After a read operation this contains the data read from the PHY.
• CODE:
Must be written to 10. Reads as written.
• REGA: Register Address
Specifies the register in the PHY to access.
• PHYA: PHY Address
• RW: Read/Write
10 is read; 01 is write. Any other value is an invalid PHY management frame
• SOF: Start of frame
Must be written 01 for a valid frame.
636
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.13 Pause Time Register
Register Name:
EMAC_PTR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
PTIME
7
6
5
4
PTIME
• PTIME: Pause Time
Stores the current value of the pause time register which is decremented every 512 bit times.
637
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.14 Hash Register Bottom
Register Name:
EMAC_HRB
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ADDR
23
22
21
20
ADDR
15
14
13
12
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR:
Bits 31:0 of the hash address register. See “Hash Addressing” on page 616.
39.5.15 Hash Register Top
Register Name:
EMAC_HRT
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
ADDR
23
22
21
20
ADDR
15
14
13
12
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR:
Bits 63:32 of the hash address register. See “Hash Addressing” on page 616.
638
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.16 Specific Address 1 Bottom Register
Register Name:
EMAC_SA1B
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ADDR
23
22
21
20
ADDR
15
14
13
12
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR
Least significant bits of the destination address. Bit zero indicates whether the address is multicast or unicast and corresponds to the least significant bit of the first byte received.
39.5.17 Specific Address 1 Top Register
Register Name:
EMAC_SA1T
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR
The most significant bits of the destination address, that is bits 47 to 32.
639
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.18 Specific Address 2 Bottom Register
Register Name:
EMAC_SA2B
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ADDR
23
22
21
20
ADDR
15
14
13
12
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR
Least significant bits of the destination address. Bit zero indicates whether the address is multicast or unicast and corresponds to the least significant bit of the first byte received.
39.5.19 Specific Address 2 Top Register
Register Name:
EMAC_SA2T
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR
The most significant bits of the destination address, that is bits 47 to 32.
640
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.20 Specific Address 3 Bottom Register
Register Name:
EMAC_SA3B
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ADDR
23
22
21
20
ADDR
15
14
13
12
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR
Least significant bits of the destination address. Bit zero indicates whether the address is multicast or unicast and corresponds to the least significant bit of the first byte received.
39.5.21 Specific Address 3 Top Register
Register Name:
EMAC_SA3T
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR
The most significant bits of the destination address, that is bits 47 to 32.
641
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.22 Specific Address 4 Bottom Register
Register Name:
EMAC_SA4B
Access Type:
31
Read-write
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ADDR
23
22
21
20
ADDR
15
14
13
12
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR
Least significant bits of the destination address. Bit zero indicates whether the address is multicast or unicast and corresponds to the least significant bit of the first byte received.
39.5.23 Specific Address 4 Top Register
Register Name:
EMAC_SA4T
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
ADDR
7
6
5
4
ADDR
• ADDR
The most significant bits of the destination address, that is bits 47 to 32.
642
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.24 Type ID Checking Register
Register Name:
EMAC_TID
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
TID
7
6
5
4
TID
• TID: Type ID Checking
For use in comparisons with received frames TypeID/Length field.
39.5.25 User Input/Output Register
Register Name:
EMAC_USRIO
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
CLKEN
0
RMII
• RMII
When set, this bit enables the RMII operation mode. When reset, it selects the MII mode.
• CLKEN
When set, this bit enables the transceiver input clock.
Setting this bit to 0 reduces power consumption when the treasurer is not used.
643
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.26 EMAC Statistic Registers
These registers reset to zero on a read and stick at all ones when they count to their maximum value. They should be read
frequently enough to prevent loss of data. The receive statistics registers are only incremented when the receive enable bit
is set in the network control register. To write to these registers, bit 7 must be set in the network control register. The statistics register block contains the following registers.
39.5.26.1
Pause Frames Received Register
Register Name:
EMAC_PFR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
FROK
7
6
5
4
FROK
• FROK: Pause Frames Received OK
A 16-bit register counting the number of good pause frames received. A good frame has a length of 64 to 1518 (1536 if bit
8 set in network configuration register) and has no FCS, alignment or receive symbol errors.
39.5.26.2
Frames Transmitted OK Register
Register Name:
EMAC_FTO
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
FTOK
15
14
13
12
FTOK
7
6
5
4
FTOK
• FTOK: Frames Transmitted OK
A 24-bit register counting the number of frames successfully transmitted, i.e., no underrun and not too many retries.
644
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.26.3
Single Collision Frames Register
Register Name:
EMAC_SCF
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
SCF
7
6
5
4
SCF
• SCF: Single Collision Frames
A 16-bit register counting the number of frames experiencing a single collision before being successfully transmitted, i.e.,
no underrun.
39.5.26.4
Multicollision Frames Register
Register Name:
EMAC_MCF
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
MCF
7
6
5
4
MCF
• MCF: Multicollision Frames
A 16-bit register counting the number of frames experiencing between two and fifteen collisions prior to being successfully
transmitted, i.e., no underrun and not too many retries.
645
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.26.5
Frames Received OK Register
Register Name:
EMAC_FRO
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
FROK
15
14
13
12
FROK
7
6
5
4
FROK
• FROK: Frames Received OK
A 24-bit register counting the number of good frames received, i.e., address recognized and successfully copied to memory. A good frame is of length 64 to 1518 bytes (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration register) and has no FCS,
alignment or receive symbol errors.
39.5.26.6
Frames Check Sequence Errors Register
Register Name:
EMAC_FCSE
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FCSE
• FCSE: Frame Check Sequence Errors
An 8-bit register counting frames that are an integral number of bytes, have bad CRC and are between 64 and 1518 bytes
in length (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration register). This register is also incremented if a symbol error is detected
and the frame is of valid length and has an integral number of bytes.
646
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.26.7
Alignment Errors Register
Register Name:
EMAC_ALE
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ALE
• ALE: Alignment Errors
An 8-bit register counting frames that are not an integral number of bytes long and have bad CRC when their length is truncated to an integral number of bytes and are between 64 and 1518 bytes in length (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration
register). This register is also incremented if a symbol error is detected and the frame is of valid length and does not have
an integral number of bytes.
39.5.26.8
Deferred Transmission Frames Register
Register Name:
EMAC_DTF
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
DTF
7
6
5
4
DTF
• DTF: Deferred Transmission Frames
A 16-bit register counting the number of frames experiencing deferral due to carrier sense being active on their first attempt
at transmission. Frames involved in any collision are not counted nor are frames that experienced a transmit underrun.
647
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.26.9
Late Collisions Register
Register Name:
EMAC_LCOL
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
LCOL
• LCOL: Late Collisions
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames that experience a collision after the slot time (512 bits) has expired. A late
collision is counted twice; i.e., both as a collision and a late collision.
39.5.26.10 Excessive Collisions Register
Register Name:
EMAC_EXCOL
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EXCOL
• EXCOL: Excessive Collisions
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames that failed to be transmitted because they experienced 16 collisions.
648
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.26.11 Transmit Underrun Errors Register
Register Name:
EMAC_TUND
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TUND
• TUND: Transmit Underruns
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames not transmitted due to a transmit DMA underrun. If this register is incremented, then no other statistics register is incremented.
39.5.26.12 Carrier Sense Errors Register
Register Name:
EMAC_CSE
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CSE
• CSE: Carrier Sense Errors
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames transmitted where carrier sense was not seen during transmission or where
carrier sense was deasserted after being asserted in a transmit frame without collision (no underrun). Only incremented in
half-duplex mode. The only effect of a carrier sense error is to increment this register. The behavior of the other statistics
registers is unaffected by the detection of a carrier sense error.
649
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.26.13 Receive Resource Errors Register
Register Name:
EMAC_RRE
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
3
2
1
0
RRE
7
6
5
4
RRE
• RRE: Receive Resource Errors
A 16-bit register counting the number of frames that were address matched but could not be copied to memory because no
receive buffer was available.
39.5.26.14 Receive Overrun Errors Register
Register Name:
EMAC_ROVR
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ROVR
• ROVR: Receive Overrun
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames that are address recognized but were not copied to memory due to a
receive DMA overrun.
650
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.26.15 Receive Symbol Errors Register
Register Name:
EMAC_RSE
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSE
• RSE: Receive Symbol Errors
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames that had rx_er asserted during reception. Receive symbol errors are also
counted as an FCS or alignment error if the frame is between 64 and 1518 bytes in length (1536 if bit 8 is set in the network
configuration register). If the frame is larger, it is recorded as a jabber error.
39.5.26.16 Excessive Length Errors Register
Register Name:
EMAC_ELE
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EXL
• EXL: Excessive Length Errors
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames received exceeding 1518 bytes (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration
register) in length but do not have either a CRC error, an alignment error nor a receive symbol error.
651
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.26.17 Receive Jabbers Register
Register Name:
EMAC_RJA
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RJB
• RJB: Receive Jabbers
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames received exceeding 1518 bytes (1536 if bit 8 set in network configuration
register) in length and have either a CRC error, an alignment error or a receive symbol error.
39.5.26.18 Undersize Frames Register
Register Name:
EMAC_USF
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
USF
• USF: Undersize Frames
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames received less than 64 bytes in length but do not have either a CRC error, an
alignment error or a receive symbol error.
652
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
39.5.26.19 SQE Test Errors Register
Register Name:
EMAC_STE
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SQER
• SQER: SQE Test Errors
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames where ECOL was not asserted within 96 bit times (an interframe gap) of
tx_en being deasserted in half duplex mode.
653
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.5.26.20 Received Length Field Mismatch Register
Register Name:
EMAC_RLE
Access Type:
Read-write
31
–
30
–
29
–
28
–
27
–
26
–
25
–
24
–
23
–
22
–
21
–
20
–
19
–
18
–
17
–
16
–
15
–
14
–
13
–
12
–
11
–
10
–
9
–
8
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RLFM
• RLFM: Receive Length Field Mismatch
An 8-bit register counting the number of frames received that have a measured length shorter than that extracted from its
length field. Checking is enabled through bit 16 of the network configuration register. Frames containing a type ID in bytes
13 and 14 (i.e., length/type ID ≥ 0x0600) are not counted as length field errors, neither are excessive length frames.
654
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
40. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Electrical Characteristics
40.1
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Table 40-1.
Absolute Maximum Ratings*
Operating Temperature (Industrial).........-40° C to + 85° C
Storage Temperature............................-60°C to + 150°C
Voltage on Input Pins
with Respect to Ground...........................-0.3V to + 5.5V
Maximum Operating Voltage
(VDDCORE, and VDDPLL)........................................2.0V
*NOTICE:
Stresses beyond those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to
the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or other conditions beyond those indicated in the operational
sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability.
Maximum Operating Voltage
(VDDIO, VDDIN and VDDFLASH)..............................4.0V
Total DC Output Current on all I/O lines
100-lead LQFP package........................................200 mA
655
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
40.2
DC Characteristics
The following characteristics are applicable to the operating temperature range: TA = -40°C to 85°C, unless otherwise
specified.
Table 40-2.
DC Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
VVDDCORE
DC Supply Core
VVDDPLL
Max
Units
1.65
1.95
V
DC Supply PLL
1.65
1.95
V
VVDDIO
DC Supply I/Os
3.0
3.6
V
VVDDFLASH
DC Supply Flash
3.0
3.6
V
VIL
Input Low-level Voltage
VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
-0.3
0.8
V
VIH
Input High-level Voltage
VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
2.0
5.5
V
IO = 8 mA, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
0.4
V
IO = 0.3 mA, (CMOS) VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
0.1
V
IO = 1.5 mA, VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V
0.2
V
IO = 0.3 mA, (CMOS) VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V
0.1
V
VOL
VOH
ILEAK
IPULLUP
Output Low-level Voltage
Output High-level Voltage
Input Leakage Current
Input Pull-up Current
Conditions
VDDIO - 0.4
V
IO = 0.3 mA, (CMOS) VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
VDDIO - 0.1
V
IO = 1.5 mA, VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V
VDDIO - 0.2
V
IO = 0.3 mA, VVDDIO (CMOS) from 1.65V to 1.95V
VDDIO - 0.1
V
PA0-PA3, Pull-up resistors disabled
(Typ: TA = 25°C, Max: TA = 85°C)
40
400
nA
Other PIOs and NRST, Pull-up resistors disabled
(Typ: TA = 25°C, Max: TA = 85°C)
20
200
nA
PB27-PB30, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V,
PAx connected to ground
10
20.6
60
µA
Other PIOs and NRST, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V,
PAx connected to ground
143
321
600
µA
135
295
550
µA
13.9
pF
Input Pull-down Current,
(TST, ERASE, JTAGSEL)
VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V,
Pins connected to VVDDIO
CIN
Input Capacitance
100 LQFP Package
On VVDDCORE = 1.85V,
MCK = 500Hz
IO
TSLOPE
Static Current
All inputs driven at 1
(AT91SAM7XC512/256/128) (including TMS, TDI, TCK, NRST)
Flash in standby mode
All peripherals off
Output Current
Typ
IO = 8 mA, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
IPULLDOWN
ISC
Min
TA = 25°C
12
60
µA
TA = 85°C
100
400
PA0-PA3, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
16
mA
PB27-PB30 and NRST, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
2
mA
Other PIOs, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
8
mA
Supply Core Slope
6
V/ms
Note that even during startup, VVDDFLASH must always be superior or equal to VVDDCORE.
656
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 40-3.
1.8V Voltage Regulator Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
VVDDIN
Supply Voltage
3.0
3.3
3.6
V
VVDDOUT
Output Voltage
IO = 20 mA
1.81
1.85
1.89
V
IVDDIN
Current consumption
After startup, no load
90
After startup, Idle mode, no load
10
µA
25
µA
TSTART
Startup Time
Cload = 2.2 µF, after VDDIN > 2.7V
150
µS
IO
Maximum DC Output Current
VDDIN = 3.3V
100
mA
IO
Maximum DC Output Current
VDDIN = 3.3V, in Idle Mode
1
mA
Table 40-4.
Brownout Detector Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
VBOT18-
VDDCORE Threshold Level
VHYST18
VDDCORE Hysteresis
VBOT33-
VDDFLASH Threshold Level
VHYST33
VDDFLASH Hysteresis
IDD
Current Consumption
TSTART
Startup Time
Table 40-5.
Typ
Max
Units
1.65
1.68
1.71
V
50
65
mV
2.80
2.90
V
VHYST33 = VBOT33+ - VBOT33-
70
120
mV
BOD on (GPNVM0 bit active)
24
30
µA
1
µA
200
µs
VHYST18 = VBOT18+ - VBOT182.70
100
DC Flash Characteristics AT91SAM7XC512/256/128
Parameter
TPU
Power-up delay
ICC
Min
BOD off (GPNVM0 bit inactive)
Symbol
ISB
Conditions
Conditions
Min
Max
Units
45
µS
@25°C
onto VDDCORE = 1.8V
onto VDDFLASH = 3.3V
10
30
µA
@85°C
onto VDDCORE = 1.8V
onto VDDFLASH = 3.3V
10
120
µA
Random Read @ 30MHz
onto VDDCORE = 1.8V
onto VDDFLASH = 3.3V
3.0
0.8
mA
Write (one bank for AT91SAMX512)
onto VDDCORE = 1.8V
onto VDDFLASH = 3.3V
400
5.5
µA
mA
Standby current
Active current
657
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
40.3
Power Consumption
• Typical power consumption of PLLs, Slow Clock and Main Oscillator.
• Power consumption of power supply in two different modes: Active and ultra Low-power.
• Power consumption by peripheral: calculated as the difference in current measurement after
having enabled then disabled the corresponding clock.
40.3.1
Power Consumption Versus Modes
The values in Table 40-6 and Table 40-7 on page 660 are measured values of the power consumption with operating conditions as follows:
• VDDIO = VDDIN = VDDFLASH= 3.3V
• VDDCORE = VDDPLL = 1.85V
• TA = 25° C
• There is no consumption on the I/Os of the device
Figure 40-1. Measure Schematics
VDDFLASH
VDDIO
VDDIN
3.3V
Voltage
Regulator
AMP1
VDDOUT
AMP2
1.8V
VDDCORE
VDDPLL
658
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
These figures represent the power consumption typically measured on the power supplies..
Table 40-6.
Power Consumption for Different Modes
Mode
Conditions
Active
(AT91SAM7XC512/256/128)
Ultra Low Power(2)
Notes:
Consumption
Unit
Voltage regulator is on.
Brown Out Detector is activated.
Flash is read.
ARM Core clock is 50MHz.
Analog-to-Digital Converter activated.
All peripheral clocks activated.
USB transceiver enabled.
onto AMP1
onto AMP2
50
49
mA
Voltage regulator is in Low-power mode.
Brown Out Detector is de-activated.
Flash is in standby mode.(1)
ARM Core in idle mode.
MCK @ 500Hz.
Analog-to-Digital Converter de-activated.
All peripheral clocks de-activated.
USB transceiver disabled.
DDM and DDP pins connected to ground.
onto AMP1
onto AMP2
26
12
µA
1. “Flash is in standby mode”, means the Flash is not accessed at all.
2. Low power consumption figures stated above cannot be guaranteed when accesing the Flash
in Ultra Low Power mode. In order to meet given low power consumption figures, it is recommended to either stop the processor or jump to SRAM.
659
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
40.3.2
Peripheral Power Consumption in Active Mode
Table 40-7.
Power Consumption on VDDCORE(1)
Peripheral
PIO Controller
12
USART
28
UDP
20
PWM
16
TWI
5
SPI
16
SSC
32
Timer Counter Channels
6
CAN
75
ARM7TDMI
160
EMAC
120
AES
123
TDES
25
System Peripherals
(AT91SAM7XC512/256/128)
200
Note:
40.4
Consumption (Typ)
Unit
µA/MHz
1. Note: VDDCORE = 1.85V, TA = 25° C
Crystal Oscillators Characteristics
40.4.1
RC Oscillator Characteristics
Table 40-8.
RC Oscillator Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Conditions
1/(tCPRC)
RC Oscillator Frequency
VDDPLL = 1.65V
Duty Cycle
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
22
32
42
kHz
45
50
55
%
tST
Startup Time
VDDPLL = 1.65V
75
µs
IOSC
Current Consumption
After Startup Time
1.9
µA
660
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
40.4.2
Main Oscillator Characteristics
Table 40-9.
Main Oscillator Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Conditions
1/(tCPMAIN)
Crystal Oscillator Frequency
CL1, CL2
Internal Load Capacitance (CL1 = CL2)
CL (6)
Equivalent Load Capacitance
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
3
16
20
MHz
Integrated Load Capacitance
((XIN or XOUT))
34
40
46
pF
Integrated Load Capacitance
(XIN and XOUT in series)
17
20
23
pF
30
50
70
%
Duty Cycle
tST
Startup Time
VDDPLL = 1.2 to 2V
CS = 3 pF(1) 1/(tCPMAIN) = 3 MHz
CS = 7 pF(1) 1/(tCPMAIN) = 16 MHz
CS = 7 pF(1) 1/(tCPMAIN) = 20 MHz
IDDST
Standby Current Consumption
Standby mode
1
µA
Drive level
@3 MHz
@8 MHz
@16 MHz
@20 MHz
15
30
50
50
µW
IDD ON
Current dissipation
@3 MHz (2)
@8 MHz (3)
@16 MHz (4)
@20 MHz (5)
250
250
450
550
µA
CLEXT (6)
Maximum external capacitor
on XIN and XOUT
10
pF
PON
Notes:
14.5
1.4
1
150
150
300
400
ms
1. CS is the shunt capacitance.
2. RS = 100-200 Ω; CSHUNT = 2.0 - 2.5 pF; CM = 2 – 1.5 fF (typ, worst case) using 1 K ohm serial resistor on xout.
3. RS = 50-100 Ω;
CSHUNT = 2.0 - 2.5 pF; CM = 4 - 3 fF (typ, worst case).
4. RS = 25-50 Ω; CSHUNT = 2.5 - 3.0 pF; CM = 7 -5 fF (typ, worst case).
5. RS = 20-50 Ω; CSHUNT = 3.2 - 4.0 pF; CM = 10 - 8 fF (typ, worst case).
6. CL and CLEXT →
AT91SAM7XC
CL
XIN
CLEXT
XOUT
CLEXT
661
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
40.4.3
Crystal Characteristics
Table 40-10. Crystal Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Conditions
ESR
Equivalent Series Resistor Rs
Fundamental @3 MHz
Fundamental @8 MHz
Fundamental @16 MHz
Fundamental @20 MHz
CM
CSHUNT
40.4.4
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
200
100
80
50
W
Motional capacitance
8
fF
Shunt capacitance
7
pF
XIN Clock Characteristics
Table 40-11. XIN Clock Electrical Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
1/(tCPXIN)
XIN Clock Frequency
(1)
tCPXIN
XIN Clock Period
(1)
20.0
ns
XIN Clock High Half-period
(1)
8.0
ns
tCLXIN
XIN Clock Low Half-period
(1)
8.0
ns
tCLCH
Rise Time
(1)
400
ns
Fall Time
(1)
400
ns
XIN Input Capacitance
(1)
46
pF
RIN
XIN Pull-down Resistor
(1)
500
kΩ
VXIN_IL
VXIN Input Low-level Voltage
(1)
-0.3
0.2 x VDDPLL
V
VXIN Input High-level Voltage
(1)
0.8 x VDDPLL
1.95
V
Bypass Current Consumption
(1)
15
µW/MHz
tCHXIN
tCHCL
CIN
VXIN_IH
IDDBP
Note:
Conditions
Min
Max
Units
50.0
MHz
1. These characteristics apply only when the Main Oscillator is in bypass mode (i.e., when MOSCEN = 0 and OSCBYPASS = 1
in the CKGR_MOR register, see the Clock Generator Main Oscillator Register.
Figure 40-2. XIN CLock Timing
tCLCH
tCPXIN
tCHXIN
tCHCL
VXIN_IH
VXIN_IL
tCPXIN
tCPXIN
662
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
40.5
PLL Characteristics
Table 40-12. Phase Lock Loop Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Conditions
FOUT
Output Frequency
Field out of CKGR_PLL is:
FIN
Input Frequency
IPLL
Current Consumption
Note:
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
00
80
160
MHz
10
150
200
MHz
1
32
MHz
Active mode
4
mA
Standby mode
1
µA
Startup time depends on PLL RC filter. A calculation tool is provided by Atmel.
663
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
40.6
USB Transceiver Characteristics
40.6.1
Electrical Characteristics
Table 40-13. Electrical Parameters
Symbol
Parameter
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
0.8
V
Input Levels
VIL
Low Level
VIH
High Level
VDI
Differential Input Sensitivity
VCM
Differential Input Common
Mode Range
CIN
Transceiver capacitance
Capacitance to ground on each line
I
Hi-Z State Data Line Leakage
0V < VIN < 3.3V
REXT
Recommended External USB
Series Resistor
In series with each USB pin with ±5%
|(D+) - (D-)|
2.0
V
0.2
V
0.8
-10
2.5
V
9.18
pF
+10
µA
Ω
27
Output Levels
VOL
Low Level Output
Measured with RL of 1.425 kOhm tied
to 3.6V
0.0
0.3
V
VOH
High Level Output
Measured with RL of 14.25 kOhm tied
to GND
2.8
3.6
V
VCRS
Output Signal Crossover
Voltage
Measure conditions described in
Figure 40-3
1.3
2.0
V
105
200
µA
80
150
µA
Typ
Max
Unit
Consumption
IVDDIO
Current Consumption
IVDDCORE
Current Consumption
40.6.2
Transceiver enabled in input mode
DDP=1 and DDM=0
Switching Characteristics
Table 40-14. In Full Speed
Symbol
Parameter
Conditions
tFR
Transition Rise Time
CLOAD = 50 pF
4
20
ns
tFE
Transition Fall Time
CLOAD = 50 pF
4
20
ns
tFRFM
Rise/Fall time Matching
90
111.11
%
664
Min
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 40-3. USB Data Signal Rise and Fall Times
Rise Time
Fall Time
90%
VCRS
10%
Differential
Data Lines
10%
tR
tF
(a)
REXT=27 ohms
Fosc = 6MHz/750kHz
Buffer
Cload
(b)
665
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
40.7
ADC Characteristics
Table 40-15. Channel Conversion Time and ADC Clock
Parameter
Conditions
ADC Clock Frequency
ADC Clock Frequency
Startup Time
Min
Max
Units
10-bit resolution mode
5
MHz
8-bit resolution mode
8
MHz
Return from Idle Mode
20
µs
Track and Hold Acquisition Time
Typ
600
ns
Conversion Time
ADC Clock = 5 MHz
Conversion Time
ADC Clock = 8 MHz
1.25
µs
Throughput Rate
ADC Clock = 5 MHz
384(1)
kSPS
Throughput Rate
ADC Clock = 8 MHz
533(2)
kSPS
Notes:
2
µs
1. Corresponds to 13 clock cycles at 5 MHz: 3 clock cycles for track and hold acquisition time and 10 clock cycles for
conversion.
2. Corresponds to 15 clock cycles at 8 MHz: 5 clock cycles for track and hold acquisition time and 10 clock cycles for
conversion.
Table 40-16. External Voltage Reference Input
Parameter
Conditions
Min
ADVREF Input Voltage Range
ADVREF Input Voltage Range
8-bit resolution mode
ADVREF Average Current
On 13 samples with ADC Clock = 5 MHz
Max
Units
2.6
VDDIN
V
2.5
VDDIN
V
Current Consumption on VDDIN
Typ
200
250
µA
0.55
1
mA
Typ
Max
Units
Table 40-17. Analog Inputs
Parameter
Min
Input Voltage Range
0
VADVREF
Input Leakage Current
1
Input Capacitance
12
µA
14
pF
The user can drive ADC input with impedance up to:
• ZOUT ≤ (SHTIM -470) x 10 in 8-bit resolution mode
• ZOUT ≤ (SHTIM -589) x 7.69 in 10-bit resolution mode
with SHTIM (Sample and Hold Time register) expressed in ns and ZOUT expressed in ohms.
Table 40-18. Transfer Characteristics
Parameter
Conditions
Resolution
Min
Typ
Max
10
Integral Non-linearity
Units
Bit
±2
LSB
±1
LSB
Offset Error
±2
LSB
Gain Error
±2
LSB
Absolute Accuracy
±4
LSB
Differential Non-linearity
No missing code
For more information on data converter terminology, please refer to the application note: Data
Converter Terminology, Atmel lit° 6022.
666
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
40.8
AC Characteristics
40.8.1
Master Clock Characteristics
Table 40-19. Master Clock Waveform Parameters
Symbol
Parameter
Conditions
1/(tCPMCK)
Master Clock Frequency
Min
Max
Units
55
MHz
40.8.2
I/O Characteristics
Criteria used to define the maximum frequency of the I/Os:
• output duty cycle (30%-70%)
• minimum output swing: 100mV to VDDIO - 100 mV
• Addition of rising and falling time inferior to 75% of the period
Table 40-20. I/O Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
FreqMaxI01
Pin Group 1 (1) frequency
PulseminHI01
PulseminLI01
Conditions
Pin Group 1
(1)
Pin Group 1
(1)
High Level Pulse Width
Low Level Pulse Width
FreqMaxI02
Pin Group 2 (2) frequency
PulseminHI02
Pin Group 2 (2) High Level Pulse Width
PulseminLI02
FreqMaxI03
PulseminHI03
PulseminLI03
Notes:
Load: 40 pF(4)
Pin Group 3
(3)
Pin Group 3
(3)
Pin Group 3
(3)
frequency
High Level Pulse Width
Low Level Pulse Width
Max
Units
12.5
MHz
(4)
40
ns
(4)
40
ns
Load: 40 pF
Load: 40 pF
(4)
Load: 40 pF
25
MHz
Load: 20 pF(5)
30
MHz
Load: 40 pF(4)
20
ns
(5)
10
ns
(4)
Load: 40 pF
20
ns
Load: 20 pF(5)
10
ns
Load: 20 pF
Pin Group 2 (2) Low Level Pulse Width
Min
(4)
Load: 40 pF
30
MHz
(4)
16.6
ns
(4)
16.6
ns
Load: 40 pF
Load: 40 pF
1. Pin Group 1 = PB27 to PB30
2. Pin Group 2 = PA4 to PA30 and PB0 to PB30
3. Pin Group 3 = PA0 to PA3
4. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 40pF
5. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 20pF
667
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
40.8.3
SPI Characteristics
Figure 40-4. SPI Master mode with (CPOL = NCPHA =0) or (CPOL = NCPHA =1)
SPCK
SPI0
SPI1
MISO
SPI2
MOSI
Figure 40-5. SPI Master mode with (CPOL=0 and NCPHA=1) or (CPOL=1 and NCPHA=0)
SPCK
SPI3
SPI4
MISO
SPI5
MOSI
Figure 40-6. SPI Slave mode with (CPOL=0 and NCPHA=1) or (CPOL=1 and NCPHA=0)
SPCK
SPI6
MISO
SPI7
SPI8
MOSI
668
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 40-7. SPI Slave mode with (CPOL = NCPHA = 0) or (CPOL= NCPHA= 1)
SPCK
SPI9
MISO
SPI10
SPI11
MOSI
Table 40-21. SPI Timings
Symbol
SPI0
SPI1
SPI2
SPI3
SPI4
Parameter
Conditions
MISO Setup time before SPCK rises (master)
MISO Hold time after SPCK rises (master)
SPCK rising to MOSI Delay (master)
MISO Setup time before SPCK falls (master)
MISO Hold time after SPCK falls (master)
(1)
3.3V domain
(1)
3.3V domain
3.3V domain
(1)
3.3V domain
(1)
3.3V domain
(1)
(1)
Min
Max
(2)
28.5 + (tCPMCK)/2
Units
ns
0
ns
2
(2)
26.5 + (tCPMCK)/2
ns
ns
0
ns
SPI5
SPCK falling to MOSI Delay (master)
3.3V domain
SPI6
SPCK falling to MISO Delay (slave)
3.3V domain (1)
SPI7
MOSI Setup time before SPCK rises (slave)
3.3V domain (1)
2
ns
3.3V domain
(1)
3
ns
3.3V domain
(1)
3.3V domain
(1)
3
ns
3.3V domain
(1)
3
ns
SPI8
SPI9
SPI10
SPI11
Notes:
MOSI Hold time after SPCK rises (slave)
SPCK rising to MISO Delay (slave)
MOSI Setup time before SPCK falls (slave)
MOSI Hold time after SPCK falls (slave)
2
ns
28
ns
28
ns
1. 3.3V domain: VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 40 pF.
2. tCPMCK: Master Clock period in ns.
Note that in SPI master mode the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 does not sample the data (MISO)
on the opposite edge where data clocks out (MOSI) but the same edge is used as shown in Figure 40-4 and Figure 40-5.
669
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
40.8.4
EMAC Characteristics
Table 40-22. EMAC Signals
Symbol
Parameter
Conditions
EMAC1
Setup for EMDIO from EMDC rising
Load: 20pF
EMAC2
Hold for EMDIO from EMDC rising
Load: 20pF(2)
EMAC3
EMDIO toggling from EMDC falling
Load: 20pF(2)
Notes:
Min (ns)
(2)
Max (ns)
2
((1/f)-19) + 4(1)
4.5
1. f: MCK frequency (MHz)
2. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 20 pF
Table 40-23. EMAC MII Specific Signals
Symbol
Parameter
EMAC4
Setup for ECOL from ETXCK rising
Hold for ECOL from ETXCK rising
EMAC5
EMAC6
Setup for ECRS from ETXCK rising
Conditions
Min (ns)
Load: 20pF (1)
0
Load: 20pF
(1)
2
Load: 20pF
(1)
1.5
(1)
2
Max (ns)
EMAC7
Hold for ECRS from ETXCK rising
Load: 20pF
EMAC8
ETXER toggling from ETXCK rising
Load: 20pF (1)
25
EMAC9
ETXEN toggling from ETXCK rising
Load: 20pF (1)
25
Load: 20pF
(1)
25
(1)
0
EMAC10
ETX toggling from ETXCK rising
EMAC11
Setup for ERX from ERXCK
Load: 20pF
EMAC12
Hold for ERX from ERXCK
Load: 20pF (1)
4
Load: 20pF
(1)
0
Load: 20pF
(1)
4
(1)
2
2
EMAC13
EMAC14
Setup for ERXER from ERXCK
Hold for ERXER from ERXCK
EMAC15
Setup for ERXDV from ERXCK
Load: 20pF
EMAC16
Hold for ERXDV from ERXCK
Load: 20pF (1)
Note:
670
1. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 20 pF
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Figure 40-8. EMAC MII Mode
EMDC
EMAC1
EMAC3
EMAC2
EMDIO
EMAC4
EMAC5
EMAC6
EMAC7
ECOL
ECRS
ETXCK
EMAC8
ETXER
EMAC9
ETXEN
EMAC10
ETX[3:0]
ERXCK
EMAC11
EMAC12
ERX[3:0]
EMAC13
EMAC14
EMAC15
EMAC16
ERXER
ERXDV
671
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Table 40-24. EMAC RMII Specific Signals (pertains only to AT91SAM7XC512)
Symbol
Parameter
Min (ns)
Max (ns)
EMAC21
ETXEN toggling from EREFCK rising
4.9
14.2
EMAC22
ETX toggling from EREFCK rising
4.4
15.9
EMAC23
Setup for ERX from EREFCK
0.5
EMAC24
Hold for ERX from EREFCK
0
EMAC25
Setup for ERXER from EREFCK
1.5
EMAC26
Hold for ERXER from EREFCK
0
EMAC27
Setup for ECRSDV from EREFCK
2
EMAC28
Hold for ECRSDV from EREFCK
0
Figure 40-9. EMAC RMII Mode
EREFCK
EMAC21
ETXEN
EMAC22
ETX[1:0]
EMAC23
EMAC24
ERX[1:0]
EMAC25
EMAC26
EMAC27
EMAC28
ERXER
ECRSDV
672
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
40.8.5
Embedded Flash Characteristics
The maximum operating frequency is given in Table 40-25 but it is limited by the Embedded Flash access time when the
processor is fetching code out of it. Table 40-25 give the device maximum operating frequency depending on the field FWS
of the MC_FMR register. This field defines the number of wait states required to access the Embedded Flash Memory.
Table 40-25. Embedded Flash Wait States (AT91SAM7XC256/128)
FWS
Read Operations
Maximum Operating Frequency (MHz)
0
1 cycle
30
1
2 cycles
55
2
3 cycles
55
3
4 cycles
55
Table 40-26. AC Flash Characteristics
Parameter
Conditions
Min
Max
Units
per page including auto-erase
6
ms
per page without auto-erase
3
ms
Program Cycle Time
Full Chip Erase
15
ms
673
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
40.8.6
JTAG/ICE Timings
40.8.6.1
ICE Interface Signals
Table 40-27. ICE Interface Timing Specification
Symbol
Conditions
Min
TCK Low Half-period
(1)
51
ns
TCK High Half-period
(1)
51
ns
ICE2
TCK Period
(1)
102
ns
ICE3
TDI, TMS, Setup before TCK High
(1)
0
ns
ICE4
TDI, TMS, Hold after TCK High
(1)
3
ns
TDO Hold Time
(1)
13
ns
TCK Low to TDO Valid
(1)
ICE0
ICE1
ICE5
ICE6
Note:
Parameter
Max
20
Units
ns
1. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 40pF
Figure 40-10. ICE Interface Signals
ICE2
TCK
ICE0
ICE1
TMS/TDI
ICE3
ICE4
TDO
ICE5
ICE6
674
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
40.8.6.2
JTAG Interface Signals
Table 40-28. JTAG Interface Timing specification
Symbol
JTAG0
JTAG1
JTAG2
JTAG3
JTAG4
JTAG5
JTAG6
JTAG7
JTAG8
JTAG9
JTAG10
Note:
Parameter
Conditions
Min
TCK Low Half-period
(1)
Max
6.5
ns
TCK High Half-period
(1)
5.5
ns
TCK Period
(1)
12
ns
TDI, TMS Setup before TCK High
(1)
2
ns
TDI, TMS Hold after TCK High
(1)
3
ns
TDO Hold Time
(1)
4
ns
TCK Low to TDO Valid
(1)
Device Inputs Setup Time
(1)
0
ns
Device Inputs Hold Time
(1)
3
ns
Device Outputs Hold Time
(1)
6
ns
TCK to Device Outputs Valid
(1)
16
18
Units
ns
ns
1. VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 40pF
Figure 40-11. JTAG Interface Signals
JTAG2
TCK
JTAG
JTAG1
0
TMS/TDI
JTAG3
JTAG4
JTAG7
JTAG8
TDO
JTAG5
JTAG6
Device
Inputs
Device
Outputs
JTAG9
JTAG10
675
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
41. AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Mechanical Characteristics
41.1
Package Drawings
Figure 41-1. LQFP Package Drawing
676
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table 41-1.
100-lead LQFP Package Dimensions
Millimeter
Symbol
Min
Nom
A
Inch
Max
Min
Nom
1.60
A1
0.05
A2
1.35
D
1.40
0.63
0.15
0.002
1.45
0.053
0.006
0.055
16.00 BSC
0.630 BSC
D1
14.00 BSC
0.551 BSC
E
16.00 BSC
0.630 BSC
E1
14.00 BSC
R2
0.08
R1
0.08
Q
0°
0°
13°
0°
12°
12°
11°
L
0.45
L1
0.20
b
0.17
e
3.5°
7°
11°
12°
13°
12°
0°
0.60
13°
11°
0.20
0.004
0.75
0.018
1.00 REF
S
0.008
0.003
7°
11°
0.09
0.003
3.5°
θ1
θ3
0.057
0.551 BSC
0.20
θ2
c
Max
13°
0.008
0.024
0.030
0.039 REF
0.008
0.20
0.27
0.007
0.008
0.50 BSC
0.020 BSC
D2
12.00
0.472
E2
12.00
0.472
0.011
Tolerances of Form and Position
aaa
0.20
0.008
bbb
0.20
0.008
ccc
0.08
0.003
ddd
0.08
0.003
677
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Figure 41-2.
100-TFBGA Package Drawing
All dimensions are in mm
Table 41-2.
Device and LQFP Package Maximum Weight
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128
Table 41-3.
800
mg
Package Reference
JEDEC Drawing Reference
MS-026
JESD97 Classification
e3
Table 41-4.
LQFP Package Characteristics
Moisture Sensitivity Level
3
This package respects the recommendations of the NEMI User Group.
678
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
41.2
Soldering Profile
Table 41-5 gives the recommended soldering profile from J-STD-020C.
Table 41-5.
Soldering Profile
Profile Feature
Green Package
Average Ramp-up Rate (217°C to Peak)
3° C/sec. max.
Preheat Temperature 175°C ±25°C
180 sec. max.
Temperature Maintained Above 217°C
60 sec. to 150 sec.
Time within 5° C of Actual Peak Temperature
20 sec. to 40 sec.
Peak Temperature Range
260° C
Ramp-down Rate
6° C/sec. max.
Time 25° C to Peak Temperature
8 min. max.
Note:
The package is certified to be backward compatible with Pb/Sn soldering profile.
A maximum of three reflow passes is allowed per component.
679
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
42. AT91SAM7XC Ordering Information
Table 42-1.
Ordering Information
Temperature
Operating Range
MLR A Ordering Code
MLR B Ordering Code
Package
Package Type
AT91SAM7XC512-AU
AT91SAM7XC512-CU
–
LQFP 100
TFBGA 100
Green
Industrial
(-40° C to 85° C)
AT91SAM7XC256-AU
AT91SAM7XC256-CU
AT91SAM7XC256B-AU
AT91SAM7XC256B-CU
LQFP 100
TFBGA 100
Green
Industrial
(-40° C to 85° C)
AT91SAM7XC128-AU
AT91SAM7XC128-CU
AT91SAM7XC128B-AU
AT91SAM7XC128B-CU
LQFP 100
TFBGA 100
Green
Industrial
(-40° C to 85° C)
43. Export Regulations Statement
These commodities, technology or software will be exported from France and the applicable
Export Administration Regulations will apply. French, United States and other relevant laws, regulations and requirements regarding the export of products may restrict sale, export and reexport of these products; please assure you conduct your activities in accordance with the applicable relevant export regulations.
680
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
44. Errata
44.1
Marking
All devices are marked with the Atmel logo and the ordering code.
Additional marking has the following format:
YYWW
V
XXXXXXXXX
ARM
where
• “YY”: manufactory year
• “WW”: manufactory week
• “V”: revision
• “XXXXXXXXX”: lot number
681
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
44.2
AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. A Parts
Refer to Section 44.1 “Marking” on page 681.
44.2.1
44.2.1.1
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
ADC: DRDY Bit Cleared
The DRDY Flag should be clear only after a read of ADC_LCDR (Last Converted Data Register). A read of any ADC_CDRx register (Channel Data Register) automatically clears the DRDY
flag.
Problem Fix/Workaround:
None
44.2.1.2
ADC: DRDY not Cleared on Disable
When reading LCDR at the same instant as an end of conversion, with DRDY already active,
DRDY is kept active regardless of the enable status of the current channel. This sets DRDY,
whereas new data is not stored.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.2.1.3
ADC: DRDY Possibly Skipped due to CDR Read
Reading CDR for channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x" with
EOC[x] already active, leads to skipping to set the DRDY flag if channel "x" is enabled.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Use of DRDY functionality with access to CDR registers should be avoided.
44.2.1.4
ADC: Possible Skip on DRDY when Disabling a Channel
DRDY does not rise when disabling channel "y" at the same time as an end of "x" channel conversion, although data is stored into CDRx and LCDR.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.2.1.5
ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Updated
Read of the Status Register at the same instant as an end of conversion leads to skipping the
update of the GOVRE (general overrun) flag. GOVRE is neither reset nor set.
For example, if reading the status while an end of conversion is occurring and:
1. GOVRE is active but DRDY is inactive, does not correspond to a new general overrun
condition but the GOVRE flag is not reset.
2. GOVRE is inactive but DRDY is active, does correspond to a new general overrun condition but the GOVRE flag is not set.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.2.1.6
ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Reading CDR
When reading CDRy (Channel Data Register y) at the same instant as an end of conversion on
channel "x" with the following conditions:
• EOC[x] already active,
682
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• DRDY already active,
• GOVRE inactive,
• previous data stored in LCDR being neither data from channel "y", nor data from channel "x".
GOVRE should be set but is not.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.2.1.7
ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Disabling a Channel
When disabling channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x", EOC[x]
and DRDY being already active, GOVRE does not rise.
Note:
OVRE[x] rises as expected.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.2.1.8
ADC: OVRE Flag Behavior
When the OVRE flag (on channel i) has been set but the related EOC status (of channel i) has
been cleared (by a read of CDRi or LCDR), reading the Status register at the same instant as an
end of conversion (causing the set of EOC status on channel i), does not lead to a reset of the
OVRE flag (on channel i) as expected.
Problem Fix/Workaround:
None
44.2.1.9
ADC: EOC Set although Channel Disabled
If a channel is disabled while a conversion is running and if a read of CDR is performed at the
same time as an end of conversion of any channel occurs, the EOC of the channel with the conversion running may rise (whereas it has been disabled).
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not take into account the EOC of a disabled channel
44.2.1.10
ADC: Spurious Clear of EOC Flag
If "x" and "y" are two successively converted channels and "z" is yet another enabled channel
("z" being neither "x" nor "y"), reading CDR on channel "z" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "y" automatically clears EOC[x] instead of EOC[z].
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.2.1.11
ADC: Sleep Mode
If Sleep mode is activated while there is no activity (no conversion is being performed), it will
take effect only after a conversion occurs.
Problem Fix/Workaround
To activate sleep mode as soon as possible, it is recommended to write successively, ADC
Mode Register (SLEEP) then ADC Control Register (START bit field); to start an analog-to-digital conversion, in order put ADC into sleep mode at the end of this conversion.
683
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
44.2.2
44.2.2.1
Controller Area Network (CAN)
CAN: Low Power Mode and Error Frame
If the Low Power Mode is activated while the CAN is generating an error frame, this error frame
may be shortened.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.2.2.2
CAN: Low Power Mode and Pending Transmit Messages
No pending transmit messages may be sent once the CAN Controller enters Low-power Mode.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Check that all messages have been sent by reading the related Flags before entering Lowpower Mode.
44.2.3
44.2.3.1
Ethernet MAC (EMAC)
EMAC: RMII Mode
RMII mode is not functional.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.2.3.2
EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading EMAC_ISR
If an event occurs within the same clock cycle in which the EMAC_ISR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared even though it has not been read at 1. This might lead to the loss of this
event.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Each time the software reads EMAC_ISR, it has to check the contents of the Transmit Status
Register (EMAC_TSR), the Receive Status Register (EMAC_RSR) and the Network Status
Register (EMAC_NSR), as the possible lost event is still notified in one of these registers.
44.2.3.3
EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading the Statistics Register Block
If an event occurs within the same clock cycle during which a statistics register is read, the corresponding counter might lose this event. This might lead to the loss of the incrementation of
one for this counter.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.2.4
44.2.4.1
Peripheral Input/Output (PIO)
PIO: Leakage on PB27 - PB30
When PB27, PB28, PB29 or PB30 (the I/O lines multiplexed with the analog inputs) are set as
digital inputs with pull-up disabled, the leakage can be 9 µA in worst case and 90 nA in typical
case per I/O when the I/O is set externally at low level.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Set the I/O to VDDIO by internal or external pull-up.
684
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
44.2.4.2
PIO: Electrical Characteristics on NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26
When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, the voltage of the I/O stabilizes at VPull-up.
Vpull-up
VPull-up Min
VPull-up Max
VDDIO - 0.65 V
VDDIO - 0.45 V
This condition causes a leakage through VDDIO. This leakage is 45 µA per pad in worst case at
3.3 V.
I Leakage
Parameter
Typ
Max
I Leakage at 3,3V
2.5 µA
45 µA
Problem Fix/Workaround
It is recommended to use an external pull-up if needed.
44.2.4.3
PIO: Drive Low NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26
When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, driving
the I/O with an output impedance higher than 500 ohms may not drive the I/O to a logical zero.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Output impedance must be lower than 500 ohms.
44.2.5
44.2.5.1
Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM)
PWM: Update when PWM_CCNTx = 0 or 1
If the Channel Counter Register value is 0 or 1, the Channel Period Register or Channel Duty
Cycle Register is directly modified when writing the Channel Update Register.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Check the Channel Counter Register before writing the update register.
44.2.5.2
PWM: Update when PWM_CPRDx = 0
When Channel Period Register equals 0, the period update is not operational.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not write 0 in the period register.
44.2.5.3
PWM: Counter Start Value
In left aligned mode, the first start value of the counter is 0. For the other periods, the counter
starts at 1.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.2.5.4
PWM: Behavior of CHIDx Status Bits in the PWM_SR Register
Erratic behavior of the CHIDx status bit in the PWM_SR Register. When a channel is disabled
by writing in the PWM_DIS Register just after enabling it (before completion of a Clock Period of
685
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
the clock selected for the channel), the PWM line is internally disabled but the CHIDx status bit
in the PWM_SR stays at 1.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not disable a channel before completion of one period of the selected clock.
44.2.6
44.2.6.1
Real Time Timer (RTT)
RTT: Possible Event Loss when Reading RTT_SR
If an event (RTTINC or ALMS) occurs within the same slow clock cycle during which the
RTT_SR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared. This can lead to the loss of this event.
Problem Fix/Workaround:
The software must handle the RTT event as an interrupt and should not poll RTT_SR.
44.2.7
44.2.7.1
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
SPI: Bad tx_ready Behavior when CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1
If the SPI2 is programmed with CSAAT = 1, SCBR(baudrate) = 1 and two transfers are performed consecutively on the same slave with an IDLE state between them, the tx_ready signal
does not rise after the second data has been transferred in the shifter. This can imply for example, that the second data is sent twice.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not use the combination CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1.
44.2.7.2
SPI: LASTXFER (Last Transfer) Behavior
In FIXED Mode, with CSAAT bit set, and in “PDC mode” the Chip Select can rise depending on
the data written in the SPI_TDR when the TX_EMPTY flag is set. If for example, the PDC writes
a “1” in the bit 24 (LASTXFER bit) of the SPI_TDR, the chip select will rise as soon as the
TXEMPTY flag is set.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Use the CS in PIO mode when PDC mode is required and CS has to be maintained between
transfers.
44.2.7.3
SPI: SPCK Behavior in Master Mode
SPCK pin can toggle out before the first transfer in Master Mode.
Problem Fix/Workaround
In Master Mode, MSTR bit must be set (in SPI_MR register) before configuring SPI_CSRx
registers.
44.2.7.4
SPI: Chip Select and Fixed Mode
In fixed Mode, if a transfer is performed through a PDC on a Chip select different from the Chip
select 0, the output spi_size sampled by the PDC will depend on the field, BITS (Bits per Transfer) of SPI_CSR0 register, whatever the selected Chip select is. For example, if SPI_CSR0 is
configured for a 10-bit transfer whereas SPI_CSR1 is configured for an 8-bit transfer, when a
transfer is performed in Fixed mode through the PDC, on Chip select 1, the transfer will be considered as a HalfWord transfer.
Problem Fix/Workaround
686
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
If a PDC transfer has to be performed in 8 bits, on a Chip select y (y as different from 0), the
BITS field of the SPI_CSR0 must be configured in 8 bits, in the same way as the BITS field of
the CSRy Register.
44.2.7.5
SPI: Baudrate Set to 1
When Baudrate is set at 1 (i.e. when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency)
and when the BITS field of the SPI_CSR register (number of bits to be transmitted) equals an
ODD value (in this case 9,11,13 or 15), an additional pulse will be generated on output SPCK.
Everything is OK if the BITS field equals 8,10,12,14 or 16 and Baudrate = 1.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.2.7.6
SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select
Bad Serial clock generation on the 2nd chip select when SCBR = 1, CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0.
This occurs using SPI with the following conditions:
• Master Mode
• CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0
• Multiple chip selects are used with one transfer with Baud rate (SCBR) equal to 1 (i.e., when
serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and the other transfers set with
SCBR are not equal to 1
• Transmitting with the slowest chip select and then with the fastest one, then an additional
pulse is generated on output SPCK during the second transfer.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not use a multiple Chip Select configuration where at least one SCRx register is configured
with SCBR = 1 and the others differ from 1 if NCPHA = 0 and CPOL = 1.
If all chip selects are configured with Baudrate = 1, the issue does not appear.
44.2.8
44.2.8.1
Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC)
SSC: Periodic Transmission Limitations in Master Mode
If the Least Significant Bit is sent first (MSBF = 0), the first TAG during the frame synchro is not
sent.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.2.8.2
SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode
If TK is programmed as output and TF is programmed as input, it is impossible to emit data
when the start of edge (rising or falling) of synchro has a Start Delay equal to zero.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.2.8.3
SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode
If TK is programmed as an input and TF is programmed as an output and requested to be set to
low/high during data emission, the Frame Synchro signal is generated one bit clock period after
687
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
the data start and one data bit is lost. This problem does not exist when generating a periodic
synchro.
Problem Fix/Workaround
The data need to be delayed for one bit clock period with an external assembly. In the following
schematic, TD, TK and NRST are AT91SAM7XC signals, TXD is the delayed data to connect to
the device.
44.2.9
44.2.9.1
Two-wire Interface (TWI)
TWI: Clock Divider
The value of CLDIV x 2CKDIV must be less than or equal to 8191, the value of CHDIV x 2CKDIV
must be less than or equal to 8191⋅
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.2.9.2
TWI: Disabling Does not Operate Correctly
Any transfer in progress is immediately frozen if the Control Register (TWI_CR) is written with
the bit MSDIS at 1. Furthermore, the status bits TXCOMP and TXRDY in the Status Register
(TWI_SR) are not reset.
Problem Fix/Workaround
The user must wait for the end of transfer before disabling the TWI. In addition, the interrupts
must be disabled before disabling the TWI.
44.2.9.3
TWI: NACK Status Bit Lost
During a master frame, if TWI_SR is read between the Non Acknowledge condition detection
and the TXCOMP bit rising in the TWI_SR, the NACK bit is not set.
Problem Fix/Workaround
688
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
The user must wait for the TXCOMP status bit by interrupt and must not read the TWI_SR as
long as transmission is not completed.
TXCOMP and NACK fields are set simultaneously and the NACK field is reset after the read of
the TWI_SR.
44.2.9.4
TWI: Possible Receive Holding Register Corruption
When loading the TWI_RHR, the transfer direction is ignored. The last data byte received in the
TWI_RHR is corrupted at the end of the first subsequent transmit data byte. Neither RXRDY nor
OVERRUN status bits are set if this occurs.
Problem Fix/Workaround
The user must be sure that received data is read before transmitting any new data.
44.2.9.5
TWI: Software Reset
when a software reset is performed during a frame and when TWCK is low, it is impossible to initiate a new transfer in READ or WRITE mode.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.2.10
44.2.10.1
Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART)
USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking
When Hardware Handshaking is used and if CTS goes low near the end of the start bit, a character can be lost.
CTS must not go high during a time slot occurring between 2 Master Clock periods before and
16 Master Clock periods after the rising edge of the start bit.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.2.10.2
USART: Hardware Handshaking – Two Characters Sent
If CTS switches from 0 to 1 during the TX of a character and if the holding register (US_THR) is
not empty, the content of US_THR will also be transmitted.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Don't use the PDC in transmit mode and do not fill US_THR before TXEMPTY is set at 1.
44.2.10.3
USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode
When timeguard is 0, RXBRK is not set when the break character is located just after the Stop
bit. FRAME (Frame Error) is set instead.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Timeguard should be > 0.
44.2.10.4
USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low.
The DCD signal is active at High level in the USART Modem Mode .
DCD should be active at Low level.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Add an inverter
689
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
44.3
AT91SAM7XC512 Errata - Rev. A Parts
Refer to Section 44.1 “Marking” on page 681.
44.3.1
44.3.1.1
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
ADC: DRDY Bit Cleared
The DRDY Flag should be clear only after a read of ADC_LCDR (Last Converted Data Register). A read of any ADC_CDRx register (Channel Data Register) automatically clears the DRDY
flag.
Problem Fix/Workaround:
None
44.3.1.2
ADC: DRDY not Cleared on Disable
When reading LCDR at the same instant as an end of conversion, with DRDY already active,
DRDY is kept active regardless of the enable status of the current channel. This sets DRDY,
whereas new data is not stored.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.3.1.3
ADC: DRDY Possibly Skipped due to CDR Read
Reading CDR for channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x" with
EOC[x] already active, leads to skipping to set the DRDY flag if channel "x" is enabled.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Use of DRDY functionality with access to CDR registers should be avoided.
44.3.1.4
ADC: Possible Skip on DRDY when Disabling a Channel
DRDY does not rise when disabling channel "y" at the same time as an end of "x" channel conversion, although data is stored into CDRx and LCDR.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.3.1.5
ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Updated
Read of the Status Register at the same instant as an end of conversion leads to skipping the
update of the GOVRE (general overrun) flag. GOVRE is neither reset nor set.
For example, if reading the status while an end of conversion is occurring and:
1. GOVRE is active but DRDY is inactive, does not correspond to a new general overrun
condition but the GOVRE flag is not reset.
2. GOVRE is inactive but DRDY is active, does correspond to a new general overrun condition but the GOVRE flag is not set.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.3.1.6
ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Reading CDR
When reading CDRy (Channel Data Register y) at the same instant as an end of conversion on
channel "x" with the following conditions:
• EOC[x] already active,
690
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
• DRDY already active,
• GOVRE inactive,
• previous data stored in LCDR being neither data from channel "y", nor data from channel "x".
GOVRE should be set but is not.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.3.1.7
ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Disabling a Channel
When disabling channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x", EOC[x]
and DRDY being already active, GOVRE does not rise.
Note:
OVRE[x] rises as expected.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.3.1.8
ADC: OVRE Flag Behavior
When the OVRE flag (on channel i) has been set but the related EOC status (of channel i) has
been cleared (by a read of CDRi or LCDR), reading the Status register at the same instant as an
end of conversion (causing the set of EOC status on channel i), does not lead to a reset of the
OVRE flag (on channel i) as expected.
Problem Fix/Workaround:
None
44.3.1.9
ADC: EOC Set although Channel Disabled
If a channel is disabled while a conversion is running and if a read of CDR is performed at the
same time as an end of conversion of any channel occurs, the EOC of the channel with the conversion running may rise (whereas it has been disabled).
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not take into account the EOC of a disabled channel
44.3.1.10
ADC: Spurious Clear of EOC Flag
If "x" and "y" are two successively converted channels and "z" is yet another enabled channel
("z" being neither "x" nor "y"), reading CDR on channel "z" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "y" automatically clears EOC[x] instead of EOC[z].
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.3.1.11
ADC: Sleep Mode
If Sleep mode is activated while there is no activity (no conversion is being performed), it will
take effect only after a conversion occurs.
Problem Fix/Workaround
To activate sleep mode as soon as possible, it is recommended to write successively, ADC
Mode Register (SLEEP) then ADC Control Register (START bit field); to start an analog-to-digital conversion, in order put ADC into sleep mode at the end of this conversion.
691
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
44.3.2
44.3.2.1
Controller Area Network (CAN)
CAN: Low Power Mode and Error Frame
If the Low Power Mode is activated while the CAN is generating an error frame, this error frame
may be shortened.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.3.2.2
CAN: Low Power Mode and Pending Transmit Messages
No pending transmit messages may be sent once the CAN Controller enters Low-power Mode.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Check that all messages have been sent by reading the related Flags before entering Lowpower Mode.
44.3.3
44.3.3.1
Embedded FLash Controller (EFC)
EFC: Embedded Flash Access Time
The embedded Flash maximum access time is 25 MJHz (instead of 30MHz)at zero Wait State
(FWS = 0).
The maximum operating frequency with one Wait State (FWS = 1) is still 55 MHz.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Set one Wait State (FWS = 1) if the frequency is above 25 MHz.
44.3.4
44.3.4.1
Ethernet MAC (EMAC)
EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading EMAC_ISR
If an event occurs within the same clock cycle in which the EMAC_ISR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared even though it has not been read at 1. This might lead to the loss of this
event.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Each time the software reads EMAC_ISR, it has to check the contents of the Transmit Status
Register (EMAC_TSR), the Receive Status Register (EMAC_RSR) and the Network Status
Register (EMAC_NSR), as the possible lost event is still notified in one of these registers.
44.3.4.2
EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading the Statistics Register Block
If an event occurs within the same clock cycle during which a statistics register is read, the corresponding counter might lose this event. This might lead to the loss of the incrementation of
one for this counter.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.3.5
44.3.5.1
692
Peripheral Input/Output (PIO)
PIO: Leakage on PB27 - PB30
When PB27, PB28, PB29 or PB30 (the I/O lines multiplexed with the analog inputs) are set as
digital inputs with pull-up disabled, the leakage can be 9 µA in worst case and 90 nA in typical
case per I/O when the I/O is set externally at low level.
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Problem Fix/Workaround
Set the I/O to VDDIO by internal or external pull-up.
44.3.5.2
PIO: Electrical Characteristics on NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26
When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, the voltage of the I/O stabilizes at VPull-up.
Vpull-up
VPull-up Min
VPull-up Max
VDDIO - 0.65 V
VDDIO - 0.45 V
This condition causes a leakage through VDDIO. This leakage is 45 µA per pad in worst case at
3.3 V.
I Leakage
Parameter
Typ
Max
I Leakage at 3,3V
2.5 µA
45 µA
Problem Fix/Workaround
It is recommended to use an external pull-up if needed.
44.3.5.3
PIO: Drive Low NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26
When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, driving
the I/O with an output impedance higher than 500 ohms may not drive the I/O to a logical zero.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Output impedance must be lower than 500 ohms.
44.3.6
44.3.6.1
Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM)
PWM: Update when PWM_CCNTx = 0 or 1
If the Channel Counter Register value is 0 or 1, the Channel Period Register or Channel Duty
Cycle Register is directly modified when writing the Channel Update Register.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Check the Channel Counter Register before writing the update register.
44.3.6.2
PWM: Update when PWM_CPRDx = 0
When Channel Period Register equals 0, the period update is not operational.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not write 0 in the period register.
44.3.6.3
PWM: Counter Start Value
In left aligned mode, the first start value of the counter is 0. For the other periods, the counter
starts at 1.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
693
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
44.3.6.4
PWM: Behavior of CHIDx Status Bits in the PWM_SR Register
Erratic behavior of the CHIDx status bit in the PWM_SR Register. When a channel is disabled
by writing in the PWM_DIS Register just after enabling it (before completion of a Clock Period of
the clock selected for the channel), the PWM line is internally disabled but the CHIDx status bit
in the PWM_SR stays at 1.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not disable a channel before completion of one period of the selected clock.
44.3.7
44.3.7.1
Real Time Timer (RTT)
RTT: Possible Event Loss when Reading RTT_SR
If an event (RTTINC or ALMS) occurs within the same slow clock cycle during which the
RTT_SR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared. This can lead to the loss of this event.
Problem Fix/Workaround:
The software must handle the RTT event as an interrupt and should not poll RTT_SR.
44.3.8
44.3.8.1
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
SPI: Bad tx_ready Behavior when CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1
If the SPI2 is programmed with CSAAT = 1, SCBR(baudrate) = 1 and two transfers are performed consecutively on the same slave with an IDLE state between them, the tx_ready signal
does not rise after the second data has been transferred in the shifter. This can imply for example, that the second data is sent twice.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not use the combination CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1.
44.3.8.2
SPI: LASTXFER (Last Transfer) Behavior
In FIXED Mode, with CSAAT bit set, and in “PDC mode” the Chip Select can rise depending on
the data written in the SPI_TDR when the TX_EMPTY flag is set. If for example, the PDC writes
a “1” in the bit 24 (LASTXFER bit) of the SPI_TDR, the chip select will rise as soon as the
TXEMPTY flag is set.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Use the CS in PIO mode when PDC mode is required and CS has to be maintained between
transfers.
44.3.8.3
SPI: SPCK Behavior in Master Mode
SPCK pin can toggle out before the first transfer in Master Mode.
Problem Fix/Workaround
In Master Mode, MSTR bit must be set (in SPI_MR register) before configuring SPI_CSRx
registers.
44.3.8.4
694
SPI: Chip Select and Fixed Mode
In fixed Mode, if a transfer is performed through a PDC on a Chip select different from the Chip
select 0, the output spi_size sampled by the PDC will depend on the field, BITS (Bits per Transfer) of SPI_CSR0 register, whatever the selected Chip select is. For example, if SPI_CSR0 is
configured for a 10-bit transfer whereas SPI_CSR1 is configured for an 8-bit transfer, when a
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
transfer is performed in Fixed mode through the PDC, on Chip select 1, the transfer will be considered as a HalfWord transfer.
Problem Fix/Workaround
If a PDC transfer has to be performed in 8 bits, on a Chip select y (y as different from 0), the
BITS field of the SPI_CSR0 must be configured in 8 bits, in the same way as the BITS field of
the CSRy Register.
44.3.8.5
SPI: Baudrate Set to 1
When Baudrate is set at 1 (i.e. when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency)
and when the BITS field of the SPI_CSR register (number of bits to be transmitted) equals an
ODD value (in this case 9,11,13 or 15), an additional pulse will be generated on output SPCK.
Everything is OK if the BITS field equals 8,10,12,14 or 16 and Baudrate = 1.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.3.8.6
SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select
Bad Serial clock generation on the 2nd chip select when SCBR = 1, CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0.
This occurs using SPI with the following conditions:
• Master Mode
• CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0
• Multiple chip selects are used with one transfer with Baud rate (SCBR) equal to 1 (i.e., when
serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and the other transfers set with
SCBR are not equal to 1
• Transmitting with the slowest chip select and then with the fastest one, then an additional
pulse is generated on output SPCK during the second transfer.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not use a multiple Chip Select configuration where at least one SCRx register is configured
with SCBR = 1 and the others differ from 1 if NCPHA = 0 and CPOL = 1.
If all chip selects are configured with Baudrate = 1, the issue does not appear.
44.3.8.7
SPI: Software Reset must be Written Twice
If a software reset (SWRST in the SPI Control Register) is performed, the SPI may not work
properly (the clock is enabled before the chip select.)
Problem Fix/Workaround
The SPI Control Register field, SWRST (Software Reset) needs to be written twice to be correctly set.
44.3.9
44.3.9.1
Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC)
SSC: Periodic Transmission Limitations in Master Mode
If the Least Significant Bit is sent first (MSBF = 0), the first TAG during the frame synchro is not
sent.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
695
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
44.3.9.2
SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode
If TK is programmed as output and TF is programmed as input, it is impossible to emit data
when the start of edge (rising or falling) of synchro has a Start Delay equal to zero.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.3.9.3
SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode
If TK is programmed as an input and TF is programmed as an output and requested to be set to
low/high during data emission, the Frame Synchro signal is generated one bit clock period after
the data start and one data bit is lost. This problem does not exist when generating a periodic
synchro.
Problem Fix/Workaround
The data need to be delayed for one bit clock period with an external assembly. In the following
schematic, TD, TK and NRST are AT91SAM7XC signals, TXD is the delayed data to connect to
the device.
44.3.10
44.3.10.1
Two-wire Interface (TWI)
TWI: Clock Divider
The value of CLDIV x 2CKDIV must be less than or equal to 8191, the value of CHDIV x 2CKDIV
must be less than or equal to 8191⋅
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.3.10.2
TWI: Disabling Does not Operate Correctly
Any transfer in progress is immediately frozen if the Control Register (TWI_CR) is written with
the bit MSDIS at 1. Furthermore, the status bits TXCOMP and TXRDY in the Status Register
(TWI_SR) are not reset.
Problem Fix/Workaround
696
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
The user must wait for the end of transfer before disabling the TWI. In addition, the interrupts
must be disabled before disabling the TWI.
44.3.10.3
TWI: NACK Status Bit Lost
During a master frame, if TWI_SR is read between the Non Acknowledge condition detection
and the TXCOMP bit rising in the TWI_SR, the NACK bit is not set.
Problem Fix/Workaround
The user must wait for the TXCOMP status bit by interrupt and must not read the TWI_SR as
long as transmission is not completed.
TXCOMP and NACK fields are set simultaneously and the NACK field is reset after the read of
the TWI_SR.
44.3.10.4
TWI: Possible Receive Holding Register Corruption
When loading the TWI_RHR, the transfer direction is ignored. The last data byte received in the
TWI_RHR is corrupted at the end of the first subsequent transmit data byte. Neither RXRDY nor
OVERRUN status bits are set if this occurs.
Problem Fix/Workaround
The user must be sure that received data is read before transmitting any new data.
44.3.10.5
TWI: Software Reset
when a software reset is performed during a frame and when TWCK is low, it is impossible to initiate a new transfer in READ or WRITE mode.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.3.11
44.3.11.1
Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART)
USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking
When Hardware Handshaking is used and if CTS goes low close to the end of the starting bit, a
character can be lost.
Problem Fix/Workaround
CTS must not go low during a time slot occurring between 2 Master Clock periods before the
starting bit and 16 Master Clock periods after the rising edge of the starting bit.
44.3.11.2
USART: Hardware Handshaking – Two Characters Sent
If CTS switches from 0 to 1 during the TX of a character and if the holding register (US_THR) is
not empty, the content of US_THR will also be transmitted.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Don't use the PDC in transmit mode and do not fill US_THR before TXEMPTY is set at 1.
44.3.11.3
USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode
When timeguard is 0, RXBRK is not set when the break character is located just after the Stop
bit. FRAME (Frame Error) is set instead.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Timeguard should be > 0.
697
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
44.3.11.4
USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low.
The DCD signal is active at High level in the USART Modem Mode .
DCD should be active at Low level.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Add an inverter.
698
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
44.4
AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. B Parts
Refer to Section 44.1 “Marking” on page 681.
44.4.1
44.4.1.1
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
ADC: DRDY Bit Cleared
The DRDY Flag should be clear only after a read of ADC_LCDR (Last Converted Data Register). A read of any ADC_CDRx register (Channel Data Register) automatically clears the DRDY
flag.
Problem Fix/Workaround:
None
44.4.1.2
ADC: DRDY not Cleared on Disable
When reading LCDR at the same instant as an end of conversion, with DRDY already active,
DRDY is kept active regardless of the enable status of the current channel. This sets DRDY,
whereas new data is not stored.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.4.1.3
ADC: DRDY Possibly Skipped due to CDR Read
Reading CDR for channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x" with
EOC[x] already active, leads to skipping to set the DRDY flag if channel "x" is enabled.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Use of DRDY functionality with access to CDR registers should be avoided.
44.4.1.4
ADC: Possible Skip on DRDY when Disabling a Channel
DRDY does not rise when disabling channel "y" at the same time as an end of "x" channel conversion, although data is stored into CDRx and LCDR.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.4.1.5
ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Updated
Read of the Status Register at the same instant as an end of conversion leads to skipping the
update of the GOVRE (general overrun) flag. GOVRE is neither reset nor set.
For example, if reading the status while an end of conversion is occurring and:
1. GOVRE is active but DRDY is inactive, does not correspond to a new general overrun
condition but the GOVRE flag is not reset.
2. GOVRE is inactive but DRDY is active, does correspond to a new general overrun condition but the GOVRE flag is not set.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.4.1.6
ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Reading CDR
When reading CDRy (Channel Data Register y) at the same instant as an end of conversion on
channel "x" with the following conditions:
• EOC[x] already active,
699
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
• DRDY already active,
• GOVRE inactive,
• previous data stored in LCDR being neither data from channel "y", nor data from channel "x".
GOVRE should be set but is not.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.4.1.7
ADC: GOVRE Bit is not Set when Disabling a Channel
When disabling channel "y" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "x", EOC[x]
and DRDY being already active, GOVRE does not rise.
Note:
OVRE[x] rises as expected.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.4.1.8
ADC: OVRE Flag Behavior
When the OVRE flag (on channel i) has been set but the related EOC status (of channel i) has
been cleared (by a read of CDRi or LCDR), reading the Status register at the same instant as an
end of conversion (causing the set of EOC status on channel i), does not lead to a reset of the
OVRE flag (on channel i) as expected.
Problem Fix/Workaround:
None
44.4.1.9
ADC: EOC Set although Channel Disabled
If a channel is disabled while a conversion is running and if a read of CDR is performed at the
same time as an end of conversion of any channel occurs, the EOC of the channel with the conversion running may rise (whereas it has been disabled).
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not take into account the EOC of a disabled channel
44.4.1.10
ADC: Spurious Clear of EOC Flag
If "x" and "y" are two successively converted channels and "z" is yet another enabled channel
("z" being neither "x" nor "y"), reading CDR on channel "z" at the same instant as an end of conversion on channel "y" automatically clears EOC[x] instead of EOC[z].
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.4.1.11
ADC: Sleep Mode
If Sleep mode is activated while there is no activity (no conversion is being performed), it will
take effect only after a conversion occurs.
Problem Fix/Workaround
To activate sleep mode as soon as possible, it is recommended to write successively, ADC
Mode Register (SLEEP) then ADC Control Register (START bit field); to start an analog-to-digital conversion, in order put ADC into sleep mode at the end of this conversion.
700
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
44.4.2
44.4.2.1
Controller Area Network (CAN)
CAN: Low Power Mode and Error Frame
If the Low Power Mode is activated while the CAN is generating an error frame, this error frame
may be shortened.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.4.2.2
CAN: Low Power Mode and Pending Transmit Messages
No pending transmit messages may be sent once the CAN Controller enters Low-power Mode.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Check that all messages have been sent by reading the related Flags before entering Lowpower Mode.
44.4.3
44.4.3.1
Ethernet MAC (EMAC)
EMAC: RMII Mode
RMII mode is not functional.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
44.4.3.2
EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading EMAC_ISR
If an event occurs within the same clock cycle in which the EMAC_ISR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared even though it has not been read at 1. This might lead to the loss of this
event.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Each time the software reads EMAC_ISR, it has to check the contents of the Transmit Status
Register (EMAC_TSR), the Receive Status Register (EMAC_RSR) and the Network Status
Register (EMAC_NSR), as the possible lost event is still notified in one of these registers.
44.4.3.3
EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading the Statistics Register Block
If an event occurs within the same clock cycle during which a statistics register is read, the corresponding counter might lose this event. This might lead to the loss of the incrementation of
one for this counter.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
701
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
44.4.4
44.4.4.1
Peripheral Input/Output (PIO)
PIO: Electrical Characteristics on NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26
When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, the voltage of the I/O stabilizes at VPull-up.
Vpull-up
VPull-up Min
VPull-up Max
VDDIO - 0.65 V
VDDIO - 0.45 V
This condition causes a leakage through VDDIO. This leakage is 45 µA per pad in worst case at
3.3 V.
I Leakage
Parameter
Typ
Max
I Leakage at 3,3V
2.5 µA
45 µA
Problem Fix/Workaround
It is recommended to use an external pull-up if needed.
44.4.4.2
PIO: Drive Low NRST, PA0-PA30 and PB0-PB26
When NRST or PA0 - PA30 or PB0 - PB26 are set as digital inputs with pull-up enabled, driving
the I/O with an output impedance higher than 500 ohms may not drive the I/O to a logical zero.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Output impedance must be lower than 500 ohms.
44.4.5
44.4.5.1
Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM)
PWM: Update when PWM_CCNTx = 0 or 1
If the Channel Counter Register value is 0 or 1, the Channel Period Register or Channel Duty
Cycle Register is directly modified when writing the Channel Update Register.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Check the Channel Counter Register before writing the update register.
44.4.5.2
PWM: Update when PWM_CPRDx = 0
When Channel Period Register equals 0, the period update is not operational.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not write 0 in the period register.
44.4.5.3
PWM: Counter Start Value
In left aligned mode, the first start value of the counter is 0. For the other periods, the counter
starts at 1.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
702
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
44.4.5.4
PWM: Behavior of CHIDx Status Bits in the PWM_SR Register
Erratic behavior of the CHIDx status bit in the PWM_SR Register. When a channel is disabled
by writing in the PWM_DIS Register just after enabling it (before completion of a Clock Period of
the clock selected for the channel), the PWM line is internally disabled but the CHIDx status bit
in the PWM_SR stays at 1.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not disable a channel before completion of one period of the selected clock.
44.4.6
44.4.6.1
Real Time Timer (RTT)
RTT: Possible Event Loss when Reading RTT_SR
If an event (RTTINC or ALMS) occurs within the same slow clock cycle during which the
RTT_SR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared. This can lead to the loss of this event.
Problem Fix/Workaround:
The software must handle the RTT event as an interrupt and should not poll RTT_SR.
44.4.7
44.4.7.1
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
SPI: Bad tx_ready Behavior when CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1
If the SPI2 is programmed with CSAAT = 1, SCBR(baudrate) = 1 and two transfers are performed consecutively on the same slave with an IDLE state between them, the tx_ready signal
does not rise after the second data has been transferred in the shifter. This can imply for example, that the second data is sent twice.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not use the combination CSAAT = 1 and SCBR = 1.
44.4.7.2
SPI: LASTXFER (Last Transfer) Behavior
In FIXED Mode, with CSAAT bit set, and in “PDC mode” the Chip Select can rise depending on
the data written in the SPI_TDR when the TX_EMPTY flag is set. If for example, the PDC writes
a “1” in the bit 24 (LASTXFER bit) of the SPI_TDR, the chip select will rise as soon as the
TXEMPTY flag is set.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Use the CS in PIO mode when PDC mode is required and CS has to be maintained between
transfers.
44.4.7.3
SPI: SPCK Behavior in Master Mode
SPCK pin can toggle out before the first transfer in Master Mode.
Problem Fix/Workaround
In Master Mode, MSTR bit must be set (in SPI_MR register) before configuring SPI_CSRx
registers.
44.4.7.4
SPI: Chip Select and Fixed Mode
In fixed Mode, if a transfer is performed through a PDC on a Chip select different from the Chip
select 0, the output spi_size sampled by the PDC will depend on the field, BITS (Bits per Transfer) of SPI_CSR0 register, whatever the selected Chip select is. For example, if SPI_CSR0 is
configured for a 10-bit transfer whereas SPI_CSR1 is configured for an 8-bit transfer, when a
703
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
transfer is performed in Fixed mode through the PDC, on Chip select 1, the transfer will be considered as a HalfWord transfer.
Problem Fix/Workaround
If a PDC transfer has to be performed in 8 bits, on a Chip select y (y as different from 0), the
BITS field of the SPI_CSR0 must be configured in 8 bits, in the same way as the BITS field of
the CSRy Register.
44.4.7.5
SPI: Baudrate Set to 1
When Baudrate is set at 1 (i.e. when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency)
and when the BITS field of the SPI_CSR register (number of bits to be transmitted) equals an
ODD value (in this case 9,11,13 or 15), an additional pulse will be generated on output SPCK.
Everything is OK if the BITS field equals 8,10,12,14 or 16 and Baudrate = 1.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.4.7.6
SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select
Bad Serial clock generation on the 2nd chip select when SCBR = 1, CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0.
This occurs using SPI with the following conditions:
• Master Mode
• CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0
• Multiple chip selects are used with one transfer with Baud rate (SCBR) equal to 1 (i.e., when
serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and the other transfers set with
SCBR are not equal to 1
• Transmitting with the slowest chip select and then with the fastest one, then an additional
pulse is generated on output SPCK during the second transfer.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not use a multiple Chip Select configuration where at least one SCRx register is configured
with SCBR = 1 and the others differ from 1 if NCPHA = 0 and CPOL = 1.
If all chip selects are configured with Baudrate = 1, the issue does not appear.
44.4.7.7
SPI: Software Reset must be Written Twice
If a software reset (SWRST in the SPI Control Register) is performed, the SPI may not work
properly (the clock is enabled before the chip select.)
Problem Fix/Workaround
The SPI Control Register field, SWRST (Software Reset) needs to be written twice to be correctly set.
44.4.8
44.4.8.1
Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC)
SSC: Periodic Transmission Limitations in Master Mode
If the Least Significant Bit is sent first (MSBF = 0), the first TAG during the frame synchro is not
sent.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
704
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
44.4.8.2
SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode
If TK is programmed as output and TF is programmed as input, it is impossible to emit data
when the start of edge (rising or falling) of synchro has a Start Delay equal to zero.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.4.8.3
SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode
If TK is programmed as an input and TF is programmed as an output and requested to be set to
low/high during data emission, the Frame Synchro signal is generated one bit clock period after
the data start and one data bit is lost. This problem does not exist when generating a periodic
synchro.
Problem Fix/Workaround
The data need to be delayed for one bit clock period with an external assembly. In the following
schematic, TD, TK and NRST are AT91SAM7XC signals, TXD is the delayed data to connect to
the device.
44.4.9
44.4.9.1
Two-wire Interface (TWI)
TWI: Clock Divider
The value of CLDIV x 2CKDIV must be less than or equal to 8191, the value of CHDIV x 2CKDIV
must be less than or equal to 8191⋅
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.4.9.2
TWI: Disabling Does not Operate Correctly
Any transfer in progress is immediately frozen if the Control Register (TWI_CR) is written with
the bit MSDIS at 1. Furthermore, the status bits TXCOMP and TXRDY in the Status Register
(TWI_SR) are not reset.
Problem Fix/Workaround
705
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
The user must wait for the end of transfer before disabling the TWI. In addition, the interrupts
must be disabled before disabling the TWI.
44.4.9.3
TWI: NACK Status Bit Lost
During a master frame, if TWI_SR is read between the Non Acknowledge condition detection
and the TXCOMP bit rising in the TWI_SR, the NACK bit is not set.
Problem Fix/Workaround
The user must wait for the TXCOMP status bit by interrupt and must not read the TWI_SR as
long as transmission is not completed.
TXCOMP and NACK fields are set simultaneously and the NACK field is reset after the read of
the TWI_SR.
44.4.9.4
TWI: Possible Receive Holding Register Corruption
When loading the TWI_RHR, the transfer direction is ignored. The last data byte received in the
TWI_RHR is corrupted at the end of the first subsequent transmit data byte. Neither RXRDY nor
OVERRUN status bits are set if this occurs.
Problem Fix/Workaround
The user must be sure that received data is read before transmitting any new data.
44.4.9.5
TWI: Software Reset
when a software reset is performed during a frame and when TWCK is low, it is impossible to initiate a new transfer in READ or WRITE mode.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.4.10
44.4.10.1
Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART)
USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking
When Hardware Handshaking is used and if CTS goes low near the end of the start bit, a character can be lost.
CTS must not go high during a time slot occurring between 2 Master Clock periods before and
16 Master Clock periods after the rising edge of the start bit.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None.
44.4.10.2
USART: Hardware Handshaking – Two Characters Sent
If CTS switches from 0 to 1 during the TX of a character and if the holding register (US_THR) is
not empty, the content of US_THR will also be transmitted.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Don't use the PDC in transmit mode and do not fill US_THR before TXEMPTY is set at 1.
44.4.10.3
USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode
When timeguard is 0, RXBRK is not set when the break character is located just after the Stop
bit. FRAME (Frame Error) is set instead.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Timeguard should be > 0.
706
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
44.4.10.4
USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low.
The DCD signal is active at High level in the USART Modem Mode .
DCD should be active at Low level.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Add an inverter
707
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
708
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
45. Revision History
The most recent version appears first in the tables that follow.
Version
6209F
Comments
Change
Request
Ref.
FFPI:
Section 21.2 ”Parallel Fast Flash Programming”, Section 21.2.1 ”Device Configuration”, added status of PIOs 5059
and Crystal Oscillator
Section 21.3 ”Serial Fast Flash Programming”, Section 21.3.1 ”Device Configuration”, added status of PIOs
and Crystal Oscillator
Mechanical Characteristics:
Table 41-4, “LQFP Package Characteristics” Symbol line A, Inch Max value is 0.063.
PMC:
Section 26.9.1 ”PMC System Clock Enable Register”, Section 26.9.2 ”PMC System Clock Disable Register”
and Section 26.9.3 ”PMC System Clock Status Register”, bitfield 11 contains PCK3.
5608
5722
Errata:
Section 44.4 ”AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. B Parts”, added to erata.
6064
Ordering Information:
Section 42. ”AT91SAM7XC Ordering Information”, MLR B parts added to ordering information.
Version
6209E
Comments
Overview,
“Features”,TWI updated to include Atmel TWI compatibility with I2C Standard.
“Features”, “Debug Unit (DBGU)” added “Mode for General Purpose 2-wire UART Serial Communication”
Section 10.8 ”Two-wire Interface”, updated.
Section 10.11 ”Timer Counter” The TC has Two output compare or one input capture per channel.
Section 10.17 ”Analog-to-Digital Converter” INL and DNL updated.
Table 3-1, “Signal Description List” footnote added to JTAGSEL, ERASE and TST pin comments
Section 6.1 ”JTAG Port Pins”, Section 6.2 ”Test Pin” and Section 6.4 ”ERASE Pin” updated.
Figure 9-1,”System Controller Block Diagram”, RTT is reset by power_on_reset.
Figure 8-1,”AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Memory Mapping”, TDES base address is 0xFFFA 8000
Section 8.4.3 ”Internal Flash”,updated: “At any time, the Flash is mapped ... if GPNVM bit 2 is set and before
the Remap Command.”
Change
Request
Ref.
4247
5846
4211
4008
5068
5225
5257
5850
ADC,
Section 35.6.2 ”ADC Mode Register”, PRESCAL and STARTUP bit fields widened.
4430
“SHTIM: Sample & Hold Time” on page 496, formula updated in bit description.
5254
Figure 35-1,”Analog-to-Digital Converter Block Diagram”, VDDANA replaced by VDDIN. PMC added to figure. rfo
Section 35.5.5 ”Conversion Triggers”, update to the third paragraph detailing hardware trigger.
AIC,
Section 24.8.16 ”AIC Spurious Interrupt Vector Register”, typo fixed in bit fields. (SIQV is SIVR).
Section 24.7.5 ”Protect Mode”, writing PROT in AIC_DCR enables protection mode (3rd paragraph).
4749
5193
709
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Version
6209E
(Continued) Comments
Change
Request
Ref.
AES,
Section 36.3.4.1 ”Countermeasures” and Section 36.4.1 ”AES Control Register” LOADSEED description
updated.
4977
CAN,
Figure 38-7,”Line Error Mode” Conditions to switch from Error Active mode to Error Passive mode and vice
4089
versa have been inverted.
Section 38.6.4.6 ”Error Interrupt Handler”, added to datasheet.
4736
Section 38.8.5 ”CAN Status Register”, added references to the new chapter in bit descriptions, WARN, BOFF,
ERRA, ERRP.
Debug and Test,
Section 12.5.5 ”ID Code Register”, AT91SAM7XC512 product part number and JTAG ID code value updated. 4447
Section 12.5.3 ”Debug Unit”, Debug Unit chip ID, typo corrected.
DBGU,
Section 27.1 ”Overview”, ...”two-pin UART can be used standalone for general purpose serial communication.
Section 27.5.10 ”Debug Unit Chip ID Register”, SRAM bit description added for AT91SAM7L in the bit field.
“SRAMSIZ: Internal SRAM Size” on page 254
Corrected bin values for 0x60 and 0xF0 and Architecture Identifier bit description for CAP7, AT91SAM7AQxx
Series and CAP11 in the bit description, “ARCH: Architecture Identifier” on page 255
EMAC,
Section 39.5.3 ”Network Status Register”, Corrected status for IDLE bit.
Section 39.3 ”Functional Description”, Added information on clocks in first paragraph.
5846
3828
3369,
3807
3326
3328
FFPI,
Table 21-6, Table 21-7 and Table 21-15 updated.
Global update to terms listed below:
Fuse →GPNVM
SFB →SGPB
CFB →CGPB
GFB →GGPB
Section 21.2.5.6 on page 154 & Section 21.3.4.6 on page 161, security bit restraint on access to FFPI
explained.
4410
3933
4744
MC,
Table 19-1, “Register Mapping,” on page 126, updated table with line for EFC1, offset 0x70, with note specific 4448
to AT91SAM7XC521
PIO,
Section 15.4.5 “Synchronous Data Output” on page 86, PIO_OWSR typo corrected.
Section 15.6 “Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) User Interface” on page 90, 10, footnotes updated on
PIO_PSR, PIO_ODSR, PIO_PDSR in Register Mapping table.
PMC,
Section 26.3 ”Processor Clock Controller” ....the processor clock can be disabled by writing.... PMC_SDR.
Figure 25-2,”Typical Crystal Connection” updated, removed CL1 and CL2 labels.
3289
3974
3835
3861
PWM,
Turned channel-dependent registers into indexed registers: Table 33-2, “Register Mapping”. See Section
4486
33.6.9 ”PWM Channel Mode Register”, Section 33.6.10 ”PWM Channel Duty Cycle Register”, Section 33.6.11
”PWM Channel Period Register”, Section 33.6.12 ”PWM Channel Counter Register”and Section 33.6.13 ”PWM
Channel Update Register”
Section 33.6.12 ”PWM Channel Counter Register”, typos corrected in bit description.
5185
710
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Version
6209E
(Continued) Comments
RSTC,
Section 13.2.4.4 ”Software Reset”, PERRST must be used with PROCRST, except for debug purposes.
SPI,
Section 28.6.4 “SPI Slave Mode” on page 267, corrected information on OVRES (SPI_SR) and data read in
SPI_RDR.
SSC,
Section 30.6.5.1 ”Frame Sync Data”, defined max Frame Sync Data length.
Section 30.6.6.1 ”Compare Functions”, updated with max FSLEN length.
Section 30.8.3 ”SSC Receive Clock Mode Register”, Corrected bit name to STTDLY
,
Change
Request
Ref.
5436
3943
2293
4773
TC,
3342
Figure 32-2,”Clock Chaining Selection”, added to Section 32.5 ”Functional Description”.
Section 32.6 ”Timer Counter (TC) User Interface”, register mapping w/indexed register scheme, consolidated in 4583
one table.
Section 32.6.3 on page 410 to Section 32.6.13 on page 424, register names updated w/indexed values, WAVE
value added where relevant.
Section 32.6.2 ”TC Block Mode Register”, typo corrected in bit fields 2 and 3.
Section 32.6.4 ”TC Channel Mode Register: Capture Mode”, bit filed 15 updated.
TWI,
“Two-wire Interface (TWI)”, section has been updated.
Important changes to this datasheet include a clarification of Atmel TWI compatibility with I2C Standard.
UDP,
Table 34-2, “USB Communication Flow”, Supported Endpoint column updated.
In the USB_CSR register, the control endpoints are not effected by the bit field, “EPEDS: Endpoint Enable
Disable” on page 484
Updated: write 1 =.... in “RX_DATA_BK0: Receive Data Bank 0” bit field of USB_CSR register.
Updated: write 0 = ....in “TXPKTRDY: Transmit Packet Ready” bit field of USB_CSR register.
Section 34.6.10 “UDP Endpoint Control and Status Register” on page 480, update to code and added
instructions regarding USB clock and system clock cycle, and updated “note” appearing under the code. “wait 3
USB clock cycles and 3 system clock cycles before accessing DPR from RX_DATAx and TXPKTRDY bit fields,
ditto for RX_DATAx and TXPKTRDY bit field descriptions.”
Section 34.2 ”Block Diagram”, in the text below the block diagram, MCK specified as clock used by Master
Clock domain, UDPCK specified as 48 MHz clock used by 12 MHz domain, in peripheral clock requirements.
Section 34.6 ”USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface”, the register mapping table has been updated.
Section 34.6.6 ”UDP Interrupt Mask Register”, Bit 12 of UDP_IMR cannot be masked and is always read at 1.
Section 34.6 ”USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface”, reset value for UDP_RST_EP is 0x000_0000.
Table 34-1, “USB Endpoint Description”, footnote added to Dual-Bank heading.
Section 34.5.2.5 ”Transmit Data Cancellation”, added to datasheet
Section 34.6.9 ”UDP Reset Endpoint Register”, added steps to clear endpoints.
4247
3476
4063
4099
4462
4487
4508
4802
5049
5150
711
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Version
6209E
(Continued) Comments
Change
Request
Ref.
USART,
“CLKO: Clock Output Select” on page 377, bit field in US_MR register, typo fixed in bit field description.
“USCLKS: Clock Selection” on page 375, bit field in US_MR register, DIV= 8 in Selected Clock column.
Section 31.5.1 ”I/O Lines”, 2nd and 3rd paragraphsupdated.
“TXEMPTY: Transmitter Empty” on page 382, no characters when at 1 updated.
Section 31.6.2 ”Receiver and Transmitter Control”, In the fourth paragraph, Software reset effects (RSTRX and
RSTTX in US_CR register) updated by replacing 2nd sentence.
Section 31.6.5 ”IrDA Mode”, updated with instruction to receive IrDA signals.
Section 31.2 ”Block Diagram”, signal directions from pads to PIO updted in the block diagram.
Electrical Characteristics,
Section 40.7 ”ADC Characteristics”, INL and DN updated and Absolute accuracy added to Table 40-18,
“Transfer Characteristics”, reference to Data Converter Terminology added below table.
Table 40.3.2, “Peripheral Power Consumption in Active Mode” AES and TDES added to Table 40-18
Table 40-9, “Main Oscillator Characteristics”, added schematic in footnote to CL and CLEXT symbols.
Table 40-11, “XIN Clock Electrical Characteristics” ,added tCLCH and tCHCL to table, tCHXIN and tCLXIN updated.
Figure 40-2, ”XIN CLock Timing” on page 662, added figure.
Table 40-6, “Power Consumption for Different Modes”; Footnote assigned to Flash In standby mode. Footnote
assigned to Ultra Low Power mode.
Table 40-2, “DC Characteristics”, CMOS conditions added to IO for VOL and VOH.
Table 40-2, “DC Characteristics”, removed reference to Tj.
Table 40-16, “External Voltage Reference Input”, added ADVREF input w/conditions “8-bit resolution mode”.
Section 41.1 “Thermal Considerations”, removed.
Table 41-3, “Package Reference”, JESD97 Classification is e3
Table 40-25, “Embedded Flash Wait States (AT91SAM7XC256/128)” and Table 40-26, “Embedded Flash Wait
States (AT91SAM7XC512)” The prododuct specific embedded Flash Wait States are defined.
Errata,
Section 44.2 ”AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. A Parts”
Section 44.2.2 ”Controller Area Network (CAN)”, added
Section 44.2.10.1 ”USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking”, updated.
Section 44.2.10.3 ”USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode”,added
Section 44.2.10.4 ”USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low.”,added
Section 44.2.7.6 ”SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select”
Section 44.2.1 ”Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)”, added.
USART: XOFF Character Bad Behavior, removed
Section 44.3 ”AT91SAM7XC512 Errata - Rev. A Parts”
Section 44.3.2 ”Controller Area Network (CAN)”, added.
Section 44.3.3 ”Embedded FLash Controller (EFC)”, ”EFC: Embedded Flash Access Time” added.
Section 44.3.11.1 ”USART: CTS in Hardware Handshaking” updated.
Section 44.3.11.3 ”USART: RXBRK Flag Error in Asynchronous Mode”, added
Section 44.3.11.4 ”USART: DCD is Active High instead of Low.”, added
Section 44.3.8.6 ”SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on 2nd Chip Select”, added
Section 44.3.8.7 ”SPI: Software Reset must be Written Twice”, added
Section 44.3.1 ”Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)”,added
USART: XOFF Character Bad Behavior, removed
712
3306
3763
3851/4825
3895
4367
4912
4905
4008
3485
3869
3968
4597/4599
rfo
4661
rfo
4970
5363
4649
3957
4644
4753
5339
4649
5990
3957
4644
4753
5787
5339
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Version
6209D
Comments
AT91SAM7XC512 added to product family. “Features” on page 1, “Description” on page 3 Global and
TFBGA package to Section 4. ”Package”, Section 41. ”AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Mechanical
Characteristics” and Section 42. ”AT91SAM7XC Ordering Information”.
Peripheral and System Controller Memory Maps consolidated in Figure 8-1 on page 18
Internal Memory Area 3 is “Internal ROM” Figure 18-3 on page 95
Change
Request
Ref.
#2724
IP Block Evolution:
RSTC:Section 13.3 ”Functional Description” added information on startup counter for crystal
oscillator.
3005
RTT: Section 14.3 ”Functional Description”: Note (asynchronization between SCLK and MCK) added
to end of section.
2522
WDT: “Block Diagram” on page 85 replaced. (WV changed to WDV) “Functional Description” on page
86 6th and 7th paragraph changed.
3002
EFC: Section 19. ”Embedded Flash Controller (EFC)” updated to reflect EFC configuration for
AT91SAM7XC512 with multiple EFCs.
2356
3086
SAM Boot: Section 21.5 “Hardware and Software Constraints” on page 139 updated
Section 21.4 “SAM-BA Boot” on page 135 SAM-BA boot principle changed.
Figure 21-1, ”Boot Program Algorithm Flow Diagram” on page 135 flow diagram replaced
2285, 2618
3050
PDC: Corrected description of user interface in Section 22.1 “Overview” on page 141.
Corrected bit name to ENDTX in Section 22.3.3 “Transfer Counters” on page 142.
AIC: Section 23.7.3.1 “Priority Controller” on page 158: incorrect reference of SRCTYPE field to
AIC_SVR register changed to AIC_SMR register.
Section 23.8 “Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) User Interface” on page 166, Table 23-2: Added
note (2) in reference to PID2...PID31 bit fields.
Naming convention for AIC_FVR register harmonized in Table 23-2, Section 23.8.6 “AIC FIQ Vector
Register” on page 169 and Section 23.7.4.5 “Fast Forcing” on page 162.
PMC: Section 25.7 “Programming Sequence” on page 183 change to Step 4. on page 184, “Selection
of Master Clock and Processor Clock” and to code.
Corrected name of bitfield PRES in Section 25.9.10 “PMC Master Clock Register” on page 199.
Removed reference to PMC_ACKR register in Table 25-2, “Register Mapping,” on page 190.
Updated OUTx bit descriptions in Section 25.9.9 “PMC Clock Generator PLL Register” on page 198.
Added note defining PIDx in Section 25.9.4 “PMC Peripheral Clock Enable Register” on page 194,
Section 25.9.5 “PMC Peripheral Clock Disable Register” on page 194 and Section 25.9.6 “PMC
Peripheral Clock Status Register” on page 195.
Changed Section 24.2 “Slow Clock RC Oscillator” on page 177.
05-460
2512
2548
05-506
1603
1719
2467, 2913
2468
1558
DBGU: Corrected references from ice_nreset to Power-on Reset in Figure 26-1 on page 206,
Functional Block Diagram, and in FNTRST bit description in Section 26.5.12 “Debug Unit Force
NTRST Register” on page 228.
2832
PIO: Section 27.5.4 “Output Control” on page 233, typo corrected.
Section 27.5.1 “Pull-up Resistor Control” on page 233 reference to resistor value removed
Figure 27-3, ”I/O Line Control Logic” on page 232 change to I/O Line Control Logic
05-346
05-497
3053
713
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Version
6209D
(Continued)
Change
Request
Ref.
Comments
SPI: Section 28.7.5 “SPI Status Register” on page 273 SPI_RCR, SPI_RNCR, SPI_TCR, SPI_TNCR
location defined.
Section 28.7.4 “SPI Transmit Data Register” on page 272, LASTXFER: Last Transfer text added.
Section 28.7.2 “SPI Mode Register” on page 269, PCSDEC: Chip Select Decode changed.
Updated Figure 28-1, ”Block Diagram” on page 256, removed Note. Removed bit FDIV from Section
28.7.2 “SPI Mode Register” on page 269 and Section 28.7.9 “SPI Chip Select Register” on page 278.
LLB description modified in Section 28.7.2 “SPI Mode Register” on page 269.
Updated Figure 28-9, ”Slave Mode Functional Block Diagram” on page 266 to remove FLOAD.
Updated information on SPI_RDR in Section 28.6.3 “Master Mode Operations” on page 260. Added
information to SWRST bit description in Section 28.7.1 “SPI Control Register” on page 268. Corrected
equations in DLYBCT bit description, Section 28.7.9 ”SPI Chip Select Register” on page 279.
Changes to Section 28.6.3.8 “Mode Fault Detection” on page 265.
TWI: Section 29.6 ”TWI User Interface”: OVRE and UNRE bit fields removed from Status and Interrupt
Registers.
USART:
MANCHESTER FUNCTIONALITY REMOVED.
Section 30.5.1 “I/O Lines” on page 302, text concerning TXD line added.
Section 30.6.1.3 “Fractional Baud Rate in Asynchronous Mode” on page 305, using USART
“functional mode” changed to USART “normal mode”.
Table 30-3, “Binary and Decimal Values for Di,” on page 307 and Table 30-4, “Binary and Decimal
Values for Fi,” on page 307: DI and Fi properly referenced in titles.
Figure 30-25, ”IrDA Demodulator Operations” on page 323 modified.
Section 30.6.4.1 “ISO7816 Mode Overview” on page 319 clarification of PAR configuration added.
Section 30.6.7 “Modem Mode” on page 325 Control of DTR and RTS output pins.
Table 30-2, “Baud Rate Example (OVER = 0),” on page 304 lines showing over 50 000 000 MHz
clocks removed.
Section 30.6.3.2 ”Asynchronous Receiver” changed 2nd sentence in 4th paragraph “For the
synchronization Mechanism......”
Section 30.6.3.8 ”Receiver Time-out” list of user options rewritten.
Section 30.7.1 ”USART Control Register” STTTO bit function related to TIMEOUT in US_CSR register
Section 30.7.6 ”USART Channel Status Register” TIMEOUT bit function related to STTTO in US_CR
register
714
04-183
05-434
05-476
05-484
1542
1543
1676
2470
#2768
1552
1770
2942
3023
TC: Section 31.5.3.6 “External Event/Trigger Conditions” on page 359 “....(EEVT = 0), TIOB is no
longer used as an output and the compare register B is not used to generate waveforms and
subsequently no IRQs. Note (1) attached to ”EEVT: External Event Selection” in Section 31.6.7 “TC
Channel Mode Register: Waveform Mode” on page 367 further clarifies this condition.
2704
PWM: Section 32.5.3.3 ”Changing the Duty Cycle or the Period”: updated info on waveform
generation.
1677
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Version
6209D
(Continued)
Comments
UDP: Added warning to Section 33.6 “USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface” on page 418, to UDP_
TXVC (3), to Section 33.6.12 “UDP Transceiver Control Register” on page 434 and to Section 33.3.2
“Power Management” on page 401.
Corrections, improvements, additions and deletions throughout section, new source document.
Section 33.5.3.8 ”Sending a Device Remote Wakeup” replaces title: “Sending an External Resume.
WAKEUP bit shown in interruput registers: Section 33.6.4 on page 422 thru Section 33.6.8 on page
427
RMWUPE, RSMINPR, ESR bits removed from Section 33.6.2 ”UDP Global State Register”.
NOTE: pertinent to USB pullup effect on USB Reset added to Section 33.6.12 ”UDP Transceiver
Control Register”
ADC:Section 35.5.7 ”ADC Timings” in Warning: “See ADC Characteristics....” typo fixed
Figure 35-1, ”Analog-to-Digital Converter Block Diagram” on page 473 dedicated and I/O lines
differentiated in new block diagram.
Change
Request
Ref.
05-413
3288
2830
3052
AES: Section 36. “Advanced Encryption Standard (AES)” on page 493 updated to reflect AES
configuration for AT91SAM7XC512.
CAN: Update to message acceptance example in Section 38.6.2.1 “Message Acceptance Procedure”
on page 538.
New information on byte priority added to Section 38.8.17 “CAN Message Data Low Register” on
page 586 and Section 38.8.18 “CAN Message Data High Register” on page 587.
Corrected MDL bit description in Section 38.8.17 “CAN Message Data Low Register” on page 586.
Update to specify allowed values for BRP field on Section 38.6.4 ”CAN 2.0 Standard Features”, page
543 and in Section 38.8.6 “CAN Baudrate Register” on page 573.
EMAC: “Interrupt Enable Register” on page 617, access changed to Write-only.
“Interrupt Disable Register” on page 618, access changed to Write-only.
“Interrupt Mask Register” on page 619, access changed to Read-only.
2295, 2296
2476
2597
1725
715
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Version
6209D
(Continued)
Comments
Change
Request
Ref.
Section 40. ”AT91SAM7XC Electrical Characteristics”
“Absolute Maximum Ratings” on page 639, change to Maximum Operating Voltages.
3060
Electrical and Mechanical Characteristics: Changed conditions of parameters IPULLUP and ILEAK in
Table 40-2, “DC Characteristics,” on page 640.
Updated Table 40-5, “DC Flash Characteristics AT91SAM7XC512/256/128,” on page 641 and
Table 40-9, “Main Oscillator Characteristics,” on page 644.
Added Table 40-10, “Crystal Characteristics,” on page 645.
Updated IDDBP in Table 40-11, “XIN Clock Electrical Characteristics,” on page 645.
Added information on data sampling in SPI master mode to Table 40-21, “SPI Timings,” on page 652.
Added Table 40-24, “EMAC RMII Specific Signals (pertains only to AT91SAM7XC512),” on page 655
and Figure 40-8, ”EMAC RMII Mode” on page 655.
Errata updated:
Added Section 44.1 “Marking” on page 665.
Added new Section 44.3 “AT91SAM7XC512 Errata - Rev. A Parts” on page 672.
Updated Section 44.2 ”AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. A Parts”:
Section 44.2.4.1 ”RTT: Possible Event Loss when Reading RTT_SR”
Section 44.2.5.4 ”SPI: Chip Select and Fixed Mode”
Section 44.2.5.5 ”SPI: Baudrate Set to 1”
TWI: Behavior of OVRE Bit (removed)
Section 44.2.7.5 ”TWI: Software Reset”
Section 44.2.8.2 ”USART: Hardware Handshaking – Two Characters Sent”
Section 44.2.8.3 ”USART: XOFF Character Bad Behavior”
716
#2872
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Version
Comments
6209C
The following errata have been added:
Section 44.2.1.2 ”EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading EMAC_ISR”
Section 44.2.1.3 ”EMAC: Possible Event Loss when Reading the Statistics Register Block”
Section 44.2.5.3 ”SPI: SPCK Behavior in Master Mode”
Section 44.2.2.1 ”PIO: Leakage on PB27 - PB30”: worst case leakage changed to 9 µA.
6209B
Section 44. ”Errata”
Device package/product number changed
Section 44.2.1.1 ”EMAC: RMII Mode” RMII mode is not functional
The sections listed below have been added:
Section 44.2.3 ”Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM)”
Section 44.2.5 ”Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)”
Section 44.2.6 ”Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC)”
Section 44.2.7 ”Two-wire Interface (TWI)”
Section 44.2.8 ”Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART)”
6209A
First Issue
Change
Request
Ref.
2456
2606
1765
717
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
718
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
Table of Contents
1
Description ............................................................................................... 4
1.1- Configuration Summary of the AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 ....................................4
2
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Block Diagram ............................................. 5
3
Signal Description ................................................................................... 6
4
Package .................................................................................................... 9
4.1- 100-lead LQFP Package Outline ............................................................................9
4.2- 100-lead LQFP Pinout ..........................................................................................10
4.3- 100-ball TFBGA Package Outline .........................................................................11
4.4- 100-ball TFBGA Pinout .........................................................................................11
5
Power Considerations ........................................................................... 12
5.1- Power Supplies .....................................................................................................12
5.2- Power Consumption ..............................................................................................12
5.3- Voltage Regulator .................................................................................................12
5.4- Typical Powering Schematics ...............................................................................13
6
I/O Lines Considerations ....................................................................... 14
6.1- JTAG Port Pins .....................................................................................................14
6.2- Test Pin .................................................................................................................14
6.3- Reset Pin ...............................................................................................................14
6.4- ERASE Pin ............................................................................................................14
6.5- PIO Controller Lines ..............................................................................................14
6.6- I/O Lines Current Drawing .....................................................................................15
7
Processor and Architecture .................................................................. 16
7.1- ARM7TDMI Processor ..........................................................................................16
7.2- Debug and Test Features .....................................................................................16
7.3- Memory Controller .................................................................................................16
7.4- Peripheral DMA Controller ....................................................................................17
8
Memory ................................................................................................... 18
8.1- AT91SAM7XC512 .................................................................................................18
8.2- AT91SAM7XC256 .................................................................................................18
8.3- AT91SAM7XC128 .................................................................................................18
8.4- Memory Mapping ..................................................................................................20
8.5- Embedded Flash ...................................................................................................21
i
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
8.6- Fast Flash Programming Interface ........................................................................23
8.7- SAM-BA Boot Assistant ........................................................................................23
9
System Controller .................................................................................. 25
9.1- Reset Controller ....................................................................................................27
9.2- Clock Generator ....................................................................................................28
9.3- Power Management Controller .............................................................................29
9.4- Advanced Interrupt Controller ...............................................................................29
9.5- Debug Unit ............................................................................................................30
9.6- Periodic Interval Timer ..........................................................................................30
9.7- Watchdog Timer ....................................................................................................30
9.8- Real-time Timer .....................................................................................................30
9.9- PIO Controllers ......................................................................................................31
9.10- Voltage Regulator Controller ...............................................................................31
10 Peripherals ............................................................................................. 32
10.1- User Interface ......................................................................................................32
10.2- Peripheral Identifiers ...........................................................................................32
10.3- Peripheral Multiplexing on PIO Lines ..................................................................33
10.4- PIO Controller A Multiplexing ..............................................................................34
10.5- PIO Controller B Multiplexing ..............................................................................35
10.6- Ethernet MAC ......................................................................................................36
10.7- Serial Peripheral Interface ...................................................................................36
10.8- Two-wire Interface ...............................................................................................37
10.9- USART ................................................................................................................37
10.10- Serial Synchronous Controller ..........................................................................37
10.11- Timer Counter ...................................................................................................38
10.12- Pulse Width Modulation Controller ....................................................................38
10.13- USB Device Port ...............................................................................................39
10.14- CAN Controller ..................................................................................................39
10.15- 128-bit Advanced Encryption Standard .............................................................39
10.16- Triple Data Encryption Standard .......................................................................40
10.17- Analog-to-Digital Converter ...............................................................................40
11 ARM7TDMI Processor Overview .......................................................... 43
11.1- Overview .............................................................................................................43
11.2- ARM7TDMI Processor ........................................................................................44
12 Debug and Test Features ...................................................................... 49
ii
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
12.1- Description ..........................................................................................................49
12.2- Block Diagram .....................................................................................................49
12.3- Application Examples ..........................................................................................50
12.4- Debug and Test Pin Description .........................................................................51
12.5- Functional Description .........................................................................................52
13 Reset Controller (RSTC) ........................................................................ 59
13.1- Block Diagram .....................................................................................................59
13.2- Functional Description .........................................................................................60
13.3- Reset Controller (RSTC) User Interface ..............................................................70
14 Real-time Timer (RTT) ............................................................................ 75
14.1- Overview .............................................................................................................75
14.2- Block Diagram .....................................................................................................75
14.3- Functional Description .........................................................................................75
14.4- Real-time Timer (RTT) User Interface .................................................................77
15 Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) .................................................. 81
15.1- Overview .............................................................................................................81
15.2- Block Diagram .....................................................................................................82
15.3- Product Dependencies ........................................................................................83
15.4- Functional Description .........................................................................................84
15.5- I/O Lines Programming Example ........................................................................89
15.6- Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) User Interface ..........................................90
16 Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) ............................................................... 107
16.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................107
16.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................107
16.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................108
16.4- Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) User Interface ......................................................110
17 Watchdog Timer (WDT) ....................................................................... 113
17.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................113
17.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................113
17.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................114
17.4- Watchdog Timer (WDT) User Interface .............................................................116
18 Voltage Regulator Mode Controller (VREG) ...................................... 119
18.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................119
18.2- Voltage Regulator Power Controller (VREG) User Interface .............................120
iii
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
19 Memory Controller (MC) ...................................................................... 121
19.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................121
19.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................121
19.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................122
19.4- Memory Controller (MC) User Interface ............................................................126
20 Embedded Flash Controller (EFC) ..................................................... 131
20.1- Overview ..........................................................................................................131
20.2- Functional Description .......................................................................................131
20.3- Embedded Flash Controller (EFC ) User Interface ...........................................141
21 Fast Flash Programming Interface (FFPI) .......................................... 147
21.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................147
21.2- Parallel Fast Flash Programming ......................................................................147
21.3- Serial Fast Flash Programming .........................................................................156
22 AT91SAM Boot Program ..................................................................... 163
22.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................163
22.2- Flow Diagram ....................................................................................................163
22.3- Device Initialization ...........................................................................................163
22.4- SAM-BA Boot ....................................................................................................164
22.5- Hardware and Software Constraints .................................................................168
23 Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) ....................................................... 169
23.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................169
23.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................169
23.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................170
23.4- Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) User Interface ..............................................172
24 Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) .................................................. 179
24.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................179
24.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................179
24.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................180
24.4- AIC Detailed Block Diagram ..............................................................................180
24.5- I/O Line Description ...........................................................................................180
24.6- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................181
24.7- Functional Description .......................................................................................182
24.8- Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) User Interface ..........................................194
25 Clock Generator ................................................................................... 205
iv
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
25.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................205
25.2- Slow Clock RC Oscillator ..................................................................................205
25.3- Main Oscillator ..................................................................................................205
25.4- Divider and PLL Block .......................................................................................207
26 Power Management Controller (PMC) ................................................ 209
26.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................209
26.2- Master Clock Controller .....................................................................................209
26.3- Processor Clock Controller ................................................................................210
26.4- USB Clock Controller ........................................................................................210
26.5- Peripheral Clock Controller ...............................................................................210
26.6- Programmable Clock Output Controller ............................................................211
26.7- Programming Sequence ...................................................................................211
26.8- Clock Switching Details .....................................................................................215
26.9- Power Management Controller (PMC) User Interface ......................................218
27 Debug Unit (DBGU) .............................................................................. 233
27.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................233
27.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................234
27.3- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................235
27.4- UART Operations ..............................................................................................235
27.5- Debug Unit User Interface ................................................................................242
28 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) ......................................................... 257
28.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................257
28.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................258
28.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................258
28.4- Signal Description ............................................................................................259
28.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................259
28.6- Functional Description .......................................................................................260
28.7- Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) User Interface ................................................269
29 Two-wire Interface (TWI) ..................................................................... 283
29.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................283
29.2- List of Abbreviations ..........................................................................................283
29.3- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................284
29.4- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................284
29.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................284
29.6- Functional Description .......................................................................................285
v
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
29.7- Two-wire Interface (TWI) User Interface ...........................................................296
30 Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) ................................................ 305
30.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................305
30.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................306
30.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................306
30.4- Pin Name List ....................................................................................................307
30.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................307
30.6- Functional Description .......................................................................................307
30.7- SSC Application Examples ...............................................................................318
30.8- Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) User Interface ........................................320
31 Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART)
343
31.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................343
31.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................344
31.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................345
31.4- I/O Lines Description ........................................................................................345
31.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................346
31.6- Functional Description .......................................................................................347
31.7- (Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART) User Interface 372
32 Timer Counter (TC) .............................................................................. 391
32.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................391
32.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................392
32.3- Pin Name List ....................................................................................................393
32.4- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................393
32.5- Functional Description .......................................................................................394
32.6- Timer Counter (TC) User Interface ....................................................................407
33 Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) ........................................ 425
33.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................425
33.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................425
33.3- I/O Lines Description .........................................................................................426
33.4- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................426
33.5- Functional Description .......................................................................................426
33.6- Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) User Interface ................................435
34 USB Device Port (UDP) ........................................................................ 449
vi
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
34.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................449
34.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................450
34.3- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................451
34.4- Typical Connection ............................................................................................452
34.5- Functional Description .......................................................................................454
34.6- USB Device Port (UDP) User Interface .............................................................468
35 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ..................................................... 487
35.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................487
35.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................487
35.3- Signal Description .............................................................................................488
35.4- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................488
35.5- Functional Description .......................................................................................489
35.6- Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) User Interface ............................................494
36 Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) ............................................... 507
36.1- Description ........................................................................................................507
36.2- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................507
36.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................507
36.4- Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) User Interface .......................................514
37 Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES) ........................................... 527
37.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................527
37.2- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................527
37.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................527
37.4- Triple Data Encryption Standard (TDES) User Interface ...................................534
38 Controller Area Network (CAN) .......................................................... 549
38.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................549
38.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................550
38.3- Application Block Diagram ................................................................................551
38.4- I/O Lines Description ........................................................................................551
38.5- Product Dependencies ......................................................................................551
38.6- CAN Controller Features ...................................................................................552
38.7- Functional Description .......................................................................................564
38.8- Controller Area Network (CAN) User Interface ................................................577
39 Ethernet MAC 10/100 (EMAC) ............................................................. 607
39.1- Overview ...........................................................................................................607
vii
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
39.2- Block Diagram ...................................................................................................607
39.3- Functional Description .......................................................................................608
39.4- Programming Interface ......................................................................................619
39.5- Ethernet MAC 10/100 (EMAC) User Interface ..................................................622
40 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Electrical Characteristics ....................... 655
40.1- Absolute Maximum Ratings ..............................................................................655
40.2- DC Characteristics ............................................................................................656
40.3- Power Consumption ..........................................................................................658
40.4- Crystal Oscillators Characteristics .....................................................................660
40.5- PLL Characteristics ...........................................................................................663
40.6- USB Transceiver Characteristics ......................................................................664
40.7- ADC Characteristics .........................................................................................666
40.8- AC Characteristics ............................................................................................667
41 AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Mechanical Characteristics .................... 676
41.1- Package Drawings ............................................................................................676
41.2- Soldering Profile ................................................................................................679
42 AT91SAM7XC Ordering Information .................................................. 680
43 Export Regulations Statement ............................................................ 680
44
Errata .................................................................................................... 681
44.1- Marking .............................................................................................................681
44.2- AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. A Parts ....................................................682
44.3- AT91SAM7XC512 Errata - Rev. A Parts ...........................................................690
44.4- AT91SAM7XC256/128 Errata - Rev. B Parts ....................................................699
45 Revision History ................................................................................... 709
viii
AT91SAM7XC512/256/128 Preliminary
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09
Headquarters
International
Atmel Corporation
2325 Orchard Parkway
San Jose, CA 95131
USA
Tel: 1(408) 441-0311
Fax: 1(408) 487-2600
Atmel Asia
Unit 1-5 & 16, 19/F
BEA Tower, Millennium City 5
418 Kwun Tong Road
Kwun Tong, Kowloon
Hong Kong
Tel: (852) 2245-6100
Fax: (852) 2722-1369
Atmel Europe
Le Krebs
8, Rue Jean-Pierre Timbaud
BP 309
78054 Saint-Quentin-enYvelines Cedex
France
Tel: (33) 1-30-60-70-00
Fax: (33) 1-30-60-71-11
Atmel Japan
9F, Tonetsu Shinkawa Bldg.
1-24-8 Shinkawa
Chuo-ku, Tokyo 104-0033
Japan
Tel: (81) 3-3523-3551
Fax: (81) 3-3523-7581
Technical Support
AT91SAM Support
Atmel techincal support
Sales Contacts
www.atmel.com/contacts/
Product Contact
Web Site
www.atmel.com
www.atmel.com/AT91SAM
Literature Requests
www.atmel.com/literature
Disclaimer: The information in this document is provided in connection with Atmel products. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise, to any
intellectual property right is granted by this document or in connection with the sale of Atmel products. EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN ATMEL’S TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE LOCATED ON ATMEL’S WEB SITE, ATMEL ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER AND DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY
WARRANTY RELATING TO ITS PRODUCTS INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE, OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL ATMEL BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE, SPECIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR LOSS OF INFORMATION) ARISING OUT
OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DOCUMENT, EVEN IF ATMEL HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Atmel makes no
representations or warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this document and reserves the right to make changes to specifications and product descriptions at any time without notice. Atmel does not make any commitment to update the information contained herein. Unless specifically provided otherwise, Atmel products are not suitable for, and shall not be used in, automotive applications. Atmel’s products are not intended, authorized, or warranted
for use as components in applications intended to support or sustain life.
© 2008 Atmel Corporation. All rights reserved. Atmel®, Atmel logo and combinations thereof, DataFlash ®, SAM-BA ® and others, are registered trademarks or trademarks of Atmel Corporation or its subsidiaries. Windows ® and others, are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the US and/or other countries. ARM ®, the ARM Powered® logo and others, are registered trademarks or trademarks of ARM Limited.
Other terms and product names may be the trademarks of others.
6209F–ATARM–17-Feb-09